Interiors: An Introduction

McGraw-Hill, 2011. — 529 p.Interiors: An Introduction is the starting point for a lifetime of design education, apprecia

405 21 53MB

English Pages [529]

Report DMCA / Copyright

DOWNLOAD PDF FILE

Recommend Papers

Interiors: An Introduction

  • Commentary
  • 870644
  • 0 0 0
  • Like this paper and download? You can publish your own PDF file online for free in a few minutes! Sign Up
File loading please wait...
Citation preview

Interiors An Introduction

To Asa and to Kristine and to all our kids, at home, at school, and wherever they may find themselves in the world.

Interiors An Introduction Fifth Edition

Karla J. Nielson Brigham Young University

David A. Taylor Brigham Young University

TM

TM

Published by McGraw-Hill, an imprint of The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc., 1221 Avenue of the Americas, New York, NY 10020. Copyright © 2011, 2007, 2002, 1994, 1990. All rights reserved. No part of this publication may be reproduced or distributed in any form or by any means, or stored in a database or retrieval system, without the prior written consent of The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc., including, but not limited to, in any network or other electronic storage or transmission, or broadcast for distance learning. This book is printed on acid-free paper. 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 DOW/DOW 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 ISBN: 978-0-07352650-8 MHID: 0-07-352650-9 Vice President Editorial: Michael Ryan Sponsoring Editor: Betty Chen Managing Editor: Meghan Campbell Developmental Editor: Janice Wiggins Executive Marketing Manager: Pamela S. Cooper Senior Production Editor: Carey Eisner Interior and Cover Design: Laurie Entringer Lead Photo Research Coordinator: Alexandra Ambrose Photo Researchers: Karla J. Nielson, assisted by David A. Taylor and Judy K. Brody Buyer II: Louis Swaim Composition: 10/12 Palatino by Thompson Type Printing: 75# Sterling Ultra Web Dull, R.R. Donnelley & Sons Cover: © Brian Vanden Brink/Group 3 Architects Library of Congress Cataloging-in-Publication Data Nielson, Karla J. Interiors : an introduction / Karla J. Nielson, David A. Taylor.—5th ed. p. cm. Includes index. ISBN-13: 978-0-07-352650-8 (softcover : alk. paper) ISBN-10: 0-07-352650-9 (softcover : alk. paper) 1. Interior decoration—Handbooks, manuals, etc. I. Taylor, David A. II. Title. NK2115.N45 2010 729—dc22 2010031462 The Internet addresses listed in the text were accurate at the time of publication. The inclusion of a Web site does not indicate an endorsement by the authors or McGraw-Hill, and McGraw-Hill does not guarantee the accuracy of the information presented at these sites. www.mhhe.com

Contents Preface

xv

Chapter 1

The Process and Profession of Design

Interior Design: A Lifetime Pursuit

2

The Language of Design 3 Residential and Contract Interior Design 3 Residential Interiors and Well-Being 4 The Need for Interior Design 4

The Process of Design 5 The Letter of Agreement 5 The Problem Statement 5 Research and Programming 5 Writing the Program 13 Design Development: Solving the Problem 14 Postoccupancy Evaluation 18 Contract Considerations 18

The Interior Design Profession

19

The Design Profession: Past and Present 19 Designer Skills 20 Training and Professional Development 20 Interior Design Resources 22 Careers in Interior Design 25 The Future of Interior Design 32

Chapter 2

Special Considerations in Design

Important Design Considerations 34 Environmental Considerations

34

Sustainability 34 Green Design 37 Other Environmental Issues 39

Considerations for Special Needs Users 44 Universal Design 44 The Americans with Disabilities Act of 1990 44 Accessible Design 45

v

vi

Contents

Design for Special Populations 45 Design for Motion Impairments 45 Design for Hearing Impairment 49 Design for Visual Impairment 49 Design for the Elderly 50 Other Special Populations 51

Special Design Considerations as Fundamental Goals 52

Chapter 3

Design Principles, Elements, and Style

The Principles of Design 54 Scale 54 Proportion 55 Balance 56 Rhythm 58 Emphasis 59 Harmony: Variety and Unity 60

The Elements of Design 62 Space 62 Shape or Form 63 Mass 64 Line 65 Texture 66 Pattern 67 Light 68 Color 68 Structural and Decorative Design 69

Design Discernment and Excellence 73 Cost Is Not the Issue 73 Training the Eye 73 Finding a Personal Style 74 Interior Design Styles 75

Chapter 4

Color

How We See Color 82 Subtractive Color 82 Visual Acuity and Deficiency 82 Metamerism 82

Color Theory 84 The Standard Color-Wheel Theory 84 The Munsell Theory 86 Other Color Theories 87

Contents

Color Harmony 88 Considerations in Color Harmonizing Neutralized Colors 88 Neutrals 90 Other Color-Influencing Factors 91

88

Color Psychology 93 Afterimage Simultaneous Contrast The Color Trend Market 94

94

Residential and Contract Uses of Color 96 Color in Residential Interiors 96 Contract Considerations 97

Chapter 5

Lighting and Technology

Lighting in Interior Design 100 Natural Light

100

Combustion Lighting 100

Artificial Lighting 101 Fluorescent Lighting 102 Incandescent Lighting 104 Light-Emitting Diode (LED) Lighting 105 Categories of Lighting Effects 106 Lighting Effects in the Interior 108

Light and the Mind and Body 109 Seasonal Affective Disorder 109 Manipulating Mood with Interior Lighting 110 Glare 111

Power Terminology and Units of Measurement Luminaires, or Lighting Fixtures

113

Architectural Lighting 114 Nonarchitectural Lighting 116 A Lighting Plan 116 Lighting Economy 118

Lighting for the Future 118 Contract Considerations 119 Types of Contract Lighting 119 Lighting Economy in Contract Interiors 121 Contract Lighting for the Future 121

112

vii

viii

Contents

Technology 121 Information-Age Home Automation Systems 122 Information-Age Wiring and Installation 122 Wi-Fi Technology 123 Wiring Plans 124 Residential Built-in Systems 126 Contract Communication and Safety Systems 126

Chapter 6

Space Planning Considerations

Prioritizing Needs and Wants 130 Function First 130 Interrelating Functions 131 Brainstorming 131 New Construction versus Remodeling 132 Economic Considerations 135 Other Factors That Affect Economy in Planning Home Space 136 Features and Benefits 138

Considerations for Specific Areas

138

The Entry or Foyer 138 Formal Living Spaces 138 Home Office Planning 138 The Library 143 Kitchen and Great Room Planning 144 The Laundry Room 146 Master Suite Planning 152 Family Bathrooms 154 Children’s Spaces 155 Indoor-Outdoor Living 156 Media and Entertainment Rooms 157 Hobby and Special-Use Areas 158 Storage 158

Space Planning and the Principles and Elements of Design

159

Living with Less Space 159 Making Large Spaces Seem Smaller 161 Traffic Patterns 162 Rethinking the Box—Planning for Flexibility 162

Contract Considerations 164 Function and Zoning 164 Traffic Patterns in Contract Spaces

Chapter 7

168

Floor Plans and Building Systems

Floor Plans 170 Diagramming and Floor Plans 171 Measurements of Space: Cubic and Square Footage Shaping the Space 172 Site, Orientation, and Climate 172

171

Contents

Floor Plans and Housing

173

Floor Plan Symbols 173 Floor Plan Types 173 Types of Housing 173 Buying an Existing Home 180 Obtaining the Floor Plan 180 Construction Documents: Working Drawings or Blueprints Who Will Do the Work 184

184

Constructing the Building 185 Structural Building Components and Systems 186 The Critical Path and the Punch List 192

Insulation and Energy Conservation 192 Active and Passive Solar Systems 195 Green Design 198

Contract Considerations 198 Contract Plumbing, HVAC, and Indoor Air Quality 198 Life Safety 203 Systems within the Plenum 204

Chapter 8

Furniture Arrangement

Function 206 Combining Functions 207 Mechanical Functions 207 Circulation 207

Human Factors 208 Anthropometrics 208 Standard Clearances 208 Proxemics 209 Crowding 211 Territoriality 211

The Elements and Principles of Design Balance, Scale, and Mass Rhythm 213 Emphasis 213 Line and Harmony 215 Form and Space 216 Proportion 217

212

212

Basic Groupings 218 Arranging Furniture with CAD Programs 222

Contract Considerations 223 Function 223 Contract Furniture Types 225 Planning for Systems Furniture 225 Circulation 225

ix

x

Contents

Chapter 9

Furniture Selection

Wooden Furniture

228

Hardwood and Softwood 228 Other Forms of Wood 228 Case Goods 228 Wood Grains 229 Joining Methods 229 Wood Finishes 230

Metal Furniture 230 Types of Metal

230

Other Furniture Materials 231 Plastic 232 Leather 232 Wicker, Rattan, Cane, and Rush 232

Upholstered Furniture 233 Frames 234 Springs 234 Cushioning 234 Coverings 234

Furniture Categories

236

Obtaining Furniture 238 Furniture Harmony and Human Factors 239 Function 239 Anthropometrics and Ergonomics

Furniture Types

240

240

Systems Furniture 240 Ergonomic Superchairs 241 Custom Designs 241 Other Furniture Types 242

Contract Considerations 242 Ergonomics 242 Durability 249

Chapter 10 Walls

252

Wood Paneling 252 Moldings 254

Doors

255

Windows Stairs

259

264

Architectural Detail

Contents

Fireplaces and Chimneypieces 266 Ceilings

269

Cabinetwork 272 Contract Considerations 273

Chapter 11

Wall, Ceiling, and Window Treatments

Wall and Ceiling Materials 276 Selection Guidelines 276 Hard or Rigid Wall Materials

277

Paint 277 Painting Guidelines

287

Wall Coverings 290 Wall-Covering Guidelines 290 Fabric-Covered Walls 292

Ceiling Treatments

293

Window Treatments 293 Window-Treatment Considerations 293 Soft Window Coverings 296 Alternative Window Treatments 296

Contract Considerations 297 Durability 306 Contract Ceiling Treatments 307 Contract Window Treatments 307 Less Pattern 308 Safety Codes 308

Chapter 12

Floor Materials and Coverings

Floor Requirements and Specifications 310 Calculations and Costs 310

Guidelines for Selecting Hard and Resilient Floor Materials 310 Hard Floor Materials 311 Resilient Floor Materials 315

Soft Floor Coverings 315 Carpeting 315 Rugs 322

Contract Considerations 330 Hard and Resilient Floorings 330 Rugs and Carpeting 331

xi

xii

Contents

Chapter 13 Fibers

Fabric

334

Fabric Maintenance 338 Fabric Construction 338 Finishes 341 Obtaining Fabric 341

Fabric—The Champion of Versatility The Human Touch 342 Fabric Aesthetics 343 Fabric Weight and Applications

342

347

Contract Considerations 347 Decorative Fabric Glossary

Chapter 14

348

Art and Accessories

Fine Art 358 Sculpture 358 Painting 358 Mosaic 359 Drawing 359 Printmaking 359 Graphic Art, Photography, Reproductions, and Rubbings Obtaining Fine Art 361 Preparing Art for Display 362

Decorative Art

362

Mirrors 362 Tableware and Cookware 362 Baskets 365 Clocks 365 Screens 366 Decorative Lighting Fixtures 367 Books 368 Textiles 369

Objects from Nature

370

Plants 370 Flowers and Greenery 370 Other Natural Objects 371

Other Accessories 371 The Use of Accessories

371

Collections 371 Overall Considerations 373 Emotionally Supportive Design 373

Contract Considerations 374

360

Contents

Chapter 15

Historic Influences in Design

Early Influences 378 Greece (Fifth Century B.C.) 378 Rome (200 B.C.–A.D. 400) 379 The Middle Ages (800–1500) 381 The Influence of the Orient 385 The Renaissance (1420–1650) 388 The Baroque Period (1580–1750) 390

European Influence in Historic America 391 Seventeenth-Century English Medieval Style (1608–95) 391 Early Georgian Style (1695–1750) 394 Late Georgian Style (1750–90) 398 Federal Style (1790–1830) 402 Jeffersonian Federal 402 American Vernacular Tradition (Seventeenth Century–Present) 405 Cape Cod Cottage (Seventeenth Century–Present) 405 Greek Revival/American Empire Style (1820–60) 407 Victorian Age in America (1837–1901) 411 Shaker Influence 416 Swedish Influence 417 German Influence 417 Dutch Influence 417 Louisiana French Influence 417 Spanish Missions 419 Southwest Adobe Style 419 California Ranch House 421 The Monterey House 422 The Beaux Arts Influence (1881–1945) 422

Historic European Style in Contemporary Design

423

Formal European Design 425 Vernacular European Design 426

Modern Design (1857–Present) 432 The Skyscraper (1857–Present) 432 Art Nouveau/Jugendstil (1890–1910) 432 Japanese Design 433 Craftsman Style (1905–1929) 434 Frank Lloyd Wright’s Organic Architecture (1908–Present) Art Deco (1918–45) 439 International Style (1932–Present) 440 Scandinavian and Midcentury Design 443 Contemporary Trends 446

Putting Things in Perspective Preservation 448

Glossary 453 Index 495

447

438

xiii

This page intentionally left blank

Preface Interiors: An Introduction, Fifth Edition, is the starting point for a lifetime of design education, appreciation, and enjoyment. Interior design is an exciting discipline that makes life better through effective design solutions to spatial, functional, and aesthetic challenges. Whether your goal is a career in interior design, or simply a better understanding of how to enhance your own living space, the information and ideas found in Interiors will help you achieve it. The objectives of Interiors are threefold: 1. to introduce a philosophy of and encourage an appreciation for ine design wherever it is found—in historical and modern examples, and in design that is continually evolving on the leading edge of technology; 2. to apply timeless design principles and elements to interiors; 3. and to make students aware of the wide variety of loor plans, materials, furnishings, and styles possible in interior design. This book is the beginning of a study that can be expanded by searching the Internet, reading interior design magazines, and visiting museums, showcase homes, showrooms, and supply sources. Educated students are more astute consumers who are able to make selections with good design and practicality in mind.

Inside Interiors Interiors: An Introduction, Fifth Edition, is an exciting look at the world of interior design. Today’s interior design is thriving and continually changing. This edition has several new features that keep pace with the reality of design in everyone’s lives. New “case studies” illustrate the design process in action as well as new ways that the world of technology has impacted interior design. The enhanced focus of this edition is also on modest living, making design more within reach to all. Photographs of interiors show spaces that are reasonable in size and scope rather than mansion-sized dream rooms. This breathes new life into the passion for interior design—the passion to create spaces that are streamlined, fresh, and inspirational to everyone. Throughout the text the term nonresidential has been changed to contract in keeping with contemporary design practice terminology. Speciic changes to this edition are listed below. The illustration program of Interiors: An Introduction, Fifth Edition, is greatly enlarged, with 277 new photographs and illustrations and 38 new drawings. Expanded captions throughout enhance the pedagogy of interior design. Photographs have been selected that can be discussed in the chapter where they are placed and as illustrations in other areas of the text as well. Chapter 1, The Process and Profession of Design, explores new technological tools used by designers as virtual design teams work around the world through the latest developments in technology. These new or updated terms include building information modeling (BIM); computer-aided design (CAD); computer communication (e-mail, Skype, virtual meetings, social networking); data or project management software; xv

xvi

Preface

e-design; ile transfer protocol (FTP); inancial accounting software; product searches and sources; telephone, cell phone, and webcam conferencing. The section “The Future of Interior Design” relects current trends. The chapter has twenty-nine updated photographs, including two case studies. Chapter 2, Special Considerations in Design, includes ways to be aware of wasteful energy consumption. New sections or terms include energy audit, carbon footprint, and ways to check your own energy usage. There are fourteen updated photographs, including more speciic photographs and descriptions on energy conservation. Chapter 3, Design Principles, Elements, and Style, has a new name. Additions include the concept of simplifying and organizing as a component of inding a personal style, and the deinition of the following interior design styles: Authentic Historic or Period, Formal Traditional, Informal Traditional, Colonial or American Country, Rustic European, Casual Contemporary, Asian or Oriental, International Modern, Organic Modern, Scandinavian Modern, Retro Modern, Contemporary Organic, inluences of Art Nouveau and Art Deco, eclectic design, and thematic interior design. There are twentynine updated photographs, including a case study of a room makeover in which cost is not the issue. We hope it will inspire students to try out their own creative ideas, even though they may be on a limited budget. Chapter 4, Color, features twenty-one new photographs, including e-design as a way to visualize the dramatic changes that color can make in a room. A case study provides further illustration of how effective color is in a room makeover. Chapter 5, Lighting and Technology, presents the dramatic shift away from incandescent lighting to more energy eficient luorescent and LED lighting. New lighting terms include color temperature, color rendering index (CRI), and eficacy. Dei nitions and thirteen new drawings illustrate surface-mounted and suspended decorative luminaires: lush, semilush, wall sconce, bathroom i xtures, chandelier, kitchen or bar chandelier, pendant, and minipendant. Portable decorative luminaires include nonadjustable loor lamp, adjustable loor lamp, torchére, adjustable desk lamp, and table lamp. Also new are guidelines for using lighting wisely and developing a lighting plan. A section on Wi-Fi in the home is new, with the term coaxial cable added. Contract luorescent and LED lighting is covered. Table 5.8, “Suggestions for Lighting Economy,” has been rewritten and reordered, with added information on tunnel skylights. Sections on contract lighting economy and lighting for the future, including Wi-Fi, have been updated or added. Chapter 5 has twenty updated photographs. Chapter 6, Space Planning Considerations, contains thirty updated photographs and expanded captions. Chapter 7, Floor Plans and Building Systems, has twelve updated photographs and expanded captions. Chapter 8, Furniture Arrangement, introduces furniture arrangement via e-design or computer-aided design with illustrations of real spaces created by a designer. The chapter features thirteen updated photographs and expanded captions. Chapter 9, Furniture Selection, includes a new section on furniture categories: antiques, collectibles, reproductions, adaptations, vintage furniture, modern classics, new furniture, custom-built furniture, furniture from kits and uninished furniture, unassembled furniture, used furniture, and multipurpose furniture. It also includes an extensive list of ways to obtain furniture: retail and custom-ordered, seasonal sales, closeout or liquidation sales, loss leader sales, marked-down items, online shopping, lease-to-own, used furniture, hand-me-down furniture, yard or garage sales and lea markets, estate auctions, thrift or secondhand stores, and building supply stores for DIY (do-it-yourself) projects. Four ergonomic computer station positions are illustrated with expanded captions, and the concept of elastic design in ofice seating is new. Chapter 9 has seventeen updated photographs and expanded captions. Chapter 10, Architectural Detail, has twenty updated photographs and expanded captions. Chapter 11, Wall, Ceiling, and Window Treatments, adds glass tile to Table 11.3

Preface

and wood plank paneling to Table 11.6. The chapter covers custom murals and the larger paint samples now available (they cover 2 or 4 square feet, to try out paint colors in situ.) Ultraviolet-light damage and window ilm are addressed. A case study presents a complete makeover using e-design. Chapter 11 has twenty-six updated photographs. Chapter 12, Floor Materials and Coverings, features sixteen updated photographs, and Chapter 13, Fabric, contains seven updated photographs. Chapter 14, Art and Accessories, includes new information in the section “Graphic Art, Photography, Reproductions and Rubbings,” and contains ifteen updated photographs and expanded captions. Chapter 15, Historic Inluences in Design, divides the European inluence into two general categories, formal and informal. Spanish Colonial and Tuscan (Tuscany/Toscano, Italy) styles are now included. Asian styles are separated, with Chinese/Oriental design as an inluence in Renaissance and European design, and Japanese design as its own style and placed as a major inluence in the development of Craftsman and Organic Modern design. A new table, “Roof and Dormer Types,” has been added to the end of this chapter, to assist in the study of historic architecture. Eleven updated photographs and expanded captions and thirty-eight new drawings have been added to the study of historic design. Because introductory interior design courses vary in their approach, Interiors is planned for lexibility: chapters can be used in the order preferred by the teacher, and selected chapters can be more heavily emphasized or left for another course of study. However this text is incorporated into a given course, we leave you our wish that it not be simply enjoyable reading, but the beginning of your lifetime of involvement in interiors.

Resources for Students and Instructors Student Resources Interiors is supported by a dynamic Online Learning Center website at www.mhhe .com/nielson5e, where students can ind a wide range of tools to help them in testing their knowledge. It includes chapter study tools, multiple-choice and essay quizzing, lash cards, and suggested websites.

Instructor Resources The Online Learning Center for instructors at www.mhhe.com/nielson5e includes a password-protected Test Bank and the Instructor’s Manual, which includes discussion outlines and suggested class assignments. Please ask your McGraw-Hill representative for access information.

Acknowledgments This book is the result of the efforts of many talented and supportive people. We would like to express our thanks to our spouses, Asa S. Nielson and Kristine B. Taylor, and to our children and extended families, and our students at Brigham Young University. We are grateful to those who provided illustrations: Jim Park for his masterful penand-ink work and the many photographers whose expertise is manifest, in particular, Kathryn Taylor and Brian Vanden Brink. Also thanks to the individuals and corporations whose designs and products appear in this book, contributing to the state of the art in design excellence.

xvii

xviii

Preface

We also thank the scholars who reviewed this text during its development. Reviewers for the ifth edition were: Leslie Asfour, San Joaquin Delta College Helen Barnes, Butler Community College Cindy V. Beacham, West Virginia University Patti Bradford, University of Memphis Claudia Harmon, Cuesta College Amy Jacobson-Peters, University of Central Oklahoma Diana Leakas, Sinclair Community College Linda L. Nussbaumer, South Dakota State University Megan M. Shaw, University of Kentucky Terrance L. Uber, Kent State University Jo Ellen Weingart, Harper Junior College Karla J. Nielson David A. Taylor

Chapter 1 The Process and Profession of Design Interior Design: A Lifetime Pursuit 2 The Process of Design 5 The Interior Design Profession 19

Photo © David A. Taylor

2

Chapter 1

Interior Design: A Lifetime Pursuit Interior design is an exciting career, and it is also a fascinating avocation, providing a lifetime of personal, aesthetic, and intellectual fulillment. A single issue of a cutting-edge residential design magazine recently demonstrated that even those who do not practice interior design as a profession often create interiors worthy of recognition and publication. The magazine’s colored pages featured the work of architects and designers, along with the designs of an illustrator, an account executive, an inventor, a hotel owner, a clothing fabricator, a law student, a housewares retailer, a writer, a contractor, and others. Anyone with a keen interest can become

knowledgeable about design and can create interiors of charm and style. Being involved in interior design is a rewarding pursuit that broadens intellectual horizons and deepens aesthetic sensitivity. Interior design is vital, vibrant, and dynamic; it is never static. As the world changes, life also changes and design keeps pace. An interior design will never really be “inished,” because as life changes, so do we. Styles evolve, our outlook changes, the composition of our families and households alters, careers shift, and our designs adjust to life’s ebb and low. What an exciting thing it is to be luent in the language of design, to know the historic roots of the design language, and to understand the new expressions of the language all around us.

Figure 1.1 This well-planned space features light, lovely colors and simple, handsome furnishings that give these connecting dining and living rooms a sense of openness and cleanliness. Modest, organized spaces meets the needs of the users or encourages people to enjoy the space and the company of those who share it with them. Design by Hutker Architects/photo © Brian Vanden Brink

The Process and Profession of Design

3

It is even more exciting to be able to speak the language of design by creating our own interiors. It is truly a rewarding lifelong avocation that is within the reach of all who are willing to invest the time and effort.

Like master writers who manipulate the language in interesting new ways, talented designers often break with established rules and expectations to create new trends and tastes.

The Language of Design

Residential and Contract Interior Design

The late design educator Sherrill Whiton compared studying interior design to learning a foreign language. If the vocabulary and the grammar of a language are mastered, we can adequately express ourselves. Interior design has a vocabulary of materials, styles, forms, details, light, colors, patterns, textures, lines, and mass. The grammar can be compared to design principles of balance, rhythm, emphasis, scale, proportion, unity, variety, and harmony. In the same way that we select words to form sentences according to rules of grammar, we use elements of design to create interiors according to established principles.

Although the focus of our interest in interior design is often personal, it certainly need not be limited to our personal home environment. Lifestyles today often dictate that we spend many of our waking hours in working situations, shopping, and dealing with various types of business services. We also spend time eating out, traveling, and staying in hotels. These contract environments should be as well planned as the home environment. The focus of Interiors: An Introduction is general. The concepts discussed apply to both residential and contract interiors. In cases where certain considerations do not apply

Figure 1.2 Interior design can be observed and evaluated in places where we shop, worship, do business, or obtain services such as dining in restaurants. At the Oliver and Bonacini Café & Grill, a contemporary patio space has been added to the existing structure where natural lighting is enjoyed through retractable textile membrane vaults overhead and through commercial French doors. Furniture placement allows many diners to enjoy this sunny space, accessorized with tree trunks and large planters of greenery. Design by Anacleto Design Associates/photo courtesy of Eventscape, Inc.

4

Chapter 1

equally to homes, separate sections with contract considerations are included in the chapters. What we learn about interior design applies to the places where we shop, eat, stay, or receive public or professional services. After studying interior design, we will view all these places with new eyes. When they function well and are creatively developed, we will feel good about being there. Armed with a new awareness of design, we become amateur critics. Even though we may keep our critiques to ourselves, we ind our appreciation and enjoyment increasing with each fresh exposure to design.

Residential Interiors and Well-Being The great British prime minister Winston Churchill said, “We shape our environments; thereafter they shape us.” This is certainly true of any place we spend time, but nowhere is it more true than in the home. The home is a refuge from the elements and the pressures of everyday life. It is the place where children are nurtured. Here they can be taught the value of work and cleanliness and the satisfaction that comes from a job well done. They can learn honesty, integrity, dependability, and service to others by taking appropriate responsibility for the home, its maintenance, and the quality of life it provides. The home is where we come for entertainment and relaxation. It is a place where we seek physical rest and sleep—no bed feels as good as the one at home. Here we can cook in order to feed and fortify ourselves for the onslaught of daily living. Home should be a place of refreshment and support, and it should be important to us as a place where the inest values can be espoused and reinforced. Interior design is the means to making homes pleasant and functional. In our fast-paced society, life is often illed with stress and sometimes unhappiness. Poorly planned interiors can add to this emotional burden and can be an unnecessary source of frustration. Well-planned and lovely homes are no guarantee of happiness, but a welldesigned interior certainly helps smooth the rough edges of life. It is also important to note that there is no relationship between the size and luxury of a home and its ability to function. A modest cottage, if it meets the needs of those who call it home, can be a pleasant place to live. It is up to us to create the kind of interior that best meets our needs and our expectations of what will take place there. A home illed with objects and materials of personal value will be unlike any other home elsewhere. It is pleasant to sit in the home of a musician or theater professional, for example, and sense his or her interests and experiences merely by looking around. When homes have the good fortune of growing and evolving with their occupants over a number of years, the charm will likely be even greater. This is the reason model homes often lack the emotional warmth of real home environments. Even though they may be designed and furnished with great

Figure 1.3 This space was designed to house the objects and furnishings of personal value that are unlike any other home elsewhere. The result is a home that gives its owners a sense of well-being, comfort, and familiarity, as well as good design. Design by McMillan Architects/photo © Brian Vanden Brink

sensitivity and illed with intriguing objects and ideas, they may still lack the sense of ownership and distinction that comes to a home that is lived in with love and care over a period of years.

The Need for Interior Design The reasons for getting involved in an interior design project are varied: • New homes and buildings require complete designs. New architecture should be completely planned— from the arrangement and allocation of space to the selection of new materials and furnishings. The extent of the purchase of new furnishings will often depend on whether one is starting fresh or moving from an existing building or home. Those starting fresh will have to select every item, whereas those who move from a more settled situation may be able to use existing furnishings. • Interiors need refurbishing. With time, materials and furnishings become worn and are no longer suitable.

The Process and Profession of Design

5

• Fashions change. No matter how carefully interiors are designed, change is often welcome. As new materials and furnishings develop, there are expanded possibilities for change that will bring freshness to interiors. This is an area that requires careful balance. The interior furnishings industry thrives on changes in fashion, and new directions in design are exciting. Yet if durable furnishings are carefully chosen with an eye to classic styling, they will not date and will not need replacing. In a well-designed interior, updating with a new paint color, fabric, piece of furniture, or accessory may satisfy the craving for new fashion.

The Process of Design Design is the process of solving problems. Good interior design solutions have the power to make people feel positive in their surroundings. Table 1.1 outlines the steps taken by designers to solve problems and answer questions posed by a design project.

The Letter of Agreement

Figure 1.4 The need for new interior design here fulfills three categories: The kitchen needed refurbishing, the program changed in family demographics, and fashions changed. The result is a kitchen with updated and well-designed lighting, seating, unique plumbing fixtures, and state-of-the-art appliances that will meet the family’s needs for many years to come. Design by Elina Katsioula-Beall, CKD, Co-designer: Sarah Michalowski; Dewitt Designer Kitchens/Photography: Suki Medencevic/NKBA Design Competition

The average life span for better-than-average soft goods (upholstery, draperies, and loor coverings), paint, and wall coverings is 6 to 12 years; when they wear out, they will need to be replaced. • The program changes. As the composition of a household or business changes, the interior may need remodeling or refurnishing. For example, as children are born into a family, more bedroom space may be required. As the children grow and move on to college and out of the home, their rooms may be given to younger brothers and sisters, or they may become personal adult spaces, requiring some design alterations. In the same way, growth and expansion of a business or institution also require design changes. Environments that are updated in response to change function better.

As protection for both parties, most designers prepare a letter of agreement outlining the responsibilities of the designer and the inancial obligation of the client to reimburse the designer for services rendered. The signed letter of agreement is a legal document; it avoids the waste of spending design time on researching, programming, and preparing conceptual designs in cases where the project never comes to fruition or the client selects a different designer. The letter also guarantees that the client will be supplied with whatever the designer agrees to provide for all or part of a project.

The Problem Statement Initial identiication of the problem might begin with some kind of problem statement indicating the basic nature of the project—as a primary residence, vacation house, ofice, clinic, retirement center, restaurant, hotel, or clothing store. Such a statement might also include the location of the project and even a speciic address. The person or group commissioning the project could also be named in a design statement.

Research and Programming A functional and successful design must solve problems. A clear understanding of the problems will lead to an effective design solution. The summary of goals, requirements, and restrictions associated with a design problem and its solution is known as the program. The process of programming is accomplished by gathering, compiling,

Chapter 1

6

Table 1.1

The Design Process

Letter of Agreement (Contract) Problem Statement Research and Programming Identiies and seeks to understand: • Users • Lifestyle and function • Relationships • Space requirements • Environmental factors • Mechanical considerations • Psychological and sociological considerations • Economic factors • Design preferences • Codes and restrictions

Writing the Program • Analysis of research data • Organizing the data into a written program

Design Development The program is implemented through: • Concept development • Working drawings and speciications • Execution

Postoccupancy Evaluation

analyzing, and verifying the information necessary to understand the problem and solve it. In contract design, the program is a formal written document; a program may be used formally or informally in residential design. There are times when the program for a project will be provided by those commissioning the design, but it will probably still be necessary to collect additional data to complete the program. When designers are responsible for the program, they will conduct research, surveys, interviews, and studies and compile inventories as part of the programming process. The following are typical factors that might be considered in research and programming.

Users The research process begins with identiication of each of the users. The users, as the name implies, are those who will use the design directly or indirectly, from principal occupants to service people to guests and friends. In a residential design, a proile may be developed for each of the principal residents who will live in the home. The proile could include such things as age, sex,

background, culture, values, temperament, personality, personal habits, need for privacy, style preferences, responses to color, and an inventory of possessions and furnishings that need to be accommodated. Proiles reveal household demographics, which is statistical information about numbers and kinds of residents. This would include traditional families with two parents, as well as nontraditional families such as those in combined households or single-parent households and special populations such as the elderly or handicapped. Household demographics can be determined through interviews of the principal users or by means of a questionnaire developed by the designer.

Lifestyle and Function The proile helps the designer understand the lifestyle of the principal users. Lifestyle is a term frequently used in residential design to describe part of the program for a home. It represents the constantly changing way a person or group of people live and how they use their time. It includes such considerations as whether they like to read, write, or use a computer; whether they have special hobbies such as sewing, crafts, or woodworking; or to what extent they enjoy and participate in sports. The way people choose to entertain; how they prepare, serve, and eat meals; whether or not a grandparent lives with them; the way they use their leisure time; the type of musical instruments they play; the routine they use for dressing and their personal toilette; the amount and type of interaction they want with their children—all are examples of lifestyle considerations. As the composition of families or groups changes and as people grow older, interests, needs, and lifestyles also change. Consequently, lexibility in planning for potential modiications is very important in order to meet changes without major upheaval. Since lifestyles are in a constant state of lux as household demographics change, it is important to be aware of the effect such changes will have. For example, many families with small children may ind a playroom well suited to their needs. Tiny children can use the space for toys and for play. As children begin to bring friends into the home, the room will provide space for playing games with peers. As children become teenagers and young adults, the playroom can accommodate music and entertainment, and even parties and dancing. When the young adults leave home, the room may start the cycle all over again with space for grandchildren. Another example of accommodating a changing lifestyle is the evolution of a bedroom from nursery into child’s room and then into a teenager’s or young adult’s room. When the young adult leaves home, the room could be used for hobbies, study, television, a home ofice, a guest room, or a combination of uses. The foresight to project changes in lifestyle is an important asset in the programming process.

The Process and Profession of Design

Many kinds of design solutions have come to be accepted as standard. However, the lifestyle of the users will often dictate solutions to design problems that go beyond standard. Individual needs should be assessed in terms of the kinds of functions a user envisions for a space, as well as the kinds of furnishings and equipment required. For example, questions one might ask in planning a kitchen space are: • • • • • •

How many of the users will be cooking at once? What kinds of equipment will be needed? Will there be minimal or gourmet cooking? What kind of supplies must be accommodated? How should supplies be stored? What kind of dining, if any, should be planned?

In a bedroom we might ask: Do the users like to read in bed? Will the bedroom be used for studying? Is an area for seating desirable? Will there be television or other forms of electronic entertainment? • What are the storage needs? • • • •

In living areas we might want to know: • Is the space used by company, family, or both? • Will there be a piano or other musical instruments? • Will television and entertainment be included here? • Should books and reading be part of the planning? • Will conversation be an important function? • Will the space be used to display art? Determinations should be made regarding every space and its use. For example, a bedroom could accommodate study or sewing space as well as sleeping. The family room could be used for dining, television, and stereo, as well as conversation and games. The dining room or guest room could double as a library or hobby room. This kind of lexibility is crucial because the cost of space is high, and infrequently used rooms need to be made more useful by planning for several functions. Every lifestyle will dictate

Figure 1.5 Open shelves serve as a place to organize valued possessions, such as occasionally used tableware and serving pieces, cookbooks, and baskets. Design by Stephen Blatt Architects/photo © Brian Vanden Brink

7

different kinds of functions for each area; thorough inquiry will determine precisely what the functions are. With this exact data, planning can be effective and accurate, and lifestyle differences can be well accommodated.

Relationships When the functions for each space have been assessed, the relationships of each function must be determined. Important lines of communication and the need for proximity must be identiied. For example, it might be convenient to plan sewing and ironing near the laundry. The laundry may be close to the kitchen for daytime

8

Chapter 1

Figure 1.6 Well-defined relationships allow integration of food preparation and other activities in this pleasant great room. Dominic Mercadante, architect/photo © Brian Vanden Brink

convenience, or it could be near the bedrooms and bathrooms where soiled clothes are removed. Bedrooms should be planned in relationship to bathrooms. Easy access from the nursery to the master bedroom may be ideal for some parents, but others might want children’s rooms and activities isolated from their own. Kitchens and dining areas where food will be served should have logical and convenient relationships. A home ofice might most appropriately be located near the front door and close to a seating area such as a living room, for the convenience of those who visit the ofice. The consideration of relationships should even extend to the location of areas outside the building. For example, the convenient relationship of garbage containers to the kitchen or of kitchen to patio or garden is important. For bringing in groceries, the relationship of the garage or parking spaces to the kitchen or pantry is signiicant. Identifying these types of relationships facilitates eficient use of space and makes the design more effective because of its convenience. Wellplanned relationships also smooth lines of communication, cut building costs, and make trafic patterns more eficient.

Space Requirements When the designer puts pencil to paper, it is important to know exactly how to divide the space. Consequently, during the programming step, it is necessary to estimate the amount of space each function will demand. This requires some understanding of standard amounts of space allowed for trafic, as well as standard dimensions for furnishings. To program space requirements, the designer must establish inventories of furnishings, clothing, and special equipment belonging to the users. In most cases programming even includes taking actual measurements of those items. Lifestyle proiles will also help in estimating space requirements. A sample checklist might include the following kinds of questions: • How is entertaining handled, and how much space does that require? • How many people might need to be seated for formal dining? • What is the maximum number of guests that might stay at one time? • What pieces of equipment will be used in the kitchen? • How much food will be stored in the pantry?

• What kind of vacuums, mops, brooms, and other cleaning supplies are there? • Are there collections of slides, videos, or DVDs that require space? • Do card tables and folding chairs need to be stored? • How many books, CDs, or tapes does the user have? • How much sporting equipment needs storage? • How many shirts, sweaters, etc., does the user own? • How many pairs of shoes need to be stored? • Are there seasonal decorations that require storage? The old saying “A place for everything, and everything in its place” neatly summarizes an important aspect of a well-designed space: Most interior environments need not be of any particular size to be well designed. If a space accommodates possessions and activities in a logical and orderly fashion, life will be more pleasant. Consideration of space also extends beyond the functional measurement of actual space needs to the psychological realm of perception. Not only should there be adequate space for movement and circulation within a space, but the designer should also consider how the mind moves through a space. Inadequate space, or spaces without windows where the eye and mind cannot expand, is unpleasant for many and even claustrophobic for some. Psychological space perception is as important as actual space.

The Process and Profession of Design

9

(A) Figure 1.7 (A) This delightful Medieval-themed space was created expressly for the use and enjoyment of grandchildren who visit this home. It includes a play area platform accessed by a ladder with a dragon slide. Beneath the platform is a cave for playing. To the right is a painted troll just over a drawbridge. (B) A tree house reveals a ladder with a painted owl inside. (C and D) A custom cabinet built with a parapet roof line and painted with towers and turrets creates a castle that opens to reveal a pull-down Murphy bed for overnight stays. Interior design by MEA designs, M. Enid Arckless, ASID/photos by Reed Kaestner

(B)

(C)

(D)

10

Chapter 1

Environmental Factors Our relationship with and responsibility toward the environment is a very important issue. As the developed nations in particular gobble resources, pollute, and destroy the environment at an alarming rate, the preservation of the environment has become not only an ethical issue but a political one as well. Chapter 2 includes environmental considerations and lists some of the things that responsible designers can do to preserve the environment. An awareness of these issues can lead to action that will affect the quality of life for us and future generations. Environmental considerations—such as climate, weather, and physical location—must be examined as

part of the programming process. Some aesthetically pleasing designs are failures because they ignore important environmental questions. Environmental concerns cannot be subordinated to aesthetics; there must be a synthesis of the two. Climate and Weather. Problems of climate and weather are generally straightforward. Climates with extremes of heat and/or cold will require ample insulation, as well as adequate heating and/or cooling systems. Climate and weather also inluence the placement of a building to take advantage of favorable climate conditions—such as breezes or sunshine—or to avoid unpleasant ones. In fact, weather and climate should be keys to determining the type of structure to be built. Building materials should be suitable to the climate so that they will not be subject to excessive deterioration. Physical Location. Physical location involves factors such as site, view, prevailing winds, solar exposure, noise, and environmental hazards. Site—The site of a building should inluence its design. The building should be compatible with its neighbors, though the style need not be the same, merely harmonious. Where conservation and preservation of the environment are important, the design should be well suited to, and harmonious with, the natural surroundings. Plans should be Figure 1.8 This outdoor living space, which is integral to the interior, was designed to accommodate a warm climate. The facing sofas are kept out of the weather and in the shade for personal comfort, while the chaise lounges by the pool take full advantage of the sun. Tile paving connects the spaces and will be unharmed by water. Beyond the pool and the privacy of the garden landscaping, the ocean beckons, making this view from the home a focal point. Design by Group 3/photo © Brian Vanden Brink

The Process and Profession of Design

developed to do the least possible damage to nature and to integrate the building with existing natural features. In other cases, the design may be created to stand out in contrast to its environment; the environment may even be altered and reworked by the designer. Good and responsible judgment is paramount in such situations. Building and development are the natural results of growth and change and should be planned so that in years to come they will have improved with age. View—Beautiful daytime or nighttime views are a valuable asset to an interior and should be featured in the design of the building. They should not be upstaged by excessively ornate window treatments. Where views are unpleasant or nonexistent, attention should be focused inward and treatments should be selected to deemphasize them. Prevailing Winds—Prevailing winds can be a positive or negative feature of a location. They can provide pleasant breezes or disturbing winds. When breezes prevail, buildings should be oriented to use the wind for natural cooling. When winds are gusty or icy cold, the building and its landscaping should provide shelter and protection. Berms (small constructed hills) or trees planted in a windbreak can help minimize the effect of cold winter winds. Solar Exposure—Like the wind, the sun can be both a positive and a negative factor. In the winter, the sun streaming through south windows may be warm and comforting, but without adequate protection from the sun, an interior may become dificult to cool, and ultraviolet rays and heat can damage furnishings as well as produce disturbing glare. Chapter 7 contains a thorough discussion of solar factors. Noise—Some types of noise are enjoyable. The tumbling of a small creek or brook, the sound of waves breaking at the seashore, the crackle of a warm ire in the ireplace, or a breeze rustling through leaves can be comforting and pleasant. While most people enjoy an environment free from loud, annoying noise, it is amazing how humans can adapt to noise. Those who are accustomed to sleeping in rooms facing busy city streets may ind it dificult to sleep in a completely quiet environment. Noise from the outside and noise through interior walls can be controlled with extra insulation, adequate construction, and insulated glass. Noise within an environment can be controlled by the use of materials that refract (bend) and absorb sound waves. Textile applications (upholstery and loor, wall, and window coverings) refract and absorb sound waves and can largely eliminate echo noise, or reverberation. Environmental Hazards—When planning, it is important to be aware of hazardous conditions, some serious enough to warrant selection of a new site. Fault lines, slide areas, eroding waterfronts, areas subject to looding or forest ires, high-power lines, railroad

11

lines, heavy industries, areas of extreme pollution, and even former pollution sites—all are examples of potential hazards. Streets with heavy trafic may be hazards for families with small children.

Mechanical Considerations Mechanical considerations include heating, ventilation, air-conditioning (HVAC), plumbing, lighting, and telephone. A basic knowledge of the way these systems function will be helpful in understanding how they must integrate with the completed interior. Such understanding will also lead to a smoother and more productive working relationship with the skilled technicians who install these systems.

Psychological and Sociological Considerations Psychological and sociological needs also must carefully be considered because the design of an interior has tremendous power to make people feel good about their environments and can even affect the way they feel about each other. Most people recognize the effect that an interior environment can have (for both good and ill) on our well-being and even on some aspects of our character. Space, color, texture, pattern, scale, balance, furnishings, and all the other design elements and principles that constitute our interiors make us feel and act in certain ways. Knowledgeable use of these elements can lead to the creation of environments that make us feel emotional responses such as cool, warm, happy, romantic, nostalgic, awed, compassionate, hungry, restless, soothed, stimulated, or relaxed. That is why an interior designer must carefully consider the subtle manipulations that affect us so strongly. Other sociological and psychological considerations include the need for privacy and interaction, cultural relationships, security and safety, and familiarity and stability. Privacy and Interaction. Some people are rather private by nature, whereas others are more gregarious. Regardless of our basic social nature, we all have times when we need to be alone and times when we need to interact with others. Spaces such as living rooms, family rooms, game rooms, dining rooms, and even kitchens should be planned for interaction. In many homes the kitchen is the heart. Even when homes are provided with areas for individual study, many times family members will end up studying around the kitchen table. When guests arrive for parties, they frequently gravitate to the kitchen. It is this tendency that has led to the popularity of great rooms, which are large kitchen/dining/family room spaces where most of the day-to-day living is centered. It is equally important to plan spaces where members of the household can be alone. Libraries, studies, workrooms, or bedrooms are logical places for privacy. When

12

Chapter 1

agencies have established guidelines and rules (codes) for safety and ire prevention. Smoke detectors and ire extinguishers offer even greater security, both physical and emotional. The need for protection is one of the most basic reasons for seeking the shelter of a home. Home security has become a multimilliondollar industry providing alarm systems and other means of securing homes. Some of these security systems utilize complex equipment and sophisticated electronic surveillance, while others are as basic as wellengineered locking mechanisms. For many people, these kinds of measures provide a sense of calm and well-being that makes a home the center of security that it should be. Familiarity and Stability. The design of an interior can include items that create stability and reassurance through their familiarity. For example, space might be designated for family photographs and other personal mementos. Art, accessories, and furnishings Figure 1.9 Interaction is a main goal of this well-planned and artistic kitchen collected while traveling also have the same where friends and family can gather on stylish modern stools around the effect of tying us to our personal experilarge island and enjoy their association with one another as well as the food ences. Such belongings are often reminders served here. Design by Terri Ruth Hosken, CMKBD; Beyond The Box—Kitchen Design/ of events or people and are part of an emoPhotography: Frank Flavin/NKBA Design Competition tional support system. The use or display of cherished collections, objects, or furnishings should be included as part of the planning children share a room, some means of division or separaprocess. Because of their familiarity and warm association should be planned so that a degree of privacy can be tions, our environments can support better mental and achieved when needed. A desire for solitude and introemotional health. spection is a basic human need that must be planned for and respected. Economic Factors Economic factors are some of the most important conCultural Relationships. Distinctive aspects of local culsiderations because they have such an impact on the exture or family history can enhance the quality of an intent of the design. Without proper funding, a design can terior. For example, the Pueblo Indian design of New remain forever on paper. Economic considerations will Mexico with its adobe construction has been adapted govern all aspects of the interior design—from the time into a local style that is charming and well suited to its allotted to research, develop, and execute the design to environment. It is also closely tied into the history and the quality of materials and furnishings. culture of the area and provides an emotional link with There are some considerations that will make dethe prevailing culture. When an interior will be used by signs more economical. For example, building materials people with ties to a foreign culture, it can beneit from that are plentiful or indigenous to an area will usually incorporating cultural elements, from structural features be cheaper. This means that brick is less costly near the and choice of materials to displays of artwork or crafts. factory because shipping costs are generally less. Where In this way the interior becomes an extension of personal brick has to be transported many hundreds of miles, the history and experience. cost will escalate. Wood is a natural choice in wooded areas and adds the economical quality of good insulaSecurity and Safety. The physical safety of the occupants tion as well. Building and inish materials that require and possessions can affect the psychological well-being of the least upkeep and give the greatest length of service or a home. There are few things that compare with the feeldurability for the climate and location are also economiing of terror and despair associated with a ire or other cal choices, a justiication for selecting brick or siding indisaster. To help prevent accidents and ire, government stead of wood.

The Process and Profession of Design

13

quality” will serve well all choices for design materials and furnishings. The cost of maintenance or upkeep of materials is another factor in planning for economy. If a inish or material requires constant dusting, cleaning, polishing, waxing, or other maintenance, it may not be the best choice. The cost is counted in two ways—the money for repair or hired cleaning help and the time and effort spent in maintaining it yourself. Economy may also include planning ahead for future changes or additions. Plumbing and wiring can be installed for central vacuum systems, intercom units, or entertainment and sound systems that will be added later. Planning ahead saves costly remodeling, with its accompanying inconvenience and frustration. The list of projected changes and additions should include any item that is built-in and must be planned for in advance.

Design Preferences As data are gathered, the client’s or user’s design preferences may be sought. They include preferences of theme, color, and even historic-period or contemporary styles (see Chapter 3). These preferences guide the designer through the concept-development phase of the design process. Personal preferences are particularly important in residential interiors where the client will be the principal user. In other cases, these kinds of choices may be left to the designer’s discretion. Figure 1.10 A richly furnished corner of the home of a New York art historian sensitively displays symbolic art and accessories celebrating the owner’s personally meaningful dual Judaic and Christian heritages. The pieces are arranged in an asymmetrical grouping, where size, shape, and proportions are carefully considered. Photo © Kathryn Taylor

Exterior and interior building components that are standard sizes are less expensive than those special ordered or custom manufactured. Examples include doors, windows, and ceiling heights, and standard in-stock items such as appliances and plumbing ixtures. The cost of replacement when materials wear out is also an important factor in planning for economy. It is sad when a home that has been mortgaged for 15, 20, or even 30 years is outitted with materials that need replacing in as few as 5 years. For example, a lower-grade vinyl looring or carpet will likely wear out and cost more to replace than a better-quality, durable looring would have cost in the beginning. Hardwood, tile, or even stone loors, which are initially expensive, will seldom wear out or need replacing. In the long run, cheap may cost more than expensive because poor-quality goods wear out before replacement is economically feasible and then those who use the design must live with shabby goods. The credo “Buy once and buy good

Codes Codes and restrictions are laws established by federal, state, and local governments and their agencies for the health, safety, and welfare of the user. They are exacting and often complex, and they tie the designer to a considerable amount of liability. Codes provide requirements for mechanical systems that will function both safely and properly and for ire and occupational safety with certain types of materials, equipment, and structures.

Writing the Program This list of considerations may seem lengthy, yet raising and answering as many questions as possible establishes a clear understanding or mastery of the problem. Such mastery becomes the basis for a good design solution. The only limiting factor in asking questions is time. At some point the information-gathering phase must end and the design must move forward.

Analysis All the data uncovered in the programming process must be studied to establish design priorities; real “needs” should be separated from “wants.” The prioritized data can then be organized into logical sequence for inclusion in the written document. If questions or discrepancies arise, they can be resolved through additional research.

14

Chapter 1

Written Program Putting the research information into written form is the last step in the critical programming phase of the design process. The resulting document is the key to a successful design solution. Since the program is a constantly changing set of circumstances, the gathered data will reveal the program only at a given point in time. The program gives the direction the design solution must take, and in this way it is like a road map that helps the design stay on course. The length of the written program will vary according to the size of the project. The inished design will be only as good as the quality of research and articulation of the data. A ine design is the result of spending adequate time to analyze and organize before beginning to create.

Design Development: Solving the Problem The creative mind will be generating ideas for design solutions all the way through the research phase of the design process. However, only after the research data have been analyzed and clearly articulated in the written program can the development of the ideas, or concepts, be formulated with accuracy. The design comes into being through: • Design concept development • Working drawings and speciications • Execution

Design Concept Development Concept development usually begins with brainstorming, freely generating many ideas without stopping to judge their quality. The ideas can be verbal, sketched, or written. Some very good design solutions have been scrawled on table napkins and scraps of building lumber. The important part of brainstorming is the low of ideas, as one idea often triggers another and the two may suggest a third or a combination idea. When the best ideas emerge, they are put on paper as the basis for the design solution. The ideas take the form of quick drawings called schematics, which are used to help visualize space plans, trafic patterns, details, or even possible color schemes. These can be modiied as the process continues until the parts begin to form the whole. As the design starts to come together, the brainstorming process continues as one scheme generates variations. These ideas must be examined, and at some point decisions must be made. Some ideas must be rejected, and those that survive can be accepted, altered, or expanded. This process continues until the pile of drawings reaches the ceiling or until time runs out. The ideation stage could go on indeinitely since solutions are limited only by imagination.

An important part of concept development is the selection of proposed materials, inishes, and furnishings. Materials consist of loor coverings, wall coverings, textiles for window coverings and upholstery, and materials for architectural trim and custom cabinetry. Finishes include paint and stain for walls, trim, cabinetry, and hard-surfaced loors. Furnishings are furniture and accessories such as rugs and lamps. Fixtures used for lighting and details as small as electrical switch plates could also be considered furnishings. These are chosen from a wide range of resources such as sample books, catalogs, showrooms, or Internet sites. Well-selected materials, inishes, and furnishings reinforce the design concept and make the project exciting because of their individuality and design harmony. Together with brainstorming notes and schematics, ideas for materials help the client/user understand what the completed design will look like. When the best ideas are brought to a degree of completion, the design concept begins to emerge. A commitment is then made to the ideas, and they are reined to a level where they can be presented for analysis. The presentation of the proposed interior design is generally made with a series of boards (mat, foam-core, or illustration board) displaying the following: • Conceptual drawings demonstrate the ideas or concepts for the design without the time-consuming precision of inished drawings. They include scaled drawings showing furniture placement. • Materials and i nishes boards are mounted with photos of furnishings and actual materials for the proposed design. These may also be computer-generated. • Renderings are hand- or computer-generated colored perspective and furniture placement drawings of the space that help to visualize how the inished design will appear. On the basis of the presentation, the client may approve the concept. If it is not agreeable, the design must go back to the drawing board and the process begins again with additional client input. When the concept is approved, the design work may proceed.

Working Drawings and Specifications The inal design development includes working drawings; inal selection of materials, inishes, and furnishings; and written speciications. When approved and signed, speciications and working drawings may become part of the agreement or legal contract between the client and the designer. The working drawings are the inished mechanical drawings or plans prepared for use by the contractors in making bids and completing the construction of the design. The working drawings are often prepared in blueprint form showing the details as they are to be executed. The complete set of working drawings (also called construction drawings) might

The Process and Profession of Design

15

(B) (A) Figure 1.11 (A) This swatch board provides samples for use in color comparison and selection for laminate surfaces. (B) Large hanging fabric samples give the designer and client a full view of the complete pattern—an important consideration in selecting fabric for applications such as upholstery, draperies, bed ensembles, or accessories. (C) Contract design presentation boards are being compiled here to show the materials proposed for the interior of a new building. Photos (A and B) © David A. Taylor, (C) © Kathryn Taylor

include a title sheet, an index, perspective drawings, site plans, loor plans, electrical plans, relected ceiling plans (showing lighting, ventilation, and other ceiling ixtures), sections (a view sliced through the building), elevations (straight-on views), detailed drawings of architectural elements, ixtures, or cabinetwork, and schedules (listing types and inishes of architectural and design elements). The furnishings and materials to be used in the design must be itemized and documented in lists called speciications. The speciications include: • • • • • • • • •

Identiication of the item Its manufacturer Pricing per unit and extended total; labor costs Quantities and types of materials Standards of durability or ire resistance Types of inishes Special instructions for construction or installation Dimensions (sizes) and shipping weights Any other necessary data

If these are not carefully and completely spelled out, the item or construction may not turn out as intended because it was subject to interpretation. Bids may also be inaccurate and inconsistent. When the working drawings and speciications are complete and approved and the contract arrangements have been made, the design process moves into its inal phase.

(C)

Execution The execution is the implementation of the design. During the execution, demolition is done, the actual construction begins, and the materials and furnishings orders are inalized. Ordering can be time consuming, yet like each step in the design process, it must be done with great care and accuracy. When working to meet a deadline, nothing is more frustrating than receiving fewer materials or different furnishings than expected. During this phase of the design process, the work of the contractors should be inspected to ensure that the plans are being carried out properly. This might entail working with builders who do the actual construction and with electricians and plumbers to make sure the electrical, lighting, and plumbing systems are installed as planned and speciied. It usually includes meeting with the carpenters and cabinetmakers who construct and install custom woodwork to verify style, dimensions, and quality. It is necessary to check with window treatment fabricators and installers as well as wall-covering and

Chapter 1

16

(A)

(B)

(C) Figure 1.12 Case Study: Music Room The design concept developed here through CAD or e-design renderings indicates the home owner’s value of fine music in a traditionally styled space. After thorough programming, (A) these black and white, then (B) colored, software renderings confirm the design program. Details of the wall and window treatment can be communicated to the carpenter and workroom, respectively. (C) Then the interior design plan is executed, which includes bas-relief wall paneling, moldings, a wood floor, and oriental rug with a musical instrument as central motif. The grand piano and lavish window treatment are complemented with a crystal chandelier and piano lamps, Neoclassic furniture, and a massed grouping of framed photographs arranged atop the piano. The result is an elegant place to converse, ponder, and listen to beautiful music in an equally beautiful setting. Design by Jamie Gibbs/ renderings by DreamDraper ® software

The Process and Profession of Design

17

(A)

(B) Figure 1.13 Case Study: Reception Area for an International Study Center The style and furnishings in this 1960s building were dated and worn, requiring replacement to accommodate the increasing number of students and alumni who come to learn about the university’s study abroad options. The design program called for clean Modern styling with an Asian influence. (A) Here the to-scale floor plan indicates size and placement of specified furnishings, numbered and cross-referenced to a furniture schedule. The schedule is a list of furnishings and manufacturers. (B) The shaded plan shows a large custom-designed area rug placed over tile. (C) This handdrawn, colored rendering gives a perspective of the finished space. Angled pairs of chairs form a modified parallel grouping, emphasizing the focal point—a map of the world flanked by plaques describing global study programs. Design by Krystal Kolts and Lisa Thompson (C)

18

Chapter 1

looring installers to ensure that the goods are correctly fabricated and installed. All of this supervision is a sort of a juggling act, but it is a crucial part of the process that will help guarantee success. This process is discussed further in Chapter 7, where scheduling, the critical path, and punch lists are explained and illustrated. During installation, furnishings must be inspected for damage. Unfortunately, damage or laws are somewhat common. In this case any necessary insurance claims with shipping irms and manufacturers must be processed without delay. Although the execution phase inevitably has its moments of frustration, it can also be the most gratifying part of the design process. There is great satisfaction when the research and design development inally come together into a completed design. It is exciting to witness what was once a few scrawls on a scrap of paper emerging into something very real, innovative, beautiful, and functional.

Postoccupancy Evaluation After a period of time in which users have lived with and tested the effectiveness of the design, the postoccupancy evaluation (POE) reveals how well the design functions. The evaluation can be accomplished by on-location interviews and open-ended questionnaires. It might seem that the information from such evaluations would be too late to be of any value. The value lies in future improvements and in the beneit of information that can be implemented in other projects. The evaluation is a tool that helps the designer perform better because of the added insight it provides.

Figure 1.14 Contract interior design is specialized. Here, the commercial or retail design problem to be solved was to break the monotony inherent in “big box” retail spaces and bring focus to center power aisles. The design solution for Style Sense Shoes and Accessories was to reinforce brand identity with ceiling panels matching the corporate colors of the entrance logo, enticing customers to enter the store. Design by Aedifica, Inc. and Sid Lee/photo by Eventscape

Contract Considerations The design process for contract or commercial interiors is largely the same as that for a residence, with the exception of the following: • Contract design has a greater emphasis on the preparation of contracts and agreements between the client and the designer. This is the reason nonresidential design is often referred to as contract design. However, contracts for residential projects are not uncommon today. • Preparation of bids is a more common procedure in contract design. The designer develops a concept and prepares an estimate of how much the implementation of the concept will cost. This information is presented to the client, who can compare the concept and its cost with similar presentations by other designers. • The specialties in contract design are diverse, including health care, hospitality (hotels and restaurants), commercial (stores and businesses), and ofice planning. Specialization allows the designer to stay current on issues within his or her area of focus. However, any designer willing to invest the time in research might be able to develop a suitable design solution for any area of specialty. • The proile for a contract design may be more generic. Because customers, employees, and guests are transient, the design of a contract space may be not for a speciic person but rather for any person who performs a certain task or uses a certain space. Consequently, it is more important to identify most contract users in terms of numbers and functions, which are generic considerations. However, for others—such as a

The Process and Profession of Design

president, a chairman of the board, or the senior partner of a law irm—personal preferences will have to be assessed as they would for a residential user. Their ofices might be furnished with more personal and costly items. • Contract designs are often larger in scope, size, and budget, so their planning may be more complex. For example, on large projects, such as hotels or hospitals that require several years for completion, it is usually necessary to substitute for items that may have been discontinued by the manufacturer in the interim. The designer will select substitutes that maintain the integrity of the original design. • Codes and restrictions require that the designer be aware of the needs of the disabled. Today, all areas of a public building must be easily accessible to those with physical limitations. Codes are contained in documents available from state building boards; from health, safety, and welfare departments; and from agencies such as the American National Standards Institute, which have prepared speciications for making buildings accessible to the physically handicapped. The International Conference of Building Oficials has prepared a document called the Uniform Building Code (UBC). This is a set of guidelines for construction that is accepted nationwide.

The Interior Design Profession As the preceding discussion of the design process shows, becoming an interior design professional requires more than enthusiasm and good taste. Successful interior de-

19

signers possess technical and administrative skills as well as insights into problem solving, organization, and cooperation, and attention to detail. In the following section we examine the evolution of this relatively new specialty and the training, qualifying hurdles, and business aspects of the interior design profession as it exists today.

The Design Profession: Past and Present Today’s interior design profession may be said to have two ancestors: architecture and decorative arts. In past centuries, the role of an architect or builder often extended to determining and installing the features of a building’s interior. Other aspects of the interior such as furnishings and carpets were fabricated by specialists such as cabinetmakers and weavers. Custom or “to-order” building and fabricating were the rule rather than the exception. Although the vast majority of people could not afford much choice in the character or quality of the buildings and furnishings they purchased, a few designers created tasteful interiors for the very wealthy. The works of Robert Adam, William Morris, and Charles Rennie Mackintosh in Great Britain and of Samuel McIntire in the United States endure today as admirable examples. By the beginning of the twentieth century, many Americans had attained enough wealth and status to demand more elaborately planned interiors than what an architect or specialized craftsperson could provide. It was at this point that architecture and decorative arts merged to produce a new kind of professional: the interior designer, who would specify, coordinate, and oversee the plans, construction, and installation of interiors.

Figure 1.15 Interior designer Lynn Lemone inspects some drawings in the studio of this contract architectural and interior design firm. Renderings, materials boards, and accompanying documents for current projects are created in this functional and efficient space. Photo © Kathryn Taylor

20

Chapter 1

Perhaps the greatest of these “society” designers was Elsie deWolfe (1865–1950). The Bauhaus school of architecture and design, founded in Germany in 1919, trained designers to create interiors with a more functional, populist orientation. Unlike previous arbiters of style who had shunned mass-produced products, the Bauhaus actively promoted the use of machine-age materials, resulting in excellent designs such as the classic modern tubular steel chair. When the school was closed during the Nazi regime in 1933, many of its faculty—including Ludwig Mies van der Rohe, Marcel Breuer, Walter Gropius, and Wassily Kandinsky—emigrated to the United States. Their techniques and ideals, together with those of Scandinavian designers, have continued to deine modernism in design from the 1950s to the present. The post–World War II period in America witnessed a new level of afluence, commercial development, building, and population growth. Technology that had originated in the war effort was turned to manufacturing domestic products such as plastics, man-made ibers, and building systems. The general public was presented with an overwhelmingly wide variety of affordable goods. As a result, the demand for professionals to help navigate through the maze of materials and furnishings increased dramatically. Both residential and contract users appreciated the ability of knowledgeable interior design professionals to create an interior design plan and then guide their choices, administer their budgets, and oversee the execution of interiors that met their needs and wants. Today’s interior designers not only design creative and individual interiors but also act as speciiers, organizers, and buyers. Although the result of the design is still the completed interior, the profession has matured far beyond the era of artisans or society designers. The complexity of creating interiors increases as the diversity of styles, products, building systems, and user needs expands. Responding to the demand for excellence in design now involves a wide spectrum of professional tasks requiring extensive skill and training.

Designer Skills The interior designer today must have skills, education, training, and experience to perform a great variety of tasks, which include the following: • Developing the design, which includes generating and reining the design ideas leading to a design concept. • Preparing the documents and letters of agreement pertaining to all contractual aspects of the interior and handling inancial and business matters concerned with the design execution. • Working with or specifying building systems, such as heating, plumbing, air-conditioning, and all aspects of lighting.

• Specifying materials, inishes, and furnishings, which requires a thorough knowledge of all types of loor, ceiling, and wall-covering materials and textile applications as well as a knowledge of period and contemporary architecture and furnishings and green design. • Preparing working drawings for cabinetry or interior details to be executed by a craftsperson or subcontractor. • Overseeing the execution, installation, and completion of all contracted areas of the design project. • Conducting the POE. Among the speciic skills and knowledge required for these tasks are: • Technical skills including drafting or technical drawing, computer skills applicable to business management, as well as design and computational skills for measuring and costing • Knowledge of construction methods, building systems, codes, architectural speciications, and safety requirements • Ongoing awareness of innovations in materials, inishes, and furnishings • Business skills such as employee management, budgeting, purchasing and lines of credit, marketing, and public relations • Verbal communication skills, including the ability to present ideas, concepts, and contracts in written and verbal form • Visual communication skills, including the ability to present ideas and concepts in sketches, renderings, and technical drawings

Training and Professional Development Formal Design Education There are many institutions offering accredited and fully developed interior design degree and certiicate programs. They include departments and schools of architecture, ine arts, and home economics within universities, colleges, and design schools. Accreditation is granted by the Foundation for Interior Design Education and Research (FIDER), which provides a list of the schools and programs that meet its standards. The Council for Interior Design Accreditation (CIDA) sets standards for postsecondary interior design education, establishing and periodically updating those standards. The council’s thorough and careful review of interior design programs’ compliance with standards ensures that graduates will be prepared for entry-level practice and poised for future professional growth, a signiicant competitive advantage considered by potential employers. Many programs are accredited, and many good programs are not accredited. Education programs generally require from two to six years of study, with additional time needed to obtain

The Process and Profession of Design

21

Figure 1.16 (A) At the drafting board, interior designer Lynn Lemone is creating a floor tile pattern for the Karl Maeser Academy, coloring his selected design to scale in the floor plan space where tile layers will execute his design. (B) A rendering for Trivani, an Italian/Tuscan-style restaurant. (C) Materials boards and renderings are shown for client approval in the presentation room of this architectural and interior design firm. Photos © Kathryn Taylor

(A)

(B)

(C)

22

Chapter 1

graduate degrees. While it is possible to bypass formal education and learn the interior design profession through apprenticeship and on-the-job experience, this process is ultimately more time consuming and dificult than a formal program of study. Most schools have internship options that allow students to receive academic credit while working in professional interior design irms; such options provide an advantageous opportunity to combine academic theories with practical applications. Table 1.2 lists topics of study in interior design programs.

NCIDQ Examination The National Council for Interior Design Qualiication (NCIDQ) serves to identify to the public those interior designers who have met the minimum standards for professional practice by passing the NCIDQ examination. The organization tries to maintain the most advanced procedures for examination and continually reviews the examination to include expanding techniques in design development and professional knowledge. A study guide to prepare a candidate for the exam is available on request from NCIDQ. The NCIDQ exam is administered periodically at many locations around the country. It is now a requirement for full acceptance into several professional organizations. The exam covers the candidate’s knowledge of interior design and poses a creative problem that the candidate must solve. A designer who has earned a baccalaureate degree and worked for a minimum of two years in the ield should be eligible to take the exam. The NCIDQ exam sets a standard

of excellence and competence so that professional interior designers may better serve the public.

Titlement and Licensing In order to ensure professionalism, competency, and quality services, some states have passed title or licensing acts. This means that in order to use the title “interior designer,” the professional must be licensed. Although requirements may vary from one state to another, generally, to obtain a license, the designer must pass the NCIDQ exam and have worked a minimum number of years in the profession. In order to maintain that license, designers are required to earn a minimum number of continuing education units (CEUs) each year. As a general rule, one CEU is equal to ten “contact” or study hours. For example, a state that requires ive CEUs per year would, in effect, require ifty hours of advanced CEU training. The CEU offers a way for designers to keep abreast of changes and developments in the interior design practice and profession.

Interior Design Resources As the English writer Samuel Johnson said, knowledge is of two kinds: we know a subject ourselves, or we know where we can ind information about it. Successful interior designers know where to go for information and how to access the resources that will best enable them to fulill the needs of a given project.

Trade Resources

Table 1.2

Topics of Study in Interior Design Education Programs

• Basic and creative arts such as two- and three-dimensional design, ine, and applied arts. • Design theory, human factors, and spatial composition. • Residential and contract design. • Design for special populations (handicapped, elderly, etc.), special problems (environmental, etc.), and special purposes (historic preservation, adaptive reuse). • Design materials (textiles, lighting, furniture, color). • Technical knowledge such as structure and construction, building systems, energy conservation, detailing, materials, laws, building codes, and ordinances. • Communication skills, such as verbal, written, and visual presentation, drafting, and computer systems. • Professional practice and organization and speciication skills. • History of art, architecture, interiors, furnishings, and materials. • Research methodologies, survey, literature search, and observation. • Computer application.

An immense number of trade sources exist to serve the interior design industry today. Trade sources are companies or vendors that sell goods and services to the trade (designers, architects, and speciiers) for purchase by their retail clients. These goods include every element of ixtures and furnishings needed in an interior. Goods and services are ordered via wholesale catalogs or online; through manufacturing and product representatives, or reps; or through regional showrooms, which may be closed (allowing only designers to enter and purchase) or open (allowing retail clients to accompany the designer). Craftspeople usually function independently of showrooms and sales representatives; quality craftspeople generally are in demand and have no need to market their services. Most major cities now have design marketing centers or markets, which are convenient clusters of trade-source showrooms that serve the designer. Many craftspeople are located near markets.

Interior Design and Technology Interior designers have access to a wide variety of technological tools that increase creativity and eficiency of design, speciication of products and materials, and communication with clients and other professionals. Today’s

The Process and Profession of Design

interior designers may work on projects locally, regionally, and/or globally. Virtual project team members may work together to bring about buildings and interiors using state of the art communications. Computers and software, handheld devices and their applications, or apps, are ever evolving. Training is ongoing, as upgrades to both hardware and software and changes in communication devices enter the marketplace in rapid-ire sequence. The following commonly used terms represent computer and technology tools and applications for interior design: Building information modeling (BIM) is an enhanced CADD software with the capability of generating and managing building data using three-dimensional, realtime, dynamic building modeling software to increase productivity in building design and construction. BIM encompasses building geometry, spatial relationships, geographic information, and quantities and properties of building components. One well-known example of BIM software is Autodesk® Revit® Architecture. Computer communication includes e-mail, used for direct professional communication. Skype and virtual meeting software allow networking and videoconferencing to gather data and evaluate designs downloaded to FTP sites or through CADD BIM software. Social networking sites are used for instant messaging or chatting and marketing. Blogs are used for sharing information and also as marketing tools. Computer-aided design (CAD) is computer software used to draw and render interior design spaces and concepts, and Computer-aided design and drafting (CADD) software features drafting, rendering, and animating of concepts, creating working drawings and details. Data or project management software keeps track of spreadsheets used for preparing speciications of materials, inishes, and furnishings. Project management software is used to oversee calendars and critical paths (scheduling deadlines) and to monitor procurement, delivery, and installation of materials, inishes, and furnishings. E-design is a general term for computer-based software with certain design and speciication capabilities, such as basic CAD features to create room plans with structural openings (walls, windows, ireplaces), placement of ixtures, furniture and accessories, wall and window treatment design, placement of sample fabrics, rugs, and furniture onto the designed furnishings copied from websites where these products are purchased. E-design interacts with speciication and calculating software to order and keep track of budgets and the execution of the design. File transfer protocol (FTP) is a site on the Internet where iles downloaded are larger and more complex than can be transmitted via e-mail attachment. The sites are continuously available until no longer needed.

23

Financial accounting software manages the income from clients and outgo to suppliers and subcontractors. Reports can be generated for the interior design irm’s bankers/lenders and tax accountants. Handheld communication devices (HHCD) are more than cell phones; they can send e-mails and perform a wide variety of tasks, from banking transactions to communicating with hardwired systems and devices. Product searches and sources are conducted on the Internet and via industry CD-ROM or printed catalog. Catalogs for products or contract speciications are mostly available on industry source websites, where photographs and information can be copied and dropped into design documents. The Internet is also used for ordering, conirmation, tracking shipping, and can be used for paying for the products. Telephone, cell phone, and computer webcam conferencing are the means by which interior designers stay in constant communication with clients, suppliers, subcontractors, and other professionals to ensure that all speciied components of a space are progressing and will be installed according to a time line or critical path. More wireless information is found in Chapter 5.

Professionals in Related Fields The process of interior design is a team effort on the part of design professionals, craftspeople, and laypeople. In addition to having the interpersonal and business skills needed to work effectively with clients and users, interior designers must have the ability to participate in teams with professionals such as: • General contractors and builders, who are licensed and legally responsible for the outcome of the structures they erect. • Architects, who are also licensed and legally responsible and are essential team members in projects for upscale clientele. Many major architectural irms have interior design departments. • Subcontractors, who specialize in handling speciic aspects such as plumbing, HVAC, and electrical systems, drywall or plaster, masonry, siding, painting, and inishing carpentry. • Cabinetmakers, who create custom closets and cabinetry and other built-ins. • Retailers and wholesalers of products such as furniture, paint and wall coverings, lighting, window treatments, and loor coverings. Dealers who sell at retail to the public often provide discounts to interior designers. • Fabricators and craftspeople, such as textile fabricators, upholsterers, custom-furniture makers, restoration specialists, ine artists, stained-glass artisans, and stone carvers. • Installers of materials, such as looring and loor coverings, bath and kitchen ixtures, paneling, tile,

24

Chapter 1

(A)

(C) Figure 1.17 Interior designers work closely with trades professionals or subcontractors such as (A) painters; (B) electricians, who install rough wiring for lighting and technology systems and finish electrical—the installation of switches and outlets, luminaires, media, and electronic devices; and (C) cabinetmakers, who measure, construct, and install built-in cabinetry for kitchen, bath, dining room, office, or other residential and contract locations where custom built-ins enhance the design and function of the space. (A and C) © David A. Taylor, (B) © Judy K. Brody

wallpaper, and drapery rods and other window treatments. Installers may be involved in measuring and estimating when the design is in the planning stage.

Professional Organizations

(B)

Design organizations exist to research and make available to their members (through continuing education) new and improved design methods, information, sources, and materials. These organizations encourage high levels of professionalism. Each organization has its own standards of excellence, various levels of association, and entrance requirements. See the Interiors website for further information.

The Process and Profession of Design

Careers in Interior Design An education in interior design provides professional opportunities in an almost endless variety of ields and specialties, and an important distinction is frequently made between residential and contract design. Each of these two career categories has certain characteristics that tend to be consistent from one project to the next.

Residential Interior Design Residential designers create interiors for homes, vacation homes, apartments and town houses, and other dwellings. They typically have close contact with users, often working directly for them, and strive to express their clients’ personal tastes. In other cases they work with rental units, or new construction, in which the occupants are not present until the interiors are completed. Residential designers may specialize in particular rooms, such as kitchens or media rooms. They also may pursue careers in the retail sector, where they staff the interior design service departments that are incorporated into quality department stores, furniture stores, and home improvement stores.

Contract Interior Design Contract design is far less personal than most residential work, and it entails a higher degree of attention to issues

25

of project management and code compliance. While some contract irms do a variety of interiors, most specialize in a speciic type, such as hospitals, hotels, or ofices. Specialization allows contract designers to gain the depth of experience and expertise that is often necessary to secure work assignments. It is not unusual for a contract client to solicit competitive bids for interior design work, to examine candidates’ business practices, and to require formal presentation of proposals before awarding a contract.

Specialized Design As indicated above, interior designers—especially those working in contract design—often become proicient and skilled in a particular specialty, such as hospitality (hotels, restaurants, resorts); commercial/retail (ofices, stores); health care (hospitals, medical ofices, hospices); and institutional design (government, education). In addition to fostering in-depth knowledge, specialization allows designers to work in areas where their expertise can help prevent mistakes and consequent litigation. As interior designers are increasingly held legally responsible for the outcome of their projects, the importance of specialization as a risk management strategy becomes greater. Table 1.3 describes many of the career specialties within the interior design ield.

Figure 1.18 Bathroom design is a residential specialty where efficiency and beauty combine. Here custom cabinets and sink area provide space for personal grooming. Generous woodwork, called the “finish package,” is painted in a clean white, contrasting with soothing gray walls and large-scale dark tile floor. This bathroom features bathing with a view to a garden area and separate showering in a spacious, custom-designed shower enclosure. Task lighting is planned into the grooming and showering areas while lovely crystal chandeliers provide pleasant general lighting. Design by Donna L.A. Riddell, CKD, CBD; Artistry Design Group Ltd./Photography: F8 Photographic/ NKBA Design Competition

26

Chapter 1

Table 1.3

Design Specialties and Related Fields

• Acoustic design—planning the sound-relecting and -absorbing qualities of an interior through the shape of the space and through speciied inishes and materials. Theater design will incorporate acoustics. • Adaptive reuse—the remodeling of old or historic structures to it a purpose different from the original. A wharf warehouse, for example, could become a shopping plaza or mall; an old home could become a law, real estate, or insurance ofice; inner-city buildings could become luxury condominiums or coops. Rehabilitation, or rehab, is the process of bringing any older building up to current standards so that it can be inhabited. • Amusement park design—carrying themes into every item of the park, from signs to trash cans and drinking fountains. It also deals with safety, trafic patterns, and eficiency. • Aquarium design—for homes, ofices, and aquatic parks and museums. This specialty could also include maintenance. • Architectural space planning or loor plan design—drafting by hand or CADD. • Art and accessory dealerships—selling i ne art and/or unique accessories retail to the public or wholesale to interior designers. • Bathroom design—an important residential specialty, bathrooms are often designed by the same professionals who design kitchens, as many are Certiied Kitchen and Bath Designers, members of the National Kitchen and Bath Association. • Buying—for large department and furniture stores. Buyers select loor merchandise or lines (merchandise offered by particular companies) carried by the company. • Cabinet, closet, and storage design—custom design to suit individual needs or dealerships in retail modular storage furniture. • Color consultation—for marketing irms, industry, architectural, or interior design irms, business corporations, government.

• Communication design—working with specialized needs in ofices for computer terminal stations, telecommunication conference rooms, and other areas. • Construction/project management—overseeing the construction and acting as liaison between client and contractor. This may include hiring the architect, engineers, subcontractors, craftspeople, and consultants. • Drafting and/or CADD, computer-aided drafting and design. • Design for the handicapped, aged, or inirm—including design for medical facilities, rest homes, hospices, residences, or products. • Energy conservation—acting as consultant to architectural irms or clients to increase energy eficiency (see also solar design). • Entertainment center design—designing the storage units for television, videocassette recorders, stereo equipment, computers, media-center rooms, and home theater. • Environmental safety—research into materials that will not burn or do not threaten the safety of the users or of the environment; consultation to manufacturers and architects. • Environmental/green design—specifying materials and furnishings that are from renewable resources, minimally impact the environment, and contribute to a safe and healthy interior. • Event planning—organizing and executing furnishings for events. These include corporate meetings or parties, wedding receptions, or other large-scale gatherings requiring temporary interior design. • Facilities management—a fast-growing ield where corporations utilize a manager to plan and purchase furnishings and to coordinate and be responsible for all building repairs and maintenance. The facility may be one building or dozens of buildings in dozens of locations; the manager oversees other employees in the facilities department.

Figure 1.19 Facilities managers are responsible for the inventory (purchase and replacement) and maintenance of systems furniture like this. Photo courtesy of Herman Miller

The Process and Profession of Design

27

Figure 1.20 Furniture design is a residential and contract interior design specialty. These classic Midcentury Modern pieces, the Swag desk and chair, were designed by Georg Nelson in 1958. Today, these clean design, light scale pieces are perfect for sleek laptops anywhere Wi-Fi connections accommodate paperless computer work. Photo courtesy of Herman Miller

• Forensic consultation—studying a product’s construction and appropriate use for manufacturing, for application, or for purposes of testifying in litigation proceedings. • Furniture design—the design of new and innovative furnishing items such as case goods, upholstered furniture, and accessories. • Furniture retail sales or rental business—residential and/or contract. • Graphic design and illustration, and signage graphics—such as creating a corporate image. • Greenhouse and solarium design—designing spaces for healthy plants (including temperature and humidity control); also designing sun spaces for people to dine, socialize, or relax in a heated spa. • Hard-surface loor-covering design—including both the actual design of the tiles or vinyl and the use/application of ceramic tiles, wood, brick, and stone on loors, walls, and ceilings (including mosaic and mural work). • Hardware design—designing doorknobs, handles, and hinges. • Health care design—designing hospitals, clinics, hospices, and doctors’ ofices. (continued)

Figure 1.21 Kitchen designers are responsible for efficient space planning, custom cabinetry that meets the clients’ needs, possessions, and lifestyles, task and general lighting, fixture and appliance specifications, and countertop, wall material, paint, flooring, and seating selections. Kitchen designers also know that a kitchen that is the heart of the home means fine design is artistic and must express individuality. Design by Siri Evju, CKD, CBD; Siri Designs/Photography: Manier Creative/NKBA Design Competition

28

Chapter 1

• Health club/recreational facility design—buildings that house swimming pools, indoor ball courts, gyms for workout and aerobics. Safety as well as good design is important. • Historic preservation and restoration of authentic interiors maintained as museums; also, restoring ine old buildings to their original state or an adaptation of it. Historic preservation is a growing concern in both residential and contract interior design and requires thorough knowledge of specialized goods and services. • Hospitality design—interior design for hotels, convention centers, resorts, cruise ships, and restaurants. A large and important area in contract design. • Industrial facilities—manufacturing plants and accompanying ofices and support areas. • In-house corporate design—design, consult with experts, and coordinate components to keep the corporate image prestigious. • Journalism—magazine and newspaper articles on design. • Justice design—designing secured facilities such as prisons and courthouses. • Kitchen design—planning the latest in cooking equipment and eficient food preparation and serving areas, plus accommodating a social environment. (A Certiied Kitchen Designer uses CKD after his or her name.) • Landscaping—design irms specializing in interior landscaping select, sell, rent, and maintain real and artiicial plants. • Law—handling litigation over interior design projects, working toward legislation, or serving as advisors concerning design laws, public safety, historic preservation, or a host of other design-related areas. • Law ofice design—incorporating specialized needs, equipment, and personnel with an image. • Library design—meeting needs of different kinds and locations (such as law libraries) and all the inherent equipment and space planning. • Lighting design—a twofold career option: designing lighting plans and specialty lighting needs for interiors, and designing the lighting ixtures or luminaires. • Management—in design irms, in industry, or in design-related business, or as facilities managers. • Manufacturer’s representatives (reps or sales reps)—liaisons between the trade and vendors. Call on design irms within a designated territory to whom they provide or sell product samples or catalogs. They order stock merchandise and provide the link between the manufacturer and retailer or designer in obtaining goods and services, providing swifter service, and troubleshooting. Reps also assist the designer in preparing speciications, selecting merchandise, preparing bids, and writing purchase orders. • Marketing—consultants to wholesale and retail irms and to exporters/importers of design goods. • Medical facilities—interior design for hospitals, clinics, and other medical care facilities. • Model-home design—renting or selling furnishings to model homes. Similar to residential design but without having to deal with a user who will live there. Luxury models for condominiums, lats, or co-ops incorporate expensive and luxurious design.

• Museum design—planning spaces; meeting specialized needs for display design, background materials, specialized lighting, humidity control, and trafic low. Curatorship—directors of museums or archives are yet another career option. • Ofice design—range from small home ofices to high-rise buildings. Professional ofices, such as medical or law ofices, are another ofice specialty. • Plumbing ixture design—designing sinks, lavatories, bathtubs and saunas, toilets and bidets, and faucets. • Product design—new and innovative furnishing items such as furniture and accessories. • Product evaluation—consulting with and recommending marketing strategies to companies that are introducing new designs and products. • Professional organizer—assisting individuals and businesses in organizing their surroundings through categorization, decluttering, cleaning, and the application of organizational principles, thus enhancing time, productivity, and task management eficiency. May belong to the National Association of Professional Organizers (NAPO).

Figure 1.22 Professional organizers assist individuals and businesses in organizing their surroundings for enhanced time, productivity, and task management. Here, possessions are categorized and neatly placed in boxes, baskets, shelves, drawers, and on hooks to enhance the interior design and uncomplicate the owner’s lifestyle. Design by Siemasko + Verbridge/photo © Brian Vanden Brink

The Process and Profession of Design

29

• Publicity and public relations (PR)—establishing and/or marketing an image for corporations, company products, or other designers. • Purchasing agent—an interior designer can act as purchaser for large companies, negotiating and overseeing correct ordering of furnishings. • Real estate specialist—interior designers often buy real estate, improve or remodel the building, and sell it at a proit. Building new nonresidential buildings and leasing them is another aspect. A real estate agent can also arrange inancing and sell homes or contract buildings. • Rendering—artists’ conceptions of interior or exterior design. • Restaurant design—a specialty in the interior design of restaurants, cafeterias, bars, and fast-food services. • Retail design—from individual boutiques to large department stores and from single shops to entire shopping malls, creative designers are in demand. • Retail selling—many interior designers own, manage, or work in retail stores. Specialty shops might include accessories, selected new or antique furniture, textiles, or ine art. Interior designers themselves are often expert sales people. • Salon/spa design—design of beauty and barber shops, tanning facilities, nail sculpturing, and health/beauty spas. • Set design—set design is needed for television, theater, movies, and for taking photographs for furniture companies. • Showroom designer—the interior design and space planning of permanent and seasonal showrooms of furniture, fabric, carpet, accessories. This can be done on a freelance basis or as a permanent employee of a manufacturing irm.

• Solar design—requiring knowledge of energy eficiency, sun control, and sunlight-resistant materials. Specialists in solar interior design are needed in both residential and contract design. • Textile design for fabrics, wallpaper, or carpeting—working inhouse for large conversion companies, or freelancing and selling designs (or being paid royalties) for textile design. Custom design occasionally calls for one-of-a-kind textiles. • Training specialists—in areas such as computers, retail sales and marketing, lighting, product or material speciications, or other design services. • Transportation design—including specialties in aircraft interiors (passenger jets to corporate jets), marine design (interiors of luxury liners to private yachts), bus and train interior design, and even automobile design. • Turnkey design—in which the designer sells the project and assumes complete responsibility to hire all consultants/ subcontractors and inish the project with very little input from the client, who needs only to turn the key and walk in to a completed interior. Vacation homes are one application of this specialty. • Universal or transgenerational design—planning and furnishing buildings that are easy to use without drawing attention to the user, regardless of age or physical abilities. • Window treatment design—today so many style and mechanical options exist in window treatments that it takes expertise to know which treatments to specify. Fabric coordination with overall design and furnishings is also necessary.

Teaching Interior Design

program by imparting the skills and experiences gleaned from real-life situations. Many academic design departments rely on practicing professionals who serve as parttime instructors.

To qualify for a full-time position in a university, college, or design school, a candidate is usually expected to have professional experience as well as a terminal degree: master of arts (MA), master of science (MS), master of i ne arts (MFA), or doctor of philosophy (PhD). The degree may be in interior design or in a related ield such as architecture, art history, business management, CAD, education, historic preservation, humanities, psychology, or housing. Hiring and advancement are based on factors such as teaching effectiveness, creative work and research, and service to the institution and the community. Teaching design in high schools or community colleges is another career option. High schools generally offer courses in interior design as a part of their Family and Consumer Science Education (FACS Ed) programs. Community colleges may offer interior design courses, and some offer vocational training or associate degrees that may emphasize design. A bachelor’s degree may be the minimum requirement to teach in either of these situations, and high schools usually require a teaching certiicate as well. Teaching part-time is also a viable career option. Designers who are active in the profession or in a related ield can add immeasurably to the strength of a design

Financial Considerations As most clients usually view creating an interior as a major expense, they want to be sure the money they invest in a design project is being spent wisely. The designer will need not only good aesthetic sense and training, but also good budget sense. A thorough knowledge of sources and products is essential to allow the designer to suggest and obtain elements that the client can afford and that will meet the client’s needs. By applying the elements and principles of design, the designer can avoid making aesthetic mistakes that would disappoint the client and require extra work to correct. The designer is also often charged with hiring and supervising subcontractors, installers, and craftspeople; the costs for these participants must also be monitored and accounted for. Last but not least, designers themselves must be paid. The amount and structure of designer fees vary according to circumstance and are, of course, based on the type and extent of services the designer provides. For

30

Chapter 1

(A)

(B)

The Process and Profession of Design

consulting with clients, a designer usually charges a lat fee or an hourly rate, freeing clients to shop on their own and purchase goods from whatever source they wish. For executing residential interiors, designers often receive payments based on retail sales or retail less a percentage. This arrangement may be combined with a design fee based on the time spent preparing estimates, drafting, rendering, shopping, and supervising installation, in which case the interior designer may be paid monthly or in increments as various phases of the design program are accomplished. Letters of agreement outline the services to be rendered by the designer, whether purchasing is to be done by the designer on the client’s behalf, and which arrangement (retail, retail less a percentage, or wholesale plus a percentage) is agreed upon. The letter will outline speciic phases of the design job, the client’s responsibility to third-party contractors and services, compensation arrangements, and collateral matters. Disclaimers (items and services for

31

which the designer is not responsible) will limit the designer’s liability and clarify the relationship between the designer and the client. A retainer fee, applicable to the design fees or the goods to be purchased, is customarily required to initiate work by the design irm. Contract interior design is often based on a lat fee, computing in advance the projected time necessary to complete the design. The lat fee may also be based on the square footage of the project. When fees are based on time, the salary of each person (principal, project manager, senior and junior designers, draftspersons, secretaries) who will be involved in a project is computed or projected, and the monthly salary of each person is multiplied by the number of months spent in each phase of the design job (programming, designing, construction, installation). That amount is multiplied by 3 to cover wages, overhead, proit, and anticipated overtime spent on the job. The square-foot method is used less often but is applicable for large spaces. Purchasing arrangements for contract furnishings are typically billed at wholesale plus 10 to 20 percent. The designer may not purchase for contract jobs but may specify furnishings that are ordered by the purchasing department of the client’s irm. Likewise, nonresidential clients are generally responsible to pay for third-party services such as those of architects, engineers, and general contractors. Billings for design goods and services are billed monthly or in prearranged installments that parallel each phase of the project.

Figure 1.23 A–C Case Study: The Pier at Caesars A dramatic addition to Caesars Palace, Atlantic City, NJ, this three-story, 100-shop, high-end retail facility extends directly out into the Atlantic Ocean. The design purpose of this project was to make a very long straight passage of 1,500 feet, captivate guests, make strolling irresistible, and also evoke the shoreline. The name of the mall, The Pier, is matched by an actual pier, a traditional plank boardwalk accessorized with real sand and beach chairs. Eventscape created framed fabric panels that float suspended from the ceiling, evoking the clouds and waves of the seascape nearby. Soothing waves of light projected on the ceiling structures create the illusion of a relaxing stroll along the beach. The rhythmic motion of clouds and waves is projected as animations onto overhead panels. The result is a decorative extension to the ceiling that creates a serene mood, leading to lingering in the retail shops. The undulating shape of the wave pattern and repetitions were required and answered with four cloud and nine wave forms. A slim profile structure was required with a complex, double-curved surface. This was achieved by the use of aluminum tubing and flexible fabric. De(C)

sign by the Rockwell Group, lighting by Focus Lighting, Ceiling Elements: Eventscape, Inc./photo by Taylor Photo, courtesy of Eventscape Inc.

32

Chapter 1

The Future of Interior Design It is clear that in the future there will be a greater need for designers to be knowledgeable about the complex and technical aspects of interior design. Increased litigation over design projects points to the increasing accountability of interior designers for the environments they create. Because of this, designers in the future will specialize further to gain expertise in one area of design. Computer technology plays a commanding role in the future of interior design. Increasingly capable databases and business management applications assist in the coordination of research and documentation, analysis, organization, and processing of all documentation handled by the interior designer. Technological developments and virtual teamwork will continue to increase globally. Financial programs aid in preparing estimates, purchasing goods and services, and monitoring budgets. Graphic applications such as CAD have become more powerful;

designers and clients will utilize enhanced virtual reality as a tool for visualizing and planning how an interior will look and feel. Technology is impacting interior design in exciting and amazing ways. Special effects from lighting and projection are just the beginning of a new realm of design that embraces technology. Materials continue to be improved through research and development (R&D), giving the designer more latitude for using both structural and decorative elements in creative and unusual ways. While traditional and country design will still be a style of choice, the future of modern and contemporary design will see a continuing evolution of media and materials that will give designers tools to create unique and even astonishing design in the future. No matter the style preference, more design will use motorization, new materials, and new ways of solving design problems. The future of interior design is very bright indeed.

Chapter 2 Special Considerations in Design Important Design Considerations 34 Environmental Considerations 34 Considerations for Special Needs Users 44 Design for Special Populations 45 Special Design Considerations as Fundamental Goals 52

© Scott Frances/Esto

34

Chapter 2

Important Design Considerations

Sustainability

Chapter 1 discussed the role of designers as problem solvers. Nowhere is this more crucial than in design that deals ethically with the environment and the special needs of users. Ethics are simply the moral obligation to do what is right. We have an ethical responsibility to care for the earth that is our home. We have similar ethical accountability to make life as free from design problems as possible for those whose needs differ from the norm. This chapter deals with design issues related to the environment and populations with special needs.

Sustainability means thinking about creating buildings and interior environments now, but also considering how they will be used 50, 100, or more years from now. It also includes strategies such as the use of environmentally friendly materials, recycling, and energy eficiency. Concepts of sustainability extend to include waste management, avoiding pollution, conserving resources, and utilizing materials and furnishings that are made from renewable resources with long life spans and requiring minimal upkeep. Sustainability is a healthy and educated mind-set about living and working to support rather than deplete natural resources. Ultimately, sustainability

Environmental Considerations Designers have an ethical responsibility to be aware of the impact their designs have on the environment and subsequently on users. That responsibility includes avoiding waste and pollution, as well as ensuring long life for design so that it will not be prematurely discarded. These are critical features of good design, and when design is good, both the environment and users beneit.

(A)

(B)

Figure 2.1 (A) This sustainable-source wood floor is harvested from forest restoration projects and only as small-diameter trees that allow old-growth forest conditions to return, restoring the forest to its original healthy integrity with greatly reduced danger of highintensity fire. These smaller trees have a dense grain and hard fiber, perfect for beautiful durable flooring and trim. (B) Broadloom carpeting and cushions can be sustainable in a number of ways. High-quality, dense tufted carpets in neutral, variegated two-tone effects have a longer physical and aesthetic life span and are less likely to show soiling and wear from traffic. During production, green manufacturing methods use less water, less energy, or renewable energy from bio-based fuel. The carpet may pass the Carpet and Rug Institute (CRI) Green Label Plus, enhancing the contribution toward LEED-certified buildings. Carpets may contain postconsumer reused content, such as polyethelene (PET—recycled plastic bottles) fiber. Carpet can also be collected at recovery and recycling centers, which diverts waste from landfills. Carpet may be made completely or in part from polylactic acid (corn syrup) renewable fibers, such as DuPont’s Bio-PDO™, a key ingredient in Sorona® fiber used in Mohawk Industries SmartStrand™ carpet. And new carpets may be engineered to release far less greenhouse gas emissions, resulting in better indoor air quality (IAQ). (A) Photo courtesy of Lupine Design, Clawson Windows and North Slope Sustainable Wood, (B) Photo courtesy of Mohawk Industries

Special Considerations in Design

means creating long-lasting buildings and interiors that tread lightly on the environment.

Use of Resources There are two types of resources used by builders and developers: renewable and nonrenewable. Renewable resources include materials such as wood from trees that can be replanted in sustained-growth forests. Nonrenewable resources include minerals and metals in their raw form as well as fossil fuels. Fortunately, some forms of both renewable and nonrenewable resources, such as metals, plastics, and paper products, can be recycled. When buildings are demolished or interiors refurnished, the demolished or discarded materials and furnishings will have to be removed to a landill unless they can be recycled.

Resource Efficiency and Sustainability Because space for landills is becoming increasingly hard to ind, good ethics point to resource eficiency. “Reduce, reuse, recycle, and repair” are old but familiar ideas that constitute resource eficiency. Reduce simply means to use less. Reuse means to ind new uses for things that have become obsolete. Recycle may be synonymous with reuse, but it also means saving used materials for reconstitution, so they can be used again as if they were new. Discarded paper, for example, can be reprocessed into new paper. Repair means doing what is necessary to return something that no longer functions, or has been damaged, to working condition, rather than discarding it. Resource eficiency has been imperative in times of hardship. Nineteenth-century pioneers and those who lived through the great depression of the twentieth century were experts at resource eficiency. In times of great abundance, resource eficiency becomes an ethical practice of those who value the environment.

35

In doing so, they preserve the environment, simplify life, and amplify life’s spiritual possibilities. Basic human needs include food, clothing, and shelter. In order to obtain these basic needs, some form of transportation— public or personal—is generally needed. Basic shelter includes places to prepare food, eat, sleep, sit, converse, and maintain hygiene. These needs include certain furnishings, ixtures, and appliances that are necessary to do household work. Beyond that, all things we possess are wants. It is startling to see how very few material goods and how little space many in the world live with, yet maintain lives of meaning and purpose. Today, many luxuries seem to be necessities. Huge houses with soaring ceilings, enormous windows, and luxurious inishes and furnishings are considered by some to be very desirable because they are symbols of accomplishment or simply because of their luxury. Such houses, however, because of their size and luxury, consume more materials and are more costly to build and maintain than more modest dwellings. Environments that are larger than needed require more energy to light, heat, and cool and are more dificult and costly to maintain. When we build or purchase houses that are beyond our inancial means, we incur debt that may lead

Modest Living and Sustainability Modest living is something few of us may consider when contemplating sustainability, but those who live modestly use their own and the earth’s resources to meet needs rather than to fuli ll wants.

Figure 2.2 This pleasant interior is an example of modest living. Because of its moderate size, it requires fewer materials and resources to build and furnish; uses less energy to light, heat, and cool; and is less difficult and costly to maintain than over-large, ostentatious homes. Design by The Green Company/photo © Brian Vanden Brink

36

Chapter 2

to inancial and emotional strain. Sustainability can be turned around to mean our ability to sustain ourselves, and when we overextend, we are incapable of sustaining ourselves. Organization and maintenance are vital parts of modest living. Our lives can become so cluttered with possessions that we no longer know what we own. Thus, we buy unnecessarily to replace what we can no longer ind. Modest living is also about being good stewards over that which we possess. Wise stewardship is not only caring for what we have, but having only what we really need. It means being aware of ways to contribute to the health of the earth while assuring personal or family well-being. If we buy wisely we need to buy only once. For example, a well-designed and well-built piece of furniture can be used for generations. Well-chosen carpets and other soft furnishings can be used for years—until they are worn out. They may require cleaning and maintenance, but if we organize and care for our possessions, they can be used for years, even indeinitely. A writer for a respected American newspaper reports that there is a grassroots movement called Voluntary Simplicity, consisting of people who want to limit the size of their homes and number of their possessions in order to temper their pace of life. Many are attracted to the movement because of environmental concerns while others are drawn by spiritual beneits. The writer notes that people are starting to see that their possessions are a deterrent to peace of conscience, peace of mind, and happiness. They feel that the more they have, the more responsible they are for their possessions and the less breathing room they have. If they can create breathing room in their lives, they are more likely to ind increased spiritual dimensions. Physical clutter is psychologically grating and emotionally taxing. Anyone who has purged a home in preparation for moving, knows the satisfaction and even happiness that come from discarding and simplifying. By living modestly we consume less, reducing the impact we have on the environment while increasing peace of mind. Those who value leaving a light footprint on the earth should carefully consider modest living.

centers of healing or learning, to facilitate the manufacture and transfer of new products and technologies, and to accommodate increased demands for transportation, as well as other worthy aims. Yet, because cost is often the most critical factor in development, communities are sometimes shortchanged by the poor quality of what is built. While vigilant communities establish design controls and restrictions that preserve and enhance the environment, those without design controls are vulnerable to the loss of open space in the name of proits. Good design stands the test of time and adds quality to a community indeinitely. Historic sites or buildings often add value to an area. But poor design may never live to become historic; it will be razed to make way for new development. This consumes resources, and demolition creates waste and debris that go into landills. If poor design escapes the wrecking ball, it may live on as blight. Ethical politicians, designers, and developers know that a development is more than a source of income. For good

Design Longevity and Sustainability In many areas, developers are turning farmland, greenbelts, and previously unused land into ofice and industrial parks, neighborhoods, and shopping centers. Some ind this kind of growth distressing, while others see it as a desirable sign of progress. Because development inevitably has an impact on the environment, it is an opportunity for design solutions that do the least possible harm to natural surroundings and leave a legacy of spaces and buildings that will become better with age. The ultimate goals of most development are to build homes in which a growing population can live, to create places in which to obtain the goods we need, to establish

Figure 2.3 Because it is well designed, this Midcentury Scandinavian Modern bookcase, purchased in Copenhagen in the 1950s, finds continued use as an entry piece in an Arizona condominium. Photo © David A. Taylor

Special Considerations in Design

or ill, it will be a continuously visible part of the community environment until, quite naturally, with time it becomes a wonderful historic setting, blight, or is destroyed by the wrecking ball. Design has great healing power for the environment because a good designer can turn blight into something wonderful. For example, derelict areas that have lain fallow for years have been given new functions and life with adroit design changes and the addition of green spaces. Older, but viable, buildings that no longer serve their original purposes have been given new life by thoughtful design changes. Good design can create and preserve communities that are pleasant and a genuine source of pride. Long-lasting design is a friend of the environment. In order to be sustainable, materials, inishes, and furnishings used in interiors should also be chosen for good design and quality, which in turn produce longevity and decrease waste. Fashions come and go, and designers must be careful to weigh fashion against longevity. They should ensure that what they select and specify has lasting quality so that those design choices do not become tiresome and outdated before the materials, inishes, and furnishings themselves wear out. When they do wear out, materials, inishes, and furnishings should be recycled whenever possible.

Universal and Transgenerational Design and Sustainability Two related concepts that increase sustainability are universal design (also discussed later in this chapter) and transgenerational design. The mission of the Center for Universal Design is to improve the quality and availability of housing for people with disabilities, including disabilities that result from aging. They deine universal design as the design of products and environments to be usable by all people, to the greatest extent possible, without the need for adaptation or specialized design. Transgenerational design is the practice of making products and environments compatible with those physical and sensory impairments associated with human aging and which limit major activities of daily life. Principles of transgenerational design require designers to think not only about clients’ present needs but also about what their needs will be throughout life. Transgenerational design does not focus on the occupant’s age, but rather centers on an environment’s usefulness to users of any age. Transgenerational and universal design are both about designing environments and household products that accommodate the widest market segments—for an environment to be truly universal or transgenerational, it has to feel comfortable to all users of all ages and abilities. If principles of universal and transgenerational design are applied, the life of an environment will be vastly extended because potential changes in need and ability will have been addressed at the start of the project.

37

Things to consider: • Reduce, reuse, recycle, and repair possessions and furnishings. • Learn to distinguish between wants and needs: build or buy only what you really need, leaving a lighter footprint on the earth. • Encourage community governments to establish designreview commissions to monitor design quality and establish criteria for building and development. • Encourage local governments to establish greenbelts and preserve green spaces as well as engage in city forestation or tree planting. • Encourage preservation and adaptive reuse of existing buildings. • Select well-designed and durable materials, inishes, and furnishings for longevity. • Plan for the long haul, anticipating changing abilities and needs.

Green Design Green design speciication describes selection of materials that produce a sustainable environment—the materials have come from a renewable source and removing them will not harm the earth’s environment. Green products will also have been green-manufactured with no adverse effect on the environment, and can usually be recycled or reused. These kinds of products are free from harmful

Figure 2.4 Bamboo, a highly renewable resource, was used to create this attractive and durable retail flooring. Bamtex, courtesy of Wood Flooring International

38

Chapter 2

toxins, are made of renewable resources, and have not created environmentally harmful by-products in the manufacturing process. Green design products are environmentally friendly because they do little or no harm to the environment or because they are made of postconsumer recycled materials. Wood used in such products comes from a certiied forest management program. Most manufacturing requires the use of water, but responsible manufacturers that use large quantities of water, clean and reuse it rather than depleting fresh water sources. Some problems of green speciication are complex. For example, some regard the use of exotic woods—taken from endangered tropical forests—as unethical because it is felt that use of such woods depletes the forests. It is widely acknowledged that the tropical rain forests of the

world are disappearing at an alarming rate and this may be affecting weather patterns and air quality throughout the world. Those responsible for the deforestation are often poor farmers who slash and burn the forest to plant their meager crops. The denuded soil is quickly depleted, and the slashing moves deeper into the forest. Some experts feel that if the emphasis could be changed from farming to the selective harvesting of exotic wood and the creation of sustained-growth forests, farmers would better be able to sustain life, slash-and-burn farming would become obsolete, and the forests would be preserved. Things to consider: • Specify green products whenever possible. • Select and specify materials and inishes that will wear well. • Reupholster or refurbish furniture rather than discard it. • Specify systems furniture (modular ofice landscape) from manufacturers that will refurbish their product when it is dated or worn. • When possible, specify reusable blanket wrapping rather than cardboard packing for shipping of new furniture and appliances. • When appropriate, specify a patterned carpet that will hide soil and wear, extending its life. • Recycle whenever possible, and encourage recycling in local communities by incorporating or supporting recycling centers in residential and contract facilities.

Assistance for Designers (A)

(B) Figure 2.5 (A) Xorel® is a sustainable fabric made of polyethelene (PET)—produced without the use of plasticizers, chlorine, or PVC. Once installed, Xorel® offers extremely low toxicity and off-gassing, making it a clean-air choice, as well. (B) Insight® is made of polylactic acid, derived from corn syrup, a renewable resource from which this sustainable, green-design fabric is produced. It is completely biodegradable. Photos courtesy of Carnegie Fabrics: www.carnegiefabrics.com

There are excellent resources for professionals who need assistance with green design and speciication. One is the Leadership in Energy and Environmental Design (LEED™) Green Building Rating System developed by the U.S. Green Building Council (USGBC). LEED certiies buildings and systems based on credits obtained in the following categories: sustainable sites, water eficiency, energy and atmosphere, materials and resources, indoor environmental quality, and innovation and design process. LEED is a voluntary, consensus-based national standard for developing high-performance, sustainable buildings, created to deine “green building” by establishing a common standard of measurement; to promote integrated, whole building design practices; to recognize environmental leadership in the building industry; to stimulate green competition; to raise consumer awareness of green building beneits; and to transform the building market. LEED provides a complete framework for assessing building performance and meeting sustainability goals. Based on well-founded scientiic standards, LEED emphasizes state-of-the-art strategies for sustainable site development, water conservation, energy eficiency, materials selection, and indoor environmental quality. LEED recognizes achievements and promotes

Special Considerations in Design

expertise in green building through comprehensive systems offering project certiication, professional accreditation, training, and practical resources. The Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) is another resource for designers. The EPA has established a certiication system whereby manufactured items can earn the title Environmentally Preferable Products because they have a lesser or reduced negative effect on human health and the environment when compared to other products that serve the same purpose. To achieve this certiication the product is evaluated according to the following criteria: product performance; total environmental impact of product manufacturing; use of “green energy” manufacturing; protection of safety, health, and environment; and end-of-life responsibility.

39

Other Environmental Issues There are other important issues that affect our relationship with the environment. These should also be considered along with sustainability and green design. Poor indoor air quality (IAQ) affects the health and productivity of users, and well-planned lighting and carefully speciied windows can conserve energy.

Air Pollution in the Interior Environment Some buildings are uninhabitable because of poor air quality that can cause users to become ill. This problem is sometimes referred to as “sick-building syndrome.” Part of this syndrome is related to airborne toxins, poisons sometimes found in common building materials. Volatile

Figure 2.6 This contemporary Arizona home is constructed of rammed earth and makes use of a ceiling fan and natural light to minimize energy consumption. Palmer residence, Rick Joy Architect, Tucson/photo © Timothy Hursley/The Arkansas Office, Inc.

40

Chapter 2

organic compounds (VOCs) are found in artiicial products such as plastics, resins, adhesives, solvents, cleaners, and some of the special inishes added to furnishings. VOCs produce toxic fumes and gases. The gases tend to dissipate with time in a process known as off-gassing, in which carpets, furniture, and other furnishings are allowed to air out before being used. Other toxins are found in tobacco smoke (nitrogen oxides), exhaust from furnaces and automobiles (carbon monoxide), and human metabolism, which creates carbon dioxide. Radon gases are emitted by radioactive decay and may be present in groundwater, soil, and air. Radon has been linked to lung cancer. Special venting systems make radon-aflicted homes habitable. Asbestos is a common toxin found in buildings built prior to 1978. It is a neutral-colored iber used in acoustical tile, ceiling and loor materials, insulation, and as a ireprooing material. When disturbed, asbestos separates into tiny particles that are easily inhaled into the lungs, affecting breathing and possibly causing cancer. Lead is a toxin that is particularly dangerous to infants. It is found in paint used in houses and buildings generally built prior to the 1950s. Ozone is produced by some kinds of ofice machinery such as old laser printers. Ozone can be explosive and may also damage lung tissue, even in low concentrations. Bacteria and fungi are two main forms of microbial contamination in buildings. Fungus, consisting of mold and mildew, can cause respiratory problems as well as create unpleasant odors. Dampness and poor ventilation foster the growth of such toxins. Microbial contamination may

Figure 2.7 Energy-saving compact fluorescent lamps create ambient light in this restaurant. © Peter Mauss/Esto

be found in the heating, ventilation, and air-conditioning (HVAC) system because it may provide ideal conditions for growth. Plants can mitigate many common toxins found in interiors. Plants have the ability to clean the air naturally, and when well cared for they also provide a wonderful aesthetic quality of life in the interior space. Things to consider: • Allow at least twenty-four hours of good ventilation for off-gassing of new furnishings. • When possible, specify particleboard and plywood products without formaldehyde. • Make whatever design decisions are necessary to ensure adequate air circulation. • Ensure that fresh-air intakes for HVAC systems are away from locations where automobile exhaust will be present. • Work with local governments to prohibit smoking in public facilities. • Ensure that building foundations are carefully sealed to prevent radon contamination. • Use plants to clean the air naturally (see Table 2.1.)

Lighting and Energy Conservation Lighting accounts for about one-fourth of all electricity used in the United States. Eficient electric lighting and increased use of natural light could save up to 90 percent of this electricity. Visible light from a lamp (bulb or tube) is measured in watts. An eficient light source provides as many lumens as possible for each watt expended. A standard incandescent lightbulb (the most widely used form of residential lighting) is very ineficient, producing about 10 to 20 lumens per watt. By contrast, luorescent lamps produce 30 to 110 lumens per watt. Because of that great eficiency, one of the most signiicant developments in lighting technology is the compact fluorescent lamp (CFL). Because luorescent light is shadowless and has typically been cool and unlattering, it may have a bad aesthetic reputation. CFLs, however, screw into standard sockets, making it possible to use them in recessed ixtures and with shades and bafles, giving their light a degree of direction. In addition, CFLs have a color quality that is very similar to incandescent, and they consume one-quarter of the energy of, and last up to thirteen times longer than, incandescent lamps. Standard luorescent lamps (tubes) provide comparable eficiency, although some people ind them aesthetically less pleasing. According to the Rocky Mountain Institute, every luorescent lamp that replaces an incandescent prevents the emission of 1,000 to 2,000 pounds of carbon dioxide and 8 to 16 pounds of sulfur dioxide from power plants, thus helping to eliminate global warming and acid rain. Halogen lamps, a bold irst cousin to incandescent lamps, are about 10 percent more eficient than standard

Special Considerations in Design

Table 2.1

41

Plants for Clean Air

Proven Pollution Fighters

Pollutant

Side Effects

Sources

English ivy, dracena marginata, Janet Craig, warneckei, chrysanthemum, gerbera daisy, peace lily

Benzene

Skin and eye irritant; may be a contributing factor to chromosomal aberrations and leukemia in humans. Chronic exposure to even relatively low levels causes headaches, appetite loss, drowsiness, nervousness, psychological disturbances, anemia, bone marrow disease, carcinogenicity.

Inks, oil paints, plastics, rubber, dyes, detergents, gasoline, pharmaceuticals, tobacco smoke, synthetic fibers

Azalea, philodendron, spider plant, golden pothos, bamboo palm, corn plant, chrysanthemum, mother-inlaw’s tongue

Formaldehyde

Irritates mucous membranes of the eyes, nose, throat; can cause contact dermatitis, irritation of upper respiratory tract and eyes, headaches, and asthma and is suspected of causing a rare type of throat cancer.

Foam insulation, plywood, particleboard, press-wood products, grocery bags, waxed papers, facial tissue,paper towels, wrinkle resisters, water repellants, fire retardants, adhesive binders in floor coverings, carpet backing, permanentpress clothing, cigarette smoke, natural gas, kerosene

Gerbera daisy, chrysanthemum, peace lily, warneckei, dracena marginata

Trichloroethylene

Considered a potent liver carcinogen by the National Cancer Institute.

Primarily used in the metal-degreasing and dry-cleaning industries; also in printing inks, paints, lacquers, varnishes, adhesives.

From Plants for Clean Air Council.

incandescent lamps. They produce a clearer, whiter light, have better color rendition than standard incandescent lamps, and last somewhat longer than regular incandescent lighting. See Chapter 5 for new developments. Natural light or daylight is healthy, economical, and aesthetically pleasing. Light from the sun is free, and because of improved window technology, natural light and heating and cooling need not conlict. Natural light can enter buildings through interior courtyards called atria (atrium is the singular form) and through clerestory windows set high up in a wall as well as through more standard kinds of windows. Light pipes and skylights can bring natural light to the interiors of buildings where no such light could normally reach. Things to consider: • Where possible, use luorescent rather than incandescent lighting. • Use incandescent lamps for spaces where occupancy time is limited. • Use higher levels of light only where and when needed to accomplish speciic tasks. • Use dimmers and timers to save energy and extend the life of incandescent lamps. • Use natural light from windows wherever possible before resorting to electric lighting. • Also consider clerestories, skylights, light pipes, and atria to bring natural light into a building.

Figure 2.8 Natural light is pleasant and economical, saving the use of electric lights during daylight hours. At night, a lightcolored shade or blind over the glass helps keep the space light and thereby decrease the demand for after-dark lighting. Photo courtesy of Andersen Windows

42

Chapter 2

Windows and Energy Conservation On average, 10 to 25 percent of internal winter heating is lost through windows, and similar amounts of heat gain occur through windows during warm seasons and in warm climates. Low-tech solutions include things as simple as caulking window frames to prevent air transfer or planting shade trees for natural cooling. About half of all residential windows are single pane, with one sheet of glass. They keep rain and wind from entering a building but do little to stop heat and cold transfer. They typically have an R-value (ability to insulate) of 2.0, which is considered poor. Today’s low-E glazing is double-pane, with two sheets of glass, and features special coatings, gas ill, good edge seals, insulated frames, and airtight construction that provide excellent insulation and prevent negative heat and cold transfer. They have an excellent R-value of 5.0 or more. Things to consider: • Where possible, specify high-performance windows for new construction or retroit. • Insulate and caulk window frames. • Use low-tech solutions such as planting deciduous trees (those that lose their leaves seasonally) to block the sun’s direct rays in the summer and let in the sun’s rays in the winter. • Design overhangs to block summer sun and admit winter sun as the sun’s angle changes seasonally. • Use screens or awnings for additional sun control.

3.

4.

5.

6.

Energy Audits As energy costs continue to rise, more home owners are looking for ways to reduce their carbon footprint, or consumption of nonrenewable energy. An energy audit is conducted room by room and examines past utility bills, resulting in a detailed report of all the ways a home uses or wastes energy. It can be conducted by a professional or as a do-it-yourself (DIY) project by following these steps: 1. Compare utility and energy bills. Compare lighting, heating, and cooling costs by month and compare to previous years, available from customer service of the utility provider. Look for trends in usage and spikes, indicating high energy consumptions. Electric bills are based on kilowatt hours (kWh) and indicate how many are used and how much they cost per kWh per month. Gas usage and costs can be found on monthly statements indicating how many decatherms are used per day and the resulting cost. 2. Locate air leaks and check insulation. Leaks can decrease energy eficiency by 5 to 30 percent annually. The incense test is to move a lit stick along walls (carefully avoiding draperies and lammables); where the smoke wavers, you have cold/hot air sneaking in and heated/cooled air leaking out. These areas can

7.

8.

be spot-insulated with foam or caulking. Around outside-wall electric plugs, a cut-to-it layer of foam can be easily installed inside the cover plate. Check insulation. Check the attic loor, which should be illed with luffy insulation (not crumbling or compacted). Also check basement ceiling, walls, water pipes, and furnace ducts. Snow melting off the roof quicker than the neighbors’ indicates poor attic insulation. Examine heating and cooling equipment. Change ilters or invest in an electrostatic permanent and eficient air ilter. Keep equipment clean and in good working condition with annual professional inspection. Keep vents open in rooms where the warm/cool air is needed, but closed in unused areas. Keep vents vacuumed clean and unobstructed. Check ductwork for dirt streaks, which mark leaks and can be ixed with insulation or duct tape. Be Energy Star savvy. Energy Star is a joint program of the U.S. Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) and the U.S. Department of Energy (DOE) that encourages energy eficiency through strict guidelines on over 18,000 products in thirty-ive categories, including whole home qualiication. Learn more at http://www.energystar.gov. Analyze the old and new. New homes, products, and appliances are far more eficient than older ones, so when replacing or improving, look for the Energy Star labels that indicate higher energy eficiency. New developments in water heaters, washers and dryers, dishwashers, and other major appliances make them far more eficient than older and even recent models. Do your research and thorough product comparison before buying. Try an electric usage monitor. Plug a “kill a watt” monitor into a plug, then into the electronic device. It gives detailed energy use information and how much the unit costs to operate. Or estimate how much energy an appliance uses with this formula: wattage multiplied by hours used per day divided by 1,000 equals daily kWh usage; multiplied by the cost per kWh charged by the utility company, this is a daily amount to run the item. Wattage is stamped on the item. This may be motivation to upgrade to a more energy eficient model or ind ways to save energy on the old appliance/device, such as adjusting temperature, cleaning, or repairing seals. Refrigerators at 37 degrees Fahrenheit and freezers at 3 degrees is about right. Look for unnecessary usage. TVs, DVD players, and cell phone chargers, for example, left plugged in but not on, can be energy vampires, or phantom loads. They still draw power and add about 8 percent to annual electric bills. Unplug unused devices, and turn off or use energy-smart, self-monitoring power strips.

Special Considerations in Design

43

(B)

(A)

(C)

Figure 2.9 (A) Solar domestic water heater systems are a sustainable and cost-effective way to generate hot water. They can be used in any climate, and sunshine is free. Two kinds of systems are used for homes—passive and active. Active systems have circulating pumps and controls. This General Electric (GE) water heater with a solar panel is an example of the glazed flat plate collector system, an insulated weatherproofed box that contains a dark absorber plate under one or more glass or plastic (polymer) covers. (B) The GE Hybrid Electric Water Heater uses half the energy of a traditional electric water heater. Here, the user-friendly electronic control system is simple and flexible, giving consumers as much or as little control of operating modes as they like: Set the thermostat and forget it, or easily change the desired water temperature to maximize energy benefits. (C) The tankless water heater powered by either gas or propane heats water on demand and saves 25 percent in water heating energy and costs. Photos courtesy of GE Appliances & Lighting

9. Use less. Turning down the water heater from 140 to 120 degrees Fahrenheit reduces costs by 6 to 10 percent. Install low-low water ixtures, such as toilets that use less than 1 gallon to lush. A low-low shower head can cut water used for bathing by 50 to 70 percent. Low-low faucets are available. Use fewer lights

(sight safety irst, however), and make them CFLs, now available in a wider variety of colors and styles. 10. Use a programmable thermostat. Resist the temptation to set air-conditioning too low and heating too high. For every degree you adjust in favor of energy savings, 1–3 percent is saved on the heating bill.

44

Chapter 2

Considerations for Special Needs Users For years, the needs of users who found designed environments dificult or impossible to use were ignored. Today, however, because we have been made aware of special needs, and because the law requires that those needs be addressed, design for special populations is a standard component of design practice.

Universal Design Universal design implies that well-planned designs will meet the needs of every user without drawing attention to persons with disabilities. For example, older buildings with many steps are not accessible to regular wheelchair users. Ramps can be installed to make the buildings accessible, but the ramp is a special addition, and while it is functional, it draws attention to the wheelchair user, who must employ a different route of entry. New facilities designed on level grade, with automatic sliding doors where all can enter in the same manner, are examples of universal design—everyone is accommodated without drawing attention to distinctions of ability.

of new wheelchairs capable of climbing stairs. Universal design is an ethical ideal that is seen more and more. In cases where universal design is impossible, however, accessibility is imperative. We can never be sure if or when a disability will become a reality for a friend, an associate, a member of our family, or for us. Until that happens, we often ignore the kind of design that makes life better for persons with special needs. But with the passage of the ADA, many such considerations are law; they can no longer be ignored. The law has pushed us from a perspective of sympathy into a mode of action. In our homes the choice is still ours but in public, accessibility is the law. Sympathy is one matter and empathy is another. If we all tried spending a day or two with a self-imposed disability, we would see how frustrating design can be, and we would quickly come to understand the need for

The Americans with Disabilities Act of 1990 In January 1992, the Americans with Disabilities Act of 1990 (the ADA) became law. This landmark civil rights legislation represents one of the most signiicant steps in eliminating widespread discrimination caused by the imposition of barriers restricting persons with disabilities. It is no longer satisfactory to provide separate facilities for people with disabilities; they must be integrated into facilities planned for the general public. The law recognizes that they are the general public and that they are entitled to the same treatment received by the public at large. Individuals who have dificulty or limitations with life activities such as walking, hearing, seeing, or using their hands are protected by the ADA. Designers have responded to the challenge with the concept of universal design that goes beyond the accessibility required by the law. The ADA allows that it is not necessary to tear down existing structures with steps; they need to be modiied, not destroyed. It is doubtful that our world will ever be completely accessible without isolating, to some degree, those with disabilities. New planning and design will certainly be universal, but older facilities will always be a reminder of a time when little thought was given to making life “normal” for those with limited ability. In Europe, where many buildings and much of the infrastructure are older, strategies for accessibility include the design

Figure 2.10 These sliding doors operate by overhead sensors that detect movement, opening for all users without calling attention to disability, qualifying them as universal design. Photo © Kathryn Taylor

Special Considerations in Design

the law. We can become aware of how special needs are being met in public spaces, but even more importantly, we can become advocates of good design for users with special needs.

Accessible Design Accessibility is the law in nonresidential design; it is optional in design for single-family homes. Given the fact, however, that we may all encounter some form of impairment at some point in our lives, it is remarkable that home designs rarely are planned accordingly. The experiences of one woman, who spent many years caring for her wheelchair-bound mother, are not uncommon. Her experience included dealing with the enormous dificulty created by barriers. Her mother’s home was never planned to accommodate such limited mobility, and it was necessary to construct an inconvenient makeshift wooden ramp up the steep front steps. The kitchen and the bathroom designs made the situation even more dificult. After the death of her mother, the woman planned and built her own home that was based on universal design principles. According to her barrier-free design, all of the entrances were level or accessed by gentle slopes, and the garage was level with the utility entrance. All doorways were wide enough to accommodate passage of a wheelchair, bathrooms were large enough to maneuver a wheelchair, and wall frames were reinforced to allow the later addition of grab bars. She commented that had it not been for the experience with her mother’s disability, she would never have planned as she did. Visitors to the home are unaware of the subtle differences, and the costs

Figure 2.11 A lever door handle is a universal design solution for those with limited hand strength, as it eliminates the gripping, twisting action required for the standard door knob. Lever handles are also easy to use when one’s hands are full, by leaning on the handle with the forearm or elbow.

45

in planning and building were negligible. The design is beautiful and functions perfectly for her, even though she may never need the features she has built in. Few of us have the foresight to imagine that such planning will be of beneit to a family member or us at some point in our lives. Accessible design works well for everyone, whether impaired or not, and has the added beneit of making the design more sustainable.

Design for Special Populations People with distinctive but similar design needs constitute special populations. Such populations include persons with limited motion, hearing, or vision, as well as the elderly who may have some form of impairment in one or more of these areas. Our tendency seems to be to lump people into tidy groups, but it is important to note that impairments need not be measured by ixed standards and that each of us is prone to some type of limitation, whether temporary or chronic. For example, many of us wear glasses for impaired vision, some of us ind ourselves with broken limbs, and those of us who have spent too much time listening to loud music will ind that we have mild or signiicant hearing losses. The designation of “special populations” is helpful only because it makes us aware of needs. Different kinds of physical impairments may require conlicting considerations. For example, curbs that are cut away for wheelchair-bound users do not signal blind users that they have reached the street. The wheelchair user prefers spaces that are open and larger than normal, while the blind user may be more comfortable in a smaller space where many things are within reach. The hearing-impaired user needs a space with little sound reverberation, while blind users need an acoustically “live” space to help ind their way.

Design for Motion Impairments People with impaired motion may be ambulant-disabled, meaning that dificulty in walking may require the use of crutches, a cane, or a walker. Chairbound-disabled people depend on a wheelchair for mobility. Those that are motion-impaired may also have some loss of ability to use their hands. Most of the design considerations for those with impaired motion center around physical barriers such as level changes introduced by curbs, multiple stories, steps, and paving or looring materials of varying thicknesses. Doors, either by their narrow width or their weight, also form barriers. Standard bathroom and kitchen designs present a number of challenges for persons with impaired motion, particularly for those conined to wheelchairs.

46

Chapter 2

Figure 2.12 This handrail diagram shows the ideal size and shape for optimum universal design comfort. Handrails are essential for steadying and balancing for many individuals, including those who are ambulant disabled.

This section presents lists of design recommendations for people with motion impairment that were prepared with the intention of heightening awareness. They are representative of the kinds of speciications found in the ADA but do not include all of its requirements.

Steps and Ramps • Many ambulant-disabled users ind stairs easier to negotiate than ramps (which are necessary for the chairbound). Consequently, a minimum slope for ramps is best, with a rise of 1 foot for every 12 feet of length (1:12). • Steps should not have protruding nosing that will catch the toes of those with stiff legs, braces, or other leg problems. • All ramps and steps should be well lit, with focus lighting directed at walking hazards. Whenever possible, they should be covered to remain dry and free from ice. • The top of a handrail should be 34 to 38 inches above the ramp or steps. • Handrails should be oval or round, with 1½-inch hand clearance between the rails and the wall. This will provide ease of grip but will prevent the hand or wrist from slipping between the handrail and the wall if the person loses balance. • The handrail should have a gripping surface of 1 to 1½ inches and should not be interrupted by newel posts or other elements.

Figure 2.13 The Americans with Disabilities Act requires a level, barrier-free, and spacious entry and an easily accessed dooropening push-button device on at least one entrance of all public buildings. On push-command, the door opens slowly, giving the chairbound-disabled person time to maneuver and wheel through the entrance. These buttons are sensitive and should be treated with care and respect by pushing gently and firmly, not “hitting” the button. Also, when a person pushes the button and then impatiently forces the door by pushing on it, the unit can break. This scenario is often the result of an ambulant person who desires the convenience of the automatic door yet misunderstands the need for the device to work slowly for the safety of all and so that ambulant-disabled persons are not rushed in accessing the building. Photo © Kathryn Taylor

• • • •

Passage and Turning



• For a single wheelchair, 32 inches is minimum clearance at a point such as a door (36 inches is better), and 36 inches is minimum clearance in a continuous



passage (42 to 48 inches is better). Minimum clearance for two chairs to pass each other is 60 inches. The space required by a wheelchair to make a 180degree turn is a clear space of 60 inches. The clear loor space required for a wheelchair is 30 by 48 inches. The force needed to push a door open should not exceed 8 pounds of pressure. Lever-type door handles are easier to operate than round doorknobs, which are slippery and hard to operate with limited strength. Thumb-latch ixtures are equally hard to operate with limited strength or motion. A kickplate at the bottom of a door protects the door from the impact of a wheelchair’s footrest. Floors should have a lat, nonskid surface. If carpet is used, it should be securely attached, without a cushion

Special Considerations in Design

47

or pad. Pile depth should not be more than ½-inch, since anything with a deeper pile makes passage dificult. • Flooring materials should be lush, since a change in depth greater than ½-inch forms a barrier.

Kitchens • All areas of the kitchen should be accessible to a frontal approach as well as a parallel approach by a wheelchair. This means an access space of no less than 30 by 48 inches, or a minimum distance of 48 inches between opposing elements. In a U-shaped kitchen, the distance should be inFigure 2.15 To turn a 360-degree creased to 60 inches. circle, wheelchairs require a 60-inch • Varying countertop heights are rec(5-foot) clearance. ommended. A low counter near the Figure 2.14 Wheelchairs require 36 sink for food preparation is helpful. to 42 inches for adequate operating Heights of 28, 32, and 36 inches are clearance. good, with a maximum depth of 24 inches so that items on the countertop can be easily reached. • Upper cabinets should be adjustable to several heights. Eight inches above the counter is the minimum for very small users. • Handles on upper cabinets should be mounted a maximum of 48 inches from the loor, with those on lower cabinets a minimum of 27 inches from the loor. • Leaving space under the counter, especially at the sink, allows a wheelchair to approach. Hot-water pipes should be insulated so that the wheelFigure 2.17 These two cooktop arrangechair user will not be burned. ments allow a wheelchair-bound person • The sink controls should be mounted Figure 2.16 For use by a wheelchairto use all elements without the danger on the side or no more than 18 inches bound person, lower cupboards should of burns from reaching over the top of from the front of the counter for easy be no higher than 34 inches, and couna heated element. Controls are on the front of the stove, assuring both ease of tertop depth no more than 24 inches. reach. use and safety against burns. • A toe-kick space under cabinets should be 12 inches high and 8 inches deep to accommodate a wheelchair Bathrooms footrest. • Doors should be at least 36 inches wide (preferably 39 • Pull-out trays allow better access than standard drawinches). Pocket doors keep the space clear and make ers and shelves. access easier. • Wall-mounted, side-opening ovens and microwaves • No cabinet under a shallow sink makes the vanity allow wheelchair access. accessible. • Cooktops should have staggered burners so that the • Toilets should be wall mounted 19 inches off the loor for users do not have to reach over a hot front burner to easy approach by a wheelchair. The toilet is most easily access a back burner. accessed from the side or with a diagonal approach. • Cooktop controls should be front mounted for easy • Grab bars must be anchored in wood so that they reach by a seated person. will support at least 250 pounds. There should be a

48

Chapter 2

Figure 2.18 This diagonal approach shows a wheelchair-bound user sliding from chair to toilet seat at an angle. This requires a full 60 inches of space.

Figure 2.19 The side approach requires less space next to the toilet, as the wheelchair stays in front of the toilet.

24- to 36-inch horizontal grab bar located behind, and 3 inches above, the back of the toilet, as well as a 30inch horizontal bar mounted 12 inches from the back wall beside the toilet. • Some users will be able to negotiate a tub, and others will need to be able to wheel into a shower. Textured, nonslip grab bars mounted 32 to 38 inches above the loor make access easier. A seat in a shower is also helpful.

Figure 2.20 This handsome universal design bathroom is planned for users who are both ambulant and wheelchair bound. Features include a roll-under sink and accessibility to the toilet, with a sliding door for privacy. The open, roll-in shower area has a seat/bench and handheld “Swedish” shower and grab bars. Tile surfaces are impervious to water and barrier free. Design by Anthony Binns, CKD, CBD; Binns Kitchen + Bath Design/Photography: Tim McClean/NKBA Design Competition

• Shower controls should be mounted no higher than 32 inches from the loor and should be a lever-type, single-mixing control. A handheld showerhead can be helpful to those with impaired motion. • Faucets at the sink should also be lever controlled as well as side mounted. Water temperature should be set lower to prevent scalding. • Medicine cabinets should be mounted lower in a sidewall so that they can be easily accessed. • Vanity mirrors should be installed low enough to be used by someone seated in a wheelchair. The mirror should be at least 16 by 20 inches and may need to be tilted for complete visibility. • Nonslip looring is imperative, as is good ventilation to prevent condensation that might cause slipping.

Bedrooms • The height of the mattress should be equal to the height of the wheelchair. The nightstand should be the height of the bed. • To accommodate a wheelchair, there must be a 60- by 60-inch clear space, usually between the bedroom door

Special Considerations in Design

and the bed, or between the storage space and the bed. A minimum of 36 inches at the foot and far side of the bed will facilitate making the bed and cleaning. • A footboard and headboard will often help in getting in and out, and a slatted headboard may be helpful in turning over or moving in bed.

Closets • Bifold or sliding doors are best. • Rods should be mounted 45 to 54 inches high for access from a wheelchair. • Shelves higher than 50 inches are not accessible from a seated position. • Slide-out shelves are more accessible.

Around the House • Electrical outlets should be 27 to 28 inches above the loor. Switches should be 36 inches above the loor. • At least one 60-inch-diameter turning space is required in each room of the house. • Drawer pulls throughout the house should be D-shaped for better gripping. • Windowsills set at a maximum of 36 inches make windows accessible to wheelchair users. • Crank-operated casement windows are better for those with impaired motion.

Design for Hearing Impairment Over 20 million people in the United States have some degree of hearing loss. These people want to live normal and productive lives. Design can help make the quality of their lives better by alleviating some of the problems inherent in the interior environment. Many of the problems associated with hearing loss center around noise and sound reverberation, as well as adequate light for manual communication (signing and lip reading). Things to consider: • Carpet and fabric wall coverings reduce noise reverberation and improve the acoustics for the hearing impaired. • Good lighting is imperative for adequate decoding of manual communication and lip reading. • Good natural light helps visually and also creates the psychological feeling of openness and well-being. • Furniture arranged in a semicircle or U shape facilitates signing and lip reading by providing clear sight lines from speaker to listener. • A round dining table is better than a rectangular table because it provides clear sight lines. • Visual signals such as lashing lights can provide important visual cues. The lights are activated by the telephone, doorbell, alarm clock, ire alarm/smoke detector,

49

or a crying baby. The lights can be placed in panels at strategic locations throughout the house. • Special phone systems are available for the hearing impaired. These systems are called TDD, an acronym for telecommunication device for the deaf. The TDD includes a screen and keyboard and will require a specially planned space. • Because of the addition of extra electronic devices, adequate outlets should be planned to avoid the unnecessary use of extension cords.

Design for Visual Impairment People with impaired vision rely heavily on the senses of hearing and touch. Consequently, tactile indicators and acoustics are critical for day-to-day activities in familiar environments and for navigating in unfamiliar public spaces. Things to consider: • The visually impaired may need tactile warning of danger. Door handles may be textured to indicate a dangerous area beyond the door, and landings and curbs can be textured to indicate steps or changes of grade. • Outdoors, hanging or projecting objects (even plants and tree branches) that extend into the path of the blind person are dangerous because they cannot be detected with a cane. • Handrails should extend 1 foot beyond the end of a stairway, even if this means extending the rail around a corner. Where there is more than one story, a handrail should extend continuously from loor to loor, rather than stopping at the landing.

Figure 2.21 Textured door handles signal warning to those who are visually impaired.

50

Chapter 2

Figure 2.23 Unobstructed walking space is essential for those with visual impairment.

Figure 2.22 Texture underfoot warns of possible danger, such as the beginning of a flight of stairs. Handrails extend to the floor level to steady the user and indicate that stair climbing or descending is complete.

• Signage is important. Small groups of letters and numbers can be easily read with the ingers, but larger groups of letters and long texts are dificult for the blind to read. • Persons born blind learn Braille, while most persons blinded later in life do not. Signage should include both letters/numbers and Braille symbols. • To be useful, tactile signals and signage should be uniform throughout a building. • Audible signals for the blind are helpful at crosswalks, in elevators, and for emergency systems such as smoke detectors/ire alarms. • Gas cooktops tend to be better for the blind because the gas makes a sound as it burns. In addition, electric elements retain heat after they are turned off, which can be dangerous. Controls should be mounted where the blind will not have to reach over the lame or coils to operate the cooktop. Elements, too, should be arranged to avoid reaching over one to get to the other. • A lip on the counter may be helpful in preventing objects from being pushed off the edge. • Furniture should have rounded corners and edges, and some padding of table edges may be advisable. • A hook next to electrical outlets might be desirable to hang a plug where it can be found easily. • Changes of grade in looring materials are obstacles for the blind and should be avoided.

Design for the Elderly People are living longer today than ever before. As a result, the elderly population is growing rapidly and becoming an important political and social force. The concerns of the elderly include limited mobility, loss of hearing, and loss of visual acuity. Consequently, all of the considerations listed above apply to the elderly. There may also be loss of memory or other cognitive function that makes some tasks more dificult. Things to consider: • Visual contrast is important in judging space and distance. For example, a countertop should be light or dark in contrast with the loor. This helps with depth perception and makes the edges more obvious. The same is true for a tabletop, where depth perception is important.

Special Considerations in Design

51

Figure 2.25 Keeping an electrical plug on a hook when not in use makes it easy to find when needed.

Figure 2.26 The yellow acetate lens allows the designer to see colors as older users might see them, as the eyes may become affected by a yellowing of the cornea. © Bradley H. Slade

Figure 2.24 Recessed numerals and Braille help identify this classroom. Photo © Kathryn Taylor

• In some public spaces and facilities designed for the elderly, way inding is important. In a long hallway the location of doors can be indicated with a slight recess in the wall surrounding the doors. Distinctive pieces of furniture and art can be visual reminders of location. Color coding of areas or loors may also prove helpful. • With age, there may be a tendency for the cornea of the eye to yellow. This causes a distortion of color perception and may make a color scheme appear drab and ugly to some. The designer can use a yellow lens to evaluate color schemes for the elderly, making selections that maintain their appeal. • Decreased control over bodily functions may make it desirable to select textiles for upholstery that have been specially treated to resist moisture or laminated with a thin layer of plastic. The lamination process is almost undetectable.

Other Special Populations The previous sections focused on design for the elderly and persons with impaired motion, hearing, and vision. But these represent just a fraction of those with special needs. Other special populations include children, homeless, abused, chemically dependent, religious groups, ethnic and cultural groups, convicted criminals, poor, rich, mentally ill, sick, terminally ill, and many others. Again, in some cases these are not ixed groups but rather situations through which the general population moves. Unlike the design needs of those with physical impairments, the design needs of these groups do not always lend themselves to universal design. For example, public toilets are not scaled to children because the population at large cannot use small-scaled facilities comfortably. The kind of security demanded by law for convicted criminals is inappropriate for other citizens. The considerations associated with these groups are important and worthy of the designer’s attention, but they are not always applicable to the needs of users in general.

52

Chapter 2

Figure 2.27 The fine design of this assisted living center makes a pleasant place for residents as well as their visitors. All areas are accessible and safe as well as beautiful. Photo © Kathryn Taylor

Special Design Considerations as Fundamental Goals The ideas and recommendations presented in this chapter can and should be applied to all the topics discussed throughout this book. Whether the subject is electrical

systems and lighting, fabrics, historical styles, or any other topic, it is important to measure what we learn against the principles of sustainability and universal design. As we embrace sustainability and universal design, not only will the future be a better place, but we will also be better able to enjoy it.

Chapter 3 Design Principles, Elements, and Style The Principles of Design 54 The Elements of Design 62 Design Discernment and Excellence 73

Hutker Architects/photo © Brian Vanden Brink

54

Chapter 3

The Principles of Design The principles of design—scale and proportion, balance, rhythm, emphasis, and harmony (variety and unity)— are abstract concepts that have been important to great architecture, art, furnishings, textiles, and hard materials for centuries. These principles, listed in Table 3.1, form the theory of design. The theory of design implies that truly ine interior design incorporates appropriate scale and good proportion, as well as harmony of all the elements, achieved through sensitive balance of variety and unity. These design principles are the bylaws that are universally accepted as the philosophy or rules that should govern the use of the elements of design, listed in Table 3.2. Each element can be judged right or wrong in its use and placement through an evaluation of the principles of design. For example, the use of color, an important and emotive element of design, can be judged or evaluated in this way according to each principle of design:

• Emphasis. Does the color create or support a focal point, or does it detract from the area of emphasis? • Harmony. Does the use of color yield harmony through the adherence to a uniied theme (unity) with enough subtle or dramatic difference to maintain interest in the scheme (variety)? Or does the interior lack harmony because the colors are too weak or competitive? Each of the elements of design can be evaluated in this way.

Scale Scale deals with actual and relative size and visual weight. Scale is generally categorized as small or light, medium, large or heavy, or grand (extra large). One of the goals of pleasing interior design is to select furnishings that are in scale with one another. This implies a similarity of objects in overall dimensions or in mass (density), in pattern, or in other forms of visual weight. When objects are out of

• Scale. Is the size or amount of the color appropriate for the decorative scheme, or is it used in too large or too small a quantity or an area? • Proportion. Do colors complement each other, or is one ill-proportioned by too much or too little intensity or quantity? • Balance. Is the color balanced with other colors in terms of size and intensity, and is the color distributed throughout the interior to create a balanced effect? • Rhythm. Does the color carry the eye along with rhythmic smoothness, or is it too punctuated and abrupt in its use?

Table 3.1

Principles of Design

Design principles are the abstract concepts that constitute the theory, bylaws, or governing ideas that determine the success of a design. Each element in a design can be evaluated according to these principles. Scale. Overall size, such as the largeness or smallness of a room, object, or pattern. Proportion. Size relationship or ratio of parts to whole, such as the size of a chair in relation to the size of its arms. Balance. Equilibrium achieved by arranging components symmetrically, asymmetrically, or radially. Rhythm. Flow of elements, usually organized according to a scheme such as repetition or alternation, progression or gradation, transition, opposition or contrast, or radiation. Emphasis. Enhancement that produces a point of interest or focal point in a design. Harmony. Compatibility of elements to create a pleasing whole, achieved through unity and variety.

Figure 3.1 Large scale is evident in the large bulbous turning and overall size of pedestal table. Dark colors, as seen in the table and broad plank hardwood floor make the scale seem even larger. The drapery fabric pattern and pendant light fixture are large scale, as well. Photo courtesy of Mohawk Industries

Design Principles, Elements, and Style

scale with one another, they are not appropriate or harmonious selections. Although the actual dimensions of two objects may be similar, one may be of a visually heavier scale than the other because of its weight or mass and the selection of material. For example, a glass table on legs will appear smaller-scaled than a solid wooden chest table. While the overall dimensions might be exactly the same, the glasstopped table allows us to see through the piece, which visually scales it down and makes it appear smaller than the wooden piece. Pattern and ornament also visually determine scale. A pattern with large motifs may appear visually heavy or massive, while a pattern of the same overall dimensions illed with small motifs and empty areas will appear smaller-scaled overall. Likewise, color will affect our impression of scale. Bright, bold colors will appear larger than light, pastel ones. The scale, or size, of the architecture will often determine the scale of furnishings; small-scale furnishings are used in small interiors and large-scale furnishings are used in large or lofty interiors. This rule can be broken to provide drama or excitement, such as a large-scale pattern in a small area (which also makes the space seem smaller). Conversely, small scale in a large interior might look tailored and may visually expand the space even further. In choosing or judging scale, perhaps the most important consideration is human scale. Very large and very small scale often feel awkward to people. Although grand scale is impressive and dramatic in public architecture, and small scale is wonderful for children, for the majority of adults, scale is most appropriate when it complements and easily accommodates the average human form. Because we are most comfortable with these dimensions, the standard ceiling height in homes is 8 feet and chairs and sofas generally have a standard seating height and depth. Floor plans are drawn to scale, with 1 ⁄4, 1 ⁄8, 1 or ⁄16 inch usually equaling 1 foot.

Table 3.2

55

Elements of Design

Design elements are the concrete, quantiiable components of any design. They embody the principles of design and transform theory into reality. Space. Open and closed areas; space may be positive (illed) or negative (open). Shape. Two-dimensional outline, often seen as a geometric igure such as a rectangle or triangle. Form. Three-dimensional shape, such as a cube, cone, or sphere. Mass. Weight, density, or relative solidity of a form; mass may be actual or visual. Line. Connection between two points; line may be vertical, horizontal, angular, or curved. Texture. Smoothness or roughness of a surface; texture may be read visually or through touch. Pattern. Arrangement of motifs in a repetitive or varied order; a small pattern may be read visually as texture. Light. Natural, artiicial, or a combination of both; light affects the appearance of all other elements of design. Color. Hues that vary from light to dark and from intense to dull and can be mixed with one another and combined in color schemes; color is the most personal and emotional of the elements of design.

Proportion Proportion is closely related to scale and is usually expressed in terms of the size relationship of parts to one another and to the whole. Proportion also deals with shapes and forms and their dimensions. It is, for example, the relationship of a chair seat or back to its base or arms or that of the size and scale of the tabletop to its legs. When the relationship or ratio is pleasing, the furniture is well proportioned. The evaluation of proportion

Figure 3.2 These Midcentury Modern classic furniture pieces by Charles Eames are lightly scaled—small scale is evident in the legs, pedestals, and arms, as well as the slim lines of the upholstery. Photo courtesy of Herman Miller

56

Chapter 3

is based on ratios, or the comparison of sizes. For example, a table that is well proportioned has side dimensions (width and length) that relate well to each other, creating a nicely shaped rectangle—neither too wide nor too narrow for the function of the piece. A sofa table (placed behind the back of the sofa and the same height as the back) must be relatively narrow or it will be cumbersome and ill proportioned. Likewise, a family dining table that is wider than 3½ feet may be too wide for food to be comfortably passed across it. Throughout the centuries that humans have worked toward pleasing proportions, many theories of what is good and acceptable have been espoused. One of the best known is that of the ancient Egyptians and, later, the classical Greeks. They stated that pleasing proportions were “golden.” The golden mean is a line that visually divides an object, a wall, a tieback drapery treatment, or other furnishings into two unequal but harmonious parts; that line falls somewhere between one-half and one-third (vertically or horizontally). For example, a chair-rail or dado molding creates pleasing proportions above and below the molding when it is placed not in the middle of the wall or one-third of the way up the wall but somewhere in between. Tieback draperies or curtains are also divided into pleasing proportions somewhere between one-third to one-half of the way up from the bottom or down from the top of the treatment. The golden section refers to proportions of parts to one another and to the whole. The progressions—3 to 5 to 8 to 13 to 21, and so on—are considered pleasing ratios or proportions as they relate to one another and roughly equate the theory of the golden mean. Further, these increments can be translated into sides of rectangles, called golden rectangles, that form the basis for a study of good proportions. For example, a table or art piece 3 feet by 5 feet is a pleasing proportion, as are multiples (or divisions) of those dimensions: 12 by 20 (4 times 3 and 4 times 5) or 15 by 25 (5 times Figure 3.3 This chest is 3 and 5 times 5). A room with divided according to the golden-rectangle dimensions golden section, just below will theoretically be the easi- the halfway mark. est in which to arrange furnishings, and a golden-rectangle window should pose few aesthetic window-treatment problems. The golden mean,

golden section, and golden rectangle are examples of how harmonious proportions can be calculated. Many other philosophies of good proportion exist, but the bottom line is the “sense of rightness” that we feel or recognize when good proportion is evident. Recognizing good proportion is an intuitive ability for some people; for others, it may take time and deliberate study to learn to recognize and to sense pleasing proportion. Much of what we learn about good proportion comes from studying historic architecture and furnishings and great works of art that have been recognized as good design with pleasing proportions.

Balance Balance is equilibrium, or the arrangement of objects physically or visually to reach a state of stability and poise. Balance is important because of the human need for balance in our lives. It is necessary for physical conidence in our actions and movement, and it is a guidepost in achieving satisfaction and fulillment in life itself. Thus

Figure 3.4 Symmetrical, bisymmetrical, or formal balance is seen in the placement of the two identical sofas and end tables, the French doors flanking the artistic fireplace, and the symmetrical composition of the beams. Design by Hutker Architects/ photo © Brian Vanden Brink

Design Principles, Elements, and Style

57

we naturally seek balance in our interiors. This state of equilibrium is achieved in one of three ways: through symmetrical or formal balance, through asymmetrical or informal balance, or by radial balance.

Symmetrical Balance Symmetrical balance is also known as formal, bisymmetrical, or passive balance. Symmetrical balance creates a mirror image by the placement of items that are exactly the same on both sides of a central point. This might be a matching pair of mantel vases on each side of a painting or mirror. Or formal balance can be seen as matching nightstands or end tables with matching lamps placed on them. It could be a formal dining table where the chairs Figure 3.5 Studied symmetry is found in the matching bookcases, chairs, and accessories. The asymmetrical placement of the plants, art, and door relieves the are placed exactly across from each other. exactness. Symmetrical balance suggests restraint, rei nement, orderliness, and formality. Bisymmetrical balance is passive because it requires no judgment; we know exactly what to expect. Because formal balance is predictable, it adds a type of steadiness and durability to interior design. Much classical design— from the Greeks and Romans to the Renaissance, Baroque, and subsequent periods—was symmetrical. The symmetry created a sense of power and grandeur. However, because of its unchanging nature, symmetrical balance can become stale and boring. In fact, it has been said that a really good symmetrical composition always contains elements of asymmetry. The symmetrical nature of historic designs was broken by asymmetric placement of igures in a frieze or by inclusion of dissimilar sculptural pieces in symmetrical niches. Rigid symmetry is less suitable to today’s less formal and more relaxed lifestyle.

Asymmetrical Balance Asymmetrical balance is also known as informal, active, optical, or occult balance. Asymmetrical balance can be accomplished in two ways: 1. Dissimilar objects can be placed at varying distances from the center point. 2. Objects of similar visual weight or form may be balanced at equal distance from an imaginary central dividing line. Asymmetrical balance is often dificult to accomplish. It requires inding objects that are compatible yet varied enough to be interesting and then arranging the objects, judging the arrangement, and often rearranging them over and over until the sense of equilibrium is judged to “feel right.” This effort justiies the nickname “active,” because it requires active participation to accomplish. The

Figure 3.6 Asymmetrical or informal balance is evident in the artwork of this Modern staircase area. The graphic red/white and black/gray panels and the pottery arrangements in this lighted niche are different on each side of the center, yet handsomely balanced. Framed artwork on each flanking wall is also placed asymmetrically—at eye level above each set of stairs. Design by Mary Kennedy, Interior Design/photo © Brian Vanden Brink

58

Chapter 3

term “optical” is derived from the necessity of judging the composition with the eye, or the optic sense. Achieving asymmetrical balance demands patience and sensitivity and certainly comes easier to some people than to others. Yet the results are deinitely worth the efforts because asymmetrical balance can be deeply pleasing and does not readily become tiresome. Although informal balance is the most common of the alternative names of asymmetrical balance, it is also known as occult balance because it has no set rules of what is right and is, therefore, somewhat elusive or mysterious. The Western world has learned much of asymmetrical balance from the strong Japanese inluence in architecture and design. Oriental philosophies are based on the intrinsic, harmonious, and asymmetrical arrangement seen in nature and then translated through careful study and application to interior design compositions.

Radial Balance

also a matter of expectation and anticipation and is a major part in the concept of emphasis or surprise. There are ive types of rhythm: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5.

Repetition and alternation Progression or gradation Transition Opposition or contrast Radiation

Repetition establishes rhythm through the repetitive use of an element of design, as previously suggested. Repetition not only establishes a continuity and low of rhythm but also provides unity, or sameness, which is a part of the principle of harmony. For example, a color repeated throughout an interior can establish rhythm if the eye can smoothly connect rather than jumping or leaping from colored object to colored object. Repetition is seen in rows of seats in a church or theater, in a set of books bound to match, or in the same style of lighting ixture used many times in a public space. In architectural detail, repetition may be seen in the same window in classic architecture such as the elegant Georgian home (see Chapter 15) or in moldings such as dentil trim. Alternation is the sequence of two or more components by which the eye can follow a rhythmic pattern. It is

Radial balance is a state of equilibrium based on the circle. It is seen as chairs surrounding a round table or as concentric circles in a chandelier or lighting ixture. On a small scale, it is seen on the round dial of a clock; on a larger scale, as circular furniture arrangements of comfortable chairs for a group gathering. Radial balance can also be seen as spokes extending from a wheel, pedestal table, or chair base. A form Figure 3.7 Repeated vertical rectangles in the cabinetry, the art glass windows, and the table of radial balance can be seen show rhythm by repetition in this early Modern-inspired kitchen. Photo courtesy of Andersen Windows in the grain of a dining table where the veneer (top layer) is laid in quarter sections that meet in the center. Historic wooden pieces frequently incorporated radial balance with inlaid pieces of wood. Spiraling forms can also create a type of radial balance.

Rhythm Rhythm is a concept familiar in music as the beat that continually carries along the melody. In interior design, rhythm carries the eye along a path at a pace determined by the elements that illustrate it. For example, rhythm might be found in the repetitive use of a color, pattern, texture, line, or furniture piece or style. Architectural detail such as stairs, window panes, and moldings illustrate rhythm. Rhythm is

Design Principles, Elements, and Style

59

Figure 3.9 Rhythm by opposition is seen in the right angles of this window fenestration, chest, and screen.

Figure 3.8 Rhythm by gradation is seen in the decreasing sizes of the nesting tables. Photo by Gordon Lonsdale

seen in historic buildings with coffered ceilings, where a waflelike pattern has both high and low areas. The eggand-dart motif repeats two shapes, symbolizing birth and death, used in alternation. Progression, or gradation, is seen in shapes progressing from large to small or small to large, such as the front steps leading to the piano nobile (main level) in classic architecture or a set of nesting tables, where each smaller table its beneath its next larger counterpart. A collection of different-size boxes or a candelabrum (descending branched candlestick) are accessory items that can create rhythm by progression, or gradation. Progressive rhythm (rhythm by gradation) can also be seen in the value of color, where a color scheme contains shades that vary from very light values (perhaps on the ceiling) to medium values (on the wall) to dark values (on the loor) and where the values are further expanded in the furnishings. This light-to-medium-to-dark progressive sequence is also discussed in Chapter 4 as the concept of value distribution. Transition is a rhythm that leads the eye without interruption from one point to another. Rhythm by transition can be established by a continuous line, usually an architectural element such as a crown or dado molding

or an arched doorway. A stenciled or wallpaper border, a painted graphic, or a long carpet runner are methods of creating an uninterrupted visual, rhythmically lowing line. Opposition, or contrast, is an abrupt change that forms interesting, repetitive rhythm and is seen in three ways. First, it can be seen as repetitive 90-degree angles— such as window frames or grids, as built-in units (such as cabinetry and luminous ceilings), and as the corners of angular furniture or framed artwork. Second, opposition or contrast can be seen in patterns: open and closed, busy and plain, light and dark combinations of fabric, area rugs, or other textiles or wall coverings. Third, forms can be placed to contrast in a pleasing rhythm. Angular shapes placed next to rounded shapes not only create rhythm by contrast or opposition but also give relief and a type of asymmetrical balance. Radiation, closely related to radial balance, is the inal type of rhythm. Rhythm established by radiating concentric or spokelike lines or forms can be dramatic and impressive. It is sometimes employed as designs in large, custom loor coverings in places such as lobbies and ballrooms or in grand ceilings where architectural carving or cast plaster creates a radial effect. As such, it can give the room a circular, sweeping, rhythmic movement. On a smaller scale, radiation can be seen in place settings at a round or oval table or as furniture forms in a circular grouping.

Emphasis Emphasis is the creation of a focal point—an area visually important enough to draw and hold attention. Examples of dramatic, demanding focal points include a beautiful ireplace, a view from a window (or even an art glass window), a wall of dramatic art, or an impressive piece or grouping of furniture. A rhythmic

60

Chapter 3

Figure 3.10 Rhythm by radiation is seen in concentric circles in the steps and as spokelike lines in the glass arch of the winter garden at the World Financial Center in New York City. © Rafael Macia/Photo Researchers, Inc.

progression—a many-doored hallway, for example—can express the principle of emphasis by ending in a vista such as a ine piece of furniture or artwork. Some interiors may have multiple focal points, each one with a different level of emphasis, progressing from the most to the least dominant in order to avoid conlict. Logically, smaller areas can handle fewer focal points than larger areas. An exception might be an art gallery, where each piece of art is given equal opportunity to be a point of interest and emphasis. Where varying levels of emphasis are planned, the dominant focal point could migrate. For example, in the winter the ireplace is a logically comforting focal point that dominates interest. In warmer seasons, through rearrangement of the furnishings, the dominant focal point might become a large window with a view. Where no

focal point exists, one can be created in the guise of bookcases, china cabinets, artwork (displayed individually or in group arrangements), tapestries, rugs, quilts or other art fabrics, and mirrors. The elements of design can be manipulated to give greater emphasis to a focal point. Arranging furniture shapes to face the focal point, directing lines toward the focal point, grouping or massing objects to give visual weight to the focal point, or using more dramatic color at the area of the focal point are ways to increase emphasis.

Harmony: Variety and Unity Harmony is the combination of design elements, architecture, and furnishings into a pleasing or orderly whole—a state of agreement or a feeling of rightness. Harmony is

Design Principles, Elements, and Style

61

Figure 3.11 This focal point wall consists of eight windows in a bow arrangement with a porthole window set into the triangular wall above with sconce uplighting. The dramatic view of the ocean becomes an extension of this focal point. The U-shaped furniture arrangement emphasizes this sweeping architectural/view focal point. The view also expands the space of this comfortable seating area. Design by Hutker Architects/photo © Brian Vanden Brink

the result of a delicate balance of two subprinciples: unity and variety. Unity suggests a oneness and uniformity—an identity that establishes a master plan. Unity is the goal that is being sought and, hopefully, achieved when all the various elements and furnishings are brought together. Unity can be achieved by carrying out a cohesive color scheme or by keeping the character and style of the furniture consistent. Unity dictates selecting background materials, fabrics, and accessories that all have a similar feeling. This means that the use of pattern or ornament, color and value, surface textures (smooth or rough), and even the grain of the wood (coarse or ine) is consistent in character with the master plan.

Variety is the absence of monotony or sameness, yet it is much more. Variety is a healthy, positive inluence that brings about vitality, interest, and diversity. It can be seen through a selection of differing colors, textures, furniture and accessory styles, through the contrast of hard materials with soft materials, and through the combination of seemingly divergent old (historic) and new (modern) architecture and furnishings. Yet variety without some order or a master plan can become confusing and dissonant. Every interior should have goals of identity and oneness, yet be varied enough to be interesting. This design statement, master plan, or set of goals should be set forth in written and graphic form, so that every furnishing

62

Chapter 3

item, whether purchased at once or over a period of years, will be selected to complement all other furnishings speciied. It is wise and thoughtful planning that sets apart ine design from interiors that lack harmony.

The Elements of Design The elements of design—space, shape or form, mass, line, texture, pattern, light, and color—are used by every designer in every discipline. These elements were not invented but discovered and skillfully incorporated and balanced by artisans and designers over the course of history. Because of the basic and crucial nature of the elements of design, they are discussed in nearly every ine-art textbook and wherever the education or evaluation of a designed work takes place. Keep in mind that every element of design can be used effectively or ineffectively and that many compositions exist that are not perfect in their use of the elements. For example, an interior may have dramatic space, perfectly balanced light, well-proportioned form or mass, and appropriate line but may be illed with poorly selected pattern, texture, or color. Or perhaps the pattern, texture, and color are well chosen, yet some of the other elements are used ineffectively. As students of design, we seek to recognize and to perfect the skillful use of the elements of design in interiors.

Space Space exists as a diffuse, endless entity until it is deined. The deinition of space occurs with building construc-

tion, resulting in exterior and interior spatial allotments. Space-restricting devices within the building—walls, loors, ceilings, and furnishings—create a series of spaces with individual dimensions and qualities. These qualities can be discovered only as a person moves through spaces and perceives them one at a time: one space lowing into another or one abruptly ending and another beginning. When the space/time movement is complete, the perceptions are mentally assembled to give a true picture and judgment of the space. The divisions and restrictions of space form the foundation of architectural planning. Interior designers often create unequal space allotments within buildings not only for aesthetic reasons but to answer human needs, as well. Treating spaces of different sizes addresses two basic human needs. First is the need to be protected, enclosed, and comforted. Small spaces give a sense of security from intruders and from the buffeting of the outside world. Small spaces establish territory; they give a sense of pride and of ownership, and they offer opportunity to personalize our own space. Conversely, small spaces can be restricting or conining and can spawn restlessness and frustration. Small spaces that are inadequate for functions that are performed there may visually be expanded through the use of light colors, wall-to-wall neutral loor coverings, small-scale furnishings, mirrors, and smoothly textured surfaces or textures with little pattern. Generous light from more than one source can also give the impression of more space than actually exists. Large space ills a second basic human need as an outgrowth of the coninement of small space. This is the need to be free, to mentally soar into a space devoid of restrictions, to be stimulated by the immensity of space

Figure 3.12 This small roomsized loft is filled with interesting shapes and forms in the built-in bench, cushions, and pillows, the oval window, dado paneling, and doors. Other elements of design are well selected: the rich pattern and colors of the Oriental rug, the red pillows, and neutralized green wood trim. Upper walls and ceiling are lighter, visually expanding this small space. Design by Bernhard & Priestley Architects/ photo © Brian Vanden Brink

Design Principles, Elements, and Style

as compared to the insigniicance of human scale. The lack of restriction, however, can create feelings of insecurity and inadequacy and a desire to return to the safe, secure quarters of small spaces. Large interior spaces can be dificult to handle; often there is a need to make the space seem smaller than it is. Effective ways of creating more intimacy in large spaces include using medium- to large-scale patterns and dark or vivid colors that visually advance, furniture that is heavy or solid looking, area rugs (particularly patterned or colored ones that visually break the loor space), large-scale artwork, and multiple furniture groupings (see also Chapter 8). Many well-planned interiors incorporate both small and large spaces. We see this in homes where a living area has a high ceiling, where a family room or great room has generous square footage, or where several rooms open onto a solarium, deck, or covered patio. In contract interiors, such as business and professional centers, shopping malls, or hotels, the small, enclosed quarters are ofices, boutiques, shops, or hotel rooms, and these are often grouped around a courtyard, atrium, ballroom, or multistoried open lobby area. To emerge from small spaces into large or tall spaces can be exhilarating and satisfying, yet the return to the small areas can bring about a needed sense of personal belonging, security, and safety.

(B)

63

Interior designers create interesting areas of positive and negative space. Positive space is space illed with color, texture, form, or mass. This could be walls, furnishings, art, area rugs, or even graphics or scenes painted on walls. Negative space is the empty space surrounding the positive space—the windows between walls, the loor around the area rug, the wall around and between works of art, the space between furniture pieces, or even the cubic footage. In a successful interior, the positive and negative spaces should be balanced in terms of both amount and placement. Some areas may be primarily positive space, others primarily negative, and still others equally distributed between the two. For example, the proportion of negative (empty wall) space between works of art hanging on walls may remain relatively even, or it may be unevenly distributed.

Shape or Form While we sometimes think of shape as only a twodimensional outline, form (which is an extension of shape) is the three-dimensional coniguration of the objects within the interior. For example, furniture seen in silhouette has shape that can be perceived, and as we move around the furniture, the silhouette changes and we begin to comprehend the three-dimensional quality of the form. Often an interior is successful because the forms that ill it are pleasing shapes and well proportioned one to another. There are several kinds of shapes: two-dimensional outline shapes or planes— such as rectangles, squares, triangles, circles, and other geometric shapes—or meandering, curved, or angular shapes that do not it neatly

(C)

Figure 3.13 The shape or form of new Modern design is one of its most compelling features. Each of these pieces has a distinctive and pleasing form. (A) The Eames molded plywood chair is a classic Midcentury Modern form, (B) Smala sofa, (C) Yang sofa. (A) Courtesy of Herman Miller; (B and C) Photos courtesy Roset (A)

USA Corp., Smala designed by Pascal Mourgue; Yang designed by Francois Bauchet

64

Chapter 3

into geometry. When these 2-D planes are given a third dimension (3-D), they become forms such as cubes, cones, and spheres or forms that are sinuous or curving. For example, a rectangular table can be an appreciated form and shape that is simple and pleasing, yet if the entire room were illed with similar shapes and forms, the room would become boring and repetitious. There needs to be a balance of form—a curved chair to soften the straight lines of the table form. The forms that are placed next to each other will have considerable effect on each other. Sometimes the juxtaposition of unlikely elements, such as the tandem placements of a vintage piece of furniture with a thoroughly modern piece, can create a delightful and charming surprise. On the other hand, certain forms destroy the integrity of each other and prove disastrous to both objects. This might be the placement of a delicate and lacy plant next to the abstract lines of a modern painting where the incongruity is jolting and disturbing. Perhaps a sculptural, abstract plant form, such as a cactus, would be better suited to the shapes in the painting. The key to selecting forms is to balance them against the proportion and scale of the architecture for the desired psychological effect or feeling and to select each form to complement other nearby forms.

The sensitive and careful selection and arrangement of forms is crucial in an interior because forms have great power to persuade us to feel certain ways, such as alert and attentive or relaxed and secure. Shapes and forms appeal to the senses and can have amazing impact on the person who enters the room. For example, a person entering a room illed with cubes will probably perceive the interior as a no-nonsense one where, perhaps, business takes place. Curved forms are gracious, may make people feel more relaxed, and are commonly used in residential living rooms and bedrooms. Being sensitive to sculptural forms can increase our appreciation for classical beauty and modern abstract expression. Historic furniture pieces (see Chapter 15) are sculptural forms that are so important that the character of an interior can become impressive with their added presence. Furniture pieces that have endured decades or centuries are revered and appreciated today as ine decorative art largely because of their timeless and appealing forms.

Mass

Mass is the solidity, matter, or density that is deined by shape or form. In furniture, mass is actual density when the material is illed in, such as a solid block of wood. Mass can also be optical density where the material may not be solid. Heavier or more solid mass will make furniture pieces look Figure 3.14 Grouped photos are examples of massing to create a unified group larger than furniture with the same overall mass for a weighted and more important appearance. On the left wall, photos and accessories are massed, as are the pillows on the bed. Photo courtesy of HGTV dimensions but with empty areas instead of solid areas. Examples of furniture with solid or heavy mass include sofas, chairs, and ottomans (oversized footstools) with skirts to the loor and/or with oversized cushions; end tables and nightstands supported with bracket feet or no feet or with doors or solid fronts; dining room tables with heavy solid legs or pedestals; and bookcases illed with books (as compared to bookcases with empty areas or areas of art or sculpture). Heavy mass is desirable where the room is large and furnishings need to visually take up as much space as possible or where furniture needs to appear dignified or commanding. Massing means grouping together components such as accessories, furniture, or blocks of architecture to create a uniied “group mass.” Massing will give a weighted, more solid, or imposing appearance. For example, several framed art pieces on a wall will create an important, heavier-looking arrangement than just one or two isolated small pieces. On the coffee table, a book, potted plant, and objects of art grouped into an

Design Principles, Elements, and Style

interesting composition will draw more attention than would the book alone. Two sofas placed in an L shape or parallel to each other will look more impressive than a single sofa. Furniture, accessories, and artwork can be massed together to balance other larger pieces or architectural components such as windows or ireplaces or to it into the scale of a room. For example, a low chest with a table lamp could be massed together with a framed art piece to become a visual unit. This unit could then balance a larger case piece such as a breakfront or secretarytype cabinet. Massing can be instrumental in giving richness and completeness to the other components that otherwise might look empty or uninished when used alone. A framed artwork by itself on the wall may loat awkwardly without something (a table, chair, or chest) to visually anchor it; this is the role of massing. Architects use massing as a tool to create emphasis or to draw attention. For example, when an exterior is analyzed, it is often clear that the architect has manipulated window openings, wings, or shapes of the roof in such a way as to create areas of emphasis and balance via massing.

65

Figure 3.15 Artistic and balanced lines—vertical, horizontal, angled, and circular— are seen in this bathroom and bedroom. Photo courtesy of Andersen Windows

Line Line is the connection of two or more points. The eye also perceives line when two planes meet and when shape is seen in silhouette as an outline. Lines may be straight (horizontal or vertical), angular (diagonal or zigzag), and curved (circular, flowing, or tightly curved). Lines are used by interior designers to create effects such as increased height, width, or the impression of movement. The psychology of line is important to creating ambience or a particular mood in interior design. The types of line are listed in Table 3.3, along with the psychological effect of each.

Combining Lines Lines are used in combination in every interior, yet often one line will be planned to dominate in order to accomplish a desired effect, such as the vertical lines that produce awe and lift the eye heavenward in a church. Furthermore, vertical and horizontal lines generally form the structural foundation for a building in the form of perpendicular loors, walls, and ceilings. Angular and curved lines are utilized for reinforcement, strength, interest, movement, and relief, as seen in triangular roof truss systems and angled ceilings or walls and in digniied archways and domed ceilings.

Figure 3.16 Flowing lines as balusters are the dominant element in this curved staircase balustrade. Design by Knickerbocker Group/ photo © Brian Vanden Brink

66

Chapter 3

Table 3.3

Psychological Effects of Line

Straight Lines

Vertical Lines: Imposing, Lofty, Solid, Formal, Restrained

Horizontal Lines: Weighty, Secure, Restful, Repose Horizontal lines suggest a solid, harmonious relationship with the earth; earth’s gravity has no further pull. Long horizontal lines can visually expand space, making rooms appear wider or longer. When found in a connecting architectural detail such as a molding, horizontal lines provide a smooth transition between rooms or areas. If they lead to a focal point, they help to emphasize it; when they stop at a window, the eye is guided to the exterior view. An interior with too many horizontal lines may become boring and lack interest.

Vertical lines lift the eye upward. They have the ability to lift the mind and the spirit as well. As such, vertical lines are a purposeful tool for architects and designers of churches and public buildings because they inspire awe and tend to diminish the signiicance of human scale. The use of vertical lines can make an interior seem higher, apparently increasing vertical space. Vertical lines are stable because they represent a perpendicular resistance to earth’s gravity. They convey a feeling of strength and dignity and are quite appropriate in formal dining rooms, entryways, and formal living areas. This formality can bring a stiffness or commanding feeling to the interior. Too many vertical lines can cause a feeling of uneasiness, of too much coninement and predictability.

Angular Lines Diagonal Lines: Action, Movement, Interest, Angular Stability

Horizontal lines

Diagonal lines are lexible because their exact direction may vary from shallow to steep angles. Diagonal lines generally suggest movement, action, or dynamism, perhaps

Vertical lines

because diagonal lines are associated with going places: up or down a diagonal staircase or an escalator, the taking off or landing of an airplane. Interest is usually sustained longer with diagonal lines than with horizontal or vertical lines, possibly because the angles appear to defy gravity and the eye and mind are stimulated. Yet diagonal lines can also be secure, such as the reinforcing diagonals of an angled roof truss system. Too many diagonal lines, particularly on the wall, can be overstimulating and tiresome.

Texture Texture is the surface characteristics and appearance inherent in every element and component of interior design. As the relative smoothness or roughness of a surface, texture is determined in two ways: by touching the physical texture and by visually reading the surface, which may appear quite different to the eye than it actually is to the touch. Some textures that read as rough are painted or printed tiny patterns that give the impression of a texture when it does not actually exist. An example is the painting of surfaces to look like rock, brick, or tile. Smooth textures generally are associated with more formal, high-style interiors, while rough textures are often thought to be more casual. Textures generally need to be handled in a uniied manner, with a compatible

Figure 3.17 Rough-textured walls, smooth wooden floors, and richly patterned Oriental rugs are authentic elements in this Tuscan-style home. Design by Greene & Greene/photo © Brian Vanden Brink

Design Principles, Elements, and Style

Zigzag Lines: Exciting, Lively, Rhythmic Movement Zigzag lines are short diagonal lines that reverse upon themselves and form a regular or irregular pattern. A zigzag line can be one single line or several in a set. A set of regular zigzag lines is called a chevron or herringbone pattern, and irregular zigzag lines are called a flamestitch pattern. Angular zigzag lines can add energy and life to an interior. If too many zigzag lines are incorporated, however, the effect can be frenzied and agitating.

dignity to interiors. Generously curved lines are viewed as feminine. An excess of curved lines may become too decorative and, consequently, visually disturbing.

Flowing Lines: Gentle Movement, Growth, Linear Development Flowing lines are irregularly curved lines that move gently in a random or spiraling

Curved Lines Curved or Circular Lines: Soft, Humanizing, Repetitive Tempo, Gracefulness Curved or circular lines provide relief and softness to straight and angular lines and balance the harshness of too many straight lines. Curved lines give a human quality to interiors; they can be easy on the eyes and pleasant to view. A series of curved lines, such as in an arcade (a procession of arches), gives a rhythmic cadence to the room, suggesting graceful movement. In architectural components, round or elliptic segments (sections of circles or ovals) such as archways provide graceful

Gently curved to flowing to tightly curved lines

feeling to every other texture selected for the interior. However, some contrast in texture is vital for relief and for emphasis. If every texture reads as smooth and glassy, for example, the interior would seem cold and unwelcoming. If every texture is rough, the interior may become harsh and irritating. A balance or a variety of textures is necessary within the uniied theme or ambience in order to achieve harmony. Upkeep is also a consideration in selecting texture. Light-colored, rough textures will show very little dirt because the relief (high and low areas that produce highlight and shadow) will conceal soil. Smooth surfaces, such as lat walls, glass, or dark, polished wood, will reveal dust and ingerprints.

Pattern Pattern is the arrangement of forms or designs to create an orderly whole. Pattern often consists of a number of motifs, or single-design units, arranged into a larger design composition. Pattern is seen in printed and woven textiles such as upholstery and drapery fabric, loor rugs,

67

manner. Flowing lines may be seen in large, live interior trees, in spiral or curved staircases, or in the lines of ine Oriental rugs. Inspiration may be taken from the graceful curved lines of growing and changing plant forms. Because we are never certain where the line will end, lowing lines can provide a great deal of interest.

Tightly Curved or Busy Lines: Playful Activity, Zest, Lively Visual Stimulation Tightly curved or busy lines are most often seen in textiles and in wall and loor coverings as complicated patterns that are lively, busy, or active. Tightly curved lines can add frivolity and fun to interiors and can make up a pattern that visually closes in space. Complicated tightly curved compositions, such as those in vivid loral fabric patterns or in area rugs, add life and may be visually stimulating and aesthetically satisfying. As such, busy lines may save interiors from becoming dull or boring, yet control over the quality of the design is imperative. Colors and contrast that are too bold or feature too much obvious pattern might prove displeasing and detract from the harmony of the interior.

and carpeting. Pattern is also seen in wall coverings and in carved or inlaid furniture designs. Pattern that is too small to distinguish may read as texture.

Combining Patterns Patterns are frequently combined in interior design. While some combinations are very successful, we often sense incompatibility in other combined pattern schemes. To achieve a feeling of rightness, four things need to be evaluated: (1) the placement of emphasis, (2) the character of the pattern, (3) the color scheme, and (4) the scale of the patterns to be combined: • The placement of emphasis. Emphasis is giving importance to one pattern over another so that conlict is minimized. Emphasis is established by using a greater amount of one pattern or a larger scale of one pattern than another. • The character of the pattern. When two or more patterns are used in the same interior, the characters or styles must be compatible. For example, a digniied Georgian damask or brocade fabric will not

68

Chapter 3

are dificult to combine unless there are enough of each to have unity in the space. Curvilinear patterns combine more successfully with straight or angled patterns. In small spaces, too many pattern directions are confusing.

Light

Figure 3.18 Colorful patterned pillows and cushions follow the rules of varying the size and scale of the related patterns. These patterns are similar in character and have a harmonized color scheme. Design by Bernhard & Priestley Architects/photo © Brian Vanden Brink

be compatible with a country Victorian printed cotton one. They will have an entirely different look or character. • The color scheme. Generally, a closely related color scheme will foster harmony. If one pattern contains blues and yellows, for example, then other patterns should also contain exact, similar, or compatible hues, values, and intensities. If the colors are close but “off,” then the patterns will not combine successfully. • The scale of the pattern. Pattern scale or size can be similar if the style and the color are compatible. However, when the scale is the same, multiple patterns often seem to conlict. Varying the size or scale of the patterns by using, for example, a large pattern, a small pattern, a tiny pattern, a inely blended stripe, or a compatible geometric shape, along with appropriate textures, can be a good means of achieving success in combining pattern.

Pattern Psychology Consider line direction and the psychological effect when combining patterns. Angled and straight patterns

Light in interior design has two sources: natural light and artiicial light. Although natural light admitted in a large quantity through expanses of glass windows may need some means of screening to prevent glare (too much bright light) or heat buildup, natural light is a desirable and an appreciated element of design. The quality, quantity, and color of light affect the way we see our surroundings and, as such, need direction, control, and perhaps supplemental sources of light. When natural light cannot fully meet the needs of the interior design, artiicial lighting can make up the difference. Artiicial light generally comprises incandescent light (the common lightbulb with a tungsten element that glows to produce heat) and luorescent light (luminous lamps). Both natural and artiicial light are discussed in further detail in Chapter 5. Light as an element of design affects all other elements. Light can make space appear large or small, friendly or cold. Areas well lit with clear, bright light will make spaces appear larger, whereas dim lights and shadows cast upon walls will seem to close in space. Light can alter the apparent form or shape of furnishings. For example, lighting portions and leaving other areas in darkness can change the appearance of a form. Low-wattage light sources or backlighting (throwing light behind an object) can affect mass by making objects appear heavier than they really are. Light affects the way we interpret texture when it highlights textural relief (surface irregularities), and light affects pattern by clarifying or by submerging details. For example, a rough texture can appear even rougher when a light is cast on it at a parallel angle. This “grazing light” will emphasize the relief through highlight and shadow. A smooth texture will appear smoother with a directional band of light, such as a spotlight or a smooth wash of light. Likewise, clear light shining directly on a pattern will emphasize the pattern details, and low light casting shadows on a pattern will minimize the details. Light can change the apparent identity of a color through the color and type of light that hits the surface. Further, different materials may relect light and color in different ways, affecting the relationship of the colors to each other.

Color Color, the last element of design, is the most emotional and personal of all the elements. Although everyone has

Design Principles, Elements, and Style

69

Figure 3.19 Natural light illuminates the lobby of International Business Machines (IBM) in Purchase, New York. © Steve Rosenthal. Courtesy of Pei, Cobb, Freed & Partners, Architects

individual preferences toward, and prejudices against, certain colors, humans generally respond similarly to color combinations within each culture. Here the psychology of color is based on the reaction of people in the United States and similar cultures in regard to color hue, value, and intensity. Hues, or colors such as reds, oranges, and yellows are stimulating; blues, greens, and violets are calming. Hues as seen on the standard color wheel can be divided into equal groups where one half of the wheel consists of warm colors that are stimulating, friendly, cozy, and inviting, and the other half consists of calming cool colors that suggest restraint, dignity, and formality. Color values are the relative lightness or darkness of the hues. For example, a high-value, light red is a pink; a low-value, dark red is a burgundy. Lighter colors seem to recede, making space appear larger and giving a more airy look to the interior, whereas darker values do the opposite—close in and give a cavelike coziness. Distribution of value is sought after in most ine interior design, where some values of light, medium, and dark hues are carefully placed to achieve the desired effect. When

placed next to each other, light and dark values (high contrast) can be dramatic, whereas hues close in value (low contrast) create a subtly blended, calming environment. Color intensity is the brightness versus the dullness of a hue. Pure colors can be lowered in intensity by adding a neighboring or a contrasting color or by adding white, black, gray, or any combination of these. Bright, bold, pure colors are exciting and happy. These need careful handling so as not to become overbearing through overuse or indiscriminate placement. Dull colors can be dark, medium, or light in value but are generally easy to live with because they are undemanding. Often a good balance is found in rooms that utilize the law of chromatic distribution: The larger areas are dulled and neutralized, and the smallest areas are brightest, with the intensity becoming brighter as the areas become smaller. Color is examined in greater depth in Chapter 4.

Structural and Decorative Design Structural and decorative or ornamentive design are two basic divisions of design that are not generally considered

70

Chapter 3

with the principles and elements, yet they are important in evaluating the success of a design.

Structural Design Structural design is seen in any element of interiors where the design is intrinsic to the structure and the form indicates the function of the piece. The concept of “form follows function” is a credo followed by architects and designers who have created modern classic works that are simple yet exactingly well thought out and executed. To say that form follows function means that the irst priority in a design is its function, and the parameters of that purpose or function will dictate the shape or form of the design. For example, many modern chairs are designed primarily for the comfort and physical support of their users. The study of ergonomics or ergoit means that a chair (or even the entire range of furnishings and the building itself) is best suited for speciic functions that will take place there. A chair designed to follow the dictum, “form follows function,” will be stripped of embellishment and will fulill only the needs of its function, with an eye to ine, Figure 3.20 Impeccable structural design is seen in this Modern kitchen. Structural sleek, and simpliied design. design is simple, unadorned, and well proportioned, with the function apparent. Structural design has no added deco- Design by Peter Rose Architect/photo © Brian Vanden Brink ration, and the design cannot be removed from the structure without destroying both the design (form) and the purpose (function) of the decoration to cover up the dimensions, the scale, and piece. In order for structural design to be considered ine the relationship of parts. or high-quality design, certain criteria must be met: Much of today’s minimalist midcentury furnishings are structural design. • Structural design must be simple. The form and materials will never be complicated or arbitrary. IroniDecorative Design cally, however, simplicity is often much more dificult Decorative design is also called “applied” or “ornamento design and execute than ornate design. Every curve, tive” design and refers to the ornamentation, or embelangle, and part of the design is absolutely necessary to lishment, of the object or structure. Some subjects are the form and the function of the design. in themselves decorative because of the way they are • Structural design is unadorned. There will be no formed, whereas others may be structural pieces with carving, decals, unnecessary color changes, or extras decorative design added. Added decoration can be of any sort. The design is found in the form and the painted, inlaid, ired, engraved, or carved. There are four materials used—wood grain, for example, or stainless types or categories of decorative design: steel or plastic—all frankly exposed to reveal their real worth. 1. Naturalistic design looks so real we could mistake • The function of the piece must be apparent. For exit for a photo or the real plant, animal, or object from ample, a well-designed structural clock will look exnature. actly like a clock and not like anything else. 2. Conventional design uses designs from nature in a • A structural piece must be well proportioned to be simpliied, stylized, or adapted way. The design is “ingood design. This is particularly true since there is no spired” by nature but does not copy it accurately.

Design Principles, Elements, and Style

71

3. Geometric design is based on geometry: circles, diamonds, squares, and rectilinear shapes and patterns. 4. Abstract design is pattern or shape where the source or inspiration is not clear; it could be a combination, for example, of conventional and geometric designs. When decorative architecture, interior architectural detail, or applied design on furnishings is well done, it will have the following characteristics:

Figure 3.21 Realistic animal skin pattern is an example of naturalistic decorative design, appearing so real that it may be mistaken for real animal fur. The Animal Collection, courtesy of Patterson, Flynn and Martin/Rosecore, a division of F. Schumacher Co.

• There must be a sympathetic relationship between the style and method of decoration and the object, such as precise etching or engraving of glass or carving or inlaying of wood. • The decoration must be suitable for the function and/or style of the piece. If the object is a French Rococo form, for example, then the decoration should not relect unrelated Victorian motifs. Truly ine decorative design will complement the function. The decoration of a clock face, for example, should not obscure the ability to read the time but should enhance the clock’s design richness. Figure 3.22 Scandinavian rosemaling painted designs are examples of conventional decorative design applied to the folk Rococo-style carving, adding charm and Old World character to these built-in beds. Photo © Brian Vanden Brink

72

Chapter 3

Figure 3.23 This “Eternal Trellis” carpet pattern is an example of geometric decorative design. The shape of the furniture is also based on geometry. Photo courtesy of Mohawk Industries

Figure 3.24 Abstract design, where the design source or inspiration is not clear, is seen in this Midcentury Modern painting and the Georg Nelson Swag chairs. Photo courtesy of Herman Miller

Design Principles, Elements, and Style

73

• The proportion of the decoration must be right for the size of the object. This means two things: (1) The scale of the decoration should be right for the scale of the object (not too large or too small in proportion), and (2) the amount of decoration should be in accordance with the size of the object. A piece too heavily ornamented will likely be considered poor design. • The ornamentation should embrace the form and not interfere with its function.

Design Discernment and Excellence The principles and elements, together with an understanding of structural and decorative design, form a solid base from which we can judge any design. The power of discernment is deined as the ability to recognize and appreciate ine design wherever it is found. We study interior design to gain the ability to discern between levels of design excellence. Thereby we learn to appreciate and incorporate the best design possible into our lives and interiors. We often label design as to its quality or integrity; from most to least desirable, these labels include: • Excellent or i ne design is impeccable, great design. It is uplifting and visually rewarding, even thrilling to aesthetically sensitive people. • Good or fair design is acceptable, though not perfect design. It is adequate for its purpose and is generally pleasing. • Average or mediocre design is bland, uninspiring, unmotivating. Much mass-produced design is mediocre. • Poor design is inadequate and disappointing. It is not aesthetically pleasing and usually doesn’t function well either. • Bad design or kitsch is repulsive or silly, unsupportive design. Some items that we label “kitsch,” however, are used for humor in the same way cartoons give comic relief. Some kitsch items have sentimental value.

Cost Is Not the Issue Keep in mind that these levels of design have little to do with cost. You can pay just as much or as little for bad design as for excellent design. The difference will be found in the inherent beauty and livability that make life more pleasant and rewarding. Fine design is the result of a commitment to ill life and our surroundings with the best design the world has to offer. Items and complete interiors of ine design endear themselves to us because of their timelessness, characterized by classic lines, pleasing forms, and superb use of textures and colors. This is true whether the design is structural or decorative.

Figure 3.25 This room is an example of excellent or fine design— both uplifting and visually rewarding. Design by Siemasko + Verbridge/photo © Brian Vanden Brink

Training the Eye An eye for great design comes from consciously observing and comparing. Here are some places and ways to develop the power of discernment: • Visit public buildings such as museums and art galleries, great public and church architecture, quality furniture stores and boutiques. These and other welldesigned contract places broaden our exposure to varying styles and can lead to discernment. • Walk through residential interiors owned by family and friends; go to showcase homes and model homes. Visit historic homes open to the public or museum homes. These exposures help in judging what works aesthetically and what is poorly designed by comparing furnishings and considering how other people function and interact in the spaces. • Analyze the media, which include design periodicals (interior design magazines), movie and video stage sets, CAD programs, and Internet sites. The media play an important role in shaping both short-lived fads and longer-lived trends. Much of what we see in the

74

Chapter 3

media is fair or good design, some is excellent, and some is poor to bad design. Don’t be easily persuaded just because it’s in a magazine or on the screen. Some “in-style” interiors have merit; others do not. It is just ine to let a fad pass by. Good design will stand the test of time. Don’t be in a hurry to copy what you see. Take a little time to consider the merits of the design direction. • Observe nature. It has been said that nature never makes an aesthetic mistake, and examples of nature’s infallibility are all around us to study and learn from. The majesty we see in nature developed over a very long time. The result—a patina or mellow, warm, old beauty—is something that we can seek to create in our own interiors. As with nature, we need feel no rush to “complete” an interior. Our lives, like nature, evolve and never stagnate. Demographics change, careers change, possessions change. Let the process be part of the beauty, rather than thinking an interior should be “done.” Great interiors, like nature, change and relect the growth of those who live there.

• Seek education in the form of book and media learning, classroom instruction, and hands-on projects. Interior design is a complex ield that involves many disciplines. A wide range of technical information and the creative capacity to solve problems often come from intense training, exposure, and seasoned experience. The study of historic styles yields a healthy perspective. Recognizing the designs that have withstood the test of time and are still considered beautiful cultivates appreciation and a love for ine design.

Finding a Personal Style Just as no two people are the same, so no two interiors should be alike. Finding ideas that appeal to you can certainly serve as a source of inspiration, but copying others’ styles will not help you develop a style of your own. Consider these suggestions: • Pare back before piling on extras. Sorting through personal possessions and giving away things that are no

Figure 3.26 Observing the infallible aesthetics of nature is an excellent way to train the eye to achieve a keener sense of design discrimination. This outdoor deck, railing, and overhead pergola is handsome structural design. Design by Stephen Blatt

Figure 3.27 Organized spaces are devoid of clutter. When needs are met without piling on extras, the space appears clean and orderly—a prerequisite of good design. Photo courtesy of HGTV

Architects/photo © Brian Vanden Brink

Dream House

Design Principles, Elements, and Style









longer useful or sentimental is a great starting point. Live with bare walls for a while—there is no shame in this. Then consider, ponder, observe, and live in the space before beginning to furnish. Rearrange what you already have before planning new purchases. Often the perceived need to own new things is folly. Good interior design rarely results from throwing out everything and starting from scratch with new furnishings. Rather, give new life by moving things around, rotating art and accessories, and moving furniture to different locations or different rooms. Think “need,” not “want.” Give serious thought to how you want to live and what you want to do in an interior. The space should irst of all meet the functional needs of the occupants. Think “What do I need?” rather than “What do I want?” The ensuing solution will make the most sense. The design program discussed in Chapter 1 should spell this out well. Remember, the more data that are gathered, the better the design solution. Simplify and organize. Cluttered, messy, or dirty rooms are not good design, no matter how costly the furnishings. Neat and clean, well-organized spaces bring peace, contentment, and harmony to the lives of those who live and work there. The dependable adage “A place for everything and everything in its place” serves well in developing a personal style. Things not in use should be put away in containers or boxes, carefully labeled. Things not used in a year’s time could be sold or given away. According to the National Association of Professional Organizers (NAPO), organized people save time and money, and reduce their stress and frustration levels. This means they can ind what is needed when it is needed. Getting rid of clutter eliminates 40 percent of housework in an average home, and 80 percent of clutter is the result of disorganization, not lack of space. When homes are neat and orderly, they increase in value, safety, and beauty. Simple, organized spaces are the best foundation for developing a creative personal design style. Cultivate creativity. Look for the charms of your living or working space rather than its limitations. Build on what the best features seem to be, rather than lamenting what you don’t have architecturally. Most importantly, look inside yourself—your lifestyle and needs—for the way you want to live. With so many furnishing choices and products available today, creativity has few bounds. Great ideas come to everyone who studies design. Do not be afraid or intimidated to implement a unique design plan. People with great style sometimes do things that are totally unexpected and out of the ordinary, perhaps ahead of their time. Although they may seem to abandon all trends in favor of their own preferences, their good choices are never made to shock, amaze, or impress anyone. True style

75

and creativity involve tuning into and following what is naturally right. They have little to do with what is in fashion, although an awareness of fashion is always evident in interiors owned by people with good taste and creativity. Fashion passes; style remains. Style abhors cliché, cuteness, and conformity in favor of an uncompromising approach to irst-class design quality and individuality. Truly great design is innovative yet demanding of the best. • Personalize the space with things you love. Furnishings should reveal who you are, what you do, where you have been, what you have experienced, and who you love. And as you change, your home should respond to the person you become. • Cultivate good taste by choosing wisely. When each item of furnishing is thoughtfully selected and considered an essential ingredient, there is promise of good taste and great style. It has been said that people with good taste know when to stop, just short of excess. Keep the plan simple; let every component be beautiful, and add to the mix only when the overall design will beneit. Look ahead to the future, and know that we never regret making good decisions, purchasing good quality, and insisting on design excellence. Of all the objectives we may choose to incorporate in life, the dedication to creating welcoming, attractive, and individual personal interiors is one of the most worthwhile. An active knowledge of the principles and elements of design helps to ensure tasteful selections that will be cherished for years to come.

Interior Design Styles The established styles of interior design form the basis for making decisions for a personal interior design style. Following are general styles and descriptions of wellknown interior design styles: • Authentic historic or period styles developed in speciic geographic areas or countries during a deinite developmental or political period with a unity of style in exterior and interior architecture, furniture, wall and loor coverings, window and bed treatments, lighting and accessory styles, and color palette. These are presented in Chapter 15. • Formal Traditional takes components from formal European and American historic design: the Renaissance and Baroque, Early and Late Georgian, French Rococo, Neoclassic/Federal, Greek Revival/American Empire, and Victorian. The look is elegant, with reined materials, textures, and patterns, and compatible, blended furnishings of historic signiicance that are comfortable for today’s lifestyles. • Informal Traditional, Colonial, or American Country is a less reined style with a handcrafted charm from

76

Chapter 3

(A) Figure 3.28 Case Study: Finding a Personal Style on a Budget College students often have a passion for good interior design, are creative, and have energy to make things happen, but have very limited budgets. Here, a newly married couple solved their design problem on a shoestring budget of $150. (A) They keep their snowboards near the front door (B) with an attempt to screen them from view with branches. The husband’s parents gave them hand-me-down bookshelves, display cabinet, and dining room furniture from Denmark—all well worth keeping, but the drop leaf is cumbersome and the natural finish seems bland.

(B)

Design Principles, Elements, and Style

(C)

77

(E)

(D) (C) The solution to the snowboard storage came in the form of four panels of semisheer printed fabric and massing the wall unit furniture, creating the illusion of two separate rooms. A color scheme of lime green, black, and white is fresh and bold, and fits well with her graphic design and his photography skills. (D) A little paint and many hours of work later, the wall unit and dining table, now relieved of its drop leaf, are placed on a faux zebra skin area rug, and (E) the dining chairs sport an Art Nouveau–inspired peacock fabric. The young wife said, “It is amazing what three yards of designer fabric will do for an old chair. I had never reupholstered a chair before. I was astounded at how easy it was.” Jennifer Ljung, Interior Design

78





• •

Chapter 3

the Medieval English Elizabethan period, Colonial America, and regional American furnishings with a focus on the original colonies of the East Coast. Informal European style comes from three areas with common backgrounds and similar furnishings. These are Country or Provincial France, Tuscany, Italy, and Colonial Spain, which spread throughout the Americas. See also Chapter 15. Casual Contemporary is a look of relaxed comfort, with handsome furnishings and low-maintenance materials. This style varies according to geographic and regional inluences. It may use wicker or natural wood, durable materials and sturdy but comfortable fabrics combined in an easy-living style with personally meaningful accessories. Asian or Oriental styles are primarily from China and Japan. See Chapter 15. Today these styles may be indicated as art or accents. International Modern originated in Europe and spread to the United States as a contract and residential style. It is a stark, clean style with expansive windows, plain

plaster walls, hard natural and man-made materials and illed with the sculptural modern furniture classics presented in Chapter 15. • Organic Modern is a style by Frank Lloyd Wright, whose Prairie Style seemed to grow from the ground, harmonious with its setting. It also includes the Craftsman style with its Arts and Crafts Interiors, a product of the Greene Brothers as architects, Gustav Stickley as furniture designer, and William Morris as textile surface designer. See Chapter 15. • Scandinavian Modern is a blend of International and Organic styles as interpreted by Scandinavian and American architects and designers. Large windows and sliding glass doors open to nature. Interiors have wood ceilings and, often, loors, and rooms are furnished sparsely with midcentury Scandinavian Modern furniture, which is found in Chapter 15. • Retro Modern is a nostalgic contemporary interplay of International, Organic, and/or Scandinavian Modern styles blended with midcentury American culture.

Figure 3.29 Formal Traditional style combines furniture, colors, textures, and patterns that are refined and elegant with a sense of history. Design by Elliott Elliott Norelius Architecture/photo © Brian Vanden Brink

Design Principles, Elements, and Style

79

Figure 3.30 Informal European style embraces the look of Tuscany, Italy, and the provinces in France and Spain with features such as rough stucco walls and arched openings, beamed ceilings, wooden floors, handcrafted wooden furniture, and some wrought iron detailing. Design by Greene & Greene/photo © Brian Vanden Brink

Figure 3.31 Casual Contemporary style uses materials such as wood, wicker, fabric, and personal accessories in a comfortable setting. Design by Hutker Architects/photo © Brian Vanden Brink

80

Chapter 3

Figure 3.32 Modern style is a clean, open style with spare furnishings. This style includes International Modern, Organic Modern, and here, Scandinavian Modern. Modern may be pure, or it may be contemporary or retro, with some elements that are less pure but intended to bring contemporary warmth to the setting. Design by Hutker Architects/photo © Brian Vanden Brink

• Contemporary Organic is a style of open cleanliness with generous use of wood on loors, walls, and ceilings as vertical or horizontal planks, paneling, or logs. This style uses a variety of window styles and furnishings from Colonial to Modern. It is popular in waterfront or nature-based homes. • Influences of Art Nouveau and Art Deco may be seen as unique pieces in many of the above interiors. These styles are also discussed in Chapter 15. • Eclectic design uses furnishings from different styles and periods in a cohesive, interesting, unique, and artistic composition. Each piece should have merit and stand on its own in terms of excellent design. Eclectic

interiors often relect the travels, interests, and values of its owner and require artistic sensitivity and sound judgment for success. • Thematic interior design is contemporary or current design based on a theme. The sources for themes are varied and nearly limitless. Examples include culture/countrystyle themes, sports, nature, pop culture, fashion, juvenile themes, space exploration, movies, or fantasy character themes. Some themes will be temporary, and as a child grows or an interest or hobby wanes, the need for refurnishing is more frequent, making theme-based interior design less sustainable and responsible than long-lived design that can adapt to changes in demographics.

Chapter 4 Color

How We See Color 82 Color Theory 84 Color Harmony 88 Color Psychology 93 Residential and Contract Uses of Color 96

Design by Cheryl Kees Clendenon, Co-Designer: Stacy Miller; In Detail Kitchen and Bath/ Photography: GFR Photography/NKBA Design Competition

82

Chapter 4

How We See Color Many factors inluence the way we see color in interior design, but the color in our environments comes from only two sources: spectral colored light and pigment or dyestuffs. These combine with the physics of light and anatomy to allow us to perceive color, the most emotional element in interior design. 1. Spectral light is colored light inherent in nature. In a rainbow or white light shining through a prism we see the colored light bands known as the visible energy spectrum. These colored wave bands of energy, or spectral colors, appear in order from longest to shortest—red, orange, yellow, green, blue, and violet. Adjoining these on each side are invisible energy wave bands beginning with infrared (too long to see) and ending with ultraviolet (too short to see). 2. Colored pigments or dyestuffs come from two sources: natural compounds in the earth—minerals, plants, or animals—and chemically compounded colors that are artiicial compositions. We apply them to our buildings and furnishings.

Subtractive Color We see color through the subtractive color theory. When natural or artiicial light hits a colored object, all of the spectral wave bands are absorbed or “subtracted” except the hues that are pigmented, painted, or dyed. These will relect and travel back through space. When we look at that object, the relected spectral and pigmentinluenced colored wave bands of energy enter the eye, where they are received through the cells on the retina wall at the back of the eye. Known as cones and rods (for

(A)

(B)

Natural light

their shapes), these cells absorb hue and light and then send impulses to the visual center of the brain, where the colors are deciphered and identiied. Colors placed very near one another are visually mixed by a process known as subtractive color mixing, or optical color mixing, which allows us to see or interpret colors other than spectral colors. Some of the impulses also travel to the master endocrine regulating glands, the pineal and the pituitary, where they become directed impulses that cause us to react to a color emotionally or psychologically. For example, when we see red, the heart rate and respiration rate rise and we feel excited or energized.

Visual Acuity and Deficiency Most people see color in the same way, although some people can decipher or distinguish more of the over 10 million colors that the human eye can potentially see. These people have greater visual acuity. In contrast, a small percentage of people have various deiciencies in their cones and rods and decipher colors less accurately. What used to be called color blindness is now termed color deiciency, or the inability to distinguish value (light and dark) or pairs of complements one from another, the most common being red and green.

Metamerism Metamerism or the metameric effect is the apparent change in color from one light to another. Judgment of the true color of an object is made under full-spectrum light—all the wavelengths of the visible energy band as seen on a clear, cloudless day. However, because most artiicial light sources lean toward warm or cool, the

(C)

Cool fluorescent light

(D)

Warm fluorescent light

Incandescent light

(E)

Halogen light

Figure 4.1 Metamerism or the metameric effect is the apparent change of colors under different lighting due to the warmth or coolness of the spectral energy distribution of the light. This means that colors are likely to look different under the lighting at home or wherever the furnishings are installed than they do in the store where samples are displayed. Matching or coordinating of colors can become problematic unless selections are made in situ during day and night hours. (A) Natural light, (B) cool fluorescent light, (C) warm fluorescent light, (D) incandescent light, (E) halogen light. Photos © Kathryn Taylor

Color

83

Figure 4.2 Primary, triadic colors—red, yellow, and blue—are a lively combination in this middle school multipurpose room. Natural lighting through windows is supplemented with overhead lighting on the white and light yellow ceiling and beams. Lighting and light yellow balance the deep red and blues, giving an upbeat contrast to this space for adolescents. Design by Stephen Blatt Architect/ photo © Brian Vanden Brink

spectral energy distribution varies, so it is wise to try out color in the setting where it will be used. From the showroom loor to the home or contract setting, colors can appear decidedly different: • When the light is warm (contains more yellow and less blue spectral colors), more warm hues are relected and the object appears more yellow-based. • When the light is cool (contains more blue spectrum and less yellow spectrum), colors appear more bluish.

Spectral Energy Distribution Factors • Orientation, or the direction of natural light, means a slant to the spectrum that affects the way colors appear: • East light is clear and bright. • North light is clear and cool.

• • • • • •

• South light is constant and warm. • West light is hazy and hot. Season and climate affect color. Winter has fewer warm wavelengths, and summer has more; hazy or cloudy conditions screen out warm wavelengths. Artiicial lighting is in some forms nearly full spectrum; these bulbs or lamps are relatively costly. Incandescent lighting contains more warm wavelengths than cool. Economy fluorescent lighting contains more cool spectral colors than warm. Warm fluorescent lighting is closer to full-spectral energy distribution light. Combustion lighting (candlelight and irelight) contains more warm wavelengths, although the lickering quality is generally darker, making colors appear darker.

Chapter 4

84

Color Theory Artists, scientists, and observers of nature have theorized about color, studying how it is made; what it is made of; how nature uses color; how people use color; how colors affect one another; and how colors affect people both emotionally and physiologically. They observed what lightness, darkness, and intensity do to color; how colors may be combined, blended, broken up, or otherwise manipulated to achieve speciic results; and what colors make pleasing harmonies or schemes. Of the many who theorized about color, a few have made signiicant observations that still guide our understanding and use of color in interiors. M. E. Chevreul (1786–1889), a French chemist and head of dyestuffs at the Gobelin Tapestry Works near Paris, published a book in 1825 that has been translated into English and is still in use today: The Principles of Harmony and Contrast of Colors. This book is considered one of the best ever written on color; in it are found the roots of all our present theories. Yel low

v io

le t

Vi o let

B lu

e-v

et iol

Direct complementary color scheme

ue

Red-or an ge

Yell ow

n ge

-gr

ee

n

e Bl

d-

or a

O ra

Red-or an ge

ue

ue

Red-or an ge

Re

w-

ng

ng

O ra

ue

l lo Ye

n

B lu e-green

Bl

O ra ue Bl

ee

e

e ng

O ra

-gr

e en

Red-or an ge

Yell ow

n ge

Gr

Analogous color scheme showing five colors

or a

d

et iol

t ole - vi

Re

e-v

Vi o let

e B lu

Yel low

d

Vi o let

B lu

le t

Yel low

Re

le t

v io

Analogous color scheme showing four colors

B lu e-green

B lu e-green

v io

d-

Monochromatic color scheme

e en

e en

d d-

Re

t ole - vi

Gr

Gr

Re Re

w-

n

ng

ng O ra

Red-or an ge

l lo Ye

n

ee

B lu e-green

ee

Vi o let

e B lu

-gr

e en

le t

Yell ow

n ge

d

v io

or a

Re

d-

w-

Gr

B lu e-green

-gr

l lo Ye

n

e en

Yell ow

n ge

ee

Gr

or a

-gr

d Re

Yel low

w-

Yell ow

n ge

Bl

or a

e

w-

e

l lo Ye

Yel low

(B)

Re

The Standard Color-Wheel theory, or system, is also known as the Palette theory, the Prang theory, and the David Brewster Color theory. This theory is based on a conventional color circle or wheel where three primary hues—red, yellow, and blue— are placed equidistant. Secondary hues are placed between these primaries and are a result of mixing any two of them: red plus yellow yields orange; yellow plus blue yields green; blue

l lo Ye

Figure 4.3 (A) The standard color wheel. (B) Color wheel theory showing (or illustrating) color schemes.

Bl

The Standard ColorWheel Theory

(A)

Re

d-

v io

le t

Vi o let

B lu

e-v

Split complementary color scheme

et iol

Color

85

plus red yields violet. Hence, the secondary colors are orange, green, and violet and are placed in their proper places between the primaries. By mixing a primary and a secondary color on the color wheel, an intermediate, or tertiary, hue emerges—for example, yellow plus orange yields yellow-orange. These colors are yellow-orange, yellow-green, bluegreen, blue-violet, red-violet, and red-orange. (Note that the primary color is written irst.) These twelve primary, secondary, and intermediate colors, placed in a circle, constitute the conventional color wheel. However, variously mixing the colors on the wheel—along with black and white—yields an unlimited number of colors (hence the name Palette theory). This method can be used to mix paint in literally any hue, value, and intensity, to match or blend with any wall covering or fabric, or to achieve any artistic result. We have only to observe the number of choices of paint-chip colors on the market to see that this is so. When a color wheel is divided between redviolet and violet and across to green and yellowgreen, the colors related to red and yellow are Figure 4.4 This monochromatic blue scheme gives a clean and precise considered warm colors—red-violet, red, red- look to this sleek modern kitchen. This interior achieves handsome value orange, orange, yellow-orange, yellow, and yellow- distribution. A variety of values from light to dark blues are accented with creamy white and off-black accents. Design by Lori Carroll, Co-Designers: green. The colors related to blue are considered Mary Roles & Bill Smith, CKD; Lori Carroll & Associates/Photography: William Lesch cool colors—green, blue-green, blue, blue-violet, Photography/NKBA Design Competition and violet. The warmth or coolness of a color is also relative to the amount of white or black added. For example, very light yellow may be rendered cool because it recedes from the viewer and gives feelings of light and space. The visual temperature also depends on the strength or intensity of the color and the placement of colors next to each other. The psychology of these warm and cool hues will be considered later in this chapter. Chevreul discovered through his studies that color combinations could be divided into “analogous and contrasting harmonies.” Monochromatic color schemes are based on one color. In interiors, successful monochromatic schemes often utilize light, medium, and dark values, varieties of the color in intensity and dullness, and the addition of other hues such as a complement to neutralize or to vary the hue slightly. Ample amounts of white or off-white, or small amounts of black or the complement hue, can be added to a monochromatic interior to balance the color distribution or relieve a potentially overwhelming use of color. Analogous harmonies or schemes are colors adjacent to each other on the color wheel. Generally, three to six Figure 4.5 Analogous colors are adjacent on the color wheel. The warm colors in this intimate restaurant setting are yellowgreen on the walls and adjacent colors, yellow and orange are seen in lighting fixtures. A glimpse of a red-orange framed graphic art piece is seen on the right. Photo courtesy of Sea Gull Lighting Products, LLC

86

Chapter 4

colors are used in analogous harmonies, with one color predominating, another secondary in importance, and a third (up to the sixth) used as accents. Here, a key to success often lies in the variety of the lightness, darkness, intensity or clarity, dullness, and exactness of the hue and in the uneven use of the different colors. For example, in a scheme of orange, yellow-orange, yellow, and yellowgreen, perhaps a softened or neutralized yellow would dominate, with yellow-orange used in smaller proportions and more neutralized tones and the orange and yellow-green as accent colors. Complementary colors are those opposite each other on the color wheel: • Direct complement colors are pairs exactly opposite— red and green; yellow and violet; blue and orange. Or

• •

• • •

they may be intermediate colors such as blue-green and red-orange, for example, that when lightened and/or dulled are a lovely combination. Split complements contain a base hue and the two colors on each side of its direct complement—yellow, redviolet, and blue-violet, for example. Triadic complements are three colors that are equidistant on the color wheel. Examples include the primary colors (red, yellow, and blue) or the secondary colors (green, orange, and violet) or a set of intermediate hues (yellow-green, blue-violet, and red-orange). Double complements are two pairs of direct complements that are adjacent or next to each other, such as yellow and violet and yellow-orange and blue-violet. Tetrad complements are four colors that are equidistant on the color wheel, such as yellow-orange, green, blue-violet, and red. Alternate complements are triad schemes with a direct complement of one of the hues.

Chevreul noted that colors that are far apart on the wheel enhance the intensity of one another. In other words, the greater the difference, the more apparent or obvious the difference. He deemed complementary combinations more beautiful than analogous ones. Both analogous and complementary harmonies are generally more aesthetically pleasing when the colors are used in unequal proportions with one color clearly dominating.

The Munsell Theory The Munsell theory is a major color theory in general use for interior design today. Albert H. Munsell (1858– 1918), an American colorist, published his studies in several books. One study published in 1905 and still in use today is his Color Notation. His basic theory is widely used today in industry, manufacturing, interior design, and other ields such as science and medicine. Munsell “packets” are available today from Munsell Color for color study and implementation of exact color needs. The Munsell theory is a precise, formula-based system for notating speciic colors. Munsell formulated a color wheel and then expanded it to a three-dimensional globe with leaves or pages of color variations. The system is based on three attributes that determine the exact color identity:

Figure 4.6 This direct-complement scheme is inspired by sun and sea. The starfish and nautical stripe room is inspired by the wall art. Pale periwinkle blue and slightly neutralized orange, with white backgrounds and furniture and carpet the color of sand combine to make a clean, fresh, and smart color scheme. Photo © Brian Vanden Brink

1. Hue—the color name; for example the hue red. The Munsell system is based on ive hues: red, yellow, green, blue, and purple (not violet). The colors between these are red-yellow, yellow-green, blue-green, bluepurple, and red-purple. Hue families are given a letter and a numerical notation, 2.5, 5, 7.5, and 10, where 5 is the pure hue. Pure red (R), for example, without any of its neighbors to the left (purple hues) or to the right (yellow hues) is assigned a 5, or 5R. If the red page or

Color

Figure 4.7 The Munsell color wheel showing hue symbols and their relation to one another. There are five primary hues and five intermediate hues. Courtesy of Gretag/Macbeth, New

Figure 4.8 A center cutaway revealing the core of neutrals at the 5/ value level shows how hues extend from neutral to the greatest chroma, or brightness. Courtesy of

Windsor, NY

Gretag/Macbeth, New Windsor, NY

Table 4.1

Normal Values

Yellow

Light value

8

Green

Medium-light value

6

Blue

Medium value

5

Red

Medium-dark value

4

Purple

Dark value

3

palette has some yellow in it, the hue page is assigned 7.5R. This is essentially red-orange. If the red hue is slightly red-purple, the page is 2.5R. Yellow without any yellow-red or green added is 5Y; 5B is blue without any green or purple inluence; and so on. 2. Value—the lightness or darkness of the hue. Value is geared to a central column of value. White, at the top, is designated as 10; black, at the bottom, is designated as 0; in between is a step series of grays going from dark gray, or 1 (next to black at the bottom), to light gray, or 9 (next to white at the top). Every color has what is termed a normal value (see Table 4.1). This means that every hue has a certain value level as it occurs naturally or in its most natural-appearing state. Yellow is naturally very light and has the lightest natural saturation point. Violet is the darkest. 3. Chroma or intensity—the amount of pure chroma in a given hue; the relative brightness versus the dullness. At the normal value level more intense colors or bright hues exist. For example, more light yellows exist than dark yellows, because yellow is light at normal value.

87

Figure 4.9 The Munsell color notation system in three-dimensional form. Courtesy of Gretag/Macbeth, New Windsor, NY

More darker purples exist than light purples because purple is dark at normal value. Chroma is also designated with a number that follows the value number and a slash. The numbers range from 1 to 16; the lower numbers are neutralized or dulled. A color is dulled or lessened in intensity by adding its color-wheel complement. The higher numbers indicate less of that complementary color, so the color becomes clearer and purer, and sometimes brighter, as the numbers increase. A sample of the Munsell notation for a pure, light, clear yellow would be 5Y 8/12; a clear, naturally occurring red would be 5R 4/14. A dull, medium-value purple would be 5P 5/2. A less pure red, one with some purple added and found in a light value and dull intensity, would be 2.5R 7/4. The advantage to this system is that it states clearly the attributes of a color. The precision of the system is also a boon to color use where exactness is paramount.

Other Color Theories Other outstanding colorists who have strongly inluenced interior design include Wilhelm Ostwald, Johannes Itten, and Josef Albers. The Ostwald theory is plotted as triangular pages with hues varied not by chroma but by the amount of black and white. The formula bases pure hue or color (C) at one angle, white (W) at the second angle, and black (B) at the third. Harmonious colors are those that have the same content or amount of hue, white, and black— (C + W + B = 1). Harmonies can be established in parallels, where colors with the same whiteness work nicely

88

Chapter 4

with colors of the same content of black. Harmonies of verticals and of step values (called shadow series) are also harmonious. Complex ring-star and elliptic-path harmonies were also plotted by Ostwald. Wilhelm Ostwald (1853–1932) was a physicist who won the Nobel Prize in 1909 for chemistry. He turned his research to color and produced the book Die Farbenibel, translated into English as The Color Primer. Johannes Itten (1888–1967), a teacher at the Bauhaus in Germany, did comprehensive work in color theory. He later taught at Yale University and published two important works: The Art of Color and The Elements of Color. Josef Albers (1888–1976), who also taught at the Bauhaus and at Yale University, has become famous for his studies in simultaneous and successive contrast. He experimented with the optics of color. As author of the text Interaction of Color, he is considered one of the most inluential teachers of this century.

are neutralized or grayed will harmonize as a group, browned colors will harmonize with each other, and pure colors or their tints and/or shades will harmonize.

Color Samples Small samples make selecting colors dificult. A tiny paint chip rarely has the color effect of an entire painted wall. It may appear darker, lighter, or more intense, and the undertones will become more obvious. Working with large samples in situ (where the installation will take place) is not always possible. However, a small sample of paint applied to the wall or to a large piece of board or sheetrock can help in evaluation of the true color and effects. A large carpet sample can often be obtained from the warehouse, and a yard or two of fabric or a roll of wall covering can conirm the rightness of the choice and save anguish as well as money.

Shibusa

Color Harmony Color harmony exists wherever colors are combined in a manner pleasing to the eye and to the senses. Color harmonizing comes naturally to some and only after struggle and effort for others. It has been said that there is no such thing as an ugly color, only colors that are used incorrectly. Colors change identity and character literally as they are blended with other hues and visually when placed next to other hues.

Considerations in Color Harmonizing Hue Identity Examine a color closely to determine its character. For example, blue is considered one of the most dificult colors to work with because it is so easily swayed by other hues or by white or black. A few of the common blue identities include: • • • • • •

Navy—blue with black added Teal—blue with green added Baby blue—a cool, light blue Country blue—a neutralized midtone blue American blue—a pure, deep blue Royal blue—a darker, slightly violet blue

Undertones The colors that are added to a base hue are called undertones. The blue examples listed above illustrate undertones that change the identity of blue. Cool undertones render any color cool, even if it is warm. Warm undertones can render a color more warm. Warm colors—yellow, orange, and red—become cooler when blues, greens, and violets are mixed into them, and vice versa. Colors that

The Japanese concept of Shibusa is a theory of harmonizing color so that combined hues are appealing for a long period of time. Based on the ratios and proportions seen in nature, Shibusa dictates that colors used together be pleasing optical interrelationships. They are subtly harmonious so that nothing offends the eye. Colors are close in value and intensity with just a bit of sharp accent and enough variety to avoid boredom. A Shibui (the adjective) color scheme also incorporates subtle patterns and uneven textures to ensure that the hues remain interesting while being soothing and long-lived. Light colors are seen above, medium values around, and darker colors underfoot. Shibusa is an appropriate choice for interiors where a sense of peace, patience, or detail appreciation is the program goal.

Bold or High-Contrast Colors Bold or high-contrast colors are pure, bright, or intense colors of any hue. They are often seen in retail design, where lively contrast stimulates shoppers to impulse buy through a sense of euphoria. They are also used in places that people visit briely—fast-food restaurants or gas stations, where the colors encourage people to hurry through their purchases.

Neutralized Colors Neutralized colors have been mixed to become less pure, or dulled in intensity. They fall into four categories: • Shades are achieved by mixing black with a hue, or black and then white. They are darker versions, also achieved by adding gray or brown. • Tints are hues made less pure by adding white. Very pale tints are clear and cool, as white paint or pigment contains blue. Midtone tints are clean and can be brighter.

Color

89

Figure 4.10 Shibui principles are exhibited in this pleasing room. Closely blended, neutralized colors from light above to dark below combine with interesting textures and patterns to form long-lived appeal. Small accents of bright color add interest. The room is peaceful with a sense of appreciation for fine detail. Photo © Kathryn Taylor.

• Tones are neutralized with a complement or contrasting color(s). Tones have undertones that can be identiied with careful examination. • Pastels are lightened tones, or tints of tones made by adding white. They are dull or “dirty” and livable as wall colors. They are rich but nonassertive.

The Law of Chromatic Distribution A technique for using chroma successfully is found in the law of chromatic distribution. It states: “The more neutralized colors of the scheme are found in the largest areas, and the smaller the area, the brighter or more intense the chroma becomes.” This means that backgrounds—loors, walls, ceilings, and large window treatments—should use neutralized colors: shades, tones, and pastels. The smaller the area, the brighter the colors should become, with very small areas receiving the intense, bold accents. It is large/dull to small/bright in chromatic progression.

Figure 4.11 The law of chromatic distribution is seen here in larger areas that are neutralized and bright colors reserved for the smallest applications. Photo courtesy of HGTV Dream House 2009

90

Chapter 4

Neutrals Neutrals are the families of whites and off-whites, grays, and blacks and off-blacks. Browns and beiges are also often considered neutrals, even though they are actually neutralized colored hues.

Whites and Off-Whites Whites and off-whites give interiors increased visual space. Whitened backgrounds look light, spacious, and farther away. Furnishings with hues seem cleaner and crisper surrounded by whites. This approach is effective in retail merchandising, where the product to be sold and the clothing of the customers are considered part of the color scheme. Off-whites are produced by adding other neutrals (gray, black, brown) to white or by mixing color and neutrals into white. These undertones produce off-whites that may be warm or cool, clean or dirty, more neutralized or more

colored. Thousands of different off-whites are used in today’s interiors. They are seen in paints, wall coverings, textiles, loor coverings, and accessories. It is usually wise to avoid using off-whites that are not similar in undertone. For example, a clear yellowish off-white and a dirty neutralized pinkish off-white will be disturbing; one will appear as the wrong color. Off-whites with similar warmth, clarity, and color undertones will blend harmoniously.

Grays

Grays are achieved by mixing various amounts of black and white, which makes true achromatic (no-color) grays. Gray is often an ideal background color against which to show other colors. Grays are easily colored with other hues to produce a wide variety of pinkish grays, yellowish grays, greenish grays, brownish grays, and so on. Colored grays need to be carefully matched or blended to be harmonious, and, like off-white, gray may be rendered cool or warm, depending on the undertones. Warm grays can be welcoming and comforting; cool grays tend to be cold and uninviting. Figure 4.12 This room is filled with natural light and light neutral colors, giving a sense of peace and calm. Neutral colors allow the emphasis to be placed on form and shape and spatial composition. Photo courtesy of Andersen Windows.

Black and Off-Blacks Blacks and off-blacks give deep, dark value to the set-off neutrals. Black sharpens and adds richness to other colors placed next to it. Black used generously may create a dramatic and theatrical setting, although it might produce feelings of depression in some people. Accents of black give richness to interiors. Off-blacks may be very dark grays or tinted blacks where the hue is barely discernible and can effectively tie into color schemes.

Browns Browns and beiges are often favored because of the warm qualities that they bring to an interior. Browns are achieved by mixing several colors on the color wheel or by neutralizing orange. Often browns are introduced into an interior through stained woods, which do not need to match as long as they harmonize. Used in large amounts, browns can produce either a cavelike coziness or a feeling of oppression. Browns are often at their peak when good value distribution is employed, utilizing many steps of lightness from beige to very dark brown. Designing rooms in neutrals is not a new idea, nor will it readily be a dated one. Many beautiful interiors are created using achromatic whites, grays, and blacks, along with the brown/beige group. These environments make ine backgrounds for colorful artwork and accessories. One major advantage of selecting neutrals for interiors is the lexibility

Color

91

(A)

(B)

to change color schemes without being locked into a set color. Interiors employing neutrals in every room also allow furnishings to be moved from one room to another.

Other Color-Influencing Factors In addition to light, discussed at the beginning of this chapter, other factors that inluence our perception of color include texture and material, color placement, and value distribution contrast.

Texture and Material

(C) Figure 4.13 Case Study: Colors Juxtaposed (A) Before: The design problem to be solved here was the need to enliven the artistic colors of this framed art. The walls and furniture were bland and neutral, and the painting seemed to lack importance. (B) This e-design rendering indicates the selection of a warm red taken from the artwork and used as a facing accent wall. A dramatic charcoal black paint has been selected as a background for the art. This red and black scheme is taken from the existing Bokhara Oriental rug. The design plan also called for a stronger Asian influence. (C) After: The framed black wall section behind the painting enhances the rich colors within the painting. The blacks and reds of the wall grouping connect to the black, red, and beige pillows atop a new tan sofa. The juxtaposition of the colors has become dynamic and handsome. Design by Annette Parker, renderings by DreamDraper ® software

Texture and materials catch and absorb or relect light. Smooth surfaces relect light, which makes colors appear lighter and more intense. Grained wood and textures absorb or refract (break up) the light, causing colors to appear darker. Thus, an exact match in colored samples will not appear as precise when installed. The attempt to match paint, drapery, carpet, upholstery, and laminates may cause frustration and dissonance in the inished interior. It is wiser to blend color by selecting various values or harmonious undertones and allow inherent differences to enhance the entire color scheme. Wood furniture sets, groups, or suites have been produced in single-colored stains for many years. This has sometimes led people to believe that all wood furniture and backgrounds should match. Today successful interiors often feature different woods in varying stains and values.

Color Placement Color placement of hues in juxtaposition, or close together, will cause colors to affect one another. A color placed near green, for example, may take on a greenish cast or bring out a

92

Chapter 4

High key

Middle value

Low key

Figure 4.14 Value scale indicating high key (light values), middle values, and low key (low values).

greenish undertone. A color selected alone and then installed in combination with other hues may take on undertones that give a different character to that color. The result may be pleasing or disharmonious. Coordinating samples under similar lighting conditions or on the site before installation may avoid unpleasant surprises when the colors become permanent in the interior.

Figure 4.15 All white and light colors create a high-key interior, producing the effect of a large, clean, and peaceful environment. Design by Hutker Architects/photo © Brian Vanden Brink

Value Distribution and Contrast As deined under the Munsell theory, value is the relative lightness or darkness of a hue or neutral, or the amount of white and black added. Value distribution is the utilization or placement of value for a desired result. High values are light hues (tints and pastels) or light achromatics (about 7 to 10 on the Munsell chart). High values visually expand space; they are a useful tool when walls, loors, or ceilings need to seem farther away. High values make juxtaposed colors seem crisper and cleaner and can unify interiors when used as backgrounds. High-key interiors have predominantly high values. The effect of many tints is an airy, somewhat carefree feeling. Pastels produce a soothing and calming interior.

High-key interiors may seem romantic or ethereal and less connected to the earth, an effect that can relieve stress but also may cause feelings of insecurity. Midtones are colors at their normal value or natural saturation point and with achromatic values from about 4 to 6 according to Munsell. They are also midvalue neutralized tones. Midtones give a sense of normality and calm. They evoke less reaction and are safe, stable, and easy to live with; yet without relief of light and dark values, midtones can become boring. The addition of accents of high/low values and bits of bright chroma and shine creates a Shibui effect—a pleasantly long-lived scheme. Dark or low values are shades and darker tones from about 1 to 3 according to Munsell. Dark or low values seem to advance and close in space; they are useful

Color

93

• Lighter values are above—in the window and near/ on the ceiling—for a sense of expanse and visual or mental freedom.

Color Psychology The psychology of color is a valuable tool that the interior designer can use to fulill the needs of the users. In homes as well as public buildings, a knowledge of how people typically view and understand colors can help the designer create effective and eficient interiors. Color psychology is both physiological and cultural. Some common associations or color symbolisms in Western societies are listed in Table 4.2. Color-group moods can also be determined through research. Philip Thiel, in his book Visual Awareness and Design, reports his inding that groups of colors produce speciic emotional responses:

Figure 4.16 Dark walls, furnishings, and bathtub yield a low-key interior, where feelings of coziness, safety, and privacy are experienced. Photo courtesy of Andersen Windows.

when walls, loors, or ceilings need to seem closer for warmth or visual effect. Low-key interiors focus on dark or low values. They can produce a stable, anchored, ponderous, or historic effect; an intellectual or research/reading mode; or even a cavelike coziness or comfort or theatrical setting. High contrast means that light and dark values are used to give a sharp or bold contrast, precision, drama, or excitement and a clean contemporary scheme. Highcontrast values also look professional and no-nonsense. Value distribution based on nature is the placing of values in the general pattern seen in nature: • Darker colors are underfoot, creating a sense of security and harmony with gravity. • Midtones are in the middle—on walls and around windows, on upholstery, and on linens—giving stability and normality.

Figure 4.17 Warm yellow and yellow-undertoned green are seen in this contemporary kitchen, making it a pleasant and optimistic place for work, dining, and conversation. Design by Scott Simons Architects/photo © Brian Vanden Brink

• Light-value and bright color groups produce feelings of spontaneity and happiness. • Light and dull or neutralized colors produce feelings of calm and relaxation. • Dark and dull or neutralized colors are serious and profound. • Dark values and bright chroma (jewel tones) suggest richness and strength. The psychology of color can be seen in the effects produced by warm and cool colors. Warm colors visually and psychologically warm the temperature of an interior. They are inviting, homey, optimistic, encouraging, and stimulating to the appetite, and they facilitate the

94

Chapter 4

Table 4.2

Common Color Associations

Red Pure, intense: Danger, passion, love, excitement, stimulus, conspicuousness. Dark, neutralized: Wealth, power, sometimes evil. Pure chroma pink: Cheerfulness, youth, festivity. Light or pastel pink: Femininity, innocence, relaxation, delicacy.

Green Pure, bright: Nature, calmness, friendliness, integrity, practicality, frankness. Dark, neutralized: Solidity, wealth, anchored tenacity, security. Blue-green: Sea and sky, cleanliness, nostalgia, calmness. Yellow-green: Youthfulness, freshness, happiness.

Blue Orange Pure, intense: Friendliness, warmth, celebration, clarity. Dark, neutralized: Wealth, success, fame, rich depth. Light or pastel: Stimulation (to the appetites), security, relaxed euphoria (sense of well-being).

Pure, intense: Loyalty, honesty, integrity, royalty, stimulation, restlessness. These also apply to deep or neutralized blues. Deep, neutralized: Sincerity, conservatism, safety, peacefulness, kindness, compassion. These also apply to pure or intense blues. Light or pastel: Tentativeness, cleanliness, calm, expanded time and space, lack of security.

Yellow Pure, bright: Cheerful optimism, sunshine, springtime, renewal, intensity, demanding, revealing, warmth (too much is hot), intellect, stimulation. Dark, neutralized golden yellow: Wealth, afluence, status, distinction, high esteem. Too much is brash, garish, or ostentatious. Middle to light value: Intelligence, wisdom, compassion, freshness, cheerfulness, optimism, goodness, clarity, cleanliness.

blending of objects, patterns, and textures. Warm colors also tend to reduce space and create more intimate interiors. Keep in mind that these are generalities. Depending on the value and the intensity of the chroma, colors can be very warm (high chroma, which intensiies these attributes), warm, or only slightly warm (middle to low chroma, which deemphasizes the qualities listed). Cool colors generally calm and relax the mind and body, giving the impression of lack of pressure and plenty of time to wait or to accomplish tasks. Cool colors often suggest more formality and precision of detail, pattern, and color. They visually expand space, and thus are effective tools in small, cramped quarters. Cool colors subdue the appetite and emotions. Very cool colors are intense, cool colors are middle chroma, and slightly cool colors are low in chroma (neutralized).

Afterimage Simultaneous Contrast When the eye focuses on an intense color for as few as thirty seconds and then focuses on a neutral area, the complementary color appears in the same pattern as a ghostly afterimage. Simultaneous contrast is most evident in pairs of intense, high-chroma complementary colors of equal value placed in juxtaposition: A vibrating or moire afterimage appears where they border. This can cause eye-focusing problems, irritation, and headaches.

Purple or Violet Pure, intense: Optimism, imagination, royalty, dignity, poise, renewal, commitment, drama. Dark, neutralized: Depth, richness, security, sternness, soberness, sobriety, dullness. Light or pastel: Freshness, springtime, lowers, imaginativeness, femininity, kindness, sensitivity.

Afterimages and vibrating simultaneous contrast can create a disturbing visual and, hence, emotional state of being. Afterimages can be reduced by varying the intensity of colors placed together, by separating them in distance, or by carefully handling strong graphics and patterns. A stark white background is more likely to create an afterimage than a neutralized color or a gray. A strong chroma of a hue will bring the complement into the visual area, which will be seen in the neutrals. Varying the value of colors will also reduce visual discomfort.

The Color Trend Market Today color trends or palettes are established by color forecasting organizations, who provide annual color palettes or color forecasts. There are a number of explanations for the yearly change: 1. The public responds to new colors introduced by the mass media. When interior fashion changes and a new look is introduced, people are generally quite receptive in order to stay in style or to stay on the forefront of fashion change. 2. Our fast-paced society leads us not only to accept change but also expect and even be impatient for it. 3. High technology—instant access to pools of computer or media-based information—has made us a changeoriented society.

Color

95

Figure 4.18 Blue and white are classic colors together—fresh, clean, precise, and cool. Photo courtesy of HGTV.

4. Economic growth paves the way for expansion of the interior design profession. Consequently, further research into organizational and individual behavior based on color response is also possible. Color organizations (see Table 4.3) research color direction and forecast color trends with remarkable accuracy. Their forecasts aid manufacturers who are anxious to keep products selling well in the marketplace, where appealing and popular color is of primary importance in item selection. Color trends are established by professional groups. Three of the best known and most inluential are the Color Marketing Group (CMG), the Color Association of the United States (CAUS), and the International Colour Authority (ICA). As these groups trace the advance and recession of color popularity, they select new hues while also

freshening hues currently on the market. In addition, they look at and decide which hues the public is most likely to accept. These decisions are based on the following: • An awareness of color trend evolutions and past and present trends • An awareness of the constant demand by consumers for change in color preference • The input from national and international companies that produce the colors and from association members who market these colors • An understanding of human response or psychological reaction to speciic hues, and an intuition for color based on this understanding • National or international events that affect color trends, as they have in the past

96

Chapter 4

Table 4.3

Color Organizations

• Color Marketing Group (CMG), 4001 North Ninth Street, Suite 102, Arlington, VA 22203, is a nonproit organization whose membership is involved in the process of color selection or speciication. The association selects colors for marketing services and products. Members pay an association fee and attend meetings— regional and semiannual national meetings. At the spring meeting, colors are chosen, and at the fall meeting, they are presented to the members. Members are sent resourceful newsletters and have access to workshops and educational seminars. • Color Association of the United States (CAUS), 24 East 48th Street, New York, NY 10016, issues color charts for home and contract furnishings each September and apparel swatches each March and September, intended to be eighteen to twenty months ahead of the actual selling season. Members receive the charts and monthly color newsletters and may attend New York–based seminars. Colors each year are selected by a rotating panel of eight to ten members recognized for their color expertise and professionalism.

• International Colour Authority (ICA), c/o Benjamin Dent & Company, 33 Bedford Place, London WC1B 5JX, England, meets in the spring and fall in London, where forecasts emerge from international members’ panels on both home furnishings and apparel. Members receive a continuous printout of ICA data that indicates colors to be promoted worldwide. Monthly reports from subscribers are tabulated and divided into speciic areas. The information is then sent back to the subscribers and is followed up with a written report that evaluates and documents trend development and forecasted color use. • Munsell Color, 2441 N. Calvert Street, Baltimore, MD 21218, is a resource for designers and educators. Munsell Color can provide many tools and educational materials for use in deining, identifying, and recording or matching colors through the Munsell color notation system.

• Creative designers and artists, whose well-known works inluence decisions, or high-proile people whose style is watched and imitated • The inluence of high technology and computer-screen colors

can express themselves more with art and accessories. As neutrals and neutralized color schemes convey a sense of rest and repose, a home in which they are used can become a calming, peaceful sanctuary. Similarly, bright color and deep chroma can be powerfully effective for immersing the occupants in a planned psychological response. Color is a good way to change a home’s look, mood, or formality without spending a lot of money. Although reupholstering furniture, replacing carpeting, and selecting custom window coverings often are costly, many other colored items are usually not. Paint, for example, is relatively inexpensive considering the square footage it covers. Bed, bath, and kitchen linens can change the look entirely when backgrounds are neutral, and art and

Color consultants provide speciic consulting services for groups or manufacturers. On the basis of interior design training and trend knowledge, color consultants can: • Select colors for a wide variety of products • Provide schemes for entire interiors • Specify colors for architectural projects

Residential and Contract Uses of Color Color in Residential Interiors In the home we are free to select colors that are the most personally appealing. When color schemes are neutralized, children and extended-family members Figure 4.19 Warm yellow/orange undertones and interesting textures in the wood cabinetry and floor are given enhanced interest with the fresh yellow-green color of the backsplash glass tile between the upper and lower cabinets and a similar green as island pendants or kitchen chandeliers. Design by Dewitt Talmadge Beall, Co-Designer: Hye Won Lee; Dewitt Designer Kitchens/Photography: David Jiro/ NKBA Design Competition

Color

accessories may be changed with the seasons or moods. Smaller colored areas that are bright and cheerful might be preferred by younger children. Tailored for their needs, the same areas may provide a source of identity and individuality for teens and young adults, may be soothing and relaxing for working adults, and may be comforting and reminiscent for senior citizens. Color in homes can be tailor-made to individual needs beyond age. People who are housebound or prone to depression can be cheered with warm, encouraging colors. People with poor eyesight may beneit from light, clear color and value. Those who need reassuring environments in which to work at home can select colors that are calming or stable. Various task or hobby areas within the home can also be outitted for individuality. Living areas where people congregate or are entertained should be neutralized enough to be generally appealing to everyone. Colors not only have to “live” well; they also must physically wear well. One cliché states that the best carpeting choice is the “nicest dirty color you can ind.” Dull or neutralized colors can conceal dirt, require less cleaning, and conceal wear better. This increases the life of the product, whether it be carpet, hard looring, wall or window treatments, furniture, or other fabric items. Patterned and textured products also wear well, provided there is long-term appeal. Ask yourself, “Will I still want this pattern-texture-color combination in 10 years?” If you sincerely think you will, it is probably a good color choice.

Contract Considerations Color in public and in work spaces is a complex topic. For example, color in medical facilities will often be handled differently than in hospitality interiors, ofice interiors, retail businesses, or production or assembly-line facilities. The differences lie in the specialized needs of the users of these various environments. Designers must be knowledgeable about and sensitive to these needs, which govern emotional responses, since they can affect behavior, attitude, productivity, or patronization.

Medical Facilities In hospitals, doctors’ ofices, outpatient facilities, and geriatric facilities, the philosophy of color has changed signiicantly in the past several years. Medical facilities used to be white or pale tints, cool-looking, and full of hard surfaces, an echo of the sterile environment. Today, we know from research that soft or neutralized colors in a variety of values, from dark to light, can promote healing. Also, colored background elements are no longer always hard. Medical facilities often incorporate carpet, warm wood textures, and ireproof fabric or wall coverings on the partitions and walls. This offers a more human, caring atmosphere to persons in sometimes frightening and bewildering circumstances.

97

Hospitality Facilities Interiors of hotels and motels, resorts and spas, and restaurants are areas where color and design are dictated by the culture and the climate. Lavish colors and patterns may dominate reception areas and rooms and suites. In restaurants, red- and orange-related hues are found to be the most stimulating to the appetite, and colors that complement the food color enhance the visual appeal and lavor of the food. Where climates are very warm, cooler colors are often used, and in colder climates, warmer colors are often more welcoming.

Office Interiors Ofice interiors have become sophisticated in terms of equipment and furniture systems and the use of computers to simplify procedures, storage, and retrieval systems (“the paperless ofice”). Color trends are relected in contemporary ofice design, with neutralized hues and complex neutrals considered most professional.

Retail Businesses The objective of design for retail businesses is to entice customers to purchase goods and services. Stimulating,

Figure 4.20 A discussion between a businesswoman and businessman may be even, fair, and honest, as it takes place over a peaceful green carpet. This is an excellent application of color psychology. © Global Business Communication/Getty Images

98

Chapter 4

warm, cheerful, and advancing colors are often utilized in large stores and shopping malls, where the bright colors help customers locate departments and services. To an extent, glitter and neon-bright colors have been incorporated into retail businesses that appeal to youth. The use of subtle, deep-value tones and neutralized pastels, accented with pure chroma, with polished wood and metal gives retail businesses an exclusive or rich appearance. This method does not necessarily limit the clientele to those with money. Rather, it is aimed toward making customers feel that they deserve quality merchandise and can afford it. White, neutrals, and neutralized hues form a background for colorful merchandise and provide lexibility.

Production Plants Requirements of psychological comfort, productivity, and safety dictate color in production plants. Light pastel

colors that relect light are generally more pleasing than stark whites, intense colors, or dark values. Cheerful colors inluence workers to be cheerful. Productivity can be increased by eliminating eye fatigue caused by afterimages, intense chroma, stark whites, very dark values, or shiny or glossy surfaces at the workstation. Matte or dull surfaces in colors that provide a pleasing contrast to the material or object being worked on will add texture contrast necessary for both comfort and productivity. Primary colors used to identify controls or parts of machinery will increase eficiency. Warm colors in cool environments and cool colors in warm environments will help workers feel more comfortable. Safety can be enhanced by using bold or intense colors on dangerous parts of machinery or in areas of potential hazard. The use of color to reduce eye fatigue will help workers be more alert and help prevent accidents.

Figure 4.21 Pure, jewel-like color contributes to the impressive mood in this restaurant setting. © Peter Aaron/Esto

Chapter 5 Lighting and Technology

Lighting in Interior Design 100 Natural Light 100 Artificial Lighting 101 Light and the Mind and Body 109 Power Terminology and Units of Measurement 112 Luminaires, or Lighting Fixtures 113 Lighting for the Future 118 Contract Considerations 119 Technology 121

Scogin Elam & Bray Architects/photo © Brian Vanden Brink

100

Chapter 5

Lighting in Interior Design Light—both natural and artiicial—is such an important element of interior design that we devote most of this chapter to examining its aesthetic, practical, and technical aspects. It is through light that we see color, and by light we discern all the elements and components of an interior. In the following sections we discuss the ways lighting is handled, what effects it has on an interior, the types of lighting and lamps (bulbs), and lighting’s effects on our minds. We also examine technical terms and information to help us make wise, informed lighting choices. In lighting an interior, we should strive toward these goals: • To make lighting effective and practical for the activities and purposes of the interior • To make the interior more aesthetically pleasing • To make the interior psychologically useful • To select lighting wisely and use it economically in terms of both product and power

Natural Light Natural light, or light from the sun, has a full spectrum of colors. Natural light makes colors appear rich and vibrant and is a healthful, cheerful light necessary for living. A balance of natural light evenly distributed from two or more directions is desirable since it helps reduce shadows in the interior and consequent visual and physical fatigue. Yet even natural light can lean toward one color, depending on factors such as the time of day, season, weather conditions, orientation, climate, and location. The color of light is different at morning, noon, and evening and, within any one of those times, will vary according to the season and weather conditions. The morning sun in the summer is brighter and warmer than the morning winter sun, and it is more brilliant and yellow on clear days than on overcast days. Orientation refers to the direction of the light. For example, southern-exposure light will be warmer and northern light will be cooler. Orientation also takes into account relected surfaces. If a northern exposure faces a large orange building, then certainly orange will be relected into the north-facing interior, rendering the light warmer than it would otherwise be. Light relecting a deep blue sea or an azure sky will bring bluish light into the interior. Natural light is not completely predictable. When there is no cloud cover or screening at the window, natural light can become too bright and intense, resulting in glare, excessive luminance in the visual ield that can cause irritation and fatigue. Natural glare is a problem

Figure 5.1 The contemporary chandelier in this dining space is well placed to be about 36 inches above the table. The suspended light balances natural light from the right, making the space practical and psychologically pleasing. Photo courtesy of Sea Gull Lighting Products, LLC

that requires interior shading or screening window treatments. (Artiicial glare will be discussed later on.) There are also times when overcast conditions or the size and orientation of the window cause natural light to be inadequate. Too little natural light for activities such as reading, writing, or other detailed tasks can cause eyestrain and fatigue. When natural light is too dim for the occupants to function well, it must be combined with an artiicial light source to become fully effective. Most people turn on lights during the day when cloud cover, fog, or smog reduces the luminance of natural light.

Combustion Lighting Firelight, candlelight, and lanterns are other natural sources of lighting called combustion lighting. Light

Lighting and Technology

Figure 5.2 Natural, full-spectrum sunlight is welcome in the Spa Café at the Cliff Lodge, Snowbird, Utah. © Ricke-Hults/Photo Researchers, Inc.

from ires and candles lickers, as do lanterns when they are moved about. This inconsistency can be charming and create coziness. The warmth from a combustion source can also be an asset. A ireplace draws people near it for warmth and comfort as much as for the light. Gas logs licker—imitative of a real ire but without the work and mess. Luminaires (lighting ixtures) may incorporate lame-shaped bulbs that licker to copy the light of real candles.

Artificial Lighting Artiicial lighting can create moods, add sparkle and emphasis, and be directed and manipulated to meet the goals of the interior. The most common forms of artiicial lighting used today are luorescent lighting, incandescent lighting, and LED lighting.

Figure 5.3 Candlelight is a warm and intriguing form of combustion lighting. Photo © David A. Taylor

101

102

Chapter 5

incandescent bulb may last 800 hours, whereas a compact luorescent may last 8,000 hours. A luorescent lamp without electrodes, using electromagnetic induction, as well as LED lamps may last up to 50,000 hours. These facts are signiicant for two reasons: First, energy costs have risen dramatically, and using less electricity will save a signiicant amount of money in both residential and contract design. Additional money is saved when lamps last longer, requiring fewer purchases. As utility rates escalate along with the cost of living, saving money on utilities may mean the ability to afford one’s house payment and other necessities of life. The second reason is the ethics of environmental awareness, as discussed in Chapter 2. The carbon footprint is deined as the total amount of carbon dioxide (CO2) and other greenhouse gases emitted over the life of a product. Since the creation of electricity may produce greenhouse gas, the more electricity used on a personal level, the more greenhouse gas may be produced. Reducing one’s carbon footprint means that if we each do our part, a greater good can be achieved. Fluorescent lamps, however, contain mercury, a hazardous waste, and so must be disposed of properly. In the shift toward more energy eficiency, research and development has yielded amazing improvements in lighting. High-deinition (HD) color technology has produced lamps (bulbs) that are closer to natural sunlight with improved quality, such as light that is easier on the eyes, more clear, hence high deinition. Improvements will continue to be made, and designers and consumers will beneit by staying abreast of new energy-eficient lighting and technology products and devices.

Fluorescent Lighting

Figure 5.4 Artificial lighting supplements natural lighting in this kitchen. A bar chandelier luminaire provides pleasant workspace light. Lighting inside cabinetry accents beautiful china dinnerware. Photo courtesy of Sea Gull Lighting Products, LLC

There has been a dramatic shift away from predominantly incandescent residential lighting to widespread luorescent and emergence of LED lighting. This has occurred as consumers have learned that luorescent lighting uses up to 80 percent less electricity to produce the same amount of light as incandescents. For example, a compact luorescent lamp (bulb) uses 14 watts of electricity to produce the same light as a 60-watt incandescent lamp. Fluorescent lamps last up to ten times longer—an

Fluorescent light is produced by an arc between two electrodes or ballasts inside a glass tube illed with very low pressure mercury vapor. The arc or discharge produces ultraviolet (invisible) radiation in wavelengths that excite or activate the white powder (phosphorus crystals) lining the lamp. The phosphorus fluoresces (glows), converting the ultraviolet energy into visible light energy. Fluorescent light is a relatively shadowless, even light, making it ideal for general lighting of environments where tasks are performed but where task lighting would be impractical or undesirable. Traditionally, luorescent lighting was commonly used in luminous ceiling panels, recessed into a dropped ceiling and covered with textured, translucent panels, under-the-cabinet lighting over counters, in bathroom lighting, and over work surfaces in hobby rooms or ofices. Even, clear light provides an environment where work can take place for hours without lighting-caused fatigue. Rapid-start fluorescent lamps have eliminated the problem of blinking when the lights are switched on.

Lighting and Technology

Table 5.1

103

Fluorescent and Incandescent Lamp Shapes and Types

Lamps (bulbs) vary according to shape and purpose. Commonly used lamps, available in a wide range of wattage in both incandescent and luorescent (compact luorescent lamps encased in these lamp shapes) are listed in this chart.

Lamp Shapes

A lamp: Arbitrary-shaped bulb; the most common lamp shape.

B lamp: Candleabra lamp—a smooth torpedo-shaped (oval or ovoid) bulb.

C lamp: Cone-shaped bulb.

R lamp: Common cone-shaped reflector—brighter and shaped to spread the beam wider.

G lamp: Globe-shaped (spherical or round) bulb.

T lamp: Tubular lamp, also a designation for tungsten halogen lamps.

PS lamp: Pear-shaped lamp—a rounded, longer shape.

F lamp: Flame-shaped bulb.

Other Reflective Lamps ER lamp: Elliptic-shaped relector lamps focus the light beam to 2 inches in front of the lamp, thereby saving energy with increased light in one spot. PAR lamp: Parabolic aluminized relector lamps have heavy, protective glass that makes them suitable for both interior and exterior (outdoor) use. Silvering is used to establish the beam spread and the relective quality of the lamp and to determine whether the beam will spread out into a floodlight or will be used for a spotlight. Silvering also creates glare-free lamps. The lamp face (the nonsilvered portion) also affects the beam spread. HID lamp: Mercury vapor and high-pressure sodium are two of the most common high-intensity discharge lamps. Commonly used outdoors. PL lamp: Compact twin luorescent bulb.

Figure 5.5 Bright fluorescent lighting gives users of this fitness center a boost of energy to assist in meeting a targeted workout goal. © David Sundberg/Esto

Fluorescent lighting is available in both warm and cool color spectrums. Cool white deluxe and warm white deluxe lamps have a balanced spectrum and are more lattering. Fluorescent lamps are available in a wide range of styles and types. When shopping for luorescent lamps, it is wise to consult with the lighting personnel for help in selecting lamps that will be most appropriate.

104

Chapter 5

Strip tube

Circular tube

U-shaped lamp

Adapts to incandescent

Twin light (compact fluorescent)

Figure 5.6 Traditional shapes of fluorescent lamps.

Compact Fluorescent Lighting A compact fluorescent lamp (CFL) is compressed into the size of a standard-issue incandescent lamp. There are two main parts in a CFL: the gas-illed tube (also called bulb or burner) and the magnetic or electronic ballast, which contains a tiny circuit board, a ilter, and transistors that convert and regulate electricity. Because this conversion process stabilizes lamp current and light over a range of input voltages, CFLs do not respond well for dimming and are a ire hazard when used with a dimmer switch. Special three-way models and dimmable models with standard bases are available for use when those features are needed. CFLs have become widely available and are adapted to most ixtures with a standard incandescent light socket via an Edison screw or bayonet itting. The most common shape used is the “minispiral” and in straight, circular, and U-shaped tubes. All shapes of lamps shown in Table 5.1 are available as CFLs, which are inside the outer glass casing. Compared to incandescent lamps, CFLs are priced higher, but give the same amount of light, consume far less electricity, and last far longer. CFLs radiate a different light spectrum from that of incandescent lamps, yet thanks to improved phosphor formulations, the light color emitted is similar to the standard “soft white” incandescent lamps. Cautions routinely listed on packaging state that CFLs should not be used in ixtures controlled with a dimmer, electronic timer, or photocell or in totally enclosed ixtures. Compact luorescents should not be used where exposed to weather. They are not for use with emergency

Figure 5.7 Compact fluorescent lamps (CFLs) fit standard sockets in every shape, including those formerly only incandescent shapes, but use much less wattage to produce an equal amount of light. Photo courtesy of GE Appliances & Lighting

ixtures or emergency lights. It is advisable to turn off the power before replacing the bulb and to install and remove the bulb from the ixture by grasping the plastic base only. These precautions help avoid breakage of lamps illed with mercury vapor, considered hazardous waste and hence dangerous. The amount of mercury is small enough that luorescent lamps can be carefully disposed of in a trash can while avoiding breakage.

Colored Fluorescent Lighting Colored luorescent light is cold-cathode lighting, commonly called neon. These use different gases or vapors to produce colors. Traditionally used to light exterior signs in business districts, today creative uses of neon lighting have brought this type of light to residential interiors. Lighting as art frequently incorporates neon lighting in homes with surprising and intriguing effects.

Incandescent Lighting Incandescent light is produced by heating a highly resistant tungsten ilament with an electric current until it glows. Incandescent light contains a continuous, warm, mellow color spectrum. Incandescent lighting produces heat and is costly. Lamps (or bulbs) wear out quickly and are discarded (or recycled into other materials, such as ceramic tiles). Long-life bulbs cost more, but they last longer.

Lighting and Technology

105

Low-Voltage Lighting Low-voltage lighting uses a type of lamp that controls the beam spread usually to about 9 degrees. The lamp typically has a built-in relector with a tungsten halogen bulb that produces superior accent lighting or spotlighting. It also incorporates transformers to reduce voltage to the source. Indoor low-voltage lighting is often used inside recessed or track ixtures. These lights are particularly useful in retail stores to highlight speciic merchandise such as jewelry, which sparkles under a low-voltage halogen beam. Low-voltage halogen is the lamp of choice where artwork is displayed.

Light-Emitting Diode (LED) Lighting A light-emitting diode (LED) is a semiconductor device or microchip that converts electricity into light by controlling the current to yield an overall white light. LEDs are small in size, but can be grouped for higher intensity applications. LED ixtures require a driver, which is analogous to the ballast in luoresFigure 5.8 This kitchen uses direct downlighting, ambient eyeball spotlights, cent ixtures. LEDs contain no mercury and undercabinet task lighting, and three minipendants for lighting the informal dinremain cool to the touch, making them safe ing bar. The lamps for these luminaires may be incandescent or fluorescent. and eco-friendly. Design by Shelya Huff-Hrenya, Hollywoodhomeware.com/© Marc Anthony Photography Each diode is about 1 ⁄4 inch in diameter and uses about 10 milliamps to operate at about 1 Incandescent lighting is used in ceiling and portable ⁄10 of a watt, for very low energy consumption—retroit ixtures such as table lamps. This lighting is lattering bulbs range from 0.83 to 7.3 watts. LEDs last considerably and best for warm mood lighting. longer than incandescent or luorescent lighting. LEDs Colored incandescent lighting can be achieved by don’t typically burn out like traditional lighting, but using colored glass on the lamps or by placing a colrather gradually decrease in light output to become inefored screen over the light. The most familiar are colored fective at about 50,000 hours. Christmas bulbs. LEDs resist thermal and vibrational shocks and perform well when subjected to frequent on–off cycling. Tungsten Halogen Lighting Fully dimmable, LEDs do not change their color tint Another type of incandescent light is the tungsten halowhen dimmed, unlike incandescent lamps that turn yelgen lamp. The ilament of the small lamp is surrounded low. LEDs can be manufactured to produce all colors with halogen gas. As the tungsten burns off, the halogen of the spectrum without ilters, and also produce white reacts with the tungsten, creating a bright light. This type light in a variety of color temperatures. Unlike luoresof light enables one to direct light to a certain area and to cents, there is no ballast to interfere with radio and televiintensify the light by placing the bulb inside a relective sion signals. (PAR) lamp. Tungsten halogen lights cost more than comLEDs are better at placing light in a single direction mon incandescent lighting but will usually last longer than incandescent or luorescent bulbs. Because of their and produce more lumens per watt. directional output, they have unique design features that Tungsten halogen bulbs are available as standard can be exploited by clever designs. LED strip lights can be lamps that look similar to the arbitrary bulbs and screw installed under counters, in hallways, and in staircases; into any incandescent socket. Tungsten halogens are also concentrated arrays can be used for room lighting. Uses used as lood, spotlight, or low-voltage lighting. In lamps also include task and reading lamps, recessed lighting, of standard wattage, halogens last three times longer, pendants, art lighting, and retroit bulbs. LED lighting burn 10 percent brighter, and are closer to the natural does not produce infrared or ultraviolet radiation, which sunlight spectrum. attracts bugs; so it is excellent for outdoor use.

106

Chapter 5

LED lights are more rugged and damage resistant than compact luorescents and incandescent bulbs. LED lights do not licker, and they turn on instantly in temperatures ranging from –40 to 185 degrees Centrigrade, making them ideal for applications subject to frequent on–off cycling, such as garages and basements. Disadvantages are heat sensitivity: Excessive heat or inappropriate applications dramatically reduce both light output and lifetime. LEDs are currently more expensive than luorescent and incandescent, and may be hard to locate. LEDs typically cast light in one direction at a narrow angle compared to incandescent or luorescent lamps; so lenses or relectors are needed in ixtures to broaden the beam where it is needed. White LED light has been criticized as ghostly light; look for improvements in the LED light quality.

Categories of Lighting Effects In order to accomplish the goals of lighting, categories are useful in directing the design. In homes, they include general, ambient, task, accent and mood lighting, and lighting as art. These are discussed here, and other categories are found under “Contract Considerations” later in the chapter.

General and Ambient Lighting General lighting is usually planned into the blueprints of the home (see “Wiring Plans” later in the chapter). General lighting provides a uniform, even, broad plane of light. It may be accomplished with direct lighting such as ceiling ixtures that shine downward. Direct general lighting often takes the form of luorescent or other utilitarian incandescent ceiling ixtures. These ixtures, particularly the luorescent type, may provide good general lighting for kitchens, ofices, workrooms, and classrooms, where tasks are performed throughout the space. However, one of the drawbacks is that such lighting is bland or monotonous and unsuitable for areas such as

(A)

(B)

living rooms and bedrooms where aesthetics are an important part of the lighting plan. Ambient lighting comes from an indirect source that throws background light against a surface such as a wall or ceiling, relecting the light back into the room. Recessed eyeball spotlights in the ceiling around the perimeter of a room “wash” the walls with light, and uplighters cast light onto the ceiling, where it is relected back into the room, creating a soft general illumination. Ambient lighting creates a pleasant quality of illumination but may not be adequate for speciic tasks. Thus ambient lighting is often combined with other types of task or accent lighting.

Task Lighting Task lighting directs the right amount of light where it is needed to perform tasks requiring hand-eye coordination. Examples of such tasks include reading, typing or word processing, writing, drawing, assembling parts, working with tools, cooking, dining, sewing, and personal grooming. Task lighting should not be high-contrast areas of light and dark. If the pool of light abruptly ends and darkness begins, unnecessary eyestrain and fatigue will result. It is wise to combine task lighting with general, ambient, or natural lighting whenever possible. In the kitchen, for example, the luminous ceiling (general lighting) may be accompanied by task lighting such as recessed downlighters, sofit, or under-cupboard lighting. Task lighting may also be seen as strip lights placed around a mirror or above a work area. Track lighting and spotlights are also used to focus light onto a task area. Task lighting can also be accomplished with portable luminaires, which can be moved from one area to another. These include loor and table lamps, plug-in wall sconces, and under-the-counter strips.

Accent and Mood Lighting Accent lighting, or artistic lighting, may focus on a piece of art or an accessory item, emphasizing the object.

(C)

Figure 5.9 General and ambient lighting. (A) General lighting: the ceiling luminaire lights an area from above eye level. (B) Ambient lighting: eyeball spotlights wash the wall from ceiling level. (C) Ambient lighting: uplighters wash this wall with light, illuminating the ceiling and the area nearby. Light-colored walls will reflect and increase footlamberts.

Lighting and Technology

107

(B)

(A)

Figure 5.10 Task lighting for specific purposes: (A) personal grooming; (B) reading, writing, or studying.

Figure 5.11 Accent or mood lighting. (A) Track spotlight accentuates artwork. (B) Low lighting from a small luminaire (table lamp) creates a mellow mood.

(A)

(B)

Figure 5.12 Accent lighting here is effectively placed on the table centerpiece, the wall art, and the Modern chaise lounge. © Peter Aaron/Esto

Accent lighting creates interest and drama through small spots of light or by casting light in small areas against a dark background. This high contrast of dark and light areas gives interest through the patterns of light and dark, such as those created by art spotlights or a play of brilliants—a myriad of pinpoints of light, the tiny lights on a tree, for example. Mood lighting creates a sense of inviting coziness, such as the contrast of soft, low, or glittering light against a dark background. Examples include dimmed recessed lights and table and loor lamps. Lighting from a ireplace is

108

Chapter 5

Figure 5.13 The connecting concourse of the United Airlines terminal at O’Hare Airport in Chicago, with its dazzling light show, is an engaging art lighting experience. © Timothy Hursley

also mood lighting. It emotionally draws people near for visual interest and for comfort and warmth. The heart of the home has long been its hearth, where meals were prepared and served for centuries. Today a seating area around a lickering ireplace is still inviting. It can become even more effective and beautiful with the addition of spotlights or directed low-voltage lighting. General and ambient, task, and accent lighting are frequently combined, since each type of lighting fulills different purposes. They may overlap to it the time of day or night or activities taking place. For example, on an overcast day general lighting can be a backup for natural lighting. General lighting is mandatory where no windows exist and for nighttime occupation. Task lighting supplements general lighting for speciic work projects during the day or night. Accent lighting is used primarily at night and in windowless interiors during the day. When lighting is used concurrently, there needs to be usage control for the sake of conserving lamp life and energy.

Lighting as Art In lighting as art, the light ixture and method of lighting become art itself. Besides traditional decorative luminaire lamps, here are ways that lighting can become artistic: • The ixture or luminaire itself may be the emphasized point of vision, as in a neon sign or artistic lighting ixture. Innovative artists combine light with other materials and textures for intriguing artistic effects. • Colored light and patterns of light and dark from one or many sources can turn lighting into art. • Lighted, etched acrylic sheets allow light to shine through the etched areas, giving unlimited design possibilities to art, loors, walls, and other areas. • Light pipes made of acrylic can conduct a variety of lights in artistic ways: by sunlight and by a selection of lamps that produce intense light up to 1,000 watts. Subtle and/or changing color can be inserted into the pipe. When the pipe is formed into shapes such as prisms, the effect can be multiplied, giving the interior designer phenomenal freedom in creating color impressions. • Laser lights, commonly used in light shows, can be made stationary or changeable and can project images of art, furniture, and people or even the illusion of more interior space.

• Holograms produce amazing three-dimensional images in midair.

Lighting Effects in the Interior Lighting effects can change the apparent shape, color, and texture of the interior. These effects include the following: • An ambient bank or plane of light is a large, welllit area. It may encompass the entire interior, or it can designate smaller areas within a large space. • An even wash is a soft plane of light from spotlights or track lights aimed at a wall or ceiling. • A light shining at a steep angle or very close to the object or to a surface grazes it with luminescence—an effective way of emphasizing texture. • A pool of light is a circle of light thrown by a downlighter or spotlight. Spotlighting from more than one direction can balance light and emphasize detail by eliminating shadows. • Perimeter lighting, around the outside of a room or an area, visually expands the space. • Point or pinpoint lighting spotlights a tiny area. Pinpoint lighting can emphasize or create shiny, glittery accents if it strikes a relective surface. • Line or outline lighting emphasizes a shape or lights an area, such as a dressing table and mirror, with a line of incandescent lamps or with luorescent or neon tubes. • Silhouette lighting is accomplished by shining a light directly on an object so that the shadow behind it echoes its shape.

Lighting and Technology

109

Figure 5.14 In this Old England farmhouse-inspired kitchen, a pair of pendant lights that evoke street lights give general lighting, while accent lighting showcases the serving pieces of red ceramic, silver plate, and pewter. Undercounter lighting illuminates the sink and counter workstation. Design by Sandra L. Steiner-Houck, CKD; Steiner & Houck, Inc./Photography: Peter Leach Photography/ NKBA Design Competition

• Lights that shine upward behind objects such as plants and art will “model” the object’s shape, thereby creating patterns on the wall or ceiling. • Lights shining directly downward will cause shadows beneath and around the object. Downward light on people casts unlattering shadows.

or even ill. A well-designed lighting plan will not only avoid these extremes but also make use of high levels of illumination to enhance people’s energy and motivation and will provide low, subtle lighting to encourage relaxation and mellow feelings.

Seasonal Affective Disorder

Light and the Mind and Body It is important not to overlook the dramatic effects that lighting can have on the mind and body. Most of us have experienced mood variations in response to natural light: On sunny days we’re likely to have a lighthearted, cheerful outlook, while dark, dreary days put us in a negative, sluggish mood. Similarly, artiicial lighting that is too bright or dim may annoy us or make us feel exhausted

A form of depression called seasonal affective disorder (SAD), irst identiied by psychiatrists around 1980, is a dramatic example of how light can affect the mind and body. SAD symptoms include lethargy, irritability, and an increased desire to sleep and eat carbohydrates. Because symptoms typically occur as winter approaches and disappear when spring arrives, experts believe SAD is caused by a disruption of the circadian entrainment rhythms, the process by which we “set” our biological clocks.

110

Chapter 5

discussed in Chapter 7, is another means of bringing light into our homes. A very simple and affordable method is to use lamps (lightbulbs) balanced to resemble the full spectrum of sunlight. We tend to feel more rested, energetic, and optimistic when natural light is a part of our daily regime.

Manipulating Mood with Interior Lighting Factors that determine the physical and emotional effects of lighting include: • • • •

Figure 5.15 Natural light is uplifting and therapeutic. Deeply penetrating sunlight in an interior may help counteract feelings of depression. Photo courtesy of Andersen Windows

It is not surprising, then, that psychiatrists recommend activities in daylight, such as morning walks, as a way to alleviate winter depression. They have also developed a system of bright-light therapy as a treatment for SAD. In this therapy, the patient uses a specially designed lightbox or light helmet for a prescribed period, usually 30 to 60 minutes a day. Therapeutic light devices are sold under several brand names, including Northern Light, Photo Therapeutics, True Sun, and Vita-Light. These devices resemble natural full-spectrum sunlight in both their brightness and their color balance. Patients need to ind the timing and distance of exposure that works best for them and be aware that bright-light therapy does not help everyone. Because improper use can cause problems such as headaches, eyestrain, and other damage to the eyes, SAD therapy lights should never be used to self-medicate a case of winter “blahs,” much less for general lighting. However, in designing interior lighting, we can take advantage of what we know about SAD to create an environment that helps people feel their best year-round. One way to admit natural light is to plan or remodel homes to include large expanses of glass such as picture windows, bay windows, and skylights. The solarium or greenhouse,

Size and source of the lighting Direction of the lighting Color spectrum of the lighting Color and texture of the furnishings being lit

For example, a plane or bank of light minimizes form and bulk, reducing the importance of objects and even people. It can ill a person with a sense of space and freedom and can be restful and reassuring. This type of general lighting is effective in open areas of public buildings, ofices, hotels, and retail businesses. In homes it is often used in kitchens, bathrooms, workrooms, or hobby rooms, where moderately bright light produces a general feeling of well-being.

• Large areas of bright light stimulate a temporary psychological and physical surge of energy, which may cause undue fatigue after periods of prolonged exposure. The mind will become bored or dulled after a barrage of continuous bright lights. If the light becomes too brilliant, it can cause malaise, or a feeling of illness. This is one reason why phototherapy lights for treating SAD should not be installed as general lighting. • Moderate to low levels of indirect lighting, accomplished with dimmer switches on ambient lighting, are sometimes called mood lighting, meaning that the area is inviting, cozy, and intimate. This type of lighting is used in restaurants where the clientele come not only for good food but for a relaxed, private, and unhurried conversation. Mood lighting is favored in homes in formal living or dining rooms, master bedrooms, family rooms, media or theater rooms, and upscale kitchens and great rooms and as an alternative in computer rooms and home ofices, where low lighting diminishes eyestrain. It helps establish the perimeter of the room and produces a sense of security. Mood lighting can be accomplished with backlighting (placing lights behind furnishings) and flickering light

Lighting and Technology

111

Figure 5.16 The Izakaya Restaurant in Atlantic City, NJ, is filled with moodmanipulating lighting. Effects include direct downlighting over dining tables, ambient/accent lighting on large-scale Japanese patterned screens, accent highlighting of the impressive custom structure that defines the entryway, and fluorescent lighting that draws attention to the central counter dining. The combination of lighting effects creates a place for elegant, ritualistic dining in an unhurried, elegant atmosphere. Design by Alvarez-Brock Design/photo courtesy of Eventscape, Inc. www.eventscape.net

emitted from candles, ireplaces, or electric lame lamps. Flickering light is usually warm in color, casting a healthy glow. • Colored light also has profound effects on the mind and body. Warm white light and soft, warm colored light generally are welcoming and uplifting. However, intensely colored light, such as bright red, orange, and yellow, produces considerable eyestrain. This may lead to an eventual feeling of physical exhaustion as the mind struggles to avoid coping with the intensity. Cool white light and cool-colored lights (blue, cool green, and violet) produce calm, restful environments but can eventually become unfriendly, cold, or depressing.

Glare Glare is excessive light that causes irritation or fatigue. These unpleasant effects result from heat buildup as well as too much brightness and can be caused by natural or artiicial light. Dark areas surrounding lighted areas cause eyestrain, fatigue, and even depression, as peripheral vision constantly has to deal with the darkbright contrast. Natural daylighting often requires shading window treatments to reduce glare. Glare from artiicial light can be controlled by lowering the wattage, using a cool-beam lamp, or adjusting the direction of the lighting source. Another means of diverting or diffusing glare is through baffles. Bafles come in many forms:

Figure 5.17 Natural daylighting from large windows is filtered through Alustra® Silhouette® Window Shadings and Alustra® Privacy Sheers. Photo courtesy of Hunter Douglas Window Fashions

• A length of wood placed in front of lights directs the light upward or downward. • Louvers or grooves on or inside a luminaire or ixture act as bafles. • A metal or wooden grid diffuses the light and produces more even distribution.

112

Chapter 5

Table 5.2

Types of Glare

Direct glare is bright light or insuficiently shielded light sources in the ield of view. Placement of lighting sources is very important; light in the center of a room can produce direct glare, as can some accent lighting. Direct glare is a problem in ofices where the desk faces the window. This may be corrected by turning the desk so that the light is coming from the side rather than the front. (Note that light from behind a seated person will cause shadows on the work surface and will be equally unacceptable.) Reflecting glare is excessive light that bounces off a shiny surface such as a glass tabletop. Fatigue is augmented when relecting glare is present. Veiling glare prevents us from seeing a task clearly. It is caused by light relecting off a surface, creating a relection. We see the relected images of the light source rather than the task at hand. Veiling glare can make seeing extremely dificult and cause eyestrain; it is due to incorrect placement of the lighting source or an inadequate bafle (screening device) of the light ixture.

• The lens or glass covering can be textured or coated to diffuse glare. • Relectors inside the bulb itself can further control the light and glare. Table 5.2 lists the most common types of glare: direct glare, reflecting glare, and veiling glare.

Power Terminology and Units of Measurement To understand how incandescent and luorescent lighting is measured, it is necessary to understand basic power terminology and units of measurement. Incandescent and luorescent lighting is measured in footcandles, footlamberts, and lumens (see Table 5.3). These terms allow lighting engineers and designers to create and evaluate lamps for speciic purposes. They are a part of the general body of interior design knowledge. Incandescent lamps, or lightbulbs, typically vary in wattage—15, 25, 60, 75, 100, 120, 150, and 175. In a luminaire that contains two or more lamps, there is often a limitation on the wattage so that the ixture will not be overheated and at risk of catching ire. The most common halogen wattages are 50 and 65. The wattage of luorescent lamps is 18, 20, 32, 40, 60, or 80; they deliver greater brightness per watt than incandescent lighting, making luorescent lamps more energy eficient. Ordinary incandescent lamps (bulbs) last from 750 to 2,500 hours, and long-life bulbs (which cost more

Table 5.3

Measuring Electricity and Light

Electricity and light are quantiied according to the SI (Système Internationale, or International System of Units). Note the relationships among the various units.

Electricity Ampere or amperage. The unit of electric current, equal to the current produced by 1 volt across a resistance of 1 ohm. A typical residence has a 15-amp circuit fed into it from the main utility line. Kilowatt-hour (kWh or kWhr). The work done by 1,000 watts in 1 hour. Electric utility companies measure consumption and bill customers in kilowatt-hours. Volt or voltage. The unit for electric potential, deining the force or pressure of electricity in the power line. Standard household current in the United States is 110 volts, and major appliances require dedicated 220-volt hookups. Watt or wattage. The unit of electric power equal to that produced by 1 ampere across a potential of 1 volt. Standard luminaires in the United States typically accommodate bulbs that consume 60 to 150 watts. The lower the watts, the lower the energy consumed.

Lighting Candela, candle, or candlepower. The unit of luminous intensity. Color temperature. The color of light. Measured in Kelvin (K or k). Sunlight at sunrise is 1800 K; a 100-watt incandescent lamp is 2850 K, and a 40-watt luorescent lamp tube has a color temperature of 3000 K. Higher numbers are cooler light, as blue in gas lames indicates higher heat. Color rendering index (CRI). Light’s effect on color, scaled from 0 to 100, with sunlight at 100; the higher the number the more “true” the color will appear. High-dei nition (HD) color rendering is a marketing term that indicates a high quality of light, typically as compared to the CRI, indicating that a light ixture produces light very similar to natural sunlight. Eficacy. The eficiency in converting electricity into light, measured in lumens per watt. More eficient bulbs provide more light using less energy. Footcandle or footlambert (fl) The amount of light thrown by one candle on a square foot of surface, equal to 1 lumen per square foot. Conventional ofice lighting may be from 50 to 150 footlamberts. Lumen. A measure of brightness and the unit of luminous lux or low, measured against the luminous intensity of candle. A typical 14-watt luorescent or 60-watt incandescent lamp (bulb) has a light output of 540 lumens. The higher the lumens, the brighter the light. Lux. The unit of general illumination, equal to 1 lumen per square meter. Bright sunshine is 10,000 lux, a well-lit ofice is 500 to 1,000, and home lighting is 300 to 500 lux.

Lighting and Technology

initially and deliver less light for the electricity used) last from 2,500 to 3,500 hours. Low-voltage lamps use less wattage or electric power and deliver greater control and a wider range of beam spread. Note that it is not the size of the lamp or the level of wattage that makes an impact in lighting. Lighting becomes most interesting when the size of the beam is controlled to create pools of light or emphasize certain areas or focal points in the interior. This is the advantage of incandescent lighting over luorescent lighting.

Luminaires, or Lighting Fixtures Luminaires, or lighting ixtures, fall into two broad categories: architectural or structural lighting and nonarchitectural lighting. Architectural or structural

Table 5.4

113

luminaires are permanently installed and planned for in the lighting or wiring plan. They include ceiling and wall ixtures that are installed to permanent wiring. Many architectural luminaires are simple and inconspicuous. They emphasize what they light, not the luminaire. Other luminaires are quite decorative and/or dramatic and can make up an important part of the design scheme. Portable decorative luminaries (nonarchitectural lighting) are those that plug in; they (1) hang on the wall or from a ceiling hook or (2) are placed on a table or on the loor. Decorative luminaires are also discussed in Chapter 14. Many styles, colors or inishes, and types of glass in luminaires are on the market today. The appeal of decorative luminaires is found in styles for every interior design. Be aware that good, poor, and mediocre design

Indirect Lighting

Indirect lighting is placing a light behind a built-in or portable feature. Types of indirect lighting placed behind delectors include the following.

Cornice Lighting

Valance Lighting

Bracket Lighting

Bracket Lighting

(Up and Down)

(Up Only)

A light behind a board mounted into the ceiling washes light down onto the wall.

A light used over the top of windows washes both the ceiling and the window treatment.

Valance lighting mounted lower on the wall washes the upper (and perhaps lower) wall with light.

A light placed just below the ceiling has the board or deflector beneath it.

Soffit Lighting

Soffit Lighting

(In a Kitchen)

(In a Bath)

Base or Toe-Mold Lighting

Toe-Kick or Riser Lighting

A light built into the soffit shines downward from the top of the cabinet overhead.

Soffit lighting provides even illumination for personal grooming.

A strip of light is placed against the floor where a deflector directs the light upward or perhaps downward, giving the effect of theatrical usher lights.

Lighting is placed under the toe-kick area of cabinets or stairs. This can also take the form of usher lights.

114

Chapter 5

and quality exist; thus the power of discrimination discussed in Chapter 3 becomes paramount when selecting luminaires.

the ceiling, called recessed luminaires, and those that are adjustable. Adjustable luminaires can be recessed or surface mounted.

Architectural Lighting

Surface-Mounted and Suspended Decorative Luminaires. These are selected for their shape and style. They provide general or ambient lighting and place light in balanced layers for ambient, task, and accent lighting. Clear or translucent covers are called diffusers. Opaque covers are lamp shades. All types are available in a wide variety of styles (see Table 5.6):

The categories of architectural lighting include luminous panels, built-in indirect lighting, recessed and adjustable ixtures, and surface-mounted and suspended ixtures.

Luminous Panels Luminous panels are strips or lines of lights, usually luorescent, over which glass or plastic translucent panels are placed. The translucent panel glows, producing a soft white or colored light, according to the texture and color of the glass or plastic. It can also cause glare in some situations. Luminous ceiling panels, quite common in kitchens, are referred to as luminous ceilings.

Built-In Indirect Lighting Refer to Table 5.4. Fixed and Adjustable Luminaires. This category (see Table 5.5) includes various luminaires that are set into

Table 5.5

• Flush-mounted ceiling luminaires or ixtures are mounted directly to the ceiling and are either completely enclosed, or the diffuser is open at the top for air low to the lamp or for ambient lighting. • Semiflush ceiling luminaires or ixtures are mounted onto the ceiling at the base and have a short extension to the diffuser and lamp. This allows the light to be cast onto the ceiling for a wider spread of ambient light. • Wall sconces are mounted onto the wall for soft accent lighting and to give supplemental, layered lighting in small areas that otherwise would be dark or lack

Fixed and Adjustable Lighting

Recessed Downlights

Surface-Mounted Downlights

Eyeball Lighting

Canisters set into the ceiling cast pools of light downward.

Ceiling-mounted canisters that hang down are used in place of recessed downlights where there is insufficient ceiling clearance, or they are added later in a remodeling situation.

Fixtures that project an adjustable lamp from the ceiling and throw pools of light onto the wall are eyeball spotlights. A series of these can form wall washers.

Strip Lighting

Adjustable Track Lighting

Strip or theatrical lighting is often used for personal grooming areas.

Flexible ceiling-mounted fixtures hold spotlights or floodlights mounted anywhere and at any position on a fixed track. (Track luminaires come in various sizes, shapes, colors, and finishes. They are ideal for accent lighting and wall-wash lighting.)

Lighting and Technology

Figure 5.18 Architectural lighting is seen in this well-lit kitchen as luminous panels for general lighting with supplemental downlights. Suspended luminaries include a pair of pendant fixtures and a trio of minipendants. © Susan Gilmore/Esto

interest. Sconces may shine up and down or in one direction only. • Bathroom i xtures are mounted onto the wall above the mirror and sink/countertop to illuminate personal grooming. Typically two or three lamps will be mounted onto one base. • Chandeliers are suspended luminaires that house many small torpedo, lame, or miniglobe lamps installed into candelabra sockets or converted to standard size sockets. Bulbs use 25 to 40-watt incandescent or their luorescent equivalent. Chandeliers range from simple, modest sizes with only a few lamps to highly complex, large chandeliers with dozens of

Figure 5.20 A simple chandelier gives general lighting, while candle combustion lighting creates softly lit table centerpieces. Accent lighting inside the china cabinet completes layered lighting effects for quiet and elegant in-home dining. Photo courtesy of HGTV

115

Figure 5.19 Wall sconces flank this personal grooming space, combined with a single overhead recessed light grazing and highlighting the multirelief stone wall. Design by Lori Carroll, CoDesigners: Mary Roles; Lori Carroll & Associates/Photography: William Lesch Photography/NKBA Design Competition

116

Chapter 5

Nonarchitectural Lighting Portable Decorative Luminaires These ixtures include a variety of freestanding loor lamps and lamps that rest on tables or desks to be placed where and when lighting is needed (see Table 5.7). Here, the term lamp means the entire ixture or luminaire that houses one or more lightbulbs or lamps: • Floor lamps are portable, freestanding units with adjustable or nonadjustable luminaires that provide light where it is needed, often for reading or hand-related tasks while seated. • Torchéres are portable loor lamps with diffusers that direct the light onto the ceiling to supplement ambient lighting. They may have dimmer controls. • Desk lamps are portable small luminaires that adjust for exact placement for the task at hand. • Table lamps are nonadjustable portable luminaires that cast light upwards and downwards for ambient lighting and task lighting, often placed on end or sofa tables and nightstands. • Buffet lamps are tall, slender nonadjustable portable luminaires meant to throw soft light on buffet food or décor and to supplement ambient lighting • Art lamps are unique accessory luminaires, generally smaller than a table lamp.

A Lighting Plan Figure 5.21 Beautiful red hand-blown glass minipendant diffusers accentuate the pools of light on the island bar of this Texas home. Recessed downlights and undercabinet light for evening illumination are balanced with windows over the sink and under the upper cabinets for daytime kitchen work. Photo © Kathryn Taylor

lights for large-scale contract settings. At their lowest point, chandeliers are placed 30 to 36 inches above dining tables, or at least 6 feet 8 inches for areas where people walk. • Bar or island chandeliers have two or three lamps, each with a separate diffuser/cover. These shine downward in single or overlapping pools of light on work/dining surfaces. • Pendant lighting consists of simple suspended ixtures with one or more bulbs within a single diffuser or shade, and are large enough to light a general area or dining space. • Minipendants are individual, small suspended lamps with a glass diffuser/cover that spotlight a pool of light downward. They may be used alone or in groups.

A well-designed lighting plan avoids extremes of too much or too little light. It also uses high levels of illumination to enhance energy and motivation and provides low, subtle lighting to encourage relaxation and mellow feelings where appropriate. The plan places light where it is needed, and balances lighting to ensure an attractive, comfortable atmosphere, lowing light seamlessly between rooms and the layered light sources.

Layered Light Sources Lighting designers use layered light sources to create effective lighting, often achieved with a combination of structural and decorative luminaires or ixtures. There are ive steps in layering: 1. Evaluate natural light from windows or skylights. Consider the quality and quantity of light relating to the overall lighting plan. Reduce glare from windows with translucent or louvered window treatments. Shiny interior surfaces can be softened using frosted or soft lightbulbs or by choosing ixtures with shades over bare bulbs. 2. Place the brightest artiicial light on focal points and balanced light on multiple focal points.

Lighting and Technology

Table 5.6

Surface-Mounted and Suspended Decorative Luminaires/Fixtures

Flush (surface)

Semi-flush (surface)

Chandelier (suspended)

Table 5.7

Wall sconce (surface)

Kitchen/Bar chandelier (suspended)

Bathroom (surface)

Pendant (suspended)

Minipendant (suspended)

Portable Decorative Luminaires

Nonadjustable floor lamp

Adjustable floor lamp

Adjustable desk lamp

Torchére floor lamp

Note: Tall, slender table lamps are “Buffet Lamps.”

Table lamp

117

118

Chapter 5

Figure 5.22 Layered lighting here includes a suspended pendant in the adjoining entryway for ambient lighting. Seen in the living/ dining area is accent lighting focused on wall art, buffet lamps on the console or buffet table, and wall sconces on each side of the mirror. Combustion light is provided by candles placed on the coffee and entryway tables. © Scott Frances/Esto

3. Use ambient/indirect lighting to ill in the background for a soft overall glow for general lighting. Light directed toward the ceiling and relected back down into the room creates a soft, wide effect and usually requires fewer ixtures to suficiently light a room. Downlighting, such as recessed cans, is more directed; so more ixtures are usually required for the same effect. 4. Add supplemental task lighting for a speciic purpose such as reading or eye–hand tasks. Combining recessed lighting with task lighting reduces shadows. Pinpoint recessed lights also work extremely well over plumbing ixtures, providing functional light when needed. 5. Use accent lighting for soft light, such as wall sconces, or to highlight a piece of art or decorative accessory, or as a hidden strip in the crown molding to illuminate the unique ceiling architecture. An artistic lamp may be its own accent.

Lighting Economy The upward surge of electricity rates, predicted to continue, is the major factor in economizing with light. Lighting consumes less electricity than heat-producing appliances such as dryers, water heaters, dishwashers, ovens, and ranges. However, lighting does consume more power than smaller appliances. Ways that lighting can be more effectively and economically used are listed in Table 5.8.

Lighting for the Future The direction and future for residential lighting is multifaceted. The buzzwords will be convenience, energy eficiency, and specialized and lexible lighting effects. Consider these trends: • Increased energy eficiency via electronic sensors that can turn selected lights on and off according to the level of natural light, and sensing devices that operate lighting in response to radiated heat caused by human presence and movement. • Devices such as timers that switch lights on and off to discourage burglary when the home is unoccupied. • Control systems, including wall-mounted, programmable units for total home or area control. • Handheld devices that operate on infrared frequencies to send instructions to wall receivers. • Greater lexibility in lighting effects, such as more combinations of types of lighting and greater use of dimmer switches to accommodate different tasks, as well as corresponding lexibility in levels of mood lighting within the same area. • Increased use of artistic lighting in residential design, including more cold-cathode lighting and motivational lighting (see “Contract Considerations”). • Increased use of the services of lighting designers, who create maximum effectiveness for lighting, both practical and aesthetic.

Lighting and Technology

Table 5.8

119

Suggestions for Lighting Economy

• Use energy-saving luorescent and LED lighting in place of incandescent lighting where aesthetically practical. • Open window treatments to allow daylight in. • Bring economical natural light into dark spaces through a tunnel skylight with advanced optics to signiicantly improve the way daylight is harnessed. An optional light kit can be installed for nighttime artiicial light just above the diffuser. See VeluxUSA Sun Tunnel™ www.veluxusa .com and Solatube®International www.solatube.com. • Put light only where it is needed, keeping in mind that high contrast (a pool of light surrounded by dark) can cause fatigue and even distress. • Use dimmer switches for nonluorescent lamps. • Use light-colored surfaces to relect and thereby increase light, and avoid textures that absorb light. • Use only some of the lights in an interior (use one, rather than two, table lamps). • Illuminate local tasks with portable luminaires with fewer lamps or lower wattage rather than general overhead lighting. • Use one higher-wattage bulb rather than multiple lowerwattage bulbs. For example, one 100-watt bulb uses less energy than two 60-watt bulbs. • Install extra light switches so that at each doorway the light can be turned off without inconvenience. • Use low-voltage or lower-wattage lamps. • Use motion sensors and photoelectric cells or timers to turn outdoor lights on and off automatically.

The Interiors website lists lighting organizations and sources of information for the latest developments in lighting.

Contract Considerations Many of the topics discussed in this chapter are applicable to contract situations as well. Here we also discuss other considerations that apply speciically to contract interiors.

Types of Contract Lighting Natural Daylighting In contract settings such as ofices, natural daylight is often desired by employees—sometimes even considered a luxury. However, problems exist with natural daylighting (as discussed under “Glare,” earlier in this chapter). Temperature control is another major consideration linked to daylighting. Excessive heat and cold can result from poor insulation or large expanses of glass. Natural daylight almost always needs to be supplemented with

Figure 5.23 A Velux Sun Tunnel™ skylight delivers harnessed natural sunlight into this laundry room, thereby eliminating the need for artificial lighting until nighttime, when this flushmounted ceiling luminaire is switched on. An option is to install a light kit with a socket for a lightbulb just above the Sun Tunnel diffuser, to provide nighttime artificial light from the same fixture. Photo © David A. Taylor

artiicial light; the lighting systems need careful control to maintain a healthy balance of light.

Fluorescent Lighting Contract interiors are illed with luorescent lighting. The bulk of ofice lighting, general lighting for public spaces such as transportation facilities, retail shops and malls, health care, and hospitality interiors are lit with economical luorescent tubes, and for recessed lighting as well as table lamps and wall sconces, CFLs are used.

LED Lighting LED lighting promises to be a strong contender with luorescent lighting as energy costs further drive the search for more economical lighting. LED lights, discussed earlier in this chapter, have a host of advantages that are directly applicable to contract spaces. As LED lamps become more affordable and offer more appealing color

120

Chapter 5

Figure 5.24 Cold-cathode fluorescent lighting is recessed into angled walls, creating a dynamic geometric architectural/lighting pattern in the Merck BRC Auditorium, Boston. Photo courtesy of NCC-National Cathode Corporation

Figure 5.25 LED lighting was planned as an attractive design element in the reveals of aluminum panels of this new facade of the Oliver & Bonacini Café Grill. Design by Anacleto Design Associates/photo courtesy of Eventscape, Inc. www.eventscape.net

spectrums, their use and applications will increase proportionately.

HID Lighting HID, or high-intensity discharge, lighting is used for bright interior and exterior lighting. HID lamps establish an arc between two very close electrodes set in opposite ends of small, sealed, translucent or transparent glass tubes. The electric arc generates heat and pressure high enough to vaporize the atoms of various metallic elements inside the lamp, causing the atoms to emit large amounts of visible-range electromagnetic energy. HID lamps are used to “uplight” exteriors of large buildings and are being used more often in interiors of contract buildings. They produce a greater quantity of light using less energy than an incandescent lamp. The problems being overcome in HID lighting are the noise or hum of the arc or ballast and the length of time to restart the lamp after a power failure.

such as restaurants and retail businesses to emphasize a color scheme and add drama and excitement. Lighting designers often create unique neon lighting for contract interiors.

Cold-Cathode Lighting

Motivational and Mood Lighting

Cold-cathode lighting, or neon lighting, uses different gases or vapors to produce colors. Neon lighting has been an important part of exterior lighting for advertising and storefronts, but it is being increasingly used in interiors

The behavior of people can be altered or directed with motivational or illusion lighting. This means that people will be motivated to sit, walk, or face a particular direction because of the impressions given them by special

Lighting and Technology

lighting (particularly the manipulation of bright versus dark areas) and inishes. Motivational lighting can create environments where the quality, intensity, and angle of light cause the illusory appearance or disappearance of objects, walls, ceilings, and even entire rooms. Lighting designers often work with interior designers to accomplish special effects in an interior. The manipulation of areas of intense brightness or darkness can affect both the mind and body, making us believe that something exists that really is not there (a wall, for example) or that something is not as close as it actually is. In addition to making us behave in a predicted manner, this can make spaces it the needs of the people in the environment.

Safety Lighting Safety lighting is required in public spaces where there are exit signs, for example. Other safety lighting mandated by building codes includes aisle or entrance and exit lighting and lighting for stairs and landings.



• •



121

control the levels of illumination. Tilting ixtures are available to adjust the direction of light and control glare at workstations. Remote-control devices are available that send instructions for reprogramming back to a central unit or that control lights from a remote location. Dimming controls can likewise be computer-controlled. Enhanced natural lighting technology, such as solatube or Velux Sun Tunnel™, will see increased usage. New designs are continually emerging in the lightingas-art ield and as decorative luminaire ixtures. Lighting design is a viable ield for a design professional because of the continual demand for new products and designs in the marketplace. Motivational and illusion lighting will play key roles in contract design in the future in public spaces such as banks, ofices, medical facilities, museums, theaters, and all types of staged events. The laser show is a standard attraction in night clubs and planetariums and is now making its way into homes as well.

Lighting Economy in Contract Interiors Fluorescent and LED lighting are used extensively in contract settings. In addition to the suggestions presented in Table 5.8, there are other ways to control energy consumption and costs in contract lighting. One is the addition of central programmable monitoring systems that automatically turn lights off and on in various parts of a building when required. Another is the increased usage of sensing devices (see “Contract Lighting for the Future”) that monitor light usage, turning it on and off according to time, daylight levels, or whether people are moving in the room. In contract interiors, lighting is a major monthly expense, and because of the tremendous amount of electricity used, contract buildings are limited by law to the amount of electricity consumed per square foot. This, in turn, limits the number, placement, and usage of lights in contract interiors. Some feel that this will limit the creativity of lighting designers. However, we are already seeing advances in economical lighting. Look for new products and innovative ways lighting can be functional, beautiful—even dazzling—and still use less electricity.

Contract Lighting for the Future • Lower maintenance through retroitted CFLs means longer-life lamps. • LED (light-emitting diode) usage will increase. • Other developments will become increasingly used, such as sensing devices and central computerized monitoring systems. • Reduced ofice glare can be accomplished by improved light dispersion at the work surface where the user can

Technology Technology is now so much a part of our lives at home and in public that the issue is not whether or not to incorporate the latest technological devices but which ones to select or replace and how to accommodate them in the home and workplace. Whereas wiring for electrical, landline telephone, and coaxial cable is still the means whereby much of the technology is run in the home and workplace, the new direction is wireless control, from a cellular telephone or other handheld device. The same portable computers (PCs), laptops, and electronics can be operated from home, from the ofice, from the car, and from any remote location where a power source can recharge the battery when needed. A major trend in new-home construction and upgrading existing homes is to make technology more livable. Developments such as wall-mounted larger lat-screen televisions with hidden wires allow technology to be smoother and less imposing. Fitting computers, televisions, DVD players, and stereo equipment into the home without overpowering it continues to be an important task in interior design. Creative solutions continue to evolve, such as creating a nook for a child’s computer station off the family room or kitchen to satisfy a parent’s desire for monitoring homework progress and Internet access. Home ofices also are becoming more functional and include more shelving and custom cabinetry, with the wiring in place for power, phone, and cable. According to the National Association of Home Builders (NAHB), one survey found that nearly three-fourths of American adults know about home automation systems

122

Chapter 5

Figure 5.26 This flat-screen television and wall-mounted speakers hide unsightly wires inside the walls for a clean-appearing media center. Photo courtesy of RapidRun www.rapidrun.com

and a majority are interested in owning products that use technology to manage a wide range of tasks. For further information on technology issues from the NAHB, lighting and technology associations, and product manufacturers, go to the Interiors website.

Information-Age Home Automation Systems There are many connection options of home automation systems, including the programmable control of lighting, appliances, computer networks, television and DVD players, digital satellite connections, and television monitoring of exterior door and window security and baby’s room. Home automation systems can augment energy savings by electronically turning off appliances and lighting and adjusting thermostats when no one is at home and at night. The system can even shop for the best electrical rates and can connect to other companies, returning unused electricity generated from the building’s own solar collectors. The system can also turn off speciied appliances during times when rates are highest.

A single control center with a television screen is where the monitoring and programming takes place. In addition, the control center can accept telephone messages, via cell phone command, for example, so that appliances, heating and cooling systems, and even the hot tub can be programmed to turn on just before the home owner arrives. Another growth area of technology is the increased demand for multimedia in the home. Computers require electrical outlets and Wi-Fi hotspots, and cable television demands that the cable be prewired to areas where televisions will be placed. With the explosion of digital and wireless electronic equipment, virtually any room in the home can be a mini-ofice or part of the entertainment scene. Home automation systems are available from a number of manufacturers whose Web addresses are listed at the Interiors website.

Information-Age Wiring and Installation For both home automation and multimedia, specialized structured wiring is necessary. Rather than conventional wiring, Category 5 unshielded twisted-pair cable is faster and less prone to interference for telephone and computer networking than standard telephone wire. This allows for very high speed Internet connections and advanced energy management via energy consumption control and energy charges. RG-6 quad-shielded coaxial cable can deliver clear signals from digital satellite or highdeinition television transmitters. Manufacturer-certiied installers and some electricians are qualiied to install Category 5 and RG-6 cable structured wiring for home automation systems. Some proprietary or well-known brand-name home automation systems can be installed only by a manufacturer-certiied installer.

Home Automation for Existing Houses Although the ideal time for upgrading wiring is in the building process, discussed above, there are several options for retroitting home automation in existing

Lighting and Technology

structures. These include the power-line carrier (PLC) system, infrared (IR), radio frequency (RF), and digital subscriber lines (DSLs)—telephone line networking. Of the power-line carrier (PLC) systems, the most well known uses X-10, a proprietary communications product that transmits coded communications signals over the existing AC wires that power the house. Many companies make X-10–compliant products. This means that nearly any appliance that uses AC power can be turned on or off remotely by using external plug-in modules or modules that it inside the electrical box. Interface cards that it into the computer will work with control software for PLC systems. Even higher data rates than X-10 are available in products that use a technique called a spread spectrum. These conform to the consumer electronics bus (CEBus) standard of the Electronics Industries Association. Coaxial cable is a type of wire that consists of a center wire surrounded by insulation and then by a grounded shield of braided wire. The shield minimizes electrical and radio frequency interference. Coaxial cabling is used for the cable television industry and for computer networks. Although more costly than standard telephone wire, coaxial cable is far less susceptible to interference and can carry much more data. Coaxial cable is wired into the walls or retroitted via raceways. The cable outlet or plug is connected to a personal computer desktop via an Ethernet cable/cord, and a laptop connects to the coaxial cable via a Wi-Fi modem or router access point. Digital subscriber lines (DSLs) give new life to copper telephone wires by providing increased speed of Internet access and allowing Internet and telephone use on the same telephone line at the same time. Infrared (IR) is a wireless method for short-distance operation of entertainment equipment or connecting computer to printer via a remote-control device. However, the signals cannot go through walls or around corners. Radio frequency (RF) transmission, familiar to us as cordless telephones, will become a standard that allows users a range of wireless computers, phones, and other devices to network with each other in multiple locations. Of these choices, RF-based networking ranks just ahead of phone-line networking as a irst choice in the “no-new-wires” data networking solutions. Power-line networking is also a viable solution in multiple personal computer households.

123

is that device plates can be installed anywhere along the raceway for power receptacles, phone jacks, and cable outlets. Installation consists of mounting the base, running the wires, and snapping on the cover.

Wi-Fi Technology Wi-Fi is connectivity without wires. A Wi-Fi network can connect a family’s computers, media, and display devices to share hardware and media resources such as printers, audio iles, and Internet access. That means everyone in the family can share stored iles, photos, and documents and print them on a single printer attached to one desktop computer—all without unsightly cables running throughout the home. Everyone can use the Internet at once, and access can be password protected. A Wi-Fi-enabled device such as a personal computer (PC), laptop, video game console, cell phone, personal digital assistant (PDA), or MP3 player can connect to the Internet through one or more interconnected routers connected to the Internet via a digital subscriber line modem or cable modem at an access point (AP) called a hotspot. The access point/hotspot/modem broadcasts a wireless

Electrical Raceways An alternative installation technique is electrical raceways. Encased PVC baseboard wiring covers come in white and wood laminate to blend into décor. They can be mounted on any surface and consist of a two-compartment design that separates electrical from low-voltage phone, data, and coaxial cables. An advantage of electrical raceways

Figure 5.27 Wi-Fi connectivity gives this home office a clean, no-wires appearance. Design by Stephen Blatt Architects/photo © Brian Vanden Brink

124

Chapter 5

Figure 5.28 A residential wiring plan.

signal that computers can detect and “tune” into. In order to connect to an access point and join a wireless network, computers and devices must be equipped with wireless network adapters. Most new laptops have these built in. Wi-Fi is a trademark of the Wi-Fi Alliance, a nonproit global association of companies that oversee tests on product interoperability and security of devices operating on a wireless local area network (WLAN). A product that passes the Alliance tests is given the label Wi-Fi Certiied®. Many devices that have not been certiied are also Wi-Fi compatible. Wi-Fi networks use radio technologies called IEEE 802.11 to provide secure, reliable, fast wireless connectivity. A Wi-Fi network can be used to connect electronic devices to each other, to the Internet, and to wired networks that use Ethernet technology. Wi-Fi networks operate in the 2.4 and 5 GHz radio bands, with some products that contain both bands (dual band). Wi-Fi was originally

associated with the term “wireless idelity,” which is no longer used by the Wi-Fi Alliance.

Wiring Plans The planning of lighting systems requires training, experience, and thinking through what lighting must accomplish in an interior. Interior designers are often actively involved in this process. A wiring or lighting plan is a part of the working drawings. The wiring plan indicates where outlets, switches, and wall and ceiling light ixtures will be located.

Switches and Outlets Light switches can be placed in one, two, or even three locations. Switches should be easily accessible at the doorway on the open side so that lights can be turned on at the doorway. Careful thought should be given to the

Lighting and Technology

Wall switch

Fluorescent fixture

Three-way switch

Telephone

Key-operated switch

Phone jack

Duplex plug/outlet

Push button

Waterproof outlet

Buzzer

Switched (controlled) outlet plug

Bell

Wall plus 48⬙ from floor duplex outlet

Chimes

220-volt outlet

Fan

Floor outlet

Power panel

Special-purpose outlet

Lighting distribution panel

Strip outlet

Thermostat

Ceiling light outlet

Smoke detector

Wall light outlet

Fuel gas

Flush or recessed light outlet

Key

Spotlights

Hose bib

125

Figure 5.29 Lighting symbols for wiring plans.

type and placement of switches, according to the needs of the users. If, for example, the user is an aged or inirm person, a “rocker switch” may be easier to operate than a standard lip switch. Dimmer switches increase or decrease the level of illumination or brightness. Dimmers make it possible to create levels of interest and different moods in the interior. Automatic sensor dimmers are used to turn on interior lights automatically to supplement natural daylight to a proportionate, preprogrammed level. Switched outlets are plugs activated by switches. This allows for lamps, lighting as art, or decorative lights (such as holiday decorations) to be turned on at the switch— the light is plugged in and turned on at the source but controlled at the switch. Switched outlets contribute

convenience and safety to the interior and its occupants. If, for example, a portable table luminaire is the only or desired source of light in the room, it can be turned on at the door. This will eliminate the necessity of irst turning on general lighting to reach the portable light and then returning to turn off the general lighting. It also reduces the danger of walking across a dark room. In addition, the inconvenience of fumbling over holiday packages, decorations, or the tree to reach Christmas lights—or walking outside to turn on exterior lights—can be removed through switched outlets. According to state and local building codes, outlets must be located from 6 to 12 feet along the wall for portable luminaires (loor, table, and wall lamps). The frequent placement of outlets minimizes the need for extension

126

Chapter 5

cords and precludes plugging too many lights or appliances into one outlet. Therefore, the building code helps ensure safety against tripping and falling and against ire from overloading a circuit and outlet. Stretching cords tight can also increase danger of damage, loose connections, and possibly tenuous circumstances where the luminaire is placed too close to the edge of a surface and could easily fall off, break, and perhaps even burst into lames. Convenience is another major reason for including frequent outlets: It is easy to place the (A) luminaire, appliance, or piece of equipment where it is needed. Vertical placement is an important part of planning outlets and switches for the sake of convenience. For example, a table-height outlet may be desirable for units such as entertainment components or computers. Appliances for kitchens, workrooms, or hobby areas need outlets above counter height. Outlets should have a grounding receiver (three-prong plug outlet) as standard in all areas for high-electric-use lights, appliances, and components. Multiple-outlet strips—casings with spaced outlets that are prewired or portable—are useful in home workbenches, home ofices, and kitchens. The exact placement of switches and outlets can be determined when the building has been framed. It is common for the client and/or interior designer to meet the electrician at the site and mark the exact location of ixtures, outlets, and switches. There may be a need to adjust placement because of the heat ducts. Before mechanical systems are installed, it is wise to plan where the luminaires, outlets, and switches will be needed.

Contract Wiring The planning of lighting systems in contract complexes and high-rise buildings entails technical studies of lighting needs, electrical code requirements, and restrictions. Contract lighting plans constitute a network of lighting i xtures that are controlled from a central location or are automated. The lighting designer need not visit the site to determine exact location, since contract lighting placement is irmly established by the architectural plans. However, special needs and considerations can be met. Prewired ofice systems that contain outlets for business equipment and lighting are connected to architectural wiring in the wall, ceiling, or loor. Where additional electric plugs are required, multiple outlet strips are commonly installed after the building is completed.

Residential Built-in Systems • Fire alert systems are single or interconnected networks of smoke detectors and heat-sensing devices

(B) Figure 5.30 Typical residential electronic devices include (A) a smoke detector and (B) intercom. Photos © Kathryn Taylor

that alert the occupants of a potential ire hazard. They may emit a shrill whistle or a long or interrupted buzz or beep that will indicate danger. They may be wired or battery operated. • Security systems guard against unlawful entry. They are sensing devices that take many forms. When activated, they may turn on lights, set off alarms, or automatically notify security guards. Security systems can become quite elaborate, even to the point of being connected with the local police dispatcher. Security systems vary dramatically in price and options. • Communication systems in the home are an effective means of communicating from one area to another without raising the voice. The intercom-system wiring should be installed when the home is being built, although radiolike units can be purchased and installed at a later date. The intercom can also pipe music to various rooms, and it enables parents to listen to children in other parts of the house.

Contract Communication and Safety Systems • Wi-Fi can provide public access at Wi-Fi hotspots either free of charge or to subscribers to various commercial services. Organizations such as businesses or institutions provide Wi-Fi to their personnel or students. Airports, hotels, and restaurants often provide free hotspots to attract or assist clients. Wi-Fi may be as large as many square miles when covered by a group of access points with overlapping coverage. Wi-Fi also allows communications directly from one computer or handheld device to another without the involvement of an access point. This is called the ad-hoc mode of Wi-Fi transmission. Wi-Fi also enables wireless voice applications (VoWLAN or WVOIP).

Lighting and Technology

127

(A) Figure 5.31 Wireless Internet access is a standard technology on college campuses where students (A) need places to study with power cord connection and (B) anywhere there is a comfortable and convenient place to open a mini-laptop. Photos © Kathryn Taylor

• Intercom systems allow occupants to talk through wall-mounted or desk units with persons in other areas of the building. In contract installations, the intercom can become rather sophisticated, including loudspeakers and two-way response without pushing buttons. Telephones can also form intercom systems. The intercom may also carry CD or radio music. • Computer networks link personal computers together or connect computer terminals (a keyboard and monitor, or screen) with a mainframe computer (large computer processing unit). This allows workers to call up information and interface (compare or put together) information for projects and business dealings. Computer systems that network outside the immediate building are often linked by telephone systems. • Telephone systems connect workstations, sometimes with a central operator, and allow calls to be trans-

(B)

ferred, put on hold, and computer dialed, among other options. In some ofices telephones can also access information from a computer. • Fire alert systems are mandatory in all contract design. In large complexes, the sensing devices are connected to a central monitor. Sprinkling systems are also required to help ight ires. • Security systems are routinely installed in contract interiors, particularly retail and high-security areas.

This page intentionally left blank

Chapter 6 Space Planning Considerations Prioritizing Needs and Wants 130 Considerations for Specific Areas 138 Space Planning and the Principles and Elements of Design 159 Contract Considerations 164

Christine Oliver Architect/photo © Brian Vanden Brink

130

Chapter 6

Prioritizing Needs and Wants In the space planning process, many things need to be considered before the loor plans are drawn and construction (or demolition and reconstruction) begins. It is far better to make changes on paper than to rip out and reconstruct a space that should have been better planned in the irst place. As part of the design process discussed in Chapter 1, research and programming take place by asking questions. This chapter will address and further explore those questions and present considerations and suggestions for making wise and carefully thought out decisions. Basic human needs include food, shelter, and clothing. All homes provide shelter, a place to prepare and eat food, and space to store and change clothing. Other human needs are to feel safe and accepted through relationships of trust and to rest and restore physical and emotional health. There are also individual needs: to be productive and creative, to successfully accomplish tasks, and, as a result, to feel worthwhile. Residential interiors that meet these needs offer comfortable spaces for interacting socially with others, quiet places in which to rest and be alone in order to rejuvenate, and functional areas for work or performance of tasks. In nonresidential settings, the needs vary according to the function of the space, but they often parallel those listed here. Wants comprise a large category of luxuries. It is human nature to want to improve one’s surroundings and to upgrade to nicer, more convenient and beautiful spaces and furnishings. The justiication is perceived to be an enhanced quality of life. Yet every want or indulgence should be weighed against the need it will fulill and then be compared to the cost it will require—in time, effort and money—and the long-term usefulness of that item. The result is common sense, meaning the planning of space that meets both needs and wants in a reasonable way.

care of household organization, bill paying, and family scheduling. If a business is conducted at home, the work zone might include a professionally equipped home ofice or, in the case of a “cottage industry,” a place for the manufacture and storage of products, perhaps with a separate entrance, if zoning laws permit. The need for employment work space may dictate two or more work zones, as separate areas are often required in order to maintain professionalism. • Social zones include entryways; formal living and dining spaces; and informal family rooms and dining spaces, great rooms, multipurpose or recreation areas, media or home theater rooms; as well as solariums or

Private

Work

Social

(A)

Patio

Bath Bed Storage

Office

Bath Bed

Function First Functional analysis is perhaps the most important of the space planning criteria. Function means the intended use of the space; it can be graphically illustrated as zones, as seen in Figure 6.1. In contract interiors, these zones vary dramatically according to the intended use—from health care to retail, from hospitality to ofice planning. (Suggestions for contract areas are found at the end of this chapter.) However, in the home, there are typically four zones. These zones may be planned in one area each in a loor plan, as seen in the simplicity of Figure 6.1, or they may be planned in separate areas as needs dictate. • Work zones include the kitchen, the laundry, and other task areas such as sewing, tool or repair, and craft or hobby areas, as well as an area or ofice for taking

Kitchen Bed Dining

Entry Garage

Living Room

(B) Figure 6.1 Two phases of schematics or graphics in the evolution of the floor plan. (A) The general zones—private, work, and social. (B) Divisions within these zones for specific rooms and their relationship to one another.

Space Planning Considerations

131

outdoor living spaces. Hallways may be part of the social zones. • Private zones are those allotted for private living: the bedrooms, bathrooms, and private sitting or retreat areas. • Zone within zone may be a feasible solution for speciic tasks. For example, a work zone involving a computer may be placed in a social zone (living, dining, or family room) because space is available there; this arrangement is convenient and doesn’t take the user away from the center of family activity. Or a work zone may be placed within a private zone. A computer station, for instance, could occupy a corner of a bedroom or a private retreat area.

Interrelating Functions At this point, a list or “bubble” of the major zones and where they might be duplicated could be explored. The next task is to determine how many rooms and what speciic functions these zones will contain and how they will interrelate (Figure 6.2a and 6.2b). Typical is the placement of the formal living zone next to the formal dining area, the kitchen next to the service (laundry, garage, or outside-entry) areas, and the bedrooms next to the bathrooms. Include in the list what areas or functions the user wishes to interrelate. There is great latitude for customization in new construction. For example, some clients may request a home ofice in a private, quiet area of the home, while others may want it near the front door or in or near the kitchen. Some prefer the family room open to the kitchen and informal dining (a combination known as the great room), while others want the informal social zone separated from the kitchen. When functions interrelate, or low smoothly from one zone to another, and when the design program is well executed, the result is quality interior design.

(A)

Brainstorming Once the basic zones are established, brainstorming exactly what should occupy those zones is next. Brainstorming is a useful tool for putting down on paper a list of everything that is needed or wanted in each zone. Speciics are listed, from the size of the bathtub to the number of places for shoes and sweaters, how many people will occupy the entry or the outdoor living space, and where each family member will go for solitude. In nonresidential brainstorming sessions, the zoning ideas will center around work productivity, ease of communication, and which functions interrelate. These are also considerations in home planning. One important rule of a brainstorming session, no matter how many prospective users participate, is that every idea be recorded for further consideration and no

(B) Figure 6.2 Work zones in a single kitchen. (A) Food preparation and informal dining. (B) Cookbook storage, meal planning, and home office desk. Photos © Mark Darley/Esto

132

Chapter 6

one be allowed to say anything negative about anyone else’s idea, no matter how absurd it may appear. Rather, the rule is to write down every idea, look for the needs and wants that it may fulill, and allow it to spawn even more creativity. After brainstorming, which can take place in one or several sessions or can be a posted list to which ideas can be added, let some time pass for the ideas to be considered by each work team or family member. Then begin the process of culling out or discarding the ideas that, after careful thought, are not desirable and building on the ones that are feasible and justiiable.

New Construction versus Remodeling Deciding wisely whether to build a new home or remodel an existing one requires careful thought. Construction and remodeling both demand a commitment of time, money, and effort. Consider the following advantages and disadvantages of each option.

Figure 6.3 This new home is a faithful and attractive contemporary recreation of the Craftsman style. Photo © David A. Taylor

Figure 6.4 New construction allows the home owner to select the location and orientation, customize the plan, and use the newest materials and technology. Design by Sally Weston Associates/photo © Brian Vanden Brink

Space Planning Considerations

New Construction Building a home from the ground up requires architector engineered-approved blueprints drawn in accordance with local zoning laws and any restrictive covenants for the area or development, a building permit approved by the municipality, someone to oversee the construction, and building inspectors to ensure that the work is sound and safe and meets the local laws known as building codes. The advantages of new construction are these: • The location and orientation of the home on the site can be custom selected. • There is satisfaction in designing and building a unique, personal space that has never before been occupied. • The plan can be completely customized as to number, placement, and shape of rooms, site orientation, exterior style, and window and door openings. • New construction can incorporate the newest developments in building materials, technology, wiring, heating and cooling and communication systems, plumbing and other ixtures, and inish materials. • New materials require less upkeep because of their newness. Wisely chosen, they can be relatively maintenance free and aesthetically pleasing for many years to come. • The space is unoccupied during construction. There is no need to live with or work in the mess. The disadvantages of new construction include: • Costs for new construction are almost always higher than the costs of buying existing structures. Both material and labor costs have risen sharply in the past decade.

(A)

133

• The time frame typically extends longer in reality than in the estimate. This can cause frustration and problems with moving or current occupancy. • Travel to and from the site is time consuming. • The need to oversee the construction, even with a general contractor, is real. The owner should be a part of the process to determine if the interim results are satisfactory.

Remodeling Remodeling is a process that has a wide scope. A remodel can be as small as adding a closet or building in a water fountain or as large as doubling the size of the building or home through a major addition. Some remodeling requires building permits, contracts with those who will perform all or parts of the work, and major time and expense. Other remodeling projects can be accomplished in a short time by the owner or subcontractors. Remodeling often entails demolition and reconstruction, again, as a large or small project. Remodeling assumes that parts of the building or home are satisfactory but others need rework to make them more functional. However, sometimes a building or home will be completely gutted, interior walls realigned, and new electrical, plumbing, and HVAC systems installed. The advantages of remodeling are these: • Relocation can be avoided. This is a major reason why most people remodel. Business location or residential neighborhood, friends, schools, and proximity to shopping and services may be so advantageous that there is no desire to uproot and move. • Changes in an existing plan can take place one at a time, over a long time, with much less pressure to

(B)

Figure 6.5 Remodeling can be a large or small project, allowing the family to stay in their chosen neighborhood and create a more livable and beautiful space. (A) Before: This modest cottage-style home was purchased and gutted, creating new rooms, an addition to the back, and (B) After: a new front, or façade, complete with new windows and roofing. Photos © David A. Taylor

134

Chapter 6

result. There is no need to give up what works or what you love about the space; just improve it to work out the little things that may be causing current frustration or not meeting a need. • Older homes, with their vintage charms and historical character, often need upgrading of the structure or of electrical, plumbing, or HVAC systems. They may also have too many small rooms for today’s lifestyles, or the owner may desire to remove previous remodeling to restore the home or building to a prior or original loor plan. Historic buildings and homes are often adapted to new uses; an old warehouse can become new ofices, an old home can become a boutique, or a barn can become a home through the process of remodeling. (A)

(B) Figure 6.6 (A) Before: Inside, the kitchen cabinets and plumbing, and the wall to the left, were removed during the remodel. (B) After: The old kitchen wall was to the left in this new family room. The new, more spacious kitchen is in the addition. This remodeled space is handsome, livable, and meets the needs of the family. Photos (A) © David A. Taylor; (B) © Kathryn Taylor



• • •

accomplish than new construction. There is time to live with the idea, plan it out carefully, execute it in a way that suits the owner or occupant, and control the size or scale of the project. Remodels can be accomplished in stages or in parts of the structure and by various individuals or teams. A general contractor or remodeler may do the work, or the owner may hire professionals, such as a framer, plumber, electrician, drywall installer, or painter, or may elect a do-it-yourself approach. The cost may be less than that of new construction, depending on the extent of the remodel, who does the work, and how it is accomplished. The area to be remodeled may not dramatically affect living or working in the space. The great features of a building or home can be kept while upgrading. This often produces a very satisfying

The disadvantages of remodeling are as follows: • Living with the mess is an emotional and physical strain. It may cause people to be irritable and put strain on relationships. Moving out during a remodel is often advisable, depending on the extent and location of the remodel. This also requires effort, is expensive and time consuming, and is dificult for everyone involved. • The presence of subcontractors in the work or living space impinges on privacy and disrupts routines. • Removing walls sometimes yields a surprise. It’s not uncommon, especially in older buildings, to discover unexpected conditions, such as a hidden ireplace or chimney lue, rotted loorboards or ceiling joists, or a complete change in building methods. These will require more time and money to correct and at times may completely alter the master plan; what you thought you could do may not be possible after all. • Whether or not there are unhappy surprises, making decisions and discussing the project as it progresses is necessary, takes time, and can be stressful. In both the new construction and remodeling processes, a few rules apply: • Each is a dificult process; it is physically, mentally, and emotionally exhausting to build or remodel. Many decisions must be made, and disagreement is common. Cooperation and negotiating will help save sanity and preserve relationships. • Not everything runs smoothly. Problems arise in delivery, materials, interpretation, and workmanship. These frustrations can cause bad feelings and real frustration. Murphy’s law applies: If anything can go wrong, it will. • Most projects take longer than anticipated—especially if the project is a DIY (do-it-yourself), which typically takes two to three times what was originally estimated. • Costs often go up as decisions are made to upgrade to a better product or expand the plan in some way. Ideally this should not happen if thorough research has been done in advance and commitments to speciic

Space Planning Considerations

135

products have been made. However, there are many variables, particularly in remodeling. When the demolition portion of the remodel begins, the structure or new perspective of the space will often change the master plan a little and may require extra structural support, upgraded wiring, or repair of other defects. Sometimes you don’t know exactly what you’re working with until the walls come down. • People doing the work may not always use the techniques you would choose. Also, if they have other projects going on at the same time and therefore must divide their time, they may not come to your job consistently. Waiting for subcontractors is a common frustration. • The necessity of having building inspectors often costs additional time, effort, and money. They typically ind more things to be ixed with each inspection and will not issue an occupancy permit until all their demands are satisied.

Economic Considerations Economy is an important consideration in planning space. In most cases, new construction will have a inancial limit (a maximum amount that can be spent) imposed by the client or by the lending institution. Therefore, the architect, designer, and builder, as well as the client or homeowner, need to make careful and wise decisions concerning the amount of space. This is because the actual square footage is proportional to the cost of the building or home. Total price is estimated on a cost per square foot. The cost per square foot will vary according to the Figure 6.7 An unused attic in an existing home can be turned into useful location, the building materials used, the amount space like this guest suite. Alan Freysinger Architect/Christina Oliver Interior of skilled labor involved, and the number of luxury Design/photo © Brian Vanden Brink items incorporated. a steeper pitch in the roof, the attic space can become A total building cost of $100 per square foot (exnot only livable but charming because of its angles and cluding the building lot or property costs) can be calcunooks. In the case of basements, there may be need for a lated as follows: crawl space or, where there is a deep frost line that would 1. An 800-square-foot building would cost approxirequire sinking a deeper foundation, this space can be mately $80,000. extended to become living space. Basements are a mod2. A 1,200-square-foot building would be about $120,000. est addition to the initial building cost in most cases. The 3. A 2,000-square-foot building would cost $200,000. attic or basement space may be framed with the home but inished at a later date, offering added living space as the Therefore, smaller total square footage means lower need arises. Therefore, the initial cost of the home would building costs when building one-story or main-levelnot relect the potential of that addition of living space only homes. in a high cost per square foot. In this way, a home with However, second-story and basement living space is half-story and basement space can be more affordable in less costly to construct than main-loor living space. This the long run than a home of the same square footage on is because the roof and foundation can serve all levels one level only. and because plumbing and electrical systems can be centralized and ireplaces stacked. Further, room inside an Financing attic (termed a “half story”) can be quite economical since While a fortunate few home owners can afford to spend the attic space would often be there anyway. With the limitless amounts of money on their projects, most addition of dormer windows or skylights and perhaps

136

Chapter 6

Table 6.1

Comparison of Monthly Mortgage Payment

Principal and Interest Only—Fixed Rates 15-Year Loan

30-Year Loan

Loan Amount

6% Interest

8% Interest

10% Interest

Loan Amount

6% Interest

8% Interest

10% Interest

$100,000 $140,000 $180,000

$843 $1,181 $1,518

$955 $1,337 $1,720

$1,074 $1,504 $1,934

$100,000 $140,000 $180,000

$599 $839 $1,079

$733 $1,027 $1,320

$877 $1,228 $1,579

Totals: When the Loan Is Paid in Full, the Following Amounts Will Have Been Paid: 15-Year Loan

[ [ [

30-Year Loan

] [ ] [ ] [

$100,000 at 6% ($843⫻180 payments)⫽$151,740 $100,000 at 8% ($955⫻180 payments)⫽$171,900 $100,000 at 10% ($1,074⫻180 payments)⫽$193,320 $140,000 at 6% ($1,181⫻180 payments)⫽$212,580 $140,000 at 8% ($1,337⫻180 payments)⫽$240,660 $140,000 at 10% ($1,504⫻180 payments)⫽$270,720 $180,000 at 6% ($1,518⫻180 payments)⫽$273,240 $180,000 at 8% ($1,720⫻180 payments)⫽$309,600 $180,000 at 10% ($1,934⫻180 payments)⫽$348,120

$100,000 at 6% ($599⫻360 payments)⫽$215,640 $100,000 at 8% ($733⫻360 payments)⫽$263,880 $100,000 at 10% ($877⫻360 payments)⫽$315,720 $140,000 at 6% ($839⫻360 payments)⫽$302,040 $140,000 at 8% ($1,027⫻360 payments)⫽$369,720 $140,000 at 10% ($1,228⫻360 payments)⫽$442,080 $180,000 at 6% ($1,079⫻360 payments)⫽$388,440 $180,000 at 8% ($1,320⫻360 payments)⫽$475,200 $180,000 at 10% ($1,579⫻360 payments)⫽$568,440

] ] ]

NOTES: • As shown above, for a 15-year loan, the cost of the loan when paid in full is between one-and-one-half and two times the loan amount. For a 30-year loan, it is from two to three times the loan amount. • Lenders apply the payments in such a way that most of the interest is paid at the beginning of the loan. By increasing the amount of principal paid each month, the borrower can shorten the term of the loan. For example, an additional $50 a month applied to the principal on a 30-year loan can reduce the years of payment to around 14 to 18 years. Making a half-monthly payment every two weeks—a convenient schedule for borrowers who receive a paycheck twice a month—is another way to reduce the overall loan term. • This chart calculates principal and interest only. Property taxes and home owners or hazard insurance will increase payment amounts, to be held in escrow by the lending institution or paid directly by the home owner. • Mortgage payments typically include money to be set aside, or escrowed, for home owners insurance and property taxes. Some borrowers are also required to carry private mortgage insurance (PMI). The calculations in this table do not include these amounts, nor do they include loan origination costs such as points or commitment fees. • The hypothetical mortgages in this table are ixed-rate loans. Payment calculations for adjustable-rate or balloon mortgages would be signiicantly different from the calculations shown here.

building and remodeling are governed by what the clients can afford. Financing the project often entails taking out a loan. The amount of money a person or family can borrow is based on credit history plus guidelines and ratios for debt management. A general rule is that a home purchase price should not exceed two and one-half times the annual income. Housing costs (mortgage payment, property taxes, insurance, utilities, repairs, maintenance, and any cooperative or condominium fees) should not exceed 28 percent of the gross monthly income. This housing-to-income ratio is expressed: Housing costs = 28% or Less Gross Income A second guideline expressed as a ratio is debt-toincome, where debt including housing costs plus other

long-term debts (more than ten months to repay) should not exceed 36 percent of the gross monthly income: Housing costs + Debts = 36% or Less Gross Income

Other Factors That Affect Economy in Planning Home Space • Interest rates also affect the cost of the payments and, hence, whether or not the home or building can be afforded. Table 6.1 lists examples for monthly payments of ixed-interest loans of $100,000, $140,000, and $180,000 at 6, 8, and 10 percent over both 15 and 30 years. These amounts represent only the principal and interest, however; they do not take into account escrow amounts required for taxes and insurance,

Space Planning Considerations

• •



Figure 6.8 Economy in home planning has much to do with space allocation. Here, scaled-down, smaller appliances have upscale features, meaning they are right for today’s more modest square footage homes. Photo courtesy of GE Appliances & Lighting



which can easily add up to another $200 or $300 a month. • Environmentally sound building and furnishing materials, such as ICFs (see Chapter 7), will stay functional for many years, thus avoiding replacement and high energy consumption. Likewise, modest square footage

Table 6.2





137

and standard-sized ceilings cost less to build, inish, heat, and cool. This is considered long-term economy. The cubic footage affects the cost. Areas with very high ceilings will be more costly to construct because of the additional building materials required. Simple building shapes contribute to economy. A home with many jogs, angles, gables (roof points), and dormers (windows in the roof) will make the cost per square foot rise, increasing the cost of the interior space. The closer the home is to a simple box, the more economical it will be to build. Long-range space planning can be a boon to saving money. When a space is to be inished or remodeled at a later date, structural planning or framing can accommodate the future changes. For example, if a room will one day adjoin another via French doors, the framework for that doorway can be put in place as the home is built, thus avoiding major remodeling. The exterior style and shape should always be taken into consideration when planning additions so that the home will look as though the addition belonged there all along, not as if it were an awkward afterthought. Careful space planning will reduce the frustrations and increase the rewards of an eventual remodel. Economy can be increased by planning to avoid unusable wasted space or poor trafic patterns. The proper scale and proportion of rooms in relation to the interior space should be considered. This means judging the intended function of the area and planning square and cubic footage to meet the demands for that space. (Table 6.2 lists several types of rooms/ functions and typical dimensions and/or square footage for moderate rooms versus large rooms.) Economy is evident when the size of rooms allows the user to function without crowding or frustration. A

Residential Space Planning for the Human Scale

Room/Function

Moderate

Large Size

Entry

35 sq. ft.

over 35 sq. ft.

Hall

3 ft. wide

4 ft. wide

Living room

13⫻15 (195 sq. ft.)

18⫻30 (540 sq. ft.)

Kitchen

8⫻12 (96 sq. ft.)

12⫻16 (192 sq. ft.)

Great room

12⫻20 (240 sq. ft.)

20⫻30 (600 sq. ft.)

Family room

13⫻18 (234 sq. ft.)

15⫻25 (375 sq. ft.)

Dining room/area

10⫻13 (130 sq. ft.)

13⫻16 (208 sq. ft.)

Bathroom

5⫻10 (50 sq. ft.)

10⫻15 (150 sq. ft.)

Bedroom

10⫻12 (120 sq. ft.)

15⫻20 (300 sq. ft.)

Two-car garage

22⫻22 (484 sq. ft.)

25⫻40 (1,000 sq. ft.)

138

Chapter 6

space that is too small can necessitate costly expansion by remodeling. • It can be economical to double up purposes in an area, called a multiuse area, and to make space appear larger than it is.

Features and Benefits The motivator for building or remodeling is rooted in function; users have functional needs and wants that are not being fulilled by the features of their existing home. Knowing that the process is going to be dificult, lengthy, and costly, people are willing to endure these inconveniences because they envision a home with design solutions that will provide a better environment for rest, recreation, work, or other activities. One of the irst things an individual or family should do when considering building or remodeling is to make a wish list (see Table 6.3), an extensive list of the features the users want and the reasons why they want them. It is important to take a hard, realistic look at the “why” during this brainstorming stage. As the best designs are based on wants justiied by needs, the “why” will determine how seriously a given feature is needed. An attractive or fashionable feature that will be only rarely used by anyone in the household is probably not a good investment. In fact, there may be a variety of design features that will convey the same beneit, so after giving careful consideration to function, the user may end up choosing an entirely different feature from the one originally named. The more beneits a feature can provide, the more likely it is to be a viable option.

Considerations for Specific Areas Several areas need in-depth thinking through before the loor plans are drawn. These include the entry, formal living spaces, the home ofice, the kitchen/great room, the master suite, indoor-outdoor living spaces, children’s rooms, bathrooms, work and hobby areas, and other special-use areas. Consider the guidelines below.

The Entry or Foyer An entryway allows for trafic to low to all areas of the house without having to cross a main or formal living space. • There should be ample room to accommodate the number of people who would occupy the space at any given time. If entertaining is customary, an entry or foyer larger than 35 square feet (approximately 5 feet ⫻ 7 feet) should be considered.

• Two-story open entryways, or atria, are dramatic and impressive. They allow for grand chandeliers and sweeping staircases. However, they typically have windows above the doorway that are ill-proportioned and allow a clear view into the upper story, radically diminishing privacy.

Formal Living Spaces Living rooms, dining rooms, and showcase dens or libraries seen from the entry or foyer are considered formal living spaces. • Formal living spaces are typically separated from the kitchen and other work spaces. This allows them to stay more tidy, and precious furnishings placed in them can be protected. • Formal spaces are ideal for reclusiveness and study, music listening or rehearsal, formal gatherings and dinners. They provide a restrained, subdued atmosphere and encourage seemly behavior. • Formal living spaces may be occupied so infrequently that they are economically dificult to justify.

Home Office Planning Planning Home Office Functions Ofice space in the home has become a necessity for a great many individuals and families as telecommuting, home-based businesses, and computer management of personal inances continue to rise in popularity. As with other space planning, it is best to consider function before making other decisions about the home ofice. Here are some of the possible functions the ofice may fulill: • “Home base,” where a worker who has a conventional ofice can accomplish work during nonofice hours or sit while resolving “on-call” emergencies • Work area for an employee who telecommutes full- or part-time • Accommodation for a home-based business, which may or may not call for additional employees or customers to spend periods of time in the house • Household inancial center, where personal bills are paid and tax returns prepared • Internet-access and study area for adults and/or children On the basis of the functions the ofice needs to fulill, consider the issues below. Some users may decide that their home needs more than one ofice space to meet all their needs. • Will more than one user utilize the ofice space at the same time or different times? • Does quiet and privacy play a role in the work to be done? If so, then having a separate room that is not

Space Planning Considerations

Table 6.3

139

The Wish List: Features and Benefits

Here are a few features that are popular in today’s homes, along with some of their beneits. While it would be unusual to ind all these features in one home or on an individual user’s wish list, think of this table as the springboard for an actual wish list. (Other wish-list ideas are found in the section “Considerations for Speciic Areas.”)

Features

Benefits

Water Indoor or outdoor fountain or wall of cascading water; pond

Spa, large jetted tub and/or swimming pool Built-in saltwater fish tank

To calm and refresh emotionally To humidify in dry climates To provide a focal point for conversation or solitary seating areas Therapeutic effects; social experience; exercise and recreation To support a hobby and love for water and living organisms

Heating Alternatives Indoor or outdoor fireplace or cooking station

Solar heating Warmed bathroom floors, heated towel bars

To establish a cozy hearth-and-home feeling To provide an aesthetic focal point A place for people to gather The heat will be needed and is a good source of heat As an alternative place for food preparation To conserve nonrenewable energy resources To physically and mentally benefit from the healthful effects of sunlight indoors To give greater physical and emotional comfort To augment heat in an area that may tend to be cold during personal grooming

Technology Home automation: Video-accessible security system Upgraded wiring for Internet access Intercom wiring and surround-sound speakers throughout the home or building Livable technology (incorporating the latest technology in a livable human atmosphere)

Ensure security for valuable possessions Mental and emotional peace of mind Full participation in the information age Research/business communication Communication with others without raising the voice Music everywhere To focus on comfort and coziness first with convenient access to technology

Living with Nature: Feeding the Spirit Natural materials (wood, tile, stone, including tumbled marble, granite countertops, stainless steel plumbing fixtures and appliances) Outdoor living spaces (including fireplace; large porch, lanai, or patio with a variety of flooring, with roof or pergola beams or open) Large windows* Spaces that feed the spirit: Zen gardens, Chinese Feng Shui design features (wind chimes, plants, mirrors, furniture placement), water garden, tabletop fountain, candles or low lighting, aromatherapy or home fragrance

Classic, timeless look that allows design flexibility for years to come Low maintenance and inherent beauty To extend the living space to the out-of-doors To give an alternative place for eating, conversation, work, and recreation To maximize view, enhance light, bring the outdoors visually inside To counterpoint the stresses of modern life To enhance a feeling of well-being To create peace in the interior, thereby enhancing communication, relationships, and personal emotional stability

*These dictate costly window treatments and may let in too much heat and light and too much cold and dark. Source: Adapted from trend reports from the National Association of Home Builders (NAHB). Go to the Interiors website for the NAHB and other website addresses. (continued)

140

Chapter 6

Table 6.3

The Wish List: Features and Benefits (continued)

Soothing music via surround sound Exercise or personal spa room (with fitness equipment, television, and massage table)

To utilize technology to calm and balance A safe, convenient exercise/health area To work out and be informed; to relax and heal

Function and Storage Increased storage (deeper and more drawers versus cabinets, huge closets, storage dormers) Refrigerated or warming kitchen drawers, wine storage, wet bar Stepped custom cabinetry, various finishes Moldings (everywhere from kitchen to home office) Upscale kitchen (integrated and computer-connected appliances, open to dining, conversation, outdoor living areas) Lots of drawers and custom kitchen island

Ergonomically easier to use Open organization for seasonal storage Storage at point of use Architectural interest in taller rooms Attention to detail and the finishing touches Kitchens are now total centers of entertainment and living

Storage and space for gatherings of people

Personalized Design Minimalist design, nostalgic design

Select a style, then plan with design in mind

Figure 6.9 The wish list of features and benefits may include outdoor living by a swimming pool. Photo © Brian Vanden Brink

Figure 6.10 This zenlike space with indoor water feature is a perfect spot for a rejuvenating massage for those seeking a natural and healthy lifestyle. This space is in an upstairs loft with a skylight—a quiet and possibly unused spot in the floor plan. Design by The Green Company/photo © Brian Vanden Brink

Space Planning Considerations

Figure 6.11 This entry or foyer is a sunny place filled with lightly scaled, functional furniture and family treasures that personalize this home and welcome family and friends. Design by McMillan Architects/photo © Brian Vanden Brink

near the noise or activity center is wise planning. Where work is ongoing or creates a necessary mess, it is wise to plan for a room with a door that can close and even lock. • Plan for shelves, iling cabinets, and closets or furniture that can hold items that need to be stored. These might include boxes of computer paper, extra ofice supplies, noncurrent iles, and reports or client or school information that should be saved.

Figure 6.12 A formal living space with formal traditional furniture is a pleasant and refined place for alone time or quiet gatherings. Photo courtesy of Focal Point Architectural Products, Inc., Tarboro, NC, www.focalpointproducts.com

141

142

Chapter 6

Figure 6.13 The home office can be a separate room where work can be contained in a handsome, exclusive setting. Here, custom storage cabinetry is complemented with stone countertops and light-controlling window blinds, custom textile treatments, and well-planned layered lighting. Design by Sheila K. Tilander, CKD, CBD; Showplace Design & Remodeling/Photography: Roger Turk/Northlight Photography/NKBA Design Competition

Figure 6.14 This home office is located in an upstairs balcony or loft of a Modern, open floor plan home where all family members can see and hear what is happening on the computer. This can safeguard against inappropriate computer use. Design by Group 3; Builder: Hankin Group/photo © Brian Vanden Brink

Space Planning Considerations

• Allot space for a work table for projects that need storing or will be worked on over an extended period. • Make a list of the electronic equipment desired or necessary for the computer. Such peripherals might include a printer, scanner, photocopier, fax machine, and phone with caller ID or answering machine. Also list the items that are routinely used in the ofice, including everything from the tape dispenser to the stapler, pen holder, and paper clips. “A place for everything, and everything in its place” is a key to a well-organized ofice, higher work eficiency, and less stress. • Many computer-holding furniture pieces are designed to close up so that when the work is done, the computer area can be closed to view. • If the ofice will double as another room, plan space to accommodate furniture for that other room.

Where to Locate the Home Office Once the functional issues of the home ofice—or ofices—are examined and the equipment needed to support the functions is identiied, then space within the home can be chosen. In addition to using a laptop or notebook anywhere, here are some location possibilities: • On the main loor, just off the entry. This is a good location if the ofice will never be untidy and if clients are expected to come to the front door. • At a separate entrance, if the ofice accommodates many clients or delivery personnel or an employee or two. • Near the kitchen in a location that is easily seen and accessible. Monitoring the use of the Internet has become a priority for many parents in order to protect their family members from exposure to inluences conlicting with family standards. This area might be a den, family or great room, or even a hallway within sight of major trafic patterns. It is best kept away from the actual food preparation/cooking area but easily seen from there. Some families need more than one computer, and when monitoring is a priority, space planning for carrels or long electrically wired tables takes special thought. • At a desk within the kitchen. This is convenient for the daily routine, but the desk should be kept outside the major work triangle(s) of the kitchen. The advantage is that cooking, family interaction, and supervising of others’ activities can take place simultaneously. The disadvantage is that it is dificult or impossible to concentrate where there is noise. • In a bedroom with a door that can close. This may be on the main loor, upstairs, or even in a basement. The advantage is quiet seclusion for long periods of writing or study. It is also good to be able to shut a door when the day’s work is over. If the ofice is in sight, the work seems to beckon at all hours. Peace of mind

143

in being able to leave and forget a home ofice is very important. Disadvantages to this location include the isolation from what’s going on in the home and the risk of other users accessing undesirable Internet sites. • In a living room, family room, or dining room. Any of these rooms can house a home ofice, particularly when the computer-housing furniture is handsome and has doors that can close over the equipment and work in progress. • A corner of a bedroom. This is an acceptable location when the use will not disturb other occupants and when the work does not get in the way of the user’s ability to relax and leave the work. The advantage is being able to work in privacy, in any dress mode, and at any hour of the day. These features can also constitute disadvantages. • Multiple locations. It is not uncommon for adults who use their ofice for employment or professional projects to be unwilling to allow other users into their space and at their equipment. One solution to this dilemma is to plan for a child’s computer station near the adult home ofice.

The Library The library has been incorporated into many new homes in recent years. Even in this information age, with all the advantages of learning online, nothing can take the place of holding a book in hand or reading a book to a child. Bookcases can be beautiful, and a room with books can set the stage for a lifetime of literacy and learning, thereby enhancing the quality of life. • Location: A library can be a separate room with doors that close (consider pocket or French doors) or can be incorporated into the family room section of the great room or be a part of the home ofice or the master suite. A formal living room can double as a library, and so can a formal den just off the entryway. Formal dining tables are often underutilized, so dining rooms can make good libraries with the addition of an armchair or other comfortable seating beyond the dining table. • Bookcases can be ceiling to loor, located in segments around the room or in an open loft above a family or living area. Lower bookcases can be for children’s books, memory books or scrapbooks, and educational learning toys. Upper bookcases can hold the treasured and valuable books that are for mature readers. Planning for custom cabinetry, shelves, and cupboards at this wish-list stage is a good idea so that the space will be adequate. • Good lighting is a must. Plan to wire for lighting that washes or spotlights the bookcases and gives good illumination to reading and study areas. Windows in a library give the eyes a chance to rest and to ponder

144

Chapter 6

Figure 6.15 This home library features custom-built bookshelves, comfortable seating, general and task lighting, and a handsome fireplace. These components create a refined and pleasant place for reading, learning, contemplating, and a special place for intimate chats between family members and close friends. Design by Scholz & Barclay Architects/photo © Brian Vanden Brink

what’s being read and are a must for a computer station, where eyestrain should be relieved every few minutes by looking off into the distance for at least a few seconds. • Plan adequate space for comfortable seating. For solitary reading, consider support furnishings such as a footstool, table and lamp, and blanket or throw; for group reading sessions, plan to have one or more love seats or sofas with a coffee table and end tables for laying down books. • Consider a table or desk where the user can sit down and spread books out for research or homework. • A ireplace is often desirable in a library to give warmth and emotional comfort.

Kitchen and Great Room Planning The kitchen has long been the hub of the home, but in recent decades it has taken on a multifaceted role. No longer a room where all cabinetry has to match or the single working triangle is the norm, today’s kitchen is the room where a majority of living and interacting takes place, and it is designed with space and equipment for a variety of activities. A great room is an area that comprises three formerly separate spaces: kitchen, dining, and family room. The following suggestions may be just a beginning; many good books on kitchen planning are available. Certiied Kitchen Designers (CKDs) or Certiied Kitchen and Bath Designers (CKBDs) can create optimum kitchen and great room spaces. See the Interiors website

Space Planning Considerations

145

Figure 6.16 Two well-planned kitchens. (A) This Modern kitchen features a cooktop, or range, in the center of the longest wall with plenty of countertop for food preparation on each side. Double wall ovens to the left aid in baking efficiently. The island features the sink/ cleanup zone, allowing a view to the great room while at work. Bar stools show informal dining, with the dining table with pendant lighting and a dinnerware storage hutch to the right. (B) This HGTV Dream House kitchen in Farm Country style also features a central cook space, this one with a large gas cook surface and double lower ovens and space to each side. Double refrigerators flank the preparation area and a pantry at the right gives ample space for food and a butler’s pantry for serving items. The sink is in the center of a large food preparation and serving island with dining table nearby. (A) Design by Gioi Tran, Co-Designers: Meghan Nohr; Applegate Tran Interiors/Photography: Dave Adams/NKBA Design Competition; (B) photo courtesy of HGTV

(A)

for pertinent website addresses. When working with building construction professionals who specialize in kitchens and remodeling, check out their references and visit remodeled kitchens they completed, and be sure that contracts are signed that spell out everyone’s responsibilities. Kitchens and great rooms may include these features: • Areas for preparation of snacks and quick meals, larger family meals, formal meals, and meals for event crowds • A quick-eating bar or island or some other informal dining area, with access to formal dining • Space for events or parties where participating in cooking and interaction of the guests is part of the fun (B) • Space for home ofice duties: taking care of family inances, doing Internet shopping or research, running a business, or having children do homework at a computer station • Casual, comfortable seating for conversation, music and video/television, and entertaining • Direct access to mudroom, laundry room, and outside service areas

Features and Trends for Kitchens and Great Rooms • With the advent of multiple users, kitchens may feature duplicate workstations, appliances, and ixtures,

such as two ovens, two microwaves (one near the eating area, one in the cooking area), two refrigerators, two sinks, and two dishwashers. These may or may not be located next to each other; more likely they are not, except for the double ovens. • Multiple islands, one for food preparation and one for serving. • Drawers that contain warming ovens, and refrigerator drawers.

146

Chapter 6

• Cabinets that are architecturally beautiful, with various heights (stepped cabinetry), moldings, and pieces that look like furniture rather than cabinets. Thematic styles, such as Traditional, Modern, Arts and Crafts, Shaker, Country French, and American Country, provide the basis for wall, window, and loor coverings as well as furniture and accessories. • Walk-in pantry and cabinetry with special features such as rolling shelves and pull-out panels, bins, and work surfaces. • Universal design elements, such as surfaces that are safe to walk on, good lighting to decrease accidents, electricity located away from plumbing and water, lockout options on ranges and ovens, water temperature– regulating devices, and safe cooktops. • Appliance features are now so numerous that research and comparison is a must. Many models offer a chip that allows operation to be monitored on the home computer or handheld digital assistant. See the Web addresses for appliance companies on the Interiors website. • Special placement may be designed for cabinetry and appliances to accommodate the needs of the wheelchair bound or ambulatory impaired. Likewise, think safety and empowerment through good planning for children and adolescents, who will use the kitchen when home alone. • More than one working triangle and various working zones to meet the needs of multiple users. • The return of the Butler’s Pantry. A separate room or open as an appendage to the kitchen, it contains cabinetry to hold larger serving dishes and extra tableware, and it often houses an extra sink, dishwasher, and refrigerator.

Zones and the Working Triangle Kitchen planning includes working arrangements in zones or work areas. Three zones are considered the basic working triangle: • The refrigerator zone • The cooking zone (range and ovens) • The sink/cleanup zone

Figure 6.17 This Old World kitchen features Energy Star appliances from GE, fitted beautifully into custom cabinetry. Stone and wood contrast beautifully with white traditionally styled cabinetry and the dark-stained dinnerware hutch. Photo courtesy of GE Appliances & Lighting

Total walking distance among these three areas should not be fewer than 12 feet (too crowded—produces frustration) and not more than 26 feet (too spread out—leads to exhaustion). Where multiple cooks work together, two basic work triangles may be planned. Other zones that add convenience and are considered essential to modern kitchens include any or all of the following: • • • • • • •

Additional food storage zones Various specialized food preparation zones A second cooking zone and/or a quick-cooking zone A second cleanup/sink zone Tableware storage zone(s) Serving and service storage zone Cleaning supplies storage zone

These zones should be planned for the convenience and consideration of the family members who cook and should be laid out logically according to individual needs. However, certain checkpoints, presented in Tables 6.4 and 6.5, are fairly consistent. Part of the kitchen planning process is deciding which types of appliances to purchase; making selections among the many makes, styles, and options of those appliances; and making sure the cabinetry dimensions will accommodate them with precision. Table 6.5 lists the major types or categories of appliances and surveys options and considerations in their selection and placement.

The Laundry Room Because the laundry room features permanent cabinetry and stationary appliances, foresight and lexibility in

Space Planning Considerations

Table 6.4

147

Cabinetry Considerations for Kitchen Zone Planning

Food Storage Cabinetry Food storage can be divided into three main categories: 1. Perishables: These items require refrigeration or freezing. 2. Regularly used dry food supplies: Foods used on a daily basis such as lour (lour bin drawers with metal liners are available), baking powders, spices and supplies, boxed cereal, various pastas, rice, and legumes. These should be located in the kitchen near the zone where they will be used in food preparation or cooking. Generally, the lour and heavy supplies go in the lower cabinets and smaller supplies above. A spice rack or specially designed cabinet is desirable to keep spices organized and handy. A cabinet or cupboard speciically for boxed cereal or for items such as sugar, cornmeal, popcorn, rice, beans, and other legumes may be preferred. The shelf heights should be adjustable and the interiors must be easily cleaned. 3. Staples and canned goods: Occasionally used. These might be located in a pantry or larder—a wall of cabinets or a walk-in closet. By keeping extra supplies in the pantry, the cook can save kitchen space and cut down on trips to the store. The pantry may also be located between the kitchen and dining room as a place from which to serve food to the formal dining room. An extension of the concept of the pantry is the food storage room that is located in a cool area (such as a basement), and that stores staples, cases of food (such as canned goods), lour, cooking supplies, legumes, other items with a long shelf life (which replenish the pantry supply), and bulky cooking pots and pans. Underground storage space may also be designed to include a root cellar and/or wine cellar.

Food Preparation Countertop/Cabinet-Top Areas Determine the kind of food preparation that will take place and plan countertop areas accordingly. In kitchens where much food preparation takes place, a minimum of two long counters (over 3 feet) are required. An island or a peninsula often provides wide countertops. Where bread is frequently mixed, a large area near lour bins and cooking supplies is imperative. If vegetables are often chopped, cutting boards that are built into the countertop or that pull out near the sink will be appreciated. Some kitchens are planned with two or more cutting boards of various sizes—larger ones for mixing,

smaller ones for cutting. As another example, if candymaking is a specialty, a separate area with supplies nearby and a counter of marble is ideal. The type of food preparation, then, should be the topic of careful consideration in planning the size and location of countertop or cabinet-top space. There may be a small sink for food preparation and a large sink for cleanup, often placed in an island or peninsula. Cooking containers such as pots and pans need to be close to the range or cooktop. Cupboards with sliding drawers eliminate awkward hunting situations. Vertical panels hold cooking sheets, dripper pans, mufin tins, and other lat dishes upright and should be located near the oven where they are used. Cooking utensils can be located in drawers near the stove, placed in a crock, or hung on the wall. Items used every day should be most convenient. An appliance garage consists of cabinet doors on the countertop with space behind to hide portable appliances; sliding shelves in lower cabinets can also hold appliances, and electric plugs can be installed inside these special cupboards. Cabinets can be designed with solid or glass doors (or without any doors at all) and to hold any special item.

Cleanup Cabinetry Cabinets for cleaning supplies need to be planned near the sink. Typically, the cabinet beneath the sink contains everyday cleaning supplies and often a trash can. A separate, taller cupboard keeps the smell away from the sink and allows for a larger trash can (trash compactors are discussed in Table 6.5). A broom closet should be planned to make brooms, mops, and vacuum cleaners conveniently accessible. Towels and washcloths should be handy to the sink. A rack for dish towels that slides into the lower cabinets helps to control clutter and to keep towels dry and more sanitary. A drawer or two should be allotted for clean kitchen linen. Drawers should be added for extra paper towels or cleaning cloths or rags, paper or plastic garbage bags, and extra disposable items such as rubber gloves or scouring pads.

Tableware Storage Cabinetry Cabinetry for tableware includes cupboards for plates, dishes, and stemware (cups, glasses). Lower cabinets next to the dishwasher

(continued)

148

Chapter 6

Table 6.4

Cabinetry Considerations for Kitchen Zone Planning (continued)

might hold dishes for everyday use (children can then easily set the table), and upper cabinets could contain special, breakable tableware. Drawers should be planned for silverware, placemats, cloth or paper napkins, and folded tablecloths; a closet can be used for hanging tablecloths (pressed and ready for special occasions). A set of shelves for centerpieces and vases is valuable.

Dining Cabinetry Islands and peninsula eating bars augment or even replace the conventional table in many of today’s kitchens. The bar may accommodate two or more stools or chairs, depending on the number of people in the household. The bar is planned and built as a part of the cabinets; it may contain drawers, cupboards, or appliances on one or two sides. It may double as a desk or contain a space for a computer. It may have no cabinets and function as a cabinet-top eating surface with only bar-stool space beneath it. The bar, island, or peninsula may also be lowered so that shorter bar stools or standard chairs can be used, rather than tall bar stools.

(A)

Service/Storage Cabinetry Planning cabinets for table service or serving dishes also requires thought because some dishes, platters, and utensils are used on a regular basis and others may be used only occasionally, such as on holidays or at more formal meals. Therefore, the serving pieces most often used should be accessible, and the items seldom used can go in less accessible places, such as above the oven or the refrigerator. Keep in mind that lightweight items should go overhead, and heavier items should be placed in lower cabinets to allow for ease and safety in removal. Glass or plastic dishes/lids, used for storing perishable items in the refrigerator or freezing unit, should be fairly close to the refrigerator and near a countertop or cabinet top. Consider drawers just for lids, perhaps one for plastic and one for glass, plus a drawer or two for plastic wrap and bags, aluminum foil, and waxed paper. It has often been said that there is never too much storage space. Although people do tend to ill up whatever kitchen storage is available, it is far better to plan generous storage space than to produce clutter and frustration by allowing too little.

(B)

Figure 6.18 (A) The Energy Guide label from the Federal Trade Commission (FTC) is to appear on all appliances so the consumer may compare energy usage and associated costs. (B) The Energy Star label, sponsored by the Environmental Protection Agency (EPA), is affixed to specific products to indicate that the item exceeds energy efficiency and conservation guidelines.

Figure 6.19 Sleek Modern design in stainless steel is a clean look in this side-by-side Profile refrigerator/freezer combination. The liquid crystal display (LCD) screen above the water dispenser electronically displays information such as interior temperature and energy efficiency controls. Photo courtesy of GE Appliances & Lighting

Space Planning Considerations

Table 6.5

149

Appliance Planning Considerations

Appliances, devices powered by gas or electricity, fall into two categories. These are large or major appliances such as refrigerators, ovens, ranges, and washer/dryers, and small appliances such as toasters and specialized food-preparation or cooking devices. Models, options, and price ranges have expanded considerably, making it worth the time to research new appliance selection, perhaps beginning with an Internet search of consumer reports. Integration with other appliances or home systems, convenience features and energy-saving options, and appearance are some items to be considered. Generally, appliances will last as long as the warranty. Whereas in the past appliances were designed to last for 20 to 30 years, today 6 to 8 years seems to be the average life span. As technology moves forward at an accelerated pace, features in current models are outdated quickly and replaced with newer, faster conveniences.

As the twenty-irst century leads to greater digital convergence, the refrigerator may be equipped with a computer with available options including electronic bulletin boards, Internet access and email, recipe databanks, a shopping list cross-referenced with a menu planner to work with available ingredients, and a barcode scanner that alerts as to expiration dates of scanned products placed inside. A second refrigerator or large freezer may be placed in a garage, basement, or butler’s pantry. Freezers come with side-hinged doors or as a chest where the lid lifts. Chest freezers keep the cold air inside rather than rushing out, but make it more dificult to organize and access food. The area in front of the refrigerator or freezer should allow for a minimum of 3 feet to open and close the door and access the food without crowding. There should be a countertop nearby for loading and unloading food.

Ovens/Ranges/Cooktops Price Point vs. Energy Costs Appliances are costly investments, and research both in-store and online will be worth the effort. Sales on appliances are typically in January and June when current models are discounted to make room for newer models. Price points can vary greatly, with more expensive appliances having more features. Yet the purchase price is only part of the true costs. The cost of running the appliance should also be considered. Energy Guide labels are now required on new refrigerators, freezers, clothes washers and dryers, dishwashers, and water heaters. Furnaces and room air conditioners have a rating rather than a label. The Energy Guide lists energy use compared to other similar appliances, with an estimate of how much it will cost to run that appliance. The Energy Star label, sponsored by the U.S. Department of Energy (DOE) and the U.S. Environmental Protection Agency (EPA), is on thirty categories of products including appliances, electronics, lighting, ofice equipment, HVAC, and even homes. The Energy Star label indicates the product is at least 10 percent more eficient than comparable products, using less energy or water, promoting cleaner air, and using materials wisely. Clothes washers with the Energy Star label are 50 percent more eficient; dishwashers are 25 percent more eficient.

Ovens and ranges or cooktops can be located together or separately. Conventional or convection ovens may be placed below the range or above it. If below, the unit may have a smaller conventional or microwave oven above as well. A cooktop contains cooking elements only and is placed in the countertop or cabinet top wherever it is desired—along the wall or in an island, for example. The microwave oven is usually placed in one of three locations: on the counter, suspended under the upper cabinets, or built into the wall. Microwaves are least attractive placed on a counter; suspended types are smaller microwave units, and built-in units are often combined with a conventional oven. Multipurpose ovens are also available for both microwave and conventional or convection cooking. Self-cleaning or continuous-cleaning options are also worth considering in new ovens. A smaller convection oven can be placed by itself in a wall away from the microwave, which may be in a quick-cooking center. Ample counter space on each side of a range is sound kitchen planning, and counter space on at least one side of an oven to place food before and after cooking while opening the door is also very important to avoid spills and burns. Experts agree that electric ovens and gas cooktops are ideal. Upscale cooktops have up to eight burners and grill options. Warming drawers keep food warm till serving, and may be placed in the dining room or other rooms.

Refrigerator and Freezers

Dishwashers

Refrigerators are available with a variety of features and price points. Adjustable shelves, special compartments (for meat, vegetables, and dairy products), frost-free and energy-saving features, and stainless steel or painted doors or with insert paneling in fashionable colors are a few of the features available today. Many refrigerators contain a freezer unit, which can be located at the top, bottom, or side. Side-by-side refrigerators are also available in wider sizes for better width storage inside. Side-by-side units often feature cold-water and ice dispensers, eliminating the need to continually open and close the door (energy-saving). Refrigerated or freezer drawers may be a part of the unit or be “integrated” into cabinetry, placed at the point of most convenient use.

Most dishwashers are built-in units that slide under the countertop or cabinet top. Portable dishwashers are rolled to the sink and attached to the faucet and drain. For faster cleaning of smaller loads of dishes, select a drawer dishwasher or optional in-sink dishwasher. Drawer diswashers provide you the opportunity to run half-full cycles, and new optional in-sink dishwashers, in addition to eliminating bending, can provide either an extra deep sink or more counter space. Other options include top-rack-only wash, hidden controls and heating elements, and a food disposer to eliminate food particles. Energy- and water-saving features qualify some models as Energy Star approved. Various colors and inishes (continued)

150

Chapter 6

Table 6.5

Appliance Planning Considerations (continued)

are available. A special frame can hold wood or laminate to match the kitchen cabinets. The dishwasher should be located just to the left or right of the sink and next to the storage area for tableware. Select a quiet-operation dishwasher.

Garbage Disposals The garbage disposal is a standard appliance in one side of the sink, in the center of a three-compartment sink, or in a second food preparation sink.

Trash Compactors Trash compactors are appliances that compress garbage and thereby eliminate frequent trips to an outside garbage can. Trash compactors are located next to the sink or virtually any place in the kitchen. For those who do not desire a trash compactor, the same space can contain a garbage container that slides or swings out.

Sinks Many styles of sinks are available today in a variety of contemporary colors. Porcelain and stainless steel are the two most popular materials for sinks. Double sinks are common, and sinks with a third, central compartment for a garbage disposal are available. Sinks may have different-sized compartments and different

depths. Smaller sinks for rinsing vegetables or alternate cleanup areas are a nice addition.

Portable Appliances There are two major categories of portable appliances: appliances for food preparation and food-cooking appliances. The number of choices increases every year. When planning a kitchen, it is wise to make a list of the appliances to be used and to prioritize their location—the most frequently used will need to be most accessible, perhaps even on the countertop or cabinet top. For convenient use and elimination of clutter, plan for appliance cubbyholes or compartments on the counter. It is important to remember that portable appliances will be used only if they are convenient and accessible. If it is necessary to move bulky items out of the way and reach to the back of low or high cabinets for an appliance, it will seldom be used. • Portable appliances for food preparation: Blender, food processor, cabinet-top mixer, hand mixer, food mill, chopper/ grinder, can opener, electric knife, knife sharpener, food slicer, pasta maker, dough roller, drink mixer, coffee grinder, juicer, ice cream maker, weight scale, food dehydrator. • Portable food-cooking appliances: Microwave oven (may also be built-in), toaster, toaster oven, coffeemaker, rice cooker, Crock-Pot, electric skillet/grill, wafle iron, popcorn popper, electric wok, warming tray, hot plate/portable range, yogurt maker, deep fryer.

(B) (A)

(C)

(D)

Figure 6.20 Working triangles. (A) The single-wall kitchen with refrigerator at left, stove/oven at right. (B) L-shaped kitchen with an eating bar and stove and refrigerator right of sink. (C) The galley or tunnel kitchen uses space economically but can conflict with traffic patterns. (D) The U-shaped kitchen eliminates traffic problems and provides ample counter space.

Space Planning Considerations

Table 6.6

151

Standard Sizes of Fixtures and Cabinet Work*

Item

Width/Length

Height

Depth

Special

Kitchen counter

as needed

36⬙

20–35⬙

28⬙ high (wheelchair bound) 34–36⬙ high

Refrigerator

28–36⬙

5–6⬘

2⬘6⬙

Dishwasher

24⬙

34⬙

24⬙

Range

30–36⬙

36⬙

24⬙

Oven

24–30⬙

24–30⬙

26⬙

Washer

30⬙

36⬙

30⬙

Dryer

30⬙

36⬙

30⬙

Stacked washer/dryer

30⬙

72⬙

30⬙

Bathroom counter

as needed

30–34⬙

20⬙

Toilet

15⬙ (seat)

28–30⬙ (tank)

26⬙

Regular bathtub

5⬘

16⬙

2⬘8⬙

Oversize bathtub

6–7⬘8⬙

to 24⬙

3–4⬘

Interior door

2⬘6⬙–3⬘

6⬘8⬙

13⁄8⬙

Exterior door

3⬘

6⬘8⬙

13⁄8⬙ (Wider as needed)

Ceiling



8⬘ (Higher as desired)

8⬘ (Higher as desired)

two units make “double-oven” size

28⬙ high (chairbound-disabled)

*Sizes and shapes vary by manufacture, and a wide variety of nonstandard-size ixtures can be purchased through specialty suppliers.

planning are required. Sizes for washers and dryers are listed in Table 6.6. Cabinets should contain shelves high enough for laundry detergents, whiteners, softeners, and other frequently used products and items. Counter space for folding clothes and a closet or rod for hanging permanent press clothing are important. The laundry room most often contains an ironing board—perhaps the builtin variety, which is excellent for saving space and keeping iron and board accessible and orderly. Drawers or cabinets can hold clothes to be ironed or mended as well as mending supplies. Sewing rooms are favorite combinations with laundry facilities because the ironing board is necessary for laundry and sewing and because mending often takes place before or after laundering. Sewing cabinetry can contain work surfaces that fold or slide behind doors, keeping the clutter out of sight when no sewing is taking place. The laundry room may also double with a mudroom and may contain closets or “lockers” for coats, winter gear, or sports equipment according to the season. The laundry/utility room may hold a food freezer, and the cabinetry may be organized for tools such as screwdrivers and pliers. If the laundry room is located near the kitchen, it could double as a storage room for bulky cooking appliances. There are at least ive options of laundry location in space planning a home:

• Most typical is to locate the laundry near the kitchen. Some smaller homes and apartments have the washer and dryer in the kitchen itself, although ideally, the laundry needs to be in a place where clothes sorting can take place and where the door can be closed on the mess if necessary. Placing it near the kitchen is convenient since much of the daily household work revolves around the kitchen and only a few steps are needed to tend to the laundry in progress. In two-story homes where the laundry is on the main loor, careful planning can locate the laundry beneath at least one bathroom and over a clothes drop, which could empty into a cabinet above the washer and dryer. It is also possible to install two or three clothes drops so that sorting takes place as clothes are being dropped: one for whites, one for dark colors and jeans, and one for bright or light colors. This concept can be extended with the idea of drawers or baskets belonging to each family member. As clothes are folded, they are put into the drawer and that individual is responsible for taking the clothes and putting them away. • A second location is in a basement. This location will keep the noise and clutter off the main loor but will necessitate climbing stairs with loads of dirty and clean laundry.

152

Chapter 6

Figure 6.21 Good planning makes processing laundry more efficient. Elliott & Elliott Architects/photo © Brian Vanden Brink

• The third location is in the bedroom wing, next to the family bathroom. This location is popular in larger two-story homes and eliminates carrying laundry up and down stairs. • A fourth location is in a hallway, but this may not be good planning since the clothes have to be sorted in the hall and a mess is created in the trafic pattern. • In smaller homes and apartments, the bathroom may house the laundry. Theoretically this may be a good location since soiled clothing is often taken off at bath time. Some conlict could easily arise between functions and users, although in households of one or two users this is not an issue. Lack of adequate space for laundry activities may also be a disadvantage.

Master Suite Planning The master suite is one area in which money can be invested with an assurance of a return if the home is resold. A bit of upscale luxury in the master suite is a major trend, perhaps because two-career couples feel they need a private place to unwind after a long day. The master bedroom is often a master suite, consisting

Figure 6.22 Convenience and space efficiency are found in this stacking washer and dryer and fold-down ironing board. Both are behind doors when not in use. Photo © Brian Vanden Brink

of various areas and adjoining rooms that become a mini-apartment supporting a variety of activities. Consider these options: • Incorporate space for seating or conversation. A single chair and ottoman or chaise lounge is a good alternative to sitting on the bed for reading or conversing. Consider a conversation area with sofas or love seats and comfortable chairs. Support them with end tables, lamps, magazine racks, or case piece furniture such as a bookshelf. • Wire and plan space for an entertainment unit. An armoire or television cabinet lanked by bookcases makes the master suite a place for private home theater. Surround-sound speakers wired into the ceiling for movies and stereo music are a luxury easily accomplished in new construction and remodeling. • A small home ofice desk or hutch can be placed in the master suite. Placing a full-scale home ofice in a room adjoining or close by the master bedroom makes working at odd hours much less dreaded. • An area just off the bedroom can accommodate exercise equipment, spa facilities, or a massage therapy room.

Space Planning Considerations

153

Figure 6.23 The master bedroom is a place for interior design creativity, where comfort, softness, seating area for conversation or media viewing, and private outdoors access may be included. Design by Drysdale Design Associates/photo © Brian Vanden Brink

• The master suite can accommodate a library that focuses on bookshelves, comfortable seating, and perhaps a ireplace or a window with a great view. In this room, the computer station may be played down, perhaps placed behind doors in a built-in or furniture unit. • Consider dual closets, or double walk-in closets, and built-in closet organizer shelves. Also consider a skylight or translucent glass windows in the closet areas or a window for fresh air. • Vaulted, domed, or high ceilings, ine millwork (moldings), and creatively planned spaces are other soughtafter luxuries in master suites. Master bathrooms are an important part of the master suite. Consider: • Luxury spa or whirlpool bathtub.

• Separate roomy shower with dual heads at different heights, or water walls of multiple small jet spray heads. Luxury showers are often deep walk-in roomlike areas. Amenities include surround-sound speakers for music, radio, or television, and television screens. • Warming towel bars. • Above counter lavatory bowls (sinks) and extensive use of stone or tile. • Where the bath area is large and open, the toilet is often inside a small room or “closet” with good lighting and ventilation fans. • Closet or dressing areas adjoining the master bathroom. • Vaulted ceilings and creative shapes can make this area seem larger than it is.

154

Chapter 6

• Consider double vanities, custom-built for the height of each person. Vanities may be in separate areas, with large mirrors and custom storage for each user’s needs. • A sit-down vanity area with drawers and cupboards, electrical outlets, and a sink close by. • Ample drawers and cupboards for bathroom linens, supplies, and personal care items. • Windows with a view. If near the bathtub, plan for remote-controlled window shades—down when entering and exiting the tub, up when submerged in the bubbles. Art or stained-glass windows are also popular. • A wet or dry sauna or massage area. • Technology: Telephone, television, and surround sound for music and radio are incorporated in today’s master bath. Waterproof electronics are widely available.

Family Bathrooms Family bathrooms are often a point of contention, with one person locking the door and staying for lengths of time, often just grooming, while others grow impatient. Some ideas to help alleviate the tension are listed here: • Compartmentalize the bathroom with a pocket, folding, or swinging door between the vanity and bath/toilet area. • Place the toilet in a closet. • Separate the vanities; lengthen the vanity; consider double sinks. • Place a vanity with sink in each bedroom. • Place a small bathroom between each two bedrooms with an access door on each side. This works especially well when the bathroom contains the toilet and bathtub or shower and the vanities are in a hallway or bedroom. • Put the bathtub and shower in separate areas. Figure 6.24 A modest-sized remodeled bathroom features stone tile and stain• Small bathroom spaces can appear larger less steel above-counter sink and faucet in striking Modern styling. Design by by the use of increased ceiling height, Leslie Ann Cohen, CKD; Leslie Cohen Design/Photography: Ed Gohlich/NKBA Design plumbing ixtures without bulky cabinetry, Competition and well-placed mirrors. • Upscale or luxury homes usually feature a full-scale private bathroom with each bedroom. This • Be sure to plan doorways so that plumbing ixtures plan makes ideal guest suites and is a boon to family are not in plain view. harmony when the children marry and come home for • Many styles of bathtubs, showers, vanities, and sinks a visit with their own children or when an aged parent are available. Website addresses for plumbing ixture comes to stay in the home. companies are listed on the Interiors website.

Space Planning Considerations

155

Children’s Spaces Whereas demographic research indicates that fewer children live in each home today than did so a generation ago, the emphasis on making a child’s world wonderful has never known such enthusiasm. Here is a list of considerations for children’s spaces: • Small bedrooms that adjoin a playroom allow for a separation of sleep and play areas. • Larger bedrooms that are carefully planned with action or move-about space make a child’s world private. • Planning a desk with good lighting and perhaps builtin shelves encourages children to study. Most parents Figure 6.25 This bathroom floor plan shows separate vanity areas, closet room for toilet, and area for bathtub and shower. This creates an upscale, luxury bathroom with compartments.

Figure 6.26 A spacious walk-in shower is an appealing feature in this sharp monochromatic family bathroom. Two sinks make grooming more functional. Photo courtesy of Delta Faucet Company

156

Chapter 6

Figure 6.27 This area was specially designed for children. Cubical storage is perfect for toys and books, which can be rotated onto the wide low table that gives plenty of playing and reading space. The playhouse is located beneath a stairwell, and the large cabinet holds the television, media equipment, and DVDs. Photo © Kathryn Taylor

Figure 6.28 An outdoor kitchen features a gas grill and cook surface as well as a builtin fireplace and, farther to the right, a serving and cleanup zone. Stone surfaces and outdoor wood furniture such as teak and ironwood are durable year-round. Design by Horiuchi & Solien Landscape Architects/photo © Brian Vanden Brink



• •



will want each child to have computer access. Not all, however, will choose to connect children’s computers to the Internet, as there are concerns about online content that conlicts with family values and about the effect of extensive Internet use on children’s development of social skills and family relationships. Luxuries such as a telephone and television are also personal considerations, inluenced by concerns about unmonitored telephone use and television viewing. The amount of family interaction desired versus the autonomy and indulgence a child is afforded should be an open matter of discussion, with research to back the decision. Surround-sound speakers for the inevitable stereo system are an option that must be planned in advance. As alternatives to a plethora of electronic devices, consider these ideas for bedrooms or playrooms: built-in fantasy play areas with climbing devices and a slide; a performing stage; a wall of full-length mirrors for dancing; a toy car racetrack or a table for model trains and jigsaw puzzles; built-in shelves for books, with comfortable and inviting seating such as chairs, love seats, or cushioned and pillowed window seats. Children’s play areas can also contain organized closets with compartmentalized shelves and drawers for educational toys and experimental science kits.

Indoor-Outdoor Living

friends. Fresh air and sunshine promote good health. Watching the children or pets play while visiting is a pleasant pastime. A well-designed yard can be an extension of the living spaces. Consider these advantages of connecting the indoor environment to the outdoors:

Whether a minuscule deck, a broad porch, or an expansive lawn, in many climates and seasons the outdoors offers an ideal place to converse and connect with family and

• The visual expanse of an outdoor living space seen through windows and doors makes the interior seem larger.

Space Planning Considerations

157

Figure 6.29 This media room is without outside windows—ideal for watching movies—but it is also a light and cheery place with ample white paint and a light-colored sofa/ chaise. Shelves were designed to accommodate the media equipment precisely. Design by Adolfo Perez, Architect/photo © Brian Vanden Brink

• A pleasant view, even of a small patio or backyard, can make indoor living psychologically more enjoyable. • An indoor-outdoor trafic low and outdoor seating can at least double the space for entertaining and gracious family living. • Outdoor living spaces may incorporate many amenities: durable well-designed furniture; beautiful architectural features such as columns, roofed porches, and well-chosen looring materials; even area rugs, art, and accessories. A whirlpool spa or swimming pool, perhaps with a retractable roof; a ireplace or upscale cooking grill; or even a small kitchenette containing a refrigerator and microwave oven behind lockable cabinet doors can be a part of the outdoor living experience. • Wiring on the outside of the home allows for working on a computer laptop or notebook. A DSL or telephone jack makes connecting to the Internet possible while sipping lemonade on the porch.

Media and Entertainment Rooms The home theater or media room can employ the following space planning concepts: • A lat-screen television with ample storage space for videos or DVDs and audio CDs • Blackout window treatments or a room without windows

Figure 6.30 A billiards room is a place for interactive recreation for family and friends. The flat screen above the fireplace provides background entertainment. Here, the wood flooring is taken from sustainable forests. Photo courtesy of Autumn Donavan Design, WaterStone Homes, LLC & North Slope Sustainable Wood

• A slanted or stepped (terraced) loor to afford everyone viewing the “big screen” an unimpeded view • Surround sound wired in during construction • Dimmable lights; usher lights low on the walls • A kitchenette or snack bar (check building codes ahead of time to determine what is allowed) Entertainment rooms beyond the media or home theater room might include: • Active game tables: Ping-Pong, foosball, billiards • A dance loor

158

Chapter 6

• Arcade machines • Soda machines or a soda fountain or snack bar with bar stools • Indoor racket ball or tennis court • Swimming pool and/or hot tub (consider retractable rooing)

located at the point of irst or most frequent use. It has also been suggested that in order to determine real storage needs, one should list things owned and their corresponding sizes and then list where these items should be stored and what size that storage area should be. Storage zones are desirable in speciic locations:

Storage is a precious commodity; it ills up so quickly and is dificult to empty because possessions are hard to part with. A cardinal rule is that storage should be

• The kitchen should include storage for dry goods (such as a wall or walk-in pantry) and ample storage for pots and pans, small appliances, serving bowls, informal and formal plates and dishes and glasses (stemware), silverware and utensils, linens, soaps and cleansers, and cleaning appliances (brooms, mops, or vacuums), all located within convenient reach. • The laundry facility should have storage for extra soap, bleach, softener, and other cleaning preparations. • The front hall closet is for family and/or guest coats. Depending on the weather and the lifestyle, there may be a place for wet outerwear such as raincoats, umbrellas, or boots. It may not always be possible, however, to accommodate all the guests’ coats, scarves, and gloves when a sizable group is being entertained. In this case, the outerwear might be placed in a den or on a bed. • Closets, lockers, a walk-in closet, or a wall of hooks near the back entrance, garage entrance, or mudroom

Figure 6.31 Hobbies can take place along with family office duties in this multifunction space. Design by Centerbrook Architects/

Figure 6.32 Carefully planned storage is also an important visual feature of this kitchen. Robert Currie Interior Design/photo © Brian

photo © Brian Vanden Brink

Vanden Brink

Hobby and Special-Use Areas Other rooms to consider in the wish list include rooms where hobbies or special activities take place: • Art studio for painting or printmaking, graphics, ceramics, stained glass, or other artisan skills or crafts • Darkroom and processing area for photography • Music practice and study room; sound or recording studio (sound-insulated) • Workshop for building or working with machinery or devices or making a product for sale

Storage

Space Planning Considerations



• •

• • •

• •

• •

159

are for winter gear (coats, boots, school bags) and individual sports gear, again depending on lifestyle. In the summer, such an area could double for summer sports gear: tennis, baseball, and soccer equipment and even swimming towels and gear. A closet for the vacuum cleaner should be placed where it is needed. In two-story houses, a vacuum might be located in a closet on each loor. Linen closets are usually located in a hall near bedrooms to hold extra sheets, pillowcases, pillows, and blankets. Bathroom storage needs include paper goods, personal hygiene sundries, and extra towels, as well as cleaning supplies. Bedrooms are often shortchanged in storage. Sizable, compartmentalized closets will be appreciated. Any area where a hobby is performed requires indivdualized storage. Figure 6.33 This modest and handsome great room features cabinetry shelves for the Home ofices need closets, shelves, storage of an impressive book collection for cozy reading near a contemporary fireand/or units that can hold reference place. Rick Burt Architect/photo © Brian Vanden Brink books, iles, paper, and other supplies. The personal computer demands certain storage items such as printer paper and disks. the human body. With this in mind, the space can be The family room or entertainment room will need planned to it the purpose. A very large or grand scale— storage for items such as cassettes, records, compact seen in places such as cathedrals, hotel lobbies, or open discs, and videotapes. atrium areas of ofice buildings—is awesome compared The library, often combined with a home ofice or anto the human scale. But in these places, that overwhelmother room, will need plenty of shelves and perhaps ing feeling serves a purpose—to give a different perspecsome storage with locking doors for valuable books or tive or alternative to viewing space. The perspective may papers. create a feeling of reverence, awe, contemplation, or simThe tool shed is a place to store lawn and garden tools ply relief from closed, small-scale quarters. However, the and equipment, and tools for use in other maintenance overall size or scale of the space best relates to the human projects. frame in most interiors. Table 6.2, on page 137, indicates Where no tool shed or yard storage shed exists, the typical sizes for living areas in homes that have proved garage is often used for lawn and garden equipment, their effectiveness in relating to the human scale. tools, bicycles, and a myriad of items too bulky for Other design principles and elements are readily aphome storage. With careful planning, the garage that plied in the space planning process. Scale, proportion, is also a storage area can be organized to avoid a clutbalance, rhythm, emphasis, and harmony (the principles tered appearance. of design) are sought in order to make space functional and pleasing for many years to come. These aspects of function and pleasantness in space planning are accomplished through the manipulation of the elements of design—the delineation of space with shape or form through mass, line, pattern, texture, light, and color.

Space Planning and the Principles and Elements of Design

Effective space planning incorporates careful consideration of the principles and elements of design (discussed in Chapter 3) in order to create interiors that are pleasing and effective. And since people are the most important ingredient of the space, the proportion and scale in particular should always be judged according to that of

Living with Less Space Smaller seems to be the direction of the future. This is not necessarily bad, since large spaces demand upkeep and extra furnishings and can pose not only cleaning burdens but security problems as well.

160

Chapter 6

dining, entertaining, conversation, and sleeping all took place. Today’s great room frequently includes a kitchen; a snack bar or island for both food preparation and eating; a seating conversation area, often grouped around a ireplace, window, or other focal point; an entertainment system of television/video/stereo equipment; perhaps a sit-down eating area (in lieu of the formal dining room); and a desk for study, scheduling, and handling personal inances, which may contain space for a personal computer and iling system. Use of this area evolved not only from rising building costs but also from today’s lifestyle. People today are busy, often employed in or outside the home, and time is a precious commodity. Conversely, the presence of many rooms, or a duplication of formal/informal spaces, requires that time be spent cleaning and maintaining those spaces. Today’s lifestyle is less formal than that in the past. Whereas a formal dinner party may have been the standard through the mid-twentieth century, today even the boss is entertained comfortably in the great room (and may even enjoy pitching in and helping with the cooking). Further, hired help today is used in a different sense. The home owner may have someone come in to clean but will rarely employ servants to prepare meals, serve, and clean up as was commonly the case among well-to-do families in past eras. Convenience foods and equipment, such as microwave ovens and dishwashers, have simpliied lifestyles and reduced much of the burden of food preparation and entertaining.

Stretching Space

Figure 6.34 Living with less space does not mean living less well. Here, organization, cabinetry, and light colors make a tiny space a functional office. Design by Dominic Mercadante, Architect/ photo © Brian Vanden Brink

Skillful and creative planning makes the best use of the space available. This can be done in advance in the blueprint stage. Multiuse space is generally open space as large as two or three rooms. The omission of walls is a cost-saving factor, and one large room rather than cubicles of smaller ones can give the entire interior a more spacious and luxurious feeling. A large space allows for greater lexibility in meeting current needs and in arranging furniture as the function changes over time. In a home where the cost disallows space for every desired purpose, some rooms can serve two or more functions. For example, a little-used but desired formal dining room can double as a library; the home ofice or den could act as a guest room. The most dramatic multiuse area, however, is the great room, a term taken from medieval England when the great hall was the place where

Because of smaller spaces in today’s homes, it is often desirable to make spaces seem larger than they actually are. A space-saving device is a method of making space appear larger, for example: • The use of open plans with few structural walls. Many homes have been remodeled to remove walls. However, a general contractor should be consulted irst to determine if walls can safely be removed without posing a threat to the structural soundness of the building. In no case should load-bearing walls be removed. • Vertical space, accomplished with vaulted (high, angled) ceilings, 1½- or 2-story ceilings, or skylights. • Half walls that allow visual and audible communication to the upper area of an adjoining room. • Extensive use of glass windows, doors, and walls. In the past, glass building materials admitted too much heat and cold. Now, however, we are able to control solar gain and heat loss through new glass types, high-performance window ilm, shading devices, and energy-conserving window treatments. Once the building is complete, decorative space-saving devices can also seem to expand space. These devices include the following:

Space Planning Considerations

161

• Light colors seem to recede, as do dull colors. • Smooth textures expand space more than do rough textures. • Properly used mirrors can expand space if, for example, the mirror relects a view out a window and not a decoratively furnished or busy, patterned area. • Floor-to-ceiling draperies make walls look taller, as do top treatments and strong vertical lines in the window treatments. • Long vertical or horizontal moldings carry the eye and expand visual space, giving the impression of greater height or width, respectively. • Plain, wall-to-wall loor coverings will give the impression of greater loor area, particularly in contrast to patterned or layered loor coverings. • Furnishings that are small scale, are lighter in color, use small or no patterns, have legs rather than upholstered skirts or solid wood to the loor, and utilize glass or other see-through materials will also help expand small spaces. A common design error is to place large, patterned upholstered pieces and large-scale wooden furniture in small spaces.

Making Large Spaces Seem Smaller Too much space can be as big a dilemma as too little space. Feelings of unfriendliness and insecurity are common in areas that are larger than human scale in height and/or horizontal space. Noises are often ampliied, or they may echo or reverberate, particularly when there are large

Figure 6.35 Skillful and creative planning makes the best use of the available and limited space. Here, a stairwell wall houses cleverly designed bookshelves. Design by Kreuger Associated Architects/ photo © Brian Vanden Brink

Figure 6.36 White paint and wide windows with strong vertical and horizontal lines make this moderately sized kitchen appear much larger than it is. Design by Heidi Schumann; V6B Design Group/ Photography: Gary Beale/NKBA Design Competition

162

Chapter 6

path from room to room or area to area. Trafic patterns are necessary and unavoidable and require careful evaluation as an important part of space planning. Trafic patterns may be drawn in lines and arrows on the diagram or loor plan, indicating where people will be walking or where objects will be moved regularly through the space. These trafic patterns should be left free and kept as direct as possible. In a home, major trafic patterns typically lead from: • Front door to a central circulation system that leads to all areas of the house • Garage to kitchen for carrying groceries • Garage to hall closet, service area, or mudroom • Kitchen to formal, informal, and private living areas • Kitchen to dining room • Kitchen to service areas and entry areas • Laundry areas to bedrooms • Bedrooms to bathrooms • Back door to kitchen, mudroom, or service area Some pitfalls to avoid in arranging trafic patterns:

Figure 6.37 Rich browns surround this free-standing tub and shower, making the space appear small, cozy, and luxurious. Photo courtesy of Hunter Douglas

areas of hard surfaces. Communication can be dificult because of this. Another pitfall is a lack of privacy and the inability to physically or emotionally claim an area as one’s own. Space-reducing devices are largely the converse of space-saving devices. The following suggestions call for groupings and techniques to make the space become more human in scale and more friendly: • Furniture can be arranged into several conversation or function groupings. • Area rugs, such as colored and patterned Oriental or designer rugs, can deine groupings. • Darker colors on walls, loors, and ceilings make space seem smaller, as do patterns or heavy rough textures. • Space will appear to decrease with large-scale furniture such as upholstery with skirts, or the overstuffed variety; wood furniture that is heavy (literally); furniture that is solid right to the loor; and tall and wide pieces.

Traffic Patterns Trafic patterns are also referred to as circulation or trafic low. A trafic pattern is the repeatedly used walking

• Rooms that act as hallways, where a room must be crossed to reach another room • Door locations that force circulation through conversation furniture groupings • Areas too small for furniture and circulation • Areas where bathroom ixtures, beds, or other private spaces are open to view • Trafic low through work areas that tend to be untidy, such as the kitchen sink or laundry area Trafic patterns must be planned for adequate width. Hallways and stairs in homes have typically been 3 feet to 3 feet 6 inches wide. However, a 4-foot-wide corridor and stairs will more comfortably allow two-way trafic, not to mention users with special needs. Another trafic planning feature is the location of doors and the direction the doors swing. Generally, doors should be placed toward the corner of a room to avoid cutting up the wall space, and the door should swing inward against the adjoining wall. Where swinging doors will be a problem, pocket doors or sliding doors that will not impede trafic may be a good choice.

Rethinking the Box— Planning for Flexibility The saying “Nothing is as permanent as change” is good to remember when summarizing space planning considerations. What is reality today may be just a memory tomorrow. For example, a college student leaving home for school or leaving home permanently, to return only for short visits, creates a demographic shift as well as an

Space Planning Considerations

Figure 6.38 Two phases of schematics or graphics in the evolution of the floor plan. (A) The size and shape of the rooms and the traffic patterns. (B) The floor plan where doorways, windows, and walls are clearly defined.

Patio

BA Closet

Bath Patio

163

Master BR

Office BA

Bed

BR

Storage Kitchen Office

Bath BR Bed

Dining Room

Kitchen

Bed

Dining

Living Room

Entry

Garage

Living Room

Garage

(A)

empty bedroom that can be reallocated for another spatial need. It may become a home ofice, a guest room, a hobby room. With a little remodeling, it may be absorbed to create a long-desired master suite sitting area. Planning for lexibility is the wisest sort of planning. Consider some of these potential changes in the needs of a family: • A couple with no children can use space in any way they want and can adapt any extra bedrooms for their own personal needs. • As children become a part of the family, spatial needs vary dramatically. Not only is the bedroom the child’s world, but the entire home becomes his or her playground unless limits are placed on where and how the child can interact with his or her surroundings.

(B)

• With a growing family, play space, study space, friendinteraction space, and even getting-away-from-thechildren space become priorities. • When students are a part of the family mix, there is increased need for computer and printer access. Many families desire to monitor use of the Internet and will opt to have computers the children use within sight of the daily task routine. This requires good advance space planning to meet the needs of the student as well as the adult. • As the children grow up and leave home and then return for visits or to live with their own children, a need exists for both integrated and separated family living spaces. Many families will plan for an “apartment” where grown family members can be autonomous. This may include a kitchenette or small kitchen

164

Chapter 6

will accommodate this demand. That secondary suite would make a nice guest room when not occupied by a live-in family member. Take note: Check local codes irst to ind out exact parameters of apartments within the home. For example, a second kitchen may not be allowed if the stove is full size. A separate entrance may not be allowed—or it may be required. To minimize dificulties with the building inspector, research the laws before making plans and beginning a project.

Contract Considerations The discipline of space planning for contract spaces is far more complex than that for residential spaces. Each area—medical facilities, hospitality, business and ofice space, retail space, and production plants—has highly complex and specialized considerations, often based on local or state building codes. As such, an evaluation of all contract space is beyond the scope of this book. However, since most of us have at least visited many or all of these spaces, it is possible to evaluate what we see as it pertains to space planning. To this end, the following information is an extension of the space planning principles discussed in this chapter; most of the information that applies to homes can, in some form or another, also apply to many contract interiors. Figure 6.39 Families who want to monitor computer use will plan for it where all can see and access the computer, such as this desk located in a great room and visible from the kitchen, dining, and seating areas. Photo © Kathryn Taylor

and eating area, a second laundry room, and another living space as well as bathroom and bedroom. • As an increasing number of children, children-in-law, grandchildren, and all their friends come to visit, the family home may need to accommodate crowds. Advance planning will provide space where they can sit, visit, and eat. • Another important consideration is aging parents, who, typically between the ages of 70 and 90, can no longer live independently and need to be taken into the family home. Advance planning for a “mother-inlaw apartment” can beneit all family members if and when the need arises. With the increased good health of the elderly making nursing home care unnecessary for many, this becomes a very real possibility. If the apartment is on ground level and other family members can move to another level, the inevitable stress can be reduced. Planning for a secondary master suite on another level or in another location in the house

Function and Zoning In each type of contract building, the zoning will be speciic to its functions. Below are some things to look for.

Restaurants • Reception/payment, waiting area including some seating, coat rack or check • Open seating at tables and booths, sometimes a bar zone (less formal dining), possibly al fresco dining area • Take-out area (casual or fast-food eateries) • Self-serve buffet area (less formal dining) • Rest room zone • Food preparation and storage zone, delivery and receiving area

Hospitality • Hotels and motels are planned with one or more openseating areas in the reception area, some within view of the check-in counter. • In multistory hotels, elevator banks constitute a zone, generally located near stairs or escalators. • Luggage bellhop stations and luggage storage/holding rooms.

Space Planning Considerations

165

A Design for Twenty-first-Century Living

Figure 6.40 The main floor of this twenty-first-century home plan features several indoor garden spaces; a great room combining kitchen and “Us Room” with fireplace, TV, and computer space for use by the entire family; activity area adjoining the patio; master suite; and a “Multi-Purpose Area” with private entry and bathroom that make it suitable for use as an accessory apartment. Upstairs is an exercise/sauna area as well as children’s bedrooms with a shared bath and study/office carrels. © Bloodgood Sharp Buster Architects and Planners, Inc.

166

Chapter 6

Figure 6.41 The reception area of a library where traffic is directed by means of color, signage, and space planning. Perry Dean Rogers & Partners Architects/photo © Brian Vanden Brink

• A lounge is often a part of the large lobby area, where people wait for friends or relax before going out to a restaurant for dinner and even where business is conducted. • Informal dining, often referred to as a coffee shop, and one or more formal restaurants may be located on the main level; the nicest restaurants are often on the penthouse level or top loor with a commanding view of the city. • Meeting rooms for business gatherings, conferences, and trade show seminars. • Ballrooms and banquet rooms that can be divided into smaller rooms. • Business centers with copying, faxing, and mailing services. • Support areas with small shops; some luxury hotels have mini-shopping malls as a part of the hotel or

adjoin larger indoor, sometimes multistory shopping or business centers.

Shopping Malls and Retail Stores • In shopping malls, both general large entrances with clear signage and entrances to the anchor stores and larger retail shops. • Open (one- or two-story) central mall spaces with benches and perhaps fountains and other nonretail images for resting the eye and body and meeting other shoppers. • Open food court, where order and pickup counters can be seen from all seating/dining areas. Notice that the shape, architectural detail, and furnishings of this open space are often interesting—the atmosphere needs to be emotionally nourishing, even fun.

Space Planning Considerations

167

Figure 6.42 Creative light-hearted design in the pediatric wing of a hospital helps children and parents as well as professionals to feel more optimistic. S.B.R.A. Architects/photos © Brian Vanden Brink

• Department store zones should be clearly marked with graphics or signage so that shoppers can ind their way in, ind what they need, and ind their way out. • Smaller shops or boutiques generally have a more open layout, where the entire store may be visible from the mall or street entrance. Notice, however, how ixtures and signage separate the merchandise into zones. • Merchandise checkout or payment stations should also be obvious, as should important support stations where functions such as repair, customer support, or gift wrap are located.

• • • •

Medical or Healing Centers

Hospitals

• Reception and patient waiting zone, checkout area • File storage and retrieval, support-staff stations, insurance processing and billing desk area • Patient exam rooms for doctors or non-Western healers

• In addition to the above, hospitals have more surgery space and areas for specialties such as obstetrics, laboratories, X-ray and nuclear medicine, various forms of therapy and counseling.

In-ofice lab space; general weigh-in area, rest rooms Doctors’ personal ofice space Surgery area Support/supply areas In healing centers there may also be:

• A sauna and/or spa treatment area • Massage, exercise, and other therapy areas including exercise equipment • Group instruction rooms or areas, in both seated classroom and open space for yoga/exercise

168

Chapter 6

• Patient rooms and support facilities. • Nurses’ stations. • Administrative areas including an extensive business ofice. • A kitchen, cafeteria, pharmacy, and chapel are igured into most hospital plans.

Public Transportation • Train stations, bus stations, and airports need speciic areas to function: check-in at counters and curbside, spaces to manage crowds and long lines, and security checkpoint areas. • Elevator, escalator, and stairs. • Public rest rooms. • Administrative and customer services; baggage-hold ofices. • Baggage-processing areas connecting or convenient to planes, buses, or trains. • Shops and casual dining. • Signage and connecting walkways and trams.

Office Buildings • Multistory ofice buildings have a lobby area with a directory of businesses per loor. • Elevator banks and stairwells; rest rooms. • Lobby areas on each loor and entrances for each business that typically include a reception area, waiting area, support facilities and administration, ofices, and conference rooms.

Other Public Facilities With the above areas in mind, think about space planning in every public place you visit: Look for spatial allotments in grocery stores, churches, gym or spa facilities, and schools. By observing and evaluating the use of the space, we can determine if the space planning was wise and well thought out or if more research in the design process should have been conducted before loor plans were inalized.

Traffic Patterns in Contract Spaces The greater the volume of people or objects, the wider the trafic pattern or corridors will need to be. This is evident in public architecture such as hospitals and shopping centers, where the trafic is heavy and corridors are wide. Local building codes must be met for corridor widths in contract buildings. Two separate sets of doors are often employed in contract settings as air-lock entries, or vestibules, to keep out excess cold air, rain, and snow. This arrangement can also be a security enhancement. The vestibule area should be sizable so that foot trafic will not pile up and there is room for shelter. Trafic patterns in settings such as department or specialty stores can be quite complex, and architects use visible markers or guideposts to aid the users. People entering contract spaces need to know three things in order for trafic to low smoothly: (1) how to get in, (2) how to i nd their way around, and (3) how to get out. Some spaces do this quite effectively. For example, in a well-planned grocery store or supermarket, the buyer is able to ind grocery carts near the entrance, locate items by checking the bright wall signs and the smaller hanging signs over spacious aisles, and then ind the checkout counter with easy egress to the doors and the street or parking lot. Trafic patterns also need to be planned in open, multiuse areas such as the open-plan ofice. Where several functions take place in one area, the furnishings or planning systems can be the delineators of space. A freestanding wall partition, desk, computer terminal desk, iling system, or shelf can be moved to accommodate changing needs, providing lexibility. Fewer structural walls allow for easier trafic low, and the removal of visual obstructions makes spaces seem larger.

Chapter 7 Floor Plans and Building Systems Floor Plans 170 Diagramming and Floor Plans 171 Floor Plans and Housing 173 Constructing the Building 185 Insulation and Energy Conservation 192 Contract Considerations 198

Winton Scott, architect/photo © Brian Vanden Brink

170

Chapter 7

Floor Plans Floor plans are part of the working drawings or documents required to build a new space or remodel an existing one. A custom loor plan may evolve slowly by hand, beginning with a bubble and then overlay through steps of reinement, or drafting may be accomplished with computer software tools. Stock plans can be edited or modiied or can be left as is, with the home built from readily available plans. This chapter explores the types of loor plans and housing, explains loor plan symbols, and presents a brief overview of the most commonly used structural building system or construction methods. Alternative building system methods are sometimes used in homes, although they are chiely seen in nonresidential buildings, as discussed at the end of this chapter. Since the inishing and furnishing of an interior are an integral part of the entire process, persons involved in interior design beneit from an understanding of the entire process.

The chapter also presents an overview of interior environmental control systems—plumbing, heating, and air-conditioning. Electrical systems and home automation are discussed in Chapter 5. The interior i nish components are listed, as are project-managing tools, including technology tools used by architects, general contractors, design professionals, and laypersons who act as their own general contractors or do the work themselves. A building system based on the use of solar energy utilizes heat and energy from the sun to warm looring, cubic living space, or water. Insulation is part of the building process, but it can be incorporated after the completion of

Bath Patio

Bed Storage

Office

Bath Bed

Kitchen Bed

Dining

Entry

Private

Garage

Work

Social

Living Room

(C)

(A) BA

Patio

Closet

Patio

Office

Bath

BA

Bed Kitchen

Storage Office

Bath

Bed

Master BR

Dining Room

Bedroom

Bedroom

Kitchen Bed

Living Room

Dining Garage

Garage

(B)

Entry

Living Room

(D)

Figure 7.1 Two phases of schematics or graphics in the evolution of the floor plan. (A) The general zones—private, work, and social. (B) Divisions within these zones for specific rooms and their relationship to one another. (C) The size and shape of the rooms and the traffic patterns. (D) The floor plan where doorways, windows, and walls are clearly defined.

Floor Plans and Building Systems

any building. Building components that conserve natural resources and use recycled products or products that are environmentally safe are termed green design, discussed in Chapter 2. Green design should be a part of the thought process and be incorporated at every opportunity in every building, remodeling, or refurnishing project. For further information on any of the topics in this chapter, go to the Interiors website, which lists Web addresses for the National Association of Home Builders (NAHB) and other organizations and businesses that supply a wealth of information on the latest developments in building processes.

171

Square footage is two-dimensional space (loor area), which equals the length of the room or building multiplied by its width. Square footage may be the determining factor of the building size based on an estimated cost per square foot. Square footage may also be limited by the

100 Square Feet

Diagramming and Floor Plans Diagramming is the process of placing a two- or threedimensional representation of the proposed space on paper. The graphics evolve by reining the schematics (drawings and allocation of space) to inally become a inished floor plan. The evolution of diagramming takes place as follows: • Bubble planning—the placement of zones on paper according to function. • Size and shape determination—the allocation of square footage and cubic footage and the shape of rooms and areas. • Rei nement—this step could take up to several overlays, the laying of tracing paper over the previous graphic to tighten and reine the sketch, or it could be accomplished through CADD software tools. • Perspective sketches and renderings—three-dimensional pencil, pen-and-ink, or full-color representations of the proposed space or how a portion of the interior will appear upon completion. • Floor plans—the inished product that indicates speciic and exact placement of walls and systems within the home. Floor plans are drawn to scale (usually ¼ inch equals 1 foot) and consist of symbols that make the plan understandable to the general contractor and subcontractors. Other components of the construction documents are discussed later in this chapter.

Measurements of Space: Cubic and Square Footage Cubic footage is three-dimensional space or the space we walk through. It is determined by multiplying a room’s width by its length and then by its height. Rooms with a typical 8-foot ceiling will contain fewer cubic feet than rooms with higher ceilings. Greater cubic footage suggests the possibility of vaulted ceilings and interesting vertical shapes, with the accompanying illusion of greater square footage or loor space.

(A)

800 Cubic Feet

(B)

1200 Cubic Feet

(C) Figure 7.2 Calculation of square footage and cubic footage. (A) Square footage is derived by multiplying the width of a room by its length. The 10 feet by 10 feet yields 100 square feet. (B) Cubic footage is the width multiplied by the length and then by the height of the room. The 100 square feet multiplied by 8-foot walls yields 800 cubic feet. (C) The same room with a 12-foot ceiling contains more cubic footage and will cost more in both material and labor, even though the square footage remains the same.

172

Chapter 7

square feet per person is generally considered the minimum for comfortable living standards, although fewer square feet may be alloted for children and modest living.

Shaping the Space The shape of the interior space has horizontal and vertical components. Although a rectangular room is the easiest to build and simplest to decorate, it can also be the most boring architecturally. Angled or curved walls, vaulted or curved ceilings, half walls or transparent walls, or even cutout sections between rooms can add interest and visually expand the actual dimensions of the room. Altering room shapes has been a boon to new smaller homes and to the remodeling of older ones, as the alternatives give the impression of greater space and provide architectural interest where none may otherwise have existed. The shape of interior spaces can also affect the exterior shape and dimensions of the home; this, too, must be taken into careful consideration when designing custom housing. From the interior living standpoint, it is ideal to irst determine the spatial arrangements and shapes within the loor plan, then let the exterior shape be determined by the sizes and shapes of the interior spaces. However, the desired style or proportions of the exterior will often limit or restrict the inFigure 7.3 The shape of this Modern-style informal dining area was planned to terior shapes or sizes. Realistically, some take advantage of a sweeping wood and waterfront view. The bow window accompromise is often necessary. A room commodates a custom-built bench and ledge ideal for leaning on while using may need to be altered in dimension or the binoculars. Design by Lo Yi Chan, Architect/photo © Brian Vanden Brink size to make the exterior more pleasing, or the placement of doors and windows in the size of the building lot. In neighborhoods of new homes, rooms may be dictated by their fenestration, or arrangethere may also be a minimum acceptable square footage ment, from the exterior. requirement, part of the restrictive covenants established by the developer or residents to ensure a consistent level Site, Orientation, and Climate of quality and price range in the neighborhood’s homes. A breakdown for square footage may be based on a The shape of the space may also be dictated by the limitapercentage for each general area. In homes, a general tions or special considerations of the building site. Look rule of thumb is to allot 80 percent of the space for living carefully at the direction of the prevailing breezes in space, 10 percent for halls, and 10 percent for storage. both summer and winter, the slope of the lot, any natural Another factor in determining square footage may be vegetation, the location and types of nearby buildings, the number of people who will occupy the space. Psychoand property values of surrounding architecture. Also logical studies have repeatedly demonstrated that overconsider the orientation, or direction the site faces, so that crowding can lead to adverse emotional consequences as solar aspects and fenestration can be incorporated. The well as physical limitations and discomfort. However, the orientation is also important in relation to the climate. number of square feet allotted per person varies accordA sunbelt home will have different planning than a ing to society. Whereas in Hong Kong 60 feet per person New England home, for example, because the former is considered adequate, in the United States 400 to 500 must provide control of heat from the sun and the latter

Floor Plans and Building Systems

must control excessive winter cold. The needs and criteria of the climate, then, are important aspects of planning a home.

Floor Plans and Housing Floor Plan Symbols Floor plan symbols are illustrated in Figure 7.4a through 7.4d. These include symbols for windows, doors, plumbing ixtures, appliances, walls, stairs, and mechanical equipment. (Electrical symbols are found in Chapter 5.) Keep in mind these are examples only; the number and types of symbols vary. A study of these symbols will increase the ability to read and understand the loor plans that follow.

Floor Plan Types There are three types of loor plans: • A closed floor plan is one in which most or all of the rooms are units that are opened to others only by a door, and when the door is shut, the room is completely enclosed. This gives privacy and control over sound, yet often it creates a chopped-up loor plan without lexibility. • An open floor plan has several areas that are open to one another without walls or with only partial walls or dividers. The cost to build may be less, and the space seems much larger than with a closed plan. There is lexibility in the use of the space. The disadvantages lie in the lack of privacy that may result and the transmission of more sound than is desirable. These loor plans may open vertically (high ceilings), horizontally (few walls), or both. • Combination (open and closed) plans have both open and closed areas or areas that can be opened to permit a lexible use of the space. This can be accomplished with double doors (such as a pair of pocket sliding doors, French doors, or accordion doors) and with some areas with high ceilings that open to areas such as lofts or balconies or other living space.

Types of Housing Housing can be divided into two broad categories: the single family residence (SFR), which is an independent house with a yard, and attached dwellings, those that share walls, with or without a yard.

The Single Family Residence The single family residence, or a home with a yard, has the greatest potential for individuality. Although some are rental units, the majority of homes are owner

173

occupied. Ownership means that the plan can be originated or remodeled to it the needs of the owners. Here are the types of plans: • A rambler, or ranch. A one-story home, with living room, dining room, kitchen, bedrooms, and bathroom all on one level. A basement, if any, typically contains a family room, utility area (laundry, half-bath, mudroom), additional bedrooms, bathroom, and/or storage. When built with a slope in the backyard, the downstairs area may be a walk-out basement, which allows for full-size windows and patio doors. In this case, a deck and perhaps steps down to the backyard will service the main loor. A rambler can be a prefabricated house moved onto the site and placed on a waiting foundation or over a basement; such homes are also built in developments ranging from modest to upscale and may even be spacious with luxury features. • One-and-one-half story. A plan with bedrooms upstairs inside the attic, usually with dormer windows. The main loor contains the living and dining rooms, kitchen, bath or half-bath, and perhaps a den or family room and/or master bedroom. • Two-story. A plan similar to a one-and-one-half story, except that the roof line begins above the second loor, allowing full-height ceilings. There is usually a full- or partial-height attic above the second loor. • Split level. A house with three or more levels. Typical plans put the living room, dining room, kitchen, and perhaps a half-bath on the main loor. Up one-half light is the bedroom wing, and down one-half light from the entry is the family room and utility space. Another level below the main loor may house storage or extra bedrooms. • Split entry or raised ranch. A rambler with a raised basement, where half the basement is above ground level. The entry is on a landing, and stairs go up to the main loor or down to the basement. Being halfway above ground level, the basement is better-lit with larger windows, making the lower level a more livable space. • Patio home. A plan suitable for a narrow lot. It may be one, one-and-one-half, or two stories. Such homes are economical because of the modest number of square feet and smaller lot size. One-story patio homes are especially well suited to the retirement-age owner who does not want to or cannot climb stairs. Patio homes are also a good choice for irst or starter homes. • Mobile home. A prefabricated home that is a part of a mobile home park. Single-wide mobile homes are 12- to 15-feet wide; double-wide mobile homes are 20to 30-feet wide and are fabricated as two units and moved to the site. Originally called trailers, and meant to be mobile, most of these are now permanent.

174

Chapter 7

(A)

(B) Figure 7.4 (A) Door and window symbols. (B) Plumbing fixture symbols. (C) Symbols for appliances, walls, stairs, and mechanical support equipment. (D) Representations of finish building materials as indicated on the elevations—part of the blueprint plans. (A and B) CAD by Gary Stewart

Floor Plans and Building Systems

Dn

Up Walls continue

Straightrun stair

Single-turn stair with landing downstairs stacked below

Curved stair

WH Water heater

Water softener AC

Walls solid

Air conditioner

F (C)

Furnace

Stucco

Concrete

Clapboard siding

Victorian wood shingles

Wood paneling

Board and batten paneling

Shake shingles (wood)

Vertical Aluminum or metal siding vinyl siding

Brick

Masonry block

Smooth ashlar stone

Cobblestone

Running Stacked bond masonry bond masonry

Boulder/ rubble

Glass block Window glazing

(D)

Spanish tile

Single tile

Ceramic tile

Fitted rough-cut ashlar stone

Stone

Asphalt shingle/ bartile

175

176

Chapter 7

Figure 7.5 A rambler or ranch-style plan with optional basement. CAD by Gary Stewart

Figure 7.6 A one-and-one-half-story plan. The upper floor includes a bonus room. CAD by Gary Stewart

Floor Plans and Building Systems

177

Figure 7.7 A two-story plan showing a great room along the rear of the home. Bedrooms and private areas are zoned upstairs. CAD by Gary Stewart

Figure 7.8 A split-level home showing three steps down to the family room and ten steps up to the bedroom wing above the garage. Storage and one more bedroom are beneath the kitchen and living room. CAD by Gary Stewart

Attached Dwellings Attached dwellings have many advantages: better use of land so that more people can live in locations convenient to urban centers, schools, or business; less cost; and more freedom from the yardwork and upkeep that a larger home and yard require. Their major categories are as follows:

• Apartment buildings are multistory buildings where multiple units are housed on each loor, accessed by stairs and in high-rise complexes also by elevators. Apartments typically have one living area, one kitchen/dining area, one or two bathrooms, and one to four bedrooms.

178

Chapter 7

Figure 7.9 This fourplex plan may be apartments (to rent) or condominiums (to own). CAD by Gary Stewart

Figure 7.10 A twin home or semidetached house plan. CAD by Gary Stewart

Floor Plans and Building Systems

• Multiplex units are small apartment buildings. A twofamily or two-unit building is a duplex, which may be one level with a basement apartment or may be sideby-side apartments. A three-unit building is a triplex, a four-unit building is a fourplex or quadplex, and so on. Each unit may have a separate or shared entrance. • Accessory apartments are located in a separate dwelling in a portion of the home, such as in the basement, in the back of the house, over the garage, or in an upstairs location. Many locales have zoning restrictions on accessory apartments; they will often require, for example, at least three off-street parking spaces. • Twin homes (also called semidetached houses) are two homes built on a lot with a shared wall between them. They may be one, one-and-one-half, or two stories high. These homes may also be called duplexes. • Luxury apartments or flats are usually larger and have more upscale or luxury features. The bottom or ground loor and nearby buildings typically have

179

all the support services required for convenient living: parking spaces, a post ofice, grocery and apparel stores, a drugstore, dry cleaners, and so on. The living space is called a suite, a lat, a condominium, or an apartment. • Town houses and row houses (also called “brownstones”) are attached city houses built as a series or development. They are narrow, usually only one or two rooms wide, and two, three, or four stories high. • Flats are a group of rooms on one level of a building, such as an apartment or luxury high-rise suite. When larger brownstones are subdivided, each unit is often called a lat. • Pied-à-terre is a French term for a lat or house for occasional use (literally, “foot on the ground”), typically kept as a second home in a city distant from the primary dwelling. Note: These terms may vary regionally.

Figure 7.11 Remodeling plans for a two-story addition. Remodeling and adding on are ways to increase space without the inconvenience of relocating. CAD by Gary Stewart

180

Chapter 7

Buying an Existing Home Most people will not build a custom home but will purchase or rent an existing one (Table 7.1). Although the list of things to know when selecting a home is extensive and more information is available through the Web addresses listed on the Interiors website, here are a few important considerations: • Location, location, and location are said to be the three most important criteria in buying a home. It is wise to buy the most modest home in a nice neighborhood (increased value) but unwise to own the nicest home in any neighborhood (decreased value). Location has to do with neighborhood, proximity to support services, ease of access, and things like view and property values. • Buy a home that meets your present and future needs. If you expect to increase or decrease your family size, operate a home business, or add luxury features, choose a plan that will allow modiications without major remodeling. • Consider upkeep. You’ll never regret buying a home with materials and systems that are relatively maintenance free. • Look for warranties on the environmental control systems (heating, air-conditioning, plumbing, electrical). • Check for structural soundness in construction— framing, rooing, walls and windows, doors, looring. • Be aware of defects or potential problems; negotiate with the seller as to who will repair existing problems. Older homes require more upkeep; be sure your budget will allow for this. A building inspector will verify if the home is soundly built and safe for occupancy. In addition, prospective buyers can hire private home inspection services to evaluate the building and its systems and ixtures. The indings of the inspection help buyers decide if the home is worth the asking price. Some defects are serious, others are just cosmetic, and still others are perceived defects because the plan or features do not suit the lifestyle of the new occupants. Go in with your eyes wide open about what will be required to make the home truly yours. • Utilize online real estate services—both listings and virtual tours. A photo bubble allows viewers to look upward to the ceiling and down at the loor and to pan right and left. As rooms are strung together, the Internet tour re-creates a walking tour. Also available are views outside to see the neighborhood and the backyard.

Obtaining the Floor Plan Figure 7.12 This split-level home has been remodeled to meet the needs of an ambulant disabled user. CAD by Gary Stewart

Before construction or remodeling can begin, the owners and contractors must obtain a loor plan speciic to the project. This can be done in one of several ways.

Floor Plans and Building Systems

Table 7.1

181

Types of Home Occupancy

Three principal forms of home occupancy are private, condominium, and rental. Each type has advantages and disadvantages for certain groups of people and for those in different stages of life.

Private Ownership Like the single detached house, private ownership—owning one’s own home—is a part of the American dream that is becoming less obtainable as the cost of housing and inancing increases (see Table 6.1). Private ownership brings with it a great deal of responsibility for upkeep, maintenance, security, and care of the house and grounds. For some, this responsibility is an unwanted burden that is eliminated by other forms of ownership.

Condominium The word condominium comes from Latin and literally means “ownership with.” Condominiums are complexes of any type of dwelling, from high rise to town house, that are owned privately but maintained and governed by groups of owners. These groups form home owners’ associations that use the owner’s monthly fees to provide for general maintenance, security, snow removal, and

• Custom floor plans are one-of-a-kind plans that meet the needs of the client, the users, and the site. There are three ways to get custom loor plans: through an architect, through a home designer, or by means of computer software. • Architects. The more custom the plan, the more likely that an architect will be hired to design and perhaps oversee the building project. Architects are schooled in structural soundness and the skill of taking a prospective home owner’s wish list and creating the home that fulills his or her needs and wants. Architects may also hire computer draftsmen to produce the actual loor plans. • Home designers. Many people have their plans drafted by a computer-trained home designer without the use of an architect. This provides a level of expertise and experience at less cost. Home designers will have their plans approved by structural engineers. • Computer software. Laypeople can create their own loor plans with any of several computer software packages, some of which are capable of producing contractor-ready plans. Some software allows the user to edit, or modify, existing stock plans. Most have the tools to create loor plans, including the selection or design of all interior components—ireplaces, window and wall conigurations, stairs, kitchen and appliances, decks. Some have a database of appliances and plumbing ixtures to select and drop in, allowing users

care of the landscape. The home owners’ associations also establish the rules and restrictions for the condominiums. Some condominiums feature amenities such as club houses, health and itness centers, swimming pools, tennis courts, stables, and parks—also maintained through the monthly fees. Condominiums can be geared to people with similar interests or ages such as singles, young families, and “empty-nesters” (couples whose children have left home). Condominiums are ideal for those who want to own property without all of the worries of private ownership.

Rental Those who are unable to afford condominiums or private ownership will usually rent housing from a landlord who owns and maintains the rental properties such as apartments. Others choose to rent because renting generally carries no responsibility for maintenance or upkeep, and in some cases all or part of the cost of utilities (electricity, gas, water, sewer, and garbage) is included in the rent. Any type of housing, from detached houses to high-rise apartments to duplexes, can be rented, although costs and quality of rental units vary greatly.

to experiment with the workability of the plan. Some have landscaping tools, and most have interior furnishings tools such as furniture, lighting, accessory, and surface texture databases that aid in the planning of everything from aesthetics to trafic patterns or circulation. Most packages include a 3-D tour, allowing the user to see what any given space will look like, with or without furniture and accessories. • Stock plans are plans designed by architects and home designers that are available for purchase. They are found in loor plan magazines, on computer software, and on Internet websites. Both software and loor plan websites contain thousands of plans that can be purchased or printed on blueprint-size printers. Some people will customize or modify plans slightly with the help of a home designer. Modest changes— say, the location of a door—can be made by communicating with the home builder. Computer-aided drafting (or design) (CAD or CADD) is the way nearly all custom and stock loor plans are accomplished. Most professionals are schooled in hand-drafting techniques, and hand-drawn bubble sketches are often utilized at the brainstorming stages of a custom project. CAD plans, however, are accurate and allow for changes to be made without an eraser. In fact, as the designer and client experiment with various options, each option can be saved in a computer ile. This provides freedom and lexibility during the design process.

182

Chapter 7

(A)

(B) Figure 7.13 (A) A typical framing plan. (B) A section showing a crosswise slice through the building. (C) Cabinet details. (D) Construction details. CAD by Gary Stewart

Floor Plans and Building Systems

(C)

(D)

183

184

Chapter 7

Construction Documents: Working Drawings or Blueprints The working drawings, sometimes called blueprints, are the sets of plans that specify designs, materials, and dimensions to guide each subcontractor who works on the home or building. Working drawings include the following: • Floor plans are drawn to scale (1⁄4 inch or 1⁄8 inch equals 1 foot) and show the layout of the rooms and their relationship to one another. They are used for estimating cost, for scheduling, and for actual construction of the building. • Exterior elevations are the exterior views of each side of the building in lat drawings (no perspective) showing the inish building materials, the location and style of doors, windows, architectural detail, roof, chimney, and other details. Exterior elevations help us judge the building style aesthetics, or curb appeal. • Schedules indicate how various parts of the building are to be inished. Materials and inishes for components such as doors, loors, walls, and ceilings are listed. • Site plans show the situation of the building on the land, legal boundaries, slope, key reference points, and possibly information on soils and vegetation. Site plans also indicate details on water, sewer, and electrical system grids (hookups). • Foundation drawings indicate necessary details on footings, ireplace footings, anchor bolts, breaks in walls, and drains. They are used to estimate labor and materials and to direct foundation work. • Framing plans give projections of the building from the lowest level and up to the roof. They show sections, key connections, and the layout of the loors and roof, with necessary information on columns, beams, and joists. Details are enlarged. • Cross sections are vertical drawings of a slice through the interior of the building, showing the relationship and scale of the foundation, walls, beams, rooms, stairs, and other architectural elements. • Utility plans show a building’s mechanical systems: heating, ventilation, air-conditioning, plumbing (usually presented separately), electrical, and lighting plans and cable wiring. These plans will include layout for other systems such as ire protection, security, and communications (intercom). • Interior elevations show types of cabinets and millwork (molding, railings) and other special interior features. They are used to obtain bids and construct the items. • Details are enlargements of construction components where clariication or additional information is needed (for example, custom window arrangement to be framed).

• Speciications are written documents that describe structural or inish materials or custom work—what is needed, where it is to be located, what quality and craftsmanship level is desired, how it is to be assembled, and any other special considerations needed for correct construction. • The subcontract is the agreement for specialized work performed by a person or company and speciied for a building’s construction or inish work. Subcontractors will take information from the blueprints, determine how much labor and materials are required for their specialty (framing, plumbing, sheetroof, rooing, electrical, for example), and produce a bid or solid estimate of the job. The general contractor will usually get three or more bids and select the lowest bid, the subcontractor with the reputation for the best quality work, or the subcontractor with a reasonable bid and proven quality. The interior design package or parts of it, such as carpeting, window treatments, wall coverings, or furnishings, may also be bid in this manner.

Who Will Do the Work With blueprints in hand, a commitment must be made as to the actual construction of the new home or building remodel. This should not be a quick decision but should be carefully researched and thought out. Home owners should check references for all professionals they consider working with. There are four ways to accomplish a building project: 1. An architect can oversee a building project and will be responsible to hire the general contractor and insist that every detail be perfect. The architect then becomes the only person the home owner deals with, and this arrangement may save a lot of frustration. Architects typically charge a fee based on a percentage of the inished building costs. 2. A home builder, general contractor, or remodeler holds a state-issued general contractor’s license and hires subcontractors to build each phase of the building, sometimes personally participating in parts or all of the building process. The general contractor will oversee every stage and work directly with subcontractors, the client, and the building inspectors. Check out credentials and talk to people for whom the builder has completed work. Look at the craftsmanship in inished projects, and ask hard questions about the builder’s reliability, ease of communication, and customer satisfaction. A contract will be signed, and the builder is paid via withdrawals from the lending institution or from your checking account. Never pay the balance until all the details are satisied, within reason. 3. Hiring subcontractors yourself is an economical option if you have some experience and a basic

Floor Plans and Building Systems

knowledge of the building and remodeling process. Keep in mind that subcontractors (masons, carpenters, installers, painters, etc.) may be more accustomed to working for a general contractor, for whom they work regularly; this may make your project less important in terms of quality or reliability. It takes a certain amount of grit to be your own general contractor. It requires time, effort, and diligence. Be sure to read up on the topic both before and during the process. 4. Do-it-yourself is ideal for people with the skills, the tools, the time, the vision, and the support of family members. Without these, the level of frustration can run high, and keep in mind that ixing a botched job often takes more money than the cost of hiring professionals in the irst place. DIY jobs are ideal for smaller remodeling jobs; a person building an entire home alone or with help will need many months away from his or her regular employment, or else the job will drag on for an inordinate amount of time.

185

with the critical path. For example, if the designer and client change the loor-covering selection from carpeting to a wood loor, the building must be left empty for a week or longer to accommodate the loor installers and inishers. This could cause serious problems with the critical path if the designer does not notify the builder in advance. It is the responsibility of the architect or designer and the builder to see that all aspects of the design are properly and correctly executed. The jobs performed by subcontractors are explained in the sections below. They are broken into two categories: the structural building components and systems and the interior inish components. Wood wall-framing members Subfloor

Constructing the Building When construction begins, the architect or general contractor will set up a method for making everything happen at the right time. A critical path (see Table 7.2 on page 193) indicates the time frame, in consecutive and overlapping order, of every step in the building and inishing process. Scheduling means setting up and reconirming dates for the selected subcontractors to arrive on the site and perform their work. If one subcontractor fails to meet the deadline for completion, it could disrupt the entire schedule. The next subcontractor on the critical path may not be available at a slightly later date because of other commitments. It is therefore the responsibility of the general contractor, architect, or project manager to coordinate the schedule by frequently contacting the subcontractors and reconirming the schedule. This responsibility may affect the work of the interior designer at the inish and/or decoration and furnishing stage. However, the smooth low of the construction critical path is crucial to the success of the inish critical path, and in many cases, they are not separated. Large interior design irms that specialize in nonresidential work routinely work out complex and extensive critical paths that track the low of jobs to be performed. The interior designer must understand the aspects of construction in order to communicate effectively with subcontractors, architects, engineers, and other professionals. A mutual respect and understanding between designers and these professionals will allow the designer to better discuss structural plans, architectural details, inish materials, and furnishing instructions. As a result, these aspects will be more successfully completed. The designer has the responsibility of notifying the builder of special materials or inishes that could interfere

Blocking Floor vent

Floor joist Concrete foundation wall

Finished grade

(A)

Anchor bolt

Wood-framed wall

Concrete footing

Floor level change to follow sloping grade

Window Subfloor Wall foundation and footings

(B)

Natural sloping grade

Figure 7.14 (A) A close-up, cutaway view of a foundation wall, floor joist system, and subfloor with placement of wood wallframing members. This illustration shows only a crawl space under the main floor—no basement. (B) A cross section showing a floor change to accommodate the natural slope of the site grade.

186

Chapter 7

High-technology devices are revolutionizing the way work is done at the construction site. Rather than requiring rolls of cumbersome blueprints, the entire set, no matter how large the project, can now be installed on a handheld “personal digital assistant.” Each project manager can then scroll to the section of the work at hand, zoom in on the details, and, if a larger view is necessary, plug the handheld device in to a notebook or laptop at the site. In addition, all the information concerning speciications, bids, critical paths, and punch lists can be kept on personal digital assistants, as can information for the materials and furnishings for a building’s interior.

Structural Building Components and Systems Many kinds of structural systems are in use today. A few are quite common; some are unusual and rarely seen. Building methods vary according to the environment, available materials, and local building codes. The system described here is wood (or steel) frame or truss system construction, used primarily in homes and smaller contract buildings. Contract structural systems are illustrated and identiied at the end of this chapter.

The Foundation After the lot has been surveyed and laid out with chalk lines, and after the hole for new construction has been excavated (dug), cement contractors set up wooden and metal frames, pour, and inish foundation footings. Footings are the strips of concrete set into the ground several inches to several feet below the excavated basement or crawl space area. Footings anchor the foundation walls and serve as a base for the weight of the building. Foundations are the concrete block or poured concrete walls of the basement or sublevel. After the concrete forms are stripped or removed, the walls must cure for a period of time. Cement is a dry mixture of lime, silica, alumina, and other minerals used to bring nonadhesive materials together into a strong, cohesive unit. Concrete is the building material made by mixing cement and a mineral aggregate (gravel) with suficient water to cause the cement to set into a hard mass. Before it sets, concrete is relatively easy to work and may be poured into forms to become a durable material used where strength and stability are requirements and where moisture may permeate interiors (moisture will rot a wooden structure but may not damage concrete). Reinforced concrete has rebar (strong, bendable steel bars) or wire mesh set into the wet mixture before it is dried, which gives structural strength and helps prevent cracking. Flatwork refers to cement for basement loors, garage loors, driveways, and walkways; it may be reinforced and poured over sand, gravel, wire mesh, or rebar to minimize shifting and settling that produce cracks.

Masonry (concrete) block is another type of foundation frequently used in frame construction. Waterprooi ng the foundation is done by spraying or rolling a sealant— such as a tar mixture and perhaps a sheet of heavy black plastic or tar paper—onto the foundation walls before the dirt is backilled around it. The sealant prevents water seepage into the foundation. The foundation walls may also be insulated with styrofoam board before the backill. Window wells are corrugated rounded steel or cement units that keep dirt away from a basement window. They may be open at the ground level or can be covered over with ironwork, plastic bubbles, or glass block. Backilling and compacting mean that some of the excavated dirt is illed into the area outside the completed footings. Compacting, coupled with wetting the excavated area, hastens the settling process so that the dirt will be prepared for the subgrade or foundation loors. Plumbing (see also pages 189–190) takes place at three stages: 1. Before the foundation loor is poured, the underground plumbing brings water and sewer pipe into the sublevel and heating (natural gas lines where applicable). 2. The rough plumbing (water systems, tubs and showers, and a central vacuum) is installed and connected when the building is framed. 3. The inish plumbing is the installation of ixtures, such as sinks and toilets.

Framing Framing, the next step, is the wood or steel skeleton. This is a crucial step in the construction process, because the wooden or steel frame that is set onto the foundation (called frame or truss construction) supports the entire building. Wood or steel joists (beams) are secured with trusses (triangular braces) and form the base for the subfloors (plywood or other material) and the walls. Walls are built of 2-by-4 studs (8-foot lengths of lumber approximately 13⁄4 by 33⁄4 inches) or with steel studs. Loadbearing walls carry the weight of the structure and the roof. Lightweight foam blocks can also be used to frame walls. These are also strong enough to support a roof system. The roof truss system, which may be triangular or lat, is made of rafters and joists. These systems are usually prefabricated to speciication and called roof trusses. (Other wall components, such as various kinds of blocks, may be used instead of wood or steel framing.) Once the walls are framed, the interior spaces are irmly established, and although it is possible to move walls after the building is framed, it is costly in terms of time, labor, and inconvenience. Framing is inished with the addition of plywood, Celotex, paperboard, styrofoam, or other exterior panel materials. These add stability to the frame, add some insulation, and provide closure.

Floor Plans and Building Systems

Two-by-four stud

Rafter

Subfloor (plywood or particleboard) Joist

Firestop

Let-in brace

Double plate

Plate

Stud

Joist Brace Girder/laminated expansion beam Joist Herringbone trusses Sill Concrete foundation wall Sheathing Figure 7.15 The wood-framing system.

A new material made of recycled content with signiicant potential to positively impact the environment is Insulating Concrete Forms (ICFs). These are blocks or panels made of special plastic foams illed with reinforced concrete. They are easily shaped into basements, walls, landscaping curves, or any shape imaginable, with convenient scrap usability. In the framing process, the blocks are most frequently used as exterior walls and are easily cut for electrical, plumbing, and window placement. They are also strong enough to hold concrete and serve as the backer for interior and exterior inishes. ICFs are simple to install; walls go up quickly. A 2,000-square-foot home, built with ECO Block ICF, will save about forty-seven trees with a net extra cost per square foot of about $0.25 to $3.25 more than a traditional wood frame house. The plastic foams used to create ICF vary in price and properties with main differences determined by use. ICF homes rank high in safety and comfort ratings. They provide more security against ire, insect problems, and wind and water damage, and reduce noise pollution. ICF buildings are also air-tight, dramatically reducing residential heating and cooling costs when compared to a typical new home by cutting energy consumption 30 to 50 percent.

187

Interior Environmental Control Systems Interior systems are now installed, which include the rough plumbing, rough electrical, and rough heating. Rough plumbing is the installation of pipes that will connect water to the taps; drains from sinks, tubs, showers, and toilets; and vents for pressure balance, allowing the pipes to drain. Tubs are set at this time so the wall material can be set around them. Rough heating includes forced-air ducts and vents run from the clothes dryer hookup. Rough electrical is the wiring from the breaker box to each area of the interior where electricity will be needed for light ixtures, light switches, and electric outlets. Wiring is also installed now for intercoms, telephones, computer, fax, built-in stereo, and media equipment. A master computer panel is a luxury feature, installed at convenient locations, that can control all electric lights and major appliances. (See “Information Age Home Automation Systems,” in Chapter 5.) Insulation is added at this time, in the form of batts, rigid panels, or blown (loose) insulation. A superinsulated structure has a deeper skeleton framework (up to 14 inches) illed with insulation and layered with a thick vapor barrier plastic. Very tight superinsulation will require air-exchange units to bring necessary fresh air into the interior. Several materials can be used to deaden sound such as sound board, which absorbs noise and is used with Sheetrock or plasterboard. Windows are set in place, and the exterior veneer and inish materials such as brickwork, siding, and stucco are added. The roof is inished with tar paper, shingles, (shake shingles are made of wood; asbestos, or ireproof, shingles are common) or other rooing materials such as bartile or metal shingles or panels. Exterior inishing includes installing any garage doors, inishing the sofit (area under the eaves), the fascia (the front of the eaves), and rain gutters (channel rainfall as it drains off the roof), plastering the foundation, and any exterior painting of trim. Figure 7.16 Windows are installed and framed here with brick masonry. Photo © Kathryn Taylor

188

Chapter 7

Figure 7.17 Sheetrock may be finished as rough plaster, as lightly textured, or with a smooth finish. Here installers attach drywall panels with screws. The seams will be covered with plaster (mud) and tape, and the screw holes will also be filled with plaster. Photo © David A. Taylor

Figure 7.18 Smoothly finished Sheetrock is used in this reproduced Craftsman-style room. The smooth finish is a pleasant contrast next to the rich warmth of wood and as a background for a fine landscape painting of the American Southwest. Photo © Kathryn Taylor

Interior Finish Components The interior inish materials and components include wall, ceiling, and loor inish materials, woodwork and cabinetry, countertops, optional wall coverings, and optional window coverings. The most common wall and ceiling material is Sheetrock, made of pulverized gypsum rock (also called drywall, gypsum board, plasterboard, or wallboard) (see Chapter 11). The Sheetrock is installed by nailing, screwing, or gluing horizontal or vertical panels to the wall studs and ceiling joists. To move walls after the Sheetrock has been hung constitutes major remodeling and is very costly. Wallboard panels measure 10-by-4 or 8-by-4 feet and are cut to it the space. Seams are covered with perfatape (3-inch-wide stiff paper tape), attached and smoothed with plaster called mud. A smooth inish is more costly than texturizing, which is spraying or hand-troweling textures of plaster and then lightly sanding the wall or ceiling to a desired smoothness. Light texturizing is called orange peel, and heavy texturizing is sometimes termed brocade texture. Other inish wall materials include wallpaper,

Floor Plans and Building Systems

ceramic or quarry tile, wood, stone, cork, and fabric. Other ceiling materials include acoustical tile (suspended ceilings), wood, fabric, and wall coverings. The i nish package—built-in shelves and closet systems, baseboard/door/window trim, and railings—is installed next, then painted along with the walls and ceilings. Any woodwork to be painted is also installed at this point. Doors are removed from the prehung frames, painted or stained separately, then hinged. If wood trim is to be stained, it may be installed after the general painting is done. Railings are then installed and inished. Cabinets, countertops, and any other built-in units (preinished) are installed as are windowsills of wood, marble, or tile, and tub and shower surrounds (cultured marble, onyx, or tile). Finish looring is set in bathrooms and laundry areas so that the inish plumbing (sinks, toilets) can be installed. Finish electric work (lighting ixtures) is done before, after, or concurrently with inish looring and plumbing. The wallpaper is installed next. Following that, the carpet or other loors that need some protection (such as wood) are installed, and hardware (door handles and strike plates) is set in place. Appliances are installed, and window treatments may now also be installed. The last step is the delivery and arrangement of furniture and accessories.

Plumbing Systems Plumbing is a term that indicates pipe installed within a building for carrying a volume of air or water. Plumbing typically means the water intake system, waterconditioning and/or water-heating system (including components of passive or active solar systems discussed later in this chapter), and water disposal systems—drains and sewer lines. The plumbing carried within the framework or threaded through the masonry block is termed rough plumbing. Copper pipe is generally used for water intake, and cast-iron (more costly but quieter) or plastic (PVC—polyvinyl chloride) pipe is used for sewer or waste-water disposal. Finish plumbing includes hookups to appliances (dishwashers and clothes washers) and installation of i xtures (sinks, toilets, urinals). Shower units and bathtubs/whirlpools are installed during the framing before the Sheetrock is hung. Plumbing is also used to facilitate central vacuum systems and may also be used for fresh air intake for woodburning stoves and for furnace (heating) and central air-conditioning (cooling) units. In contract design, space will usually be allotted for a plumbing chase (the thick plumbing wall area) that provides access for maintenance. While details of plumbing systems are beyond the scope of this text, here are a few considerations for both new construction and remodeling:

189

Figure 7.19 Rough plumbing is installed after the wall is framed. The black and copper pipes will carry fresh, culinary water to sinks, dishwashers, bathtubs, showers, and washing machines. The larger white pipe will carry away the waste water. Photo © Kathryn Taylor

Figure 7.20 Plumbing is shown installed back-to-back. A kitchen sink on one wall uses the same wall to house the plumbing for a washer, a sink, and toilet. This is economical and wise planning, although there is an advantage to placing a dryer on the outside wall. Plumbing may also be stacked, where bathrooms, for example, are located one above the other, using the same walls for plumbing.

190

Chapter 7

• Plumbing is installed within ceilings, loors, and walls, and its location is generally permanent. Although some modiication is possible, the process of relocating plumbing is dificult, messy, and expensive. • Central plumbing—stacked or back-to-back bathrooms/ kitchen/laundry—is more economical and prevents waste of materials and energy. • A slope or grade of about 1⁄ 8 inch per 10 feet is recommended for indoor waste plumbing so that gravity will aid draining, although in many cases this is not mandatory. Waste lines need to be direct (no curves or elbows) to main plumbing stacks (drains) or exit lines in order to drain properly. Vents that connect to the roof are also necessary for correct draw and drain. • Water that has a shorter distance to travel from the water heater to the point of use will stay hotter than water that travels a greater distance. • Two water heaters are useful in large homes; multiple water heaters are used routinely in contract interiors. A second water heater may be necessary for a hot tub or spa, for example. • Conservation should be a consideration. Controls on the water heater allow for the adjustment of temperatures. Natural gas may be less costly for water heating than electricity or heating oil, although costs vary according to geographical region and from time to time.

• Running pipes through the loor to a designated water heater is an excellent, even form of radiant loor heating, especially under tile.

Heating, Ventilation, and Air-Conditioning

Central heating or space heating of the interior is generally handled through a furnace and connecting hot water pipes or ductwork or ducts (run through the walls, loors, and ceiling joists). With forced-air heating, the furnace heats an element that in turn heats air that passes by it and is blown out. Cold-air return vents draw air back to the furnace where it is reheated for recirculation. Warm air typically enters a room at the loor or ceiling level through registers. Many types and price ranges of furnaces exist, fueled by electricity, natural gas, coal, or oil. A high-eficiency furnace uses less fuel to heat the interior and therefore costs less to run, although these units have a higher initial purchase price. Furnaces may also be itted with humidifying devices (humidiiers) that add moisture to the heated air. (Any method of heating will draw moisture out of the air, which is harmful to health, plants, and furnishings.) Radiant heat is produced by using a furnace to heat water in a boiler. The hot water passes through pipes to a radiator that warms the room. This type of system is not used commonly today, but it may be found in older homes. Most heating systems are controlled with a thermostat, which can be set to maintain Figure 7.21 Finish plumbing is seen in this HGTV Dream House Master Batha speciied temperature. Thermostats for room as the free-standing bathtub and dual undercounter vanity sinks and dual small systems are often programmable to accontrol faucets. Photo HGTV commodate needs according to the time of day or the use of the building. Large HVAC (heating, ventilation, and air-conditioning) systems will be monitored and controlled by computer. Interior furnishings must never obstruct heat registers or cold air returns. Where draperies hang to the loor, clear plastic delectors can be placed over a vent or register that channel or direct the hot air into the room. Room or area heating can also be handled by electric or gas-fueled baseboard units, radiant ceiling panels, radiators, portable space heaters, or wood- or coal-burning stoves and ireplaces or ireplace inserts. These units also must not be obstructed with furnishings that may combust or catch on ire. Local building codes will require a clearance, or distance (usually about 3 feet), that restricts placement of combustible materials, including walls and structural components, near the heat source. An exception is for insulated zero-clearance ireplace units, which can be placed in combustible walls.

Floor Plans and Building Systems

191

(Space and room heating are also discussed later in this chapter under “Active and Passive Solar Systems.”) Ventilation and air-conditioning are interrelated terms. Ventilation refers to natural breezes or air currents from open windows and doors. The designer must be aware that window treatments and furniture placement should allow for, and not obstruct, desired natural ventilation. Ventilation may suficiently cool the interior for most of the year, supplemented by air-conditioning only in the hottest seasons. However, hot, arid, or humid regions rely heavily on air-conditioning for livable comfort for much of the year. Air-conditioning can be handled similarly to heating in small-scale settings: by a central system or by cooling one room at a time. A central air-conditioning system may be handled through the forced-air furnace unit or by a separate unit located outside or inside the building. In very humid climates, the airconditioning unit may have a dehumidiier,

Figure 7.22 This contemporary wood-burning stove supplements heating and gives the owners a greater sense of self-sufficiency. Located in the center of this open plan space, the heat can radiate into both the living/conversation area and the kitchen and dining area. Design by Elliott Elliott Norelius Architecture/photo © Brian Vanden Brink

(A) Figure 7.23 (A) Ducts or ductwork is the system that brings heated air from a furnace to all areas of the home. This shows ductwork in an unfinished basement and insulation in the floorboards, to be covered later with Sheetrock when the basement is finished. The smaller duct leads to a register in the floor. Rough electrical wiring is also seen here. (B) This central airconditioning unit provides refrigerated air to the home. These units are efficient, but generally costly to run in terms of electricity used. Photo © Kathryn Taylor

(B)

192

Chapter 7

a unit that removes excess humidity (moisture) from the air. In dry climates, an evaporative cooling system, or swamp cooler, may be less costly to run and may cool more eficiently. The evaporative or swamp cooler works by forcing air through moistened pads or ilters. It is installed in a wall, window, or ceiling and connected with central ductwork. With this system, windows or doors are kept ajar in the rooms where the cooled air is to be drawn. Heating and/or cooling can also be accomplished or augmented by a heat pump, which uses a geothermal connection to exchange cold and hot above-ground temperatures for the moderate temperatures that prevail several feet beneath the earth’s surface. The designer should be aware of the heating and cooling system and ductwork in the case of remodeling or structural changes in the interior design. Walls or ceilings that carry ductwork cannot easily be removed or altered. Contractors and HVAC specialists are valuable resources for the designer in this regard and should be consulted before structural changes are made.

Acoustics Also integral to the planning of space is the need to control noise through the shape of the interior space and the materials selected for walls, windows, ceilings, and looring. In most contract interiors where many people walk or meet, noise control is imperative. Here are some tools through which acoustics are controlled: • Rough materials as opposed to smooth materials. Even hard surfaces, if they are substantially textured with high/low relief or are rough-hewn, will refract sound. • Shape and volume of space can be planned to break up noise level. • Materials that are part of the interior package: carpeting, wall materials, window treatments, and furnishings will have a great deal to do with the quality and control of acoustics. Carpeting and textile applications absorb sound. • In large concert halls, churches, or public areas where sound needs to be evenly distributed and enhanced, acoustic specialists plan for the exact length, width, and height of the space, the speciic shapes of the loors, walls, and ceilings, and materials that will perfectly balance absorption and relection of sound waves. This is done through mathematical equations and formulas.

The Critical Path and the Punch List The critical path graphically illustrates the overlapping order of everything that must be accomplished in a job. The exact items will vary according to the nature of the job—whether it is new construction or remodeling. The

punch list is a series of items that must be accomplished as the project progresses. The sample includes spaces for noting the start and inish dates. Table 7.2 is a sample construction/inish critical path, and Table 7.3 is a sample punch list. Both represent the types of things that are done in new construction, remodeling, and interior design, though neither is intended to address every detail of the construction/design process. This sample critical path represents a typical time frame for a small home, which can be completed within two months. Larger homes with more features typically take from four to six months or longer to complete. Remodeling projects can take from two weeks to two years, depending on factors such as extent of demolition and reconstruction, funds available, and size of the workforce. Small contract buildings will take from three to eight months to build and furnish, and large contract buildings require a time frame of four months to three years. Not taken into account in this sample critical path is the preliminary design process. Chapter 1 outlines the method involved in gathering data and developing the design before the actual building begins. This sample critical path also does not include lead time, which is the time required to ile for and obtain a building permit, to take the plans to the city and receive approval, to survey and establish the relationship of the building to the lot, and to prepare the property before the excavation begins. Lead time is also required to prequalify the client for the loan and to begin the loan processing—which can take longer to inalize than it takes to construct and inish the building. The critical path and punch list are typically expanded to it the job requirements. The punch list may consist of several sublists and may include speciic items requested by a client as the job progresses. A punch list is also used to note unresolved problems observed during inspection tours of a project. These problems must be resolved by the contractor and subcontractors before the project is inished.

Insulation and Energy Conservation Insulation refers to standard materials used in building construction: rigid panels or sheets of insulation, batting (rolls of luffy iberglass insulation), and blown-in attic and wall insulation, often made of recycled paper or chopped manufactured iberglass. Heavy plastic sheeting can aid insulation by forming a vapor barrier that will not allow heat or cold to penetrate by convection or air movement. Additional window glazing can increase insulative values. Two or even three panes of glass, called double

Table 7.2

Critical Path Week 1

Activity

Week 2

Week 3

Week 4

Week 5

Week 6

Week 7

Week 8

Week 9

Week 10

Week 11

Week 12

Week13

Week 14

Week 15

Week 16

Week 17

Construction Days

1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85

Calendar Days

1 2 3 4 5 8 9 10 11 12 15 16 17 18 19 22 23 24 25 26 29 30 31 32 33 36 37 38 39 40 43 44 45 46 47 50 51 52 53 54 57 58 59 60 61 64 65 66 67 68 71 72 73 74 75 78 79 80 81 82 85 86 87 88 89 92 93 94 95 96 99 100 101 102 103 106 107 108 109 110 113 114 115 116 117

Stake Out and Excavation Dig and Pour Footings Pour Foundation Utility Hook-Up Strip and Cure Foundation Subgrade Rough Plumbing



Grade and Pour Basement Floor Backfill Framing and Building Erection Window Glazing Rough Plumbing Rough Heating Rough Electrical Roof Shingles Masonry/Siding, Soffit, Fascia, Gutter Form and Pour Exterior Concrete Insulation Cleanup Dry Wall (Sheetrock) Ceramic Tile (a. Surround); (b. Countertops) Install Finish Package (Woodwork) Interior/Exterior Painting Install Cabinets/Countertops/Hardware Finish Electrical Install Vinyl/Tile Flooring Install Wallcoverings Finish Plumbing Finish Cleanup Grade Site

Paint Touch-Up Finish Punch List Install Carpet Finish Heating-Registers Clean Windows Install Window Treatments Furniture/Accessories Finalize Billing

Floor Plans and Building Systems

Landscaping

193

194

Chapter 7

Table 7.3

Punch List

Start Date Finish Date Start Date Finish Date Architectural plans Windows set in place/glazed Turn in plans to city Bricking/masonry exterior Order temporary power Order cabinets/built-ins Lay out lot Order looring Order footing material Ceiling insulation Order steel for footing/walls Order inish package Dig hole (excavate) Hang Sheetrock Order concrete for footing Cleanup after this phase Deliver footing material Order tub & shower surrounds Set footing Taping & texture walls/ceiling Call to conirm foundation crew Conirm painter Pour footing Brick interior (ireplaces) Strip & stack footing material Finish work (woodwork) Order underground plumbing Cleanup after this phase Order underground heating hook-up Conirm cabinets/countertops Caulk footing Interior painting Order waterprooing of walls Conirm tile installer Call for inspection of walls Conirm looring installers Order window wells Setting of cabinets Waterprooing of foundation Conirm inish plumbing Call for inspection plumb. & heat. Conirm heating Backill house & loor Conirm electrical Grading & compaction of loors Setting of countertops Run water and sewer laterals Setting of marble and tile Order framing material Order garage doors Pour concrete loor and garage Ceramic tile in entry Deliver framing material Conirm carpet and vinyl Framing of house Finish electrical Cleanup after this phase Set vinyl in bathrooms Conirm windows/doors Finish plumbing Conirm plumbing Finish heating Conirm heating Install garage doors Conirm electrical Install wall coverings Order brick/masonry Finish setting vinyl/carpet Rough heating Install hardware Rough electrical Appliances Run dryer/bathroom vents Install window treatments Install ireplace Finish sofit, fascia, rain gutters Inspection of plumbing, heating, Cleanup after this phase electrical Call for inal move-in inspection Cleanup after this phase Set furnishings in place Note: The critical path and punch list are typically expanded to it the job requirements. The punch list may consist of several sublists, and it may include speciic items requested by a client as the job progresses.

or triple glazing, will signiicantly reduce heat loss or gain. Triple glazing can be found in the form of storm windows. A tinted “summer storm window” cuts down unwanted solar gain, as does solar window ilm. Weatherstripping around doors and windows also helps stop drafts or air iniltration. Draft dodgers are any material (heavy rug, fabric tube illed with sand) pushed tightly against a door to prevent cold air iniltration. Storm doors

and vestibules (air-lock entries) are other means of keeping out cold air. The comfort of conventional and solar buildings often depends on the control of excessive heat loss or heat gain. In the winter when the heat loss occurs during overcast days and cold nights, the windows or collectors will need either movable insulation, such as iberglass insulation panels on the interior or exterior, or insulative window

Floor Plans and Building Systems

treatments, such as layered fabric shades, insulating shutters, or lined and interlined draperies. In the summer, excessive heat gain will need control through exterior or interior shading devices. Exterior shading devices include awnings; rolling, hinged, or angled shutters; solar screens or sunscreens; architectural projections or roof extensions; vine-covered trellises; or deciduous trees. Interior shading window treatments include metallized pleated shades, horizontal and vertical blinds, opaque roller shades, shutters, and soft window treatments such as curtains, draperies, and shades.

Active and Passive Solar Systems Many buildings incorporate active or passive solar heating. The designer needs to understand the terms and concepts of solar energy so that the interior design may complement and augment the system.

Active Solar Systems An active solar system is made of mechanical parts that convert incident solar radiation (insolation) to thermal energy to warm air space, heat water, and even run airconditioning units. The system consists of six basic components that may be altered as needed: 1. Collectors capture or collect the sun’s warmth by means of panels mounted to face the sun at approximately 90-degree angles. They may be focusing (like a magnifying glass) or nonfocusing (like a greenhouse— heating a material, which in turn heats a gas or liquid medium). 2. This thermal energy is moved by transport, usually via a luid or air, from the collectors. This may require pumps, valves, and pipes for liquid transport or blowers, dampers, and ducts for hot air. 3. The transport component moves the heat to storage, a reservoir that stores the thermal energy. It may be simple or complex, made of water, rocks, aluminum oxide, or other materials. The storage ensures warmth

195

at night and on cloudy days when no thermal energy is being collected. 4. Distribution carries the heat through pipes and ducts to the space to be heated. It usually requires larger ducts and radiating surfaces than conventional furnace systems. 5. Auxiliary heating is usually a central or localized system. Hooked into the solar distribution unit, the furnace is capable of taking over heating needs if the active solar system cannot produce enough heat on successive sunless days. 6. Control, perhaps in the form of a thermostat, is an automatic or a manual system to control heat and energy low.

Passive Solar Systems Passive designs share common aspects with active systems. Both collect, store, and distribute thermal solar energy for space heating and water heating. The difference is that passive designs depend on natural heat and cold movement. Heat is naturally transferred in three ways: 1. Radiation is the spreading of heat through space, as in the radiating heat from the Sun to the Earth. Heated elements that send forth warmth (ireplaces and space room heaters) are called radiant heat sources. The heat waves from the Sun, called solar energy or solar gain, are long, strong electromagnetic waves. These waves are strong enough to pass through glass windows, where they refract against loors, walls, ceilings, furnishings, and people. As solar waves bounce off surfaces, some of that energy is absorbed, and the remainder becomes shorter, weaker wavelengths that cannot repenetrate the glass windows. Thus, heat is trapped and builds up inside glass-enclosed spaces, a phenomenon known as the greenhouse effect. 2. Conduction is the transference of heat through matter. Certain materials such as glass and metal are excellent conductors, allowing heat and cold to pass easily through their molecules (which is why they are most

Figure 7.24 Passive solar systems: (A) radiation, (B) conduction, and (C) convection.

(A)

(B) (C)

196

Chapter 7

often used as cooking utensils). Glass- and metalframed windows conduct heat and cold into the interior; metal also makes an excellent component of solar collectors used in active solar systems and passive water heaters. 3. Convection or air movement is based on natural thermal flow (the path of rising warm air and the subsequent falling of cool air). The greenhouse effect warms interior air, making convection work to our advantage through these natural thermal air lows. When the passive system is augmented by mechanical devices such as pumps, fans or blowers, and ductwork— or even connected to an existing furnace system—it becomes a hybrid solar energy system. New buildings may integrate passive solar design principles or hybrid systems into the design of the building. Existing buildings that are remodeled, or have additions, to include an active, passive, or hybrid solar system are retroitted. It is important to note that most solar systems are custom designed for the architecture and space; effectiveness will therefore vary. Direct Gain. The simplest form of passive solar heating is direct solar gain, which is sunshine coming through south-facing windows. The heat is generally absorbed by a thermal mass (dense material slow to heat and cool) such as loors or walls of concrete; ceramic or quarry tiles over cement or rocks; bricks or stone; or barrels or pools of water or sand. Direct gain may allow too much heat, light, and direct sunshine to enter the interior (causing fading and damage to furnishings), and too much heat loss may occur at night. For this reason, direct gain windows may require light-iltering or shading devices and movable insulation to guard against excessive heat loss.

(A)

(B)

(C)

Indirect and Isolated Gain. Indirect and isolated passive solar gain means gathering the heat or energy separate from the occupied areas. Listed and illustrated here are some of the most commonly used passive solar systems: • Trombe walls are thermal storage walls named after the French scientist who developed them. A Trombe wall system uses large areas of south-facing glass as collectors. Within a few inches of the glass, a darkcolored masonry of brick, concrete, or stone slowly conducts the collected heat to radiate warmth to the interior at night. The Trombe walls have vents at the top and bottom to utilize a natural convection loop— hot air becomes lighter and rises so that vents high in the wall bring warm air into the interior; low vents allow cooler, heavier air to return to the heat trap to be warmed. • Thermosiphoning traps air in spaces in the walls and roof. The air is heated and rises to a point where it can be drawn off with fans through ducts. Fiberglass

(D)

(E) Figure 7.25 (A) Direct solar gain, (B) Trombe wall, (C) thermosiphoning, (D) roof monitor, (E) solar greenhouse.

Floor Plans and Building Systems

197

Figure 7.26 This Arizona home receives abundant natural light through a long, narrow north-facing skylight and expanses of south-facing glass. Direct solar gain from the south is permitted in winter and obstructed in summer by a deep, precisely angled roof overhang. A high-efficiency heat pump fulfills all heating and cooling functions. Eddie Jones Architect, Phoenix. Photo © Timothy Hursley/The Arkansas Office, Inc.

Figure 7.27 Passive solar heating is gained in this attached solarium. The French doors are opened to bring natural solar-heated air into the home during cloudless days, even in the deepest of wintertime. The French doors are closed at night and on cloudy days when the solarium is chilly to keep the gained heat in the interior living areas. Design by Whitten Architects/photo © Brian Vanden Brink

panels used in the ceilings can also admit translucent light. A thermosiphonic system is less effective than thermal mass Trombe walls but also is less costly. • Roof monitors are window arrangements set high in the wall or ceiling such as clerestory windows, skylights, or cupolas (glassed-in extensions, also called sun-scoops, in the roof). Monitors admit light and solar winter heat, and they ventilate out summer heat. In the winter the lighter hot air must be circulated to the loor level and the monitors should be protected against heat loss at night. • Solar greenhouses or solariums are the most popular of all indirect passive solar system options, probably because they are the easiest to retroit and because a greenhouse sun space is a delightful, healthful, and versatile extension of interior space. They are even popular in restaurants and contract settings, and in homes they can serve as living/dining space, as a hot tub or swimming pool area, or as a gardening greenhouse. A solarium works best with a thermal mass (rock or sand) surrounded by rigid insulation. Insulated glass facing within 14 degrees of due south works

198

Chapter 7

best to collect sunshine. The thermal mass stores the heat in direct-gain fashion to be released through convection and reradiation in cold weather and at night. The solarium/greenhouse can be designed to close off from the interior at night and during cold, cloudy spells in order to control excessive heat gain and heat loss in the main body of the house. Greenhouses can produce 10 to 50 percent of the heat for the interior, depending on the size and insulation of the building, the climate, the size and orientation of the greenhouse, and factors such as protection from prevailing winds, landscaping, movable insulation, interior air low (an unobstructed convection loop through the house and back to the greenhouse is essential), and the design and quality of the greenhouse itself. Diagonal glass, used in many greenhouses, is the most dificult to protect against heat loss at night and excessive heat gain in the summer, making it less eficient than vertical glass. When air is trapped in or around a home, it forms a natural insulative barrier that conserves energy. The envelope concept, originated by architect Lee Porter Butler, has an integral solarium on the building’s south side, and vents carry the heated air through channels over the ceiling in the attic, down a double north wall, and through channels under the lower loor. The continuous air convection loop utilizes passive solar gain with or without a thermal mass. A berm is an earth mass placed on the north side of a building. Southern window exposure brings in winter heat; shading devices such as trees cool in the summer.

Green Design Green design is not only a major trend in building and interior design; it is also a responsibility we have to future generations. Every decision made during the building and systems selection process should be checked against whether or not the following criteria are met: • The eficiency and long-term durability of the product. A material or mechanical system component that fails to perform will likely end up in the landill. Quality counts, even if the initial cost is a little higher. Eficiency in utilizing natural resources is of utmost importance. • Materials and furnishings should come from sustainable resources, not from resources that are too dificult or take too much time to replant or regrow or that cannot be replenished. • How eficiently the interior will function, and whether the lifestyle and/or working conditions within the building support green design. The monitoring or conservation of water, electricity (light and appliances), natural gas, or heating fuel is one example. Another is the ease of recycling products such as paper,

cardboard, plastics, cans, and glass. Yet another eficiency factor is the ease of controlling heat and cold and light and dark through window coverings. • Green design does make a difference. Through attitude and commitment, each act of conservation, recycling, or reuse (longevity) can add to our ability to ensure a safe, quality life for future generations.

Contract Considerations Structural building systems (seen in Table 7.4) for contract interiors often utilize complex planning that must meet code restrictions and speciications and thus are beyond the scope of this introductory text. However, the beginning interior design student can recognize the following structural building systems that are commonly seen in both historic and new building construction. In historic buildings mass density was the measure of strength, where, for example the weight of the building rested on the thickness of the walls and foundation. Tall structures, such as Medieval churches, were supported with lying buttresses built upon massive walls and foundations so that the upper walls and ceilings would not collapse. Fitting these blocks together through skillful engineering and utilizing friction versus the earth’s gravitational pull made possible the great cathedrals with their soaring rib-vault ceilings and also the domes of great public and church architecture. In the mid-1800s, as iron and steel were mass produced and utilized for steel skeletons, much larger and taller built spaces were possible. Skyscrapers and steelframed houses were referred to as space frames or “curtain wall construction,” meaning that the “skin” of the house between the steel members could be all glass. Steel also made possible the many forms in use from the early 1900s through the present as reinforced concrete, where reinforced concrete slabs allowed for lexibility in shape. In the mid- to late twentieth century, new building materials were developed, and more continue to be developed today. Plastic and other artiicial ibers, extruded materials, and foams used for framing, building blocks, or skins have made possible structures with shapes that are the antithesis of medieval architecture. Buildings that appear to loat, bend, or lean challenge our perceptions about what architecture really is, and give us new horizons for both creativity and function.

Contract Plumbing, HVAC, and Indoor Air Quality Plumbing systems for contract interiors will be gauged by the local building codes. Major plumbing is typically located within a central location in a section of the wall called the plumbing chase, which connects directly to the

Floor Plans and Building Systems

Table 7.4

199

Additional Structural Systems

In nonresidential buildings, metal, concrete, and masonry are the most common building materials. The most often used structural systems are illustrated here.

Metal or space frame is a three-dimensional truss/beam and column system assembly that creates a steel skeleton and is also called curtain wall construction. The exterior finish material can be glass or brick veneer or siding, for example.

Slab system is reinforced concrete ribbed or waffle design that transfers the lateral loads to supporting end beams; slabs can span short distances and are widely used.

Frame system is made of a rigid steel skeleton sheathed with prefabricated rolled steel or precast concrete.

Masonry block construction consists of walls made of structurally supportive brick, such as concrete block or adobe block. Masonry block construction is commonly seen in convenience store/gas station buildings.

Arch systems are stone blocks cut and fitted to form a curved shape, anchored firmly in vertical supports and with a keystone to stabilize the compression and friction needed to bind the arch together. The arch system has been in existence since ancient Romans built viaducts.

Vaulted systems form an elongated arch such as seen in Medieval cathedrals. The vaulted system is used in ecclesiastical and public architecture where lofty spaces are desirable.

(continued)

200

Chapter 7

Table 7.4

Additional Structural Systems (continued)

Dome systems are an arch rotated about a circular plan, with a compression ring rather than a keystone that stabilizes the dome. The dome system is most often seen in rotundas of government buildings and in some churches. The dome is a soaring space inside the building and is essentially an arch system rotated around an axis.

Geodesic domes are constructed of triangular steel skeleton components filled with opaque or transparent materials. The geodesic dome was developed in the twentieth century by American architect Buckminster Fuller. Based on the strongest and most stable building shape, the triangle, this interlocking system creates lightweight and economical spaces for a variety of purposes and even for transportable buildings and shelters.

Beam systems are often seen in gas station canopies and are straight, solid structural elements of reinforced concrete, solid or laminated wood, or rolled steel section based on compressive and tensile stress. The load is laterally transmitted along the axis to the vertical support beams.

Folded plate systems are of thin, reinforced concrete in a strong, rigid geometric form.

Pneumatic systems are air-inflated or air-supported lightweight, flexible membranes.

Tensile systems are fabric structures stretched over vertical posts or frames like a tent.

Cable systems are based on a vertical column and horizontal slab connected with flexible steel cables.

Thin shell membranes are self-supporting concrete or lightweight foam membranes over a steel-reinforcing mesh (like an eggshell) with freeform curvatures as seen in the cutaway illustration.

Floor Plans and Building Systems

Figure 7.28 The green design features of an award-winning New York skyscraper, known as the most environmentally friendly office building in Manhattan. Four Times Square—Developed and owned by The Durst Organization, Inc. Fox and Fowle Architects

201

202

Chapter 7

(A)

(C) (D) (B) Figure 7.29 (A) The new addition to the old library, seen in the background at Brigham Young University, is underground. Three stories down, the new entry is in the glass enclosure at the back of the photo. A wall of windows and ground-level skylights bring natural light for studying into the first underground level. (B) Here the new main entrance is within a metal space framed enclosure, also called “curtain wall construction” where the curtain is glass. This enclosure feels much like a greenhouse space, counterbalancing the destination, which is the new library addition underground. (C) Students gather around a lighted window well wall. (D) Inside the underground first story, these students study with the pleasant qualities of natural light from the window seen in photo (A). All courtesy of Brigham Young University

Floor Plans and Building Systems

rough plumbing beneath the building. Size or capacity of plumbing systems as well as restrictions for intake and waste are governed by code. In many large buildings such as hotels and ofice buildings, windows are ixed or nonoperable, thus creating a mechanically sealed environment that eliminates natural ventilation. This ensures that the HVAC system can eficiently deliver a mix of warm and cool air to achieve a constant temperature. The rate of air exchange—the infusion of clean, fresh air into an environment to replace stale air—is also dictated by code. The number of people and frequency of occupancy compared to the size of the space yields the quantity of cubic feet exchanged per minute or per hour. Additionally, individual rooms sometimes have heating or air-exchange units, typically located beneath the windows, so that the air temperature can be regulated or fresh air can be taken into the space. The desire for enhanced indoor air quality, air that is free of toxins, smoke, mold, and dust, as discussed in Chapter 2, has led many people to incorporate portable

203

air puriiers in homes and contract spaces. In large buildings, such as huge ofice complexes, clean indoor air is often a serious problem. If the air-intake units are drawing poor-quality air from the outside, the indoor quality will suffer. In the miles of contract HVAC ductwork in a single building, it is not uncommon to ind construction debris, buildup of dust, mold, dead insects, and even rodent dung and remains, which contribute to poor indoor air quality. A combination of low air-volume exchange (sometimes sacriiced to save energy costs) and poor air quality creates the sick building syndrome. Studies have linked such poor air quality to a wide spectrum of physical maladies and illnesses that are dificult to diagnose and cure. Optimum air quality can enhance the productivity of the workforce, who will think more clearly, feel more energized, and experience less illness. Ductwork in both homes and contract buildings should be vacuumed and sanitized as a part of routine maintenance. In addition to the discussion in Chapter 2 about air quality, consider that when remodeling older buildings, special care must be taken to protect the remodelers or occupants against the toxins that may be released, including asbestos microibers and lead paint.

Life Safety Public buildings must include life safety systems. The most imminent life safety danger is ire, which can be potentially averted if the following system devices are in effect: • Smoke detectors and ire alarm systems • Sprinkler systems to put out ires

(B)

(A)

Figure 7.30 (A) The plenum is the area above the ceiling; here a suspended ceiling of acoustical tiles provides access to any of the systems in the plenum, including the lighting, heating/ventilation/ air-conditioning (HVAC), the projection system, or the fire alert/ sprinkling system. (B) Egress lighting must be visible both when the lighting works and when there is a temporary electrical outage or emergency, in which case the LED lights continue to operate to lead users to outdoor safety. Photo © Kathryn Taylor

204

Chapter 7

• Automatic closing doors in case of ire • Egress/exit lighting via light-emitting diodes that require no electricity • Easy-to-follow directions posted in an obvious location for escape plan and stair/exit locations in case of ire • Portable ire extinguishers in obvious locations • Backup lighting and power systems for any part of a building that is without natural daylighting and for nighttime emergencies

Systems within the Plenum Life safety and interior comfort-control systems are generally located in the area known as the plenum, a space between the roof/ceiling and the suspended ceiling, which is a metal grid that holds acoustical tile. The plenum contains wiring for smoke detectors and/or ireextinguishing sprinklers, lighting, possibly telephone and intercom (these may also be run in the loor), and HVAC ductwork and registers. The advantage of the acoustical tiles set into the grid is easy access to the plenum when maintenance is required.

Chapter 8 Furniture Arrangement

Function 206 Human Factors 208 The Elements and Principles of Design 212 Basic Groupings 218 Contract Considerations 223

Photo © Kathryn Taylor

206

Chapter 8

The placement of furniture and ixtures in an interior is an extension of space planning and is directly linked to aesthetics and function. Arrangement of furniture according to aesthetic principles adds to the visual appeal of a space and may make its use more satisfying. But furnishings placed without regard for function and user needs will fall short of intended goals, and the aesthetic appeal of the design will vanish as users begin to move furniture around to make the space meet their needs. A good arrangement of furniture will be both functional and pleasing to the senses.

Function Function is the use an environment will have and the activities that will take place there; it dictates the selection and the arrangement of furniture. For example, a livingroom space could be used to accommodate conversation, a library, musical instruments, a stereo, a television, video equipment, slides or movies, games, reading, napping, formal or informal dining, writing letters, paying bills, growing plants, displaying art, or any combination of these or other functions. The arrangement of furniture should be planned to accommodate appropriate activities

in the amount of space available. If the primary use of the space is conversation, then it is logical that the comfortable seating pieces should be placed in groupings that facilitate communication and maximize interaction between users. If the main function of the room is television viewing, the sofas and chairs should be arranged to face the screen. Reading will require the placement of lamps near seating pieces to avoid the eyestrain caused by inadequate lighting. The consideration of function extends to every area of the home. A bedroom will naturally be used for sleeping, but it might also serve for dressing, conversation, a studio, an ofice, a library, an art gallery, a sewing room, or computer or stereo use. Each requires appropriate arrangement of furniture. For example, if reading in bed is important, then a table must be placed close enough to the bedside to reach books. A lamp may be placed on the table, or some other form of lighting should be provided. Another very simple function that often takes place in a bedroom is putting on shoes and stockings. Something as obvious as a small chair or ottoman, appropriately placed in or near the dressing area, can make this simple task much more pleasant. Such considerations, though they may seem insigniicant, can make life run much more smoothly.

Figure 8.1 This bedroom space is arranged to accommodate not only sleeping, but also conversation, reading, and relaxation. Tom Catalano Architect/photo © Brian Vanden Brink

Furniture Arrangement

207

Unless they are custom designed and carefully planned from the beginning, most residences do not offer the kind of lexibility that allows an electric outlet in the middle of the loor. Consequently, furniture groupings will have to be “anchored” to a wall where there are electric and phone connections. Careful planning before construction or during remodeling might include loor plugs for greater lexibility in arranging furniture.

Circulation

Figure 8.2 An arrangement showing combined function.

Combining Functions Often, functions will have a strong relationship to each other. For example, the conversation area previously mentioned might also accommodate informal buffetstyle dining, and the way those two activities interface should be considered. Tables should be arranged close enough to seating for easy placement of drinks or plates, and a serving table should be conveniently located near the seating area. Tables used with seating pieces should be approximately the same height as the arm of the seating piece so that food or drink can be reached easily. The combination of functions is an absolute necessity in small homes or apartments. Such spaces must often include both a dining table and comfortable seating in the same room. Some creative planning not only will solve the problem but will create a solution with a great deal of functional and aesthetic appeal. One such solution might include moving the sofa to the center of the room. A dropleaf table could then be placed behind the sofa to provide dining space for one or two people. With the table pulled away from the sofa or with one leaf extended, even more diners could be accommodated. When not being used for dining, the drop-leaf table could double as a sofa table.

Furniture arrangement needs to accommodate free movement, or circulation, from one space to another. Furniture should be placed to enhance that movement by allowing trafic to low or by restricting and redirecting the trafic when necessary. This kind of control provides the best utilization of space because it eliminates unnecessary trafic patterns. The speciic amounts of space necessary for free circulation are addressed in the next section. As discussed in Chapter 6, interiors have natural trafic patterns. These patterns can easily be seen by drawing

Figure 8.3 The natural traffic pattern of this room consumes nearly half of the available space.

Mechanical Functions It is also important that furniture be arranged so as not to interfere with the mechanical functions of an interior. Heating vents and cold-air returns should not be covered by furniture. Blocking them causes the heating, ventilation, and air-conditioning systems to function much less eficiently. Doors should be able to swing and open freely without interference from furniture pieces, and furniture placement should not hinder the opening and closing of windows. Furniture designed to hold lamps or telephones should be placed near electric outlets and phone jacks for convenience and safety and to prevent tripping over cords.

Figure 8.4 The arrangement of furniture corrects the problem and makes the flow of traffic more efficient.

208

Chapter 8

lines on a loor plan to represent where we would most logically walk to get from one space to another—the natural trafic pattern. The complexity and lack of organization in the completed pattern usually shows quite clearly the need to control trafic. We can control the low of trafic by placing furniture at key locations so that it forces trafic to low away from areas that should be used for seating and conversation or other functions where trafic might be disruptive. These locations can be determined by preparing a corrected plan indicating where the trafic should low. Laying the corrected plan over the natural trafic plan will show where furniture should be placed to control the low. For example, some homes have no entries—the front door opens directly into the living area. In this kind of plan, a sofa or other large piece of furniture could be used to divide the seating area from the door area and establish a visual entry that directs trafic behind the seating area instead of through it. Such placement avoids cutting the room in half with an unnecessary trafic pattern. Thus, a well-placed piece of furniture can be a simple deterrent to misdirected trafic.

Figure 8.5 This arrangement allows 3 feet of clearance for major traffic.

Human Factors Anthropometrics Anthropometrics, the dimensions of the human form, are an important consideration in arranging furniture because human dimensions must be the standard of measure for interior design. One must also consider people whose needs for circulation are different from the norm. For example, the needs of those who use wheelchairs, canes, crutches, or walkers must be addressed if they are to be able to move freely in an interior (see Chapter 2).

Figure 8.6 Three feet of clearance for extending the legs.

Standard Clearances Users without physical impairments require variable amounts of space, or clearance, to circulate comfortably within an environment. • Major trafic paths should be 3 feet or wider. • Minimal clearance for trafic is 1 foot 6 inches. • Seating pieces used with coffee tables need slightly over 1 foot of clearance between the table and the front of the seat. • For a user to be able to extend his or her legs in front of a seating piece, about 3 feet of space is required, depending on leg length and the degree of extension. • Desks and pianos require a minimum of 3 feet of clearance for chairs, benches, and users. • Comfortable dining requires slightly more than 2 feet of space per user along the perimeter of the table.

Figure 8.7 Three feet of clearance for a piano bench and a desk chair.

Furniture Arrangement

209

Figure 8.10 Three feet of clearance between beds.

Figure 8.8 Three feet of clearance for dining chairs.

Figure 8.11 Standard clearance in a bathroom.

• Space between two beds should be from 2 feet 6 inches to 3 feet. • Minimal clearance to facilitate bed making is 1 foot 6 inches between the bed and the wall. • In a bathroom, clearance of 2 feet 6 inches to 3 feet 6 inches in front of the toilet provides adequate space for most functions.

Figure 8.9 Three feet of clearance between bed and dresser.

• In order to accommodate a seated diner and space behind for passage and serving, 3 feet of space should be planned. • Getting in and out of a dining chair requires about 1 foot 6 inches of space. • Three feet is considered good clearance between a bed and dresser.

Proxemics Proxemics, a term coined by anthropologist Edward T. Hall, describes the way people use space and the way that use is related to culture. Proxemic patterns vary in different cultures; the distances suggested here apply to North Americans. Hall’s study identiies four distances: 1. The space from 1 foot 6 inches to actual physical contact is considered intimate distance and is reserved for displays of affection, comfort, protection, or physical aggression.

210

Chapter 8

are customarily seen appropriately touching and even embracing without any threat or discomfort.

Figure 8.12 Intimate distance—1 foot 6 inches to contact.

Figure 8.13 Personal distance—1 foot 6 inches to 4 feet.

2. Personal distance is equal to the invisible “bubble” of space with which we separate ourselves from others. Everyone has a different perception of this space, and many are made uncomfortable by those with smaller bubbles who stand too close and violate personal space. Personal distance usually extends from 1 foot 6 inches to 4 feet. In many cultures, particularly those of southern Europe, the Middle East, and Latin America, the personal-space bubble is much smaller; people

The way people normally use furniture is also affected by their perception of personal space; for example, few people choose to sit in the center of a sofa. Most people sit at one end, and most often they prop one arm on the armrest. In this way, a sofa that can comfortably hold three people is most often occupied by only two people, since no one wants to sit in the middle. A third person sitting on an 8-foot sofa between two people leaves only about 1 foot between each person. This comes very close to intimate distance, leaving people who are just friends—or, worse yet, acquaintances or strangers—in the uncomfortable position of being too close. Furthermore, the middle person has no “anchor” in the form of an armrest to cling to for mental protection when that personal space is invaded. When forced into close contact, we become uncomfortable because we perceive our personal-space bubble as a necessary privacy. Those who use crowded public transportation or elevators have methods of coping with the unnatural intimacy of such situations. Most will become immobile and avoid eye contact. Body contact is avoided, and when touching does occur, the tendency is to recoil quickly. Eyes are kept focused away from others; to help avoid eye contact, some may keep their eyes ixed on a book or other object. When strangers enter an empty seating space, they tend to take seats at opposite ends, gradually illing the space but leaving a seat between themselves and others. When the only spaces left are next to a stranger, some people will choose to stand or will hesitate before taking a seat. Many would consider a person aggressive who sits next to them when there are still areas of open seating available. Under dificult circumstances, such as when airports are illed with grounded travelers, many of these notions of personal space are repressed. In such conditions, strangers may be viewed as colleagues in discomfort and the crowding perceived as more tolerable. 3. From 4 to 12 feet is considered social distance. At the far end of that scale interaction tends to be more formal, and at the close end interaction is characterized by greater involvement and less formality. 4. Beyond 12 feet is considered public distance. In public distance there is little personal interaction.

Furniture Arrangement

These distances can be helpful in planning interiors. For example, furniture groupings for conversation should be planned within the 4- to 12-foot bounds of social distance. Optimal distance for conversation is 8 feet—it seems to feel neither too close nor too distant.

Figure 8.14 Social distance—4 to 12 feet.

211

Crowding The effects of crowding on animals are well known. In crowded conditions, animals begin to suffer stress, abnormal social behavior, illness, and in some cases death. Studies of crowding in humans have shown confusing results. Hall cites a study by Frenchman Paul Chombart de Lauwe, who discovered that when the subjects of his study had less than 8 to 10 square meters of space per person in their residences, their social and physical pathology doubled. He also discovered that when the space grew beyond 14 square meters per person, the problems also increased, though not as dramatically. Crowding is not strictly a function of dimensions. It also seems to be closely related to culture, personality, and the desire for involvement with other people. Those who enjoy involvement and interaction with others tolerate and, in some cases, even enjoy crowding. They ind a crowded, lively environment exciting. Shops, cafés, restaurants, clubs, shopping areas, and markets are areas where one might expect to see planned crowding. The crowded environment should also provide islands of tranquility for those who enjoy less involvement or for those who need to retreat periodically. This type of person may ind the effects of crowding (sounds, smells, and touch) overstimulating. In home environments, some people enjoy being surrounded by lots of furniture, books, and art objects. Others need more visual or actual space in which to mentally expand. Designers must be sensitive to these differences in personality and preferences when planning furniture arrangements because the amount of furniture and its placement will affect the way users feel about their homes.

Territoriality Territoriality is an aspect of proxemics that deals with the need to have a space of our own. This need manifests

Figure 8.15 Public distance—more than 12 feet.

Figure 8.16 Eight feet is optimal for conversation.

212

Chapter 8

itself in many ways. For example, you may have noticed that many people select a classroom seat at the beginning of a school term and sit in the same seat each time the class meets. When someone else sits in that place, they are annoyed and feel displaced. The same kind of behavior occurs in families where adults and children have determined their places at the table or in the car. Variations from the normal seating pattern may lead to conlict. Those who share bedrooms may ind that certain parts of the room or even a certain side of a bed “belongs” to one person. When it is time to clean or straighten the space, things not belonging to one person may end up in a pile somewhere in the area that is perceived as the other person’s territory. These behaviors are expressions of the need to claim space. It is important to understand this need so that, when placing furniture, we can not only allocate adequate

space for each person but also design shared areas with space and amenities that give users the opportunity to personalize and establish territoriality.

The Elements and Principles of Design Several of the elements and principles of design are directly applicable to the arrangement of furniture. Understanding how these tools apply to furniture placement leads to attractive and pleasant furniture arrangements.

Balance, Scale, and Mass Furniture should be arranged to provide a feeling of balance within the interior. Mass or visual weight (how heavy the piece appears to be) is a primary consideration in arranging furniture to create balance. Furniture is particularly effective in achieving equal distribution of mass because it is available in so many different sizes, shapes, materials, and colors, which are all factors that inluence mass. For example, darker pieces appear heavier than lighter pieces, bold and large-scale patterns have more mass than subdued or smaller-scaled patterns, heavier textures are more massive than smooth textures, and pieces the eye can penetrate are less massive than solid pieces. For this reason a glass table appears to be lighter scaled and less massive than a solid wood table, and a piece that sits up on legs has a lighter appearance than a piece that is solid or upholstered clear to the loor. Following are some guidelines for considering balance and scale in the arrangement of furniture:

Figure 8.17 The skirt makes the chair on the left look more massive.

(A)

(B)

Figure 8.18 Parallel groupings showing (A) symmetrical and (B) asymmetrical arrangements.

Furniture Arrangement

• The visual weight or mass of the pieces is more important than actual dimensions or scale in creating a well-balanced arrangement. • Furniture can be balanced with other pieces of furniture. For example, two chairs of the same visual scale placed across from each other will be visually balanced. • Furniture can also be used to balance architectural elements in an interior. For example, a sofa or love seat could be used opposite a ireplace to create balance. • Massing furniture together may create heavier mass in order to achieve balance. For example, a large-scale wing chair does not balance with a small side chair. However, if the side chair is arranged with a table and lamp, the three pieces massed together may balance the heavier wing chair. • Groupings may be arranged to create symmetrical or asymmetrical balance. For example, a pair of matching sofas facing each other in front of a ireplace creates a symmetrical grouping. If one of the sofas were replaced with a pair of chairs, the grouping would be asymmetrical but balanced nonetheless. One form of balance is not better than the other—each type has its own appeal. In a symmetrical grouping when small details such as lamps, tables, or even small occasional chairs are varied, the feeling will still be one of symmetry, but the grouping will have the intriguing quality of asymmetry. (An occasional chair is a small-scaled piece that sits away from the main seating area and can be drawn up on occasion when it is needed for additional seating.) • Lighting should also be considered in planning the balance of a furniture arrangement. At night the balance of a room can be drastically altered by lighting. Artiicial light will create areas of emphasis that should be balanced along with the furniture. If the lighting is well placed and the levels of light are appropriate, the balance will be maintained. • The inal judgment as to whether balance has been achieved will have to be personal, visual, and intuitive—no device exists for such measurement other than the eye.

• •





213

and soft textures are alternated. A number of upholstered pieces without contrasting textures of wood or other hard materials to break the low may feel monotonous. The alternation of textures creates contrast, an element that makes any design more pleasing. Alternation of rectilinear and curvilinear forms will also make the interior more appealing. The addition of rounded forms in an otherwise rectilinear design softens the impact of the straight lines and lessens any harshness such lines may have implied. The same subtle appeal is created when high and low forms are alternated. Particularly when seen in elevation (a lat, straight-on view), an arrangement of furniture is more interesting when high and low pieces are mixed in such a way that wall space is broken into interesting shapes and proportions. Alternation of high and low pieces away from the walls, in the open space of an environment, helps relieve monotony and can provide interest.

Emphasis Emphasis deals with the creation of a focal point. A focal point is the object or area where the eye is drawn irst.

Rhythm The placement of furniture is an exercise in rhythm. One particularly important aspect of rhythm to consider when creating furniture arrangements is rhythm through alternation. Here are some considerations for the use of rhythm by alternation: • An interior will be more interesting when upholstered and wooden pieces or hard

Figure 8.19 This Modern home conversation area features a variety of textures and shapes that balance strong architectural elements. Alternation of rectilinear and curved forms is carefully planned. The sofa is flanked by a pair of armless upholstered chairs on the right and a pair of curved wooden X-shaped chairs on the left. The low rectangular bench contributes rhythm by repetition of the vertically placed tree branches. The round wooden coffee table contrasts with the rectilinear pieces and is easily accessible from all seats. Photo by Inti St. Clair, Digital Vision/Getty Images

214

Chapter 8

Figure 8.20 Large open spaces like this one inspired by Asian design, need furniture placed to create smaller groupings that define different areas. Here the conversation area is one grouping and the dining area is another. The windows are covered with Silhouette® window shadings that give a translucent effect when opened as shown here. The largest window forms a backdrop for the Chinese table and warrior statue with a grouping beneath of a vase, a basket, and a small pot. This arrangement gives a focal point where no obvious focal point exists. Photo courtesy of Hunter Douglas

Furniture arrangement is an important factor in creating an area of focus within an interior. The planning of primary and secondary focal points gives the environment a sense of purpose and subtly involves and stimulates the senses as the eye moves from one area of emphasis to another. Fireplaces, windows, and other architectural features are natural focal points that draw the eye. Following are some guidelines for creating emphasis: • In rooms with natural focal points, furniture can be placed to emphasize and take advantage of them. A grouping around a window or ireplace will emphasize the ine natural features of the room. • In rooms that lack natural focal points, furniture can be placed to create groupings that take their place. For

example, a case piece such as a chest or secretary could be placed against a wall with a pair of sofas placed facing each other at right angles to the case piece. The seating area would then be focused on the case piece. • Most rooms will have just one primary focal area and other secondary or minor focal areas. In a standardsize living room, the area around the ireplace could be the primary focal area, and the secondary focal points could be (1) a desk with a chair and a lamp, (2) a console table with a painting or mirror and a lamp, or (3) a comfortable chair with a table and lamp for reading tucked into a corner. A chest with an occasional chair could also be a secondary focal point. • Very large spaces may require more than one primary focal area. For example, very large living rooms may

Furniture Arrangement

215

need more than one main seating area to adequately ill the space. • The table will be the primary focal point in a dining room, and a serving piece with a painting or mirror and side chairs could be a secondary focal point. • The bed will generally be the primary focal point in a bedroom, and a small area with comfortable seating, tables, and lighting could be the secondary focal point.

Line and Harmony Whenever a piece of furniture is placed in an environment, a line is created where the piece meets the loor or where its silhouette is seen against the background. In plan drawing (a view drawn from above), the furniture arrangement is also a study in line. Line is a powerful tool and should be used judiciously to create harmonious furniture arrangements. Some points to consider about the harmony of line when planning furniture arrangements include the following:

(A)

• If a line is introduced into a space, it should relate harmoniously to the other existing lines. For example, a sofa or other large piece placed diagonally across the corner of a room feels awkward unless other elements repeat and enhance the diagonal line of the piece. • Placing large pieces at an angle often disregards the basic lines of the architecture. However, if other elements are arranged in concert with the diagonal line, the result may be very harmonious and interesting. For example, if an area rug turned on an angle is used as the format for an arrangement in a room of suficient scale, the grouping will feel right. If the other pieces or the architectural elements in a room follow

(B) Figure 8.21 (A) Incorrect and (B) correct placement of furniture using angles that contrast with the natural lines of the room.

Figure 8.22 A diagonally placed fireplace and upper cabinet is the anchor for this U-shaped furniture grouping, placed at 90-degree angles, assuring harmony of line of the grouping with the fireplace. Photo © Melabee M. Miller

216

Chapter 8

the same diagonal format and repeat and accentuate the diagonal lines, the arrangement will be pleasing. • Chairs in a grouping placed at a slight angle tend to make the arrangement feel less formal and rigid because they soften the solid feeling of a rectilinear composition.

Form and Space The forms in a furniture arrangement are the individual pieces of furniture. The space is the empty area between the furniture pieces. The design of space is as important as the furniture forms themselves. Furniture arrangement is a two- and three-dimensional study in space and form and should be planned with sensitivity to negative space. Seen in plan, the arrangement should make interesting use of space. Seen in elevation, the furniture placement should break the wall space into interesting forms and create well-proportioned negative spaces. Art and accessories hung on the wall must be treated as part of the composition. Consider the following when arranging furniture and hanging accessories: • Negative space needs to be interesting; avoid arrangements with the furniture “holding hands” in dancehall fashion around the perimeter of the room. This type of arrangement is often safe but without the interest it could have if some of the furniture were drawn into the room instead of being placed lat against the wall. • Large pieces of furniture pushed tightly into corners are not as pleasing as pieces placed leaving some negative space. This is true in both plan and elevation—the piece needs breathing room to separate it from the corner or some negative space to separate it from a doorway or window. • A desk that is placed perpendicular to a wall or actually moved out into the room may be more interesting than one that is pushed lat facing the wall. Turned perpendicularly, it extends into the negative space and changes the shape of the space, making it more interesting.

(A)

(B) Figure 8.23 The (A) negative space in a grouping is made more interesting (B) by pulling pieces away from the wall. Figure 8.24 A desk placed at a right angle to the wall makes a functional and interesting composition.

Vertical Space In considering form and space, it is important to recognize the way that the interior will be experienced in elevation. Together with the architectural openings (windows and doors), the furniture and accessories (art pieces, hangings, collections) form a vertical pattern or wall composition. Thus the planning of where to place furniture and accessories in relation to walls is an integral part of applying the elements of form and space to design: • In many instances the accessories can be used to complete the composition and inish the balancing process.

There are no rules governing the hanging of pictures and other accessories, only the consideration of form, negative space, and balance. • When hanging more than one piece in a grouping, it is important to lay the pieces out on a table or on the loor just as they will be hung. By doing this, one can evaluate the composition and see how the pieces relate to each other and how the proportion of the

Furniture Arrangement

217

(A)

(B) Figure 8.26 Two ways of hanging art pieces: (A) in a grouping and (B) gallery style.

Proportion Figure 8.25 The placement of two framed black-and-white photos is in proportion to the wall and in good relationship to the headboard and sconces. Photo courtesy of Sea Gull Lighting Products, LLC









negative spaces between the pieces relates to the pieces themselves. Accessories must be considered in relationship to the furniture with which they share a wall. Art pieces should not be hung so high above the furniture that the relationship between the pieces is lost. The scale of the accessory should relate well to the scale of the furniture with which it will be placed. If the scale of a piece is too small, several smaller pieces could be massed to create a grouping of appropriate scale and mass for the furniture. For example, a mirror or painting can be massed together with a chest or table to balance a higher case piece on the opposite side of a ireplace. On walls without furniture or architectural openings, the accessory pieces could be massed in groupings or hung gallery fashion. Hanging pictures gallery fashion requires that the pieces be placed in a row at eye level with appropriate spacing between each piece. If the pieces are all close to the same size, an imaginary line could be traced along the wall to mark the top or bottom edge of the pictures. If this seems too rigid, then an imaginary line could be used instead to mark the center of each picture. The height of hangings should relate to other pieces in the room as well as to the composition of all the other walls.

Every space has its own shape and proportions. Some spaces are long and narrow, some are square, and others are well-proportioned rectangles. In a large-scale interior, the proportions will be less apparent and consequently of less concern when arranging furniture. In most environments, however, the proportions of a room should be carefully considered when placing furniture. Furniture arrangements can be planned to make best use of awkward spaces, and in some cases the proportions of a space can be visually altered by a good furniture arrangement. The following considerations may be helpful: • Rectangular rooms, if not too narrow, are the most lexible and easy to arrange. • A square room is more dificult but could be arranged with a rectangular grouping as a primary focal point on one side, with open space along the opposite side for secondary focal points. An area rug could be used to help deine the primary focal point. • If the square room is large enough, an area rug could also be used to create a central focal point with a square or rectangular grouping placed in the center of the room. This would require careful planning of loor plugs or the use of recessed or other ceiling lighting. • Long, narrow spaces can be challenging. The best way to handle this type of space is by dividing it into areas of function or use. For example, in long, narrow family rooms or game rooms, part of the space could be devoted to conversation and music/video. The next section of the room could be planned for a game, pool, or Ping-Pong table or for eating space. The back of a sofa could serve as a divider between the spaces and help alter the visual proportion of the room.

218

Chapter 8

1. Straight-line groupings are formed by arranging furniture in continuous lines. Because this coniguration is the most eficient for seating the largest number of people in a space, it is a popular choice for contract interiors. It is used in theaters, airplanes, waiting rooms, classrooms, churches, and arenas, as well as in homes when they have been arranged for club meetings or other large gatherings. This type of grouping makes interaction dificult since it requires leaning forward, weaving back and forth, or craning your neck to talk with anyone except the person next to you. Its principal advantage is its ability to handle crowds.

Figure 8.27 The proportions of a long narrow room are improved by dividing the space visually according to function.

Figure 8.28 A straight-line grouping.

• A narrow living room could also be divided according to use into seating area, music area, dining area, or even into more than one area for conversation and seating. • Long, narrow rooms do not need extra-long sofas to match the proportion of the space. The long sofa only tends to exaggerate the uncomfortable proportions. It is wiser to divide the space into smaller modules with furniture groupings. • In contract interiors, narrow spaces can be intriguing. For example, a narrow space with a row of tables can make a restaurant more interesting because the function its the space.

(A)

Basic Groupings Most seating arrangements it into seven basic conigurations. The seven groupings can be composed of any combination of benches, ottomans, chairs, sofas, lounges, or love seats, and each grouping will be appropriate for different functions:

(B) Figure 8.29 (A) A straight-line grouping is ideal for places such as this lecture hall, where little interaction is desired and (B) where the attention is focused toward a speaker or visual presentation. Photos © Kathryn Taylor

Furniture Arrangement

2. L-shaped groupings, formed with two seating pieces placed at right angles to each other, are more conducive to interaction. The L could be an intimate arrangement of two chairs and a small table tucked into a corner or a pair of sofas capable of seating several people. It could be formed by something as simple as a chair placed at a right angle to the end of a love seat or sofa. The L-shaped grouping allows people to converse easily because the angle of conversation is comfortable. They do not face each other directly but sit at a slight angle, elbow to elbow. 3. U-shaped groupings are an extension of the L shape. They can be formed by adding a chair, sofa, love seat, or Figure 8.30 L-shaped groupings.

Figure 8.31 In a great room, containing kitchen, dining, and living areas open to each other, the furniture grouping forms a division of space. Here, the overstuffed sofa and chair form a tight L-shaped grouping with an end table and coffee table a close part of this arrangement. Photo © Kathryn Taylor

219

any seating piece to the L. This coniguration also enables interaction and further expands the space for seating. 4. Box-shaped groupings are formed by adding seating pieces to partially close the opening of the U-shaped grouping. This is the best coniguration for interaction among the largest possible group of users. Conversation pits, which are built-in seating areas designed as an integral part of the environment, are often boxshaped. If built around a ire pit, the interaction is often diminished by the ire hood, which interferes

Figure 8.32 U-shaped groupings.

220

Chapter 8

Figure 8.35 Box-shaped grouping.

with visual contact. But if the line of sight is carefully maintained, the interaction can be excellent. In more standard furniture groupings, the opening of the U will usually be closed with a chair or pair of chairs Figure 8.33 A possible solution for furniture arrangement in a allowing suficient room for users to enter and exit the square room. grouping with ease. 5. Circular groupings are much like boxshaped groupings except that, as the name implies, they are arranged in circular shapes. Some modular furniture pieces are designed in a circular or curving fashion. These groupings, like the box-shaped groupings, are excellent for interaction because eye contact can be maintained with nearly everyone in the group. However, their unusual shape makes them unsuited to many situations. 6. Parallel groupings are an excellent arrangement for emphasizing a natural focal point or creating one where none exists. Two seating pieces are placed so that they face each other at right angles to a window, ireplace, or other natural focal point. The seating pieces frame the focal point, and the users face each other for good interaction. Where no natural focal point exists, the grouping can focus on a case piece or some other object of interest. Parallel groupings have a disadvantage of directly facing others, which is a confrontational or interview position. This potentially awkward situation can be remedied with a coffee table, which forms a safety barrier Figure 8.34 This spacious living area is anchored with a central U-shaped furbetween the people. The rectangular dinniture grouping. The perimeter of the room is furnished with fully accessorized ing table is a similar illustration—the dintables and one solo grouping chair. Framed wall art is arranged gallery-style and ers facing each other are safely behind the in groupings. Design by Whitten Architects/photo © Brian Vanden Brink sides of the table.

Furniture Arrangement

221

Figure 8.36 This circular grouping is created by placing chairs around a table. Circular groupings are similar to box-shaped groupings, but more flexible. Design by John Silverio Architects/photo © Brian Vanden Brink

Figure 8.37 Parallel groupings.

222

Chapter 8

Figure 8.38 Parallel black leather sofas emphasize this contemporary fireplace and abstract artwork. The table between the sofas softens the potential awkwardness people may feel sitting directly facing each other. The focal point also helps people to have a place where they can direct their attention. Photo courtesy of HGTV

Figure 8.39 Solo grouping.

7. Solo groupings may sound like a paradox— the ideas may not seem compatible. However, it is important to remember that single pieces placed away from main groupings of furniture generally need some form of accompaniment. For example, a reading chair at least needs a lamp and would be even better with a table to hold a book and a refreshment. The chair becomes more functional and feels more purposeful with the table and lamp. Consider also that when a single chair is placed in a particularly beautiful spot to complete a point of emphasis, it may never be occupied. Where the design may call for a chair as part of a vista—placed under a window or at the end of a hallway— people may feel “on stage” if they use it. Seating pieces in some sleek, modern rooms may have no need for accompaniment. In such environments, the furniture is often treated as sculpture whose principal purpose is aesthetic. The lighting in these spaces will often be architectural and preclude the need for tables and lamps. The appeal of such designs is in their clarity and lack of embellishment; extra pieces of furniture would only detract. However, most rooms are designed with a wider range of purpose in mind and are made better by grouping pieces that extend the function of the furniture. Even a wall of books can be made more functional by placing an ottoman or occasional chair next to the bookcase for browsing.

Arranging Furniture with CAD Programs Computer-aided design (CAD) programs, also called e-design or room planners, have the capability to

Figure 8.40 A single chair and small table form a place for just one person to enjoy a solo grouping—a place to read, work on projects, or relax. A solo grouping is perfect for a corner of a room where limited space or the interior design plan calls for a limited furniture arrangement. Photo courtesy of Andersen Windows

create room loor plans with structural elements such as looring, windows, doors, and ireplaces. Furniture, rugs, and accessories can also be placed and easily rearranged. The size and proportion of all elements can be changed from the standard elements to match the actual furnishing pieces. There are two types of programs: courtesy online programs on some furniture store websites, and purchased software loaded onto a

Furniture Arrangement

223

Figure 8.41 Case Study Furniture Arrangements for an Upscale Home. These furniture arrangements have been created with a CAD program with the capability of specifying colors as well as furniture placement. The renderings were created by the interior designer to help the client see what pieces would be purchased and placed in which room with selected colors used on floors and furniture pieces. (A) A U-shaped arrangement around a fireplace is centered in this formal living room atop a large Oriental rug. The coffee table is an upholstered ottoman. Two solo groupings are placed on the right and are on each side of a columned opening to an adjacent room. An angled L-shaped grouping on the left is anchored by a smaller Oriental rug. Wood pieces include a sofa console table, placed directly behind the love seat with a pair of lamps indicated placed on top. A French armoire is located next to the wall behind the sofa with a minimum of 3 feet clearance for circulation. A shaped oblong table is placed between the chaise lounge and armchair. (B) Furniture placement in the home’s solarium or conservatory follows the lines of the bay window with chairs in a circular, modified U-shape. Four chairs are placed at the round glass table with two other chairs close by to accommodate up to six persons. Circular groupings offer flexibility. The rendering also indicates glass tables and wood pieces. The design also calls for plants and a tile floor—sensible elements for this sunny glass-enclosed space. Design by Linda Mannherz, renderings by

(A)

DreamDraper ® software

(B)

computer. Free online programs allow the designer and consumer to quickly create a room plan and may allow the user to save the plan on the website for future reference. Purchased programs come with far greater capabilities, including perspective placement and wall and window treatment design. Detailing and speciications, including the selection of custom upholstery fabric for furniture taken from online fabric supplier sites, are some of the features offered. The plans can be printed or transmitted for presentation to a client, and form

the basis for furnishings purchase as well as a plan for the installer.

Contract Considerations Function Many contract designs will include areas of seating, dining, or sleeping that are treated in the same way they

224

Chapter 8

(A)

Figure 8.42 (A) Systems furniture provides versatility and has great design interest as well. (B) The “Ethospace” cubicle gives a sense of territoriality and privacy, allowing the user to concentrate on the work at hand. Photos courtesy of Herman Miller

(B)

Furniture Arrangement

would be in a residence. However, in other cases of nonresidential design, the list of functions will not always relate to a speciic person but rather to a generic need or function. For example, in an ofice with a receptionist, those who enter should have their attention drawn directly to the reception desk. The reception area must then be placed so that it is the irst thing seen as a person enters. The designer will not ask the receptionist if a center-stage position is agreeable because in this situation the function supersedes the personal preferences of a speciic user.

Contract Furniture Types Contract design often includes placement of ixtures that are quite unlike any furniture used in residential design. For example, in health care facilities, such as doctors’ ofices, clinics, and hospitals, there will be furniture specially designed for examination and procedures. The design must relect understanding of each procedure and the relationship between different procedures so that the ixtures and equipment can be placed for eficiency and convenience. This kind of specialized need is one of the main reasons designers develop and practice in specialty areas such as health care design, restaurant design, hotel design, and ofice planning. Such specialization allows a design group to stay current with the latest technology and developments in each area and with the ways to best implement these developments in a design.

Planning for Systems Furniture Many businesses and institutions are designed with large, open work spaces for many users. To make eficient use of such spaces, designers often specify systems furniture (discussed in Chapter 9). This consists of prefabricated modules that can be arranged in a number of different ways to create spaces and workstations for an endless number of different needs and functions.

225

Systems furniture provides a great deal of lexibility, but determining space and function needs for each area is an enormous undertaking. This task is made much simpler by the use of computer software provided by the systems furniture manufacturer for collecting and analyzing data on needs and functions. These programs generate speciications for the types of modules that best meet the users’ needs. The systems furniture is also laid out by the software as the designer plans the space. Those representing the manufacturer and selling the systems furniture are also available to help the designer specify the right components and plan their optimal arrangement.

Circulation Because many of the basic problems of circulation and trafic control are the same for residential and contract design, principles or solutions observed in one setting can be applied in the other. For example, many contract environments are designed with open plans, where one enters directly into open areas. Spaces with open plans have a particular need for trafic control. In retail stores and restaurants, furniture and ixtures are often used to deine areas for trafic. In restaurants, the placement of tables will create aisles for circulation; the patterns can be altered by rearranging the tables. In retail stores, ixtures such as clothing racks or display tables are used to create lanes for trafic. Changes in material will sometimes suggest trafic patterns to a user. For example, in a store or restaurant, the main trafic lanes might be paved in slate or tile, and the seating or sales area covered with hardwood or carpet. The change in material indicates where major trafic should low. By plotting natural patterns of circulation and then determining where trafic should low, open spaces with carefully placed furniture or ixtures can be designed to function as well as they would if they had actual walls or dividers to control trafic.

This page intentionally left blank

Chapter 9 Furniture Selection

Wooden Furniture 228 Metal Furniture 230 Other Furniture Materials 231 Upholstered Furniture 233 Furniture Categories 236 Obtaining Furniture 238 Furniture Harmony and Human Factors 239 Furniture Types 240 Contract Considerations 242

Photo © Brian Vanden Brink

228

Chapter 9

Furniture selection is a prime means of expressing individuality in interiors. Furniture has become an art form that can move us with its beauty, and whether or not we are conscious of it, the furniture we choose says much about our values and design sense. Because furniture often represents a sizable investment it is particularly important that it be well chosen for its quality of design, construction, function, and comfort, as well as for its lasting good looks. In order to make the best possible selection when specifying furniture, it is important to understand relative quality and its relationship to price. Only when the quality of design, materials, and construction are in line with the price can furniture be considered a good value. Consequently, a knowledge of materials and construction is important to making wise selections.

Wooden Furniture Because wood is an excellent material for furniture construction, it has been utilized by craftspeople for thousands of years. It is a renewable resource that can be regenerated by reforestation or by planting seedlings to replace trees that have been cut down for lumber. Wood is strong yet relatively easy to cut, carve, join, inish, and reinish. Wooden pieces are easily cared for, and if well constructed and carefully maintained, they may become better looking with age and last almost indeinitely. Beautifully inished wood appeals to our senses because of the unity and ininite variety of its grain patterns and the warmth of its colors. Wood was once part of a living organism, and even after the tree has been felled and the wood cured, worked, and inished, it still has that appealing quality of life.

Hardwood and Softwood Woods are categorized as hardwood or softwood. Hardwoods such as oak, pecan, walnut, birch, maple, and cherry come from broad-leaf deciduous trees that lose their leaves in the winter. These tend to have tighter grains than softwoods and consequently are stronger and harder and can be carved and worked in more detail. Exotic hardwoods, such as ebony, mahogany, and rosewood, come from broad-leaf evergreen trees grown in tropical rain forests. Because many of these forests are being destroyed by excessive logging, it is important when specifying tropical hardwoods to obtain them from a reputable source, preferably one that harvests the lumber from sustainable groves. Softwoods such as pine, cedar, cypress, spruce, ir, and redwood come from conifer or cone-bearing trees. These trees do not drop their needles, and they grow more rapidly than hardwoods.

Softwood has generally been less expensive than hardwood, making it well suited as a building material. Because it is less costly and can easily be worked without expensive, sophisticated machinery, it has been widely used by provincial craftspeople for furniture construction. Softwood has a more open grain than hardwood and, in the proper setting, adds simple warmth and character to an environment.

Other Forms of Wood Wood in several other forms is also used for construction of furniture: • Plywood is used as a substitute for solid woods and is made by lamination—laminating (gluing) thin sheets (plies) of wood or other materials, sandwich fashion, in successive layers to make a panel. When each ply is rotated a quarter turn so that the grain of each layer runs perpendicular (at a 90-degree angle) to the layer below it, a material of great strength is created. If the grain of each layer runs in the same direction, the plywood can be bent and shaped with heat, pressure, and chemicals to create beautiful furniture designs. • Particleboard, or chipboard, is made by compressing lakes of wood with resin under heat and pressure to form a solid panel. Particleboard will not warp and can be used as a base for veneers of wood or plastic laminates and can be vinyl-wrapped for use in drawers. • Hardboard is also produced by gluing ine wood ibers under heat and pressure. MDF, or medium-density iberboard, is a widely used type of hardboard. MDF contains a substance called urea formaldehyde that irritates the eyes and lungs, and may be released when the material is cut or sanded. Another type of hardboard (often known by the brand name Masonite) is used for drawer construction, dust panels between drawers, and backing on mirrors and case goods. Hardboard is also used as paneling with simulated wood-grain veneers, textures, or drilled with holes for attaching hooks and brackets.

Case Goods Furniture pieces made without upholstery such as desks, dressers, cabinets, and chests are called case goods by the furniture industry. Some case goods are made of

Furniture Selection

solid wood, but many pieces are made using other combinations of materials: • All-wood construction means that the visible parts of the piece are made of wood. • Combination indicates that more than one type of wood is used on the exposed parts of the piece. • Genuine denotes the use of veneers of a particular wood over hardwood plywood on all the exposed parts of a piece. • Solid refers to the use of solid pieces of a certain wood in the construction of all the external (visible) parts. • Veneer is a thin slice of beautifully grained wood bonded to plywood or particleboard. Veneers have been used since earliest times to create pieces of great appeal and strength. Because beautiful pieces of wood are used in thin slices, handsome effects with matched

229

grains and inlaid patterns (called marquetry) can be achieved with veneers. One frequently used type, burl veneer, comes from the scarlike growths where trees have been diseased or repeatedly pruned. This results in an irregular growth pattern that becomes a beautiful and complex grain in the inished piece of furniture.

Wood Grains By using several cutting methods, different grain patterns can be revealed in most woods: • Plain slicing means that the half log (flitch) is cut parallel to a line through the center of the log, producing a vaulted or cathedral-like grain. • Quarter slicing indicates that the quarter log (also called a flitch) is cut so that the blade meets the grain at right angles to the growth rings, resulting in a generally straight, striped grain. • Rotary slicing shaves a continuous, thin layer of wood from a log mounted to a lathe. It is as if the log were being unwound like a roll of paper. The grain produced by this method is broad, open, and bold.

Joining Methods A well-made piece of wooden furniture is assembled by fastening pieces of lumber together in junctions or closures called joints. There are several ways of joining and reinforcing furniture. The most common of these are listed below:

Figure 9.1 This case piece is an Arts and Crafts–style secretary designed by Gustav Stickley. It features four lower drawers and a drop-down door/writing surface. Photo © Kathryn Taylor

• Corner blocks are triangular pieces of wood that are glued and screwed into place at an angle. These blocks are considered not true joints but rather reinforcements. Corner blocks are used in points requiring extra strength, such as where legs join tabletops, frames for case pieces, or frames for chair and sofa seats. • Dowels are a third piece of wood used to join the other two parts of the frame together. The rounded dowel is glued into holes that have been drilled into the other pieces. The quality of this type of joint relies on the strength of the dowel. • Dovetail joints are used to secure drawer fronts and sides. This joint takes its name from a series of dovetail or fan-shaped notches carved into one piece and

230

Chapter 9

projections on the other that are carved to it the notches. • Miter joints are two pieces of wood that meet at a 45-degree angle. Mitered corners must be reinforced with screws, dowels, nails, or metal splines in order to be strong and functional. • Mortise and tenon is an ancient method of joinery that imparts great strength. It is formed by two pieces of wood that have been carved to interlock. Into one of the pieces a square hole (mortise) is carved, and the second piece is carved with a projection (tenon) that its into the hole. Mortise-and-tenon joints make secure connections for furniture frames.

to polish and protect inished wood surfaces; the manufacturer’s instructions for speciic care of wood should be followed so that inishes will not be damaged. Some furniture is distressed to make it appear used and worn like an antique. The surface of the wood is intentionally dented, scratched, and lecked with dark paint as part of the i nishing process. As with any phase of the furniture manufacturing process, this can be done very well or in a poor manner. It is the care that is taken at each step, together with the quality of the materials used, that determines the value of a piece of wooden furniture. When case goods are being purchased directly from a showroom, or even when a selection is being made from a catalog (and a comparable piece is available in the showroom), simple quality checks can be made:

Wood Finishes

• Doors and drawers should it tightly without sticking. • Drawers should slide easily on glides or ball bearings. • Drawer interiors should be smooth and free from splinters that might snag clothing. • Pieces should be checked for quality of joinery and presence of corner blocks. • Back panels and dust panels should be placed between drawers. • Sanding and inishing of unexposed surfaces should be examined for smoothness. • Hardware can be examined for quality and style. • The exterior inish can be checked for clarity and possible defects.

Finishes are applied to wood for its protection and to enhance grain characteristics that cannot readily be seen in uninished pieces. The irst step in the inishing process is the preparation of the surface by smoothing and sanding to remove any unevenness and imperfections. The wood may then be illed with a liquid or paste wood iller to level the pores inherent in the natural grain. After further sanding, color may be applied to the wood. Color is generally added in the form of stains mixed with water, oils, or other agents; the natural color of the wood grain can be lightened by bleaching. Paint can also be used to color a inish. When paint is applied to a surface and then wiped away, leaving a “scum” of paint, the inish is called antique i nish. When no color is added to or extracted from the wood, the inish is referred to as natural. The next step in the inishing process is the application of a transparent ilm to protect the piece from moisture and stains. One of the oldest inishing ilms is shellac, made by dissolving a secretion of the lac bug in denatured alcohol. Shellac produces a beautiful inish that, unfortunately, is not resistant to moisture, alcohol, or heat. A much stronger inish can be obtained with varnish. Varnish, a preparation of resinous substances dissolved in oil or alcohol, can be used on almost every surface and is very durable as well as moisture- and alcohol-resistant. Polyurethane is a synthetic resin used to give today’s varnish its remarkably durable properties. Lacquer is a resin that has been dissolved in ethyl alcohol. With the addition of pigments to the lacquer, beautiful colored inishes are possible. Interestingly, lacquer is also used as a inish remover. Consequently, a sealer must be applied between stains or other inishes and the lacquer in order to keep the lacquer from softening the previous inish. Finishes are frequently polished with mild abrasives to soften or reine the inish ilm. Waxes and oils are used

Metal Furniture Like wood, metal is an important material for furniture construction and has been used as such for thousands of years. Metal has great durability and strength and can be worked in many different ways. It can be cast into solid forms, rolled into thin sheets that can be manipulated into an ininite variety of pieces and components, and extruded (forced through an opening) into tubes and other shapes that can also be bent and formed into beautiful furniture pieces.

Types of Metal Though furniture could be made from most metals, only a few are commonly used: • Aluminum is used for some outdoor furniture because it is lightweight and does not rust. It can be enameled, left its natural silver color, or anodized a dark bronze color. (Aluminum is anodized with an electrolytic process, whereby it is subjected to a chemical solution together with an electrical charge.)

Furniture Selection

231

Figure 9.2 This simple metal poster bed with canopy frame is a handsome contrast to the light natural wood and upholstered pieces and bed fabrics. Accents of metal furniture add interest and variety to interiors. Photo courtesy of Andersen Windows

• Brass is a gold-colored metal made from an alloy (combination) of zinc and copper. It is used either in solid form or as a plating for furniture and accessories. • Chromium, or chrome, is used as a plating on steel furniture. It is known for its brilliant silver shine. Chromium is also used as a plating on lighting ixtures and plumbing accessories. • Iron is a strong black metal that can easily be wrought (worked) to create indoor and outdoor furniture, railings, grates, grills, and accessories. It will rust, so it must be protected with paint. • Steel is an alloy of iron and carbon. The combination has greater hardness and strength than iron but still can easily be worked. Steel is used extensively for contract furniture and ittings, ofice systems and furniture, and residential pieces. Steel furniture is usually chrome-plated or painted. • Stainless steel is an alloy of steel with chromium. The addition of chromium makes the steel rust-proof. Stainless steel is used for furniture hardware and trim, as well as for a variety of ittings in contract applications. • Other metals such as silver, gold, pewter, bronze, copper, tin, and lead are used principally for accessories or for speciic functions within the building structure. Most metals need to be inished, for if the uninished metal is left exposed to the natural elements in an

environment, it will tarnish or rust. This quality is sometimes exploited by the designer to create a desired effect. Copper weathers to a beautiful blue-green color often referred to as a verdigris inish; A588 steel weathers to a self-protecting coat of rich reddish brown rust. Metals can be polished to a high gloss and maintained with a coat of lacquer or with continued polishing, and if a less lustrous inish is desired, the metal can be brushed. Metal pieces can also be painted or plastic coated in every conceivable color. The quality of metal pieces will depend on the care and craftsmanship used in their construction. Like a ine automobile, the components of a piece of metal furniture should it together tightly and the inish should be smooth and free from imperfections. Metal furniture can be found in many ranges of price and quality, and because of its durability and aesthetic lexibility, it can be used in almost every environment.

Other Furniture Materials Over the years, creative designers have used every material imaginable—from animal horns to papier-mâché— to create furniture. Today a range of natural and synthetic materials other than wood and metal are available to

232

Chapter 9

those who design and manufacture furniture. The most common of these are plastic, leather, wicker, rattan, cane, and rush.

Plastic Plastic is a type of nonmetallic compound, produced synthetically, that can be molded and hardened for a wide range of design uses. It is a complex product that is in a constant state of development and redevelopment. Consequently, it may be dificult for the interior designer to stay abreast of new technology in this ield. Fortunately, of the thousands of plastics that have been created, only a few are used for furniture and interior design. Families of plastics such as vinyls, acrylics, polyurethanes, and melamines (laminates) are the most common. Each of these families belongs to a larger group of either thermoplastics or thermoset plastics:

Figure 9.3 Leather furniture lives long and well when properly cared for. Here the natural qualities of the leather complement the laminate flooring.

• Thermoplastics change their form by heat- Photo courtesy of Mohawk Industries. ing and can be damaged by too much heat. Acrylics and vinyls are thermoplastics. luxurious choice. It is also found as an inlay or embel• Thermoset plastics use a combination of compounds lishment to case goods, notably leather-topped desks and that are set by heat, so they are not easily damaged writing tables. Leather can be tanned to varying degrees by it. Melamines are thermoset, and polyurethanes are of softness and durability, embossed or tooled with decoboth thermoset and thermoplastic. rative patterns, and dyed in colors ranging from subtle to vivid. Plastics today can be foamed, molded, vacuformed, sprayed, calendered (rolled), or blown in just about any • Full-grain leather retains the natural texture and imweight or consistency, from spongy to rigid, to create a perfections of the animal hide. surprising variety of forms. This great lexibility makes • Top grain is the outer, most durable layer of the hide. plastics an ideal material for creative expression as well This is the leather most suitable for furniture use. as function. Plastics have been maligned because they are • Suede and nubuck are leathers that have been buffed often used to imitate natural materials or intricately deto produce a soft, velvety nap. Nubuck, which is made signed details traditionally executed by hand. Yet when from top-grain leather buffed on the upper side, offers plastics are used in the context of their own potential, superior durability. novel pieces of great aesthetic value are possible. Because technology changes so rapidly, it is important Full-aniline leather is processed with a natural, transfor the designer to understand the speciications for a parent dye that allows the grain to show through. Other particular plastic before selecting it. Some plastics may color processes include semianiline or protected aniline, be highly lammable, and some may give off poisonous in which aniline-dyed leather is treated with additional or explosive gases if they burn. Since the designer is lisubstances to increase color saturation and resistance to able for the health and safety of the user, understanding stains, and pigmenting, in which chemical dyes are used the performance of the material under every condition is to give the leather a deeply saturated color. most important. Care of plastics should be according to the manufacturer’s directions.

Wicker, Rattan, Cane, and Rush

Leather Leather is most frequently used as a covering material for chairs and other upholstered furniture, where its ability to “breathe” makes it an exceptionally comfortable and

Wicker, rattan, cane, and rush are all natural materials used to make furniture or certain furniture components. These materials tend to be rather informal, although cane is used to make formal pieces as well. Following are some considerations of these materials:

Furniture Selection

233

Figure 9.4 Wicker furniture adds the right qualities of casual living in this sun-filled enclosed porch. Design by Albert, Righter & Tittman Architects/photo © Brian Vanden Brink

Upholstered Furniture

• Wicker is not a speciic material, but rather the term is used to identify any piece that is fashioned from small twigs or lexible strips of wood. Common wicker pieces include chairs, tables, and baskets. • Rattan is made from the unbranched stem of an Indian palm and is used to manufacture wicker furniture. Rattan poles are lexible, can be bent into beautiful forms, can be stained, lacquered, or painted, and, unlike bamboo (which is brittle and hollow), can be nailed or screwed. • Cane is made from grasses, palm stems, or plants such as rattan or bamboo. Thin strips of these materials are woven to form a mesh that is usually itted into the seat or back of chair frames. The mesh allows air to pass through and is strong yet has the ability to lex and give, providing a degree of comfort. Cane has been used throughout history to create beautiful pieces of furniture; today manufacturers continue to use it on pieces of classic design. • Rush is a type of long grass that is twisted to form a thin cord. Rush is a strong and long-lasting material with great appeal and has been used for centuries to weave loor mats as well as chair seats. Today, rush is sometimes duplicated with strong paper cords. The paper version is nearly identical to real rush and is particularly well suited to dry climates, where rush can dry out and split.

The quality of fabric-covered furniture is more dificult to assess than case goods because upholstered pieces are “blind” items; one cannot see what is inside. This means that one must rely on written speciications of a particular product as well as the information that a sales representative might furnish about the product. Because quality is important to the durability of a design, designers often choose manufacturers and products with which they are most familiar and whose quality they know and trust. Understanding the construction and composition of ine upholstered goods leads to the selection of pieces of quality and value.

Figure 9.5 The upholstery process showing the frame, webbing, coil springs hand-tied eight ways, and sinuous wire springs (in the back).

234

Chapter 9

Frames Frames for upholstered furniture are made from the same materials as case goods: wood, metal, or plastic. Wooden frames are made of hardwood, since softwoods generally lack the necessary strength and may split when joined. Wooden frames should be securely joined with double dowels and glue, and the corners should be braced with blocks or metal plates and securely glued and screwed into place.

Springs Springs are generally of two types: 1. Coil springs are attached to a tightly woven webbing of rubber and metal, linen, jute, or synthetic. The webbing is stretched across and attached to the bottom of the frame and serves as the base for the springs, which are then tied together at the top in at least eight places per spring. 2. Sinuous wire (no-sag) springs are fashioned from a single wire that is bent in a continuously curved zigzag and attached to the frame. This type of spring is used in chair backs or in upholstered pieces with particularly thin proiles because it requires less vertical space than traditional coil springs.

Cushioning A layer of burlap or other material protects and supports the padding and keeps it from working into the springs. The padding is a soft layer of batting made from a ibrous material such as cotton or polyester that covers the springs and frame and gives shape and form to the upholstered piece. A casing of muslin holds the padding in place and keeps the inal cover from abrading the padding. Some seating pieces are designed with loose cushions for reasons of aesthetics and comfort. Such cushions or pillows can be illed with foam-covered springs, down and feathers, foam, polyester iberill, or a combination of these materials. Reversible cushions can help extend the life of an upholstered piece because the cushions can be turned. Down is considered luxurious and is distinguished by its rumpled look. Because down and feathers are not resilient, such cushions require frequent plumping. Down cushions are increasingly rare due to high cost. The most common cushioning material is polyurethane foam with a wrapping of polyester batting. Polyurethane foam comes in a variety of densities and is resilient, nonallergenic, and impervious to moisture. The polyester iberill gives added softness and comfort to the cushion and has the quality of resilience missing in down ill.

Figure 9.6 An upholsterer removes the worn fabric of this chair to begin the process of reupholstery. Revealed is the webbing on the back, padding and batting of the arm, and the frame of the piece. Photo © Kathryn Taylor

Lower-quality furniture typically has solid foam or laminated (sandwiched) foam, where the thinner outer layers are less dense and resilient than the thicker middle layer, giving some of the feeling of more costly polyesterwrapped foam.

Coverings Coverings have a major impact on the aesthetics of upholstered furniture. Identical pieces covered in dissimilar covers will have very different inished appearances. Because the cover is such a visible part of the piece, it will often be a major factor in the selection process. Covers are available in a wide range of materials and qualities; manufacturers use the cover quality as a means to set prices for upholstered goods. A piece may be covered in material the client has obtained through a

Furniture Selection

235

Figure 9.7 This pair of leather tuxedo-style overstuffed chairs have tufted backs, held with buttons to give extra cushion comfort and style. Photo courtesy of Mohawk Industries

designer or elsewhere. These goods are referred to as “C.O.M.” (customer’s own material) and are shipped to the manufacturer for upholstery on the selected piece. The manufacturer also maintains a supply of fabrics in several grades of quality that can be speciied and ordered from catalogs and sample books. Each sample is assigned a grade corresponding to its quality; different prices are listed for each grade of material. An upholstered piece may be covered with slipcovers that can be changed seasonally. The quality of the covering is dependent upon the material and inesse used in tailoring the piece. It is often necessary to order goods from catalogs without actually inspecting the pieces; one must rely on manufacturers that have an established reputation for quality and service. In some cases, however, where pieces are available in showrooms, quality can be observed irsthand:

Figure 9.8 Upholstered furniture assures comfort and gentility in this lovely textilefilled room. Design by Sally Weston Associates/photo © Brian Vanden Brink

• Evaluate the comfort of the piece by sitting in it. • Check for careful matching of patterns or naps (direction of pile). • Look for smooth seams and straight welts (covered cords) without puckering.

• Verify that cushions it properly. • Be aware of loose or hanging threads that might indicate poor craftsmanship. • Ensure that buttons are tight on tufted pieces.

236

Chapter 9

• Examine quilted fabric to see that the quilting has been carefully executed. When delivered, upholstered furniture should be allowed to off-gas for twenty-four hours before the interior is occupied.





Furniture Categories Furniture comes from many sources and with varying value depending on authenticity, age, quality of design, and quantity of like items available. • Antiques are furniture pieces over 100 years old in a historic style. The quality and relative rarity of antiques determine their price. “Museum quality” rare antiques of the inest craftsmanship are very costly.

Figure 9.9 Antique furniture is over 100 years old and an authentic historic style, such as this Fauteuil a la Bonne Femme, a nineteenth-century Country French ladderback chair. This cherished antique has been in the collector’s family in La Framboisier, France, for several generations. Photo © David A. Taylor





More commonly available pieces of good quality are somewhat affordable. Collectibles are less than 100 years old, but are no longer made and highly valued because they are somewhat rare. They become antiques after they are 100 years old. Reproductions are newly constructed copies of antique originals. Some are i nished to appear lawless; others are i nished to achieve a worn, antiqued appearance. Adaptations are based on an antique style, but changed, blended with other similar styles, or slightly modernized. These “adjustments” make the piece an “inaccurate reproduction,” although the piece may still be handsome and appealing for contemporary historic traditional or eclectic interiors. Vintage furniture is over 25 years old but is not costly. The value of vintage furniture is found in its charm or

Figure 9.10 This reproduction, now a collectible, is a faithful copy of a Chippendale Late Georgian secretary. Photo © Kathryn Taylor

Furniture Selection

237

Figure 9.11 The Eames Lounge and Ottoman is an example of Modern classic furniture, designed in 1956 and in continual production since then. Available from Herman Miller Furniture/Photo courtesy of Herman Miller

Figure 9.12 Custom-built furniture fills a particular space and need, such as these built-in bench/settees with storage drawers under the seats in a breakfast nook. Design by Elliott Elliott Norelius Architecture/photo © Brian Vanden Brink









nostalgia. It is often reinished and/or reupholstered to give it a more fresh or contemporary appearance. Modern classics are designs by twentieth-century architects and designers that have never fallen out of favor and continue to be produced as exact replicas of original designs. Many examples of Modern classic furniture pieces are shown in Chapter 15. New furniture is a vast category that expands continually and is offered by hundreds of manufacturers worldwide. Quality and design integrity of new furniture vary markedly, which is why design scrutiny, warranties, and quality checks are important. Custom-built furniture may be speciied by a designer to be a particular style, size, or shape. Custom furniture is built and upholstered, or made of wood. Often a specially designed piece is crafted to it the dimensions of a space for a speciic purpose, such as a built-in bench, or for a certain use, such as child-sized furniture. Furniture from scratch, from kits, and uni nished furniture can be constructed and inished by a skilled

238

Chapter 9

do-it-yourselfer and can be a gratifying hobby, especially when custom inishing makes a one-of-a-kind piece. • Unassembled furniture is lower-quality furniture that comes ready to assemble. • Used furniture is previously owned and may be in excellent, fair, or poor condition. Sources for obtaining used furniture and the furniture categories listed here are discussed next. • Multipurpose furniture can be used for two or more functions, such as a sofa bed or a storage bench.

Obtaining Furniture Where and when to ind furniture requires careful planning through a sequence of steps: 1. Prioritize the order of purchases and the time frame. Few people can afford to buy all their furniture at once. Meet the basic furnishing needs irst. Some pieces, such as a dining table and chairs or a sofa, will be a higher priority than a coffee table or a china hutch. 2. The cost of furnishings varies dramatically, and only after careful research and hands-on quality checks can a piece of furniture be determined to be of high quality. Getting the best quality for the best possible price is a worthy goal, because some furniture is overpriced. Comparison shop to ind exact or similar pieces from different sources; then compare the prices, quality, and warranties. 3. Set a budget; determine what is a reasonable price to pay based the comparison shopping results. Save until the purchase price goal is met. Borrowing money or using credit cards to pay off furniture slowly is an expensive and unwise way to obtain furniture. Likewise, buying entire matching sets of furniture eliminates the ability to develop a unique, personalized interior. 4. Select a personal style and create a master furniture purchase plan that will eventually result in a complete, well-coordinated, stylish interior. 5. Plan to obtain furniture pieces that are well designed, well proportioned, and that will stand the test of time aesthetically. It will be a wise investment, and your furniture will last for many years. 6. Decide where and when (on sale, for example) to shop or how to procure the furniture by exploring the options described below. Custom-built furniture ordered through interior designers provides options of selecting a particular upholstery fabric for a particular furniture frame, wooden pieces with a selected stain and inish, and unique pieces not found in retail stores. Retail furniture or department stores offer a wide selection of styles and can usually order pieces not in

stock from the manufacturers each store represents. Retail stores specialize in antique, collectible, used, or new furniture. Retailers may offer interior design services, delivery, unpacking, and placement services and customer service departments. This is usually a more costly way to buy furniture. Some ways to save money while being careful consumers include: • Seasonal sales are discounted items at the end of a season, such as the patio furniture at summer’s end. • Closeout or liquidation sales are held when stores are closing for relocation or going out of business. • Loss leader sales are advertised items priced very low to attract business. Sometimes the item sells out quickly or is something that matches another item not on sale—and perhaps overpriced—which can make a combination purchase more expensive than buying elsewhere. Resist the temptation to buy other items when shopping loss leader sales. • Marked-down items may be available in a “scratch and dent” section of the retail store, or in an outlet store that specializes in slightly damaged or discontinued merchandise. Be sure the damage is repairable. Discontinued items are marked down to make way for new styles. No reordering or matching is possible. Online shopping can be useful in comparing prices and shipping costs on identical items, particularly when the quality is an assured brand name. Online shopping is convenient, but furniture quality cannot be examined and shipping costs may be more than sales taxes paid to local retail stores that offer free delivery. Again, be thorough in comparison shopping. Lease-to-own stores rent or lease furniture with an option to buy the pieces, which are generally of mediocre style and construction quality. Used furniture comes from a variety of sources and may be acceptable as is or require slipcovers, reupholstering, painting, or stripping and reinishing. A used piece may have new life as a recycled piece, used for a different purpose than it was originally intended. Creativity and a little work can result in delightful furniture items. Here are some sources of used furniture: • Hand-me-down furniture is gifted from family and friends, such as a piece inherited from a parent or grandparent or found stored in the family attic gathering dust because it was damaged or out of style. For a younger generation, these are great inds and often become treasured pieces. • Yard or garage sales and flea markets are a hit-and-miss source. Early-bird shopping is a key to inding good items. Prices can often be negotiated and are generally modest. Some people love the “thrill of the deal” by shopping this way. A word to the wise: Buy only furniture that you like, need, and its your style master plan.

Furniture Selection

• Estate auctions are conducted by professionals, where bids are entered and the highest bid wins the right to purchase speciic items. Estates include entire households of furnishings left by a deceased person. • Thrift or secondhand stores are places where used furniture is “donated” and resold to the public. Building supply stores for DIY (do-it-yourself) projects provide the opportunity to replicate expensive furniture by building a piece from scratch. Some woodwork training can pay big dividends in the future and become a gratifying hobby that binds family members in a common project.

Furniture Harmony and Human Factors Harmonious and aesthetically pleasing combinations of furniture are the result of a selection process that may be partially intuitive but is also based on an understanding of styles, themes, and pieces that have classic

239

quality. By studying and knowing styles from history, and by keeping abreast of innovative developments in the marketplace, we can make sound judgments about the kinds of furniture that will best suit our aesthetic needs. Because many people ind selecting furniture a bewildering task, manufacturers have always made matched sets or “suites” of furniture. For example, they produce bedroom sets with dressers, nightstands, chests of drawers, headboards, armoires, and mirrors with matching details, woods, and styling. This is an easy solution for those who lack the conidence to choose, but as we know from studying the principles of design, harmony is made up of unity and variety. Matched sets are uniied, but they often lack variety. The most interesting rooms have a personal mix of pieces that results in a harmonious setting with a pleasing balance of unity and variety.

Function The irst consideration in selecting individual pieces of furniture and built-in ittings and ixtures for an

Figure 9.13 Vintage, hand-me-down furniture is often discovered in places of storage, such as a family attic. Photo © Brian Vanden Brink

240

Chapter 9

environment is the users and the tasks they will perform in the environment. Each environment has a certain function or group of functions for which it is designed. It is important to be familiar with all of these functions so that furniture and ittings can be designed or selected to enhance the desired function. For example, soft, deep, low seating pieces for casual television viewing and music listening are very different from the kinds of seating one might choose for work at a sewing machine or computer. Such pieces should provide proper height and back support and should be based on actual human dimensions.

Anthropometrics and Ergonomics Anthropometrics are human physical dimensions, including height, weight, and volume. Ergonomics, or biotechnology, is the study of human relationships to the furniture and products that ill our environments. These terms may seem formidable, but their application to furniture design is simple: The human form, its dimensions, and its need for movement are the bases for functional and comfortable furniture design. The ideas of comfort and function are often linked to culture. For example, people in parts of Asia and South America learn from childhood to sit on their haunches in squatting fashion. Given the choice of a stool or a grassy spot by the roadside, these people might opt for the grass. Those from other areas of the world could certainly argue the relative comforts of sleeping in hammocks, on a Japanese futon mattress atop tatami mats, or on more

conventional mattresses illed with coil springs. The ancient Egyptians developed sleeping arrangements with a headrest that today appears anything but comfortable. Regardless of cultural inluences, the best measure of function and comfort is the human form. Ideally furniture and ittings should be scaled to the average human form—but unfortunately, there is no such thing as an average person. Hertzberg, Daniels, and Churchill measured 132 different features of 4,000 air force lyers and found that there were no men who fell in the average range on ten key measurements. Nonetheless, most design is keyed to an average set of dimensions. These average measurements will not be optimum for everyone but will likely cause less inconvenience than would be the case if furniture, ittings, and ixtures were designed for the very short or the very tall. Personal environments can be custom designed to the dimensions of extreme individual sizes, and where possible, this should be an important goal of the design. With all the research and developments in furniture design, it is remarkable how little the overall form and dimensions of furniture have changed over the millennia. Today’s ergonomic superchairs differ very little in general dimensions from the chairs used in ancient Egypt.

Furniture Types An ininite variety of furniture types have been used through the ages in response to speciic needs. Most of these types have changed very little over the years, responding primarily to changes in taste and style. Recently, developments have introduced new types of furniture such as the systems used extensively in contract design. Even these, however, were need-based designs.

Systems Furniture

Figure 9.14 According to the American National Standards Institute (ANSI), computer workstation users frequently change their working postures to maintain comfort and productivity. Four reference postures used as a standard upon which to base computer component placement and the selection of ergonomic chairs are shown here: reclined sitting, upright sitting, declined sitting, and standing postures. From Human Factors Engineering of Computer Workstations, ANSI/HFES 100-2007. Copyright 2007 by Human Factors and Ergonomics Society. All rights reserved.

To meet the challenge of lexibility created by complex and changing needs, particularly in contract design, product designers developed systems furniture, manufactured in modules that can be assembled and reassembled in different conigurations. The spaces created may be open, private, semiprivate, or a combination. The modules might consist of full- or partial-height panels or divider units to which coat racks, iling cabinets, bookcases, storage bins, writing surfaces, computer stations, work surfaces, drawing surfaces, and drawer units can be attached. The systems can also be integrated with freestanding furniture components. These systems contain all the wiring for task lighting, ambient lighting, telephones, computer links, and electric power. The systems designed for laboratories even provide lexible plumbing connections. The wide acceptance of systems furniture is the result of its tremendous lexibility. The inlexibility and

Furniture Selection

241

Figure 9.15 (A) Systems furniture provides personal workstations in an open workspace. (B) Different components in each module allow individual users flexibility to accomplish specific tasks. Ethospace photos courtesy of Herman Miller

permanence of wall construction is eliminated by the use of modular dividers and components that deine space in much the same way as conventional constructed walls. These modules also allow, with very little effort or disturbance, users to reclaim unused space or space whose designated function has changed. Because of their wide use, manufacturers ind it worthwhile to invest in the aesthetic design of modular components; the result is exciting lines of systems furniture with great appeal as well as utility.

(A)

Ergonomic Superchairs In today’s society many people spend the greater part of their day in work situations where they must be seated. In order to be functional, seating must offer sustained comfort. Consequently, research has led to the design of highly lexible seating pieces. These self-adjusting chairs are designed to sustain and support the human form and to accommodate the body, which is constantly shifting and changing. These chairs

(B)

absorb the shock of sitting down and support the body in an upright position until the user decides to lean back. When reclining, the chair shifts to transfer body weight from the buttocks to the back, legs, and thighs. The feet remain on the loor as the user tips back, and the back of the chair lexes to provide constant support for the lumbar area. The result is sustained comfort, reduced physical strain, and less muscle fatigue in the lower back. This kind of comfort is a boon to productivity and satisfaction. Figure 9.16 Case Study: Ergonomic Chairs Formway Design created Generation for Knoll, representing the ergonomic need for flexibility. Based on the idea of elastic design, where the product rearranges itself in response to the user, this new standard in comfort and unrestrained movement supports the range of postures and work styles typical of today’s working environment, whether at home or in an office setting. Photo courtesy of Knoll www.sithowyouwant.com

Custom Designs Design projects often include needs and functions that require specialized ittings and furniture that may not be available from manufacturers. Such pieces can be custom designed and built to exact speciications. For example, a restaurant design may include a long padded bench (banquette) against a wall, intended for seating with a

242

Chapter 9

series of tables. Such pieces must be custom designed and built for a particular set of dimensions—they cannot be ordered from a catalog. Custom designs help establish a distinctive look for an interior because they are one of a kind, created for a unique set of requirements.

Other Furniture Types The vocabulary of furniture selection includes the names of a wide variety of types. These are not styles, but simply different kinds of pieces with varying functions that are often available in a wide range of styles. Table 9.1 illustrates many types of furniture.

Table 9.1

Contract Considerations Ergonomics Unlike residential work, in which the designer often knows the users and can cater to individual body sizes and types, contract design entails the ergonomic challenge of selecting furniture for a continually changing group of users whom the designer has never seen. In many interiors, a proile of the typical, or target, user can be created from demographic information supplied by the client. For example, target users in a ine restaurant will be different from those in a sporting goods store or

Furniture Identification

Side Chair

Side Chair

Side Chair

No Arms

No Arms

No Arms

Hitchcock, nineteenth century

Sheraton, eighteenth century

Chippendale, eighteenth century

Open Armchair

Open Armchair

Open Armchair

With Arms

Belter Designer

Hoffman Designer

Queen Anne, eighteenth century

Rococo Revival, nineteenth century

Prague chair, twentieth century

Furniture Selection

Table 9.1

243

Furniture Identification (continued)

Fauteuil

Fauteuil

Fauteuil

French Open Arm

French Open Arm

French Open Arm

Régence, eighteenth century

Rococo, eighteenth century

Neoclassic, eighteenth century

Bergère

Bergère

Windsor Chair

French Closed Arm

French Closed Arm

Bow Back

Rococo, eighteenth century

Neoclassic, eighteenth century

American, eighteenth/nineteenth centuries

Windsor Chair

Windsor Chair

Lawson Lounge Chair

Comb Back

Pierced Splat

Rolled Arm

American, eighteenth/nineteenth centuries

English, eighteenth/nineteenth centuries

Contemporary

(continued)

244

Chapter 9

Table 9.1

Furniture Identification (continued)

Armless Chair

Ottoman

Settee

Slipper Chair

Upholstered Footstool

Deacon’s Bench

Contemporary

Contemporary

American, eighteenth/nineteenth centuries

Settee

Settee

Sofa

Double Pierced Splat

Bentwood

Camel Back

Chippendale, eighteenth century

Thonet, late nineteenth century

Chippendale, eighteenth century

Sofa

Sofa

Sofa

Bow Back

Tuxedo

Lawson with Rolled Arms

Hepplewhite, eighteenth century

Contemporary

Contemporary

Furniture Selection

Table 9.1

245

Furniture Identification (continued)

Sofa

Chaise Longue

Chaise Longue

Chesterfield with Tufted Back and Rolled Arms

Reclining Sofa

Pony Chaise

Contemporary

American Empire, nineteenth century

Le Corbusier, twentieth century

Chaise Longue

Wing Chair

Wing Chair

Also Called Chaise Lounge

Upholstered Wings

Upholstered Wings

Contemporary

Queen Anne, eighteenth century

Chippendale, eighteenth century

Tub Chair

Club Chair

Ladder-Back

Rounded Back

Oversized Upholstered

Sausage-Shaped Turnings/Rush Seat

Contemporary

Contemporary, Victorian reproduction

American, eighteenth/nineteenth centuries

(continued)

246

Chapter 9

Table 9.1

Furniture Identification (continued)

Ladder-Back

Ladder-Back

Ladder-Back

Chaise á Capucine

Pierced Slats

Rocker

Country French

Chippendale, eighteenth century

Shaker, nineteenth century

Ladder-Back

Table Desk

Knee-Hole Desk

Hill Chair

French Bureau Plat

Space for Knees

Mackintosh, twentieth century

Neoclassical, eighteenth century

Chippendale, eighteenth century

Rolltop Desk

Rolltop Desk

Tall Case Clock

Tambour Top Rolls Shut

French Bureau á Cylindre

Also Called Grandfather Clock

American, early twentieth century

Rococo, eighteenth century

Chippendale, eighteenth century

Furniture Selection

Table 9.1

247

Furniture Identification (continued)

Secretary

Chest on Chest

Chest of Drawers

Drop-Front Desk with Bookcase

Stacked Double Chest

French Commode

Chippendale, eighteenth century

Chippendale, eighteenth century

Rococo, eighteenth century

Chest of Drawers

Highboy

Highboy

Block Front

Chest on Raised Legs

Also Called Tall Boy

Chippendale, eighteenth century

Queen Anne, eighteenth century

Chippendale, eighteenth century

Breakfront

Armoire

Hutch

Front Breaks or Comes Forward

Closet: Also Called Wardrobe

Open Cupboard

Chippendale, eighteenth century

Country French

American vernacular

(continued)

248

Chapter 9

Table 9.1

Furniture Identification (continued)

Buffet

Nesting Tables

Tilt-Top Table

Serving Piece: Also Called Sideboard

Stack Underneath One Another

Top Tilts, Also Called Tip-Top

Hepplewhite, eighteenth century

Hepplewhite, eighteenth century

Chippendale, eighteenth century

Pedestal Table

Gateleg Table

Butterfly Table

Also Called Tripod

Legs Swing Out on Drop Leaf

Small Drop Leaf

Shaker candlestand

English/American vernacular

Vernacular, seventeenth/eighteenth centuries

Pembroke Table

Tea Table

Flap-Top Table

Tea Table-Sized Drop Leaf

Small Tall Table

Top Opens for Games

Hepplewhite/Sheraton, eighteenth century

Queen Anne, eighteenth century

Duncan Phyfe, nineteenth century

Furniture Selection

Table 9.1

249

Furniture Identification (continued)

Console Table

Console Table

Butler’s Tray Table

Goes Against the Wall

French

Used as a Coffee Table

American Empire, nineteenth century

Rococo, eighteenth century

Chippendale, eighteenth century

Four-Poster Bed

Canopy Bed

Sleigh Bed

No Canopy

Posters Topped with Canopy

Headboard/Footboard Same Height

Chippendale, eighteenth century

Chippendale, eighteenth century

Country French

a pediatrician’s ofice. While individual patrons and employees will change, their statistical similarities in age, height and weight, physical condition, and special needs will remain fairly constant. The designer’s goal is to select furnishings of the right height, shape, and feel to satisfy the user that the particular interior is intended to serve. In some interiors, the ergonomics of furniture selection are governed by the interests of the client rather than those of the users. You may have noticed that the seating in fast-food restaurants, airports, and shopping malls is somewhat uncomfortable. This is not an accident; the managers of these locales intend to discourage loitering. Visually, too, the furniture in a contract interior may be less “comfortable” than that in a residential one, where the same users will live with it day after day. Hotel lobbies, restaurants, and retail stores may utilize elaborately

decorative, even outrageous furniture to evoke a memorable impression during the short time the target user is present.

Durability While it may be obvious that furniture selected for contract use needs to be durable, it is worth considering speciic characteristics that can help furniture meet the test of hard wear over time: • Patterns, lightly textured surfaces, and medium-dark colors camoulage dirt and scratches better than solids, smooth surfaces, and light colors. • Materials and inishes should be suitable for thorough cleaning with detergents or other solvents.

250

Chapter 9

• Drawer pulls, cabinet handles, and other operational parts should be chosen with the irst-time user in mind. If the method of operation is not evident at irst glance, some users will inevitably misuse the piece and damage it. • Quality materials and construction methods are worth the investment. Many manufacturers describe their merchandise as suitable for both home and institutional

settings, but the designer should evaluate it according to the planned use before accepting this generalization. • Cabinets in contract interiors are often custom made. Even on a modest per-unit budget, custom-designed furniture may be an option if the project calls for enough units to create an economy of scale. • The designer should read any warranties in advance to make sure that they cover contract use.

Chapter 10 Architectural Detail

Walls 252 Doors 255 Windows 259 Stairs 264 Fireplaces and Chimneypieces 266 Ceilings 269 Cabinetwork 272 Contract Considerations 273

Design by Catalano Architects/photo © Brian Vanden Brink

252

Chapter 10

Architectural details are permanent features such as stairs, doors, windows, panels, moldings, trim, chimneypieces, ireplaces, and cabinetwork. During a given historic era, certain details were popular and commonly used. The details became typical of the period, and today they are an important key to identifying rooms of a particular era. Now, as in times past, designers and builders choose details to provide an element of inish in an interior, as well as to make the design more interesting and appealing.

Walls

Certainly, one of the most popular treatments through the years has been panels of wood. However, the inluence of the International style (with its lack of historical ornament) and the rising cost of ine historic detailing have made historic paneling less common. In some historically styled homes and in certain contract settings requiring a traditional feeling, paneled walls are still used.

In common dwellings from many periods, the wall treatment was generally the same as the building materials. For example, Medieval interiors often included a timber Figure 10.1 Linenfold framework and stucco inill as a wall treatment. They Wood Paneling panel. might also have stone walls left plain, stuccoed with The three most common panel rough plaster, or simply whitewashed. Panels of wood types are traditional, board and batten, and tongue and that were joined (itted together) and carved like furnigroove (types of wood, inishes, and joints are discussed ture were used in the great churches of the Middle Ages. in Chapter 9): This type of paneling was also used in castles and manor houses as a barrier from the dampness of stone walls and • Traditional paneling is made with panels that may as a form of decoration. This paneling, which usually be lat, beveled (perimeter of panel is cut at an angle reached above the level of the doors, was called a wainto meet the frame), or raised (panel projects beyond scot. The wood was framed in small vertical panels that the frame). The panels are framed with stiles (vertiwere carved with a motif resembling a stylized piece of cal part of the frame) and rails (horizontal part of the folded linen called linenfold. Wainscoting in this style frame). The frames are joined with mortise-and-tenon was also popular in some interiors from the nineteenth or dowel joints. The frame is grooved where the panel and twentieth centuries. These more recent wainscots and the frame are joined, and a small space is left to were frequently inished at the top with a plate rail (a allow for expansion and contraction of the panel. narrow shelf used to display plates). The Renaissance brought a return to classicism, and the designs of Rome became the basis for most wall detailing. The Roman temple was built with columns resting on a raised podium. The columns supported a complete entablature, including an architrave, frieze, and cornice. During the Renaissance the exterior details of the Roman temple were translated into interior wall details, executed in materials such as wood, plaster, and marble. The podium became the dado (the lower portion of a wall set apart by moldings). The columns were applied decoratively as lat pilasters with appropriate bases and capitals (also treated in a lat manner), and the entablature was interpreted as a series of moldings where the wall meets the ceiling. The spaces between the pilasters were illed with molded panels that varied in size and style. During certain periods the pilasters disappeared, leaving just the simple panels. These basic classical details have been reinterpreted many times in every culture touched Figure 10.2 Dado and pilaster. by the Renaissance.

}

Dado

Architectural Detail

253

Figure 10.3 Traditional paneling is seen in the background at a wainscot level, as full wall panels behind the entry table, and around the stairs as a dado. Design by Seimasko + Verbridge/photo © Brian Vanden Brink

Figure 10.4 Beadboard wainscot with plate rail.

• Beadboard is a type of nineteenth- and early-twentieth-century paneling that became very popular again at the end of the last century and the beginning of the new millennium because it is so well suited to informal vernacular/country-style design. It is made with narrow vertical strips separated by a rounded vertical bead. The iberboard paneling comes preinished or primed, ready for painting. Beadboard is often used as a wainscot or dado.

254

Chapter 10

Figure 10.5 Beadboard is used creatively in this straight-run, semihoused stairwell. Design by Hutker Architects/photo © Brian Vanden Brink

• Board and batten is paneling made from wide vertical boards. The gap between the boards is covered with a 1-inch by 2-inch strip of wood called a batten. This type of paneling was used in America during the seventeenth century to cover the ireplace wall, creating what was referred to as a palisade wall. Reverse board and batten produces the opposite effect of boards with a wide reveal or groove between. • Tongue-and-groove paneling consists of boards coped (cut to it an adjoining piece) with a projecting tongue on one edge that matches and its into the recessed groove on the opposite edge. The two edges of the board are generally beveled producing a V-shaped

groove where the boards meet. The groove hides any irregularities in the thickness of the boards. Inexpensive plywood or pressboard paneling sheets are produced to imitate the look of genuine tongue-andgroove paneling.

Moldings Moldings are trims used to create decorative effects. At the same time, they may cover the uninished ragged edges of the wall left in the construction process. Moldings are frequently made of wood that can be worked easily—most often pine and oak. Mitering the corners

Architectural Detail

Figure 10.6 Board and batten paneling.

255

• Cornice moldings often include decorative ornamentation such as the acanthus leaf, egg and dart, modillions, or dentils. • Cove molding is a rounded piece placed where the wall meets the ceiling. It makes a clean smooth transition from the ceiling to the wall.

Doors Figure 10.7 Tongueand-groove paneling.

The selection of a door is important for practical reasons. Major considerations are security against breakage and unlawful entry, upkeep with regard to climate and the amount of wear and tear it will receive, and protection against ire (burn time). Beyond these crucial safety and maintenance factors come the considerations of initial cost and upkeep cost. Upkeep considerations include painting, reinishing, and ability to withstand breaking or shattering. The initial cost should be balanced with the upkeep costs. When these considerations are met, aesthetics will be the determining factor in style selection.

(cutting and itting together the trim at a 45degree angle) allows for a pleasing it where pieces are joined. Moldings may be stained or painted. When they are painted the same color as the walls, they tend to have less visual importance. When they are painted to contrast with the walls, they become a more dynamic feature of the room. Following is a list of trim types: • Base describes the molding used to inish the wall where it meets the loor. Any workable material, including rubber or plastic, can be used to make a base. • Baseboard designates bases of wood. The base hides any slight irregularities in the level of the loor and keeps the wall from being scuffed by vacuums or other equipment. This trim is sometimes called a mopboard because it protects the wall during cleaning. • Chair rail is a molding placed at the usual height of a chair back to protect the wall from damage. If the section below the rail is paneled, dado fashion, the trim is called a dado cap. The portion below the rail is sometimes called a wainscot, although wainscot is a term better used to describe a door-height section of paneling. The height of the chair rail may vary from approximately 30 to 36 inches. • Crown or bed moldings are placed where the wall meets the ceiling to add a inishing touch to traditionally styled rooms. They are generally simple; the more complex and ornate ceiling molding is called cornice molding.

(A)

(B)

(C)

(D)

Figure 10.8 (A) Example of crown, chair rail, and base molding. Details of (B) crown molding, (C) chair rail, and (D) base.

256

Chapter 10

Figure 10.9 Cornice molding.

Figure 10.10 Cove molding. Figure 10.11 Paneled door.

The front doorway sets the tone of the building. The scale of a large door can inspire awe and indicate the importance of the structure. The captivating doors of London, painted bright “London bus” red, cornlower blue, butter yellow, shiny black, or Georgian green, trimmed with brass hardware, are a striking counterpoint to the white stucco or somber brick of the town houses. They also provide the touch of individuality that a door demands. The doors on the interior of a house serve more common functions but are no less worthy of attention. Interior doors are framed with moldings to conceal the ragged space between the door frame and the wall. Doors may be made of wood or from metal, glass, or plastic. They are available in many decorative styles. Doors fall into two basic categories, paneled doors and lush doors: • Traditional paneled doors of wood are made in the same manner as traditional wooden wall panels. This type of door consists of wooden stiles and rails that secure the molded panels. • Flush doors, as the name indicates, are lat with no raised or sunken panels. They are made of wood using two principal methods. The irst utilizes a solid core of wood, also called lumber core. In this type of construction, a thin cross banding (veneer with a horizontal grain) is laminated (glued) to a core of wood blocks that has been framed with rails and stiles. The door is inished with a vertical-grained face veneer. The second type is hollow core, which is made with a stileand-rail frame illed with a lightweight honeycomb of cardboard and covered with as many as three veneers of thin wood. These doors are not as strong as the lumber-core type.

Figure 10.12 Flush door.

• Metal doors, once used only for areas with serious security problems, today have become quite acceptable in most settings. They are now made of steel and illed with a core of high-density polystyrene or polyurethane plastic foam, which makes them well insulated. Compared to wooden doors, metal doors are less subject to dimension changes resulting from temperature and humidity shifts. They can be formed in traditional paneled styles or itted with panes of glass, and when painted, they are almost indistinguishable from wooden doors when seen from a distance. • High-strength tempered glass doors in metal frames (or unframed) are functional, particularly in contract settings, because they permit visibility in areas of high trafic and allow passersby to see into areas where products or services are available. • Glass doors with metal or wooden frames make inviting entrances to patios or balconies or attractive dividers between rooms. When the glass is leaded (smaller pieces held together with lead strips), beveled (edges cut at an angle), or stained (colored leaded glass), it creates beautiful effects with light and can be an important decorative feature of the interior. Sliding glass doors have become less popular because they Figure 10.13 Sliding glass door.

Architectural Detail

Figure 10.14 High-quality wood-clad sliding glass doors establish an Organic Modern style interior, making the outside an extension of the inside. Windows in the background are nonoperable, or fixed glass. Photo courtesy of Andersen Windows

are heavy and dificult to operate. They often develop problems with their glides (sliding tracks) and are also dificult to secure. • Molded plastic doors in many designs, including the traditional paneled type, are available today. They may be embossed with a faint wood grain or perfectly smooth. When painted, they have the appearance of a wooden door, especially from a distance.

257

section is anchored on the side, both top and bottom, so that the doors pivot and glide freely. They are kept in place by a small wheel ixed to the top of the unanchored section that guides the door along a metal track ixed to the top frame of the door. They stack against the doorjamb and project slightly into the room when open. They are also used in double conigurations with four sections that stack on both sides of wider doors. • Accordion doors are made with narrow panels of wood, metal, or plastic. They fold accordion-style on a track from which they are suspended, and they stack neatly in a small space. • Louvered doors are wooden-framed with angled louvers or slats like shutters. Louvered doors allow circulation of air yet still provide visual privacy. They are commonly installed on closets or other spaces where air circulation is advisable. Louvered panels are used on pocket doors, bifold doors, and standard doors.

Several other types of doors are seen in today’s interiors. Among the most important are those described below: • Pocket doors glide on a metal track from which they are suspended. When they are opened, they slide into a recessed pocket in the framing of the wall. They come as a preframed package that is installed during the framing phase of the construction process. They are particularly advantageous in areas where a door that swings open would be in the way. • Bifold doors are hinged Figure 10.15 Sliding pocket with two sections. One door.

Figure 10.16 Beautiful art glass is inset into these traditional paneled doors. The sliding door pockets behind the front door, allowing access to the toilet area. The art glass brings natural light from the outside wall into the grooming area. Design by Hutker Architects/photo © Brian Vanden Brink

258

Chapter 10

Figure 10.17 Bifold doors.

Figure 10.18 Accordion doors.

Figure 10.19 Louvered doors.

Figure 10.20 French doors.

Figure 10.21 A “Palladian” arrangement of French doors, an elliptical fanlight transom, and a pair of fixed-glass windows are framed with Italian Renaissance columns, entablature, and raised podium. Photo © Paul Warchol

Architectural Detail

• French doors are double doors similar to paneled doors, but the wooden frames are illed with glass rather than wooden panels. One door is often kept latched in place and the other is used for passage. New French-type doors with one permanently stationary door are called atrium or patio doors and frequently replace sliding glass doors. • Dutch doors break horizontally in two sections so that each can open or shut separately or the two can be latched together into a single door. They may have windows in the top section. Dutch doors were originally designed to admit fresh air through the opening above and to keep out animals by closing the section below. In contract settings, Dutch doors are used for service areas to keep out unauthorized trafic yet still allow communication or act as a service counter. • Shoji screens are Japanese sliding panels made with wooden frames illed with oriental paper Figure 10.22 Dutch door.

Figure 10.23 A handsome Dutch door allows light and, when open, fresh air into this entry where traditional paneled dado is painted in a pale green to match the wide expanded keystone arch and side pilasters. A porthole window above the sailboat model suggests oceangoing vessels. Design by Shope Reno Wharton Architects/ photo © Brian Vanden Brink

259

(or frosted glass or Plexiglas). A grid is placed on one or both sides to divide the screen into panes that resemble traditional windows. The grids can be simple rectangles or quite comFigure 10.24 Shoji screens. plex and ingenious in their design. They were used like sliding walls as dividers in the traditional Japanese house and are used today in some Western interiors for the same purpose or for a purely decorative effect.

Windows Through windows we look out at the world and the world looks in at us. The placement of windows not only is important to the wall composition of the interior but largely determines the fenestration (architectural arrangement of windows)—a crucial part of the style and character of the exterior. Some major considerations in the selection and placement of windows follow:

260

Chapter 10

• Security. Windows are the easiest point of unlawful entry; the greater the quantity and the more accessible and poorly lit the windows are on the exterior, the greater that risk. • Orientation and solar gain. Where solar gain is desirable, windows should be most plentiful on the south of the building and least plentiful on the north. Limiting their number, strategically placing them, and protecting against bright sun on the east and the west orientations are imperative. Light is clearest and most steady from the north, most warm and constant on the south, clearest and brightest on the east, and most colored and hottest on the west. • Quantity of light desired. Great quantities of light can be healthful to mind and body, yet when accompanied by heat and glare, light can be emotionally and physically unhealthy. Too much light and heat can also be damaging to interior furnishings. • The view. Windows should be planned to frame any pleasant view. The view can serve to visually expand space and bring the exterior into the interior as an extension of the design. • Privacy. The location, the height of the wall, and the number of windows can largely determine the amount of privacy afforded the occupant. Windows high in the wall give greater privacy, as do smaller windows. There are few architectural details that can compare in elegance to beautifully designed windows. The exquisite Federal-style fanlight with its delicate tracery and the boldly handsome Palladian window (Figure 10.26) are treasured features of many older buildings. They represent the inest historic architectural development. Like doors, windows are trimmed in appropriately styled moldings to complete their inished appearance. Windows have evolved from crude openings draped with animal skins to Medieval leaded panes to large Late Renaissance windows to the glass houses of the twentieth century. Not surprisingly, glass has been an important part of that evolution. Setting the glass in place is called glazing and can be done with one or more sheets of glass: • A single layer of glass is called single glazing. • Double glazing, or thermal pane, is two sheets of glass sandwiched in a frame to deter heat and/or cold transfer. • Energy eficiency can be further enhanced with the addition of a third sheet of glass to produce triple glazing. This is often used for winter storm Figure 10.25 Double and single glazing. windows.

Windows that can be opened mechanically or by hand are termed operable. The obvious beneit to operable windows is their ability to admit fresh air. Certain types of operable windows also offer the advantage of being easy to clean because both inside and outside glass surfaces can be reached from the inside. Fixed, stationary, or inoperable windows are used where ventilation is undesirable because the HVAC system is sealed, where the window is out of reach, or where a view is to be framed without being interrupted by a divider bar. Windows are made in a wide range of types. Each type is appropriate to a historic style or to a functional purpose. Following are common window types: • Arched and round windows have been appreciated for centuries. The Palladian window, previously mentioned, is an arched window with two lower sidelights framed with classical columns, pilasters, and moldings. The fanlight is also an elliptic arch form of the Neoclassic era. Round porthole windows were especially popular during the Victorian era and may be seen in some vintage houses. Hexagonal windows are six-sided variations of the rounded window. • Awning windows are hinged on the top to swing outward at an angle like an awning. They may be stacked or grouped in horizontal bands along a high wall, clerestory fashion, for privacy. They may also be used as the bottom component in a sashlike window

(A)

(B) Figure 10.26 (A) Palladian window. (B) Federal-style elliptic fanlight.

Architectural Detail

261

Figure 10.28 Awning window.

Figure 10.27 Round porthole window.

Figure 10.29 Bay window.

Figure 10.31 This wood-framed bay window arrangement is made of a pair of French casement windows and a center fixed glass window. Photo courtesy of Andersen Windows Figure 10.32 French casement window.

Figure 10.30 Bow window.

or some other window arrangement. They have the advantage of being able to remain open in a rainstorm. • Bay and bow windows are projecting windows. The bay is canted (angular) or projects straight out, and the bow has a curved projection. Bay and bow windows provide attractive interest to the exterior of a building. They add extra space to the interior, as well as admit light. They may, however, be costly to drape because they require custom drapery rods. • Casement windows are side-hinged, swinging windows. They are an important historical style popular in many countries. Casement windows may be used as operable sections beside large, ixed picture windows. They have great appeal because they provide maximum ventilation, and if they swing out, they keep the interior free for draperies or other window treatments. • The clerestory was the highest window in the Gothic church, and today clerestory windows are still those

Figure 10.33 Clerestory window.

that are set high in the wall. These windows may be for light only or for light and ventilation. They may be of almost any style; it is their location at the top of the wall that makes them clerestory. They provide light while ensuring privacy.

262

Chapter 10

Figure 10.34 A richly architectural interior, this room features casement windows with four-pane transom or clerestory windows above and crowned with an arched window. Beams, wood paneling, and a stone fireplace are all tactile, handsome elements. Design by Bernhard & Priestley Architects/photo © Brian Vanden Brink

Figure 10.35 Cathedral window.

• Cathedral windows are angled, A-frame windows that follow the pitch of a vaulted ceiling. They embody a strong architectural quality that makes them particularly well suited to contemporary interiors. They work best in settings with pleasant views where no window coverings are necessary. • The greenhouse window is a projecting glass box used to catch the sun’s rays. Some may be just large enough to ill a kitchen window, and others may be room size. Like botanical greenhouses, they are ideal for plants; the room-size version can also be a favored spot for dining and relaxing. They can also be designed as sunrooms with hot tubs, spas, or comfortable areas for conversation and relaxation. • The jalousie window is made with a set of louvered slats that tilt open and closed. The principal beneit of this window is the ability to provide ventilation while restricting entrance of rain. The name is French for “jealousy”; a wooden blind, slatted like the jalousie

Architectural Detail

window, may have allowed jealous lovers to see in without being seen. • The sash window is made with two window panels designed to slide up and down in a vertical channel of the window frame. The panels may be larger, single sheets of glass or may be divided into several smaller panes. The smaller-paned windows were designated historically by the number of “lights” (panes) in each panel; for example, twelve over twelve indicates twelve panes in the top frame and twelve in the bottom, and six over six indicates six above and six below. A singlehung sash window has an operable lower window that can be raised and lowered. In the double-hung sash window, both sashes are operable, allowing good air circulation. Cooler air enters through the lower opening, and warm air rises out through the top. The traditional sash window, divided into smaller panes, is a classic. Those that are well proportioned and well built add a clear note of distinction to traditionally styled buildings. Because they are so popular, manufacturers have been experimenting with new methods of fabrication. Some have designed wooden grids that

263

it over a single pane, giving the appearance of individual panes. The grid can easily be removed and then snapped back into the frame, making it easier to wash the windows. Others have placed metal grids between two panes of glass to create the impression of panes. The traditional framing method, with individually framed panes, is called a true-divider system. • A sidelight is a narrow window next to a door. A pair of sidelights is used to lank a door. A transom is a window above a door. Arched transom windows are called fanlights. In older buildings, operable transoms were often used between rooms to improve air circulation. • Skylights are custom-installed or prefabricated units mounted in the roof and ceiling to bring natural light into interiors that have no direct access to windows and would otherwise be dark. Light pipes require only small roof openings, as they use mirror-like inserts to magnify the light they admit. Skylights are made of glass, plastic, or Plexiglas.

Figure 10.39 Sidelights and transom.

Figure 10.40 Skylight.

Figure 10.36 Greenhouse window.

Figure 10.37 Jalousie window.

Figure 10.38 Sash window (nine over nine).

Figure 10.41 A trio of skylights cast abundant overhead natural light onto this bed and sitting area. In the background, a sash window and transom unit is centered in the half-story wall. Photo courtesy of Andersen Windows

264

Chapter 10

• Attic windows are operable pivoting windows placed in an angled roof in lieu of dormers. They are less expensive than framing a dormer and admit more light. They are utilized in new construction and remodeling projects where unused attic space is being transformed into living or working space. • Sliding windows are technically the same as sash windows but are designed to slide horizontally. A sliding window may be a single operable panel of a larger window. Sliding windows may be framed in wood or vinyl-clad wood as well as aluminum.

the house. These same choices govern the design of stairs today. They may be functional and unobtrusive or a very dramatic part of the design. Stairs often have some romantic associations, such as sliding down banisters or hiding on stairways decked with pine boughs to sneak an early peek on Christmas morning. They may conjure up mental pictures of a grand entry on the night of a irst date or of children watching and listening from an upstairs landing as guests arrive for a party. Stairways can be a beautiful and exciting part of an interior. Because the components from which they are assembled may be unfamiliar, they are listed, deined, and illustrated as follows:

Stairs

• The stringer is the diagonal, notched structural piece that supports and gives form to the stair. On the completed stair, the structural stringers are not visible because they are usually covered by the treads and risers. On the inished stair, the diagonal molding on the wall next to the steps is also called a stringer. • Treads are the lat, horizontal pieces on which the feet step when going up or down a stair. • Nosing is the rounded edge of the tread. The nosing makes the stair less sharp and dangerous. It also prevents carpet on the stair from wearing against a sharp edge. • The riser is the vertical member between the treads. It is the riser that acts as a toe kick on the staircase. In certain designs the riser is omitted, creating an openriser stair. Some people feel nervous and insecure on open-riser stairs because the stairs may not appear solid.

During the Middle Ages, stairs were tucked into tiny turrets (towers) or hidden between walls. In the Renaissance the stairway became more imposing, and by the eighteenth century it was often a dramatic focal point of

Wall stringer Figure 10.42 Attic window.

Tread

Banister

Baluster Volute

Riser

Face

Stringer

Figure 10.43 Sliding window.

Figure 10.44 Stairway components.

Newel post

Architectural Detail

• The starting step is the irst step of the stair. It is often bullnosed (with a rounded curve) on the open end to support a newel post. • Landings are the intermediate platforms on a stair (often where it turns) or the area at the bottom and top of the stair. These are important because they allow the stair to turn and because they make the stair safer. People who have dificulty climbing stairs are able to rest on the landing. The landing also provides exciting design possibilities—it makes a perfect place for a beautiful window. • The handrail or banister is the piece that follows the pitch of the stair and is held by the hand. Easements are the short bends that allow for a change of direction in the handrail. A volute is the spiral or scroll end of the handrail that rests on the newel post. Handrails may be the traditional carved type, or they can be formed with metal pipes, tubes, lat pieces of wood or metal, or any device that is compatible with the design of the stair. • The baluster is the vertical member that supports the handrail. In traditional stairways the balusters are usually turned wood. However, they can also be bent metal, square wooden pieces, or panels of glass. • The newel post is a larger baluster that supports or receives the handrail at points of the stair, such as the starting step, the landing, and the top of the stair. The design of the newel post can be elaborate or simple. The balusters, handrail, and newel posts together make a balustrade, or railing.

265

• The stairwell is the open space in which the stair is set. Its shape and size will vary with the design of the stair. Stairs may take several different forms. The most common forms are listed here: • A stair whose sides are not attached to any wall is termed an open stair. • A semihoused stair is connected to the wall on one side and open on the other. • A stairway with walls on both sides is called a closed or housed stair. • A straight stairway without any turns is said to have a straight run. • A stairway that turns 90 degrees at a landing is a oneturn stair. • A double-turn stair makes two 90-degree turns at two separate landings. • A U-stair turns 180 degrees at a single landing. • A spiral staircase twists around a central axis like a corkscrew. This type of stair takes the least amount

(A)

(B)

(C)

Figure 10.45 Stair forms. (A) Open stair (no walls). (B) Semihoused stair (wall on one side). (C) Closed stair (enclosed by walls).

Figure 10.46 A straight-run, semihoused stair also features traditional paneling on the walls. The contrast of white balusters and risers to the cherry-stained banister, newel post, wall stringer, and treads makes a high-contrast color scheme with a keen sense of rhythm by alternation. Design by Donham & Sweeney Architects/photo © Brian Vanden Brink

266

Chapter 10

(D)

(C) (A)

(B)

Figure 10.47 Stair forms. (A) Straight-run stair. (B) One-turn stair (with landing). (C) Spiral staircase. (D) U-stair (with one landing). (E) Double-turn stair (with two landings). (F) Semihoused curved stair.

(E)

(F)

of space but is often dificult to negotiate and makes moving furniture dificult. • A curved staircase may be open or semihoused and forms a graceful curve.

Fireplaces and Chimneypieces

Figure 10.48 A long, sweeping curved staircase gives dramatic beauty to this entryway. Design by Siemasko + Verbridge/photo © Brian Vanden Brink

The ireplace is another detail often associated with pleasant memories. The leap and licker of constantly changing lames and the crackle of the burning wood create a mood of warmth and evoke memories of a chilly winter evening by a ire with family or friends. For thousands of years, ire was the only source of heat in buildings. During the Middle Ages, when someone discovered that a hole in the wall with a hood could siphon the smoke from a ire, the design signiicance of the ireplace was instantly elevated. Before that, the ire had been built in a pit in the loor and the smoke escaped through cracks or vents in the roof. The hood provided new possibilities for design. Because it was a source of warmth, the ireplace was the logical focal point in the room, and designers lavished it with attention. Through the years, the basic technology of the ireplace has changed very little. It is the design of the decorative chimneypiece that has changed the most. Each new period saw changes in the style of the chimneypiece that gave the ireplace the proper character for its surroundings. The projecting shelf of a chimneypiece is called a mantel.

Architectural Detail

A ire requires fuel, heat, and oxygen. As it burns, the ire consumes oxygen, and this creates a draft as more air is drawn in to feed the ire that warms the air. The ireplace works on the principle that warm air rises, drawing the smoke off as it ascends and radiating some heat into the room. The rising air creates a suction that also pulls air from the room. As the intensity of the ire dies, it begins to suck precious warm air from the room. To keep the warm air in the house from escaping, it is necessary to close the front of the ireFlue place with glass or metal doors. The ireplace is made of several components: • The hearth is the noncombustible slab that forms the base for the ire and projects into the room to prevent embers or sparks from charring the loor. Damper • The irebox contains the ire and is built of masonry or metal on top of the hearth. • The surround is the noncombustible piece that frames the Firebox opening of the irebox. It is frequently made of tile, marHearth ble, or other stone. • The flue is the chimney pipe that is separated from the irebox by a movable damper Figure 10.49 Fireplace that controls the low of air components. and escape of smoke. • Zero-clearance ireplace units are self-contained units with triple-insulated walls that allow placement in walls without irebrick or masonry.

(A)

(B)

Figure 10.50 Flush-face fireplace. (A) Side cutaway section view. (B) Front view elevation.

267

Fireplaces can be built in any form—imagination and function are the only real restrictions. However, the most common types are lush-face, projecting, hooded, corner, raised, freestanding, and stoves: • The breast (face) of the flush-face ireplace is even, or lush, with the plane of the surrounding wall. Because the lush-face tends to be less decorative, it is well suited to contemporary interiors where it often consists of a surround and a simple molding. Several historically styled ireplaces are also lush-faced with or without a mantel. • The breast of a projecting i replace projects into the room, forming a mantel. This type is adaptable to clean contemporary versions as well as more decorative historical types. • A hooded ireplace incorporates a projecting hood that may be formed in nearly any shape, from rounded to angled to boxlike. This was the irst type of ireplace to be built during the late Middle Ages and early Renaissance, used also in both French and Italian Rustic interiors. • The corner ireplace is located in the corner of a room; it may have a hood or may be built like a standard ireplace. Because they cut off the corner of a room, corner ireplaces often have inherent problems of balance and line and may present challenges in furniture placement. • Many ireplaces are designed with a raised hearth built just in front of the irebox or extending the entire length of the wall. With a raised hearth, the irebox is elevated so that it can be seen more easily through the furniture grouping that often surrounds a ireplace. The raised hearth requires less stooping and has the added advantage of making the ireplace easier to fuel

(A)

(B)

Figure 10.51 Projecting fireplace. (A) Side cutaway section view. (B) Front view elevation.

268

Chapter 10

(A)

(B)

Figure 10.53 Hooded fireplace. (A) Side cutaway section view. (B) Front view elevation.

Figure 10.54 This home with Spanish Colonial and Southwest Adobe influences features a hooded fireplace and large vigas, or log beams. © Photodisc/Getty Images

Figure 10.52 This traditional fireplace is decorated for the winter holidays, giving a glad, festive appearance to this warmly inviting focal point. Photo © Kathryn Taylor

Architectural Detail

269

Ceilings

Figure 10.55 Corner fireplace in a Southwest adobe home.

and clean. This type of hearth also provides a nice place to sit next to the ire. • Two-way ireplaces have openings on two sides as a dividing wall between two rooms, such as living/family and dining rooms, where the irebox is open on opposite sides (180 degrees). A corner two-way unit has two openings in a 90-degree or L-shaped arrangement. • A free-standing ireplace is a metal unit or other ireplace that is placed in the room away from the wall, with the lue or chimney pipe exposed. The ireplace unit may be placed on a raised platform or may rest at loor level. • Until the advent of central heating, the pot-bellied stove was a standard ixture in homes, churches, schools, and stores. Today, in areas with cold winters, stoves are still used in some homes. Stoves are generally freestanding units placed in front of a noncombustible wall with clearance between the wall and the stove. Fireplaces can also be itted with enclosed stove units called ireplace inserts for more eficient use of fuel and little loss of warmed house air. Some stoves and ireplace inserts are designed with forced-air systems that can heat most of a medium-sized house. These draw air from outside; the air is warmed by the stove and then forced by a fan into the house, creating positive pressure. When a vent or window at the opposite end of the house is opened slightly, the warm air will be drawn to that part of the house. A fresh-air intake pipe to the stove will eliminate drafts caused by combustion.

Ceilings are literally the crowning glory of a room. For example, the great hammer-beam ceilings of Early Renaissance England—with their Tudor arch-shaped trusses supported on magniicently carved brackets—are awe-inspiring. And the delicate-patterned plaster ceilings, designed by Robert Adam in eighteenth-century England, are still beautiful examples of the importance a ceiling design can have in a room. Today, there is a vast selection of ceiling materials and types from which to choose. Ceilings may be decorative or structural and may even serve the important function of covering, yet providing access to, mechanical systems located in the ceiling. Ceilings can provide dramatic changes in plane or space. A low, cozy ireplace nook can suddenly open to the main body of the room that soars to the rafters. Angled ceilings are interesting because of the variety of line and form they create. Ceilings can be formed in many ways. The most common types of ceilings are plain lat, vaulted, domed, coffered, coved, bafled, and suspended: • The simplest type of ceiling is lat plaster or Sheetrock. This plain treatment is ideal when the intent of the design is to emphasize other areas of the room. The lat ceiling may be embellished with textured plaster, raised patterns, moldings, or medallions, which may be painted to harmonize or contrast with the ceiling. These embellishments are called anaglypta, which is

Figure 10.56 This creatively artistic interior features a barrel vault ceiling. Design by Barrett Studio Architects/photo © Brian Vanden Brink

270

Chapter 10

the Greek word for “raised ornament.” Today, anaglypta patterns are frequently made of hardened plastic foam. • A vault is a ceiling constructed on the principle of an arch. Therefore, a vaulted ceiling may be round (a barrel vault) or pointed like the Gothic church ceiling. In today’s interiors, the tall, open, cathedral ceiling belongs to this group. Rooms with barrel-vaulted ceilings often have rounded ends with half-domed ceilings called niches. • Cathedral ceilings are pointed with two slopes. Those with one slope are shed ceilings. These can be exciting because of the way they open up the space, making a relatively small room feel much larger than it actually is. Cathedral and shed ceilings can also add grandeur to large spaces such as hotel lobbies, ofice atriums, and churches. • Tray ceilings are stepped up to become higher than the perimeter; often trimmed with moldings.

(A) Figure 10.57 (A) Anaglypta as a Victorian ceiling light fixture medallion. (B) Anaglypta as French Rococo ceiling ornament.

(B)

Figure 10.58 These ceiling beams are stained charcoal black, giving a greater appearance of strength and matching the black metal of the Modern open-riser stairs and fireplace surround. Design by Hutker Architects/photo © Brian Vanden Brink

Architectural Detail

271

Figure 10.59 This custom-built master bathroom features a step-up tray ceiling that adds height and architectural detail to this intimate space. Design by Jack LaRoe Busby, CKD, Co-Designers: Deborah Burnett Busby; Design Cabinets & Furniture, Inc./Photography: Cucciaioni Photography/NKBA Design Competition

• Domes are bowl-shaped, rounded ceilings. When the dome covers a drum-shaped (round) room, the space is called a rotunda. Domes may be quite lat and dish shaped or deep and high. Because its form is the shape of the heavens, the dome draws the eye upward and creates a feeling of expanse. In public spaces such as capitol buildings, domes create spaces of great dignity and grandeur. In a residence,

a shallow recessed dome in an entry or dining room expands the visual space. • Beamed ceilings frankly expose the rafters or trusses as a decorative feature of a room. They can be very simple and rough or richly carved or painted. Beams can impart a provincial or rustic feeling to an environment. The buildings of the Southwest incorporate large pine beams called vigas as structural support for

272

Chapter 10

Figure 10.60 Traditional coffered ceiling.

the smaller cross beams, called latillas, which form the ceiling. Logs add a rugged feeling to cabins and ski lodges in any geographic setting. Squared, inely inished hardwood beams trimmed with molding are favored in rich traditional interiors such as law ofices, libraries, and luxury housing. Since buildings are generally no longer made of timbers, these will usually be false beams used just for effect. Metal trusses are left exposed in some of today’s designs because, like their wooden counterparts from earlier times, they have interest and strength as design forms. • Coffers are boxes constructed in the recesses between beams and cross beams. • Coved ceilings are formed with a curved radius or straight angle where the wall meets the ceiling. This is accomplished by actually structuring the ceiling in that fashion or by the application of cove moldings. The absence of a sharp right angle has a softening effect on the room.

Cabinetwork Cabinetwork, or cabinetry, is inished interior woodwork such as shelves and cabinets. Those who custom-build freestanding and built-in units are called inish carpenters. Cabinetwork is manufactured in two basic ways. Cabinets can be mass produced on an assembly line in standard sizes or crafted to custom speciications in large or small woodworking shops by skilled inish carpenters. These units are brought to the site as components and installed, itted, and trimmed with molding.

Figure 10.62 Craftsman style built-in cabinetry can be seen as a hutch in the foreground dining room and as kitchen cabinetry in the background. Design by Hutker Architects/photo © Brian Vanden Brink

Figure 10.61 High-quality wood cabinets in a glossy finish are the hallmark of excellence of this Modern kitchen. Design by Erica S. Westeroth, CKD, Co-Designers: Tim Scott, Sheena Hammond; XTC Design Inc./Photography: Donna Griffith Photography/NKBA Design Competition

Architectural Detail

Mass-produced cabinetwork is installed wherever standard sizes will it the space and where a tight budget demands economy. Prefabricated units may be purchased at home improvement stores and builder supply houses. Custom pieces are planned by the designer and executed by the cabinetmaker or inish carpenter; for example, custom cabinetwork is seen in living/dining rooms, kitchens, bathrooms, laundry rooms, and sewing areas of luxury homes. One area of the home where custom cabinetwork is particularly impressive is the home ofice, study, den, or library. Custom details make such interiors more individual, distinctive, and functional.

Contract Considerations Many of the details used in residential design are the same as those in contract design. However, the following details are more common to contract design: • Today, coffered ceilings are formed when concrete is poured over inverted “pans” or forms in such a way that when the concrete has set and the pans have been removed from below, a waflelike pattern of coffers is produced. • A baffled ceiling is hung with wooden or metal slats or fabric banners. These are installed in parallel or

273

grid patterns that act as a screen for the lighting system and also serve as an acoustic treatment. The fabric banners provide an excellent opportunity to add color and texture. The wooden and metal slats also create patterns that add an interesting quality to the environment. • Suspended ceilings are metal grid systems hung from the superstructure of the building with wires. The plenum, or space between the grid and the building structure above, contains ducts for the HVAC (heating, ventilation, and air-conditioning) system, as well as plumbing and electrical systems (see Chapter 7). The grids are illed with acoustic panels that can be removed and replaced, allowing easy access to the equipment above the ceiling. Lighting systems, sound systems, sprinkler systems, smoke detectors, and vents for the HVAC system are often integrated with the suspended ceiling. • Custom cabinetwork is extremely common in contract design. For example, the reception desk in a hotel must be designed to it the physical and aesthetic requirements of the project. The same is true of a nurses’ station in a hospital or the cashier/host station in a restaurant. All of these kinds of pieces are custom designed and built.

(A) (C)

(B) Figure 10.63 (A) Contemporary coffered ceiling. (B) Baffled ceiling. (C) Suspended ceiling.

This page intentionally left blank

Chapter 11 Wall, Ceiling, and Window Treatments Wall and Ceiling Materials 276 Paint 277 Wall Coverings 290 Ceiling Treatments 293 Window Treatments 293 Contract Considerations 297

Christina Oliver Interior Design/photo © David A. Taylor

276

Chapter 11

Wall and Ceiling Materials Materials for walls and ceilings come from a variety of sources, both natural and fabricated. Some materials used on walls and ceilings can also be used on loors; others are appropriate only for walls or ceilings. Wall and ceiling materials are hard or rigid, lexible or soft, and their weight varies from heavy to light. Table 11.1 provides an overview of the selection of materials typically used.

Selection Guidelines • Generally, hard materials echo and relect or amplify sound; lexible and soft materials absorb sound. • Permanently installed materials initially cost more but may be the least costly in the long run, as they require little inishing, upkeep, or replacement. These

Table 11.1



• •



include stone, wood, tile, and brick. The time frame of occupancy must also be a factor in selecting permanent materials. A long occupation can justify the costs, whereas frequent moves will not. Interiors need to be lexible for change. Shifts in the lifestyles of occupants will beneit from lexible materials that can be replaced, such as paint, wall coverings, or fabric. Pattern on the walls will lock in a style or color scheme and can be restrictive. Upkeep is a major consideration where there is limited time or budget for cleaning or where trafic or youngsters would tend to soil, mark, or damage the wall surfaces. Authenticity and style are factors in selecting wall materials. The reproduction of a period room or the general look or feeling or level of formality will largely

Wall and Ceiling Materials—an Overview

Brick. Heavy, hard, costly material, expensive to install. Lasts indeinitely and is structurally handsome. No upkeep. Concrete. Heavy, hard building blocks or cast slabs. Can be painted or left natural gray or colored before casting. Cold to the eye and touch. Moderate cost of material; can be costly to install. No upkeep unless painted. Cork. Very lightweight, lexible, sound absorbent; costly material but moderate installation. Handsome and subtle appearance. Easy upkeep. Fabric. Flexible, sound absorbent, three-dimensional; can carry out a fabric scheme by coordinating with other furnishing fabrics. Several methods and styles of applications. Can be changed at will. Cost of fabric varies from low to high; installation is moderate. Easy upkeep. Glass. Architectural glass (windows), glass block, stained glass used as transparent or translucent building materials. Can be very structural and moderately to very decorative. Costs vary from moderate to expensive. Upkeep varies according to use and environment. Glass tile requires little upkeep, but cost is high as an imported item. Fiberglass is used in tub surrounds. Upkeep requires nonabrasive cleaners. Mirrors enhance space visually. Metal. Aluminum, brass, bronze, copper, stainless steel, and tin are costly to purchase and install. Effects are rich whether structural or decorative. Permanent material. Upkeep depends on inishes and location or use; most require little or no upkeep. Paint. The least expensive of the wall treatments, but must be applied over a prepared, rigid surface such as Sheetrock or wood. Color range and effects are unlimited, and paint can be reapplied at will. Paint can imitate many materials, such as marble and wood. Professional painting services are costly. Upkeep depends on the use, environment, and type of paint used. Plaster. Versatile, from very smooth to very rough (stucco). Can be cast into decorative anaglypta moldings and ornaments to document a particular period. Cost is moderate; upkeep depends on the type of paint or inish the plaster is given. Stone. Fieldstone, flagstone, granite, limestone, marble, and travertine are all heavy, costly materials that are also expensive to install. Structural or decorative effects, but all with natural beauty and little or no upkeep. Lasts indeinitely. Cultured stone (imitation onyx and marble) is used for tub and shower surrounds and countertops or cabinet tops. Lightweight; moderate cost; requires nonabrasive cleansers. Tile. Acoustical tile absorbs sound. Set into a ceiling grid framework; lightweight; decorative or structural; moderate cost, no upkeep—tiles that become stained are replaced or painted. Ceramic, quarry, Mexican, and mosaic tile installations are heavy and costly in terms of material and labor to install. Permanent material, they require little or no upkeep. Tile is also popular in kitchens and bath or hot tub areas as a countertop or cabinet-top material. Wallboard. Sheetrock, wood paneling, particleboard—all come in sheet form to cover large areas. Sheetrock (plasterboard, drywall) is the most common wall and ceiling material and requires painting or wall coverings. Moderate material and installation cost. Upkeep depends on inish methods and materials. Wall coverings. A variety of paper, vinyl, or cloth products that come in rolls or bolts. Subtle and structural to very decorative patterned effects. Moderate cost of goods, moderate installation costs. Upkeep depends on i nal layer (fabric, paper, vinyl) and placement and use. In most cases, upkeep is minimal. Wood and wood moldings, planks, paneling. Wood is costly to purchase but modest to install. Wood has lasting beauty. It can be stained, sealed, or painted. Little or no upkeep.

Wall, Ceiling, and Window Treatments

277

dictate the actual surface and visual texture as well as the pattern. • The size of the space can be a determining factor. Heavy textures, large patterns, and dark or intense colors close in spaces, making them appear smaller, whereas smooth or subtle textures, small patterns, and light or dull colors visually expand spaces. • The function of the interior should determine wall material durability. Heavily used areas need impervious materials; little-used areas can accommodate more fragile treatments. High levels of humidity, smoke, fumes, or airborne oils or dirt may dictate nonabsorbent materials.

Hard or Rigid Wall Materials Most hard or rigid materials are permanent installations with common characteristics:

Figure 11.1 An International Modern home at water’s edge on a clear winter day is warmed with a brightly burning fire. This structural fireplace, centered in a slate stone tile wall, needs no mantle. The Warren Platner Wire Group Chair is a Midcentury Modern classic. Design by Robin Oesler Architect/photo © Brian Vanden Brink

• Are costly to purchase and to install • Require little or no upkeep, depending on the inish or character of the surface • Have inherently handsome natural texture or pattern • Have withstood the test of time and are considered classic wall and ceiling treatments Tables 11.2 through 11.6 describe various types of wall and ceiling materials and provide details of applications, maintenance, special considerations, and cost structure.

Paint Paint is used on walls and ceilings more than any other inish material. The reasons are diverse and all valid: • Paint is a versatile, inexpensive wall inish and is relatively easy to apply. • Paint offers color and texture variety and ensures protection to the surface. • Painted walls can reinforce interior architecture through neutral, noncompetitive colors.

• Paint has contrast and graphic ability, providing visual excitement or drama. • Paint can add richness and subtlety through lowcontrast, deep, or soft colors. • Bright-colored paint can accent or draw attention to surfaces and details. • Dark-colored paint relects little light, thus making the surface seem to advance, and light-colored paints can visually expand spaces. • The chromatic and textural variety of paint allows it to imitate other materials—wood, marble or other polished stones, tortoiseshell, or fabric, for example. • Trompe l’oeil, painted three-dimensional scenes that fool the eye, adds architectural interest and sometimes humor as scenes of architecture, accessories, or even people that are not really there. • Custom-painted wall or ceiling murals are scenic depictions of mythical faraway places and perhaps in a distant time. They can be very realistic or more suggestive and ethereal; in one location or in various locations indicating a continuing “story” or journey throughout the interior.

278

Chapter 11

Table 11.2

Stone

Stone Description. Natural stone includes lagstone, granite, limestone, marble, and terrazzo, all described in this table. In addition, other general types it the deinition of stone: Ashlar refers to a stone that is cut into rectangular shapes so that it can be itted together into a geometric pattern with grout. Cobblestone (or river cobbles) are large, rounded, somewhat smooth rocks used to face walls and ireplaces in rustic settings. Fieldstone is a rugged type of large rocks that may or may not be rounded and smooth. When laid, ieldstone has a random pattern. Sandstone is a soft, reddish stone that is a type of ieldstone and may be cut into ashlar shape. Rubble means rough uncut stone or stone that is not uniform. Artiicial stone is made to imitate rubble or ashlar.

Ashlar

Granite Description. A very hard crystalline rock with small amounts of feldspar, quartz, and other minerals in crystal or grain form. The size of the crystals varies from very ine to fairly coarse. The colors vary from light to dark values and variations of gray, pink, green, brown, and black and may be combinations such as greenish or pinkish gray. May be highly polished or rough cut. Applications. Walls, countertops, ireplace surrounds. Used in both residential and contract settings. Maintenance. Low upkeep; wipe with a damp cloth. Special considerations. Exact color match will need to be carefully coordinated between the designer and the quarry or supplier. Cost structure. High.

River cobbles

Figure 11.2 A natural stone in ashlar configuration frames this fireplace and French door. Stone is a durable, timelessly handsome wall treatment that requires little to no maintenance. Design by Hutker Architects/photo © Brian Vanden Brink

Fieldstone, sandstone, or rubble

Granite

Wall, Ceiling, and Window Treatments

Table 11.2

Stone (continued)

Limestone Description. A calcite (calcium carbonate) stone with a light-grayish neutralized color. Has little to no pattern and subtle texture, with a typically matte or dull inish. Formed from the calcium carbonate that crystallizes out of a freshwater or saltwater solution and settles via evaporation, leaving a limestone “mud”; also formed from shells and bones of sea animals, which are broken up by waves into mud. Application. An excellent building stone, as it can be easily carved or cut in any direction without splitting. Because of this, limestone and sandstone are often called freestone. An unpolished, largely ungrained wall material in the form of slabs and tiles. Also used for ireplace surrounds and shaped mantelpieces. Maintenance. Dust or wipe with clear lukewarm water or mild, nonoily detergent if stone is sealed. Cost structure. High.

Marble

Marble

Description. A metamorphic limestone, granular or crystalline, white or colored, often with streaks. The hardest and typically the most expensive of the stones. May be cut into thin sheets or slabs. Can be polished to a high sheen. Cold to the touch. Terrazzo is a composite looring of broken chips of marble set into cement and polished to a sheen. This is a practical use of marble, since up to 50 percent waste occurs from breakage at the quarry. Applications. Walls, ireplace surrounds, tiles for special or custom installations. Exclusive look for both residential and contract installations. Maintenance. Clean with warm water and infrequently with soap and water. Special considerations. The most formal of the stones; rich-looking inish material. Cost structure. Very high.

Travertine Description. A light-colored limestone rock formed near mineral springs. Trapped gas in the stone causes holes and interesting textures that can be illed according to the intended use. Applications. Walls, ireplace surrounds and hearths, bathrooms. Used frequently in contract settings and as accents and for custom installations in residential interiors. Maintenance. Wash when necessary with clear lukewarm water. Wash no more often than every six months with soap and water and rinse thoroughly. On vertical surfaces it needs little if any cleaning. Special considerations. Travertine is slightly less formal than marble and widely used. Cost structure. High.

Marble terrazzo

Travertine

279

280

Chapter 11

Table 11.3

Brick, Concrete, Tile

Brick Description. Clay, shale, and water mixed and shaped into solid or hollow rectangular blocks, etc., then baked or ired to harden. Brick is colored according to the clay used (red is most typical) or the dyes added before iring. Brick used for constructing walls is typically 7 to 8 inches long by 3 to 4 inches wide and 2 to 3 inches thick. Applications. Interior and exterior walls and ireplace surrounds, vaulted or arched ceilings, residential and contract. Maintenance. Low upkeep—dust or use a mild soap and water solution. Often no upkeep is required. Special considerations. Can be treated with a sealant such as polyurethane that will prevent the brick from absorbing oil-based spills. Cost structure. Moderate to high. Brick

Concrete Block and Slab Description. Large porous bricks made of concrete with air pockets that make the material lightweight enough to handle but also somewhat fragile during handling. Poured slabs of concrete form walls and can be relatively smooth or very rusticated or brutalistic. Applications. Walls, some contract ceilings. Maintenance. Little or no maintenance. Concrete block surfaces are usually painted and then treated as any porous painted surface. Concrete slabs are rarely painted but are used as a frank and structural building material. Special considerations. May be used for an exterior building material; then it must be sealed against water permeation. Cost structure. Low to moderate, although installation or labor to install is high.

Ceramic Tile Description. Fine, white clays formed into tile shape (bisque), glazed, and ired at very high temperatures. Finishes vary from shiny and smooth to painted/decal-patterned to rough. Mosaic tiles are very small tiles used to create permanent patterns and pictures on walls. Today mosaic tile comes in preset sheets, a face mount or back mount, ready to be set with grout. Applications. Walls, counters, backsplash areas, ceilings. Used extensively in contract settings because of its durability. Often used in entries, bathrooms, kitchens, and solariums or in any room in warm climates. Maintenance. Low upkeep. Dust or wipe with clear water, vinegar water, or soap and water for heavy dirt. Grout may soil and discolor. Silicone treatments will make grout less susceptible to soil. Newer developments in grout are more resistant to stains. Special considerations. Durable surface that maintains good looks indeinitely. Ceramic tile can break, is cold, and is very hard. Cost structure. Low to high—costs vary considerably in ceramic tiles. Imported tiles from France and Italy can be expensive. Labor to install is also high. However, because it is permanent, the life-cycle cost is low.

Concrete block / Concrete slab

Ceramic tile

Glass Tile Description. Vitreous glass tiles are thin, square mosaic tesserae. They offer a wide range of colors and are often used to carry out a color scheme. They have a depth of color due to the relectance of the glass. Application. Durable for walls when luminosity is desirable, especially in bathrooms and kitchens; also suitable for outdoor use. They can add sparkle and shimmer to a space, and are sometimes used as artistic accents within a ceramic or quarry tile application. Special considerations. Because the surface is lat and even, it will be slippery when wet, limiting use to walls and ceilings in many cases, although glass tile can be used as a looring material. Even though glass tile is ired at high temperatures, it is still breakable. Cost structure. Moderately high.

Glass tile

Wall, Ceiling, and Window Treatments

Table 11.3

Brick, Concrete, Tile (continued) Quarry Tile Description. Made of ine clay and graded shale, with color distributed through the body of the tile. Most is a terra-cotta rust/red, the color of the natural clay. May be glazed but usually left natural. Typical square or hexagonal shapes are most popular. Applications. Walls, counters, backsplashes, ceilings, residential and contract applications, similar to ceramic tile. Maintenance. Same as for ceramic tile. Special considerations. Natural terra-cotta color gives quarry tile a timeless appeal. Cost structure. Tile cost is low to moderate, although installation is costly. Quarry tile

Mexican Tile

Figure 11.3 Glass tile surrounds this vanity area, with mosaic tile framing the mirror above the glass sink. Glass tile reflects the surroundings, giving an added dimension to its multicolored beauty. Design by Carriage House Studio Architects/photo © Brian Vanden Brink

Description. Hand-shaped clay taken from the ground and left to set before iring, relecting imperfections of hand labor that add to its charm. Applications. Large squares are not often used on walls; smaller, glazed tiles are used for decorative effects on walls, countertops, backsplashes, stair risers, and doorway surround trim. Maintenance. Glazed tiles clean the same as ceramic or quarry tiles. Special considerations. Mexican tile is durable, but if not sealed it is susceptible to oily stains. The softest of all the tiles, it can be chipped or broken more easily than quarry or ceramic tile. Cost structure. Tiles are low to moderate cost; installation is costly.

Mexican tile

Acoustical Tile Description. Acoustical ceiling tiles or panels are made from mineral iberboard or from fabric or plastic-clad iber, iberglass, and even metal. Applications. Ceilings in primarily contract settings; occasionally for walls. Maintenance. Maintenance is low. Ceiling installations may show soil around air distribution openings. Follow manufacturer’s directions for cleaning. Tiles that become stained are usually replaced or painted. Special considerations. Acoustical tiles may not be tiles at all but strips of insulative materials. Square, rectangular, and strip materials are usually mounted on a track or grid system, making it relatively easy to install, replace, or access the plenum area above, which houses lighting, HVAC, and other systems. Cost structure. Moderate. Acoustical tile

281

282

Chapter 11

Table 11.4

Glass, Mirror, Metal

Architectural Glazing Description. Transparent or translucent brittle material of molten sand, potash, lime, and perhaps metal oxides for color or for relecting and screening properties. Applications. Window glazing, curtain wall construction (glass walls over a steel skeleton frame), both residential and contract; interior ofice walls and dividers; and one-way-visibility windows and dividers. Maintenance. Transparent glass will show dirt easily and needs occasional maintenance with a glass-cleaning solution. Professional window washers are usually employed for contract installations. Special considerations. Glass for angled (skylight, greenhouse) installations must be tempered for strength (known as tempered or safety glass). Low-E (low-emission) glass screens out the harmful ultraviolet rays. Cost structure. Moderate to moderately high.

Glass Block

Figure 11.4 Glass block provides pleasant diffused daylight and privacy for a computer work area. Photo © Brian Vanden Brink

Description. Transparent or translucent glass pressed and formed as two halves and fused together. The semihollow blocks offer light diffusion and transmission and good insulation. Designs may be imprinted on one or both sides. Applications. Residential and contract applications where light diffusion is needed with some privacy. May also be used in wall and ceiling installations with artiicial light behind the blocks. Glass blocks are not for use in loadbearing situations. Maintenance. Little upkeep. If the blocks become dirty or greasy, soap and water will clean them. Polishing is not necessary. Special considerations. Variations of glass block include a ibrous glass insert that controls glare, brightness, and excessive heat gain. Solid glass blocks are available for wall installations for greater protection against breakage and forced entry. Cost structure. Moderately high.

Architectural glass (glazing)

Glass block

Fiberglass

Description. Glass ibers spun or pressed into a lightweight, insulative mass; translucent or opaque. Applications. Wall panels and dividers, bathtub and shower surrounds and units. Fibrous iberglass “wool” is an insulative material used in wall and ceiling structures. Fiberglass panels are also used for corrugated ceiling panels and patio covers. Both residential and contract applications. Maintenance. Fiberglass panels and pressed forms are easily scratched and need to be cleaned with a nonabrasive cleanser. Special considerations. Used where little hard use is anticipated, since it loses its shiny inish with abrasion or hard-water deposits. Cost structure. Moderate.

Fiberglass

Wall, Ceiling, and Window Treatments

Table 11.4

Glass, Mirror, Metal (continued)

Mirror Description. Flawless loat glass backed with a coating of silver or silver alloy. May be bronzed, grayed, antiqued (smokey), veined with gold color, or etched with a design. Applications. Walls and ceilings, residential and contract. Maintenance. Clean with glass cleaner; polish with soft cloths or paper products. Special considerations. Mirrors will visually expand the space and may be set in place as lat, lawless panels or shaped into patterns such as tile. Mirrors may be used on folding screens or sliding closet doors. Cost structure. Moderately high.

Metal—Aluminum, Brass, Bronze, Copper, Stainless Steel, Tin Description. An extremely durable material that can be used in several forms. Sheets of aluminum, brass, bronze, copper, and stainless steel may be cut and itted in place; strips of metal may be installed on clips. Metal panels are available, solid or perforated. Tin panels, with stamped patterns, document Victorian designs. Applications. Walls, ceilings, and custom installations such as wrapped columns. Custom residences and contract installations. Maintenance. Little upkeep. If surfaces should become spotted from handling, use a metal polish preparation. Painted metals can be washed with soap and water. Follow manufacturer’s instructions for cleaning. Most metals are treated to be impervious to oil, dirt, and corrosion. Special considerations. Metals are available in shiny or brushed surfaces. Some metal ceiling systems are designed to be installed over existing ceilings in renovation or remodeling work, making it possible to maintain existing heat and air-conditioning ducts and wiring. Finishes (see Chapter 9) include anodized satin, polished, and brushed. Cost structure. Moderately high to high.

Mirror

Metal

Figure 11.5 Mosaic tile is surrounded by metal vanity and walls in this upscale bathroom. Lighting enhances the luminance of the tiles and adds a soft glow. Designer: Lori Carroll, Co-Designers: Mary Roles; Lori Carroll & Associates/Photography: William Lesch Photography/ NKBA Design Competition

283

284

Chapter 11

Table 11.5

Wallboard, Plaster

Wallboard Description. A general category of drywall goods including Sheetrock or drywall (gypsum board—made of crushed and processed gypsum rock). Available in sheets 4 feet by 8 feet or 4 feet by 12 feet and hung with nails or screws to wooden or metal studs. Seams are sealed with perfatape (paper) and covered with plaster mud, smoothed out to be inconspicuous. The wallboard may be textured or left smooth. Smooth wallboard is best for wallpaper installations. Applications. The most common of the wall inish materials for both residential and contract settings. It is a basic material that may be i nished as described or overlayed with wall coverings or fabric. Maintenance. Upkeep will depend on the texture and inish given the wallboard. Paints vary in their ability to withstand repeated cleanings, as do wall coverings and fabric. Special considerations. Economical wall-covering material. It is also fragile. It will dent and scratch and can be punctured when doorknobs or other hard objects are thrust against it. Cost structure. Moderate.

Wallboard—Sheetrock or gypsum board

Plaster Description. A paste mixture of lime, sand, and water that hardens as it dries. May be applied as a inish material to be smooth, textured, or rough. Stucco may be a smooth or rough consistency, depending on the ineness of the sand used. Plaster may also be cast into decorative ornaments or cornices, generally called anaglypta or anaglyphs, that can imitate handcarved wood and be nailed or glued in place and painted. Applications. Walls, exterior and interior, ceilings; anaglypta ornament, moldings. Authentic smooth plaster walls are coated over lath (thin strips of wood nailed to the wall studs horizontally, about three-eighths of an inch apart) or over wire mesh. Today, plaster is more often applied over plasterboard or Sheetrock (see wallboard) or concrete block. Plaster is applied as “mud” to seal the perfatape to conceal wallboard seams or applied as rough-textured stucco. It is also sprayed on or hand-applied in a texturizing process and then sanded into the desired texture. A light application of blown plaster is usually called orange peel. Plain plaster applications are more common in contract settings. Maintenance. Upkeep of plaster depends on the use or abuse, as it can chip, crack, and peel. It scratches and mars easily, and smooth plaster is dificult to touch up with paint. Washability depends on the type of paint used. Special considerations. Smooth plaster applied over Sheetrock is more costly than sprayed or textured walls. New lath-and-plaster walls are nearly nonexistent because of the labor involved. Cost structure. Moderate.

Plaster or stucco

Wall, Ceiling, and Window Treatments

Table 11.6

285

Wood, Cork

Wood: Millwork Traditional Paneling Description. Stock and custom-milled wood applied to walls and as cabinetry in the form of lat and raised panels, shelving, and moldings. The wood may be hardwood or softwood, plywood or solid wood. Applications. Walls in residential and now, to a substantial extent, in contract work. Maintenance. Depends on the inish it is given. Oiled or waxed wood may need protection against moisture and will show ingerprints. Millwork is usually sealed with lacquer, acrylic, or urethane, which then is easy to clean with a mild detergent solution. Special considerations. Installation is considered to be part of the architectural detail and hence a permanent part of the building that is rarely removed unless remodeling takes place. It gives visual richness to the interior, particularly when stained rather than painted. Cost structure. Moderate to high, depending on whether the millwork is paint grade (less costly) or stained wood (very costly).

Traditional paneling

Wood Paneling Description. Solid wood paneling comes in thin 4- by 8-foot sheets of hardwoods. More typical, however, is high-quality veneer plywood with a thin layer of hardwood (veneer) laminated to the surface. Hardboard (Masonite) is made of wood ibers compressed under heat or pressure. These may have a veneer or a photo reproduction of wood applied to the surface and grooved to represent a plank wall material. They may also be formed with a surface texture to imitate carved wood panels. Tongue-and-groove strips (milled to interlock) are also used for walls as a paneling. Board-and-batten walls are long strips of wood with narrow strips or lath nailed or screwed over the seams. Beadboard has grooves to imitate board and batten. Wood planks can be installed in a horizontal or vertical direction on walls and ceilings. Scandinavian interiors often feature horizontal wood planks on angled or cathedral ceilings. Wood planks can be butted against each other or installed as tongue-and-groove slats. They offer enhanced insulation; the thicker the plank, the greater the insulation. Log planks are split in half lengthwise so that the lat side is attached to a lat wood-framed wall and the rounded litch side is the wall material, requiring little or no inishing. Advantages include economy (using half the log), high insulation value, and the ability to run wiring and plumbing in a traditional manner within the wood frame, while the log planks give the look of authentic log cabin walls. Applications. Walls and ceilings. The quality of the wood will determine the type of residential or contract application. Maintenance. This depends on the surface of the product. Paneling may be oiled, waxed, urethaned, or treated with acrylic or other products, or it may have a plastic inish, which varies from a very thin coat to a durable, permanent i nish capable of withstanding the wear of any contract installation. Wall-cleaning products are available for wood only, or follow the manufacturer’s instructions. Durable inishes may be washed with soap and water. Special considerations. Wood paneling ranges from a do-ityourself-project look to an exquisite and costly appearance. Cost structure. Moderately low to moderately high. Solid wood will be most costly.

Board and batten, or beadboard

Cork

Cork Description. The thick outer layer of the cork oak tree, a broad-leaf evergreen that grows in the Mediterranean region. It is light in color, elastic, and insulative. It is resilient and may be treated with a vinyl coating, making it more durable. It is sound absorbent. Applications. Residential and contract settings where a quiet, resilient surface is required. Maintenance. Dust or wipe with a damp cloth. Special considerations. Due to its insulative properties, cork should not be used where solar gain is desired. It will absorb bumps well but can be broken off and is very dificult or impossible to repair. In very thin sheets it may be laminated to paper for wall coverings. Cost structure. Moderate to high.

Figure 11.6 Wood plank paneling covers the walls and ceiling of this home office, providing additional insulation, low maintenance, and timeless appeal. Design by Albert, Righter & Tittman Architects/photo © Brian Vanden Brink

286

Chapter 11

Figure 11.7 Painted cabinets, painted beadboard backsplash behind the countertops, and painted walls and ceilings in a fresh blue, yellow, and white scheme establish country-style charm in this kitchen. Designer: Gerard Ciccarello, CMKBD; Covenant Kitchens & Baths, Inc./Photography: John Savarese/NKBA Design Competition

Figure 11.8 Painted “trompe l’oeil” scenes transform the walls of this California laundry room into an ocean view. Courtesy of Amy Weiss Design

Figure 11.9 Outlining is seen in the painted clean white wood trim that contrasts with the green walls. Photo courtesy of Sea Gull Lighting Products, LLC.

Wall, Ceiling, and Window Treatments

• Skilled professional painters can produce texture and pattern, contrast and camoulage; they can create imitations of nearly any type of material. Professional painting is not inexpensive, although the cost for painting faux (false or imitation) marble, for example, is far less than surfacing with real marble.

Painting Guidelines Because paint varies in versatility and ease of application, careful planning and preparation are imperative to achieve truly beautiful results. Tables 11.7 through 11.9 list paint types, inishes, and techniques. Some guidelines and cautions for using paint include the following: • Surfaces must be properly prepared. Old paint that is cracked, bubbled, laked, or peeling must be removed or sanded. Remove wallpaper. Cracks, holes, and damaged areas must be patched and sanded smooth. A

Table 11.7

287

clean, dust-free surface will help ensure a lawless inish. • Before selecting paint colors or textures, evaluate the room itself. Look at the dimensions, the moldings, the architectural assets and defects. Evaluate the number of windows, the direction they face, and the amount of light admitted. • Don’t try to judge paint color from a small paint chip—the color in large quantities becomes darker and brighter because of quantity. Several paint companies now sell samples of premixed colored paint, available at stores or online. These samples cover a 2- by 2-foot or 4- by 4-foot area to test the color in the room where it will be painted, with the lighting that will affect its appearance, as discussed in Chapter 4. • Trying colors via online painting is another way to judge the effect of paint color, although the actual color may vary according to the computer monitor. The following companies have paint application programs

Types of Paints

By understanding the characteristics of each type of paint, you can make the best selection. It is also wise to describe the project to painting contractors or retail paint store specialists who can recommend a suitable product. Acrylic paint is a synthetic resin water-based paint. It is odorless, quick drying, durable, and easy to use. It cleans up with soap and water and is moderately priced. Alkyds and alkyd enamels are durable resins, oil-modiied, that dry faster and harder than oil paints. Alkyd enamels produce a glossy surface. Alkyds are moderately priced, are easy to work with, and have very good coverage and color range. Cleanup is with solvents or paint thinners. Artist’s paints—oil or acrylic—come in small bottles or tubes and can be thinned with mineral spirits or water and used as glazing for transparent color-overlay painting techniques. Eco-friendly paints are available from many paint companies. These have low to zero volatile organic compounds (VOCs) that pollute the air and are hazardous to the health after painting until the paint completes off-gassing the VOCs. Enamel paints are oil-based or sometimes water-based. They usually come in gloss or semigloss (may have lattening agents added for a matte inish). These paints are used most often for their hard, glossy, smooth i nish. Epoxy paints come already mixed or have hardeners mixed in at the site. Epoxies can be used to paint metal and water-holding surfaces such as bathtubs and swimming pools. Fillers and sealers are used prior to staining or painting. Fillers are putty or stick-putty materials that ill in holes or cracks. Sealers are liquid preparations that make a smoother surface. Finishes refer to the relative shine (see Table 11.8). Finishes also consist of a separate group of liquid sealants used on cabinetry and furniture, including shellac, lacquer, polyurethanes, and acrylics. Flame-retardant paints retard the spread of lames or the toxic fumes and smoke given off by burning paints. Most speciications for new or remodeled contract buildings require that paint meet a Class A lame spread, the lowest possible. Latex paint is the least costly of the paints. Latex paints vary in their quality and durability. They are easy to apply and dry quickly, reducing recoating time. They have an excellent color range and are fairly durable but must be protected from freezing temperatures. They are not as scrubbable as alkyds but do have the ability to breathe, allowing moisture to escape. Cleanup is with soap and water. Oil-based paints were for a number of years considered the best paint to buy. They were thought to be the most durable, were the most expensive, had the strongest odor, and took the longest to dry. Cleanup of oil-based paints is with paint thinner or solvent. These paints have largely been replaced with alkyds, and they may eventually be off the market due to environmental concerns. Primers are liquid sealers applied to some surfaces before the paint. They ill in small pores and help the paint become more durable. Solvents are liquids that dissolve resins, gums, or oils and are used to thin or clean up oils, alkyds, and oil-based enamels. Stains are thin liquids used to color woods by penetrating the porous surface. Stains come in water base, oil base, varnish, and wax.

288

Chapter 11

Table 11.8

Paint Finishes

Terms for paint inishes may vary according to the manufacturer, but in general they fall into the following categories: Flat or matte paint relects very little sheen. It is appropriate for walls and ceilings to give a soft, velvetlike texture. Flat paints are the least washable of the lusters. Satin or eggshell paint has a small amount of light-relecting quality, so it hides ingerprints better and is more washable than lat paint. It may be called low sheen or low luster/lustre. Semigloss paint has some sheen to hide marks, is more washable than lat or satin, and contrasts nicely with either lat or gloss paints. Gloss paint is highly relective, durable, and easier to clean than lower gloss paints. High-gloss paint is the shiniest of the paint lusters and the most durable and scrubbable. Its relecting qualities, however, will show every law on a surface that has not been properly prepared for painting. Texturizing paint comes in various textures. While the majority of the paints used are smooth, some thicker paints are available that can be applied to give the effect of stucco or of suede. These texturizing paints will also absorb more sound.

Table 11.9

Paint-Texturizing Techniques

Visual texturizing can be achieved in many ways; just about any effect the design calls for can be accomplished by a skilled painter. Smooth textures are achieved by using one of the four common methods of applying paint listed below. These techniques may produce an even surface appropriate in many period settings and modern interiors where woodwork and architectural detail are not important. They also make appropriate backgrounds for the broken and textured paint techniques presented in this chart. 1. Brush painting is used for corners; small, hard-to-reach areas; and detail work such as window grids and moldings. 2. Roller painting is very useful for large areas such as walls and ceilings. Small rollers are handy for narrow areas. A different sleeve should be used for each color. Rollers do spatter somewhat, and the roller should never be too full of paint. 3. Pad painting is useful for smaller areas and will not spatter. Pads cover evenly and are easy to work with. 4. Spray painting takes on two forms. Airless spraying uses luid pressure and undiluted paint—it gives a better coverage but uses more paint. Air-compression spray guns use diluted paint and give less-complete coverage. Spraying is common in new buildings, both residential and contract. It is fast and economical. It should be followed with a roller to even out the paint. Antiquing means to make a surface look old, to soften and blur slightly in imitation of the mellow patina that naturally accompanies the aging process. Techniques frequently used in antiquing include color washing, glazing, spattering, and dragging. Color washing is a technique of applying a coat of thinned, sometimes translucent, paint over a white or colored background. It is versatile, attractive, and easy to use, giving effects from rugged texture (over rough walls) to shimmering translucence (over smooth walls). Dragging and combing produce ine lines and may be used in wood graining. Dragging or coasting a dry brush over a wet glaze reveals a base color and can imitate ine fabric yarns. Combing uses any hard comblike tool. Dragging and combing can be done in straight lines, curving lines, or fan shapes. Cross-hatching by combing can produce a fabric burlaplike texture. Glazing is a technique in which transparent colors are overlayed in sequence, thereby producing various gradations of color. Marbling is the technique of imitating polished marble stone. If it is done by artisans with a high degree of skill and artistic sense, the marbled surface cannot be distinguished from the real stone. Marbling can also be a mottled whirling, moving low painted onto the surface. Outlining means painting contrasting colors or white values on architectural molding. Picking out means highlighting features on molding, such as dentil trim or carved bas-relief. Porphyry is a granitelike texture achieved by crisscross brushing, then stippling, spattering, and inally cissing (dropping mineral spirits on the splatters to dilute and make shadows of the spatters). Ragging and rag rolling partially removes the wet paint or glaze by dabbing with a rag or rolling paint off with a rolled rag. Shading is the technique of blending color values from light to dark across a wall or ceiling. Smooshing is a slightly marbled effect achieved by applying a plastic dropcloth to a wall of wet paint, rubbing or “smooshing” the hands over the plastic, and then peeling off the plastic. Spattering is achieved by illing a brush and lipping the paint onto the base color to produce uneven spots or spatters. Sponging (or paint applied with sponges) produces a broken, splotchy effect. Larger sponge pores will produce a more coarse-looking texture and a larger splotch than i ner sponges. Stippling uses a stippling brush to dab on a colored glaze or paint, revealing some of the base color. The result is iner than sponging. Wood graining is done by brushing on a glaze and drawing wood grains and lines with an artist’s brush. Techniques vary according to the type of wood being imitated. When well done, wood graining can be very beautiful.

Wall, Ceiling, and Window Treatments

289

(C)

(A)

(B)

that allow you to try paint colors on surfaces of generic room photos or by uploading a photo of the room you intend to paint: Behr, www.behr.com—Color Smart by Behr™ Benjamin Moore, www.benjaminmoore.com—Personal Color Viewer® Sherwin Williams, www.sherwin-williams.com—Color Visualizer Valspar, www.valspar.com—Online Painter

Figure 11.10 Case Study This contemporary restaurant in a century-old building has been designed with environmentally sound materials and celebrates the work of local artists. (A) A view along the communal table that gives the restaurant its name, Communal. Architectural and decorative interest is achieved with a charcoal gray painted ceiling with beams in olive green, counterpointing the environmentally acceptable Venetian plaster in a clean white, seen in (B) closeup above the banquette. (C) The kitchen walls are subway tile, contrasted with an inset metal grill as a wall feature. Countertops are cast white cement. Wall art paintings are part of a rotating display of work by local artists, and art glass transoms are also created by a community artisan. Photos © David A. Taylor

• Consider glazing (transparent paints) for unique lightrevealing effects and texturizing techniques. Experiment with different color combinations. • Consider orientation and climate when selecting the hue for painted walls. For example, a lively yellow may be warm and comforting in a cool room with a north exposure or in a cooler climate, whereas that same color would visually and psychologically bake the inhabitants of an interior with a broad southern exposure or in a hot climate. • Evaluate what contrast in the paint will do to the room. High-value contrast (very light hues against very dark hues) will accentuate and draw attention to that contrast. This can be dramatically effective where the contrast is in large planes and busy if the contrast is, say, around every door and window. On the other hand, light values next to medium ones or medium values near dark values can provide depth and richness. • Consider the psychological effect of the color. The way people feel about color should be respected. Warm colors are lively and welcoming; cool colors are calm, providing a restful, restrained environment.

290

Chapter 11

Wall Coverings Wall coverings—including wallpaper, vinyl and textile wall coverings, and fabric—provide tremendous variety in pattern, color, texture, sound absorption, and lexibility. Walls and ceilings beneit from the many wall coverings that add visual and architectural interest. The reasons for using wall coverings include the following: • Colors, patterns, and textures of wall coverings are unlimited. • Wall coverings can imitate natural materials such as stone, wood, brick, or tile at a fraction of the cost of those materials. • Costs vary, but they can be modest. Installation can be done professionally or by the layperson. • Three-dimensional fabric wall coverings absorb sound and give a sense of quiet or peace to the interior. • Wall coverings can cover badly cracked walls or old paint; they can even camoulage architectural laws or defects. • Fabric installed on the wall can coordinate with fabric used in other areas of the interior. Many wallcovering companies offer companion fabrics to match wallpapers. • Wall coverings can provide “instant decor”—they can add charm, beauty, and character to interiors. • Fabric wall coverings can be installed lat, pleated, shirred, draped, or folded, allowing creativity in the way the pattern, color, or texture is utilized.

differ in style or color will be discordant, and if two or more clashing wall coverings are visible from any one vantage point, the effect can be disastrous. Obvious patterns on the ceiling will visually lower the ceiling and can be psychologically disturbing. Patterns that clash with fabrics in the interior are poor choices. Keep in mind how often the furnishings may be changed or replaced. Many textured and colorful wall coverings are lovely and sophisticated, and their subtle qualities establish pleasing transitions from one room or area to another. However, very intense colors, or cheap imitations (such as plastic grass cloth), may not be considered good design. Installation is a key factor in how nice a wall covering looks. The work of professional wall-covering installers will look far superior to a careless do-it-yourself job. Wall covering terms useful in selecting and ordering are found in Tables 11.10 and 11.12. Table 11.11 lists methods of fabric installation as wall-covering material.

Wall-Covering Guidelines Wall coverings are so extensively used as “instant decorating” that some guidelines and cautions are in order: Select wall coverings that are compatible with the style of furnishings and with the architecture of the building. Formal Baroque or Renaissance designs in a modern building are not only out of character; they may insult the integrity of both the wall covering and the architecture. Choose pattern with great discrimination. Consider how long a pattern will stay stylish and aesthetically appealing. A general rule is that the more dramatic or lamboyant the pattern, the more quickly it will become tiresome. Limit the number of patterns in an interior and coordinate them to provide harmony from one area to another. Patterns that

Figure 11.11 Connecting rooms require careful coordination of wall treatments. In this dining room, wainscot wall paneling is installed below a large-scale Arts and Crafts patterned wallcovering. The adjoining room behind has a small-scale wallcovering, and the entry to the library as well as walls next to the stairway are painted. Design by Sally Weston Associates/photo © Brian Vanden Brink

Wall, Ceiling, and Window Treatments

Table 11.10

291

Wall-Covering Terms

Single rolls contain 30 to 36 square feet, being about 28 feet long by 27 inches wide. When calculating wall-covering quantity, igure that single roll will cover 25 to 30 square feet, which allows for waste. European papers have 28 feet per single roll. Wallpapers are priced as single rolls and may be purchased by the single roll (abbreviated S/R). Double roll is the equivalent of, and is priced as, two single rolls rolled into one—it usually contains about 72 square Single roll feet. It saves waste and is therefore more economical. Triple roll is priced as and equals three single rolls in one length, about 108 square feet. The most economical use of the paper. Dye lot is a single run of colors or a single production. The dye-lot shades may vary. If it becomes necessary to re- Double roll order, always specify the dye-lot number (included on a piece of paper with the roll) or send in a swatch of the paper. It is not always possible to obtain the same dye lot at a later date, so do not skimp when ordering. Border is a narrow or wide band of wallpaper used to trim and accent. Borders are usually packaged in single Triple roll “spools” of 15 feet (5 yards). Pattern repeat comes in two directions. A vertical pattern repeat is the complete motif or pattern from the top of one length to the top of the next. A large pattern repeat is more wasteful, since a complete pattern repeat must begin at the top of each length. A horizontal pattern repeat means that the pattern can be matched straight across or drop-matched by lowering the next length of paper. Peelable wall covering means the top layer of the wallpaper will peel off, leaving a substrate (lining) material that can be papered over again. Prepasted wall covering means the paper has a dry coating of paste and will need only to be moistened to be applied. Pretrimmed wall covering means ready to hang. Hand-printed wallpapers have a selvage (border) with separate printed information, including blocks of color used in the paper. This must be trimmed off before the paper is hung. Pretrimmed papers have the selvage cut off. Semitrimmed has only one side of the selvage trimmed, so the selvage left on is under an overlap or is trimmed off at the site. Scrubbable denotes a wall covering that can withstand repeated wet cleaning. Most vinyl wall coverings are scrubbable. Sizing is a thin liquid painted onto the wall surface that reduces the amount of paste absorbed by the wallpaper. It also gives the surface “tooth,” or enough abrasiveness to stick well, and it seals the surface so that alkali cannot penetrate into the wallpaper. Strippable is a term applied to papers that can be stripped off the wall completely without scraping or steaming. Washable means the paper can be cleaned gently with a little soap and water.

Table 11.11

Methods of Installing Wall Fabric

Covered-frame method uses a lath frame (1-inch by 2-inch wooden strips) laid on the back of the fabric. The fabric is pulled tightly over the frame and stapled. The result is a blind wooden frame with top and sides covered with fabric. This can be mounted or hung on protruding nails as panels and may not cover the entire wall. Smaller fabric-framed panels may be accessory items. Direct pasteup uses fabrics that come prepared for installation as a wall covering with a paper or foam backing, or the installer may apply a spray backing or iron on a stiffening fabric backing. Sometimes the preparation or paste causes the fabric grain to slip, making it dificult to match patterns horizontally. A skilled professional is an asset in direct fabric pasteup. A less permanent method is to sponge liquid laundry starch onto the wall or dip the fabric in it. The fabric will stick to the wall until it is remoistened and pulled off. Hook-and-loop fasteners may be used to install fabric in cases where the fabric needs to be taken down frequently for cleaning. The bestknown brand of hook-and-loop fasteners is Velcro. One half of the tape is sewn or glued to the fabric and the companion part is applied to the wall. Lath method uses wood lath strips nailed to the wall perimeter. The fabric is stapled, glued, or fastened to the strips with hook-and-loop tape. This saves the effort of preparing badly damaged walls or stiffening the fabric for direct pasteup. Panel-track method can use several brands of metal or plastic tracks that are on the market for the professional, usually contract installation of fabric on the wall. These include ofice systems furniture, which provides a lexible wall where fabrics can be changed when necessary. Stapling with a staple gun is a fast, easy method of applying fabric to the wall. The staples may be covered with trim such as welt or gimp or braid or with wood or plastic molding. Strapping-tape method is a very inexpensive and easy method. Simply roll lengths of strapping tape into circles and latten against the wall; then press the fabric in place. High humidity or certain paint surfaces may make this method unsatisfactory, however. Upholstered walls mean that there is a layer of batting applied irst to the wall in the form of polyester or cotton batting or foam. The fabric is then stapled over the padding, and a trim is placed on top. This gives extra sound-absorption and insulation values.

292

Chapter 11

Table 11.12

Types of Wall Coverings

Coordinating or companion fabrics are available with some wall coverings. This is a convenient, although not inexpensive, way to coordinate fabric installations with wall coverings. Cork wall coverings use cork, a natural resilient bark, cut into very thin layers with a paper backing. Embossed wall coverings are calendered to produce a three-dimensional, raised pattern. Anaglypta wall coverings are embossed to resemble sculptured plaster, hammered copper, or hand-tooled leather and may be paintable. Fabric or textile wall coverings are fabrics laminated to a paper backing and sold in rolls or bolts. The most common fabric wall coverings are linen, jute, and wool. They give a rich natural-textured look and are very appropriate for both residential and contract interiors. Fabric-backed wall coverings are used for heavy-face papers or vinyl to give strength to the installation. Flocked wallpapers use flocking, a process of gluing tiny ibers in a pattern to a paper surface for a decorative effect, imitating cut velvet. Foil/mylar wall coverings have a shiny, highly relective quality. Grass cloth is made of dried grasses that are left natural or dyed a color and woven into a textile with i ne cotton threads (a more reined product) or other grasses (coarser looking), and paper backed. Leather is a luxurious and quieting wall covering. Leather squares or leather tiles, the tanned hide of cattle and swine, are dyed brown or other colors and possibly embossed with patterns. Murals are printed scenic wallpapers that come in panels. They have traditionally been scenes of romantic or faraway places, sometimes ruins of ancient civilizations. Paper wall coverings are the most common wall coverings. They may be coated with vinyl (explained below). They are easy to hang and come in a wide variety of patterns and colors. Vinyl wall coverings come in several types, from light to heavy weight. Vinyl-protected wall coverings in which a thin layer of vinyl is applied over wallpaper to make it more washable and durable Vinyl latex, paper impregnated with vinyl and applied to a fabric or paper backing Coated fabric, coated or laminated fabric wall covering Vinyl wall coverings are the heaviest of the wall coverings, the most scrubbable and strippable, and possibly even reusable. They are more dificult to hang because of their weight. They may imitate wood, leather, tile, marble, or any other hard material.

Fabric-Covered Walls Fabric installed or upholstered onto a wall or ceiling has many advantages. It is the most flexible wall covering, as it can be applied lat, gathered (shirred), pleated, or folded. Fabrics can change their character with the different methods of installation. A patterned fabric laid lat looks quite different from one that is shirred, pleated, or folded. Installations can be quite temporary, permanent, or semipermanent. Fabrics provide these additional beneits: • Insulation against both noise and temperature extremes • Visual comfort as well as physical softness • The ability to use the same material on other installations, such as upholstered furniture, bedspreads, and accessory items Fabrics used on the wall may be subject to soiling and may discolor or stain when spot cleaned, making upkeep dificult. Fabrics should not be used in heavy trafic areas where people, particularly children, tend to touch the wall frequently. Figure 11.12 Fabric on the wall, here wrapped as blocks or upholstered, absorbs noise and increases comfort. Courtesy of DuPont “Teflon” soil and stain repellent

Wall, Ceiling, and Window Treatments

Ceiling Treatments While most of the materials discussed for wall treatments may also be applied to ceilings, the most typical ceiling materials are those that are lighter in weight, such as acoustical tile, wallboard, plaster, wood, and cork. Most guidelines for the use of paint and wall coverings on walls will also hold true for ceiling treatments. The ceiling treatment can have a powerful, yet subtle, inluence on the overall feeling of space in the interior. For ceilings that need to be visually lowered, use patterns, dark or bright colors, or texture. To visually raise the height, use smooth surfaces and light, pale, or dull colors. Horizontal beams or bands will visually lower a ceiling, whereas angled ceilings with beams that carry the eye upward—an effect often seen in church interiors—will increase the visual height. Fabric is sometimes draped on a ceiling in sunburst or tentlike fashion to create a cozy atmosphere. In interiors where sound needs to be absorbed, fabric is a good choice. It can be upholstered onto the ceiling as well as draped, and it is also available in fabric panels and acoustical panels. Acoustical tile, of course, is also a good sound absorber, as is textured acoustical plaster. In addition, texturing is frequently desirable as a way of covering up blemishes before the ceiling is painted. Chapter 10 discusses and illustrates different architectural ceilings.

Window Treatments Because of consumer demands for beauty, privacy, energy conservation, comfort, and cost eficiency, today’s window treatments offer a variety of options that continually expands with advancing technology. Window treatments are generally divided into two categories—soft and alternative. Soft window treatments include draperies, curtains, fabric shades, and top treatments; alternative coverings include a wide array of art glass, horizontal and vertical slat blinds, screens, shades, and shutters. These treatments are presented in Tables 11.13 through 11.19. Recent trends have favored layered treatments—two or more fabric treatments, or a practical and durable alternative treatment (a blind, shutter, screen, or shade) layered with a soft fabric treatment of curtain, drapery, or top treatment.

Window-Treatment Considerations Many factors go into making a wise choice for a window covering. These include aesthetic coordination, privacy, energy consciousness, light control, and also operational control.

293

Aesthetic Coordination Aesthetic coordination is the careful selection of window treatments not only to look beautiful but also to blend with and support the interior and exterior design and architecture. Aesthetic coordination also requires sensitivity to good proportion. It helps to judge proportion by sketching the window treatment to scale. Window treatments that are top heavy, too wide, overdone—or, on the other hand, too skimpy—can throw off the proportions of the entire room. This is because the window itself is an important architectural feature that will inevitably draw attention because of the light and view. If the window treatment is aesthetically disturbing, the interior will seem incomplete and lacking in harmony, no matter how handsome other furnishings are.

Privacy Privacy protects valuable belongings against burglary. Privacy also gives a psychological sense of well-being and makes a space more usable after dark. During the day, adequate privacy can be obtained with translucent treatments, which also offer the advantage of allowing daylight into the interior. Sheer and semisheer curtains, pleated fabric shades, louvered blinds or shutters, and pierced screens all give good daytime privacy. Translucent treatments do not give nighttime privacy. Alternative treatments that have holes or slats that do not close completely do not provide total privacy either. Only opaque treatments that can be closed fully provide complete nighttime privacy. These include opaque draperies and shades, solid vane vertical louvers, opaque cellular pleated shades, and routless (no holes) horizontal blinds.

Energy Consciousness Energy consciousness is important for two reasons: 1. The cost of heating or cooling a room is reduced through energy-eficient treatments. 2. The comfort of the room is enhanced by controlling excess heat gain and heat loss. Heat gain or solar heat gain can be a problem not only in hot climates and in the summer but anytime heat from the sun becomes uncomfortable and begins to fade or damage interior furnishings. Treatments that control heat gain are referred to as shading devices. The ideal shading device is actually on the exterior, preventing the sun from hitting the glass of the window. Glare and UV control can be achieved through window ilm and through shading window devices. Glare is excessive luminance, often from large window expanses, that causes fatigue and irritation. Natural light also contains ultraviolet (UV) light, which permanently damages furniture by fading art and accessories, fabric applications, carpets and rugs, and wood looring. UV

294

Chapter 11

Figure 11.13 This wall of windows and French doors are treated with Vista window film, applied directly to the glass to eliminate glare and reduce over 99 percent of the UV light that damages and fades furnishings. Window film helps eliminate hot and cold spots near windows and will hold glass shards together in case of breakage. Photo © CPFilms Inc., a subsidiary of Solutia Inc.

light also dries out wood loors and furnishings, causing them to split or crack. Window ilm can eliminate glare and over 99 percent of the UV light. Sheer fabric draperies and curtains and alternative window treatments such as shadings and pleated shades can also do this. Glare can also be decreased in slatted treatments—shutters and horizontal and vertical blinds. UV protection can also be achieved by operating blinds and shutters to keep furnishings in the shade of the treatment. This method, however, requires vigilance and perhaps a schedule whereby the louvers are adjusted to a particular angle. By coupling window ilm with shading devices, protection against glare and unwanted UV light is assured.

Once the sun hits the glass, temperatures between the window and the interior window treatment can climb to as high as 300 degrees Fahrenheit, heating the room and causing damage to furnishings. The most effective interior shading devices are those that can relect a high percentage of sunlight back through the glass. Window ilm and metallized pleated shades and light-colored treatments do this best. Room-darkening treatments also effectively control heat and brightness. Heat loss is a problem in moderate to cold climates in the winter. When heated interior air rises and travels toward the window, it comes in contact with cold glass, cooling the heated air, which then drops to the loor and

Wall, Ceiling, and Window Treatments

(A)

(B) (C)

(D)

Figure 11.14 Case Study In a section of a nineteenthcentury New York City brownstone or multiple-storied home, this small derelict space will be transformed into a sitting room. (A) Before: The problem included the need for the sink to be removed, framed Sheetrock to encase the corner pipe, then new wallcoverings, and a window treatment that also must accommodate an in-window air-conditioning unit. The designer has written instructions for the subcontractors on the sink and door. (B) Using DreamDraper ® software, the window and wall are drawn to scale with exact measurements indicated. (C) Next, an asymmetrical, shirred drapery with a semisheer London shade is designed, leaving space beneath for the air-conditioning unit. The treatment style is Empire, complete with an exposed decorator rod and heavy use of fringe, which is a drapery reproduction of this nineteenth-century style. (D) The next step is indicating the actual wallcovering and fabric, selected from online sites and click-pasted onto the wall area and drapery fabrications. Artwork and furnishings are also indicated. (E) The furnished space is executed, much as seen in the computerized renderings, and finished with elegant historic furniture, luminaires, and accessories. Design by Jamie Gibbs/renderings by DreamDraper ® software

(E)

295

296

Chapter 11

circulates at ankle level, where we may feel a draft. Preventing the warm air from striking the glass is the best preventative for heat loss. Insulated fabric shades sealed on the sides and at the bottom and insulated shutters are the best treatments. Other good choices are opaque roller shades and heavy lined/interlined draperies that reach to the loor, are securely attached to the walls, and have sealed top treatments. The heavier and more solid the treatment, the better it insulates.

Light Control Control of light is a major consideration in selecting window treatments. Light-controlling needs should be noted in the design program. If the room needs to be completely darkened, certain opaque treatments will ill that requirement. Light is often desirable, although glare (intense directional light) causes irritation and fatigue. Many treatments do a good job of controlling glare: draperies, curtains, shades (of light to medium weight), all types of vertical and horizontal blinds, pleated and translucent shades, louvered shutters, screens, and bamboo shades. Within an interior, the need for light and glare control may vary according to the orientation, or direction, the windows face. Whereas north-facing windows may need little light control, the bright east light, constant south light, or hot, piercing west light may require shading devices during particular times of the day when the sunlight comes directly through windows facing those directions.

through color, texture, and perhaps pattern. In addition, light-iltering fabrics can give daytime privacy (and be layered with opaque fabrics or hard materials for nighttime privacy) and can effectively reduce or eliminate glare. Fabrics can be installed on traverse rods to be drawn off the window. Fabrics also can be made into many decorative shapes, giving architectural support, authenticity, or decorative effects. There seems to be no limit to the styles and combinations of fabrics used at the window, making the window perhaps the most creative of all background material installations. See Table 11.18 for calculations.

Draperies Draperies are pleated fabric panels hung on a rod. Draperies may be opaque, casement (semi-opaque), or translucent. There are many types of pleats, the most common being the French or pinch pleat. See Table 11.13.

Curtains Curtains are often shirred, or gathered, onto a rod, making them stationary or hand operable. Shirred curtains may be formal or informal. Curtains can also have a variety of headings depending on the use. Table 11.14 lists some types of curtains.

Fabric Window Shades Fabric shades are panels of fabric that operate top to bottom. In Great Britain they are called blinds. See Table 11.15.

Operational Control

Top Treatments

The selection of a window treatment should also be based on whether or not it needs to be operable, and this will largely be dictated by the needs previously discussed. Stationary treatments—tied-back draperies, rufled curtains, top treatments, stationary screens—cannot be closed for privacy, nor can they be removed for desirable solar gain or maximum light penetration. Ventilation may be inhibited by a treatment that is dificult to operate or that will not adequately stack out of the window area. For many treatments on cord- or pulley-operated hardware, motorized units can operate the opening and closing of the treatment. Many situations can beneit from motorized units—from hard-to-reach controls (such as solarium shades) to control by a disabled person to the convenience of automation or remote control. There are also mechanisms that can sense, by light or temperature change, when to close treatments, thus enhancing energy eficiency.

Top treatments are used for a number of reasons: to hide rods or pleats, to cover the area from the top of the window to the ceiling, to give a soft and inished look to the room. Top treatments may be shaped according to architectural detailing or may be inspired by furnishings. They are often an effective medium to unite a room and carry the eye gracefully along the top of the walls. Types of top treatments are discussed in Table 11.16.

Soft Window Coverings Fabric at the window gives softness to an inherently hard and poorly insulative material. Fabric provides sound and temperature insulation, visual comfort, and interest

Drapery Hardware Much of the versatility possible in soft window coverings is due to the many kinds of hardware that have been developed, some of which are presented in Table 11.17. Many variations of each type are available through interior designers and window-treatment specialists.

Alternative Window Treatments Alternative materials are generally very durable and require little maintenance. They can be clean and contemporary or very traditional, crossing boundaries in many cases. They serve as versatile backgrounds and are often simple statements that will coordinate with many styles of furnishings. Some are moderately priced and offer

Wall, Ceiling, and Window Treatments

297

(A)

(B)

(C)

Figure 11.15 Many contemporary homes have windows with transoms that need window treatments for beauty, privacy, energy efficiency, light control, and operability. (A) The wall/window configuration is indicated to scale. (B) Operable draperies are designed in black and white, and (C) in color, ready for specification worksheets and workroom fabrication. Renderings by DreamDraper ® software

Figure 11.16 A fully executed window treatment with draperies on the lower windows and Vignette Modern Roman shades on both lower windows and upper transom windows. The shades are set within the window frame and offer flexibility in being raised from the top or bottom, assuring light control, privacy, and energy efficiency. Horizontal lines are handsome from both inside and outside. The custom-designed pleated draperies are nonoperable/stationary panels that give beauty and softness to this modified parallel furniture grouping. Photo courtesy of Hunter Douglas

both privacy and light control. Alternative treatments are presented in Table 11.19.

Contract Considerations Materials for contract walls, ceilings, and windows often differ from those used in the home. Materials generally must be different in three ways:

1. More durable—they should be able to withstand harder abuse from greater trafic and in less controlled situations. 2. Less patterned and more textured in appearance— contract materials are plain compared to the variety of decorative materials used in homes. 3. Flame-retardant, ire-resistant or ireproof, and staticand microorganism-resistant—they must meet state and local building codes for public safety.

298

Chapter 11

Table 11.13

Types of Draperies

Draw draperies are installed on a traverse (cord-operated) rod and may be pulled or drawn open and closed. Privacy draperies are installed under a transparent fabric or separated tiebacks to provide nighttime privacy or insulation. Sheer draperies include transparent and translucent fabrics, often placed next to the glass and historically called glass curtains.

Table 11.14

Casement draperies are draw draperies made of a woven or knit fabric with novelty yarns and a strong textural look. They are popular in contract settings, such as offices, and in casual settings at home. They screen light and cut down on glare but do not provide nighttime privacy.

Parisian pleat or inverted pleat draperies are installed on rings that slide along a designer rod.

Tieback draperies are ideally slender stationary panels that meet in the center on narrow windows or are separated on wider windows. They are tied back with fabric bands (ties) or metal holdbacks.

Types of Curtains

Cottage curtains are short lengths, shirred, and hung in informal style within or on the window frame. They may be tiered or layered. Café curtains cover the bottom half of the window.

Cottage curtains may also be simple tied back and shirred.

Priscilla curtains are ruffled cottage curtains that fill the window with a sheer, semisheer, or muslin fabric. They meet in the middle or crisscross.

Wall, Ceiling, and Window Treatments

299

Figure 11.17 Batiste semisheer fabric cottage curtains screen light and provide a pleasant contrast to the freestanding porcelain bathtub. They are as soft as a deep, relaxing bubble bath. Design by Hutker Architects/photo © Brian Vanden Brink

Table 11.14

Types of Curtains (continued)

Long or formal curtains are shirred (gathered) onto the rod and are nonoperational.

The standard ring-top panel is installed with rings that slide along the rod and attach to the curtain with metal clips or thread loops.

Sash curtains are sheer or semisheer fabrics shirred at the top and bottom and installed most often on casement windows and French doors so as to swing with the sash or door.

The grommet panel uses metal grommets, installed in the curtain fabric, to slide along the rod.

Tab curtains are flat panels with straps of fabric sewn to the top and looped over dowel rods—a simple, classic treatment.

The camisole panel uses narrow fabric straps to attach the curtain to the rod.

300

Chapter 11

Table 11.15

Fabric Window Shades

Waterfall Roman

London shades are constructed with inverted pleats that are nearly flat at the top and fall softly to form one or more swags. The fabric stacks in neat pleats when the shade is raised.

Balloon (pouf or cloud) shades are softly gathered to be billowy at the bottom, forming poufs or balloons. The top may be constructed in several ways including shirring, flat-box pleats, and French pleats.

Flat Roman

Pleated shades are factory-made products of stiffened fabric, plain or printed, that fold up in narrow accordion pleats. They may be translucent or opaque.

Cellular (honeycomb) shades are energy conscious, constructed in layers that fold in opposite directions to leave an insulating channel of air inside. They may have a single, double, or triple cell construction.

Relaxed Roman Roman shades are sewn in horizontal folds that stack when the shade is raised.

Wall, Ceiling, and Window Treatments

Table 11.16

301

Types of Top Treatments

Shirred valances are gathered at the top. They may have plain, shaped, or scalloped hems or may be gathered onto a bottom rod.

Flat inverted box pleat valances may be stiffened with an interlining. Many other styles of pleats can also be used to construct valances.

Shaped valances are made of fabric with a stiffened interlining. Their shape might carry out a theme, document a historic period, or echo forms found in other features of the room. Shown here is a shaped pleated valance.

Swags or festoons—half-round fabric treatments in overlapping arrangements—are the top treatment perhaps most used throughout history. Many widths, depths, and variations are possible. Cascades, falling from above or beneath the valance, are often added to frame swags or festoons.

Swagged scarf valances are made of simple lengths of fabric, looped through swag holders which come in a wide range of shapes, sizes, and styles.

Balloon tab valances or London valances are constructed of fabric that falls in a soft swag shape and is attached with tabs or straps.

Cornice

Tabbed relaxed swagged valances fall in soft folds, and are attached with fabric loops or tabs which slide along a designer rod.

Upholstered Cornice

Cornices are straight or shaped wooden or resin top treatments. When covered with padding and fabric, they are called upholstered cornices. When cornices extend down the sides to the floor or partway, they are called lambrequins or cantonnieres. When upholstered, these are energy efficient because they inhibit the exchange of cool and warm air at the window.

302

Chapter 11

Figure 11.18 A gently scalloped French Rococo-style valance frames and enhances this blue and white window seat area that overlooks the Atlantic Ocean. Bookcases and a barrel vaulted ceiling are strong architectural counterparts to the Palladian window, and the fabrics lend softness and romantic imagination to a fairy-tale setting. Design by John Morris Architects/photo © Brian Vanden Brink

Table 11.17

Types of Drapery Hardware (A)

(A)

(B) Conventional traverse rods are cord-operated rods with carriers to hold the drapery hooks. Conventional traverse rods come in single-hung (for one pair of draperies), in double-hung (for two sets of draperies), and with a plain curtain rod underneath or a curtain or valance rod on top. They also come in one-way draw for stacking draperies to one side.

(B)

(C) Curtain rods come in oval shapes. Some curtain rods are made with spring tension, so no brackets are necessary on an inside frame mount. Curtain rods also come in (B) round shapes or (C) with attached finials and may have rings to hold drapery hooks or clips to clip onto pleats or panels.

Wrought iron rods are available with finials styled to give a rustic or traditional look. There are dozens of styles available, and wrought iron can be custom designed.

Wall, Ceiling, and Window Treatments

Table 11.17

303

Types of Drapery Hardware (continued)

Decorator rods have special carriers that look like rings but operate as traverse (cord-operated) rods. They come in wood colors, white, antique, brass, chrome, black, and specialty finishes.

Wood rods come plain and fluted, and they may be stained or painted or covered with fabric or wallpaper. Curtains may be shirred onto wood rods, the fabric may be draped over in loose swag fashion, or the wood ring carriers may hold drapery hooks, which must be hand operated.

Bay and bow rods are available in nearly as many varieties as listed for conventional traverse and curtain rods. Motorized rods are for hard-to-reach draperies or large installations or simply for the convenience of pushing a button rather than drawing a cord or wand. Motorized systems are common in contract settings.

Tieback holder of braided rope and tassel.

Architectural rodding comes in several varieties, and each company has patented names for its products. Contract or architectural rods have sturdy ball-bearing carriers, and many of the styles are operated with a wand rather than a cord, which eliminates many problems of cord-operated rods in places such as hotels, offices, and institutions. Although components can be specified for any type of custom installation, contract rods are usually for flat panels or for less full draperies with few pleats.

Swag holders or metal tieback holders come in patterns such as decorative rosettes and as concealed (clear plastic placed under the drapery) holders.

304

Chapter 11

Table 11.18

Calculating Yardage for Window Treatments

For Curtains and Draperies 1. Determine rod width (end of rod to end of rod). 2. Add on for overlaps (for traverse draperies that meet in the center) and returns (around the corner to the wall), if applicable. A measure of 12 inches is standard for a single-hung layer, 16 inches for a double-hung layer, and 4 inches for an underlayer. 3. Divide by 20 inches to determine the number of widths or cuts (a typical 45- to 48-inch fabric will pleat or gather down to about 20 inches including side hems). 4. Determine the desired inished length (add 6 inches for puddling if desired); then add for hems, headings, and any rufles to determine the cut length. Hems are usually 4 inches doubled, or 8 inches. For pleated headings add 8 inches. Rufled headings will need 6 to 12 inches added depending on the depth of the rufle and the width of the rod. (Figure the inished length plus the rod pocket, the rufle, and another 2 inches for the self-lining and hem, which is turned under.) 5. Multiply the cut length by the number of widths or cuts to ind the total inches; then divide by 36 inches to yield the number of yards. Always round up. For pattern repeats, igure the number of complete pattern repeats needed for each cut; then multiply that number by the inches in one pattern; repeat for the total inches needed per cut. There will be waste in pattern-repeat fabrics because the pattern must start at the same point at the top of each cut. Yardage will be an average of 20 percent greater. 6. Costs for sewing, installation (charged by the width or foot), and the rods are additional.

For Balloon Shades 1. Determine inished width; then divide by 20 inches for the number of cuts or widths. 2. Add 6 to 8 inches for hems and headings; then add 20 inches for the pouf at the bottom. 3. Rufle yardage is igured in widthwise or lengthwise strips. Total inches of rufle needed will be multiplied by 2 or 3 (for desired fullness), and the depth of the rufle doubled plus 1 inch for self-lining. These dimensions are calculated or sketched out in scale into the width of the goods either widthwise or lengthwise. 4. Cost to sew is igured per square foot (rufles are extra, charged per linear foot), and fabrication costs are greater if the shade is operable. 5. Installation board and cost to install are priced per linear foot. Board may be included in cost of shade fabrication.

For Flat, Shaped, and Pleated Valances 1. Determine whether the width should run vertically in cuts or horizontally (railroaded) with no seams. Railroaded fabric may appear a different color than the curtain or shade beneath it because of the way the light hits the weave. 2. Determine the cuts or widths (if selected) as previously determined for curtains, eliminating the overlap but iguring in returns. Multiply the cuts by doubling the inished length for self-lining, plus 2 to 4 inches for seams, or multiply by the inished length plus 2 to 4 inches if lining fabric is used. Divide by 36 inches for yardage; then round up. Order the same quantity of lining fabric if the fabric is not to be self-lined. 3. Railroaded valances and curtains/draperies turn the width to run the lengthwise direction of the goods. Multiply the inished width by 2½ (or fullness desired) and divide by 36 inches for yardage. For valances, igure strips this way—i nished length—face only or self-lined measurement divided into the width of the goods.

For Swags and Cascades 1. Determine the number of swags or festoons by sketching them in the coniguration desired and determining the overlap and width of each swag. Measure for desired depth. 2. A self-lined swag up to 20 inches wide and 12 inches deep will need 1 to 11⁄2 yards each; a self-lined swag up to 40 inches wide and 24 inches deep will need 3 yards each. 3. Cascades and jabots need yardage equal to double their inished length. Costs to sew are determined by the workroom. Sewing on rufles or trimmings will cost extra (trimming yardage is 21⁄2 times the top of the swag); installation is per swag or cascade or per linear foot of installation board.

Wall, Ceiling, and Window Treatments

Table 11.19

305

Types of Alternative Window Treatments

Stained and art glass gives pattern, color, and interest to the glass. Patterns and privacy levels vary. Costly.

Two-inch metal or wood blinds are handsome and provide light control and privacy. Moderate cost.

Roller shades can be translucent or opaque, with the latter being energy efficient. Low to moderate cost.

Bamboo shades give a natural look as they screen glare and diffuse light. They offer no nighttime privacy. Modest cost.

Miniblinds control light and glare, give relative privacy, and are sleek. Inexpensive.

Vertical louvers are durable, can provide good light control, can offer privacy (when heavy or opaque), and can conserve energy. Moderate cost.

Figure 11.19 Bamboo shades with self-valances that hide the headrail controls operate by folding up Roman shade-style from the bottom to a desired level to expose a view and for a light-screening, natural effect in this breakfast nook. Photo courtesy of HGTV

Shoji screens provide light diffusion and the serenity of old Japan. They operate by sliding on tracks. Costly.

One-inch movable louver shutters shown here as double-hung, give light control, privacy, and the warmth of woods. Costly.

Plantation shutters have wide blades and have a permanent look to them. Costly.

306

Chapter 11

Figure 11.20 Duette® Architella® honeycomb shades are sleek, energy efficient, and handsome from inside and outside. Operational control of both top and bottom assures light/glare and privacy flexibility. Photo courtesy of Hunter Douglas

Figure 11.21 Pirouette® window shadings appear as soft shutters. These have an ingenious construction—a double layer of sheer polyester fabric with fused opaque fabric slats between that are adjustable from fully open, as seen here, to completely closed for privacy and light control. These shadings roll up into the headrail to fully expose the glass. This treatment assures both day and nighttime privacy and are excellent as stand-alone window coverings or for the privacy and glare control layer beneath decorative fabric treatments. Photo courtesy of Hunter Douglas

Durability Because of the durability requirement, permanent hard materials are often used in contract settings. It is not uncommon to see stone, tile, or brick used not only on the exterior but on the interior. This allows people to touch, bump, soil, or abrade the surface without worry that it will be damaged. Wall-covering materials are specially made to be durable for contract applications. For example, vinyl and fabric wall coverings can withstand a great deal of physical abuse, and many contract wall coverings have been tested and rated, so the architect or designer can match the durability rating to the trafic classiication required by code or building speciication: • Class I. Decorative wall coverings. • Class II. Decorative and serviceable wall coverings. Serviceability includes colorfastness (low) and washability. • Class III. Decorative wall coverings that have good serviceability. Serviceability includes colorfastness (low to moderate), washability, scrubbability, and resistance to abrasion, breaking, crocking, and staining. • Class IV. Wall coverings that are decorative with full serviceability, including colorfastness (low to moderate), washability, scrubbability, and resistance to abrasion, breaking, crocking, staining, and tearing. • Class V. Medium-commercial-serviceability wall coverings that include colorfastness (very good), washability, scrubbability, and resistance to abrasion, breaking, crocking, staining, tearing, heat aging, cracking, and shrinkage.

Wall, Ceiling, and Window Treatments

307

Figure 11.22 For centuries marble has been a preferred finish material in large public spaces, such as seen here in the Utah State Capitol building. Columns, walls, and floors are stone, a material that provides a sense of permanence and stability and one that will last through generations of heavy traffic. Photo by John Wang

• Class VI. Full-commercial-serviceability wall coverings that are the same as Class V coverings but have greater resistance to tearing. Contract wall coverings are classiied as either nonmildew resistant or mildew resistant. They may also need to meet ire code restrictions, and this makes the product selection somewhat different from that for residential wall coverings. The range of selections tends to be more textured and subtle, without the many changing designer patterns found in residential wall coverings. Contract wall coverings often are 52 to 54 inches wide and contain 30 square yards, dimensions that are more convenient and economical for large installations. However, this much weight is unwieldy and requires expert installation.

Contract Ceiling Treatments There are many materials and types of treatments used in contract interiors that are worth mentioning. These include acoustical ceilings in tile or larger panel sections, mounted in suspended grid systems and dropped to accommodate heating, ventilation, and air-conditioning

systems, lighting systems, communication systems, and ire-extinguishing systems within the plenum area. The ceiling must allow access to these systems in case of system or component breakdown. Ceilings may consist largely of indirect lighting; they may contain sofits for lighting or for accommodating the previously mentioned systems. The ceiling may be of glass, such as a solarium ceiling, in which case it must be safety glass.

Contract Window Treatments Window treatments for contract interiors must withstand operation from many different people who are unfamiliar with them. Therefore, mechanisms are usually engineered to be as trouble free as possible. Drapery rods without pull cords are often speciied. Draperies are often slid open and closed one panel at a time with a wand attached to the leading carrier. This not only prevents breakdowns that would occur in a cord-andpulley system but discourages the handling (and soiling/ damaging) of the fabric to ind the cords. Window-treatment materials must reduce glare for ofice use, a particularly important facet for those working at computer terminals (glare on the screen must be

308

Chapter 11

minimized or eliminated). Daytime privacy in working/ contract situations is also of prime importance. Therefore, alternative window treatments are used frequently. Of these, the most popular are miniblinds, vertical louvers, roller shades (opaque and ilm), and cellular shades. Casement draperies—generally an open-constructed cloth—are standard in ofices and situations where glare control and sound control are required. Window treatments may also be required to provide any or all of the following six energy conservation functions:

have coordinated or matching draperies and bedspreads; hospitals and clinics may have patterned draperies in patient rooms and sometimes as cubicle curtains. These are inished with soil- and stain-resistant treatments. Patterns are good choices where the fabric will be handled, since patterns will not readily show soil and will hide wear better than plain fabrics (unless, of course, the patterns fade from sunlight, which makes them look wornout prematurely).

1. 2. 3. 4.

Less Pattern

Allow winter solar heat gain. Allow daylighting all year. Relect summer solar heat gain and control glare. “Seal” the window from the room air when mechanical heating and air-conditioning are operating. 5. Insulate against heat and cold extremes. 6. Allow for natural ventilation during temperate weather. Nighttime privacy is a need in some installations, requiring a hard treatment that can close fully or a fabric that is lined, opaque, or a combination of hard and soft materials—such as a casement fabric over a blind or shade. Printed fabrics are sometimes used in hospitality and medical facilities. Hotels, for example, will often

Figure 11.23 In the upper level of this modern structural building, automated roll-down solar shades protect a gallery display and seating areas from the potential harm of UV light and discomfort of excessive glare or heat gain. Photo © Kathryn Taylor

Most materials used in contract installations do not include much pattern. Rather, texture is seen for nearly every surface installation. Hard materials (stone, brick, tile, concrete) often have natural patterns that read as texture and cannot be removed. Where plaster is used, it is often textured as well. Flexible wall coverings are frequently given textures that imitate natural materials such as grass cloth, leather, suede, or marble. Fabric wall coverings can be amazingly durable as well as handsome. Natural linen and wool coverings are ine-quality examples of beauty combined with durability. Artiicial ibers can also make tough, good-looking wall-covering fabrics and are often used in wall partitions or dividers in open ofice planning where they serve to absorb sound. Acoustical ceiling tiles, likewise, have texture and very subtle pattern, as do other ceiling panel materials—metal or fabric, for example. Textures show less soil and wear and will last longer under use and abuse than will plain fabrics. Whereas patterned fabrics and wall coverings soon become dated and the color schemes last only a few years, textured fabrics do not go out of style as quickly. This is important in contract settings where the design scheme may not be changed for many years.

Safety Codes Safety codes are laws that ensure the safety of the occupants in public spaces. Codes routinely govern ire safety, static resistance, and protection against microorganism and bacteria growth. The architect or designer must ind materials that meet building codes or written building speciications. These materials have been tested and rated for their resistance to ire, static, and microorganisms. Most materials will have been tested in most of these areas, and the information will be written on the samples (part of product speciications) or available from the manufacturer. The documentation of these ratings is of prime importance in designer liability. Fire safety is obviously the most crucial of these standards. The material should also have been tested for smoke density and for the emission of toxic or poisonous gases while burning or smoldering. Flammability terms are presented under “Contract Considerations” in Chapter 13.

Chapter 12 Floor Materials and Coverings Flooring Requirements and Specifications 310 Guidelines for Selecting Hard and Resilient Floor Materials 310 Soft Floor Coverings 315 Contract Considerations 330

Photo © Brian Vanden Brink

310

Chapter 12

Floor Requirements and Specifications

• Sheet vinyl and carpeting are calculated per square yard and cost less than most hard materials, though they are less durable.

Floor coverings are a major element in an interior and deserve careful consideration as they are often permanent or long lived. The criteria that determine the choice include:

To ind the square footage, multiply the room’s width by its length (in feet). Divide this igure by 9 to ind the square yardage (9 square feet in 1 square yard). Because roll goods (vinyl and carpet) must be installed all in the same direction with no quarter turns, roll goods are “plotted” on a loor plan to determine exact widths and cuts (vinyl is usually 6 feet wide; carpet, 12 feet wide). Each cut (width) is multiplied by its length and then divided to determine the yardage to be ordered. Installation costs for stone and tile are high and igured per square foot according to the charges of the installer ($6 or more per square foot—pr/sq/ft). Wood installation is also costly and is charged by the square foot ($4 or more pr/sq/ft). Wood may need professional inishing (acrylic or polyurethane), and brick may need a sealant. Carpet costs are igured per square yard and generally include pad or underlay and installation (using the tackless strip method or the direct glue-down method) at $8 and up. Flooring materials are divided into three categories— hard (nonresilient), resilient, and soft. Nonresilient flooring materials include brick, concrete, stone, tile, and wood. Resilient looring materials are asphalt tile, cork, fabric, leather, linoleum, rubber, and vinyl. Soft loor coverings include wall-to-wall carpeting and a wide selection of area rugs.

• The durability required. High-trafic areas must have loors of high durability. • Cost of materials, installation, and maintenance in terms of time, effort, and expenses. • Aesthetic considerations, such as establishing a particular architectural style. • The necessity of acoustic noise control. • Applicable insulative and solar absorption or relection needs. • Fire or building codes that must be met.

Calculations and Costs Floor materials are calculated and priced per square foot or square yard: • Hard materials such as stone, wood, wood combined with another material, and some tiles are calculated per square foot and are costly, although they are also very durable.

Figure 12.1 Ceramic tile is a durable flooring in this entryway. Photo: Montana/Sage Brush/Photo courtesy of Mohawk Industries

Guidelines for Selecting Hard and Resilient Floor Materials Hard and resilient loor materials form a substantial part of the character of an interior. The integrity of looring is so important that it is impossible to create successful interiors if the looring appears to be cheap, a poor imitation, or of poor design or quality. Flooring is not only a background but also a material that will provide years of satisfaction in terms of beauty, durability, and upkeep. With that in mind, it is wise to select looring according to the following criteria: • Beauty means good design merit and integrity. Flooring should be appealing even if there were no other furnishings in the interior. • Harmony as a background for a variety of furnishing styles over time. Look for neutralized colors, subtle textures, and lack of a deinite pattern. • Graceful aging in the form of a patina, or mellowing of the inish through continued use. Permanent looring is often in place for 10 or 20 years, and many historic interiors that have stood the test of time feature

Floor Materials and Coverings











hard materials that have lasted and continued to be beautiful for a century or more. Subfloor preparation supports and enhances the inishing material. Thin resilient loors such as vinyl require a smooth subloor, or irregularities will show through the inish looring. Heavy materials such as stone, tile, or brick require a sturdy subloor, which will raise the loor level. Life-cycle costing is the total cost divided by the number of years of expected use. Surprisingly, more costly products often have a lower life-cycle cost because they don’t require replacing. Upkeep means maintenance frequency and ease of cleaning. Hard looring materials generally require less care than resilient ones. Surfaces with grooves or indentations tend to trap dirt. Natural materials are superior at camoulaging tracked-in soil. Durability is the ability to withstand trafic. Particularly in high-trafic areas, avoid looring materials that are vulnerable to wear. Safety. Smooth hard resilient loorings without added texture are slippery, especially when wet. To avoid accidents due to visual confusion, looring should avoid glare, three-dimensional patterns, or abrupt pattern changes that would create a depth illusion. Strollers, wheelchairs, and walkers operate best on looring with a medium texture; avoid extremes of rugged textures (including deep carpet pile) or highly polished smooth hard materials.

Hard Floor Materials Hard loor materials, such as brick, concrete, stone, and tile, have several advantages. Tables 12.1 through 12.3 describe types of nonresilient looring. Generally these materials have the following characteristics: • Strong and durable • Nonabsorbent and relatively impervious to soiling and staining • Easy to maintain and clean • Timeless—”classics” with aesthetic appeal that lasts indeinitely • Versatile—adaptable for use in formal or informal, structural or decorative, textured or patterned interiors • Able to serve as structure as well as inish materials Disadvantages of hard materials include the following:

311

• High initial cost—although the life-cycle cost is often comparatively low. • Subloor preparation. • Rigidity—a hazard for objects (and people) that may fall on the hard surface. • Chilliness—hard materials tend to be cold to the touch unless heated artiicially or by sunshine. • Acoustic “liveness”—being nonporous, hard materials relect sound and amplify noise. This effect is often mitigated by using hard materials as a background for softer, sound-absorbing area rugs.

Figure 12.2 Flagstone has been selected as the floor material in this custom-designed bathroom. The wall stone is installed in the ashlar configuration. Designer: Siri Evju, CKD, CBD; Siri Designs/ Photography: Steve Taque/NKBA Design Competition

312

Chapter 12

Table 12.1

Stone Flooring

Exposed Aggregate Description. Aggregate (smooth rocks or small pebbles) set or rolled into wet concrete. Part of the concrete is hosed off before it dries in order to expose the aggregate. Also called pebble tile or pebble concrete. Applications. Interior and exterior paving. Residential and contract. Maintenance. When sealed with a polyurethane or another inish, exposed aggregate has very low upkeep. Brush vacuum. Cost structure. Moderate to high.

Exposed aggregate

Flagstone Description. Flagging describes exterior or interior paving: bluestone, quartzite, sandstone, and slate. Shape can be regular or irregular and surface will be fairly uniform. Applications. Residential and contract. Maintenance. Little upkeep: Sweep, vacuum, or damp mop if necessary. Cost structure. High. Flagstone

Granite Description. A very hard crystalline rock with small amounts of feldspar, quartz, and other minerals in crystal or grain form. Crystals vary from very i ne to fairly coarse. The colors vary from light to dark values and variations of gray, pink, green, brown, and black. May be rough-hewn or smooth and polished. Applications. Floors and countertops; used in high-end residential and contract settings. Maintenance. Low upkeep: Wipe, sweep, vacuum, or damp mop if necessary. Use very mild detergent and remove soap residue. Polish with cloths. Cost structure. High.

Granite

Limestone Description. A calcite (calcium carbonate) stone with a light-grayish neutralized color. It has little to no grain, with a typically matte or dull inish. Applications. Residential and contract looring in high-trafic areas. Fireplace surrounds and mantelpieces. Maintenance. Sweep, vacuum, or damp mop with clear lukewarm water. Cost structure. High.

Limestone

Marble and Terrazzo Description. A metamorphic stone, granular or crystalline, white or colored, often with streaks. The hardest and typically the most expensive of the stones. May be cut into thin sheets or slabs. Can be polished to a high sheen. Cold to the touch. Terrazzo is a composite looring of broken chips of marble set into cement and polished to a sheen. May be tiles or poured as a solid loor. This is a practical use of marble, since up to 50 percent waste occurs from breakage at the quarry. Applications. Floors, ireplace hearths. High-end residential and contract installations. Maintenance. Clean with warm water and infrequently with soap and water, taking care to rinse well; soap residue will render the loor slippery. Cost structure. High.

Marble parquet

Terrazzo

Floor Materials and Coverings

Table 12.1

313

Stone Flooring (continued)

Slate Description. A metamorphic, inely grained rock that cleaves or splits naturally into layers. Slabs are ½- to 1-inch thick. The surface may be (1) fairly rough (if it is a natural cleft or split); (2) rubbed with sand to achieve an even plane; or (3) honed, producing a smooth i nish with a patina or mellow glow. Colors vary from grays to greenish or reddish grays to blacks and browns. Applications. Residential and contract settings. Maintenance. Low upkeep: Sweep, vacuum, clean with mild soap and water. Do not wax. Cost structure. Moderate to high.

Slate

Travertine Description. A light-colored limestone rock formed near mineral springs. Trapped gas in the stone causes holes and interesting textures. When used as looring, the holes are illed with cement or epoxy. Applications. Residential and contract. Floors, stair treads, ireplace hearths. Maintenance. Vacuum, wash when necessary with clear lukewarm water. Wash no more often than every six months with soap and water and rinse thoroughly to prevent a slippery surface. Cost structure. High. Travertine

Table 12.2

Tile, Brick, and Concrete Flooring

Ceramic Tile Description. Fine, white clays formed and glazed before the irst or second iring. Shiny or smooth to patterned to rough and matte (dull). Mosaic tiles are small tiles set into a pattern; may be preset sheets, a face mount or back mount, ready to be set with grout. Applications. Contract and residential. Entryways, bathrooms/restrooms, kitchens, solariums, high-trafic areas, countertops. Maintenance. Low upkeep: Sweep, vacuum, wipe, damp mop, or soap and water for heavy dirt. Grout may soil and discolor. Silicone treatments will make grout less susceptible to soil. Cost structure. Low to high—with moderate to high installation. Ceramic tile

Mosaic tile

Mexican Tile Description. Hand-shaped clay taken from the ground and left to set before iring. Imperfections of hand labor add to the tiles’ charm. Thick, fragile, rustic. Tiles may be decorated and glazed. Applications. Large squares are used in residential and contract settings. Maintenance. Porous surface should be treated with linseed oil or paste wax. Sweep, dust mop, wax, and buff. Rewax or reoil when tile shows signs of wear. Cost structure. Low to moderate, plus installation.

Quarry Tile

Mexican tile

Description. Fine-colored clay and graded shale. Most is a terra-cotta rust/red, the color of the natural clay. It may be glazed but usually is left natural. Square or hexagonal shapes are most popular. Applications. Residential and contract looring and countertops. Maintenance. Same as for ceramic tile. Cost structure. Low to moderate, plus installation.

Quarry tile

(continued)

314

Chapter 12

Table 12.2

Tile, Brick, and Concrete Flooring (continued)

Brick Description. Clay, shale, and water mixed, colored, and shaped into solid or hollow rectangular blocks and then ired to harden. Solid bricks for looring are ¾-inch to 2 inches thick and are referred to as pavers. Applications. Interior and exterior loors and patio paving, residential and contract. Maintenance. Low upkeep: Sweep, dust, vacuum, damp mop, or buff. Cost structure. Moderate to high.

Brick

Concrete Description. Portland cement, sand, gravel or rock aggregate, and water mixed and poured into forms or slabs, texturized. Hardens as it sets. Naturally gray but may be colored. Applications. Subloors and loors may be cast or stamped into shapes. Contract looring. May be both structural element and inish material. Sealed, textured concrete is used for custom countertops. Maintenance. Raw concrete absorbs stains and generates dust; painted or sealed concrete is impervious to stains as long as the paint or inish remains intact. Sweep, damp mop, or hose off where possible. Sealed countertops: Use mild detergent; wipe as customary. Cost structure. Moderate.

Table 12.3

Concrete

Wood and Laminate Flooring

Wood Planks and Parquet Description. Oak, maple, cherry, teak, or pine strips range from 1½ to 2¼ inches wide and 2 to 7 feet in length. Random-plank widths range from 3 to 8 inches, typically installed in three varying sizes. Strips and random plank are tongue and groove to it snugly together. Parquet is strips or squares set into shapes. Applications. Residential and contract looring. Solid wood may come prei nished or may be impregnated with stain and acrylic for a durable contract surface. Maintenance. Depends on the inish: Oiled or waxed wood will need protection against moisture, require dust mopping frequently, and need rewaxing. Two inishes used frequently today are polyurethane and acrylic. These require only sweeping, dust mopping, or vacuuming and occasionally damp mopping with a water-vinegar solution. Hard (liquid) wax can be used on top. Cost structure. Moderate to high.

Basketweave parquet

Basketweave/octagonal parquet

Random plank

Herringbone parquet

Floor Materials and Coverings

Table 12.3

315

Wood and Laminate Flooring (continued)

Bamboo Flooring Description. Bamboo looring is a rapidly renewable resource made from hollow round shoots of the bamboo Asian grass plant that matures in three years, regenerates without need for replanting, and requires minimal fertilization or pesticides. Although it is not wood, bamboo looring is categorized with hardwood looring. Bamboo is attractive because it is very hard, strong, and dimensionally stable. Bamboo loors provide a very rich visual texture, with thin strips of varying color interrupted by the bamboo nodes. It installs similar to standard hardwood looring. Applications. Residential and contract looring where green products are desirable. Maintenance. Comparable to wood looring. Cost structure. Slightly more expensive than looring from domestic hardwoods. Bamboo

Laminate Description. Wood particleboard with a hard, durable composite vinyl layer laminated (glued under heat and pressure) to bond to the wood core. Applications. Imitation-wood loor planks and parquet; countertops. Flooring for residential or lower trafic areas of contract interiors. Maintenance. Dust mop, sweep, or damp mop. Countertops: Wipe with cloths or nonabrasive scrubbers and cleaning preparations as needed. Cost structure. Moderate.

Figure 12.3 Long-lived wood laminate parquet is handsome, easy to maintain, and can be installed professionally or as a skilled do-it-yourself (DIY) project. Photo courtesy of Mohawk Industries

Resilient Floor Materials Resilient materials have lexibility, or give. These include cork, fabric, leather, rubber, and most vinyls (Table 12.4). Like hard materials, resilient loor materials have common sets of advantages and disadvantages. The advantages of resilient looring are as follows: • Initial cost is generally lower than that for hard materials. • Resilient loor materials are warmer to the touch. • By absorbing more sound, they produce quieter, more comforting interiors. • They are easier on the body for standing and thereby produce less fatigue. • Items dropped are less likely to break, and less damage is done to the loor itself because of its ability to give (resilience). • There is a wide variety of designs or patterns, colors, and even visual textures (particularly in the vinyl looring types). • The maintenance is moderate, depending on the inish and the durability of the inish.

Disadvantages of resilient looring include the following: • They may require more maintenance and cleaning if the surface has no protection or as a no-wax surface treatment wears off. • Resilient loors can be damaged, dented, or torn by dropping sharp objects such as kitchen knives or by dragging furniture or appliances across the surface. • Resilient loorings are less durable than hard loor materials, making them a costly choice in the long run due to the necessity of replacement. • If poorly installed, seams will open and become worn.

Soft Floor Coverings Carpeting Carpet, particularly wall-to-wall installed carpet, has become a standard item in interior design. The use and placement of broadloom carpet (12 feet wide on average) is restricted only by the aesthetic and maintenance requirements of the room. Carpets are made in many ibers

316

Chapter 12

Table 12.4

Resilient Floor Materials

Cork Description. The outer layer of cork of the cork oak tree, a broadleaf evergreen that grows in the Mediterranean region. Light in color, elastic, insulative, and sound absorbent. Usually treated with a vinyl coating or impregnation, removing some of its resilience but making it a more durable product. Applications. Residential and contract settings where a quiet surface is required for low or limited trafic. Maintenance. Vinyl-cork loors may be damp mopped or buffed. They tend to show dust and footprints easily. Cost structure. Moderate to high.

Leather Description. Squares or tiles of leather, the tanned hide of cattle and swine. Dyed brown or other colors. Embossed with patterns historically. Leather may be cut into strips and made into shag-type area rugs. Applications. High-end residential in small, low-trafic areas. Quiet looring. Maintenance. Damp mop with very mild detergent; no saddle soap. Cost structure. Very high.

Linoleum Description. A mixture of oxidized linseed oil, ground cork and wood, color pigments, and gums, poured onto a backing of canvas, burlap, or jute. Linoleum is a highly durable, ecologically friendly substance. Unlike vinyl, it does not release PVCs into the air. It can last 50 years and more and still be an excellent looring. In fact, it continues to become more durable after installation due to the oxidation of the linseed oil. This smooth and washable looring is primarily produced in Europe. Application. Residential and some contract.

Figure 12.4 Resilient sheet flooring provides graphic design and relative warmth and quiet in the Portland, Maine, Children’s Museum. Stephen Blatt Architects/photo © Brian Vanden Brink

Maintenance. Damp mop, sweep, vacuum. Polish/wax products are optional. Cost structure. Moderate.

Rubber Description. Tiles made of butadiene styrene rubber and synthetic materials come in two forms: a lat surface with a marbleized pattern and with raised discs or squares—a solid-colored threedimensional surface. The latter was designed to knock dirt off shoes and to provide water drainage off the surface. Applications. Primarily contract looring. Maintenance. Sweep or vacuum. May be washed with detergent and water. Rinsed and mopped with a water and 5 percent liquid bleach solution. Buff for shine return. New loors require more bufing. Cost structure. Moderately high.

Vinyl Description. Vinyl is a shortened name for polyvinyl chloride (or PVC), a plastic solution that hardens to a solid ilm. Many materials may be coated with vinyl, such as cork and fabric.

Vinyl Composition Description. A blended composition of vinyl, resin, plasticizer, and coloring agents formed into sheets under pressure and heat. Sheets or tiles. Vinyl is also called resilient sheet looring. Applications. Both residential and contract settings, primarily health care, as it is an even, solid surface that can be kept clean. Maintenance. Sweep, vacuum, damp mop; detergent. May be waxed. Cost structure. Moderate to moderately high. (continued)

Floor Materials and Coverings

Table 12.4

317

Resilient Floor Materials (continued)

Sheet Vinyl Description. Vinyl resilient sheet looring comes in 6-, 9-, and 12foot widths. There are two kinds of sheet vinyl. One is a solid or inlaid vinyl, built up with successive layers of vinyl granules that are usually plain or patterned with a suggestion of texture. The other type, called rotogravure or roto, is a printed pattern. The surface is coated with vinyl or vinyl/urethane (a thinner layer), called the wear layer. Both types of vinyl may or may not have a cushioned backing. Applications. Flooring, both residential and contract. Contract vinyls are thicker or have a thicker wear layer. Maintenance. Most sheet vinyl is given a no-wax surface to help maintain a shiny surface. However, heavy trafic, furniture movement, and detergents may remove the shine. Damp mopping with a water and vinegar solution will help keep the shine. Vinyl loors may be waxed. Cost structure. Moderate to moderately high.

able in solid colors, plus patterns such as marble, travertine, slate, brick, and stone. Some vinyl tiles may have a wood veneer sealed between layers. Applications. Flooring, both residential and contract. Maintenance. Sweep, vacuum, damp mop (as for sheet vinyl) without detergents, which can dull the i nish. Cost structure. Moderately low.

Vinyl Tile Description. Solid vinyl is composed of PVC, plasticizers, pigments or coloring agents, mineral illers, and stabilizers. Avail-

Vinyl resilient sheet flooring

and in a wide selection of colors, textures, and prices. The quality of the carpet and how well it will wear can be dificult to determine when examining the store sample. The small size of most carpet samples also makes it hard to visualize the effect of an entire area covered in that carpet. The following guidelines may be helpful: • Understand the ibers used in carpeting (Table 12.5) and the advantages and disadvantages of each. • Learn carpet constructions and the selection of textures available. • Look for guarantees against laws (holes, streaks, color variations) or after-installation problems (such as fading, premature crushing, or pile loss). • Purchase locally from carpet dealers known for business integrity, quality installation, and service. • Compare quality. Poor-quality, inexpensive carpets can appear similar to moderately priced carpets yet have inferior-quality yarns, less latex glue to hold the primary and secondary backing together (see “Tufted Broadloom Carpets”), and other compromises not immediately apparent. These carpets will wear out faster and need replacing much sooner, thereby costing more than a good-quality carpet. • Ask for recommendations from sales personnel for carpets that will stand up to wear and trafic. See if there is a written guarantee of quality and durability. • Determine quality with hand tests. Bend back the face of a tufted carpet to reveal the primary backing. This







• •

is called making the carpet “grin.” If a lot of primary backing is exposed, the tufts are not close together and the carpet will likely mat or crush under trafic. When close together or dense, the carpet will have better resilience. Also try untwisting the pile to see if it may become fuzzy, and pull the pile to determine if the face will lose ibers. Take the carpet sample to the site where it will be installed. Evaluate color during different times of the day and at night with artiicial light, and walk on it to determine whether it will show footprints or crush easily. Drop thread or other debris on the surface and evaluate whether it will readily show soil. Select color wisely. For a heavy-trafic area, select a color medium in value (not too light or too dark) and low in intensity (fairly dull). This will hide the shadows and soiling caused by foot trafic. Patterned carpet will increase the life span of a carpet under heavy use because pattern can effectively hide both soil and wear. Compare the carpet’s life span to its aesthetics. A vivid or demanding color may prove tiresome sooner than would a more neutralized carpet. Neutrals and neutralized colors are lexible for redecorating, which may take place several times during the life span of a carpet. Select a quality padding or underlay, and check to see that the padding delivered to the site is the one you selected. The quality of installation may determine how the carpet looks, lays, and performs. Insist on the most

318

Chapter 12

(A) Figure 12.5 (A and B) Smart Strand® carpet contains 37 percent DuPont™ Sorona®, whose key ingredient is Bio-PDO®, made of the renewably sourced polymer, corn sugar. This qualifies as a “green” carpet. The luxuriously soft SmartStrand® with DuPont™ Sorona® has superior stain resistance engineered into the fiber that will never wear or wash off. Even tough stains are removed with warm water and mild detergent. This represents a new generation of beautiful, sustainable, and cleanable carpeting. Photos courtesy of Mohawk Industries (B)

Figure 12.6 Axminster carpeting is especially useful in hospitality contract settings such as this restaurant, where it hides soiling and wear while giving life, color, and pattern to an otherwise understated interior. Copyrighted and registered, Soroush Custom Rugs and Axminster Carpet, www.soroush.us

highly skilled carpet installers that can be hired in your vicinity. • Upgrade carpeting to a better quality than the standard allotment for carpet in new construction. Lower-quality carpeting costs more in the long run because it will wear out quickly and require replacement and labor to remove and install.

Carpet Fibers Most carpets are constructed of a single iber, such as nylon. However, there are an increasing number of carpets made of blended ibers, such as 65 percent wool and 35 percent acrylic, or 80 percent nylon and 20 percent wool or polyester. These and other blends are popular for three reasons: 1. A blend has the positive qualities of each iber; it is durable and may be pleasing to the touch. 2. A more costly iber can be extended with the combination of less expensive ibers. 3. Cross-dyeing effects can be obtained by coloring the yarn with a single dyestuff— the two different ibers take the dye differently, creating a two-tone effect.

Floor Materials and Coverings

Table 12.5

319

Carpet Fibers Comparison

Wool

Olefin/Polypropylene

Source. Wool is the iber taken from domesticated sheep. It varies from very i ne to very coarse, as well as varying in length. Shorter staple lengths are used in lesser-quality and longer staple lengths in higher-quality wool carpets. Wool may be dyed any color or left in natural white, cream, brown, or gray, as are berber carpets. Advantages. Long a standard of comparison as a durable carpet iber, wool is resilient due to its overlapping scale, giving it long life and resistance to crushing. It takes dyes beautifully and is woven and tufted into carpets of high quality. It is used in pile for Oriental, folk, and designer rugs. Disadvantages. Wool carpets must be treated for moth resistance. When wet, wool emits a distinctive animal smell. Some people are allergic to wool. It is susceptible to fuzzing (ibers working loose) and pilling (ibers working into small balls or pills). Wool is the most costly of the carpet ibers. Maintenance. Wool should be vacuumed regularly and spots cleaned immediately. Wool takes a long time to dry but may be wet cleaned. Professional dry-cleaning methods are recommended. Avoid scrubbing brushes that could untwist the pile or encourage pilling. Cost structure. High.

Source. Olein and polypropylene carpets are made of ethylene or propane gas constituted into a synthetic long-chain polymer. Polypropylenes are modiied oleins. Advantages. Olein is lightweight, inexpensive, durable, and strong. It resists fuzzing, pilling, and abrasion. Used for indoor and outdoor carpeting, contract carpeting, and carpet tiles. Also used for artiicial turf. Disadvantages. Olein is less soft to the touch. Must be treated for resistance to sunlight fading and deterioration. Tends to crush, pill, and stain. Less durable than nylon. Maintenance. Vacuum regularly. Cleans well; is unaffected by moisture and most chemicals and acids. Cost structure. Low to moderate.

Nylon Source. A manufactured synthetic based on the raw materials phenol, hydrogen, oxygen, and nitrogen. Nylon is heated into a solution and then extruded into long threads that may be texturized and cut into staple (short ibers) to meet requirements of the many textures found in nylon carpet. Advantages. Nylon is the most widely used carpet iber, accounting for over 90 percent of all carpeting sold alone or combined with other ibers. A lexible iber used for level-loop carpets and cut piles, both tufted and woven, and used often for accent or scatter rugs. Nylon is strong, durable, resilient, and abrasion resistant, has good color retention, hides dirt, and has excellent bulk. There is a minimum of fuzzing and pilling; it is nonallergenic and mildew and insect resistant. It also has good lame resistance. Disadvantages. First- and second-generation (chemical composition) nylons are prone to static electricity and have a harsh sheen and unpleasant touch. However, these weaknesses have been overcome. Fifth-generation nylons are guaranteed against stains and soiling. However, there are many quality levels of nylon, and some of these problems may still exist. Maintenance. Nylon cleans exceptionally well. It should be vacuumed regularly and spot cleaned as needed. Both steam, or wet, and dry, or chemical, cleaning are effective. Accent or scatter rugs may be machine washed and dried. Cost structure. Moderate.

Polyester Source. Polyester is a synthetic long-chain polymer derived from a reaction between dicarboxylic acid and dihydric alcohol. Advantages. Polyester takes and holds dyes well. Next to acrylic, it most closely resembles wool because of its dyeability and softness. Polyester is mildew and moth resistant, nonallergenic, and nonabsorbent. It is a durable iber that resists fuzzing and pilling. Polyester is soft and cool to the touch. Disadvantages. Polyester crushes easily and must be heat-set to maintain yarn twist. Heat-set polyesters are good selections for residential areas with light trafic. Polyester lacks warmth and tends to hold oil-borne stains. Cost structure. Moderate to moderately high, depending on the quality of the iber.

Acrylic Source. Acrylic is a synthetic iber composed mainly of acrylonitrile and can be texturized and cut into staple ibers and spun into a bulky yarn. Advantages. Acrylic is the iber that is most similar to wool. It looks like wool, so it is often combined with wool to lower the cost. It is soft and warm to the touch. Acrylic is often used to imitate wool berber carpet. Disadvantages. Acrylic has low resilience, mats easily, and fuzzes and pills. It has a relatively short life span compared to wool or nylon, but its life span increases dramatically when blended with either of these two ibers. Acrylic is vulnerable to oil-borne stains, which are dificult to remove. Maintenance. Acrylic responds well to wet cleaning, but care must be taken to avoid brushing and untwisting the ibers, as they will mat down and pill more easily when they have been loosened. Vacuum regularly and remove spots immediately. Cost structure. Moderate.

320

Chapter 12

Table 12.5 lists carpet ibers and their sources, advantages and disadvantages, maintenance requirements, and cost structures. There are many quality levels of each of these ibers, both natural and synthetic. Higher-quality ibers make the carpet perform better and last longer, but they cost more per square yard.

Woven Broadloom Carpet Broadloom carpets are woven or tufted by machine and are typically 12 feet wide. • A Wilton carpet is woven on the Jacquard loom. It allows complex patterns to be constructed, and each color is carried as a separate weft or bank of yarns beneath the face of the design, making Wilton carpets heavy and substantial. Wiltons are nearly always of quality wool and are very costly. They are seen most often in exclusive areas of contract interior design. • Axminster carpets are also Jacquard woven but without the extra warps. Only the colors needed are inserted, making complex patterns possible without great expense. Axminster carpets are of wool or nylon and are seen in many kinds of contract settings such as restaurants, theaters, retail businesses, and hotels. Axminster carpets are readily adaptable to custom design, and in cases where they are still cost prohibitive, carpeting can be printed to imitate the design. • Velvet weave carpets are also woven but without any design. They may be solid or woven of variegated yarn, usually of wool or a wool and nylon blend.

iber-punching machine. They are inexpensive and durable and come in yardage and square tiles with or without a latex backing. They may be installed over a pad or glued down directly.

Carpet Textures Carpet texture means the pile surface. Yarns are cut or looped, ine or bulky, one level or multilevel: • Cut-pile surfaces are sheared to one height or multilevel. This term encompasses all textures that are not loop textures.

Figure 12.7 (A) Cut-pile broadloom carpet texture.

• Plush carpets are cut pile, densely tufted (close together) and with a short pile. Residential plush carpeting is typically one solid color; it tends to show trafic and vacuum marks, which emphasize the plush quality that imitates the density of Oriental rugs. Contract plush carpeting can also be two-tone or subtle patterns, which hide wear.

Tufted Broadloom Carpets Tufted carpets make up the majority of carpets today. They are constructed on a loom that employs multiple needles threaded with the yarn. The carpet yarn is punched into the primary backing in a zigzag pattern, which holds the yarn in place in case of a loose tuft that is pulled. The tufts are held securely with a latex coating (rubber-based glue) that also holds on a secondary backing of polypropylene. Some tufted carpets have no secondary backing, and custom hand-tufted area rugs have a layer of latex to which is afixed a loosely woven scrim textile that adds some stability to the construction. Rubber-backed tufted carpets are tufted into a thick rubber-cushioned backing and directly glued to the surface. Fuse-bonded carpets (such as artiicial turf) are tufted into a heavy layer of latex and are also directly glued down without padding. There are many levels of quality in the construction of tufted carpets.

Other Carpet Constructions • Knitted carpets are constructed of knitted yarns held together with a latex backing. They account for very few carpets on the market. • Needlepunch carpets are masses of ibers (rather than yarns) that are held together by an interlocking

Figure 12.7 (B) Plush carpet texture.

• Frieze (fri-zay’) yarns are tightly twisted, for greater resilience. Many residential frieze carpets are slightly two-toned and referred to as “trackless” since they hide dirt and footprints. Frieze is physically and visually a durable carpet texture.

Figure 12.7 (C) Frieze carpet texture.

• Sculptured multilevel textures consist of various levels of cut pile or of loops (also called multiloop or embossed loop). They may also be tufted of variegated yarn (colors vary), producing a type of random pattern. Deep sculpturing of cut pile, seen in some residential carpeting, can weaken the resilience, whereas tightly tufted carpet with understated sculpturing (contract) can be very strong and resilient.

Floor Materials and Coverings

321

• Averting potentially dangerous ripples, which are a hazard in high-trafic and especially contract installations • Saving the expense of the pad, tackless strip, and labor to install two layers • Doing installations where no softness is required Figure 12.7 (D) Sculptured loop texture (left) and sculptured cut-pile texture (right).

• Deep-pile or shag carpets have returned to the residential market. Quality deep-pile carpets are tufted tightly and are both durable and luxurious. They are an “upgrade” carpet, costing more than a typical cutpile carpet.

Figure 12.7 (E) Deep-pile or shag carpet texture.

• Level loop, also called round-wire construction, is the most common short-pile contract carpeting. Yarns are looped over wires for uniformity and then the wires are removed. Level-loop textures are strong, durable, and resilient but not soft to the touch.

Figure 12.7 (F) Level loop or round-wire construction carpet texture.

Pad and tackless strip uses a pad attached to a thin board with tacks that protrude toward the wall. The pad is stapled, nailed, or glued down. Using equipment that stretches the carpet, the installer hooks the carpet over the tacks and then pounds the tacks into the carpet. The padding for this method is available in several types, listed here in order of popularity: • Urethane foam is made from synthetic polymers in varying thicknesses. It may be formed to be extra dense. • Chopped urethane, or rebond, is bonded into sheets with additives such as paper, vinyl, fabric-backed foam, or wood chips. This factor makes bonded foam subject to various quality levels. • Foam rubber pads are irm, lat sheets made from natural or synthetic rubbers. They are suitable for medium trafic. • Sponge rubber pads combine natural and synthetic rubber and illers to form a lat or a wafle sponge, suitable for light to medium trafic. With age and wear, rubber will disintegrate. • Felt padding was originally animal hair. Though animalhair felt padding is now rare, a combination felt padding made of some animal hair and some synthetic ibers is more common, while iber felt padding is all synthetic. Felt is irmer than other padding materials, making it an excellent substrate for Oriental rugs, whose backing can be damaged by too much resilience.

• Random or level-tip is a contract short pile of cut and loop texture in which the cut pile is the same height as the loops, creating a more plush texture with the strength of level-loop textures.

Figure 12.7 (G) Random or level-tip carpet texture.

• Contract carpet textures are often used in residential interiors where durability, strength, and longevity are more important than luxury and softness. Applications often include hallways, stairs, home ofices, family rooms, and perhaps children’s rooms.

Installation Methods and Padding Carpet can be installed according to two basic methods. Direct glue-down uses no separate cushion and is suitable for any type of carpet. Reasons for direct gluedown include:

Figure 12.8 Tackless strips are nailed next to the wall, then padding or underlay is stapled down (if subfloor is wood), and carpet backing is hooked into angled staples to anchor it securely to the floor.

322

Chapter 12

Carpet Maintenance and Cleaning The appearance and life span of a carpet often depend on the way it is maintained. Although heavy trafic will wear carpet out faster, keeping the carpet clean is a key to good looks and to increasing its life span. Soil allowed to stay on the surface of a carpet is not only unsightly; the longer it is left, the more dificult it is to remove. When dirt, grit, or sand settles to the bottom of the pile, it can abrade the yarns at the base, wear them off, and eventually destroy the carpet. In heavy-trafic areas such as hallways and rooms that contain trafic lanes, carpeting should be vacuumed every day. Areas of little trafic, such as bedrooms, usually require vacuuming only once a week. A light vacuuming is three times back and forth, and a thorough vacuuming is seven times back and forth. Repetitive vacuuming loosens and pulls the dirt from the base to the surface and then sucks it up into the machine. Spots should be removed as quickly as possible and never allowed to remain on the carpet long enough to become set. Mild detergent and clear water are useful for many stains, and oil- or tar-based stains can be removed with a commercially prepared dry-cleaning solution. Carpet stores will often recommend products or sell kits for cleaning spots. Carpets should be cleaned when they become so soiled that vacuuming or spot-cleaning the carpet no longer keeps the surface looking good. • Steam extraction forces very hot detergent solution into the carpet and then extracts it immediately with a suction or wet vacuum.

• Carpet cleaning can also be done by spraying a solution onto the carpet and following with suction extraction. This may be called dry cleaning as there is less moisture in the carpet.

Rugs Rugs add softness and warmth, provide positive acoustical properties, and give character and richness to interiors. A ine rug can be the basis for interior design furnishings and may even be the focal point in a room. Area rugs deine an area, such as a conversation area or placement under a dining table, and may include many of the types of rugs discussed below.

Authentic Oriental Rugs Oriental rugs are knotted or tied by hand by native craftspeople from Iran, Turkey, Romania, the Caucasus, Afghanistan, Pakistan, India, Tibet, and China. The inest Oriental rugs originated in what was called Persia (today primarily Iran) at the height of the rug-weaving era in the ifteenth century. An Oriental rug is typically composed of a cotton warp, pile knots of wool or sometimes silk, and a cotton weft inserted after every two rows of knots. The design and colors are drawn on graph paper and called a cartoon. Patterns are symmetrical, often mirroring the design on all four corners. The iner the warp and knots and the greater the number of knots per square inch, the more intricate the patterns.

(C)

(A)

(B) Figure 12.9 Floor coverings help define space. (A) Wall-to-wall carpeting unifies an entire room. (B) An area rug defines a portion of the room, such as a conversation grouping. (C) A room-sized rug nearly covers the room; the exposed floor forms a border adjoining the walls.

Floor Materials and Coverings

Fine rugs have 400 knots or more per square inch and can take months to weave in a rug-weaving center and years if the weaver is working alone. Oriental rug weaving is an art and skill of the highest order, and this is relected in prices of the iner rugs: • Antique Oriental rugs are older than 75 years and are the most costly if they are in good to excellent condition. • Semiantique rugs are those from 25 to 75 years. • New rugs are less than 25 years old. Oriental rugs will often increase in value over the years despite some wear. This is true even of new rugs if they are authentic and woven in the area where they originate, called the traditional rug-weaving area. Nontraditional rug-weaving areas, such as India, have made traditional designs readily available. It takes an expert to evaluate and appraise a rug. It is best to shop for an Oriental rug at a reputable dealership that specializes in them.

Figure 12.10 This rustic European Country French entryway calls for classic and timeless flooring. Here, a finely woven Persian Oriental rug placed over wood-plank flooring will provide beauty and durability. Photo: Andersen Ross, Digital Vision/Getty Images

323

Oriental rugs are divided into Persian, Caucasian, Tibetan, and Chinese rugs. Persian rugs have intricate curving patterns, are often loral, and have high knot counts. Persian rugs from Iran are considered the inest rugs, although there is a great variety in quality. Persian rugs are also produced in India and surrounding countries. The best-known types are the Hamadan, Hereke, Herez, Isfahan, Kashan, Kerman (Kirman), Nain, Qum, Sarouk (Saruk), Senneh, Sereband, Shiraz, Shirvan, and Tabriz. Persian prayer rugs are unique in that they contain a Moorish arch imitative of those found in mosques. These rugs are often very inely woven with complex designs and may have a wool or silk pile. They are used as wall hangings as well as accent rugs. Historically, these rugs were carried by Islamic peoples, who would point the arch toward the holy city of Mecca to prostrate and pray at designated times.

Figure 12.11 Turkish Oriental rugs are often an artistic and enduring focal point in contemporary interiors, as seen here. Oriental rugs hold up well under traffic patterns and can be rotated to more evenly distribute the wear. The wool pile of Oriental rugs is easy to maintain by regular vacuuming, but when deeply soiled, should be professionally cleaned by Oriental rug care specialists. Photo: John A. Rizzo/Digital Vision/Getty Images

324

Chapter 12

Figure 12.12 (A) Complex Persian Oriental rug. Fine rugs have over 400 hand-tied knots per square inch; more knots yield curved lines.

Figure 12.12 (C) Caucasian or Turkish rug.

Figure 12.12 (D) Tibetan rug. Figure 12.12 (B) Persian prayer rug.

Caucasian or Turkish rugs are generally those from the Caucasus region in the former Soviet republic, and Turkish rugs originated in Turkey, though many are produced in Afghanistan, Pakistan, and India. These rugs are generally coarser, of brighter primary colors, and with simpler and geometric designs. Best known are the Afghan, Belouch, Bokhara, Kazak, Kurd, Qashqa’i (Kashkai), Tekke (Tekke Turkoman), and Yomut (Yamout).

Tibetan rugs are a type of deeper-pile Caucasian rugs. Made in Tibet and Nepal in styles dictated by Western tastes, these rugs are woven of very coarse yarns and in abstract, almost undeined patterns in earthy or faded colors and with streaked effects. They are primitive and coarse and have been well received in contemporary interiors as a counterpoint to the world of high technology. Chinese rugs are woven with a deeper pile of coarse wool (fewer knots per square inch). By law, all modern Chinese rugs have the same number of knots per square inch. Designs may be traditional—with open

Floor Materials and Coverings

Figure 12.12 (E) Chinese rug.

Figure 12.13 (A) Indian dhurrie rug.

background, central medallion, and a large-scale border, typically in cream, Ming blue, gold, and/or red. They may also copy designs from Persia and France, or they may be contemporary patterns. All will be sculptured or beveled on both sides of the design, giving a deeper, richer look and emphasizing the design. Rugs from India and surrounding countries have made Oriental rugs more readily available. Since labor costs are low and skill is high, rugs of all types are produced there. By law, all wool is native, and quality varies. Chinese rug depth and sculpturing is applied to French patterns and termed Indo-Aubusson rugs. Flat folk rugs are also produced in great quantity in India.

Folk Rugs Folk rugs can be deined as any rug woven by an ethnic group or relecting the native heritage of a country. Folk rugs are lat weave or pile weave, generally of wool. The dhurrie (dhurry, durry) and kilim rugs have been produced for centuries in India and Romania, respectively. Indian dhurries were traditionally of cotton, so few authentic antiques exist; Romanian kilims were of wool. In both rugs, folk designs are woven with no pile. They are reversible, and they vary from dark and vivid to pale colors. Designs are often geometric but may be based on loral patterns or have only textures and no patterns. Today the designs and colors are largely dictated by Western tastes, where the market has been strong. Navajo rugs are made in the southwestern United States—Arizona and New Mexico, primarily. These lat tapestry rugs relect Native American (Indian) tribe motifs and colors—geometric, angular, simple patterns in gray, cream, white, black, brown, rust, and red. Navajo

Figure 12.13 (B) Romanian kilim.

Figure 12.13 (C) Navajo rug.

325

326

Chapter 12

rugs can be valuable as investments, although they are imitated by Mexican laborers who produce knockoffs, which are not valuable. The types of Navajo rugs include the Chinle, Crystal, Ganado-Klagetoh (Ganado Red), Shiprock-Lukachukai (Yei and Yeibechi), the Storm Pattern, Teec Nos Pos, Two Gray Hills, and Wide Ruins. Of these, the inest weave and most valuable are the Two Gray Hills rugs. The rya and rollikan rugs are the best known of the Scandinavian rugs. The rya is a hand-knotted deep pile rug in abstract designs and contemporary colors. The rollikan is a lat tapestry rug that relects the simpliied, modern tastes inluenced by the folk arts and lowers of Scandinavia. Rag, braided, and hooked rugs are the New England colonists’ contribution to folk rugs. These rugs were made of clothing that was no longer usable (rags) and turned into utilitarian loor coverings. Rag rugs are plain-weave, lat rugs, originally woven on a loor or hand loom. Braided rugs are made of strips of fabric, braided and sewn into an oval or circle. Both rag and braided rugs are produced by hand and machine today. Hooked rugs are made by inserting strips of fabric into a heavy scrim or burlap backing cloth; they form simple patterns, usually loral.

Figure 12.13 (F) Braided rug.

Figure 12.14 An updated kitchen in a vintage home is a pleasing and practical mix of old and new. Broad plank-wood floor has been painted slate blue. Practical and artistic long rag-rug runners save wear-and-tear on the floor near the sink and cooking work stations. Photo © Brian Vanden Brink Figure 12.13 (D) Scandinavian rya rug.

European Handmade Rugs

Figure 12.13 (E) Rag rug.

The best known of the European rugs are the French Savonnerie and Aubusson, the Portuguese needlepoint, and the Spanish rugs. Savonnerie rugs have been produced at the Savonnerie factory in France for over 300 years. These rugs are a hand-knotted pile, traditionally with deep, rich, vivid colors and large-scale patterns. The Savonnerie rugs produced there today may be of very contemporary patterns as well as the historical French motifs of the Baroque (Louis XIV) and Empire periods.

Floor Materials and Coverings

327

Figure 12.16 (B) French Aubusson rug.

Figure 12.15 An child’s attic bedroom tucked within an extended shed dormer is a bright and delightful place. White-painted broad plank floors are a clean and ideal surface for playing with toys, while the oval braided rug gives warmth and visual anchor to this shipshape space. Design by Belle Maison; Sheldon Tager, Interior designer/photo © Brian Vanden Brink

Figure 12.16 (C) Portuguese needlepoint rug.

Figure 12.16 (A) French Savonnerie rug.

Aubusson rugs are named after the factory where they were irst produced. These French rugs are lat tapestry weaves, historically of Oriental rug–inspired motifs

in faded or muted colors. These rugs were particularly favored during the reign of Louis XVI, when light-scaled Neoclassic designs were in vogue. Today Aubusson rugs may have loral or abstract/modern patterns. Needlepoint rugs are mainly produced in Portugal and China. Although some needlepoints are machine made, authentic needlepoints are still hand-embroidered wool on a heavy scrim. The characteristic round stitches are usually formed into lovely loral patterns. These rugs are popular because of their European lavor.

328

Chapter 12

Figure 12.17 An antique Aubusson tapestry hangs as textile art above the fireplace complemented by a room-sized Neoclassicpatterned French Savonnerie rug. Photo © Rafael Macia/Photo Researchers, Inc.

Designer Rugs

Machine-Made Rugs

Designer rugs are made to custom speciications by several companies in America. The rugs are most often hand or machine tufted of quality wool onto a canvaslike fabric and then coated with a latex to hold the stitches in place. There may be a heavy fabric sewn onto the back as a secondary backing. The value of designer rugs lies in the freedom and creativity possible. The rug may be a simpliied, enlarged version of a selected textile. It may have large- or small-scale patterns and a variety of pile heights and yarn textures. The size and shape are also custom. In contract applications, designer rugs may center around a corporate logo or carry out a speciic theme. Designer rugs can be used as focal points or as wall tapestries. They may be pictorial, relecting regional histories, architecture, geology, or industry. Manufacturers work with interior designers to create the exact colors, textures, and designs. Designer rugs are less costly than Oriental rugs.

Rugs that are mass produced on machine looms can imitate many kinds of rug designs—Oriental rugs, folk rugs, French rugs, needlepoint rugs, and designer rugs. They are easily recognized in home improvement and furnishings stores by their economical prices, standardized patterns, and iber content—wool, nylon, or olein. Machine-made rugs that imitate Orientals are called domestic Oriental rugs, and when these are made of highquality wool with an extended warranty they are often used in custom interior design.

Natural Fiber Rugs Natural iber rugs include animal skins, berber rugs, cotton rugs, loccati rugs, sisal/maize mats, tatami mats, and wool rugs. Animal skins include zebra; black, brown, and polar bear skins; and any other animal skins laid on the loor or hung on the wall. The use of animal skins has been

Floor Materials and Coverings

329

Figure 12.19 This room-sized rug is machine woven to look similar to Oriental rugs, with adapted motifs and contemporary colors. They form the basis for the color scheme of this bedroom. Photo courtesy of Sea Gull Lighting Products, LLC.

Figure 12.18 This understated designer rug is a contemporary adaptation of Oriental motifs of bamboo leaves and stems. Designer rugs can be made into any size, shape, pattern, and texture required for the interior. Designer: Sandra L. Steiner-Houck, CKD; Steiner & Houck, Inc./Photography: Peter Leach Photography/ NKBA Design Competition

curtailed in recent years due to conservation efforts. Berber rugs, originally woven by the Berber tribal natives of North Africa, are made of wool that is not dyed but left in its natural color state—cream, brown, and black. The wool hues are mixed to frankly expose the natural lecks of the various colors. Berber rugs come in off-white, beige, darker brown, and charcoal. Berbers today are most often nylon or wool machine-tufted broadlooms for contract and residential application. A Berber area rug may be a portion of a broadloom with bound edges, cut or shaped to cover an area. Floccati, or flokati, rugs originate in Greece. They are tufts of sheared goat hair worked into a knit or woven fabric. They

Figure 12.20 The natural creamy white of the deep-pile comfort of a large natural wool rug echoes the neutrals of these Hunter Douglas Silhouette Shadings, which soften glare in this modern beach-house interior. Photo courtesy of Hunter Douglas, www .hunterdouglas.com

330

Chapter 12

have a deep, luxurious pile. Floccati rugs are used in both informal and formal settings and have been favored area rugs in contemporary settings for many years. They are available in off-white and brown and are surprisingly inexpensive. Sisal and maize mats are also available in squares or tiles, so the installations can cover small or large areas. They are not known for their comfort; sisal is particularly prickly to the touch. But these natural ibers form interesting and handsome loor textures. Tatami mats are traditional loor coverings for Japanese homes and are seen in contemporary Western residences as well. They are woven of dried sea grasses and edged with black fabric and are set together in geometric patterns. The thickness of tatami mats varies from about 1 to 4 inches. They offer good insulation as well as a precise appearance. Natural wool rugs are often woven or tufted into neutral, subtly patterned area rugs. Surface textures vary from cut pile to beveled designs to level-loop construction. Cotton rugs are woven by hand or machine and left neutral or yarn dyed to form simple patterns and textures. Cotton rugs may be machine washable and dryable if they are small rugs, and in larger installations they absorb dirt but clean up nicely.

Hard and Resilient Floorings Hard looring is frequently speciied by interior designers for contract settings. Factors that dictate this decision include the looring budget and the trafic level or classiication. A Class A or I trafic rating indicates extremely heavy trafic low. Many residential loorings such as medium-grade vinyl or tufted carpeting would wear out quickly under heavy trafic. Thus, contract loorings are more durable. They include solid vinyl, rubber, and particularly tile, brick, and stone. Although initially very costly, tile, brick, and stone will outwear any other looring because they last indeinitely under even very heavy trafic. Because of their weight, the subloor must have extra strength and support. Another advantage of hard materials is that they will generally not show dirt or trafic-pattern shadows and will be easy to clean and maintain. Tile, brick, and stone

Contract Considerations In addition to the guidelines in this chapter for selection of residential looring, contract looring has further criteria and considerations.

Figure 12.21 Intriguing one-point perspective is accentuated with the grid lines of the ceramic tile floor in this New York subway station. Ceramic tile can withstand years of hard abuse and still look good. Italian Trade Commission, Ceramic Tile Department

Figure 12.22 Patterned carpet is a key element in this hotel lobby design. Patterned carpet can have a life span double that of a plain carpet; it hides both soil and wear. Photo by Andy Battenfield and Kelly Haas

Floor Materials and Coverings

331

Figure 12.23 Modular carpet tiles in random abstract patterns allow for simple replacement of worn areas without the expense and waste of replacing carpet in large spaces, such as this heavy-traffic contract hallway. Photo © Kathryn Taylor

will not be damaged unless a very hard blow is struck; then the material will need to be replaced. Rubber and solid vinyl have other advantages. In addition to their resilience and resistance to damage, they are easier on the feet and are quieter than nonresilient looring.

Rugs and Carpeting Carpeting selected for contract installations varies somewhat from that used in residential settings, where color, price, and durability are the criteria. Contract carpets must meet some or all of the following requirements: • Cost must meet budget limitations. • Flammability resistance forms a stringent requirement in many public buildings. Testing for lammability is often conducted, and ratings are available to the client through the designer. • Construction is an important criterion. In order for a contract carpet to be durable, minimum requirements must be illed for pile density, which means the

number of tufts or stitches per square inch, together with the distance between rows and the pile height. The more dense the tufting or the weave, the stronger the carpet is likely to be. The strength of the tuft bind, or how tenaciously the face yarn is held onto the primary and secondary backings, is also a construction criterion. A thin layer of latex, for example, may not prevent the yarn from unraveling when pulled. • Weight of the face yarn will be one measure of carpet durability. Heavier face weight will indicate the amount of yarn per square measure. Finished pile weight includes the backings as well. • Carpet tiles, typically about 18 inches square, are economical and environmentally friendly in contract settings. Only the worn tiles (would) need replacing, saving resources. Carpet tiles are tufted construction and quite durable. • Abrasion resistance includes the type and quality of ibers and the type, thickness, and twist tightness of the yarn, as well as the density.

332

Chapter 12

• Resilience means the carpet must have the ability to withstand light, medium, heavy, or extra-heavy trafic without undue crushing or matting. • Appearance means the carpet will hide and release soil and will resist staining and fading, fuzzing, and pilling. • Maintenance is an important factor. Carpets must not show dirt easily. Many contract carpets are patterned

because they show about 50 percent less wear and soiling than an unpatterned carpet. • Static resistance is important where delicate machinery such as computer terminals may be affected or where highly lammable materials are present. • Sanitation is a requirement for carpet cleaning and maintenance in clinical and institutional facilities.

Chapter 13 Fabric

Fibers 334 Fabric—The Champion of Versatility 342 Contract Considerations 347 Decorative Fabric Glossary 348

Design by Hutker Architects/photo © Brian Vanden Brink

334

Chapter 13

Fibers The study of fabric begins by examining the substance from which fabrics are made: iber. Because ibers vary in strength, dimensional stability, and a host of other criteria, a knowledge of ibers is essential to both interior design professionals and consumers. When selecting ibers, one should take a close look at the level of expectation for the given installation, as no one iber can do everything and meet every need. To increase their usefulness, ibers may be blended, either in the viscose-solution stage (manmade ibers) or the raw-iber stage (natural ibers). In addition, threads may be spun together to make intimate blends, or two or more ibers can be used in fabrics—one as a base and the other(s) as pile or as one direction of yarns (the warp or the weft). The reasons for blending ibers are threefold:

Table 13.1

Man-Made Fiber Production

The man-made cellulosic fibers rayon and acetate come from cotton linters, wood chips, and chemicals blended into a liquid or viscose solution.

Petroleum, natural gas, coal, and chemicals are the ingredients for the noncellulosic or synthetic fibers nylon, acrylic, modacrylic, polyester, vinyl, and others.

1. To extend a costly iber with one that is less expensive 2. To strengthen a weaker iber with a stronger iber 3. To give different characteristics such as bulk, texture, and different color reactions to one dye Fibers are two general types: natural and man made. Natural ibers come from two sources: cellulose and protein. Cellulosic ibers are derived from plants—from the fruit, such as cotton, or from plant leaves, stems, or stalks, called bast ibers, such as linen (from lax), jute, ramie (China grass or linen), sisal, coir (coconut), piña (pineapple), maize (corn), and Oriental grasses. Protein ibers come from animals (wool of sheep, hair of goats, camels, horses, rabbits, and other animals) and insects (silk from the silkworm caterpillar). Sericulture is the tedious process of producing silk under cultivation. Leather is the tanned hide of cattle and swine. Man-made i bers are cellulosic and noncellulosic, or synthetic. Rayon and acetate come from cellulose— cotton linters or wood chips—to which various chemicals are added. Noncellulosic, or synthetic, ibers—nylon, acrylic, polyester, saran, olei n, vinyl, and many others not frequently used in interior design—begin with organic compounds such as petroleum, natural gas, coal, air, and water. (See Table 13.1.) These generic ibers are produced for speciic end uses. Trademarks or trade names identify generic ibers by manufacturer. An independent iber category is natural/mineral ibers that must be processed in ways similar to man-made ibers. These include asbestos, rubber, and metal. All man-made ibers are formed in much the same way. The compound is made into liquid or viscose form, then forced through holes in a shower-head-like oriice called a spinnerette. The size and shape of the openings can build in certain iber characteristics. Variety in the yarns comes through texturizing the ilaments, through

The spinnerette extrudes liquid that solidifies into filaments that are twisted into man-made fiber yarns.

Filaments can be crimped or given texture before spinning into thread or yarn.

types of yarn formations, and through the tension and direction of the yarn twists. In addition, generic ibers may be combined in the viscose stage, making blended ibers that can be engineered to meet speciic needs. Table 13.2 lists the most commonly used interior design ibers and their sources, natural types or man-made trademarks, positive and negative characteristics, and uses in residential and contract settings, as well as the care and cleaning of each iber, its relative cost structure, and its lammability rating.

Fabric

Table 13.2

Fiber Comparison

Natural Cellulosic Fibers

Cotton boll

335

Flax

The Cotton Council and Cotton Incorporated logo.

International Linen Promotion Commission logo

Cotton

Linen

Source. Fruit of the cotton plant, a member of the mallow family. Needs extended sunlight and a long growing season. Types. Short, long, extra long, carded, combed, mercerized. Egyptian and Sea Island are the inest cotton ibers. Positive characteristics. Versatile, dyes and prints well; good hand, dimensionally stable; absorbent iber. Negative characteristics. Wrinkles, fades, shrinks unless mercerized and preshrunk. Mildews if kept moist. Eventually rots from sunlight exposure. Low abrasion resistance. Residential uses. Draperies, walls, upholstery and padding, slipcovers, bed and bath linens, trimmings, accessories, rugs. Contract uses. With a lame-resistant inish, used for draperies, upholstery, and accessory items. Care and cleaning. Washable or drycleanable. Washing removes more inishes; dry cleaning recommended. May require ironing. Remove spots with mild detergent. Cost structure. Depending on grade, varies from low to moderately high. Flammability. Burns readily; lammable. Must be chemically treated for lame resistance.

Source. Fibers within the stalks of the lax plant; a bast iber. Grows in moist, moderate climates such as Great Britain and the low European countries. Types. Tow linen (short staple), demiline, line linen (long staple). Ramie or China grass is a bast iber with some similarities to linen. Positive characteristics. Crisp, strong iber. Appealing natural texture in tow linens. Dyes well, maintains good appearance. Absorbent. Line linens are smooth, lustrous. Durable. Negative characteristics. Brittle, stiff, inlexible; sun fades; short ibers have low abrasion resistance. Stains are dificult to remove. Permanently creases. Residential uses. Upholstery, slipcovers, draperies, semisheer casements, wall coverings, ine table linens (line linen), kitchen linens. Contract uses. Wall coverings. When treated for lame resistance, casement draperies, upholstery blends. Care and cleaning. Dry-clean. Table and kitchen linens may be washed in hot water and machine dried. Ironing is required for table linens. Cost structure. Depending on iber length and inishes, medium to moderately high. Flammability. Flammable, burns readily. Must be treated for lame retardance in contract settings. Paper-backed, adhered linen wall coverings are inherently lame resistant, receiving a class A rating.

Jute Source. Fibers within the stalks of the jute plant; a bast iber.

Types. Burlap, gunnysack cloth. Positive characteristics. Dyes bright colors, inexpensive, strong when dry. Negative characteristics. Will rot if kept damp, fades, is brittle. Residential uses. Crafts, wall covering. Drapery blends. Contract uses. None. Care and cleaning. Hand wash, dry thoroughly. Dry cleaning recommended. Cost structure. Low. Flammability. Burns readily; lammable.

Natural Protein Fibers

Wool comes from sheep The “Wool Mark” logo

Wool Source. Wool of sheep; hair of goats and camels. Types. Virgin—100 percent new wool; worsted—longer staple; woolen—short-, medium-staple ibers. Mohair—Angora goat hair. Positive characteristics. Great resilience, dyes well, durable, lame resistant. Appealing hand. Dimensionally stable. High absorbency. Negative characteristics. Some wools are scratchy, and some people are allergic to wool. Susceptible to moths. No resistance to alkalis. Low tensile strength. Residential uses. Upholstery; draperies; casements; wall coverings; broadloom carpets; designer, folk, Oriental, and other area rugs. Contract uses. Upholstery, carpeting, rugs (designer, folk, Oriental), wall upholstery accessory items, draperies. Care and cleaning. Dry-clean or clean by professional wet method. Cost structure. Moderate to very high. Flammability. Flame resistant; slow to ignite, self-extinguishes when lame is removed. (continued)

336

Chapter 13

Table 13.2

Fiber Comparison (continued) Flammability. Flammable—ignites readily; melts before burning.

Bombyx mori moth

Bombyx mori moth eggs

Acetate The silkworm (caterpillar)

Leather is the tanned hide of swine and cattle Moth escapes to lay more eggs

Cocoon filaments twisted to form silk threads

Silk Source. Filament of domesticated or wild silkworm cocoons. Types. Cultivated, reeled—Bombyx mori produced via sericulture. Wild (raw)— off-white tussah silk with slubs from A. myllita and A. perny moth species. Positive characteristics. Lustrous, smooth to slubby, dry hand, excellent drapability. Strong when dry. Dimensionally stable. Resists organic acids. Not harmed by wetting. Negative characteristics. Subject to sunlight deterioration as well as soil and moisture decomposition. Low resistance to alkalis. May be eaten by carpet beetles. Residential uses. Draperies (must be lined), trimmings, upholstery, wall hangings and coverings, ine Oriental rugs. Accessories—pillows, scrolls, embroidered art fabric. Contract uses. Draperies (lined), ine trimmings, luxury upholstery. Care and cleaning. Dry cleaning recommended. Some silks are washable. Cost structure. Moderately high to very high. Flammability. Burns slowly. Self-extinguishes when lame is removed.

Leather Source. Hides or skins of cattle or swine. Types. Full, top grain, split leather. Sueded, buffed, embossed, glazed. Aniline, pigment dyed. Positive characteristics. Extremely durable. Wears well and long. Resists fading, tearing, stretching, cracking.

Negative characteristics. Quality varies according to hide, tanning, and company branding. Susceptible to marks, holes, and tears. Residential uses. Upholstery, desktops, book bindings. Rarely for loor tiles, wall coverings, and area rugs. Contract uses. Upholstery, desktops, book bindings. Executive situations—loor coverings and wall coverings. Care and cleaning. Mild soap and water; no saddle soap. Cost structure. High. Flammability. Flame resistant/ire retardant. Emits no toxic fumes.

Man-Made Cellulosic Fibers

Source. Reconstituted cellulosic, wood chips, cotton linters, and acetic acid. Trade names. Airloft, Celanese, Chromspun, Estrom, Acele, Celaperm, Lanese, Loftura. Positive characteristics. A silklike sheen and hand. Stable iber, low absorbency; good solvent resistance. Negative characteristics. Low resistance to abrasion, acids. Susceptible to sunlight deterioration. Mildew; will discolor. Weakens with age. Residential uses. Bedspreads, draperies (should be lined), curtains, iberill, mattress ticking, lining, slipcovers, upholstery. Contract uses. As blends, some draperies. Care and cleaning. Dry-clean. Some acetates are washable. Cost structure. Low to medium. Flammability. Flammable—ignites readily; melts before burning.

Man-Made Noncellulosic/ Synthetic Fibers Nylon

The Man-Made Fibers Industry logo

Rayon Source. Regenerated cellulosic from wood chips and cotton linters. Trade names. Avril, Coloray, Colorspun, Enkrome, Jet-spun, Zantrel, Bemberg, Cordura, XL, Fibro, Beau-Grip. Positive characteristics. Imitates silk in luster, drapability. Good solvent, insect resistance. Negative characteristics. Low abrasion resistance, susceptible to sun, low moisture resistance; will mildew. Residential uses. Draperies (should be lined), trimmings, bedspreads, upholstery, slipcovers, scatter rugs. Contract uses. As blends, some draperies and upholstery fabrics. Care and cleaning. Dry-clean. Cost structure. Low to medium.

Source. Amide linkages attached to two aramid rings. Trade names. Anso, Antron, Cadon, Caprolan, Cumuloft, Nomex, Perlon, Quiana, Cantrese, Courtaulds, Cordura, Ultron, X-Static, Zefran, Zelon. Positive characteristics. Strong, stable, durable, resilient, versatile. Sheer to thick. Not affected by water, moisture, insects, microorganisms, aging. Resists alkalis, acids, solvents. Negative characteristics. Conducts static electricity; sheen, harsh hand; low sunlight resistance. Residential uses. Bedspreads, carpets, mattress pads, scatter rugs, slipcovers, upholstery, wall coverings. Contract uses. Carpets, curtains, upholstery, wall coverings. Care and cleaning. Dry-clean or wet-clean. Cost structure. Low to medium. Flammability. Some lame resistance; melts before burning; self-extinguishes when lame is removed.

Fabric

Table 13.2

337

Fiber Comparison (continued)

Acrylic Source. Over 85 percent acrylonitrile units, synthetic long-chain polymer. Trade names. Acrilan, Bi-loft, Creslan, Dolan, Dralon, Fina, Leacril, Orlon, Zefran. Positive characteristics. Excellent resilience. Soft wool-like texture, hand, and appearance; dyes well. Resists alkalis, acids, solvents, mildew, insects, and aging. Negative characteristics. Oleophilic—holds oil-borne stains; variable strength and stability; may fuzz and pull. Residential uses. Carpets, upholstery blends, curtains, draperies. Contract uses. Carpets, wall coverings. Care and cleaning. Dry cleaning recommended. Cost structure. Low to medium. Flammability. Flammable; melts, then burns slowly.

Modacrylic Source. From 35 to 85 percent acrylonitrile units, long-chain polymer. Trade names. Acrilan, Dynel, Kanekalon, Elura, Sef, Verel. Positive characteristics. Soft, buoyant, good hand, drapability, texture. Resists water, aging, insects, alkalis, acids. Negative characteristics. Restricted application, low abrasion resistance; heat sensitive; moderate strength. Residential uses. Casement draperies, fakefur blends, upholstery. Contract uses. Casement curtains, draperies, walls. Care and cleaning. Dry cleaning recommended. Cost structure. Medium. Flammability. Flame resistant; burns only with lame source; self-extinguishes when lame is removed.

Polylactic Acid Fiber (PLA) Source. A manufactured iber in which the iber-forming substance is composed of at least 85 percent by weight of lactic acid ester units derived from naturally occurring sugars, such as those in corn or sugar beets. PLA relies on basic fermentation and distillation followed by

polymerization. The Federal Trade Commission (FTC) granted PLA a new generic category designation in 2002. Trade names. Nature Works(TM) Ingeo. In Japan: Ecodear, Lactron, Terramac, Plastarch. Positive characteristics. Sustainable and renewable resource. Lightweight, low absorption, high wicking, breathable. Similar to cotton in appearance, natural iber hand, good drapability. High ultraviolet (UV) resistance, color absorption. May blend with cotton or polyester. Negative characteristics. Low moisture absorption, moderate strength. Residential uses. Upholstery, carpeting, draperies. Contract uses. Upholstery, carpeting, draperies. Care and cleaning. Dry-clean or machine wash, according to product and manufacturer’s recommendations. Cost structure. Moderate. Flammability. Low lammability and smoke generation.

Polyester Source. Synthetic polymer ester of substituted aromatic carboxylic acid. Trade names. Alvin, Blue C, Caprolan, Dacron, Encron, Fortrel, Holloil, Kodel, Lanese, Quintess, Shantura, Spectran, Strialine, Tergal, Terylene, Textura, Trevira, Twistloc, Vycron, Zefran. Positive characteristics. Resists sunlight fading and deterioration, mildew, insects; dimensionally stable; good strength. Soft hand, dyes well, resembles wool appearance. Water, heat, aging have no effect. Negative characteristics. Susceptible to abrasion, low resilience, oleophilic (holds oil-borne stains), pills. Residential uses. Sheer curtains, draperies, wall fabric, upholstery, slipcovers, carpets, awnings, iberill battings. Contract uses. Curtains and draperies, wall fabric, upholstery. Care and cleaning. Wash or dry-clean. Cost structure. Low to medium. Flammability. Flammable; will burn with lame source; self-extinguishes when lame is removed. Easily lame-retardant treated.

Olefin Source. Long-chain polymer of ethylene, propylene, or other olein units. Trade names. Durel, Herculon, Marvess, Polybloom, Polypropylene, Vectra, Patlon, Fibralon. Positive characteristics. Durable, economical, good resilience. Oily stains easily removed with water and detergent. Resists acids, alkalis. Negative characteristics. Low melting point, susceptible to sunlight and heat deterioration, oily, rough texture. Residential uses. Awnings, carpets—face and backing, upholstery, loor mats. Contract uses. Indoor-outdoor carpeting, upholstery, carpet backing, artiicial turf. Care and cleaning. Dry-clean or wet-clean. Cost structure. Low to medium. Flammability. Flammable; burns slowly. Melts and burns when lame is removed.

Vinyon/Vinyl Source. Vinyl chloride, long-grain polymer. Trade names. Naugahyde, Valcren, Vinyon, PVC, Phovyl, Eibranyl, HH, Leayl, Teylron, Thermoyyl, Cordelan. Positive characteristics. Imitates leather; many colors and textures. Negative characteristics. Splits; holes dificult to repair. Residential uses. Artiicial leather upholstery, wall coverings. Contract uses. Artiicial leather upholstery, wall coverings. Care and cleaning. Mild soap and water; solvents for ink removal. Cost structure. Low to medium. Flammability. Melts, self-extinguishes.

Lyocell Source. Lyocell is a manufactured iber, but it is not synthetic. It is made from wood pulp harvested from tree farms. In 1996, lyocell became the irst new generic iber group in 30 years to be approved by the FTC. Trade names. Tencel® lyocell, Lenzing lyocell. (continued)

338

Chapter 13

Table 13.2

Fiber Comparison (continued)

Positive characteristics. Breathable, absorbent, and generally comfortable; moderate resiliency. Strong and durable. Lustrous, may have soft drape, particularly in microibers. Short staple–length ibers give a cotton-like look. Long ilament ibers are silk-like. Negative characteristics. May be unresilient and may wrinkle, may shrink. May be susceptible to mildew and damage by silverish.

Table 13.3

Residential uses. Bath towels, sheets, pillowcases, window treatments. Contract uses. None yet. Care and cleaning. Interior design lyocell fabrics perform best when dry-cleaned. Bed and bath linens may be hand or machine washed and tumble-dried at moderate temperatures. Avoid oxygen or chlorine bleaches which may affect either dyes or resin inishes applied to the fabrics. Avoid excessive rubbing during

Fabric Maintenance Guidelines

• Regularly vacuum upholstery and window treatments to prevent soil from becoming embedded and prevent dust from combining with humidity and air impurities to become sticky grime. • Remove spots promptly with a dry-cleaning solution, very mild detergent (1 teaspoon detergent per quart lukewarm water), or a weak water and vinegar solution, depending on the iber and inish. Always blot the excess, lifting it out rather than rubbing it in. • Vacuuming and spotting can decrease major cleanings. This is desirable for a number of reasons: 1. Repeated cleaning can weaken ibers. 2. Cleaning solutions can remove inishes and fade colors. 3. Repeated cleaning can take body out of fabric, causing it to hang limply or lose shape. 4. Cleaning involves cost, time, and effort. • When selecting professional cleaners, inquire as to method and guarantee. Seek personal recommendation for quality work.

Figure 13.1 Plain weave fabric—Oxford plaid. © D. E. Lanners/ Courtesy SoFro Fabrics/House of Fabrics

stain removal. It can take high ironing temperatures, will scorch, not melt. Cost structure. Moderate. Flammability. Flammable unless treated. Note: Other ibers—such as saran, spandex, iberglass, latex, and metallic—have limited use in interiors and are therefore not included in this chart.

Fabric Maintenance In addition to the points in Table 13.2, there are some general guidelines in Table 13.3 that, when followed, maintain the appearance and long life of fabric.

Fabric Construction Fibers are made into fabric in a variety of ways; textiles may be woven or nonwoven, knitted or needle constructed, layered or compounded, and extruded (Table 13.4). The majority of fabrics are still woven on looms, which vary from simple, hand-operated instruments to Figure 13.2 Twill weaves seen here as Scottish Lomond Clan Tartan and a subtle plaid with herringbone weave lie atop a Jacquard weave in a coordinated palette of persimmon, copper, yellow and green. Courtesy of Highland Court ®

Fabric

339

Figure 13.4 This Scottish lace tablecloth is named “A Tribute to Charles Rennie MacIntosh” and features his famous MacIntosh rose design. Scottish Lace and Gifts by Mary Keil/photo © David A. Leviton

Figure 13.3 These 100 percent solution-dyed acrylic Sunbrella® fiber trims are guaranteed not to fade or stain and are both water and mildew resistant, making them good choices for pool, patio, or sunroom. The striped fabric is a satin weave. Courtesy of Duralee ® Fabrics

Figure 13.5 These woven Jacquard textiles show a variety of styles from traditional to contemporary designs. Courtesy of Stroheim and Romann

Figure 13.6 A lively mix of fabrics featuring a bright floral, two plaids, a check, and stripe patterns are coordinated in happy colors and informal theme. Courtesy of Stroheim and Romann

340

Chapter 13

Table 13.4

Fabric Construction

Woven The Plain Weave A host of fabrics are plain weaves, including chintz, broadcloth, ninon, batiste, and tweed, for example.

Plain weave

Plain weave. The plain weave is formed by interlacing yarns one over, one under (1/1) in regular sequence. Variety is introduced through different-sized yarns or by varying the plain weave. Plain basket weave

Plain basket weave. Basket weaves are equal, two over two or three over three. Plain Oxford weave. The Oxford weave variation loats two ine warp threads over and under one heavier weft thread.

Plain Oxford weave

Plain leno weave. Another variation is the leno weave in which the warp threads form an hourglass twist. The dobby attachment weaves in small geometric Plain leno weave one-color igures. Twill weave. The warp-face twill weave is made of an interlacing pattern that loats one warp thread over two or three weft threads and then under one, called a weft tiedown. This order produces a diago- The twill weave, identified by nal wale. Steep wales result the diagonal wale, is often when two low-pitch wales loat used for sturdy fabric over three. Novelty twills are formed by reversing or altering the order of interlacing, such as the herringbone (a zigzag chevron pattern) and the houndstooth (a four-pointed star, or a square with a tooth projecting from each side). Twills can be incorporated into complex Jacquard-woven patterns, as well. Duck and serge, as well as houndstooth and chevron, are twill fabrics. Satin weave. The satin weave loats one warp yarn over four or more weft yarns and then is tied down with one thread (4/1, 5/1, 6/1, 7/1, or 8/1). The order of interlacing is staggered, so the result is a smooth face with no wales. Many satin-weave fab- The satin rics are woven in very ine threads weave that increase the luster of the cloth. produces Satin weaves are also used inten- a lustrous sively in cotton decorator fabrics. smooth face Satin weaves that loat weft or Warp sateen iller yarns on the face of the goods are termed is used for horizontal satins, satines, or warp sateens. In admany printed dition, satin weaves often form the background for cotton fabrics damask and brocade.

Jacquard weave. Frenchman Joseph Marie Jacquard invented a loom attachment in the eighteenth century that became known as the Jacquard loom. Hole-punched cards are strung in sequence high above Jacquard weave the loom. As the wires carry each card into position above the loom, the holes allow some of the threads to raise and keep others in position, producing large, complex patterns. This loom today takes a long time to thread and set up, but then large runs of fabric can be produced at relatively little expense. Jacquard fabrics include matelassé, damask, brocade, brocatelle, and igured velvets. Pile weave. The pile weave inserts supplementary warp or weft threads into the fabric as it is woven. The extra threads may be looped or cut pile. Examples are velvets, corduroys, and terry cloths.

Cut and uncut pile weave

Nonwoven Textiles Needle-Constructed Fabrics These are iber mats, webs, or extruded (lowed then solidiied) textiles used for fabric backings or for upholstery, wall, and carpet padding. An increasing number of fabrics today are needle-constructed by knitting, tufting, and interlock- Lace construction ing. Knitted fabrics comprise the majority in constructions such as single and double knits and rachel or warp knits for casement draperies. Arnache and malimo needle machines use multiple needles to chain stitch or interlock threads onto a cloth as it is formed. Lace is a needle-constructed fabric.

Malimo and arnache

Rachel knits

Layered or Compounded Fabrics As the name layered implies, this group of fabric construction takes more than one production step to complete. Examples of layered or compounded fabrics include embroidery: hand, crewel, and schifli (machine embroidery). Appliqué, the layering of additional fabrics by gluing and/or stitching, is also a compound cloth. Tufting is the method by which the majority of carpets are constructed today. Tufting punches yarns into a base fabric. In carpet, the tufted yarn is held in place with a layer of latex adhesive and then adhered to a secondary backing of polypropylene (see Chapter 12). Chenille bedspreads are also tufted fabrics.

Fabric

341

sophisticated, computer-controlled elaborate machinery. Weaving is the interlacing of lengthwise continuous warp yarns that are strung on the loom with crosswise illing, or weft, yarns to form a fabric. The order of interlacing determines the type of weave. There are ive basic types of weaves: plain, twill, satin, Jacquard, and pile. A fabric may be composed of a single weave, variations of a single weave, or a combination of weaves.

Finishes Finishing is the process of converting textiles from their raw or gray goods (greige) state (dingy gray without pattern, color, or textural interest) into an identiiable fabric for interior design. Finishes can be broken into two main categories: i nishing and coloring. Both of these processes take place at a variety of times. For example, the fabric may receive preinishing steps, then be dyed, and be further inished for aesthetics and/or durability. Or the cloth may be dyed irst and then treated with inishes later. Most fabric goes through an average of six different inishing steps or processes before it is ready to market. Many fabrics are prei nished, such as preshrinking or heat setting. A common preinish is mercerizing, which subjects cotton or linen to caustic soda. This increases the iber’s ability to absorb dye and increases luster, causing the yarn to become rounder and more consistent. Finishes may be durable—those able to withstand repeated cleaning—or nondurable or soluble—those that will be removed with cleaning and will need to be reapplied.

Coloring Coloring of fabric takes place in two general ways: by dyeing and by printing. Table 13.5 lists terms that are used to help us understand the materials and processes used in the coloring of fabric.

Standard Finishes Standard i nishes are also called chemical, wet, or functional i nishes. Their purpose is to improve the performance of the fabric or its resistance to environmental factors. Standard inishes may be durable or nondurable. Examples of standard inishes are antistatic, wrinkleresistant, flame-retardant, mothprooi ng, soil-release, and soil- and water-repellent inishes.

Decorative Finishes Decorative inishes may be durable or nondurable. These are also termed mechanical or surface treatment inishes. They may determine the decorative identity of the fabric, such as chintz (done by durable press calendering— lattening and shining with hot heavy rollers). Other decorative inishes may brighten, deluster, soften, add texture, or press or engrave designs to the surface of the fabric.

Figure 13.7 Dyeing and printing are the ways these textiles have received their color. Dyeing is usually solid coloration via immersing the yarn or “piece” of fabric into a dye bath. Printing achieves individual design colors, as seen in the leaf pattern of these pillows in this Asian-inspired bedroom/sitting area. Design by The Green Company/photo © Brian Vanden Brink

Obtaining Fabric Fabrics for interior design travel an interesting road from their natural or compounded raw goods state (greige or gray goods) to our homes and the places where we work or visit. The ibers discussed in this chapter are woven, knitted, or extruded into goods that need an average of six inishes to become marketable. While some fabrics stay on the market for several years, there is an amazing turnover in current fabrics. Every six months, new fabric lines are introduced to the interior design marketplace (the spring line and the fall line), relecting current styles, trends, favored ibers, colors, and inishes. Design inspiration is sought the world over for design trends in color, pattern, and texture. Fabrics obtained from interior designers are purchased through a jobber who sells cut orders “to the trade.” In metropolitan locations, the designer may take a client to an open showroom, where samples of the “lines” carried by a fabric company (or fabric house) are

342

Chapter 13

Table 13.5

Fabric Dyeing and Printing

Dyestuff. A water-soluble coloring matter that is mixed with water and chemicals to make a liquid solution or dye bath. Pigment. A nonsoluble coloring agent that is held onto the surface of fabrics with resin binders. It looks more like paint; white, gold, silver, and other metallic special inishes are pigments. Stock dyeing. Dyeing natural ibers before they are spun into yarn. Solution or dope dyeing. Adding dyestuff to the man-made-iber solution before extrusion. Yarn dyeing. Dyeing the yarn by the skein, by the package, on a beam, or through space dyeing (different colors of the skein, package, or beam). Piece dyeing. Dyeing a full length of woven fabric (45 to 150 yards long). Types of dyeing include beck, jig, padding, pressure jet, union dyeing, and cross dyeing. Dye lot. When a new dye bath is constituted, several pieces are dyed at once. The new solution may vary slightly from previous batches of the same color, so may not perfectly match other dye lots. Afi nity. The attraction of certain chemical compositions to certain ibers. Chemical afinities must be carefully matched. Cross dyeing. Two ibers of different afinities dyed in the same bath, accepting the dye in different ways.

Hand printing. Techniques that print fabric through hand-only labor. Silk-screen printing. A stencil technique using a thin fabric with a ilm painted or transferred. Ink is squeegeed across, penetrating where the ilm is absent. A new screen is needed for each color. Rotary screen printing. A fully automatic silk-screen process wherein the screens are wrapped around circular drums that rotate the ink onto fabric that moves beneath the rotary screens. Roller printing. A mechanical printing method employing a large engraved metal cylinder, which is continuously inked as fabric moves around it. Resist or reserve printing. A mechanized process in which a pattern is printed with a chemical paste that resists the dye. The background is colored and the design is light and neutralized. Heat-transfer printing. Decals are dispersed-transferred from waxed paper to the cloth under heat and pressure. Air-brush printing. Use of hand-operated mechanical pressure ink-jet guns that spray dye over a stencil. Etch or burn-out printing. Prints a design with a chemical that dissolves one of the two or more ibers in a fabric to leave some areas more sheer and the nonprinted areas more opaque. Typical is burning out cotton in a cotton/polyester semisheer fabric. Colorfast. Resistant to fading.

displayed. Selections are made from individual samples or swatches or from bound sample books. Showrooms that do not allow the client to accompany the designer are termed closed showrooms. Designers order fabrics for their clients as cut yardage, or occasionally by the half bolt (about 30 yards) or full bolt (about 60 yards). Clients may also purchase decorator fabrics directly from retail stores. Although retail selection usually consists of overruns and discontinued or lawed goods, the fabrics are useful, appealing, and less costly.

remarkable achievement of our civilized and modern society, for in past centuries, even nobility did not enjoy the quantity and easy care of luxurious fabrics that we take for granted today. Today we also have the ability to keep our fabrics clean, fresh, and appealing. We know how to maintain fabrics and extend their life span. If we so desire, we can change the interior design by rotating fabrics seasonally or by keeping up with current color and style trends that last only 1 to 3 years. We can replace fabrics as they wear out, as our lifestyles change, or as our needs evolve. Or we can choose durable and timeless fabrics that will be just as appealing 10 or 20 years after we bring them home. Fabric may be used lavishly or sparingly. However it is to be applied, the work-order form must be completed accurately for correct fabrication and installation. Since some fabrics and labor are so costly, it is crucial that interior designers be well trained to shoulder the responsibility of overseeing correct speciication, fabrication, and installation.

Fabric—The Champion of Versatility Fabric is a malleable element that can be used in more ways than any other material. Fabric softens the straight lines of the interior while complementing and establishing an interesting counterpoint to them. Fabric is used at the window as draperies and curtains, shades, top treatments, and trimmings. On furniture, fabric serves as upholstery, slipcovers, pillows, trimmings, and throws (blankets or afghans). In the kitchen and bath, fabric “linens” dry and caress our bodies as well as our precious and everyday objects. Fabrics also function as loor cloths and wall and ceiling treatments. Because of its affordability and availability, fabric can be utilized in every room in the house. This is in itself a

The Human Touch Fabric humanizes interiors. It can establish quietude and seclusion as it absorbs sound. Fabric can give a sense of personal space; it is selected with personal preference as a prime criterion. Fabric surroundings can be psychologically appealing and uplifting. Seeing a familiar fabric, whether a handmade heirloom or store-bought textile,

Fabric

343

the fabric is also a durable and an appropriate selection. Three attributes—color, pattern, and texture—form the basis for personal choice. These three form criteria for judging the appropriate use of the fabric, whether the fabric is in itself good design, and whether combinations of fabrics are tastefully and discriminately used.

Color

Figure 13.8 Subtle, neutral tones are seen in the sofas, ottoman, and pillows in this peaceful and sophisticated master bedroom. Semisheer draperies lend an ethereal softness, while striped Roman shades assure complete privacy and light control. Design by Catalano Architects/ photo © Brian Vanden Brink

gives us a sense of belonging and comfort. As we select our fabrics and their use, we reveal to others our values and lifestyles. In past centuries, smooth, elegant fabrics were the exclusive right of the wealthy. As fabrics became more readily available and as man-made ibers imitated fabrics of luxury inexpensively, the wealthy saw, to their dismay, that anyone could achieve a pseudo-elegance. Those with money and taste have often turned to a new sensual pleasure of handwoven, unique fabrics, rustic or reined. These fabrics are costly because of the complexity of the construction and inishing processes or the relative obscurity of their source. Textiles are brought back from exotic travels or obtained through exclusive interior design irms to establish a look that cannot be easily copied. In this way, fabric establishes identity and status. Fabric appeals to the visual, tactile, and emotional senses; it can stimulate or excite, be dramatic or theatrical, even produce a sense of intrigue and fascination. Fabric can enliven and cheer through light, bright, or pastel colors and patterns; it can draw us to the earth with coarse, rugged textures, patterns, and colors; and fabric can lift us above earthly cares with soothing texture, neutralized color, and subtle pattern. Fabric can establish seclusion and privacy by shutting out the world and can satisfy the deep human craving for indulgence in that which gives pleasure.

Fabric Aesthetics Often a fabric is preferred because of its beauty and emotional appeal, and this is as it should be, providing

It is often inding just the right color in a fabric that clinches the selection. Color preferences are often deep rooted and should always be respected. Color affects the mental and physiological health and well-being of those who live with it.

Figure 13.9 A striking contemporary motif of large flowing gold swirls on a sea of jewelled aqua is complemented with a smaller pattern of abstract leaf shapes reminiscent of Moorish tiles. These fabrics have a three-dimensional quality achieved by incorporating rayon and polyester with metallic yarns. Courtesy of Duralee ® Fabrics

344

Chapter 13

Figure 13.10 A high-key, light-value color scheme coordinates the Victorian-inspired floral fabrics, ticking stripe wall covering, and circular braided rug in this storybook cottage interior. Weston & Hewitson Architects/photo © Brian Vanden Brink

Texture

There are guidelines in selecting color for fabric coordination that will give security to both the professional and the layperson when making fabric color decisions. These guidelines are listed in Table 13.6.

To the touch and to the eye, fabrics are textural. From smooth and reined (satin, velvet, damask, brocade) to sturdy and coarse (tweed, matelassé, frieze, bouclé), fabric is aesthetically appealing because of textural relief. Relief is the way the surface reads—the peaks and valleys, highlights and shadows. This added third dimension gives depth and interest to fabric and accounts for much of its appeal. Guidelines to careful texture coordination of fabric are suggested in Table 13.8.

Pattern Pattern establishes the character and personality of a fabric. Pattern can irmly tie a fabric to a period whose patterns look good together because they evolved around a cohesive “spirit of the times” predominated by one social, political, or artistic/architectural movement. This spirit or character must remain consistent in order for the patterns to coordinate and look right. Some guidelines for coordinating fabric patterns are included in Table 13.7.

Livability, Flexibility, and Durability Other important criteria for selecting fabrics include: • Livability Interior design fabrics should be not only aesthetic but also comfortable for the people who live with them. For residential design, consider the lifestyle— how formally or casually do you want to live and

Fabric

Table 13.6

Fabric Color Coordination Guidelines

• Colors are typically either pure and clear or neutralized and dulled. Colors should be used together with other colors from these same families. • Warm and cool colors can have either warm or cool undertones, produced by mixing other colors into the dye. In complementary schemes, either the warm or the cool hue should dominate. • Consider the color of the light and how it will affect the fabric colors. Always try out fabric combinations on site to be certain they will coordinate under lighting conditions in that room. It may become necessary to change the quality, type, and direction of the light to coordinate and enhance the fabric color scheme. • Look carefully at the orientation and needs of the room and its inhabitants. Is it a cold, north room that needs cheerful colors, or is it a hot, south or west exposure that cries for cooling hues? • Vary intensity or brightness within the fabric color scheme. If all the fabrics are intense, the scheme may prove unlivable, and if all colors are dull, the scheme may prove uninteresting. The law of chromatic distribution has proved its validity: Large areas are dull and neutralized (light, medium, or dark), and small areas are really bright. Midsized objects are middle intensities. • Be sensitive to value distribution. Light values above, medium around, and dark colors below have consistently proved pleasing. However, some schemes can be very successful as all light (high-key), all medium, or all dark (low-key) values. Some schemes even reverse the standard distribution to light below, dark above. High-value contrast (light next to dark) is stimulating and dramatic; low-value contrast (blended values) is soothing and pleasant. • Consider what colored fabrics do to each other. Colors should enhance, support, and beautify one another, never compete or cause visual irritation. • Avoid too many coordinated fabrics with exactly the same dyes in varying colors and patterns. Although these coordinated “designer fabrics” can be lovely, there is also pleasure derived from searching many sources and inding fabrics that do not perfectly match as much as they blend and complement. This approach takes effort and time but is ultimately worth the hunt.

Table 13.7

345

• Fabric color schemes that are sensitively coordinated will feel natural and interesting, with an almost destinylike rightness. It is the skill in the coordination that produces this effect.

Figure 13.11 Cool, clean, crisp fabric colors coordinate beautifully with each other, with paint colors and with the vista in this waterfront bedroom. Design by Polhemus Savery DaSilva Architects Builders/photo © Brian Vanden Brink

Guidelines for Coordinating Patterned Fabric

• Look to the source of the fabric, its period or inspiration. If it is an adaptation, does it still possess the integrity and color of its origination? • The pattern itself should be handsome, well proportioned, and livable, whether or not it is authentic. • When bringing together more than one pattern, vary the scale of the fabrics—for example, a large pattern with a small one. • Add appropriate support patterns and textures, such as correctly scaled stripes and geometrics with a loral or abstract pattern and plain-textured fabrics.

• Consider the thematic goals of the overall look of the interior. If, for example, the fabrics are to replicate the look of English Country, then seemingly conlicting patterns of printed textiles will work because they are authentic. The seemingly haphazard appearance looks lived-in, hence its strong appeal. If the look is American Country, then small-scale calico-chintz or sateen fabrics will pull off the look well. If a formal look is desired—say, a Georgian or French room—then the patterns should be elegant brocades and damasks.

346

Chapter 13

Table 13.8

Guidelines for Coordinating Fabric Textures

• Textures used together must be compatible. For example, leather is not usually compatible with reined damask or brocade but is with matelassé or tweed. Lace is not in character with dramatic modern textures, but it complements moiré or velvet. • Harmony is a key to good texture coordination. There must be a uniied theme or ambience, a period or style, that holds together all fabrics in a scheme. There must also be variety in order to achieve harmony. For example, in a formal setting there may be velvet, damask, satin, sheer, moiré, and other different textures of the same character. A Country French provincial setting uses

tapestry, ticking, toile de Jouy, tweed, and woven herringbone or plaid. • The textures should be appropriate to their intended use. Fabrics as upholstery should feel comfortable. Wall fabrics should coordinate with the level of formality, and all appointments should be selected to be pleasing for their use. Refer to Table 13.9 for a comparison of fabric weights and applications or uses. Also refer to the “Decorative Fabric Glossary” at the end of the chapter for dei nitions, weights, constructions, and i nishes of fabrics by name.

Figure 13.12 A formal textile application inspired by the French Neoclassic style has been specified and custom fabricated for this lovely master bedroom. Coordinated pastel green fabrics are selected for the upholstered headboard, the bed draperies, valance, and bed skirt/dust ruffle. A white duvet/comforter, pillows, and valet bench upholstery create clean, high-value, soft elegance. Design by Sally Weston Associates/photo © Brian Vanden Brink

Fabric

347

strength and longevity is due to iber, yarn, and construction factors. Weaknesses in fabrics include: • Fuzzing—tiny ibers working to the surface • Pilling—ibers working into balls or pills • Fading—color loss from excessive light exposure or repeated cleaning • Lack of serviceability—dificult to clean Aesthetic durability is another consideration; faddish colors and patterns will date quickly, whereas more neutral or classic fabrics will stand the test of time.

Fabric Weight and Applications Fabric may be categorized by weight and by speciic use or application. Table 13.9 lists four basic categories of weight and the common uses for fabrics that fall in each category. In the “Decorative Fabric Glossary” at the end of the chapter, each fabric is given a weight designation that can be cross-referenced to the information in this chart.

Contract Considerations

Figure 13.13 Contract fabrics must meet stringent requirements for high performance and resistance to flammability, as well as beauty. Here the fabrics in the draperies, upholstery, and accent pillows are unpatterned so that the hand-knotted Tibetan rug furnishes deep, rich pattern that holds up well to repeated foot traffic. Hotel Viking, Historic Homes of America, Newport, RI. Copyrighted and registered, Soroush Custom Rugs & Axminster Carpet, www.soroush.us

entertain? Match the lifestyle to textures, patterns, and colors that will be livable and thematic. • Flexibility Fabrics that are neutral in theme can be lexible as the decor changes, even seasonally. Pillows, trim colors, slipcovers, table covers and linens, and window treatments can alter a room’s appearance while furniture style remains. Storing off-season fabrics requires only modest space. Of all the elements in an interior, fabric makes the quickest and most effortless design statement. • Durability Fabrics intended for much use and even abuse, such as often-used upholstery, will stand the test of time better if they are patterned or textured and have medium tones or values. Fabrics that are very light or very dark will show spots and stains readily. Very low end (economical) or very high end (costly) fabrics may require more frequent cleaning. Fabrics should look great after repeated cleaning. Fabric

Fabrics installed in contract buildings must meet minimum requirements for durability, colorfastness, and ire safety. These minimum acceptable standards are written as speciications by an architect or interior designer. The interior designer then selects fabrics that meet the speciications or requirements listed in Table 13.10.

Table 13.9

Fabric Weight and Applications

Weight

Application and Use

Sheer, thin, very lightweight fabrics

Bed hangings, canopies, bed curtains, window curtains, sheer curtains/draperies, window semisheer casement and contract draperies, soft top treatments, thin table coverings, wall curtains

Lightweight fabrics

Accessory items and trimmings, casements, curtains, draperies, shades, top treatments, kitchen linens, lamp shades, supported bedspreads, table cloths

Medium-weight fabrics

Bedspreads, pillows and accessories, bath linens, slipcovers, supported upholstery, wall and partition upholstery, window treatments—draperies, heavier curtains, shades, stiff top treatments

Heavyweight fabrics

Bedspreads (tapestrylike), floor cloths, wall upholstery, wall hangings and tapestries, upholstery

348

Chapter 13

Table 13.10

Criteria for Contract Fabric Specifications

• Cost. Contract installations typically have a strict budget. • Durability. The ability of a fabric to exist for a long time without signiicant deterioration. Durability includes: 1. Abrasion resistance—the fabric’s ability to withstand friction, rubbing, or grinding. Tests are conducted to rate abrasion resistance. 2. Colorfastness—resistance to both sun fading and fading from cleaning. Fabrics can be tested and rated for colorfastness. 3. Resistance to crocking—crocking is the rubbing off of color onto another fabric or onto the skin. 4. Strength or tenacity—the actual or physical strength of the iber. The strength of a fabric is based also on the way the yarns are spun and plied, the closeness of the weave, and the thickness of the fabric. • Dimensional stability. The ability of a fabric to maintain its original size and shape dimensions. This includes: 1. Resistance to sagging—elongation or sagging may occur in fabrics that absorb moisture (hydrophilic ibers) when humidity is high or the fabric is wet-cleaned. 2. Resistance to hiking—hiking up or shrinkage can occur when humidity drops or fabrics dry out. The lack of dimensional stability in hung fabrics through sagging and hiking is called the yo-yo effect—the bottom hem becomes quite uneven. • Resilience. The fabric’s ability to return to its original shape after stretching or elongation. In upholstered fabrics, dimensional stability also includes resilience, or the ability to bounce back to its original shape. Resilience is the result of two qualities: 1. Flexibility—stretching and rebounding. 2. Strength or tenacity—a fabric lacking strength, which tears easily, is termed tender. • Resistance to static electricity. An important consideration where static electricity buildup may affect delicate instruments,

such as computers, or where they may be a source of ire ignition. • Resistance to insects and microorganisms. Necessary to prevent fabric disintegration and the spread of disease, particularly in hospitals and institutions. • Flammability resistance. Fibers in contract settings must meet the rigid ire code. Fabrics are tested for lammability, smoke density, and toxicity. 1. Flammable or inlammable—fabrics that catch ire easily or are highly combustible, such as cotton, linen, rayon, and acetate. 2. Flame resistant—natural ibers (wool, silk) that do not ignite easily, are slow-burning, and will often self-extinguish. 3. Fire retardant—man-made ibers that are lame resistant (not easily combustible, slow burning, may self-extinguish). These are modacrylic, saran, polyvinyl chloride, nomex, and novoloid. Fire-retardant fabrics may be lammable natural ibers (cotton, linen, rayon, and acetate) that have been given chemical inishes to inhibit their lammability. These treatments are termed lame-retardant inishes. 4. Nonlammable or lameproof—ibers that will melt but will not burn are asbestos, metal, and iberglass. • Flame-retardant i nishes. These are chemical applications that enhance a fabric’s ability to withstand or resist combustion. Most lame retardants provide one of the following degrees of durability: 1. Nondurable—a water-soluble compound that is removed with wet cleaning, requiring reapplication. 2. Semidurable—a compound that will resist wet-cleaning but not dry-cleaning solutions. 3. Durable—treatments that will withstand repeated dry cleaning and are permanent, lasting the lifetime of the fabric.

Decorative Fabric Glossary

Batik

Antique Satin A lightweight drapery fabric in a sateen or horizontal satin weave with slubs that imitate spun shantung silk. Most antique satins are one color, though the warp and weft yarns may be dyed different colors to produce iridescence; may also be printed. Suitable for bedspread fabric if quilted.

Armure

A lightweight to medium-weight hand-printed textile. Certain areas are waxed; then the fabric is dyed. For two or more colors, each preceding wax layer is removed, and wax is reapplied in a different pattern. A crinkled pattern is achieved by crumpling the fabric and cracking the wax. Primitive or ethnic batik patterns from Indonesia and Africa are reproduced by mechanical silkscreen or roller printing.

Medium-weight fabric in one color with small woven repetitive dobby igures. Plain-weave ribbed background cloth.

Batiste

Arnaché

Bengaline

Needle-constructed lightweight casement cloth. Weft threads are inserted just ahead of the multiple-needle lockstitch knitting.

A medium-weight horizontal or weft-ribbed fabric produced with ine warp and plied or grouped illing yarns. Strong and reined cloth.

A thin, semisheer curtain/drapery fabric.

Fabric

349

Figure 13.14 Case Study This impressive fabric “torch tree” in the Olympic Store of the Vancouver, British Columbia, Hudson Bay Company (HBC) won three major awards for retail design including 1st Place Award at the Retail Design Institute’s 38th Annual International Store Design Awards. To make the massive “S-Wall” structure appear light and floating, Eventscape engineered three pointed fabric arches using steel reinforcement in order to support the recyclable lightweight aluminum framing for the fabric branches. HBC wanted the elements to be modular and reusable, so each segment has hang-points for suspension. The center base incorporates glass, colored acrylic, and concealed lighting. The flexible nature of fabric is a key element in its effective use in contract design. Photo by Ed White/courtesy of Eventscape, Inc. www.eventscape.net

Bird’s-Eye

Bouclé Marquisette

A lightweight to medium-weight fabric with small dobby woven all-over diamond patterns in one color. Originally a toweling/linen fabric, cotton is used most often.

Fine leno-weave sheer marquisette with bouclé weft or iller yarns. Originally glass curtains of nylon; today of polyester and used as lightweight casement fabric.

Bouclé

Broadcloth

Medium-weight to heavyweight knitted or woven cloth. Looped bouclé novelty yarns give a tightly curled, bumpy surface texture to the fabric.

Lightweight cotton plain taffeta weave with ine horizontal ribs. Yarn twist or tightness is slightly irregular. Also a inely napped twill weave wool in various weights.

350

Chapter 13

Brocade

Chenille

Medium-weight formal Jacquard weave with supplemental warp or weft woven into the fabric to give an embroidered, often colorful, design. Background weave is often satin. Threads not tied down are carried as “loats” on the back of the fabric. Cut loats make broché brocade.

Medium-weight to heavyweight fabric with chenille yarns that are fuzzy and resemble soft pipe cleaners. Velour textures are common.

Brocatelle Medium-weight Jacquard fabric with slightly heavier and pufier surface than damask. Fine cloth with two sets of warp and weft.

Buchram, Buckram, or Crinoline Lightweight fabric, in width 3, 4, or 5 inches, stiffened and used as drapery heading interfacing. Plain weave or nonwoven web of cotton, linen, jute, or synthetic iber.

Burlap Medium-weight jute fabric in plain, loose weave; also called gunnysack cloth. Coarse texture, solid colors. Natural and synthetic ibers imitate jute burlap.

Burn-out A method of printing designs into semisheer or lightweight casement cloths. Usually a cotton polyester base fabric printed with an acid design that eats or dissolves the cotton. Edges around the burn-out area are often printed with pigment ink to seal edges. Also used to produce eyelet holes. Also called etch printing.

Chevron Regular and repeated zigzag pattern, also called herringbone, formed by reversing the twill weave. Fabric is of natural and/or synthetic ibers. Medium weight to heavyweight.

Chiffon Sheer, very lightweight ninon or voile drapery fabric. Also a soft inish given to a fabric, such as chiffon velvet.

Chintz Lightweight ine cotton or cotton/polyester plain-weave fabric. Solid colors or loral or exotic prints. Most often sized or glazed—hence, glazed chintz. It is a multipurpose fabric.

Corduroy Medium-weight to heavyweight pile-weave cotton or cotton-blend fabric. Lengthwise cords or wales are named according to width: pinwale corduroy—narrow wales wide-wale corduroy—large wales

Crepe Calico Lightweight cotton or cotton/polyester fabric similar to broadcloth. Usually printed in small country-style multicolored loral patterns.

Cambric Semisheer to lightweight plain-weave cotton or linen fabric, often printed. May be inished dull and soft or stiff with a sheen. Also called handkerchief linen.

Canvas Versatile medium-weight to heavyweight cotton fabric in plain or twill weave. May be dyed any color and has many uses such as upholstery, shades, and awnings.

Casement Lightweight to medium-weight casual drapery fabric. Plain or combination weave or needle-constructed fabric. Interesting texture, color, and pattern through dyed novelty yarns and weave variations. May be semisheer, translucent, or opaque.

Chambray Lightweight cotton or blend fabric in plain, balanced weave. Yarns are slightly slubbed in both directions. Usually white warp and colored weft or illing.

A ine yarn that is twisted so tightly that it gives a pebbly or crinkled surface in woven fabrics. Crepe may be plain or satin weave and includes the following types: canton crepe—heavy fabric with ribs chiffon crepe—soft inish thin crepe crepe-de-chine—sheer, very thin, limp crepe crepon crepe—heavy crosswise ribs faille crepe—ine horizontal ribs lat crepe—smooth, ine surface plissé crepe—puckered or crinkled surface

Cretonne Medium-weight unglazed printed cotton fabric slightly heavier than chintz. Versatile decorative fabric similar to toile.

Crewel Embroidery Medium-weight compound fabric. Base cloth is basket weave of cotton, linen, or wool, with hand or machine embroidery of worsted wool. Patterns are meandering vine and loral motifs based on English interpretations of the Eastern Indian tree-of-life motifs.

Crinoline Same as buchram.

Fabric

351

Damask

Felt

Medium-weight Jacquard fabric with reversible pattern, historically a large loral or Renaissance design. Contemporary damasks are medium weight in a variety of designs; multiple-use fabric.

A nonwoven fabric made of wool and perhaps hair and cotton ibers compressed with moisture, heat, and agitation. Felt comes in many weights, from craft felts to upholstery and interlining felts.

Denim

Flamestitch

Medium-weight sturdy twill cotton or cotton/polyester cloth. Navy-colored denim is jeans fabric; cream or white denim is drill.

Dimity Thin, very lightweight semisheer fabric in plain weave with a crisp inish. Vertical warp spaced ribs or cords are formed with heavier or piled threads. Checks may also be woven in. One color or contrasting thread may form the ribs, cords, or checks.

Dotted Swiss Plain- or leno-weave Swiss is sheer curtain fabric, within tiny embroidered or locked dots or squares in spaced sequence.

Duck Durable medium-weight cotton fabric in oxford weave similar to canvas. Different-sized weft threads and the addition of colored stripes may vary the appearance.

Embroidery A thread or set of threads sewn onto a fabric for surface ornamentation. Types include: piecework—embroidery done by hand crewel embroidery—tree-of-life motifs originating in India done by hand-guided machine using a looped crewel stitch schifli embroidery—decorative machine embroidery for mass production

Eyelet Lightweight cotton, cotton/polyester, or other blend plain-weave fabric with schifli-embroidered designs and small burn-out or etched dots that are part of the design. The fabric is usually a solid white, cream, or pastel color with matching or accenting embroidery. Also comes in smaller widths—usually 5, 7, 11, and 14 inches—with scalloped borders.

A pattern originally from the Early English Renaissance that represents the lames of a ire and is loosely a chevron design. Flamestitch patterns are multicolored and may be embroidered, woven, or printed on various weight cloths.

Flannel Any fabric that is woven and then brushed to achieve a soft nap. Types include: cotton lannel, lannelette—lightweight, thin fabric used for lannel sheets outing lannel—medium weight, suitable for upholstery; pilling may be a problem french lannel—ine plain-weave lannel melton lannel—heavyweight cotton and/or wool dense plain weave; used for interlining and stiffening as a support fabric suede lannel—two-sided nap, trimmed and pressed

Foam back Loose adjective for a latex or other synthetic coating laminated, lowed, or sprayed onto the back of drapery and upholstery fabrics to increase energy eficiency and/or dimensional stability.

Frieze or Frisé Heavyweight, sturdy nylon upholstery fabric with a looped pile. May be a Jacquard weave to achieve a sculptural or ribbed effect. Types include: Grospoint—frieze in even or staggered rows with large loops; may also be Jacquard woven petit point—very small loops; resembles ine hand needlepoint

Gabardine Steep-pitched twill fabric woven of natural or synthetic yarns; lightweight to medium weight. Surface has obvious diagonal ribs that are tightly woven of ine, lustrous yarns.

Gauze Faille A lightweight, inely woven fabric generally of cotton, silk, acetate, rayon, or blends, with horizontal or weft ribs that are slightly heavier and latter than taffeta. When these ribs are pressed or calendered in a watermark design, faille becomes moiré.

Very thin (sheer or semisheer) loosely woven fabric used for curtains and draperies.

Gimp Narrow braid trimming in many designs for drapery and upholstery. Also term for metallic cording.

352

Chapter 13

Grenadine

Khaki

Thin, sheer leno-weave curtain fabric. May be locked or swivel lappet embroidered with small dots or designs.

Multipurpose twill or plain-weave fabric of a greenish, dusty, earthy beige. Lightweight to medium-weight cotton or blend ibers.

Grosgrain Narrow trimming ribbon or textile with round, even, heavy ribs in the weft or crosswise direction.

Herringbone Originally a medium-weight wool fabric. Pattern is a novelty or complex twill that is a regular zigzag pattern. Named after the spinal structure of the herring ish. May also be woven or printed on lightweight, medium-weight, and heavyweight fabrics and in a variety of natural or synthetic ibers.

Homespun Coarse, lightweight wool, linen, or cotton fabric from Early American hand-spun and handwoven plain-weave textiles. Today in nearly any iber, a textile that imitates this look. May be natural colors with lecks of vegetable matter. May also be simple stripes or checks.

Hopsacking Similar to plain homespun yet less sturdy. Usually woven in a loose, semiopen basket weave and given a soft inish. Lightweight casement fabric.

Houndstooth

Knit Knit fabrics are produced on multiple-needle knitting machines and include: rachel, raschel knit—warp knit casement fabrics single or jersey—lightweight knit with weft ribs used for fabrics such as tricot double knit—heavier knit textiles stretch knits—elastomeric threads for stretch upholstery Knit terry cloth—knit toweling

Lace A lightweight machine-made or handmade, needleconstructed fabric of natural or synthetic yarns. Open, loral, or geometric patterns sometimes on a net background, lace is typically used for curtains, draperies, and table settings. Geometric lace for contrast settings is sometimes termed architectural lace.

Lampas Medium-weight Jacquard fabric with a plain or satin background and igures of contrasting colors in both the warp and weft in ribbed, plain, or twill weave.

Medium-weight to heavyweight fabric with woven twill pattern in contrasting color that resembles squares with projecting toothlike corners called four-pointed twill stars. Originally a coarse provincial wool fabric, now in a variety of ibers and may be woven in iner yarns.

Lappet

Interfacing

Fine, thin fabric that is the base cloth for batiste, organdy, and printed sheer fabrics. Usually cotton, linen, rayon, or blends.

A lightweight, stiffened woven or nonwoven fabric that is usually placed between decorative and lining fabric to give body and irmness. White or solid colors.

Swivel or discontinuous (no loats carried on back) embroidery accomplished with an attachment to the plain or dobby loom.

Lawn

Leno

A thick, lofty woven or nonwoven textile of natural or synthetic ibers used to insulate against noise or heat and/or cold. May be a polyester batt or lambs’ wool batt, for example.

A variation of the plain weave in which pairs of warp threads are twisted in hourglass fashion as they interlock weft threads to give strength and texture. Used in thin, very lightweight, marquisette sheers as well as lightweight casement fabrics.

Jacquard

Lining

Any textile woven on the Jacquard loom, which permits large designs to be machine woven. Used for both cloth and carpeting, Jacquard fabrics are brocade, brocatelle, matelassé, lampas, tapestry, and moquette velvet.

A lightweight support fabric (cotton, synthetic ibers, or blends) in plain or sateen weave sewn onto or used as a separate backing for the decorative fabrics.

Interlining

Malimo Jersey Single vertical knit fabric that includes tricot and some stretch knits. Fabric is usually lightweight, though some upholstery stretch jersey fabrics are medium weight.

Casement, contemporary fabric where groups of weft yarns are chain stitched together in clear monoilament thread with multiple needles. Groups of warp threads may also be laid and stitched into the top of the weft groups.

Fabric

353

Marquisette

Ottoman

A thin, sheer curtain or drapery cloth of natural or synthetic ibers in a leno weave. Slightly heavier than ninon or grenadine.

Natural or man-made ibers woven in a medium-weight to heavyweight fabric with broad, round weft threads that produce a horizontal rib. Fine warp threads completely cover the large-, even-, or alternate-sized illing yarns.

Matelassé A heavyweight textile in Jacquard weave of two sets of warps and wefts. Background surface appears puffy or cushioned since the sets of threads are woven together only where the pattern is. Also called double cloth or pocket weave.

Moiré Lightweight to medium-weight faille fabric embossed with a watermark moiré pattern. A versatile fabric.

Oxford Cloth A lightweight cotton or cotton/polyester fabric in an oxford variation of the plain weave: Pairs of warp threads are grouped together and carried over and under a heavier illing yarn. Often used as a base cloth for decorative prints and may be woven with slightly heavier yarns to produce a medium-weight fabric. Oxford cloth is traditionally a inely woven shirting cloth.

Paisley

Thin cotton cloth of a plain balanced weave similar to lawn but stiffer. Muslin forms the base for several cotton fabrics. May be natural (bleached or unbleached), dyed, or printed. Also lower-thread-count bed sheets.

A printed or woven pattern in lightweight or mediumweight fabrics. The curved pear, leaf, or water drop shape originated in India but is named for a city in Scotland where woolen paisley shawls have been produced for centuries.

Mylar

Pellon

Muslin

Trade name of the DuPont Corporation for a clear or metallized extruded material. Use in lat sheets such as relective wallpaper backgrounds or cut into ribbons, texturized, and woven to achieve a novelty-textured fabric.

Needlepoint Heavy upholstery-weight textile of tight hand-stitched wool yarn on art canvas net. Types include: petit point—iner needlepoint using very tiny stitches grospoint—coarser, larger embroidered stitches

Net Historically made by hand as a base for lace, now a machine-, needle-, and open-construction thin textile with a background of square, diamond, hexagonal, or irregularly shaped mesh.

Ninon Very ine sheer drapery and curtain fabric in pair warp thread plain-weave variation. Usually of polyester in varying widths up to 118 inches seamless. It has excellent drapability, crisp body, and a lustrous appearance. Sometimes called French voile, triple voile, or tergal voile.

Organdy Plain-weave sheer curtain and drapery cloth of natural or synthetic ibers (originally cotton), which is given a stiff, very crisp inish. A semisheer organdy is called semiorgandy.

Stiffened interfacing fabric that is a trademark of the Pellon Corporation.

Percale Lightweight plain-weave cotton or cotton/polyester fabric in a ine yarn and high thread count. Finely woven bed sheets are generally percale. Percale is inished to a variety of lusters from soft to stiff or given a textured plissé inish.

Pile Fabric Medium-weight to heavyweight fabric with an extra set of warp or weft threads that are woven or knitted into the fabric to produce a deep surface texture. Examples include velvets, terry cloths, friezes, and corduroys.

Piqué Lightweight to medium-weight versatile cloth in a plainweave variation, which inserts raised cords, stripes, or geometric patterns. The rib or cord usually runs lengthwise in the face of the goods. Types include: bird’s-eye—lightweight diaper cloth, small geometric three-dimensional weave goose-eye—larger bird’s-eye with diamond-shape pattern in relief, lightweight dimity—thin, semisheer fabric with lengthwise ribs of heavier threads ribcord or pinwale—medium-weight fabric with lengthwise ribs, often used for bedspreads and draperies embossed piqué—design pressed or calendered into face of fabric wafle piqué—three-dimensional square patterns

354

Chapter 13

Plaid Lightweight, medium-weight, or heavyweight yarn dyed, woven, or printed with a design consisting of stripes in both warp and weft directions that cross at intervals to form different colors in square or rectangular patterns. Plaids may be plain or twill weave. Variations include: tartans—Scottish clan plaids plaidback—reversible plaid

Plissé A sheer, thin, or lightweight fabric given a blistered or puckered surface through chemical treatments.

Polished Cotton Lightweight to medium-weight plain or sateen weave cotton fabric with smooth, lustrous yarns. Sateen weave is also called glosheen. Unglazed chintz may be classiied as polished cotton.

lustrous surface. Lightweight to medium weight. Types include: antique satin—horizontal slubs to imitate silk shantung lining satin—lightweight drapery lining fabric ribbed satin—resembles faille or calendered into satin moiré satin damask—background satin with Jacquard pattern; lighter weight known as ticking satin upholstery satin—heavier-weight satins, may be the base cloth for Jacquard weaves

Schiffli Any fabric with machine-embroidered designs, other than dotted swiss, eyelet, and swivel or lappet embroidery. Threads may be one color or variegated. Embroidered on fabric from very sheer to very heavyweight and in simple to complex patterns.

Scrim Poplin Lightweight to medium-weight fabric with pronounced horizontal ribs. Weft threads are heavier than warp. Often a base cloth for decorative print fabrics.

Quilted Fabric Any fabric that is lined and usually interlined with a lofty batt and then hand or machine stitched through so that stitches show both front and back. Pinsonic quilting is often used for mass-produced bedspreads, where layers are fused together with ultrasound heat in a predetermined pattern.

Rachel, Raschel Knit Also called warp-knit casement, a lightweight drapery fabric where knitted warps form the body of the fabric.

Rep, Repp A horizontally or vertically ribbed fabric in plain weave with heavier threads in one direction. Durable medium to heavy fabric with many applications. High-quality reps are often of wool.

Very thin plain-weave cloth with loose construction. Types include: theater scrim—sheer, curtain-weight, softer, more drapable upholstery scrim—woven or nonwoven web dust cover fabric for the bottom of upholstered pieces.

Seersucker Lightweight to medium-weight cotton or cotton blend plain-weave fabric. Crinkled or puckered surface usually in spaced stripes or plaids, permanently woven. Or permanent puckers are formed in polyester by heat-setting.

Serge Lightweight to medium-weight fabric in natural or synthetic ibers (originally silk) in durable, crisply inished twill weave.

Shade Cloth Plain or plain-weave variation, such as canvas, poplin, or oxford. Medium weight to lightweight, it is stiffened to become roller shade fabric. Also called Holland cloth.

Sailcloth Same as duck, sometimes heavier.

Shantung

A horizontal satin lightweight to medium-weight fabric. Used for linings and printed decorator fabrics in natural or man-made ibers.

Originally a spun silk fabric with slubs that formed interesting and exotic textures. Shantung today is a lightweight fabric of natural or synthetic ibers. Fabrics that imitate shantung are antique satin (sateen-weave rayon/ acetate) and antique taffeta (plain weave).

Satin

Sheer

A basic type of weave where warp threads loat over four to eight weft threads and then are interlaced or tied down with one weft thread. Fine thread yields a smooth,

A translucent or transparent thin, very lightweight curtain or drapery fabric. Examples include ninon, chiffon, grenadine, marquisette, swiss, and voile.

Sateen

Fabric

355

Yarns with slight irregularities in diameter and proile, originated with wild silk yarns where ilaments are knotted or joined.

casings). Today a woven or printed stripe, in one color on cream or white. Multiuse fabric. Mattress ticking may also be a satin damask fabric, called damask ticking or ticking damask.

Strié

Toile

Slubs

Also called jaspé, meaning shadow stripes, a sateen or satin weave with colored warp threads that produce a inely blended vertical stripe. Lightweight to mediumweight multipurpose fabric in natural or synthetic ibers or blends.

Suedecloth A lightweight to medium-weight synthetic knit or woven textile with brushed nap that imitates genuine suede.

Swiss A very thin, semisheer curtain fabric of plain weave. It is a crisply inished fabric and may be embellished with woven or locked dots or igures. Originally of cotton, today it is often polyester. Also called swiss muslin.

A lightweight to medium-weight cotton or linen fabric similar to muslin or percale in plain or sometimes twill weave. It is similar to a heavier unglazed chintz. Toiles are typically roller- or screen-printed in one color: gold, navy, green, red, or black on a cream background. Types include: toile de Jouy—eighteenth- and nineteenth-century rural scenes and people; originating in Jouy, France federal toile—American federal buildings and eagles country toile—contemporary provincial loral patterns

Tricot Nylon jersey knit that has a weft-only stretch. Lightweight, limp fabric.

Taffeta

Tufted Fabric

A plain, balanced weave in lightweight fabric of natural or man-made ibers. Weft threads are slightly larger, creating a ine horizontal rib. Types include:

A pile fabric that is formed by tufting a yarn into a woven background. Early American tufted bedspreads are one example. Some upholstery fabrics and all tufted carpets utilized this method. The fabric may be tufted with a small handheld tufting gun or on a large machine that utilizes multiple needles, tufting entire sections in rapid sequence.

moiré taffeta—calendered as moiré; pressed ribs make the classic watermark pattern faille taffeta—heavier-ribbed taffeta antique taffeta—horizontal slubs, a reversible fabric paper taffeta—very crisp inish, often woven in plaid patterns

Tapestry A plain-weave technique used to produce heavy, complex, handwoven European pictorial tapestries. These are now most often Jacquard-weave fabrics with multiple warps and wefts and are very heavy fabric. Tapestry techniques are also used for handmade lat, reversible folk rugs and further apply to a large category of fabric and nonfabric wall hangings or textiles. Tufted wall hangings may also be referred to as tapestries.

Terry Medium-weight pile weave used for absorbent cotton terry cloth toweling. Loops may be cut for a plush or velour surface texture or left uncut as loops.

Textured Polyester Lightweight to medium-weight multipurpose fabric with heat-set, permanent textures.

Tweed Heavy upholstery-weight textile in plain balanced or variation weave or (originally) twill-weave variation. Plain and twill weaves may also be combined. Made irst of wool in Scotland, today’s tweeds may be of wool, nylon, or a combination of natural and man-made ibers in solid colors, a heathered effect, or plaid.

Union Cloth A coarse, medium-weight cloth that is approximately 50 percent cotton, 50 percent linen. Yarns are calendered or lattened somewhat. Union cloth may be dyed one color or printed and often resembles a very coarse chintz. Versatile fabric with many uses.

Velour A heavy pile fabric with a soft, velvetlike texture that includes some velvets and all plush-pile surface cloths, such as velour terry.

Velvet Ticking Originally a twill navy blue and cream vertically woven striped fabric used to make ticks (mattress and pillow

Woven pile fabric with a soft yet sturdy face. May be of one or more ibers, including cotton, linen, wool, silk, rayon, acrylic, and nylon. Types include:

356

Chapter 13

antique velvet—streaks pressed or woven in: slubs on woven back, or slight strié effect brocaded—etch-printed or burn-out pattern, often exposing the woven background chiffon velvet—thick, soft surface inish velvet crushed velvet—varies from light to heavy crushing of pile electrostatic velvet—locked, rather than woven pile, usually bold color and pattern embossed velvet—bas-relief roller calendering to produce pressed-in pattern moquette velvet—exposed ground with loral historic patterns of cut and uncut looped pile in Jacquard weave panne velvet—pile lays lat, pressed in one direction plush velvet—deeper pile, sometimes crushed

upholstery velvet—deep thick pile and sturdy back velveteen—short, cotton-faced pile and back printed velveteen—roller or screen printed, typically in loral or geometric patterns

Vinyl Extruded polyvinyl chloride (vinyon) synthetic fabric lowed onto a woven, knitted, or nonwoven base cloth. Medium-weight to heavyweight upholstery fabric, which is also called imitation leather or artiicial leather.

Voile Sheer, transparent fabric in plain weave with tightly twisted yarns. Often has a stiff inish. May have novelty effects such as piqué stripes, printed patterns or stripes, or woven with nubby yarns for novelty voile.

Chapter 14 Art and Accessories

Fine Art 358 Decorative Art 362 Objects from Nature 370 Other Accessories 371 The Use of Accessories 371 Contract Considerations 374

Photo © Kathryn Taylor

358

Chapter 14

Art has been an integral part of interiors since prehistoric times, when early humans painted the walls and ceilings of caves with images expressing their relationship to the world they knew. Throughout every period of history, people in cultures the world over have created works of art that served to enhance, embellish, and even sanctify the interiors they occupied. In today’s society, we have devised categories such as ine art and decorative arts as a way of organizing the myriad of things we see that have artistic qualities. Works of art add great distinction and individuality to interiors because their selection represents personal taste and experience.

Fine Art The i ne arts are concerned with the creation of two- and three-dimensional works of art, designed as expressions of beauty and faith or as a statement of the personal meaning or feeling of the artist. The great masters are those throughout the ages who have excelled in the creation of art and whose work has passed the test of time to become what we call classics. Every era has its masters, and these men and women were often aware of each other and the work produced by each artist. This mutual awareness often produced similarities in philosophy, technique, subject matter, or other areas of inluence. Art historians have classiied the work of the masters into schools according to these similarities and inluences. Many of the masters were equally comfortable drawing with a pencil, painting with a brush, or working sculpture with their hands. The ine arts include sculpture, painting, mosaic, drawing, and printmaking.

a number of different vehicles (substances that give the pigment form and body). The paint can be thinned with different media and manipulated by pouring, dripping, splashing, or applying with brushes, sponges, or palette knives to many different surfaces such as plaster, wood, canvas and other textiles, paper, glass, or any material or surface capable of holding the paint. • Oil paint is colored pigment mixed with linseed oil or varnish and thinned with turpentine. Oil painting is very versatile because the color application can be thick or thin, opaque or transparent. Oils tend to be one of the most permanent types of painting, which may account for their popularity with collectors. • Watercolor is colored pigment mixed with gum arabic and thinned with water. The pigments are slightly transparent. Because the water used as a medium dries quickly, the artist must work rapidly to complete the painting. This technique typically imparts a fresh, underworked quality to the inished piece. • Acrylic can duplicate the appearance of oils and watercolors. It is made of plastic and can be mixed with several kinds of media or thinned with water. Its appearance can be opaque or transparent. The untrained eye may ind it dificult to distinguish acrylics from the older, more traditional oils and watercolors. Many artists enjoy the versatility provided by a single medium capable of so many different effects.

Sculpture Sculpture is a three-dimensional art form created by carving stone; working clay, wood, or other materials; or casting or assembling metal. Sculpture may represent the human form, animal forms, or other forms from nature in a realistic, conventionalized, or abstract fashion. Bas-relief is French for “low relief.” It is a type of sculpture carved or cast in a lat manner where the design is raised from the background to create a three-dimensional effect. Bas-relief is often seen in friezes (sculptural panels or bands) used on exteriors, in interiors, and even on furniture and small decorative objects.

Painting Painting is a one-of-a-kind, two-dimensional art form created with colored pigments and

Figure 14.1 Fine-art pieces such as the painting above the mantel add great interest and individuality to a space and help draw the eye to the grouping around the fireplace, establishing a primary focal point in the room. Design by Siemasko + Verbridge/photo © Brian Vanden Brink

Art and Accessories

• Tempera, one of the oldest types of paint, is pigment mixed with egg and thinned with water. It is somewhat transparent but more opaque than watercolor. Budding artists at kindergarten easels often use a form of tempera to create their bright, fresh, uninhibited paintings, and tempera poster paints are frequently used to create banners and posters. However, the tempera used by ine artists is much more reined than poster paint. Fine tempera is often called gouache. • Fresco is the Italian word for “fresh” and denotes a combination of pigment and limewater applied with brushes to fresh, damp plaster. When it dries, the pigment and plaster become uniied. The artist must work quickly, and plaster is applied only as far as the artist can work before it dries. Frescoes were often used to decorate the ceiling and walls of Renaissance buildings.

Mosaic Mosaic is a two-dimensional art form made of tesserae (small pieces of marble, tile, or colored glass) itted together to form a pattern. The design is held in place with plaster or cement. The Romans used mosaics to decorate their loors, and artists in the Byzantine empire took the art of mosaic to a high level of perfection. The interiors of Byzantine churches shimmer with scintillating mosaic designs of great beauty.

Drawing Drawings are also one-of-a-kind, two-dimensional art forms produced with pencil, pen and ink, charcoal, chalk, crayon, or grease pencil on paper or other surfaces. Drawing is considered a fundamental skill for artists. Drawings are produced as inished works and also as preliminary studies in the development of paintings, sculpture, and other art. The work of the masters often includes a large body of drawings that were used as studies for later work and now stand by themselves as treasured art pieces.

Printmaking Printmaking is a method of creating mass-produced two-dimensional ine art. Prints are produced in limited editions by the artist, who prepares a screen, plate, block, or stone and then makes a numbered set of prints. The artist signs and numbers the prints that are of acceptable quality. The numbers read as a fraction and indicate how many copies were made and the order in which they were printed. For example, 8/10 would indicate that a particular print was the eighth print out of a total of ten. Generally, the smaller the number of prints produced, the greater the value. Several screens, plates, or blocks

359

representing different parts of the design can be utilized to create multicolored prints. When using more than one run of color, each plate, screen, or block must be carefully registered (aligned) to produce a clear and even print. • A woodcut or wood block print is made by carving a design into the lat surface of a piece of wood. The background is cut away, leaving the pattern standing out in relief. The block is then inked and printed to create a negative or reverse pattern on the paper. A wood engraving is executed in the same way, except that the pattern is carved into the harder end grain of the wood, a technique that usually results in a iner and more precise design. • A linoleum block print is made by cutting a pattern into a piece of heavy-gauge linoleum. The process is similar to the woodcut process except that the design will have less detail in the form because of the softness of the linoleum. Woodcut, wood engraving, and linoleum block printing are all forms of relief printing because the portion of the pattern that receives the ink and does the printing stands out in relief. • Engravings are prints made from a metal plate that has lines hand-engraved (scratched) with a tool called a burin. These lines make small impressions or grooves in the plate. The plate is covered with ink and then wiped clean, leaving ink only in the grooves. The plate and paper are pressed together so that the ink is transferred from the grooves in a negative impression onto the paper. • Etchings are made by covering a metal plate with an acid-resistant substance such as wax. The artist uses a needle to draw through the wax. The plate is immersed in an acid bath that bites or etches the design into the metal wherever the wax has been scratched away. After the plate is etched and the remaining wax removed, the plate is used to print in the same manner as an engraving. Because wax is less dificult to cut than a metal plate, etching designs tend to be less rigid than engravings. Engravings and etchings are forms of intaglio, where printing is done with the ink in the plate’s recesses. • Lithographs are produced on the principle that water and grease repel each other. The artist creates a design on a smooth limestone block or metal plate with a grease pencil or with a brush and tusche (a waxy liquid). The block or plate is then chemically treated to attract ink to the greasy design and water (which repels the ink) to the untouched portions of the stone or plate. The stone or plate is then charged (wetted) with water and ink and pressed together with the paper to create a negative image. • Serigraphy, or silk-screen printing, utilizes a ine screen of silk or other iber and stencils cut to create a positive, direct (not reversed) image. The stencils

360

Chapter 14

are applied to the screen and ink is squeegeed across the pattern, forcing a thin layer of ink onto the surface being printed through the open areas of fabric where there is no stencil.

Graphic Art, Photography, Reproductions, and Rubbings • Graphic art includes posters designed to publicize athletic contests, concerts, plays, shows of artists’ works, and other cultural events. Maps, botanical drawings, architectural drawings, fashion illustrations, book illustrations, and even some mechanical or architectural drawings may also have value as graphic art. These are often worthy of display on the merits of their ine design and, in time, may become valuable. Posters and other graphics are an important resource for people who love art but are unable to afford paintings and other art forms. Another type of popular graphic art is produced by creating sayings or words, in a variety of fonts, on a computer. These are reproduced in vinyl lettering and applied to plaques, designed to be hung on walls, or applied directly to a wall (over a doorway, for example). • Photographs are pictures or likenesses obtained by photography, which is the art or process of producing images by the action of radiant energy (especially light) on a sensitive surface such as ilm, or in the case of digital photography, a CCD (charge-coupled device) chip. The images produced by any photographic means may have artistic merit and photography is

Figure 14.2 A graphic art poster from the Victoria and Albert Museum in London has been simply framed for display in this office. Photo © Kathryn Taylor

considered an important ine-art form. Good photographs, properly displayed, make attractive and sometimes personal ine-art accessories. • Color photography is appealing because of the wonderful sense of life expressed by the image. Colors in a photograph may form the basis for a color scheme or be selected to enhance an interior color palette. Colored images, however, may fade over time making them lose their original appeal. To avoid this, select archival safe, low-E (emission) glass that screens out and prevents ultraviolet (UV) light from damaging the photograph. • Black and white photographs create a different kind of impact because details that may be unnoticed in a colored photo become dynamic in black and white. There is often a stronger graphic quality without color. One of the primary reasons for selecting black and white photographs for display is that they are not subject to fading in the same manner as colored photos. • Sepia-toned photographs, like black and white, are monotone, but are brownish gray to dark olive brown in color. Sepia tone is often chosen to enhance the dramatic or pictorial effect of a photograph or to create an aged, antique look. • Digital images, taken with digital cameras, can be printed and displayed in the same manner as ilmbased photographs. Film-based photo prints and slides can be scanned and converted into digital images. Digital images can be manipulated and enhanced with computer software such as Photoshop to alter the photograph in countless ways. Scanned images of older ilm-based photos can be repaired and touched up, eliminating defects that are caused by age and handling. Digital photos can also be merged with other digital images to create distinctive photographs. Digital picture frames display digital photographs that can be rotated on a timer for a constantly changing display, and digital images can be projected to create unique interior still or moving effects as seen in Figure 1.23. • Reproductions are copies of the artist’s work and are an important educational tool. Without them, people unable to visit the world’s museums would ind it dificult to study the history of art. When specifying reproductions, it is important to remember that once the original piece of art is complete, the quality control of the reproduction is generally out of the artist’s hands; the quality of reproductions ranges from excellent to poor. Reproductions may be the same dimensions as the original or may be scaled from postcard size to full poster size or larger. Color quality of reproductions may also vary. For example, colors that were red in the original may appear violet in the reproduction.

Art and Accessories

Despite these drawbacks, reproductions are an affordable means of bringing great art into the interior. • Rubbings are not a true form of printmaking, though they are often framed and used in much the same way as prints. Rubbings are made by placing a sheet of paper over a lat metal or stone plaque—such as a grave marker or an architectural detail that has a lat bas-relief or a raised pattern. The paper is then rubbed with a crayon or chalk to create a direct image of the pattern beneath. The quality of the piece is determined by the care and skill of the person doing the rubbing.

Obtaining Fine Art

361

important to be discriminating and choose pieces of ine quality and lasting value. Obtaining art for our homes is certainly a matter of personal taste, but the more we learn about art, the greater our level of enjoyment and appreciation. The design of a home is a relection of personal style, and the art chosen for such settings should also be a statement of discrimination and taste. Unfortunately, many people are underexposed to quality art. Designers or consultants could be used to help make wise selections, but the most pleasing and personal collections belong to persons who put forth the effort to become knowledgeable about art and its history. Not everything that is advertised as original art is worthy of collection. Knowledge, training, and exposure are the only means to ensure wise selection. Following are some important guidelines to help develop the conidence to choose ine-quality art:

Art can be found at many locations in a vast range of prices. The works of the great masters are generally sold for enormous sums at auction houses like Christie’s or Sotheby’s in London and New York. Some less well known • Do not be intimidated by a blank wall—it may have but important pieces are sold by art and antique dealers more appeal than a piece of poor art. Take the time who operate retail shops and galleries. Contemporary artand steps necessary to develop conidence in your ists are usually represented by galleries and dealers who ability to choose. act as agents for the artist. Galleries may specialize in a • Those who are seriously interested in collecting art will certain type of art such as historic, Oriental, or Western. study its history. This can be done formally or inforArt-minded communities and organizations often sponmally with classes or independent study. Study of art sor art festivals where artists informally display and sell their work. Some businesses and corporations sponsor art shows or display artists’ works that may be purchased. People who have less to spend on art pieces should know that art teachers and artists who need to inance travels and studies will often sell their work at relatively reasonable prices and artists frequently will barter services for art. Schools of art may have shows of student work, much of which is for sale. Because they have not usually established a reputation, students tend to sell their work at lower prices. Economical graphic art or posters can be purchased—sometimes obtained without charge—directly from museum shops or from organizations sponsoring the event being publicized in the poster. Old posters, prints, and maps can frequently be found at lea markets or bookshops. When collecting art, one should be prepared to pay fair market prices, though the price is less important than the quality and appeal of a piece. Print shops specialize in graphic designs from museums, galleries, shows, and other cultural events. In addition, this type of shop will often have ine photography in Figure 14.3 Framed photographs of Brazil, England, France, and Italy are hung poster format and reproductions of the mas- over a stairway next to an informal dining area. The photographs were taken ters’ works in varying sizes of posters. It is while the home owners lived abroad. Photo © Kathryn Taylor

362

Chapter 14

history builds a sincere appreciation and understanding of art and those who created it. • Taking art classes and attempting to actually create works of art add profound depth to the appreciation of art and help build the ability to see quality. • Visiting museums of ine art to observe irsthand the works of the great masters and contemporary artists sharpens the ability to discriminate. It provides the kind of exposure that enables a buyer to detect the difference between real art and the poor-quality pieces we see advertised as “original oil paintings.” • As with anything of real value, it takes time and effort to build an understanding and appreciation of art. It is a lifelong pursuit and an important part of the process of developing the ability to discriminate. It is a goal worth the effort, however, because of the satisfaction that ine art provides.

Preparing Art for Display When purchasing a piece of art, it may be necessary to select a frame, mat (heavy lat paper frame), or some other means of display that will show the piece to best advantage and add to its quality and character. Frames are available in unassembled kits or are ready-made from art shops, from paint stores, on the Internet, and by mail. In some places there may be hobby shops or specialty shops where customers can cut mats and make and assemble their own frames. However, with truly ine pieces of art, it may be worthwhile to consult a qualiied framer who understands art conservation and can advise on the proper method and materials for displaying and preserving art pieces. Following are some suggestions for framing ine art: • Generally, oil paintings are framed but left unglazed (not covered with glass). They may be framed with heavy, elaborate period frames that often include a fabric liner to separate the painting from the frame. Contemporary oils and acrylics may be left unframed, or they may be treated with a simple, minimal frame. • Watercolors, drawings, photographs, and prints are frequently framed behind glass with simple, narrow frames and a mat that keeps the painting from touching the glass. Clear glass is preferable to nonglare glass or Plexiglas. Nonglare glass does not allow clear color and line transmission. Plexiglas is subject to scratching and bowing. Posters can be framed like watercolors or prints but can also be mounted behind glass with no frame, with the glass and backing held together by clips. When mounting paintings, prints, graphic designs, or reproductions, it is important not to cut or crop the piece to make it it a frame. Cropping destroys the value of the work. • For permanent display, matting and other materials that will come in contact with the art should be

acid-free. Look for matboards sold as archival, museum, or conservation quality. Avoid buffered matboard, which is acidic. Be aware that artworks framed before about 1980 are likely to have acidic mats, which are subject to deterioration.

Decorative Art The decorative arts include utilitarian pieces such as mirrors, tableware, baskets, clocks, screens, lamps, books, tapestries, and rugs as well as nonutilitarian pieces like igurines or statuettes. Objets d’art, bibelots, and curios are French terms used to describe both utilitarian and nonutilitarian objects of artistic value and beauty. Furniture, also considered a decorative art, is discussed in Chapter 9. Not all pieces created as decorative art have strict artistic value. Kitsch is a German term that connotes bad taste and is applied to pretentious or foolish art and design. In our contemporary world we are inundated by objects of mediocre or poor design. As people develop the ability to discriminate, they can sift out the kitsch from their environment and replace it with that which is ine and uplifting. It is worth the effort to ind good design in decorative and functional objects because it enriches and deepens our appreciation for true beauty. Both good and bad design can be found at every price level, and many times it costs no more to choose good design.

Mirrors In the fourteenth century the skilled artisans of Venice discovered that a layer of quicksilver sandwiched between a piece of tin and a piece of glass (a process called silvering) created a mirror. Today, mirrors are often used to add depth, a feeling of spaciousness, and sparkle to interiors. They can be obtained in many sizes and framed to harmonize with period styles or used in sheets large enough to cover entire walls. However, many people ind it uncomfortable to have to look at themselves in a mirror for prolonged periods when sitting or standing. Large areas of mirror on several different walls may visually duplicate the elements of a design in a manner that creates visual confusion and makes the space seem smaller. Mirror inishes or types include clear glass, smoked glass, Venetian glass (veined), beveled glass, leaded glass, and etched glass.

Tableware and Cookware Tableware is the term that describes plates, cups, drinking vessels, and latware or eating utensils. Artisans through the ages have lavished their inest creativity and the best

Art and Accessories

363

Ceramics Ceramics are made from clay that has been molded in its softened form into useful shapes and then ired or baked at high temperatures in an oven called a kiln. The soft clay can be molded by hand, formed in molds, or thrown on a potter’s wheel run by motor or foot power. Clay mixed with water to the consistency of thick cream is called slip and is used to ill molds and for other functions in the ceramic process. Glazes are thin layers of glass ired onto ceramic pieces to produce a glossy surface, to add colored effects, and to make the pieces nonabsorbent and sanitary. Glazes may be dull or shiny, clear or colored, and can be used by the ceramist to create decorative effects. Following is a list of ceramic types:

(A)

(B) Figure 14.4 Decorative art can be both useful and decorative. (A) Old Charley is an English Royal Doulton china character jug that serves as a decorative accessory. (B) On occasion, however, the jug can be employed in a more useful manner. Photos © Kathryn Taylor

developments of technology on the creation of beautiful and useful pieces for the table and kitchen. Materials of all kinds have been used to create tableware and cookware, and today plastics and other innovative space-age products are used alongside more traditional materials such as ceramics, glass, wood, and metal for the design of quality pieces. (The same materials are also used to create a wide variety of functional and decorative objects such as small sculpture, planters, containers, bookends, desk sets, and dressing or grooming accessories.)

• Porcelain is the highest-grade ceramic body. It is made of ine, white clay (kaolin) and feldspar (crystalline materials) and is ired at very high temperatures that vitrify the clay (change it to a glasslike substance), harden the glaze, and make the piece breakageresistant. Porcelain is sometimes used in the manufacture of ine dinnerware, vases, igurines, and other decorative objects. Porcelain may be plain or decorated with colored glazes and patterns. • China was the designation given by Europeans in the sixteenth century to the porcelain imported from the Orient. It contains a large percentage of animal bone ash (hence the term bone china) that produces a hard, translucent porcelain. Today, the terms china and porcelain are generally used synonymously. • Stoneware is a heavy, durable, thick pottery used for less formal dinnerware, serving and cooking pieces, and other art objects. Stoneware inishes may be less formal and show lecks and speckles in the clay or glaze. Stoneware inishes vary from natural browns, grays, and bluish grays to bright, lively colored patterns. • Earthenware is the most coarse and inexpensive of the ceramic bodies. It is derived from red earthen clays and often inished like a common clay lowerpot. It is ired at lower temperatures, making it softer and less durable. Earthenware products are sometimes referred to as terra-cotta, an Italian term that literally means “cooked earth.” It is commonly used for baking and serving pieces and other decorative pieces for the interior and garden.

Glass Glass is used to fashion decorative objects, dishes, serving pieces, and drinking vessels of all shapes and sizes. The quality and design of glassware ranges from inexpensive molded glass to ine lead crystal: • Molded or pressed glass is a method for mass-producing glass. Molten glass is poured into forms or molds of metal or wood. The mold often leaves a seam where

364

Chapter 14

Stemware is the name given to formal drinking pieces with a slender pedestal and raised bowl.

Wood Wood, aside from its use in construction and sculpture, was used historically to make crude plates, utensils, and serving pieces. Today it is still used to create beautiful art objects, both carved and plain, as well as serving pieces, handles for metal utensils and cookware, spoons, and other cooking implements.

Metals and Alloys Metals and alloys such as aluminum, brass, chrome, iron, steel, and stainless steel, together with gold, silver, pewter, bronze, and copper, are common materials used to fashion art objects, cookware, serving pieces, dinnerware, latware (silverware), ixtures, and hardware: • Gold, a bright, lustrous yellow, is the most precious, costly, and prestigious metal and was used historically to create dishes, latware, drinking vessels, candle holdFigure 14.5 Three different kinds of wooden pieces are displayed here: A wooden fretwork panel creates a strong graphic pattern on the wall, an abacus has outers, and other objects of art. Because of lived its calculating function to become an important vertical design element, its great expense, gold is used principally and four turned wooden vases add a contrasting soft line to this sensitively detoday as a plating for metal pieces or as signed composition of accessories. Photo © Brian Vanden Brink paper-thin sheets applied to objects in a process known as gold leaf. Gold electroplate is a type of latware created by the the molds meet. The molding process can be used to electrolytic process of layering pure gold form simple and functional glass shapes or to imitate over a silver/nickel alloy (silver plate). the look of cut glass. • Silver is a bright, lustrous, gray-white metal used in • Cut or etched glass is decorated with patterns inthe manufacture of objects of art and tableware. Stercised with chemicals or abrasives. The cut patterns ling silver is the inest and most costly, being by law are quite clear, and the etched designs have a frosted at least 92.5 percent pure silver. Sterling will tarnish appearance. and must be polished and protected from the air. It • Enameled glass is layered with a porcelainlike inish. becomes more beautiful with use, developing a soft • Cased glass is a layer of clear glass encased in a layer patina of almost invisible scratches. Sterling II is a of colored glass. latware that combines silver handles with stainless • Gilded glass has a layer of silver or gold applied to its steel blades, bowls, and tines, costing about half as surface. Enameled, cased, and gilded glass are often much as sterling silver. Silver plate is made of a silver/ engraved or cut to reveal patterns in the sparkling nickel alloy electroplated with pure silver. It is the clear glass layer underneath. most affordable type of silverware and is also used as • Crystal is a high-grade glass containing lead. Because a base for gold electroplate. of legal requirements, American lead crystal contains • Stainless steel is also used to make attractive, affordless lead than European lead crystal. Higher lead conable latware and serving pieces. These pieces are poptent makes the glass softer, allowing the glassmaker ular because they do not tarnish or scratch easily, and to cut more intricate designs. Fine lead crystal sparthey are strong, durable, and dishwasher safe. Some kles beautifully in the light and rings or sings when designs feature handles of wood or colorful plastic. tapped lightly with a ingernail. Crystal is used to cre• Pewter is a soft, dull gray alloy of tin, copper, lead, ate art objects, serving pieces, and drinking vessels. and antimony used to create dishes, drinking vessels,

Art and Accessories

365

and shine, it must be polished with copper paste and a soft cloth. Some copper pieces are coated with lacquer or other inishes that prevent tarnishing. These inishes must be removed if the piece is to actually be used for cooking or if a tarnished inish is desired. • Bronze is a deep reddish brown alloy of copper and tin used primarily for sculptural pieces or plaques. • Iron is cast or wrought (shaped and bent with heat) to make lighting ixtures, candle holders, and other decorative accessories. Cast iron is molded in its molten form to create substantial cookware and some art objects. Wrought iron pieces and heavy cast pieces such as corn pone or mufin molds, skillets, and Dutch ovens are frequently used as decorative accessories in less formal, country settings.

Plastics Plastics are used extensively to create informal tableware and other accessories for interiors. Plastic is generally less expensive than the other materials discussed in this chapter and can be used to create designs of great appeal and integrity. For example, some contemporary plastic dishes are bright, colorful, and well designed. Because they are relatively inexpensive, one can indulge in a splash of color without undue concern for budget. Plastic is sometimes used in a lighthearted manner to imitate natural materials such as glass or metal. This is particularly true in the manufacture of disposable objects that are not meant to be taken seriously. When plastic is used to imitate natural materials in a serious manner, the design becomes questionable. For example, plastic molded to resemble carved wood or ine cut crystal might only be considered kitsch.

Baskets Figure 14.6 Metal accessories add texture and color to this interior and complement the stainless steel refrigerator, stove, and range hood. A cast iron rack suspended above the bar holds pieces of stainless-steel-clad aluminum, copper, and cast iron. Photo © Kathryn Taylor

candle holders, and other art objects. Historically pewter was considered poor man’s silver. Today, though it is less costly than sterling, pewter is expensive. Once considered dangerous because of its lead content, pewter is now often made without lead and is safer and easier to care for. Pewter adds character and warmth to informal, provincial (country) settings. Less expensive imitations of pewter are made of cast aluminum. • Copper is a bright, shiny, pinkish brown metal used principally for cookware, because of its ability to conduct heat. When copper is allowed to tarnish, it irst turns reddish brown and then a beautiful blue-green called verdigris. To maintain the original copper color

Baskets are woven for function, each type or shape relecting its speciic use. Produced by almost every culture in the world, baskets incorporate beautiful patterns using materials such as wicker and willow. Because of their decorative nature, baskets make excellent additions to informal interiors, particularly when they serve a useful purpose such as a container for plants, bread, fruit, or fragrant potpourri.

Clocks Today, timepieces such as hourglasses, sundials, and antique clocks are collected as objects of art. Looking at ine clocks with intricately designed cases, we appreciate the cabinetmakers and furniture designers whose creative genius turned scientiic instruments into functional and decorative art. The design of clocks has changed over the years. Today’s high-tech clocks are often the work of industrial or product designers rather than furniture

366

Chapter 14

Figure 14.8 Coromandel screen. Figure 14.7 Baskets come in an interesting variety of shapes and textures that add interest to many kinds of interiors. In this rustic interior they are not only decorative but can also be taken down for use in the house or garden. Photo © Brian Vanden Brink

craftspersons, and these frank, sleek designs may be as beautiful in their own way as the handcrafted pieces of the past. Clocks may be displayed on shelves, mantels, brackets, or walls, or they may be loor clocks. Largescale loor clocks are often referred to as grandfather clocks, and those of a slightly smaller scale are called grandmother clocks. Clocks are frequently included as a feature in appliances such as radios, microwave ovens, stoves, and video equipment. These often utilize a digital display system that indicates the hour and minutes as digits instead of using the traditional clock face.

Screens Screens are hinged or sliding panels designed to divide and separate spaces or create areas of privacy. In today’s

Figure 14.9 Byobu screen.

interiors, screens are used as dividers, wall art, window treatments, and as backgrounds for furniture. Screens can be made of wood with solid panels or louvers, lattice, pierced wood, or wrought iron. Screens are also custom-made items that might be upholstered, covered

Art and Accessories

367

with mirrors, painted, lacquered, papered, or treated in other interesting ways. • Antique screens from Europe and America, with details appropriate to period styles, are attractive additions to interiors as functional dividers or simply as objects of art. Such screens were often traditionally used to create dressing spaces in bedrooms and bathrooms. • Coromandel are large Chinese blacklacquered folding screens, decorated with low relief, all-over patterns. They were introduced into Europe in the seventeenth century by the East India Company. • Byobu are small-scaled folding Japanese screens. They are decorated with scenes painted on silk or paper and are generally used as wall hangings, on tables, or as freestanding pieces in today’s interiors. • Shoji or fusuma are traditional Japanese screens made of mulberry or rice papers mounted onto a wooden frame. The frames are set into tracks or grooves as sliding panels or hinged and freestanding and used as partitions. Shoji are exterior sliding panels or window screens, and fusuma are decorative interior sliding room partitions or doors. Translucent transoms set above the screens add light through a grid or intricate design patterns. • Near Eastern screens are intricately patterned pierced wooden screens from Figure 14.10 The soft, subtle color and the muted quality of the painting on the Islamic cultures. The piercings create a Japanese byobu screen, seen on the raised cabinet behind the chair, contribute “blind” from which it is possible to see to the serenity of this Asian-inspired interior. A Japanese shoji screen and carved out without being seen. Islamic design wood transom frame the entrance to the room. Design by Eck/MacNeely Architects was taken to Spain in the eighth century Inc./photo © Brian Vanden Brink by invading Moors. The Near Eastern inluence can also be seen today in the screens of Mexico and other countries with Hispanic caddies (antique tea containers), ginger jars, cloisonné ties. Today, many pierced wooden screens are made in (enameled metal) and porcelain vases, as well as iguIndia and imported to Western countries. rines and other sculptural pieces, made into table lamps. Luminaire is the technical term used by lighting designers and engineers to describe table lamps, loor lamps, Decorative Lighting Fixtures and ceiling- or wall-mounted lighting ixtures such as chandeliers and sconces. (The term luminaire distinLighting ixtures have evolved over the centuries from guishes these lighting ixtures from the technical usage torches, oil- and gas-burning vessels, and candle holdof the term lamp, which refers to a lightbulb or luorescent ers into the electric ixtures we use today. (Architectural tube.) Following is a list of the most common art-lighting lighting and principles of lighting are discussed in Chapluminaires: ter 5.) Some of today’s most common lighting ixtures are electric versions of historical lighting pieces. It is • Table lamps are designed to sit on the table for general also common to see decorative objects such as metal tea lighting of a space or for reading, writing, and other

368

Chapter 14

Figure 14.11 Examples of structural and decorative table lamps, sconces, and chandeliers.

• •

• •

speciic tasks. Traditional designs usually incorporate a shade to diffuse the light. Floor lamps serve the same basic purposes as table lamps but are designed to stand on the loor. Torchère is a historical term that was used to describe a candle table or candle stand. Today it describes a type of loor lamp that casts its light upward onto the ceiling. Sconce is a wall-mounted luminaire of any style derived from wall-mounted torches or candle holders. Chandelier is a decorative, ceilingmounted, hanging, or pendant-type luminaire. This type of ixture functions best in high-ceiling rooms and in areas where a strong focal point is the intent of the design.

Many antique and contemporary lighting pieces are used simply as objets d’art. Candle holders made of metal, wood, and ceramic—and various styles of oil and gas lamps—are often collected and displayed because of their aesthetic appeal and not because of a need for light. Candlelight is used to create a special mood because, like irelight, it has a moving and scintillating quality that is not commonly duplicated with electric luminaires. Neon lamp designs created for advertising or as pieces of art are sometimes seen in today’s interiors. Such pieces are far more important as decorative art than as light.

Books Books are not only decorative but also appealing because of their unity of form and variety of color and texture. They may also lend a certain amount of emotional warmth

Figure 14.12 A bookcase creates a stage for displaying a wide assortment of accessories from china, to clock, to model ship, to paintings and photos, to the predominant collection of books. Books add personality, warmth, and visual interest to every room because they are personal selections and come in a broad range of colors and sizes. Sconces mounted right on the frame of the bookcase and the potted orchid on the lamp table are complementary accessories. Design by Catalano Architects/photo © Brian Vanden Brink

Art and Accessories

to a space because, when read, they become like old friends, associated with all kinds of memories. Secondhand hardcover books are sometimes purchased and displayed like stage props. These look attractive in settings such as restaurants and shops where the design is intended to create a homey atmosphere. In a residential setting, books purchased as props may be visually pleasing but will lack the emotional appeal of books that have been read and loved. Books stashed in attics or garages might be an untapped resource that could add a warm inishing touch to interiors. Walls of books make a suitable background for furniture groupings; they are a welcome addition to almost any interior. They can be interspersed with objets d’art or plants to create pleasing compositions. Interesting books and magazines placed on tables for browsing make stimulating accessories. A home ofice or children’s homework room is an excellent place to display books, allowing them to serve as an active reference library as well as an attractive display. Entries, living rooms, family rooms, dining rooms, kitchens, bedrooms, and even bathrooms are all appropriate locations for books. A formal dining room used only occasionally for meals might double as a library or study; the table would be useful for reading or writing, and the books would make a pleasant background for occasional dining.

• Bed linens are sheets, pillowcases, pillow shams (removable, decorative pillow covers), dust ruffles, bedspreads, blankets, comforters, quilts, and duvets (nondecorative comforters) and their covers. These are available in a wide array of colors and styles. Today, bed linens are the domain of the designer and are manufactured in classic whites as well as designs compatible with every type of interior. • Bath and kitchen linens consist mainly of towels. These are generally made of linen, cotton, or cotton terry cloth, all of which are absorbent and easy to launder. Linen (lax) cloths are particularly good for drying glassware, because they are lint-free and shine glass nicely. • Rugs and carpets are discussed with loor coverings in Chapter 12. The types of rugs generally considered to be accessories are art rugs, designer rugs, and Oriental rugs, particularly when they hang on the wall. • Tapestries and hangings were used for hundreds of years to provide actual physical warmth to the interior environment. They were used to cover the windows

Textiles Textiles serve important functional and decorative purposes as accessories. Linen, the name of the natural iber derived from the lax plant, today is used to describe the fabric products of natural, artiicial, or blended ibers used on the dining table, the bed, and the towel rack. These items are an important part of the appearance of a completed interior and should be chosen in harmony with the other elements of the design. Fine, traditional white linens are still considered classic, but today linens also provide an opportunity to add color and pattern to appropriate settings. Because they are relatively inexpensive, linens relect the constantly changing color and design trends. Textiles are also used in the form of rugs and carpets, tapestries, and other types of hangings to add warm inishing touches to interiors. The following represent some of the uses of textiles as accessories: • Table linens include tablecloths, napkins, place mats, and runners. These are made in every possible shape and of many ibers. The artiicial ibers are generally easier to care for, but the natural ibers have a ine look and feel that are dificult to duplicate. A table beautifully set with linens, tableware, and lowers chosen to create a harmonious and stimulating mood can be an important part of the pleasure of a good meal.

369

Figure 14.13 Bed linens and an area rug create warmth and comfort as do the framed art, fresh flowers, and books in this bedroom. Design by Peter Breese, Architect/photo © Brian Vanden Brink

370

Chapter 14

and walls of cold and damp castles; as bed hangings to protect from drafts, to keep in the warmth, and to provide privacy; and as table covers. Their use today is far more decorative, although they may provide a certain amount of psychological warmth because of their texture, pattern, and color. Traditional European tapestry designs are still being manufactured today, and contemporary artists are creating textile hangings with innovative methods of construction and design. • Handwoven or constructed fabric or textile pieces that hang on the wall are called fabric art or soft sculpture. Handmade antique or new coverlets or quilts are also used as wall hangings and table covers.

Objects from Nature

available in many places. These plant services care for greenery on a contract basis and will advise as to the type of plant that does best in a given setting. These irms may sell or lease the plants and in some cases will offer a warranty for their products and service. Another alternative is to seek professional advice on selection and care so that a plant will thrive in its new environment. Some plants will survive very well with artiicial light, but in dark environments with dramatic lighting like certain restaurants and lounges, artiicial plants may be a suitable alternative. Fortunately the quality of artiicial plants is improving. Today silk leaves and blooms are combined with actual trunks and plastic stems to create fairly convincing artiicial plants, trees, and lowers. Both real and artiicial plants need regular cleaning in order to continue to look their best.

Plants

Flowers and Greenery

Plants add life and interest to interiors because they are continually growing and changing and because of their free-lowing and sculptural forms. Each type of plant has a distinctive quality of design that makes it better suited to one style of interior than another. For example, the cactus has a strong, bristling, hard-edged quality and a dramatic sculptural form well suited to clean, structural interiors. The Boston fern is soft and feathery— characteristics that make it suitable in both traditional and contemporary environments where it adds textural variety. When selecting plants, pay close attention to the shape, texture, and suitability to the area where they are to be placed. Plants need adequate light, proper temperatures, and careful feeding, watering, and cleaning. These needs vary according to the type of plant. Some are sturdy, whereas others are quite sensitive to environmental changes. Any room with abundant natural light, whether direct or indirect, can house plants. The humidity produced by running water makes bathrooms and kitchens especially good places for plants that dry out easily. In some interiors such as greenhouses and solariums, plant care may be the very reason for the room’s existence. Plants look healthy and well formed in loral shops or nurseries because they have been raised in greenhouses under controlled conditions. Yet when they are moved into typically overheated, overcooled, or dry human environments, they often become sickly. Living with plants from day to day, it is easy to be unaware of how bad a sickly plant might appear. People who have the ability to raise and maintain healthy plants are said to have a green thumb. Those who do not have green thumbs or whose interior environments are not conducive to healthy plants may need to consider alternatives. One alternative is commercial plant services,

Any time of the year, one can ind growing or natural things that can be brought indoors to brighten the environment and lift the spirits. Cut lowers from the garden or lorist add color and life to interiors. Arrangements can be very formal and precise, like the Japanese ikebana, in which lowers are arranged according to strict, ancient rules of placement. Geometric bouquets purchased through lorists remain popular, but bouquets of spring or summer blooms that appear to have been brought straight in from the garden and loosely arranged in an artistic way are often more pleasing because they have soft lowing lines that imitate the way lowers actually grow. Flowers can be used as single blooms or massed in myriads of color and texture combinations. But when lowers are not available, or simply as a change of pace, other natural and growing things can be used seasonally to bring life to interiors. For example, wreaths or baskets full of pine boughs and cones can be used all through the winter, not just at Christmas, to add a touch of greenery. In the early fall, branches of bright autumn leaves are cheerful, and in late fall and early winter, bowls, baskets, or sprays of hardy berries like pyracantha bring visual warmth to a cool season. Bowls or baskets full of apples, horse chestnuts, or other late-fall delights are attractive and long-lasting. Pumpkins, gourds, and winter squash or piles of lemons, limes, or oranges make ine winter displays. In the spring, blossoms from fruit trees or pussy willows and corkscrew willows are interesting alternatives to lower arrangements. In the summer there is a wonderful array of lowers available, but other growing things can be equally exciting. Fresh summer fruits and vegetables in interesting arrangements can be beautiful. Freshly cut herbs from the garden make unusual greenery for lower arrangements and are also very appealing by themselves in

Art and Accessories

371

monochromatic arrangements. Dried herbs, grasses, and weeds make long-lived compositions if arranged with restraint and care. Ivy pulled from the garden is also longlasting when placed in water. With so many possibilities, there is no need to despair the lack of a green thumb. Creating arrangements of lowers and other types of plant life is a pleasing and creative activity. Selecting the container is a delightful part of the creative process. A beautifully designed vase is a ine way to display lowers, but anything that will hold water is fair game for arrangements. Watertight containers can often be hidden inside baskets and other porous or leaky objects to make them lower-worthy. Some of the most interesting arrangements may be created in very unusual containers. For example, an old rusty disk from a tiller on a farm could hold a fall arrangement, a wicker picnic basket could be illed with summer garden lowers, and a small copper teakettle could complement a sweet country bouquet.

Other Natural Objects Consider this list of other objects from nature that often ind their way into interior environments: • Sea shells and rocks can be displayed as decorative accessories. Large shells can be mounted on specially designed pedestals or displayed on a table or shelf as any other art object. Small shells can be massed together in baskets, glass bowls, or any appropriate container where their beauty can be fully appreciated. Rocks can be displayed in much the same way as shells, massed together or mounted on stands. The beauty of some rocks becomes evident only after cutting and polishing, which often reveals natural designs of amazing beauty. • Animal skins and hunting trophies may add an exotic or rustic quality to certain interiors. However, they may provoke objections on grounds of sensitivity, concern for conservation, or cruelty to animals. This should be a matter of careful discrimination. • Fish tanks or aquariums can also bring life to interior environments. However, like plants, they require meticulous upkeep in order to be attractive—a dirty aquarium or sick ish are anything but appealing. As with plants, there are also services available in some areas for maintaining aquariums and ish.

Other Accessories There are a number of other things in our environments that are products of rapidly developing and constantly changing technology. Appliances, computers, video sys-

Figure 14.14 This vignette captures a composition of interesting accessories, including a small, informal bouquet of flowers, a beautifully shaped conch shell, and a bowl of lemon drops grouped on a table. Behind the table, a soft throw pillow is appliquéd with a pattern in yellow that is repeated by the color of the lemon drops. Design: Drysdale Design Associates/photo © Brian Vanden Brink

tems, audio systems, and telephones are important elements of an interior. These are chosen primarily for their function, although they may be good design as well. They should be considered an important part of the design and be accommodated with sensitivity to their function and aesthetic appeal.

The Use of Accessories Collections Many of us enjoy collecting objects, and the collections usually say something about the background, travels, or experiences of the collector. Some collections are worthy of display and impart a personal quality to the environment. These collections might be pieces of ine art, porcelain or other ceramics, antique toys, shells, books, bottles, or other glass pieces, stamps, coins, guns and swords, photographs,

372

Chapter 14

Figure 14.15 This kitchen/dining area features a well-maintained fish tank. The fish bring a constantly changing quality of life to the interior. Designer: Bryan Reiss, CKD, CBD, Co-Designers: Theresa Bishop; Cabinet Concepts, Inc./Photography: John Smoak/NKBA Design Competition

or any pieces of personal interest. When there is inadequate space for an entire collection, the inest pieces should be selected for display, grouped and arranged in harmony with the principles and elements of design.

The Less-Is-More Approach The Japanese are widely esteemed for their aesthetic sensitivity. There is much to be learned from the way they collect and display objets d’art in their traditional environments. The traditional Japanese home had a specially designated area called the tokonoma (see page 434 in Chapter 15), which was a type of shrine for the display of one or two art objects and an arrangement of lowers (ikebana). These displays were changed regularly, and pieces were often chosen to honor a special guest. Objects not on display were safely stored for later use. This approach to the display of art objects is characterized by the excitement of bringing out old and treasured pieces that have been packed away for a time and then rediscovered.

These possessions become new again and are used with refreshed appreciation. This clean or minimal philosophy is in harmony with the idea that “less is more”—a concept that has been a hallmark of the modern design movement and is still the favored approach to many designs. Such designs, stripped of all unnecessary embellishment, can be appealing because they create a sense of space and freedom. Neat, well-ordered spaces devoid of mess and clutter can be peaceful and calming as well. Any object placed in this kind of environment is important because it does not compete visually with other elements of the design. Therefore, a carefully selected art piece or accessory can become a focal point in the room.

Organized Clutter During the Victorian era of the nineteenth century, there was a tendency to ill every available inch of space with knickknacks. Shelves and tables were crowded with

Art and Accessories

373

Figure 14.17 This craftsman-style room is an example of the organized-clutter approach to displaying accessories. The displays of books; paintings; Victorian, Japanese, and Native American ceramics blend to create a personal interior. Photo © Kathryn Taylor

Figure 14.16 When an interior is clean and spare, and pieces are displayed just a few at a time, each accessory stands on its own. This is the essence of the less-is-more approach to displaying accessories. Photo © Joshua McHugh/courtesy of Knoll, Inc.

objets d’art. When new pieces were introduced, the others were pushed a little more tightly together to make room for the new piece. Everything was on display. This approach, still common today, is sometimes called organized clutter. Some environments may appear this way due to a lack of organization and planning, an inability to part with anything, or a desire to create a feeling of nostalgia. To others, however, each object in the space may have special signiicance and may add to the warmth of the environment. Some interiors are appealing because of their clean, streamlined approach to art and accessories, while others are interesting and charming because they are illed with personal treasures. Somewhere between the extremes of Japanese and Victorian philosophies of accessory display lies comfortable and pleasing middle ground that suits an environment and provides the right balance of emotional support for the users.

Overall Considerations When selecting any kind of art for an interior, it is important to keep the principles and elements of design in

mind. Artworks and objects that it with the proportions, line, texture, color, and other characteristics of a room’s design will complement that room. Conversely, art that may be exquisite on its own will look out of place and detract from its surroundings if placed in an interior whose design characteristics are at odds with it. Function is another factor to consider in selecting and arranging art. A fragile sculpture, for example, should not be placed near a high-trafic doorway, even if the visual effect of the placement is stunning. It would be poor design to place watercolors that are vulnerable to shifts in humidity above a sink or to place a woven hanging that cannot be cleaned near a window that is usually kept open, admitting dust and pollutants. The subject matter of art, too, can be chosen in relation to the function of the interior. For example, while botanical prints of fruit and vegetables may be appropriate in a number of different places, they are particularly well suited to a kitchen or dining room. These functional factors need not stand in the way of creativity or good taste, but they are worth considering as part of the decision-making process.

Emotionally Supportive Design Art, accessories, and furnishings have the power to provide emotional support because they are often links to esteemed people or events. This is why a piece of

374

Chapter 14

furniture or cherished piece of porcelain often serves makes an environment emotionally supportive as well as as a memento of a person, time, or place. Those who a statement of personal experience. emigrated from one country to another or who, in years past, moved from civilized surroundings to settle the wilderness often carried and protected treasured objects from their past into their uncertain futures. Preserving a fragile remembrance from the past and keeping it unArt and accessories in contract interiors create a feeling of damaged through the years is a remarkable accomplishinish and add the important element of human interest ment and source of pride. Today, these same objects are to spaces that could otherwise be quite impersonal. For passed from one generation to another with great rethis reason, many contract design projects have speciic spect and love. budgets for artwork. The decision on how to spend those A photograph, a certiicate, and memorabilia such budgets usually belongs to the architect, the designer, a as pressed lowers, a tiny christening gown, a watch committee, or an art consultant. Sadly, sometimes the art or medal, and even a map can also preserve a memory budget is extremely limited or consumed by cost overand help recall an important time in one’s life. Objects rides in other areas. At the other end of the spectrum collected while traveling serve as reminders of exciting are the large corporations that collect art not only for its places and experiences. Well-designed pieces received as aesthetic value but for investment as well. Some of these gifts from cherished friends may be decorative and also have staff members whose sole responsibility is the acserve as remembrances of those people. quisition of art and its dispersement to permanent collecDrawings and crafts created by children are part of tions throughout the corporation. Other contract venues the emotional support system of a family and should be function as unoficial art galleries, displaying work from displayed with pride to encourage creativity. Such pieces sources such as schools and community artist guilds on often have artistic merit, and a child seeing the work on a rotating basis. display is encouraged to continue the creative endeavors. Many large contract projects such as ofices, hotels, and These pieces could be matted and displayed in a place of hospitals beneit from the use of art, though not always honor or simply taped to the refrigerator door. It is the in permanent collections. These interiors are usually recognition that counts. Human beings generally want to be surrounded by the things they love, whether it be in large doses or one object at a time. The clutter approach is not more correct than the minimal philosophy, merely better suited to certain interiors and individual needs. It is important to determine what kind of a balance is most pleasing to us and appropriate to our interiors; we should be careful not to discard well-loved pieces simply because we might not be completely conident of their aesthetic quality. For example, to some, a porcelain igurine might seem to be valueless kitsch. To another it might represent a cherished childhood memory, or it may have belonged to a dear friend Figure 14.18 Industrial design educator Doug Stout’s office provides the setting for an unusual or relative. We alone can make link with his native Britain and his lifelong fascination with trains. His bookshelf displays part those determinations of value, of his collection of British locomotives and rail cars purchased during visits to England and and it is the inclusion of val- Scotland. They are not only visually appealing but serve as an important cultural tie with his ued art and accessories that past. John Wang and Doug McIntosh, photographers

Contract Considerations

Art and Accessories

375

Figure 14.19 The interior of the Salt Lake City International Airport features large-scale paintings of the ruggedly beautiful southern Utah landscape. Andrew Arnone and Darlene Langford, photographers

redesigned every few years, and a change in the art is often part of the new design program. Selecting pieces for this kind of design project requires extreme sensitivity, because not only must the art be purchased in large quantities but it must also be chosen for its relationship to the elements of the design, its price, and its aesthetic merit. Success in this kind of art selection is not as common as it should be, but the errors made in these situations can provide one key to understanding how to select quality art. Fine art, regardless of price, cannot be exclusively tied to a decorative scheme by color or some other element—it must have its own aesthetic merit. If a new design program truly demands a change in the art, then the pieces being removed, if they have aesthetic merit, should still be of value in some other setting. If they have no value 10 years after their initial installation, then they probably had no aesthetic merit to begin with. Such pieces of decorator art or motel art will only ind their way to incinerators or dusty thrift-store tables. Finding good-quality prints, reproductions, or originals at the price points required by large projects may demand some effort. However, the search is worth the impact that good-quality art creates in an interior design. When judging a piece of art, it might be wise to ask ourselves, What will be the value of this piece 10 years from now? If it can weather the test of time, it will be well chosen.

Figure 14.20 Accessories are the key ingredient of the interior design at the Hard Rock Café in Dallas, Texas. Photo © Norman McGrath

376

Chapter 14

Some designs such as restaurants and boutiques often require the selection of art and accessories keyed to a theme such as English Tudor or Country French. This kind of project may be like creating a stage setting, and each piece of art and every accessory will be selected because it reinforces the concept for the design. This often requires some research into the history of the decorative arts to ensure that selections are supportive and appropriate to the stated theme. One of the most crucial aspects of a design is its relationship to the users. Designers may ind it discouraging to return to a design for a postoccupancy evaluation and ind that things have changed; for example, the pristine

reception area has been invaded by the receptionist’s personal items, and the manager’s wall is covered with postcards and pictures of the family. It is human nature to surround ourselves with things we love, and design must accommodate that tendency so that the work environment can be pleasant and supportive in every way. If a design is so clean that it forces management to create policies prohibiting personal belongings, then it has failed to meet the emotional needs of its users. It should not be dificult to provide a surface for photographs or cards and a space for personal mementos. Such considerate planning, rather than detracting from, will add vitality to the design.

Chapter 15 Historic Influences in Design Early Influences 378 European Influence in Historic America 391 Historic European Style in Contemporary Design 423 Modern Design (1857–Present) 432 Putting Things in Perspective 447

Design: Belle Maison, Sheldon Tager, Interior Designer/photo © Brian Vanden Brink

378

Chapter 15

Early Influences The design we see in America today is the result of centuries of inluence, development, and change. It is dificult to separate innovations from the factors that shaped them. Even those trends that claim to be free from previous inluence have some basis in the experience and technology of preceding generations. Some of the most signiicant and inluential architectural designs originated in classical Greece, Imperial Rome, the Middle Ages, and the Italian Renaissance. Historic styles are identiied by examining their architectural details. Many architectural and interior design details are explained and illustrated within the body of this chapter. In addition, a table showing two common architectural details, roofs and dormers, is located at the end of the chapter. There, roof types and dormer types can be compared side by side in a single location. See Table 15.31, page 450.

Greece (Fifth Century B.C.)

which was executed principally by the sculptor Phidias. Much of the original sculpture was taken to England during the nineteenth century by British collector Lord Elgin. These extraordinary pieces are now housed as a collection called the Elgin Marbles in the British Museum in London. The Parthenon shows clearly the characteristics of Greek architecture. The entire building rests on a base called the stylobate, which can be approached from any angle (the actual entrance was in the rear). The columns (supporting posts that carry the weight of the roof) form a colonnade (row of columns) around the exterior of the building. A lintel, or crosspiece, called the architrave rests on the capitals at the top of the columns. The capital is a decorative detail that helps distinguish one style, or order, of Greek architecture from another. A second set of beams rests on top of the architrave and runs the length and width of the building. On the exterior, these beams are covered with a decorative panel called the frieze. The architrave and frieze form the support for the triangular trusses of the roof. The trusses extend beyond the architrave and frieze and create an overhang called the cornice. The architrave, frieze, and cornice together form a combination of the three details known as the entablature. The row of roof trusses extends forward and backward to the front and rear of the building. The triangular shape of the roof forms a pediment (like a gable) at the front and rear. The pediment holds a triangular panel of sculpture called the pediment frieze.

The Parthenon, considered one of the most beautiful buildings in the world, is the classical embodiment of ancient Greek architecture. This magniicent combination of sculpture and architecture, designed to honor the goddess Athena, rests on an outcropping of rock called the Acropolis in the capital city of Athens. The Parthenon, built during the ifth century b.c. (golden age), was partially destroyed in 1687 by a bombardment during the TurkoVenetian war. But even in its ruined state it is an inspiring sight. The construction of the Parthenon is solid marble, generally without mortar. The triangular roof trusses were wooden and covered with terra-cotta tiles. The building, designed by Ictinus and Callicrates, is beautifully proportioned. Through minute adjustments to the curvature of the horizontal lines and by manipulation of the shape, placement, and inclination of the columns, optical illusions were created that make the Parthenon appear visually perfect. One of the Parthenon’s in- Figure 15.1 Even in its ruined state, the Parthenon of Athens is a timeless example of classical est features was its sculpture, Greek design. Su Davies/Life File/Getty Images

Historic Influences in Design

(A)

379

capital is shaped like an inverted bell and embellished with two rows of acanthus leaves. The bell shape is topped with four small volutes that support each corner of a square abacus. The Corinthian cornice may also be enriched with square dentil ornament. Table 15.1 is an overview of Greek design.

(B)

Greek Furniture Classics The Klismos is one of a group of beautiful reproductions of Greek furniture pieces taken from depictions on archaeological artifacts. The pieces, designed by T. H. Robsjohn-Gibbings (1905–76), are made in Greece by Saridis S. A. and are distributed in America by Gretchen Bellinger, Inc. (C)

(D)

Figure 15.2 The classical Greek and Roman orders: (A) Doric, (B) Ionic, (C) Corinthian, and (D) Tuscan. Photos © Kathryn Taylor

The Greek Orders As stylistic details evolved, certain types of entablatures were more compatible with certain columns and capitals, and distinct styles or orders were born. The three Greek orders are Doric, Ionic, and Corinthian. The simplest and apparently the oldest order is the Doric. The shafts of Doric columns are luted in shallow curved sections and have no base, resting directly on the stylobate. The Doric capital consists of a square abacus (plate) at the top and a simple curved echinus (dish) below. The Doric entablature has a plain architrave and a frieze divided into triglyphs and metopes. Triglyphs are blocks divided by vertical channels, and metopes are panels placed between the triglyphs, often decorated with sculpture in low relief. The Ionic order is a more recent development, though it appears to be related to earlier Egyptian and Near Eastern prototypes. It consists of a capital with two frontfacing scroll volutes, whose design may have been derived from animal horns or shells. Below is a molding of egg and dart with a second lower molding of bead and reel or anthemion relief designs. The column itself is thinner than the Doric and is luted with separated semicircular grooves and inished at the bottom with a molded base that rests on the stylobate. The Ionic entablature is narrower than the Doric and features an architrave that rises in three distinct planes. It has an undecorated frieze or one decorated in a continuous band of sculpture and a cornice that projects less than the Doric. The Corinthian order was not widely used by the Greeks but was adopted by the Romans. The Corinthian

Rome (200 B.C.–A.D. 400)

During the Imperial Age of Rome (beginning in the irst century b.c.), Greece was annexed and absorbed into the Roman Empire. At that point, Rome began to overshadow the Greek civilization it had conquered, though the Romans never reached the level of artistic achievement attained by the Greeks. Designs of classical Rome were magniicent and showy but never executed with the care and craftsmanship that characterized Greek design. That is probably to be expected because the far-lung Roman Empire had a massive program of building, and such meticulous care would have been impractical. The construction spread to every corner of the Empire—from Spain in the west to Asia Minor in the east and from Africa in the south to England and Germany in the north. The Romans adapted Greek design to suit their needs, but they also brought to the style their own materials and unique engineering techniques. The Romans incorporated the roundheaded arch and barrel vault with the post and lintel, often in the same building. The perfection of the arch and vault led to the development of the dome. Bricks and concrete made from volcanic ash and lime facilitated rapid and sturdy construction. The brick and concrete were faced with a veneer of marble or plastered with stucco. The Roman orders include the Doric, Ionic, and Corinthian styles as well as two orders developed by the Romans: the Tuscan and Composite. The Roman Doric order varies most from the Greek original. The Roman version, which incorporates a base on the column, is less massive, and the column is often left unluted. The Roman Ionic and Corinthian orders are almost identical to the Greek, varying mostly in small details of decoration. The Tuscan order is a simpliied version of the

380

Chapter 15

Table 15.1

Greek Design

Classical Details

Ionic Capital with Decorative Details

The Greek Orders Doric

Ionic

Corinthian

Greek Klismos with Saber Legs

Roman Doric, without lutes or ornamental moldings. The Composite order, as the name implies, is a combination of the Corinthian and Ionic orders. Large volutes, together with a band of egg-and-dart and bead-and-reel moldings, are borrowed from the Ionic capital, and two rows of acanthus leaves are taken from the Corinthian order. The resulting design is even more decorative than the Corinthian capital. The Roman temple was based on the design of Greek temples but differed from them in at least two important ways. First, the Roman temple was built on a raised podium instead of a stylobate and was approached only from the front by means of a single set of steps. Second, the interior space (cella) was expanded to the edge of the podium and illed the area that would otherwise form a porch at the sides and rear of the building. The exterior

walls were lined with half columns that formed a continuous line with the columns of the covered porch or portico at the front of the building. The Maison Carrée (c. 16 b.c.), Nimes, France, is an excellent example of a small Roman temple. The Pantheon (a.d. 120) in Rome is an important example of a circular Roman temple. The building, which was dedicated to all the gods and later consecrated as a Christian church, features a large dome (over 142 feet in diameter) that rests on a round drumshaped cella. The round domed space is called a rotunda. The interior is lighted by an open oculus (circular opening at the top of the dome), 142 feet above the loor. The exterior incorporates a portico attached to the circular body of the building. Much of what remains of Roman domestic design was rediscovered in 1754 with the irst excavations of Pompeii

Historic Influences in Design

381

Color in Antiquity Color has played an important role throughout history. Colors have relected climate, political and social atmosphere, and trade with or exposure to other cultures. Today as we view the ruins of antiquity, we have only a glimpse into the real colors enjoyed by peoples of every era in history. These colors are useful to interior designers today as historic interiors are re-created, restored, or adaptively reused. Colors of ancient Greece included stellar, slate, and mist blues; scarlet; pale violet; pale and medium malachite and olive greens; sun yellow; ivory white; marble pink; clay beige; copper brown; and charcoal. Fragments of color on the Parthenon in Athens show us that blue was dominant, with igures in realistic tints of yellow, pink, and pale blue. Classical Roman interiors were decorated with painted stucco and colorful mosaics, accented with rich fabrics. The brilliance and relative clarity of colors such as magenta (the imperial purple), rich gold, Pompeii red, and Roman greens, accented with black, surprised the Western world upon their discovery at Pompeii and Herculaneum.

The Middle Ages (800–1500) Figure 15.3 The Pantheon in Rome with its coffered dome is a remarkable Roman temple originally dedicated to all the gods. Giovani Paolo Panini, The Interior of the Pantheon, ca. 1740. Oil on canvas, 4 ft. 2½ in. ⫻ 3 ft. 3 in. National Gallery of Art, Washington, DC. Bridgeman Art Library.

and Herculaneum—cities buried and preserved by the eruption of Mount Vesuvius in a.d. 79. The House of the Vettii, an example of a Pompeiian house, opened into an atrium (a space open to the sky). The atrium contained a pool, which held rainwater collected from the roof. The rear section of the house opened into a colonnaded garden area called the peristyle. These houses also typically had libraries, picture galleries, kitchens, and rooms for sculpture, dining, sleeping, and conversation and reading. The terms classical and classicism are often mentioned in conjunction with architectural design and detailing. These terms refer to the use or adaptation of Greek and Roman forms, motifs, and proportions in the designs of subsequent periods. The Roman orders and their proportions were documented and preserved in drawings by Vitruvius, a irst-century Roman architect. Correct classical proportions are often referred to as Vitruvian proportions. Table 15.2 illustrates aspects of Roman design.

With oficial acceptance of Christianity in Rome, the faithful in Italy began the construction of churches. These were built in a style known today as Early Christian and were an important inluence on the styles that followed. By the year 1000, all of Europe was Christian. The barbarians who repeatedly streamed out of the north to sack Rome and the rest of southern Europe had intermarried, converted to Christianity, and in fact become Europeans. The lives of these people were inextricably tied to the church in a manner that is dificult for us to comprehend today. The church took care of every need, whether spiritual, physical, or intellectual, and in return everyone was expected to contribute money and labor to the building of churches. Many of the Early Christian buildings were destroyed by ire, and in the eleventh century a new style of church with a ireproof stone ceiling became popular. These buildings used the roundheaded Roman arch and vault as forms for windows, doors, and ceilings. The French term Romanesque, meaning “Roman-like,” is the designation given to the architecture of this period. In England the same style is generally called Norman after William I (the Conqueror) of Normandy, who conquered England in 1066. The Gothic style grew out of Romanesque around 1135; it irst appeared at the church of Saint-Denis near Paris, France. The name Gothic, which has become synonymous with design from the Medieval era, or Middle Ages, was irst applied by Vasari, a post-Renaissance

382

Chapter 15

Table 15.2

Roman Design

Roman Arch

Maison Carrée Keystone

Nimes, France

Pompeiian House Plan Peristyle

Triangular Pediment

Segmental Pediment

Atrium

Pantheon Rome, Italy

The Roman Orders Tuscan

Composite

Historic Influences in Design

383

high as the aisle arcade. Some churches have windows that open from the aisles to the exterior of the building, while others have small chapels that are entered from the aisles and run parallel to the nave and choir. The chapels radiate off of the apse aisle or ambulatory. The area between each opposing set of aisle arches is called a bay. Each bay is divided by tall piers (columns) that carry the weight of the ceiling, the trusses, and the roof. The ribs that form the framework of the ceiling spring from brackets carved as part of the pier and reach across the ceiling to the opposite side, creating vaults. As the style developed, the vaulting became increasingly more complex and ornate. In some churches, large, decorative, carved medallions, called bosses, are attached to the ceiling where the ribs cross. The wall between each of the piers is open at the loor level along the aisle arcade. Above the arcade is another set of openings called the triforium. In some cases the triforium serves as a gallery for looking into the nave and choir. In other churches the triforium is Figure 15.4 Canterbury Cathedral has an impressively scaled tower over its crossing, a typical feature of English Gothic churches. Photo © Kathryn Taylor

scholar who must have decided that the style was no further advanced than that of the barbaric Goths in the sixth century. He and his contemporaries probably felt that the designers of the Renaissance had corrected the architectural drift away from the classicism of ancient Greece and Rome. Today, with added perspective, Gothic design and architecture are considered one of the inest achievements of all time. Gothic architecture incorporates the Gothic arch (pointed arch), which led to the development of a very complex and ingenious system of vaulting that allowed the buildings to rise to great heights. These tall spaces draw the eye upward and inspire feelings of reverence and awe. The churches, often built over the crypt (basement) of earlier Romanesque churches, were laid out in the shape of a Latin cross or cruciform. The main body of the church, illed by worshippers, is called the nave. The nave is broken by the transepts, which extend outward on both sides from the crossing (the area where the nave and transepts cross). Beyond the crossing, the main body of the church is called the choir (or quire) because the choir stalls and organ were located there. The end of the main body that frequently houses an altar is called the apse. The nave is divided on each side from the aisles by an arcade (row of arches). The aisles run along the sides of the nave and continue behind the choir and apse. The aisles are not as tall as the nave and extend only as

Figure 15.5 This view, from the aisle through the nave, provides a clear view of the arcade, the triforium, and the clerestory on the opposite wall of this Gothic church. Photo © Brian Vanden Brink

384

Chapter 15

Table 15.3

Medieval Design—Romanesque and Gothic

Romanesque Arches

Gothic Church Interior Elevation

Gothic Church Cross Section Gothic Church Plan

Notre Dame Cathedral: Gothic

Historic Influences in Design

385

shallow and has no room for passage. The large openings above the triforium are the clerestory windows. These windows, as well as the windows on the aisle, are divided into smaller sections by vertical stone dividers called mullions. The lower part of the windows is divided into smaller pointed windows called lancets. The lacelike pattern of stone above the lancets is called tracery. The windows are often illed with stained glass. Stained glass consists of pieces of plain, colored, and painted glass, itted together with lead strips called came to make patterned panels of glass that are ixed to the metal framework between the mullions of the window. Light entering the windows and illing the building was symbolic of the presence of God. The quality of colored light added further to the feeling of mysticism. The relatively slender piers support the tremendous weight of the roof and stone ceiling and have a tendency to bow outward unless they are braced. Consequently, the weight of the roof of the nave is carried outward from the wall, above the roof of the aisles, by curved horizontal braces called flying buttresses. These connect with tall vertical structures, called buttresses, built on the exterior walls of the aisle. These grow increasingly thick in steps as they reach toward the ground and carry the weight from the lying buttresses. Each country developed characteristics that distinguished the church designs of that area. For example, elegant lying buttresses were a striking feature of many French Gothic churches. English churches often had two sets of transepts, wide fronts, and tall towers over the crossing. Italian Gothic churches were covered with elaborate patterns in contrasting colors of marble. Every

area of Europe produced beautiful Gothic churches, and when one stops to consider the sacriice, hardship, devotion, and ingenuity required to build them, they become monuments to an age of faith. Table 15.3 shows elements of Medieval design. Late Medieval domestic design continued well beyond the end of the Gothic era into the seventeenth century, particularly in the homes of the common people. The common houses from the end of the Middle Ages were constructed of stone, brick, or timber. These houses had steeply pitched roofs and small casement windows (that swing in or out) made with leaded glass panes (small panes held together with lead strips, like stained glass). The timber-framed houses utilized two types of inill to form the walls between the timbers. Panels of woven sticks called wattle were ixed, like lath (groundwork for plastering), to the timber frame and then covered with coarse plaster known as daub. The second type of inill was brickwork called nogging. The houses often featured an overhang or jetty at each story. These may have provided additional space in cramped city settings, but their use in less crowded areas suggests that overhangs were mostly a detail of style. Another theory is that the jetty helped to keep rainwater away from the foundation. Roofs were frequently thatched with bundles of reeds attached to the roof timbers and shaped and cut into smooth rounded curves. Slate roofs were made of thin, lat pieces of stone fashioned into shingles. Wooden shingles were also used in some areas. These Late Medieval common houses were the prototype for the seventeenthcentury American houses. The English versions of this style are often referred to as Tudor, because this type of building was common during the reign of the Tudor kings and queens. Table 15.4 contains examples of Late Medieval design. Figure 15.6 The Anne Hathaway Cottage in England, with its thatched roof, is an

example of Late Medieval design. Photo © Kathryn Taylor

Medieval Color Although color in castles and homes during the Medieval era was somewhat somber, the impact of color seen in the magniicent stainedglass windows throughout Europe still impresses us today. Techniques used to create these colorful masterpieces were temporarily lost until research revived the production of colored stained glass during the Victorian era (1842–1910). Colors of the Middle Ages and previous periods were governed by symbolism and were not freely and creatively used.

The Influence of the Orient The cultures of the East have been inluential in European and Western design since the time of the Crusades, when Europeans were introduced to the wonderful textiles, rugs,

386

Chapter 15

Table 15.4

Late Medieval Design Interior Details Floors. Stone, wood plank Walls. Timber frame with daub-and-wattle inill Windows. Casement with leaded panes Doors. Wooden plank Chimneypiece. Large brick or stone with wooden-beam mantle Ceiling. Beamed Stairs. Simple, tucked away

Hall’s Croft Stratford-Upon-Avon, England

Late English Medieval Interior

and other goods produced by the peoples of the Near East. The expression, “the Orient” historically referred to the geography that included the Near East to and including China and the subcontinent of India and only as far north as the Caucasus Mountains in today’s southern Russia between the Black and Caspian Seas. Commodities continued to be imported to the West by land until 1492, when the fall of Constantinople closed those trade routes to the East. The thirst for Oriental products remained strong, however, and Columbus set sail looking for a new sea route to India. With the establishment of the East India Company by the English and the United East India Company by the Dutch at the beginning of the seventeenth century, Oriental goods became readily available in Europe and even made their way to America. Fine Chinese porcelain, lacquer work (Coromandel) screens, chests, and other pieces of furniture, as well as Chinese rugs, have been important features of Western interior design for centuries. Features of Chinese design, including motifs such as fretwork and details from Chinese

furniture, have been regularly incorporated into Western design. In the eighteenth century, the French created fanciful designs based on their notion of Chinese design, which they called Chinoiserie. Chinese fabric designs that date back to nearly 3000 b.c. were highly revered during the European Renaissance and continue to be a source of inspiration in traditional design today. Silk was developed in China and, beginning in the seventeenth century, was produced in Italy and then throughout Europe. Table 15.5 shows examples of Chinese design. From Near Eastern Persian Islamic cultures, Westerners have chosen architectural elements such as the horseshoe arch and the onion dome—a feature Islam borrowed from Byzantium—to embellish their buildings. During the nineteenth-century Victorian era, a picturesque architectural style known as Exotic or Oriental Revival was based on Islamic design. The beautiful rugs made by Islamic weavers have been prized in Western interiors since the time of the Crusades of the Middle Ages (see Figures 12.12A–D, page 324).

Historic Influences in Design

Table 15.5

387

Chinese Design

Coromandel Screen

Chinese Table

Chinese Tsu Chair

Chinese Chippendale Chair

Chinese Scholar Cap Chair

Chinese Textile

Chinese Rug

Chinese Cupboard Textile Description

Chinese Porcelain Vase

Chinese colors. The Ming and T’a Ch’ing Dynasty colors include Ming (medium value royal blue); ivory and dull, cinnabar red; warm, deep Manchu red; coral; gold; jade green; and peacock (turquoise) blue. Chinese lowers imported to Europe added peony pink (bright, deep pink) and yellowish chrysanthemum gold. Chinese patterns. Largely symbolic patterns steeped in a history thousands of years old include the Imperial dragon clutching the pearl of wisdom in its claw, deer and the peacock, the fanciful chimera and phoenix bird, the tortoise shell, and birds. Landscapes include rivers with raised bridges and vertical mountains, Chinese houses and pavilions/pagoda roofs with eaves, plants, trees, humans in Chinese costume/dress. Climbing, gnarled branches with a variety of exotic leaves and lowers often hang downward, as do peonies in full bloom, the chrysanthemum, foliage, and old, often bent, pine trees. Fretwork is used as borders and as rounded central medallions; old coins, circular and hexagonal shapes, as components of complex patterns including water, waves, and clouds. Chinese textiles. Fabrics include all manner of silk— printed, complex embroidery, velvets, sheer, smooth, and slubbed (wild silk). Cotton is used in printed textiles and elaborate tapestries.

388

Chapter 15

The term Asian was not used historically, although it is in broad use today and represents a much larger portion of the world, including Siberia east of the Ural Mountains in Russia, and Mongolia, plus all of the Paciic Rim. Japan, considered both an Oriental and Asian country, inluenced the late nineteenth- and early twentieth-century Arts and Crafts movement. The Japanese inluence is discussed later and found in Table 15.27.

The Renaissance (1420–1650)

four Roman Ionic porticoes. The house has a narrow attic story topped with a hipped roof of terra-cotta tiles that rises gently to support a low drum and shallow dome. The windows of the main loor are topped with triangular pediments supported by curved brackets called modillions. The Renaissance architects did not always try to duplicate the designs of Greece and Rome but adapted their proportions, forms, motifs, and orders to create a new and important style. See Table 15.6 for examples.

Renaissance Furniture Classics

The Renaissance began in Florence, Italy, in the fourThe Renaissance witnessed the development of furniture teenth century and marked the rebirth of classical inluthat was adapted in every country where its inluence ences in architecture, art, and many other areas of human was felt—from Spain to England, and from Scotland to endeavor. The architectural Renaissance moved through Germany. Some of those important pieces remain clasEurope by means of pattern books containing drawings sics even today. For example, the Dante and Savonarola and descriptions published by leading architects and dechairs, designed during the Renaissance, are still seen signers from Italy, France, and Holland. These books, along with the writings of Vitruvius, discovered in 1414, inluenced architecture until the nineteenth century. The Renaissance palace was a boxlike city fortress with massive gates opening onto a roofless courtyard or atrium around which the house was built. The exterior of the palace was divided into three distinct stories by means of different textured stone, ranging from rusticated on the ground level to smooth on the third story, or by means of protruding rows (courses) of stone carved to form entablatures. The entablatures were visually supported by lat, false columns called pilasters, which progressed from the Doric order on the ground level to Ionic and Corinthian on the second and third levels. The top of the palace was inished with a very large overhanging cornice. The windows on the ground level were small and covered with iron bars. The second loor, or piano nobile (the noble level), and third loor had larger, well-proportioned windows. The facade (front face) of the building was arranged in a symmetrical fashion. The Renaissance architect whose work had the greatest impact on English and, subsequently, American architecture was a sixteenth-century stonecutter-turned-architect named Andrea Palladio. Palladio’s work, centered at Vicenza near Venice, included some public buildings but focused mainly on the design of villas for wealthy farmers. The most famous of these is the Villa Rotonda (1567). This house sits at the crest of a hill with a ine view in every direction. The basic form of the building is a plain box on a raised Roman podium. A portion of the podium extends outward on all four sides to cre- Figure 15.7 The Medici Palace in Florence, Italy, is a fortress-like city house ate staircases. The four sets of steps lead up to from the Renaissance. Alinari/Art Resource

Historic Influences in Design

Textile Description

Table 15.6

Renaissance Design

Palazzo Rucellai Florence, Italy

Colors. Rich and vibrant reds, blues, golds, and greens predominate Patterns. Large-scale lorals, the artichoke, the pomegranate Textures. Plain and igured velvet, tapestry, silk brocade, and damask

Savonarola Chair

Dante Chair

Renaissance Textiles

Villa Rotonda, Andrea Palladio Vicenza, Italy

389

390

Chapter 15

in today’s interiors. These are X-frame chairs patterned after Roman folding chairs. The Savonarola chair is made of a series of X-shaped slats, while the Dante chair has a double X frame and usually an upholstered seat.

Renaissance Color The Renaissance was a time of rebirth of artistic and architectural pursuits. No longer tied strictly to symbolic color, artists discovered the freedom to creatively use color. Color became a pleasing, decorative, and satisfying element for artists and patrons alike. Oil paintings reveal rich, sensuous hues such as garnet and persimmon reds, bright copper, deep cobalt blue, blue-green, medium blue, pale and deep greens, medium and deep malachite greens, rich and dull brown, marble and ivory cream and white, and metallic gold. Renaissance color elements migrated from Italy northward to Europe, notably France, Germany, the Lowlands, and England, and then inally to America.

to Protestantism during the Reformation, and the Jesuit order was given the mission to bring back the faithful— which it did through the coercion of the Inquisition and the enticement of the lavish Baroque style. The Baroque style began in Italy, spread to France, and eventually made its way to Great Britain and northern Europe. As it moved north it became less exuberant, however. For example, the French found Bernini’s design for the Louvre far too outlandish for their taste. However, the scale and showy quality of the style was perfectly suited to the Palace of Versailles, built for Louis XIV; it was built not so much as a home but as a symbol of Louis’s and France’s power. Sir Christopher Wren, the great English designer, studied French Baroque designs and simpliied them even more. The inluence of the Baroque style, by the time it made its way to the American colonies, had lost its showiness and appeared in simpliied form in the beautifully reined details of the Early Georgian style.

The Baroque Period (1580–1750) The Baroque period is often considered the inal phase of the Renaissance, and it represents the full lowering of the classical tradition reintroduced by Renaissance designers. Baroque design incorporates all of the classical elements such Figure 15.8 as columns, pediments, Baroque scroll pilasters, entablatures, pediment. rounded arches, and domes. However, it takes on an exaggerated form in terms of scale and ornamentation. Baroque design is large scaled, bold, and even theatrical, with dramatic effects of light and shadow. Ceilings are painted with incredible realistic scenes loating in the clouds and with angels hovering overhead. The architectural forms are taken to extremes and made to undulate and twist. The facades of the churches curve in and out, the interior spaces are rounded without corners, and columns are twisted. Hence the origin of the term baroque, which comes from the Portuguese barroco, or imperfect pearl, with its undulating, irregular surface. The materials of Baroque design are rich marbles, gilded metals, and ornately painted plaster. The overall effect is impressive. The style was called “Jesuit” in France, which relects an important function of Baroque design. Many Catholics converted

Figure 15.9 Melk Abbey in Austria demonstrates the exuberance, richness, and emotionally rendered classical forms typical of Baroque design. Photo © Paul M.R. Maeyaert

Historic Influences in Design

European Influence in Historic America Seventeenth-Century English Medieval Style (1608–95)

391

generally an addition made to an existing house, but by the eighteenth century some houses were built with saltbox roofs. The gambrel roof, with two different pitches on each side, was also used somewhat during the seventeenth century, but it was more popular on the vernacular houses of the eighteenth century. This type of roof, which was also English, was practical because it allowed more space in the garret (attic).

Settlers arriving in America from England in the early part of the seventeenth century quickly built crude, temporary shelters. However, as soon as conditions permitSeventeenth-Century Furniture Classics ted, they constructed permanent buildings of the style Seventeenth-century furniture was brought from Enthey had left in England. Because these settlers were gland by settlers or made in America with rather generally not from the wealthy class, they were probably primitive methods. The pieces are solid, sturdy, and ununacquainted with the Renaissance style; instead, they pretentious. Chests were important storage pieces and were accustomed to Medieval construction methods and were frequently carved or decorated with split spindles, design. The result is the Seventeenth-Century English a method of embellishment also common in England. Medieval style (see Table 15.7). Chairs were straight and rigid with turnings, probably Seventeenth-century American houses featured varbecause turning was a relatively simple yet decorative ied use of materials and distinctive characteristics in each way to make legs and stretchers. Two important examarea of the country. Brick was prevalent in the South, ples are the Carver and Brewster chairs. These chairs are where lime to make mortar was more available than almost identical except that the Brewster chair has many it was elsewhere. In New England, timber houses were more spindles than the Carver chair. The gateleg table often covered with clapboard, a sheathing of hand-split with turned legs is another important piece from the peoak. Houses sided with clapboard were also common in riod that has never really gone out of fashion. East Anglia, the English region that had been home to many of the early American settlers. In Rhode Island several houses—called stoneenders—were built with stone chimneys that covered the end of the building. The Medieval characteristics of the seventeenth-century American houses were the use of stone, brick, and timber construction, daub and wattle, nogging, jetties with decorative pendants, small casement windows with leaded panes, chimneys built in the shape of Gothic buttresses (buttressed chimneys), and steeply pitched, gabled roofs. Saltbox roofs, though not necessarily Medieval, were English. The saltbox slopes to the rear from the ridge of the roof to a level below the line of the front eaves and usually covers a lean-to addition at the back of the house. These additions were probably made Figure 15.10 This English Medieval–style room incorporates many features common to in response to the need for seventeenth-century American houses, such as the summer beam, palisade wall, and a large more space. The saltbox was timber mantelpiece. Photo © Brian Vanden Brink

392

Chapter 15

Table 15.7

Seventeenth-Century English Medieval Design

Exterior Characteristics

Thoroughgood House

• English Medieval construction—brick, stone, timber with daub and wattle or nogging, and clapboard siding • Steeply pitched gabled roof • Small casement windows with leaded panes • Overhang or jetty with pendants (optional) • Buttressed chimneys (optional) • Columned chimneys (optional) • Stone-ender chimneys (optional) • Projecting entry (optional) • Saltbox (optional) • Gambrel roof (optional)

Brick Construction

Arnold House Stone-Ender

Influences • Late English Medieval domestic architecture • Early English Renaissance architecture

Residential Examples • Adam Thoroughgood House (1640), Princess Anne County, Virginia • Corwin House (c. 1675), Salem, Massachusetts • Eleazer Arnold House (before 1676), Johnston, Rhode Island • Henry Whitield House (1639), Guilford, Connecticut • Whipple House (1638), Ipswich, Massachusetts • Bacon’s Castle (c. 1665), Surrey County, Virginia • Thomas Clemence House (1680), Johnston, Rhode Island • Parson Capen House (1683), Topsield, Massachusetts

Contract Example • St. Luke’s Church (1632), Isle of Wight County, Virginia

Whitfield House Stone Construction

Corwin House Clapboard Construction

Historic Influences in Design

Table 15.7

393

Seventeenth-Century English Medieval Design (continued)

Gateleg Table

Interior Details Floors. Wide wooden plank Walls. Stucco Windows. Small casement with leaded panes Doors. Planks (later paneled) Chimneypiece. Large, open, brick ireplace for warmth and cooking; large wooden mantel beam; board-and-batten palisade wall Ceiling. Beamed Stairs. Simple, modiied, wooden, double-turn, with wooden balustrade

Brewster Chair

Sunflower Chest

Carver Chair

Typical Three-Part Casement Window with Leaded Panes

Seventeenth-Century English Medieval Interior

394

Chapter 15

Color in Seventeenth-Century America Seventeenth-century colors tended to be earth colors seen in pewter, wood, and unbleached muslin, as well as in the simple homespun checks in indigo blues, yellows, and madder reds. Colors, limited as they were, tended to be dull, natural, and faded.

Early Georgian Style (1695–1750)

were used in New England, and stone was common in the mid-Atlantic colonies. Where brick or stone were used, the irst and second stories were frequently divided by a stringcourse or beltcourse. One or two Early Georgian–style houses built after 1750 include the use of quoins (decorative corner block details), which were more common in the Late Georgian style. Because these houses were larger, they required more than one chimney, and the chimneys were frequently placed at opposite ends of the house. Like the English prototypes, the houses had hipped roofs, which slope from the ridge in all four directions to the eaves. The roof was often broken by dormer windows that projected to provide light for the attic story. Some builders of independent spirit ignored the English prototype and incorporated gambrel or gabled roofs into their designs. Such variations give these houses a distinctly American feeling. Medieval details from the seventeenth century, such as casement windows with leaded panes, were replaced by sash windows; a door lanked with pilasters and crowned with a classical pediment took the place of the simple Medieval doorway. Pediments were the simple triangular type, rounded segmental pediments (the arch is a segment of a circle), or the more ornate, Baroquestyle scroll pediments. On some of these buildings,

The classical style of the Renaissance began to be widely accepted in England primarily due to the work of Sir Christopher Wren, Surveyor of the King’s Works (royal architect). In 1666, when the City of London was destroyed by ire, Wren was commissioned to rebuild St. Paul’s Cathedral as well as ifty-two smaller churches. His designs for churches and royal buildings were classical with some rich Baroque ornamentation. The inluence of Wren extended to the building of houses as well. These medium-sized, Wren-Baroque-style houses were the prototype for American houses during the irst half of the eighteenth century. Compared to the seventeenthcentury Medieval houses, the Early American Georgian houses seemed splendid. They were, however, versions of middle-class English residences. The very large homes and palaces of the English aristocracy and royalty were not used as models for homes in the colonies. At the beginning of the eighteenth century, Colonial America was prospering, and certain segments of society were ready for more elaborate houses. The new Wren-Baroque style of architecture was introduced in Williamsburg, Virginia, at the end of the seventeenth century. The Wren Building (1695) at William and Mary College in Williamsburg—the irst example of the new style in America—though much less elaborate than most of Wren’s English designs, is very much like his Chelsea Royal Hospital (1682) in London. Residences in the new style began to appear in America after the beginning of the eighteenth century. The irst few years of the 1700s saw the death of Queen Anne and the accession to the British throne of George I. He was succeeded by George II, George III, and George IV, who gave their name to the Georgian era. The new architectural style popularized by Wren in England a quarter of a century earlier is called Early Georgian in America. The basic form of the Early Georgian house was a rectangular two-story box, broken by ive symmetrically placed bays (sections of wall that include window and door open- Figure 15.11 The MacPhaedris-Warner House, a fine Early Georgian dwelling ings). Brick was the preferred building mate- in Portsmouth, New Hampshire, features a cupola and balustrade on its roof. rial in the South, painted clapboard or brick Photo © David A. Taylor

Historic Influences in Design

pediments were also used above the windows. The rafters were extended far enough to create an overhang that was treated like a classical cornice, often with modillions or dentil trim. A few of these houses had railings or balustrades around the ridge of the roof and a windowed tower called a cupola. Kitchens, servants’ quarters, dairies, and other types of service areas were frequently located in outbuildings away from the main body of the house. Some of these outbuildings were attached to the houses during the twentieth century, altering their original appearance.

395

of four or ive drawers is placed on top of the lowboy. The top of the highboy may be crowned with some type of pediment, but most often it will be lat with a slight cornice. Table 15.8 shows Early Georgian design.

Early Georgian Color Early Georgian colors were the Renaissance colors imported from England and France, with a preference for greens and dark dull blues; deep olive greens (examples of Colonial Williamsburg colors); and some golds, oranges, and browns reminiscent of English Medieval interiors.

Early Georgian Furniture Classics Both the William and Mary and Queen Anne furniture styles were popular during the Early Georgian era. However, it is the Queen Anne style that has remained popular and is still loved and used today. The Queen Anne tea table was a popular piece in eighteenth-century England and America as tea drinking became increasingly fashionable and the serving of tea a highly reined art. The tea table is characterized by its cabriole legs with club feet. Below the apron, the knee of the leg may be carved with a shell or other motif. The Queen Anne wing chair evolved from a seventeenth-century sleeping chair; the wings provided support for a nodding head. The wing chair is upholstered and has typical Queen Anne cabriole legs, some versions with stretchers, others without. Queen Anne chairs feature upholstered seats, round-shouldered hoop backs with a vase- or iddle-shaped splat, cabriole legs generally without stretchers, and club feet. The side chair is armless, and the armchair has open arms in various forms, the most common of which is the gooseneck or shepherd’s crook arm with its beautifully shaped curve. The Queen Anne lowboy and highboy are important case pieces from the eighteenth century. The lowboy is a raised chest on cabriole legs, generally with two drawers or a single wide drawer and two smaller square drawers in the curved apron (the face of the chest just below the drawers). The highboy is created when a chest

Figure 15.12 Westover is considered to be one of the finest houses from the early eighteenth century. Its gently arched windows and beautiful doorway detail—believed to have been made in London—would feel at home in England. Photo © Brian Vanden Brink

396

Chapter 15

Table 15.8

Early Georgian Design and Queen Anne Furniture

Exterior Characteristics • • • • • • • • • • • • •

Westover

(Before Wings Were Added) Two-story rectangular block Built of brick, clapboard, or stone Symmetrical facade with ive or more bays Hipped roof, often with dormer windows Tall end chimneys Sash windows Cornice with dentils or modillions Stringcourse (optional) Pediment and pilasters at doorway or windows (optional) Balustrade (optional) Cupola (optional) Gabled or gambrel roof (optional) Quoins (optional)

Influences • Christopher Wren • English-Baroque middle-class houses (late seventeenth century)

Residential Examples • Westover (c. 1730), Charles City County, Virginia • Governor’s Palace (1706–20), Williamsburg, Virginia • MacPhaedris-Warner House (1718–23), Portsmouth, New Hampshire • Brafferton Indian School (1723), Williamsburg, Virginia • The President’s House (1723), Williamsburg, Virginia • Hunter House (1746), Newport, Rhode Island • Carter’s Grove (1750), James City County, Virginia • Wentworth-Gardner House (1760), Portsmouth, New Hampshire

Contract Examples • Christ Church—”Old North” (1723), Boston, Massachusetts • Trinity Church (1725–26), Newport, Rhode Island • Independence Hall (1731), Philadelphia, Pennsylvania

Early Georgian Interior

Governor’s Palace Williamsburg, Balustrade and Cupola

Historic Influences in Design

Table 15.8

397

Early Georgian Design and Queen Anne Furniture (continued)

Queen Anne Highboy

Queen Anne Wing Chair

Queen Anne Armchair

Early Georgian Textiles

Queen Anne Tea Table

Interior Details

Textile Description

Floors. Wooden plank Walls. Large raised wooden panels, unpainted; also, plain plaster with chair rail Windows. Sash Doors. Paneled Chimneypiece. Flush, framed with simple, projecting bolection molding Ceiling. Flat, plain Stairs. Wooden U-stair with turned balusters

Colors. Williamsburg (dull medium value) blue, green, or rose were predominant, inluenced by the Renaissance; recent tests at places such as Colonial Williamsburg and Mt. Vernon, Virginia, have revealed that these colors may have originally been more vibrant than what we see today Patterns. Authentic or adapted Renaissance loral sprays Textures. Woven damasks and brocades, velvets, and some plain or satin textures

398

Chapter 15

Late Georgian Style (1750–90) The style called Late Georgian came to America in English pattern books. These contained drawings of houses, loor plans, and details that could be built with little or no architectural training. One of the most signiicant of these books was James Gibbs’s A Book of Architecture (1728), which had reached America by 1751 at the latest. His designs had great appeal for Americans because they were conservative in scale and within their means. Also, unlike his contemporaries, Gibbs showed a strong tendency to maintain much of the richness of the WrenBaroque design, which was suited to American taste. Gibbs’s book contained illustrations of homes designed with a central house or block, connected to symmetrical dependencies (outbuildings) by straight or curved passages or wings. Such dependencies created a forecourt in the Palladian manner. Gibbs also designed houses in the Wren-Baroque style—as simple self-contained rectangular houses without wings or dependencies. His designs include the use of rusticated stone, balustrades, quoins, and pilasters, details too ornate for use by other Palladian architects of his time. Gibbs often designed houses with a two-story projecting pavilion or breakfront. The breakfront topped with a triangular pediment above the rooline is the most distinctive feature of the Late Georgian–style house. In most other respects, it is similar to the Early Georgian style—a rectangular box with ive or more bays, hipped roof, and tall end chimneys. The hipped roof is often lower-pitched than the Early Georgian roof and may, in rare cases, feature a balustrade or parapet (solid railing-height wall) at the eaves

that hides the roof. The Late Georgian house may have a portico or a bracketed cornice, as well as pilasters and pediments at the doorway. The door may be crowned with a roundheaded fanlight (a rounded, over-the-door window), and the windows in the dormers may also be roundheaded. These houses may also feature a roundheaded arched window with lower rectangular windows on each side called a Palladian window. (They bear that name because they resemble an architectural detail used by Palladio on several of his designs.) When placed above a front door or at the end of an important room, they create an impressive focal point. The standard windows on the Late Georgian house are frequently capped with crown, or jack arch lintels, which are trapezoid-shaped stone pieces with a wedge-shaped keystone. Corner trim is plain or quoined, and sometimes this style features two-story pilasters.

Late Georgian Furniture Classics

In the late Georgian period the Chippendale furniture style was popular. This style, like the Queen Anne style, remains a favorite today. Chippendale furniture was designed during the mideighteenth century by Englishman Thomas Chippendale (1718–99). His book of designs, The Gentlemen and Cabinet-Maker’s Director (1754), featured 160 plates with drawings of furniture pieces. Because the designs were published in book form, any skilled woodworker could build or adapt them, and as a result, their popularity soon spread throughout the British Isles and America. Chippendale’s drawings showed the inluence of French (Louis XV), Chinese, Gothic, and Neoclassic designs. The Chippendale chair is characterized by its upholstered seat, cabriole legs with claw and ball feet, and a yoke-shaped back with an ornately carved splat. The backs might be carved in the form of ribbons, in Gothic tracery, in Chinese fretwork, or into pierced slats forming a ladder-back. The Chippendale cabriole legs joined the apron in the same manner as the Queen Anne cabriole legs. On some pieces a straight square leg known as the Marlborough leg was common. The Chippendale wing chair is similar to the Queen Anne wing chair, but generally has either Marlborough legs or cabriole legs with claw and ball feet and is larger scaled. The Chippendale camel-back sofa is an upholstered piece with a serpentine-shaped back that dips and rises from rolled arms to a hump in the center. The sofa has either cabriole legs with claw and ball feet or Marlborough legs with or without stretchers. The block front is a furniture detail associated with John Goddard (1724–85) of Newport, Rhode Figure 15.13 This lovely Late Georgian room features furniture in the style of Thomas Chippendale. Courtesy of Winterthur/Photo Gavin Ashworth Island. The block front, which was applied to

Historic Influences in Design

Chippendale-style case pieces, consists of a front panel divided into three alternating vertical convex and concave sections. The inside section is concave, the two outside sections are convex, and the top of each section is inished with a carved convex or concave shell. The Chippendale breakfront is a case piece designed in such a way that the front plane of the piece is broken (i.e., part advancing and part receding). The breakfront was commonly built as a secretary or a china cupboard and had an enclosed cabinet below and open shelves with glass doors above. The breakfront was also popular in succeeding periods and appears in several styles. The Chippendale highboy, like the Queen Anne highboy, consists of a low, two-drawer chest on legs (lowboy) with an additional chest of drawers above. The chest is

Table 15.9

399

topped by a scroll pediment with a inial. In the eighteenth century, Philadelphia was an important center for furniture manufacture. The Philadelphia highboy, with its magniicent carving, is a particularly beautiful example of the American version of the Chippendale style. Table 15.9 contains examples of Late Georgian design.

Late Georgian Color Late Georgian colors were peach, ivory, Wedgewood blue, opal pink, and green with clean and creamy white backgrounds of English garden-printed fabrics. More intense colors such as reds, golds, and deep greens and blues were still often seen in rich imported textiles such as silks, ine cottons, linens, and in the increasingly popular Oriental rugs.

Late Georgian Design and Chippendale Furniture

Exterior Characteristics

Mount Pleasant

Same basic form as the Early Georgian house Two-story projecting pavilion or breakfront with pediment Small portico over doorway (optional) Two-story double portico (optional) Building massed into symmetrical blocks and connections; Palladian massing (optional) • Doorways with roundheaded fanlights, bracketed cornices, or pilasters and pediments (optional) • Corners untrimmed or trimmed with quoins or pilasters (optional) • Crown lintels (optional) • • • • •

Influences • James Gibbs and other English Palladian architects • English pattern books

Residential Examples • • • • • • • •

Tyron Palace

Tyron Palace (1770), New Bern, North Carolina Mount Pleasant (1761), Philadelphia, Pennsylvania Longfellow House (1750), Cambridge, Massachusetts Mount Airy (1758–62), Richmond County, Virginia Lady Pepperell House (1760), Kittery Point, Maine Miles-Brewton House (1765–69), Charleston, South Carolina Brandon (1765–70), Prince George County, Virginia Hammond-Harwood House (1773–74), Annapolis, Maryland

Contract Examples • • • •

St. Michael’s Church (1752–61), Charleston, South Carolina First Baptist Meetinghouse (1774–75), Providence, Rhode Island Redwood Library (1758–50), Newport, Rhode Island Brick Market (1761–62), Newport, Rhode Island (continued)

400

Chapter 15

Table 15.9

Late Georgian Design and Chippendale Furniture (continued)

Palladian Window

Chippendale Philadelphia Highboy

Late Georgian Interior

Interior Details

Textile Description

Floors. Wooden plank Walls. Large raised wooden panels, painted; also, dado with wallpaper above Windows. Sash Doors. Paneled, moldings with ears (molding breaks to form squares at corners) Chimneypiece. Flush, with molding forming ears, and often with cornice and frieze; cornice forms mantel, over mantel with ears Ceiling. Flat, plain, or decorated with anaglypta (raised patterns) Stairs. Wooden U-turn, turned balusters

Colors. Baroque and Rococo inluence; more vivid colors—red, gold, blue, turquoise or teal, and rich coral sometimes lightened to soft peach Patterns. Renaissance patterns still in use and strong inluence of Chinese and Rococo motifs; English garden block-printed patterns Textures. Smooth silklike textures in damask and brocade, printed cotton fabrics from slightly coarse to very reined; some velvets

Historic Influences in Design

Table 15.9

401

Late Georgian Design and Chippendale Furniture (continued)

Chippendale Tilt-Top Table

Chippendale Breakfront Late Georgian Textiles

Chippendale Wing Chair

Chinese Chippendale Chair

Chippendale Side Chair

Chippendale Ladder-Back Chair

Chippendale Camel-Back Sofa

Chippendale Block-Front Chest Newport, Rhode Island

402

Chapter 15

Federal Style (1790–1830) In the decades after the Revolutionary War, Americans sought to deine a style of design that would depart from European models and express the ideals of the new nation. To a large extent they expanded on trends that had already developed on the American continent before independence. However, the resulting style, which came to be called Federal, was in reality still heavily inluenced by European design—particularly that of the British architect Robert Adam (1728–92). After Adam visited the Italian excavation sites at Pompeii and Herculaneum, he used his drawings of ancient Roman and Renaissance design to create a Neoclassic style. Federal-style houses generally are beautiful American adaptations of the Adam style from Georgian England. The typical Federal house has a symmetrical facade of ive bays and, like the English prototype, usually has three stories. A few Federal houses have longer second-story windows that extend to the loor. These second-story rooms were the public spaces of the house and were given more importance with the larger windows—a concept related to the Renaissance idea of the piano nobile. The windows on the third level were usually smaller than the other two, a characteristic also typical of the English prototype. The Federal doorway was sometimes sheltered by a small portico similar to those designed for English terrace houses (row houses). The door itself was commonly topped with a roundheaded or delicate elliptical fanlight and lanked with a narrow set of windows called sidelights. The elliptical fan shape, discovered on the walls of Herculaneum, was possibly the most versatile and signiicant motif of the period. The fan was doubled to form ellipses known as paterae. These were used in every possible decorative fashion: furniture hardware, inlaid wood patterns on furniture, plaster patterns for ceilings, and elliptical room plans. The roof on the Federal house was low pitched and hipped and often featured a balustrade at the eaves. The Federal period includes the work of Boston architect Charles Bullinch, Samuel McIntire of Salem, and English transplant Benjamin Latrobe. Bullinch’s work was widely copied in the pattern books of the day and was likely the basis for much late eighteenth-century and early nineteenth-century architecture in New England. McIntire was a skilled carver as well as an architect, and his interiors and exteriors relect the master’s touch.

Federal Furniture Classics The Hepplewhite and Sheraton style from England was fashionable during the Federal period. The Hepplewhite/ Sheraton chairs are typical of the delicate Neoclassic style of the late eighteenth century. George Hepplewhite (d. 1786) produced a book called The Cabinet-Maker and Upholsterer’s Guide (published posthumously in 1788),

which contained furniture designs inspired by the work of Robert Adam. Thomas Sheraton’s (1751–1806) The Cabinet-Maker and Upholsterer’s Drawing Book, published in 1791, was illed with variations of Hepplewhite’s designs. Because both men worked in the same style, it is often dificult to distinguish their designs. The distinctions are usually based on very slight differences in detail such as the direction of the curve on a drawer front or the shape of a chair back. Their chair designs featured straight square or reeded round, tapered legs without stretchers. The chair with the rectangular back is considered typical of the Sheraton style, and the shield- or heartshaped back chairs are typical of Hepplewhite designs. The Hepplewhite/Sheraton sideboard, or buffet, is a serving piece with drawers, raised on straight tapered legs. If the side drawers are concave, the piece is considered a Hepplewhite piece; if they are convex, it is considered a Sheraton piece. The Hepplewhite/Sheraton pembroke table is a dropleaf occasional table with a drawer in the apron. The top, when open, is oval in shape, and the legs are straight and tapered, without stretchers. Table 15.10 contains examples of Federal design.

Federal Color Colors during the Federal period were light and pastel. Americans were inluenced by the French Neoclassical colors such as cream; powder green and pink; French lilac and turquoise; Sevres blue (a clear medium blue); Pompadour blue and DuBarry red (soft colors named after Louis XV’s mistresses); and accentuated gold and silver tones like Federal yellow. English and Americans added Robert Adam colors to the spectrum: a clear spring green called Adam green, dove gray, pale lavender, faded red, deep olive green, grayed green and blue, warm pink, and the Wedgewood jasperware colors, which were tones of blue, warm coral pink, creamy sage, or stark white— sometimes accentuated with gold leaf.

Jeffersonian Federal Thomas Jefferson was not only an important statesman but also a ine architect, and his designs represent an important divergent style during the Federal period. Unlike the mainstream of Federal design, which was based on English prototypes, Jefferson based his work on the designs of classical Rome. In his role as statesman, Jefferson traveled to Europe where he saw remnants of Roman culture. He considered the ancient style appropriate for the new American republic and patterned his most famous contract buildings after two well-known Roman temples. The Rotunda at the University of Virginia (1822–26) at Charlottesville is the American incarnation of the Pantheon in Rome, and the State House (1785–92) at Richmond, Virginia, is a larger version of the Maison Carreé

Historic Influences in Design

Table 15.10

403

Federal Design and Hepplewhite/Sheraton Furniture

Exterior Characteristics

Contract Examples

• Five-bay, three-story, box-shaped facade of brick, stucco, or clapboard • Smaller windows on upper story • Second-story windows to loor (optional) • Doorway with fanlights and sidelights • Flattened hipped roof with optional balustrade at eaves • Classical detail from earlier periods such as the crown lintel, portico, Palladian window, stringcourse, and quoins (optional)

• State House (1795–98), Boston, Massachusetts; Charles Bullinch, architect • Baltimore Cathedral (1804–18), Baltimore, Maryland; Benjamin Latrobe, architect • Lancaster Meeting House (1816–17), Lancaster, Massachusetts; Charles Bullinch, architect • United States Custom House (1819), Salem, Massachusetts

Influences

Federal Interior

• Robert Adam • English Georgian design

Residential Examples • Pingree House (1804), Salem, Massachusetts; Samuel McIntire, architect • Pierce-Nichols House (1782), Salem, Massachusetts; Samuel McIntire, architect • Harrison Gray Otis House (1796), Boston, Massachusetts; Charles Bullinch, architect • Nathaniel Russell House (before 1809), Charleston, South Carolina • Amory Ticknor House (1804), Boston, Massachusetts

Pingree House

Fanlight and Sidelights

(continued)

404

Chapter 15

Table 15.10

Federal Design and Hepplewhite/Sheraton Furniture (continued)

Hepplewhite/Sheraton Style Pembroke Table

Hepplewhite Sideboard (Buffet)

Hepplewhite ShieldBack Chair

Sheraton SquareBack Chair

Hepplewhite Bow-Back Sofa

Interior Details

Federal Textiles

Floors. Wooden plank Walls. Plain plaster Windows. Sash Doors. Paneled, with fanlights used as transoms, sidelights Chimneypiece. Projecting, classical, in the Adam style, with a raised panel in the center of the frieze Ceiling. Plain, plaster with cornice molding Stairs. Various conigurations; wooden with turned balusters

Textile Description Colors. Pastel, light, creamy dull colors accented with white or a little rich color, Federal yellow and blue Patterns. Fine stripes, garlands, bows, ribbons, oval shapes, classic Greek and Roman urns and motifs, tiny lorals; in America also the pineapple (symbol of hospitality) Textures. Plain satin, reined damask and brocade, plain and antique taffeta, batiste, moiré, voile, chintz (crisp cotton textures)

Historic Influences in Design

405

in Nimes, France. His home, Monticello (1768–82), at Charlottesville, Virginia, features a prominent templelike portico that foreshadowed the ensuing Greek Revival style. The time Jefferson spent in France had a strong effect on the layout of Monticello as well as its dome—both were inspired by eighteenth-century Parisian hôtels (town houses). Jefferson’s work constitutes a significant and inluential departure from the typical Federal style.

American Vernacular Tradition (Seventeenth Century–Present)

Figure 15.14 Jefferson’s Monticello displays originality blended with influence from classical Roman architecture.

In spite of over a century of exposure to classical inluences, grassroots American architecture held tenaciously to the English Medieval tradition. Generally it was only the wealthy upper class who built the classically inspired houses discussed thus far. The vast majority of people living in America built adaptations of the new styles using the sturdy Medieval house form with its gabled roof, while others remodeled existing seventeenth-century houses, adding new details to make the Medieval house more stylish and upto-date. For example, during the Early Georgian period symmetrically placed sash windows and pilastered and pedimented doorways gave the gabled house a feeling of the new style. During the Federal period, the addition of fanlights and sidelights at the doorway imparted a sense of belonging to the era. These hybrid houses are referred to as vernacular, which literally means “common,” and implies the houses were adapted by local builders and developed regional characteristics. It also implies a naive, unschooled approach to design quite different from that which attempted to copy faithfully the i ne English houses. Vernacular design may result from lack of exposure or resources, or it may represent a strongwilled independence or personal preference. Vernacular is not a negative term; most vernacular houses are charming and, in fact, are the most enduring type of house in America. The majority of colonial-style homes built today are vernacular versions of the Georgian- or Federal-style houses. Though vernacular is generally considered a quality rather than a style, one type of vernacular house is so distinctive and well known that it has become a style: Cape Cod.

Cape Cod Cottage (Seventeenth Century–Present) The dwellings characteristic of rural Cape Cod, Massachusetts, have come to typify the American small house. The Cape Cod cottage is a one-story gabled house, usually inished in shingle siding that was allowed to weather to a soft gray in the salty coastal air. In the eighteenth century, the steep Medieval-style roof was lowered and sash windows and classical doorway details were added to make the houses more in step with the times. A few houses had slightly bowed roofs, called rainbow roofs, attributed to shipbuilders. (This type of house with a gambrel roof is called a Cape Ann house.) The eaves of the houses are very shallow, which gives them a crisp, boxy character. The size of the houses varied: a one-room half house of three bays, a four-bay, three-quarter house with one large and one small room, or a full-sized, ivebay double house containing two full-sized rooms with the doorway in the center. The Cape Cod house has maintained its popularity since it was introduced in the seventeenth century.

Vernacular Furniture Classics Several pieces of vernacular furniture used by the common people throughout the eighteenth and nineteenth centuries still have great appeal for today’s interiors. The American ladder-back chair is an important piece based on an English prototype. It has a frame made of straight members turned in a fashion that resembles a string of sausages (called sausage turnings) and joined with stretchers. The ladder-back chair would often appear

406

Chapter 15

Table 15.11

American Vernacular Design

Cape Cod Exterior Characteristics

Influences

• Small half house, three-quarter house, or full-sized house • One story (some two-story versions built in Nantucket, Massachusetts) • Gabled or rainbow roof, less steeply pitched than the Medieval houses (gambrel roofs make a Cape Ann house) • Sash windows directly under the eaves • Shallow eaves • Doorway with simpliied pilasters and entablature • Shingle siding (some clapboard)

• Seventeenth-century Medieval houses • Early Georgian houses • New England ship carpenters

Residential Examples • Kendrick House (c. 1790), Orleans, Massachusetts • Shadrach Standish House (1730), Halifax, Massachusetts • Hezekia Swain–Maria Mitchell House (1790), Nantucket, Massachusetts

Vernacular Georgian Deacon’s Bench

Cape Cod Cottage

in more humble homes or in the kitchens and servants’ quarters of grander homes. Like some other provincial chairs, the ladder-back chair has a seat of woven rush. The Welsh dresser or hutch is a side piece with cupboards, drawers, and a set of open shelves above. The hutch is descended from a sixteenth-century French kitchen cupboard and was popular in England in the seventeenth century as well as in Early America. The American Windsor chair, as the name implies, is based on an English prototype. The Windsor chair is

characterized by its saddle-shaped seat, turned legs with stretchers, and spindle back. The early versions were invariably painted. The most common backs are the curved bow or loop back and the comb back. Some later Windsor chairs featured legs turned to resemble bamboo. The English Windsor chair has a pierced splat and may have cabriole legs (see Table 9.1, p. 242). Vernacular design is shown in Table 15.11.

Historic Influences in Design

Table 15.11

407

American Vernacular Design (continued)

Gateleg Table Ladder-Back Chair

Textile Description Colors. Natural colors or neutrals (off-white, brown, gray) and colors that came from natural sources—madder or cranberry red, indigo blue, dull gold from birch leaves or other plants Patterns. When they were found, simple stripes and checks, stenciled or embroidered loral or folk patterns Textures. Homespun, muslin, lannel, broadcloth, burlap, ticking, handspun coarse textures

Bow-Back Windsor Chair Hutch Comb-Back Windsor Chair

Butterfly Table

Vernacular Textiles

Greek Revival/American Empire Style (1820–60) The Greek Revival grew out of the spirit of the times and was a natural expression of the growing independence of American culture. Greek mythology, culture, and often even the classical Greek language were part of educational training during the early nineteenth century. Literature and art often alluded to the ancient Greeks, and the Greek war of independence from Turkey had focused

the world’s attention on modern Greece. The Greek style was not tied directly to English inluences. In fact, the Greek Revival was the irst style that was truly harmonious with the American vernacular taste for the gabled house. The gabled end of the house, when turned toward the street, became a Greek temple facade. It was adaptable enough to make it suitable for ine city dwellings as well as regional vernacular houses. The style found acceptance everywhere in the country, but it varied so much in its interpretation that it is

408

Chapter 15

and American Empire or Regency. Duncan Phyfe (1768–1854), a Scottish cabinetmaker who worked in New York, is famous for his delicate Regency-style furniture. His designs often incorporated the lyre or harp as a prominent motif. Until recently, only the Phyfe designs from this period had widespread popularity. However, today the heavier French Empire and Biedermeier styles ind wide acceptance as antiques, and their reproductions are being manufactured in larger numbers. The Hitchcock chair is a vernacular design by Lambert Hitchcock (1795–1852), a Connecticut designer. The chair shows the inluence of Duncan Phyfe and English Figure 15.15 Stanton Hall in Natchez, Mississippi, exemplifies the stately quality of the Regency designs and is characterGreek Revival style. Photo © David A. Taylor ized by its black painted inish, turned legs, rush or cane seat, and dificult to identify a single set of characteristics. The one gold stenciled fruit and lower decoration. Greek Revival characteristic that seems to be universal is the use of all and American Empire design are shown in Table 15.12. or part of the Greek temple form on a one- or two-story dwelling. The most extravagant examples feature a full Empire Color Doric, Ionic, Corinthian, and even Roman Tuscan colonThe Empire style, which was strongly inluenced by nade with a complete entablature, and the most unasFrench taste, was a relection of Napoleon’s campaigns suming interpretations are those where the gabled end and personal admiration for the classical interiors. The forms an extremely simple pedimented facade that is colors that predominated are bright royal red and gold; turned toward the street. The Greek Revival door openemerald to olive green; majestic purple and brown; and ing was generally lanked by sidelights and headed by an oblong transom (over-the-door window). The doorway might be framed by a full portico or simply trimmed with pilasters and an entablature; pilasters were sometimes used to give deinition to the facade. The basic twostory temple form might be given additional space with one-story lanking wings.

American Empire Furniture Classics The interior and furniture styles of the Greek Revival are referred to as American Empire style. Much of the furniture from the American Empire era was based on French and British prototypes. The French Empire and English Regency styles date from the early nineteenth century, during the reign of Napoleon in France and George IV in England. Much of the furniture from this period was heavy, based on designs from Rome, yet some of the chairs were amazingly light and delicate—inspired by a new appreciation for the designs of classical Greece, and maintaining much of the delicacy of the previous Louis XVI and Sheraton styles. The Empire and Regency designs made their way to northern Europe and America, where the styles are known respectively as Biedermeier

15.16 Hitchcock chairs are painted black with gold decorative stenciling. The legs are turned and the seats are of rush. This type of chair is often referred to as a “fancy chair.” Photo © Brian Vanden Brink

Historic Influences in Design

Table 15.12

409

Greek Revival Design and American Empire Interiors and Furniture

Exterior Characteristics

Residential Examples

• Bold forms with an emphasis on strength rather than delicacy • Greek temple form with pediment (gabled end) oriented toward the front • Porticoes and colonnades with two-story Greek columns • Some use of Roman Tuscan columns • Exterior inish of stone, brick, wooden siding, or stucco • Sash windows • Door openings lanked with sidelights and headed with oblong transoms, or lanked with pilasters and crowned with an entablature

• Andalusia (1836), Bucks County, Pennsylvania • Joseph Bowers House (1825), Northampton, Massachusetts • Russell House (1828–30), Middletown, Connecticut (now Honors College, Wesleyan University) • Shadows-on-the-Teche (1830), New Iberia, Louisiana • James Lanier House (1844), Madison, Indiana • Dunlieth (1847), Natchez, Mississippi • Alonzo Olds House (1848), Rushton, Michigan

Influences • Previous classical styles • The architecture of classical Greece and Rome • Some French inluence

Contract Examples • Philadelphia Water Works (1819), Philadelphia, Pennsylvania • Girard College (1833), Philadelphia, Pennsylvania • Second Bank of the United States (1924), Philadelphia, Pennsylvania • Quincy Market (1825), Boston, Massachusetts • Hibernian Hall (1835), Charleston, South Carolina • Congregational Church (1838), Madison, Connecticut

Vernacular Greek Revival

Andalusia Shadows-on-the-Teche

Doorway with Transom (continued)

410

Chapter 15

Table 15.12

Greek Revival Design and American Empire Interiors and Furniture (continued) American Empire Console Table

American Empire Interior

American Empire Fainting Sofa/Grecian Sofa

American Empire Textiles

Interior Details Floors. Wooden plank, patterned broadloom carpet Walls. Plain plaster or chair rail Windows. Sash or French doors Doors. Paneled, heavy molding; wooden transom with cornice Chimneypiece. Projecting, classical, black marble, or faux painted Ceiling. Plain with crown or cornice molding, anaglypta Stairs. Several conigurations; curved was popular; wooden with turned balusters

Duncan Phyfe Flap-Top Table

Hitchcock Chair

Textile Description Colors. French-inspired color schemes included rich vivid red, gold, deep green, brown, and royal purple; these were also used in America and were sometimes softened to pale mauve, spun honey, dull greens and browns, and dull gray-violet Patterns. Plain satin background with isolated small motifs such as the laurel wreath, the star or snowlake, honeybee, or classical urns; also the grifin, festooning, both broad and blended satin stripes Textures. Plain satin, antique taffeta and silk textures, various sheer and semisheer fabrics

Duncan Phyfe Chair

Historic Influences in Design

411

accents of pale mauve, cream, white, or black. The bold color statements were seen particularly in upholstery, draperies, and broadloom woven (Wilton and Axminster) carpeting.

Victorian Age in America (1837–1901) The Victorian era in America corresponds to the reign of Queen Victoria of England from 1837 to 1901, though the architectural styles attached to her name extended beyond the turn of the century and coexisted with the radical new architectural developments of the Modern era. This coexistence was less than peaceful and may account for the scorn that was heaped upon Victorian design during the middle of the twentieth century. Victorian architecture is not a single style but a succession and eclectic mixing of styles. Some of the styles have their roots in the philosophies of the nineteenth century. For example, the Gothic Revival was ired by the notion that pagan buildings (Greek and Roman) were not it for Christian living—the only suitable style for Christians was Gothic. However, those who adopted the styles were likely less concerned with philosophy than with aesthetics. The nineteenth century saw the full bloom of the Industrial Revolution and a rapid succession of advancements that radically changed the way people lived. The ireplace and stove were replaced by central heating. Gas lighting and, eventually, electric lighting took the place of oil lamps and candles. Indoor plumbing made the outhouse and water pump things of the past. The modern lifestyle with its many conveniences, often taken for granted today, was developed by the Victorians. The advancement of technology also paved the way for migration from the farm to the city, where industry was creating a growing middle class and a new wealthy class. This rapid change in society seemed to trigger a proliferation of decorative styles and treatments that have become the hallmark of Victorian design. As each new Victorian style developed, elements of former styles were retained and adapted to create an eclectic design patchwork that signaled the end of classical dominance. Each new variation in style was historical in nature but lacked the authenticity of the original styles upon which they were based. They were re-creations of a distant and romantic past by craftspersons in possession of the new technology of the Industrial Revolution. The most important of these styles were the Gothic Revival, Italianate, Egyptian Revival, Oriental, Mansard, Stick, Shingle, and Queen Anne styles. Victorian design is seen in Table 15.13.

Victorian Furniture Classics Because the Industrial Revolution spawned a large furniture industry, many new pieces and styles emerged during the nineteenth century. Foremost among the

Figure 15.17 Longwood in Natchez, Mississippi, is an octagonal house in the Oriental Revival style characterized by its onion dome. Photo © David A. Taylor

styles were the Gothic Revival advocated by Englishman Charles Eastlake (1793–1865), the Rococo Revival, and the Renaissance Revival. Eastlake wrote a book called Hints on Household Taste that discussed furniture of good taste based on Medieval and Japanese inluences. He was opposed to the rapid changes in style and the machine construction so common during the Victorian era. The calls of Eastlake and others for a return to the simple handcraftsmanship of the Middle Ages did little to stem the tide of mass production, but it did heighten the taste for Gothic design. The Rococo Revival was based on eighteenth-century French Rococo designs and featured a fantastic array of curved lines in both wooden and upholstered pieces. John Henry Belter (d. 1865) created heavily carved pieces of furniture from laminated rosewood, and his name is often associated with the Rococo Revival style. The Renaissance Revival was inluenced in part by the writings of Eastlake. A return to clean, straight lines was seen as an Eastlake principle, and many of the rectilinear designs actually came to be known as the Eastlake style. Renaissance Revival pieces also bear a strong

412

Chapter 15

Table 15.13

Victorian Design

Gothic Revival Exterior Characteristics

Italianate Exterior Characteristics

• Steeply pitched gables (sometimes combined with low-hipped roof) • Parapets or battlements (low walls on the roof) that are crenellated (notched) • Towers, spires, and inials on the roof • Stone construction (iner houses only) • Vertical wooden siding of board and batten (these wooden houses are called Carpenter’s Gothic) • Lacy wooden version of Gothic tracery called gingerbread used to decorate eaves and porches • Pointed Gothic and lattened Tudor arches used for window, door, and veranda framing • Leaded pane windows

• Also called Italian and Tuscan, inspired by Italian country houses and Prince Albert’s design of Osborne House in England • Low-pitched hipped or gabled roof • Wide overhanging cornices with large brackets • Square tower with a low pitched roof (optional) • Belvedere (lookout with windows in tower) • Roundheaded windows (optional) • Ornate versions of classical details such as modillions and pediments • Often used for New York brownstone and other city row houses

Residential Examples • Lyndhurst (1838), Tarrytown, New York; Alexander Jackson Davis, architect • Greystone (c. 1859), Pevely, Missouri • Town Ofice Building (1847), Cazenovia, New York; Andrew Jackson Downing, architect

Contract Examples

Residential Examples • • • •

David Mayer Farmhouse (1867), Lancaster, Pennsylvania Edward King House (1845), Newport, Rhode Island Mills-Stebbins House (1849–51), Springield, Massachusetts Morse-Libby House (1859), Portland, Maine

Contract Examples • Haughwout Building (1857), New York, New York (cast-iron facade) • Sanger-Peper Building (1874), St. Louis, Missouri (cast-iron facade)

• St. Patrick’s Cathedral (1858–79), New York, New York; James Renwick, architect • Brooklyn Bridge (1869–83), New York, New York • Baptist Church (1878), North Salem, New York • Calvary Presbyterian Church (1883), Portland, Oregon

Gothic Revival

Italianate Style

Gothic Revival, Calvary Presbyterian Church

Historic Influences in Design

Table 15.13

413

Victorian Design (continued)

Egyptian Revival Exterior Characteristics

Residential Examples

• Not philosophically suited for residential design but was considered appropriate for cemetery gates, tombs, and mausoleums (perhaps because of the Egyptian preoccupation with the afterlife and preparation for death) • Also used for prisons and churches • Featured sloping walls with wide cornices

• Longwood (1860), Natchez, Mississippi • Olana (1870–72), near Hudson, New York

Contract Examples

Mansard Exterior Characteristics

• Whaler’s Church (1844), Sag Harbor, New York • Gates, Grove St. Cemetery (1848), New Haven, Connecticut

• Also called Second Empire and inluenced by nineteenthcentury French design • Also called General Grant Style because it was popular during the presidency of Ulysses S. Grant • Mansard roof crested with a low, wrought-iron railing • Dormer windows that rest on or break through the line of the eaves • Quoins (optional)

Oriental Exterior Characteristics • Also called Moorish or Persian, inspired by Islamic design • Pointed and horseshoe Moorish arches used for doorways, windows, and porches • Bulbous onion domes used to crown towers or belvederes

Contract Examples • Wise Temple (1866), Cincinnati, Ohio

Residential Examples Oriental Revival, Longwood

• • • •

Governor’s Mansion (1871), Jefferson City, Missouri John DeKoven House (1874), Chicago, Illinois Governor’s Mansion (1878), Sacramento, California Iolani Palace (1882), Honolulu, Hawaii

Contract Examples • • • •

City Hall (1872–1901), Philadelphia, Pennsylvania Grand Union Hotel (1872), Saratoga Springs, New York McKinley High School (1872), Lincoln, Nebraska Hill County Courthouse (1890), Hillsboro, Texas

Egyptian Revival, Whaler’s Church

Mansard Style

(continued)

414

Chapter 15

Table 15.13

Victorian Design (continued)

Stick Exterior Characteristics

Shingle Exterior Characteristics

• Victorian version of Late English Medieval house • Steep gables • Stickwork patterning applied to represent vertical, diagonal, and horizontal timber construction • Jetties or overhangs

• Inspired by colonial seaside dwellings like the Cape Cod, Cape Ann, and Nantucket houses; appeared irst as resort houses on the eastern seaboard • Covered with shingles • Small paned windows

Residential Examples

Residential Examples

• Griswold House (1862–63), Newport, Rhode Island • Emlen Physick House (1879), Cape May, New Jersey

• Kragsyde (1884), Manchester-by-the-Sea, Massachusetts • Dr. John Bryant House (1880), Cohasset, Massachusetts; Henry Hobson Richardson, architect • William Low House (1887), Bristol, Rhode Island; McKim, Mead, and White, architects • Frank Lloyd Wright House (1889), Oak Park, Illinois; Frank Lloyd Wright, architect

Stick Style, Griswold House

Shingle-Style, Kragsyde

Historic Influences in Design

Table 15.13

415

Victorian Design (continued)

Queen Anne Exterior Characteristics

Queen Anne Style

• Features a variety of decoration and surface embellishments such as stone, rounded ish-scale shingles, clapboard, stickwork, lathwork, turned balusters, and fretwork • Strong horizontal lines or bands • Combination of gabled and steep-hipped roolines • Turret (towers) often rounded with round pointed roofs • Rounded gazebos—part of the veranda • Moon gate arch—part of the veranda (optional) • Some use of stained glass

Residential Examples • Miss Parks House (1876), Cape May, New Jersey • Glenmont (1880), West Orange, New Jersey • Haas-Lilienthal House (1886), San Francisco, California

Contract Examples • Hotel del Coronado (1888), Coronado, California

Victorian Interior

Interior Details Floors. Wood plank Walls. Plain plaster with wallpaper Windows. Sash—large panes of glass Doors. Paneled; some sliding pocket doors Chimneypiece. Projecting carved marble, with a roundheaded arched opening Ceiling. Mass-produced crown moldings, anaglypta patterns, and chandelier medallions of plaster Stairs. Various conigurations, straight run favored; wooden with turned balusters and elaborate newel posts

Textile Description

Victorian Belter/Rococo Revival Armchair

Victorian Gothic Revival Side Chair

Colors. Called the mauve decades—due to the many varieties of dull, somber reds; also deeper values of green, blue, violet, and gold; backgrounds were often off-white or black Patterns. Copied and adapted, stylized and combined from many sources including Gothic, Egyptian, Byzantine, Oriental, Neoclassic, Rococo, Renaissance, with plenty of large- and small-scale loral and lacy patterns Textures. Velvets of every description, woven Jacquard fabrics from very smooth to very heavy, cotton prints, lace, and heavy trimming

(continued)

416

Chapter 15

Table 15.13

Victorian Design (continued) Victorian Renaissance Revival Cabinet

Victorian Belter/Rococo Revival Table

Victorian Renaissance Revival Side Chair

Victorian Textiles

resemblance to Louis XVI furniture. This style is also characterized by the use of a segmental pediment form in many pieces.

Table 15.14

Shaker Design

Shaker Rocker

Victorian Color The Victorian period was an age of richly furnished eclecticism. This era is often referred to as the mauve decades, supporting colors such as deep, old-looking red and faded rose red or mauve, wine and dark violet, taupe, and black. Also seen were sage, dark olive, clear green, dark and creamy gold, tobacco brown, rust, and accents of royal blue, bright red and magenta in traditionally designed textile patterns. From the turn of the century through the 1930s, many pure revivals were seen, and colors were often documented to the era of the revival.

Shaker Candle Stand

Shaker Influence In contrast to contemporary Victorian designs, Shaker furniture was particularly simple. The Shakers were a nineteenth-century religious group whose beliefs included the design of furniture free from excessive decoration. The Shaker chair has straight legs with straight stretchers and straight uprights with simply formed slats or a woven back. Like the woven backs, the seats are generally webbed with cotton tapes. The uprights and arms might be i nished with simple i nials, and

the top rail was sometimes designed to accommodate a folded blanket. The Shaker candle stand is a small tripod pedestal table of beautiful proportions and delicate lines. Like other Shaker pieces, it is remarkable because of the purity

Historic Influences in Design

417

Figure 15.19 The log cabin is a Swedish contribution to American culture.

Figure 15.18 This vignette shows Shaker craftsmanship. The chair seat is made of interlaced woven tapes, the back of the chair is topped with an acorn finial, and the arm is capped with a mushroom finial: Decoration is minimal. The simple turned wooden knobs on the cabinet are typical of Shaker design. Photo © Brian Vanden Brink

of its design and its suitability in contemporary environments. Table 15.14 shows Shaker design.

Swedish Influence Seventeenth-century Scandinavian settlers introduced the house type for which America is most famous—the log cabin. The log house was a typical Scandinavian rural architectural form adapted by eighteenth- and nineteenth-century settlers of many origins. As Americans pushed the country’s borders westward, the log cabin made a strong and quick shelter. Closer to our own time, the simple dwelling has been adapted for the construction of rustic cabins and resort hotels, such as Old Faithful Inn (1904) at Yellowstone National Park.

German Influence The German settlers in Pennsylvania used the plentiful local gray and brown ieldstone to build houses that varied only slightly from the mainstream of American

English architecture. The Germans, or Deutsch, were mistakenly called Pennsylvania Dutch, a designation that has endured. The Pennsylvania Dutch have long been noted for their arts and crafts. The marriage chest, used to hold a young woman’s dowry, was often painted in an artistic and decorative manner and is a good example of the Pennsylvania Dutch style. Table 15.15 shows German design.

Dutch Influence Nothing remains of the seventeenth-century Dutch buildings in New York City (originally New Amsterdam), and of all the Dutch houses in America, the most distinctive type may not even be Dutch. Historians differ as to whether the so-called Dutch house, with the bellshaped gambrel roof and laring eaves, was an American or Flemish development. Regardless of its origins, the house type has come to be known as Dutch Colonial. Unlike the Dutch, who were merchants, the Flemish settlers were generally farmers and built ine farmhouses. Table 15.16 shows an example of a Dutch house.

Louisiana French Influence The architectural characteristics of the houses of French settlers along the southern part of the Mississippi River were distinctive, but not all were strongly tied to the architecture of France. Instead they represented an adaptability to the warm and wet climate and waterlogged terrain of that region. The stucco-covered houses with steeply pitched hipped roofs built by Norman French settlers were soon itted with an encircling porch called a galerie. The roof was extended at a lower pitch to cover the galerie, forming a bonnet roof ideally suited to protect from rain and

418

Chapter 15

Table 15.15

German/Pennsylvania Dutch Design

Exterior Characteristics

Residential Examples

• • • • • •

• Troxell-Steckel House (1756), Egypt, Pennsylvania • Thompson-Neely House (1710), Washington Crossing, Pennsylvania • Georg Mueller House (1752), Milbach, Pennsylvania • Peter Wentz House (1758), Worcester, Pennsylvania

Large, simple, rectangular construction Built of roughly inished ieldstone or brick Transom over front door Sash windows Gabled or gambrel roof A narrow, overhanging roolike projection between the irst and second stories, called a pent roof (optional) • Cantilevered (unsupported) triangular portico (optional)

Contract Examples • Washington’s Headquarters (1758), Valley Forge State Park, Pennsylvania • Trout Hall (1770), Allentown, Pennsylvania

Pennsylvania Dutch Marriage Chest

Pennsylvania Dutch, Wentz House

Table 15.16

Dutch Design

Exterior Characteristics • • • •

Houses of stone, brick, or clapboard Gambrel roof with a line that breaks near the ridge Flaring eaves that give the roof a bell shape Sash windows and doors typical of mainstream English/ American design

Dutch Design, Dyckman House

Residential Examples • • • •

Dyckman House (1783), New York, New York Zabriskie–Von Steuben House (1752), Hackensack, New Jersey Richard Vreeland House (1786), Leonia, New Jersey Jacobus Demarest House (1719), Bergen County, New Jersey

heat. French doors and casement windows opened onto the galerie and allowed the air to move freely through the house. The galerie with French windows and doors was also an important feature that persisted in the design of Greek Revival and Victorian houses of the area. These French details imparted a quality of elegance that is still associated with southern culture. Low piers raised

some French houses above the dampness. Some houses were built above a raised basement—it was used as a service area and also offered protection from looding or dampness in areas with high water tables. The French town houses of New Orleans were built around galeried garden courtyards. During the Victorian era, with the advent of cast iron, galeries were also added

Historic Influences in Design

Table 15.17

Louisiana French Design

Exterior Characteristics • • • • •

Galerie French doors French windows Bonnet roof, sometimes with dormer windows Frequently built over a raised basement

Residential Examples • Madame John’s Legacy (c. 1727), New Orleans, Louisiana • La Veuve-Dodier House (1766), St. Louis, Missouri • The Fortier-Keller House (1801), St. Charles Parish, Louisiana • Le Pretre Mansion (1836), New Orleans, Louisiana

Louisiana French Design, Madame John’s Legacy

419

to the front of the houses. These galeries of lacelike cast iron, though found elsewhere, are a symbol of New Orleans and add a touch of character that makes that city particularly charming. Table 15.17 shows an example of a French house.

Spanish Missions The earliest Spanish settlement in America was at St. Augustine, Florida, predating English settlement in Virginia by nearly 50 years. However, due to lack of colonization, frequent destruction and rebuilding, and repeated English inhabitation, no signiicant inluences of these original Spanish settlements remain. The Spanish also controlled the area along the southwestern border of the United States, from present-day Texas to California. Traces of Spanish inluence can be seen throughout that region, particularly in the design of missions and churches. These were vernacular designs incorporating Spanish detailing contributed by the missionary-priests, together with the local materials and construction methods employed by the indigenous Indians. Some examples of remaining Spanish-style missions include: • San José y Miguel de Aguayo (1768–78), San Antonio, Texas • San Xavier del Bac (1783–97), near Tucson, Arizona • San Carlos de Borromeo (1797), Carmel, California

Southwest Adobe Style

Figure 15.20 San Carlos de Borromeo in Carmel, California, is considered one of the jewels of the California Spanish missions.

In New Mexico, the Southwest Adobe style has endured. Colonists of European extraction arrived in New Mexico early in the seventeenth century and began building houses using the same methods employed by the local Pueblo Indians. The Indian dwellings, or pueblos, were communal structures of adobe (clay bricks) several stories high. The Indians reached the upper stories by means of ladders. The thick adobe bricks are natural insulators in a climate that is hot in the summer and cold in the winter. Adobes are made by forming clay (bonded with straw) in wooden frames about 1½ feet long and drying the bricks in the sun. Adobe “melts” in the rain and is stuccoed with clay and straw to slow deterioration. The mud imparts a grayish-brown to pink color that varies according to the clay used. Table 15.18 contains examples of the Southwest Adobe style. The irregular walls support the large log roof beams, known as vigas, which are not cut to size but protrude through the walls. These make a convenient place to dry chilies and hang other objects. The beams are covered with thin sticks called latillas that are laid across the vigas in parallel fashion or herringbone patterns and form the ceiling of the structure as well as the base for rooing material. Originally the roof was made of sod or

420

Chapter 15

Table 15.18

Southwest Adobe Design

Exterior Characteristics • • • • • •

Southwest Adobe Interior

Thick, irregular, adobe walls with rounded corners Mud-colored stucco inish on exterior walls Deep-set windows and doors Vigas (log beams) protrude through the walls Flat roofs Portal (porch) with wooden post and lintels decorated with carved double corbels called zapatas

Residential Examples • Palace of the Governors (c. 1610—restored to its nineteenthcentury appearance), Santa Fe, New Mexico • Casa San Ysidro (eighteenth century), Corrales, New Mexico • Filipe Delgado House (c. 1872), Santa Fe, New Mexico

Contract Examples • San Francisco de Asis (c. 1772), Ranchos de Taos, New Mexico • Mission Church (c. 1710), Santa Ana Pueblo, New Mexico

Southwest Adobe Design, Palace of the Governors

Figure 15.21 These adobe-style buildings in Santa Fe, New Mexico, have strong ties to local culture and are well suited to the New Mexican climate. Photo by Markus Fant

Historic Influences in Design

421

Interior Details

Table 15.18

Southwest Adobe Design (continued)

Territorial Style

Floors. Wood plank or tile Walls. Stucco Windows. Casement Doors. Plank or paneled Chimneypiece. Irregular, rounded, stuccoed adobe, corner ireplace with a round, arched opening Ceiling. Vigas and latillas Stairs. Early versions generally one story; contemporary versions incorporate various conigurations and styles

Textile Description Colors. Authentic Spanish colors are either dramatic and bold red, gold, and black (all used sparingly as accents) or dull, sun-drenched, very livable colors. The dull pastel colors have inluenced Western trends of recent years. The inluence from Latin America gives accent colors of brilliant blue-green, chartreuse, vivid violet, and sunshine yellow Patterns. Geometric patterns based on American Indian motifs, stripes Textures. Heavy, coarse matelassé, tweed, homespun textures, leather

Zapatas

Southwest Textiles

packed earth and required constant repairs (today they are made of more durable materials). The early pueblos had no windows, but during the eighteenth century the settlers began to incorporate paned windows deeply set into the thick adobe walls. The irst settlers’ houses were built, Spanish style, around an open courtyard. The house served as a fortress, opened to the interior with no exterior windows, and was entered through a sturdy wooden gate. As the threat of attack lessened with the years, the house took on a friendlier aspect, opening to the front, which often includes a covered porch or portal. The porch is supported by sturdy posts capped with a carved double corbel or bracket called a zapata, and topped with lintels. When brick became available, it was used to form a row of trim along the top of the adobe walls. The trim,

Corbel Brackets

called pretil, is a protection for the weaker adobe and is characteristic of the Territorial style frequently seen in Santa Fe. It is a vernacular version of classical design and may feature dentil trim, simple pediments above the windows, and square painted columns in imitation of the Greek Revival. Special ordinances in Santa Fe and Taos permit building only in the Adobe (or Territorial) style, giving both those cities a unique architectural continuity found in few other places.

California Ranch House Early California ranch houses (c. 1820), like Southwest Adobe houses, were lat-roofed structures built of adobe. However, the lat roof soon gave way to the low-pitched, gabled, red tile roof, which was more practical in a rainier

422

Chapter 15

Figure 15.22 This building in Santa Fe, New Mexico, is an example of the Territorial style. Note the boxed columns and the brick pretil as well as the lack of vigas. Photo © David A. Taylor

climate. Because there was less need for protection, the house was generally not enclosed with a walled court but open and rambling with a covered porch running the length of the house. The original houses do not exist in numbers suficient to warrant listing their characteristics. Their signiicance lies in the fact that they are thought to be the precursor of the twentieth-century rambler or ranch-style house found in many parts of the country. These builder/developer houses, so well suited to the informal California lifestyle, soon found acceptance in other parts of the country. Many of the newer versions have been adapted to the point where any similarity to the originals is purely coincidental.

The Monterey House The Monterey house is a California vernacular style that blends mainstream American English inluence, local inluence, and the ingenuity of its irst builder. Thomas Larkin, a merchant from Boston, was the United States Consul to California when Monterey was the colonial capital. The two-story house he built in Monterey was made of adobe but built with a Georgian central hall loor plan, paned windows, and a low, hipped, shingled roof. Larkin designed the roof to cover a second-story balcony and a porch that surrounded the house like the French galerie (Larkin likely arrived at the design independent of French inluence). The Larkin house was the prototype for several other houses and contract buildings in the vicinity, and today the style, built

throughout California and the West, is called Monterey (see Table 15.19).

The Beaux Arts Influence (1881–1945) Beaux Arts is not a style. Rather, it is the inluence on the training of architects, either direct or indirect, of L’École des Beaux Arts in Paris, France. At the beginning of the 1880s, in the midst of Victorian eclecticism and informality, Richard Morris Hunt, the irst American architect trained at L’École des Beaux Arts, designed a home for the Vanderbilt family in New York that was elegant, reined, and historically correct. Thus, America was launched on a new sea of historical inluence in architecture. The training at L’École des Beaux Arts focused on historical design in its most minute details. This type of training, which became the standard for American architectural schools, produced designers capable of creating the magniicent palaces and châteaux demanded by the new rich, as well as accurately styled smaller homes for those of less means. By the early years of the 1900s, most American architects were being trained in the historical Beaux Arts tradition, and its inluence was felt in most areas of the country. Much of the traditional, historical architecture of the Tudor, French, Dutch, Georgian, Federal, Greek Revival, Spanish, and Colonial styles, in the pre–World War II neighborhoods of the country, shows the Beaux Arts inluence. Row houses or town houses also came from the drawing boards of Beaux Arts architects. Without understanding

Historic Influences in Design

Table 15.19

423

Monterey Design

Exterior Characteristics

Contract Examples

• • • • •

• Thomas Larkin House (1835–37), Monterey, California (also used as a store) • Old Customs House (1827), Monterey, California

Two stories Hipped or gabled roof of tile or shingles Second-story balcony, cantilevered or supported with posts Sash windows Generally stucco covered

Residential Examples • Thomas Larkin House (1835–37), Monterey, California • Los Cerritos Ranch House (1884), Long Beach, California

Monterey Design, Larkin House

Figure 15.23 Architect Julia Morgan’s Hearst Castle is an extravagant example of Beaux Arts architecture on a mountaintop overlooking the central California coast. Photo © David A. Taylor

this signiicant inluence, it is dificult to account for much of the period-style architecture that surrounds us. Table 15.20 shows examples of Beaux Arts buildings.

Historic European Style in Contemporary Design We have seen the inluence of European style on the development of design in North America. There are, however, popular contemporary design styles that did not develop in America. They certainly may be related to indigenous American designs, but these styles have been imported directly from Europe and now have great popularity. For example, beyond Rome and the Renaissance, there was no signiicant inluence of Italian popular design in North America during the seventeenth, eighteenth, nineteenth, and early twentieth centuries. But today we see the Tuscan style from Italy appearing in many places. Tuscan design in America is a contemporary development without a North American history.

424

Chapter 15

Table 15.20

Beaux Arts Influence

Exterior Characteristics • Vary according to the intended style of the building

Residential Examples • Biltmore (1890–95), Asheville, North Carolina; Richard Morris Hunt, architect—French Renaissance • The Breakers (1892–95), Newport, Rhode Island; Richard Morris Hunt, architect—Italian Renaissance • Marble House (1892), Newport, Rhode Island; Richard Morris Hunt, architect—French Neoclassical • Hearst Castle (1919–47), San Simeon, California; Julia Morgan, architect—Spanish Renaissance • Benjamin Winchell House (1922), Fieldston, New York; Dwight James Baum, architect—Dutch Colonial • Conkey House (1934), Santa Fe, New Mexico—Southwest Adobe

Contract Examples • Boston Public Library (1895), Boston, Massachusetts; McKim, Mead, and White, architects—Italian Renaissance • Union Station (1907), Washington, D.C.; Daniel H. Burnham, architect—Classical • County Courthouse (1920), Santa Barbara, California; William Mooser, architect—Spanish

French Renaissance Style, Beaux Arts Influence, Biltmore

• Woolworth Building (1913), New York, New York; Cass Gilbert, architect—Gothic Skyscraper • Palace of Fine Arts (1915), San Francisco, California; Bernard Maybeck, architect—Classical • Grauman’s Chinese Theater (1927), Los Angeles, California; Meyer and Holler, architects—Chinese • Savoy Plaza Hotel (1928), New York, New York; McKim, Mead, and White, architects—Classical French Château Skyscraper

Beaux Arts Influence, Late Medieval (Tudor) Style

Historic Influences in Design

Other such styles include the formal Louis XV and Louis XVI styles from France, and less-formal vernacular styles like Country French and Spanish Colonial.

Formal European Design Formal European interior design styles considered here include the French Louis XV style and the Louis XVI style. The formal English styles (Queen Anne, Chippendale, Hepplewhite, and Sheraton) are discussed in the Early Georgian, Late Georgian, and Federal sections of the chapter. The furniture illustrated here furnished the palaces of French monarchs and the town houses and chateaux of the French aristocracy during the eighteenth century.

Table 15.21

French Rococo/Louis XV Design

425

These pieces are seen in contemporary interiors both as antiques and reproductions. For over two centuries, these formal and sophisticated designs have graced the interiors of those who appreciate the reinement of French design, and they will likely continue to be admired and used for generations to come.

Louis XV Rococo-style furniture, from the Louis XV period, celebrates curved lines as do pieces from the pre-Rococo French Régence period. Open armchairs (fauteuil) and upholstered armchairs (bergère) both feature curved cabriole legs and rounded back shapes. The same predominance of curved lines is seen in tables, desks, and chests (Table 15.21).

Interior Details Floors. Parquet Walls. Large, rectangular, painted wooden panels, often with carved or painted asymmetrical, curvilinear designs; French paneling is called boiserie Windows. Long French casement or French doors Doors. Paneled, double doors Chimneypiece. Projecting, ornate carved marble, curvilinear opening Ceiling. Flat, plain, cove molding Stairs. Stone U-stair, with ornate wrought-iron balustrade

French Rococo Interior

Textile Description Colors. Soft and feminine—turquoise, rose, warm creamy yellow, pale sage green Patterns. Shells were quite popular, along with ribbons, scrolls, love knots, country folk in country scenes, and Chinese chinoiserie motifs—pagodas, architecture, nature scenes, fretwork, and Chinese people in native dress Textures. Fabrics were very reined and smooth—taffeta, chiffon, damask, brocade, velvet, lampas, batiste

Régence (Pre-Rococo) Fauteuil Open Armchair

Rococo Console Table Rococo Bergère Upholstered Armchair

(continued)

426

Chapter 15

Table 15.21

French Rococo/Louis XV Design (continued)

Rococo Bureau-à-Cylindre

Rococo Fauteuil

Rococo Commode

Rolltop Desk

Open Armchair

Low Chest of Drawers

Rococo Textiles

Louis XVI During the period between the reign of Louis XV and the French Revolution at the end of the eighteenth century, Louis XVI was monarch in France. Spurred by the archeological rediscovery of Pompeii and Herculaneum, design became classical and rectilinear (straight-lined). The interior details and furniture of the period all relected the new trend toward classicism and clean lines (Table 15.22).

Vernacular European Design The major inluences of Vernacular European Design seen here are Country French, Spanish Colonial, and Italian Tuscan design. These southern European styles incorporate similar materials and inishes that are informal and unreined—hence vernacular. Furnishings in each of these design styles developed over several hundred years with handcrafted and rustic charm

Country French Country French design is also sometimes known as French Provincial, named for the provinces or rural areas of France. The term provençal, sometimes confused with provincial, refers to design from Provence, a single French province. The Country French style developed in both spacious country chateaux and small cottages during the reigns of Louis XV (Rococo era), Louis XVI (Neoclassic era), and throughout the nineteenth century from the time of Napoleon (Empire) onward. Table 15.23 illustrates

Rococo-inspired furniture pieces, although pieces such as the ladder-back chair and armoire were made in Neoclassic- and Empire-inspired styles as well. The combination of simple, unreined materials and inishes, beautiful textiles, and charming furniture pieces has appealed to several generations of discerning home owners since Else deWolfe introduced the light and lovely look of eighteenth-century French interiors at the end of the heavily decorated Victorian era. The chaise à capucine or fauteuil à la bonne femme is a ladder-back chair with a rush seat from the provinces of France. Provincial designs were inluenced by court styles, so the chair may feature straight or curved lines, depending on the inluence. Most of the ine reproductions feature curved back slats and legs. The Country French armoire is a large carved wardrobe used for storage. Like the fauteuil à la bonne femme, the design of the armoire was inluenced by the designs at court and may show asymmetrical elements common to the Rococo style or the rectilinear qualities of Louis XVI designs.

Spanish Colonial The Spanish Colonial period, during the time of Spanish exploration, conquest, and settlement in the Americas, dates from 1500–1840. As a mainstream architectural and interior design style, Spanish Colonial was popular during the Beaux Arts period (1881–1945), with a shorter surge of popularity during the 1970s and 1980s, and again today, as an important interior design style. The style is

Historic Influences in Design

Table 15.22

427

French Neoclassical/Louis XVI Design

French Neoclassical Interior

Interior Details Floors. Parquet wood Walls. Large, rectilinear, painted wooden panels Windows. Tall French casement or French windows Doors. Paneled, double doors Chimneypiece. Projecting, carved marble, rectilinear with corner-block designs Ceiling. Flat, plain, with decorative cornice Stairs. Stone U-stair, with wrought-iron balustrade

Textile Description Colors. Pastel, light, creamy dull colors accented with white or a little rich color Patterns. Fine stripes, garlands, bows, ribbons, oval shapes, classic Greek and Roman urns and motifs, tiny lorals Textures. Plain satin, reined damask and brocade, plain and antique taffeta, batiste, moiré, voile

French Neoclassical Fauteuil Open Armchair

French Neoclassical Bergère Upholstered Armchair

French Neoclassical Textiles

French Neoclassical Bureau Plat Writing Table

428

Chapter 15

Interior Details

Table 15.23

Country French Design

Country French Interior

Floors. Wooden plank, terra-cotta tile Walls. Stucco or papered Windows. French casement Doors. French doors Chimneypiece. Simple version of Renaissance hooded ireplace, also, carved natural wood version of Rococo chimneypiece with curved opening Ceiling. Plain or beamed Stairs. Various conigurations of wooden stairway with plain balusters

Textile Description Colors. In the provinces, the colors were deep and somber— royal blue, cranberry red, goldenrod yellow, rich avocado green, accents of black; printed textiles sport light, lively lorals Patterns. Shells were quite popular, along with ribbons, scroll, love knots, country folk in country scenes, and Chinese chinoiserie motifs—pagodas, architecture, nature scenes, fretwork, and Chinese people in native dress Textures. Fabrics included tapestry, printed toile de Jouy, loral fabrics, sturdy twill ticking, and woven tweeds such as houndstooth and herringbone

Country French Armoire Country French Panetière Country French Ladder-Back Chair

Bread Keeper

Country French Sleigh Bed

Country French Textile

Historic Influences in Design

429

Figure 15.24 Country French charm is seen in the ladder-back chair and the neoclassically inspired bed. Photo from Laura Ashley’s archive of past product lines

a blend of traditional Hispanic (Spanish and Portuguese) design—inluenced by 800 years of Moorish/Islamic occupation in Hispania. Many Hispanic elements of the style are drawn from the Italian Renaissance, whose inluence was felt all over Europe, particularly in southern Europe. Table 15.24 gives examples of Spanish Colonial design. Much architecture of Central and South America and portions of the southwestern United States is inluenced by Hispanic style, including churches, public buildings, and domestic architecture. Its appeal lies in graceful lines of arcades (rows of arches) set on simpliied classical columns, combined with rustic, durable materials to yield a style that is well suited to local cultural heritage. Exteriors are of rough stucco with deep-set windows and

red clay roof tiles. Inside the house, rooms may open onto a paved central courtyard or private patio, often surrounded with a covered walkway or portal, and possibly built around a well or fountain. This open-centered plan comes from the Italian Renaissance, with inluence going back as far as the Roman house. In Beaux Arts architecture, turrets and exterior stairs were often seen in public buildings and homes of all sizes. Spanish Colonial furniture is heavily scaled and nicely carved. Many Hispanic seating pieces are upholstered in leather with large nail heads (clavos) left exposed. Trestle tables were popular and often featured wroughtiron bracket supports. Some furniture, particularly case pieces, was decoratively carved with geometric patterns, a design element adapted from Islamic design.

430

Chapter 15

Table 15.24

Spanish Colonial Design Spanish Colonial Interior Spanish Colonial Leather Chair

Spanish Colonial Armchair

Spanish Colonial Table with Cannon-Ball Turnings Spanish Colonial Trestle Table Interior Details

Textile Description

Floors. Red quarry tile, red brick pavers, or stone Walls. Rough stucco Windows. Tall and narrow casement windows, one or two panes wide; decorative wrought-iron grills in geometric designs are sometimes bolted to the exterior as a means of privacy, protection, and decoration; hand-painted tiles surround some windows in place of wood trim Doors. Paneled doors, sometimes hand carved with simple to complex Islamic-inspired geometric designs Chimneypieces. Hooded, projecting overmantles with stucco hoods, with optional beamed mantles or carved supports, and/or wooden or stone columns or pilasters Ceiling. Beamed, with either stucco inill or an upper layer of smaller beams Stairs. Black wrought-iron balustrades, colorful tile risers with tile, stone, or wood treads

Colors. Authentic Spanish colors include dramatic red, gold, deep green, light and dark brown, bright and dark blue, brilliant yellow, old Spanish gold, and black in high contrast but small applications such as upholstery fabrics, colorful tile trim, and area folk rugs. Red quarry tile or red paver brick loor is common and adds color to stucco walls and wood trim Patterns. Complex designs based on the geometric Moorish religious ethic that forbids artisans to create anything lifelike. After the period of Moorish inluence, trees, lora, birds— especially the chickadee—were added to these geometric patterns Textures. A variety of leather textiles, plain or stamped, tooled, engraved, painted, and studded with nail heads. Thick materials—tweeds, twill, tapestry, matelassé of cotton, linen, wool

Historic Influences in Design

Table 15.25

431

Tuscan Design

Tuscan Farmhouse Interior

Wrought-Iron Bed with Roman-Inspired Textile

Italian Ladder-Back Chair

Low Tuscan Chest Interior Details Floors. Stone, brick, or tile, overlaid with folk rugs in seating areas Walls. Plaster generally; tile on kitchen backsplash and in bathrooms Windows. Casement windows in heavily framed wood sometimes with wrought iron Doors. Rustic variations of traditional paneled wooden doors Chimneypiece. Hooded ireplaces or rustic adaptations of Baroque and Neoclassic mantlepieces Ceiling. Beamed, often with smaller crossbeams or stucco inill Stairs. Wood or tile treads with wrought-iron railing

Tuscan Design Tuscany, or Toscana (in Italian), is more or less a triangularshaped region situated between the northern part the central Apennine Mountains and the northern part of the Tyrrhenian Sea. Tuscany’s capital is Florence, the birthplace of the Italian Renaissance, with its wealth of extraordinary architecture, art, and culture. The Tuscan countryside is hilly and interspersed with a few very fertile plains where wheat and vineyards thrive. The gently rolling hills are picturesque and dotted with

Tuscan Farmhouse Table

centuries-old farmhouses, villas, and an occasional monastery or convent. Some of these buildings have found new life as vacation retreats catering to Europeans and Americans. This exposure has given rise to the current popularity of Tuscan design in American homes, restaurants, and other commercial developments. The Tuscan farmhouse design illustrated and described here is illed with simple, rustic charm (Table 15.25). Background elements include stone, brick paver or tile loors, rough stucco walls, beamed ceilings, and

432

Chapter 15

hooded ireplaces or rustic adaptations of Baroque or Neoclassic mantle pieces. Furnishings include handcarved wooden high or low chests and free-standing cabinets, ladder-back side and armchairs with rush seats, rustic farm tables with bulky turned legs, wrought-iron bed head- and footboards, simple Tuxedo or Lawsonstyle sofas and chairs. Fabrics vary widely and are generally understated textures rather than patterns, although stripes are favored as an upholstery fabric. Folk or Oriental rugs are used in the conversation seating areas. Because the style is Italian, it has its roots in the Italian past. Consequently, it has much in common with the Spanish Colonial style that is also Renaissance-based. Genuine Tuscan style is clearly unpretentious. Many choosing the style today, however, have created an ostentatious, quasiBaroque version of the style that might give a true Toscano (person from Tuscany) cause to pause.

not yet ceased and has left its mark on almost every corner of the globe. Examples of early skyscrapers include: • The Auditorium Building (1889), Chicago, Illinois; Adler and Sullivan, architects • The Wainwright Building (1891), St. Louis, Missouri; Louis Sullivan, architect • Monadnock Building (1892), Chicago, Illinois; Burnham and Root, architects • Reliance Building (1895), Chicago, Illinois; Daniel H. Burnham, architect • The Guaranty Building (1895), Buffalo, New York; Adler and Sullivan, architects • Carson Pirie Scott & Co. (1904), Chicago, Illinois; Louis Sullivan, architect

Art Nouveau/Jugendstil (1890–1910)

Modern Design (1857–Present) It was the Victorians and their technological developments that laid the groundwork for modern architecture. Use of reinforced concrete, structural steel, plate glass, plumbing, and central heating were nineteenth-century developments. The Victorians had also experimented with novel loor plans, as well as new types of architectural massing. Some tend to think of the changes that gave birth to modern architecture as radical. In reality, it is sometimes dificult to know exactly where modern architecture begins, but one place to start is with new technology.

The Skyscraper (1857–Present) The skyscraper is a New York and Chicago phenomenon. It was in Chicago that the metal skeleton, which is the basis for skyscrapers, was developed. However, previous innovations also contributed. The installation of the irst practical passenger elevator in New York’s Haughwout Building in 1857 paved the way for the tall buildings that steel would make possible. The Brooklyn Bridge (1883) had shown that steel could carry far heavier loads than iron. In that same year, William Le Baron Jenney planned the eleven-story Home Insurance Building using a skeleton framework of steel. This building demonstrated that skyscrapers could reach incredible heights without the support of thick walls. The walls could be as thin as glass; the weight of the building was carried on the steel skeleton. The master of the skyscraper was Chicago architect Louis Sullivan. To Sullivan is attributed the famous philosophy that “form follows function.” He designed a number of important skyscrapers (some with partner Dankmar Adler) and started a building trend that has

Art Nouveau was a new style that emerged at the turn of the century in France, Belgium, Scotland, and Austria (where it was called Jugendstil). Its exponents attempted to create designs unrelated to any previous style. Art Nouveau drew inspiration from nature and incorporated vines and lowers, often in extremely sinuous and twisted form, as well as animal forms such as lizards and peacocks.

Art Nouveau/Jugendstil Furniture Classics The Vienna café chair, corbu chair, and bentwood rocker are pieces designed by the German craftsman Michael Thonet (1796–1871) and manufactured in Austria during the last half of the nineteenth century. Thonet invented a process for bending wood that gives these pieces their beautiful curvilinear design and eliminates the need for complex joinery. Today these chairs are manufactured by Thonet. The Prague chair, a bentwood and cane piece arranged in a square composition, was designed at the turn of the century by Josef Hoffmann (1870–1956), a member of the Vienna Secession and founding member of its offshoot, the Wiener Werkstätte (Vienna Workshops). The Fledermaus chair, with its distinctively shaped back and ball pendants, is Hoffmann’s 1905 design. The Fledermaus and Prague chairs are also available from Thonet. The Hill chair and Argyle chair are striking perpendicular Art Nouveau pieces created by Scotsman Charles Rennie Mackintosh (1868–1928). They are constructed of black ebony with padded seats and are distinguished by a high back treatment. The Hill chair, considered an extraordinary design for the period, was particularly inluential with the Secessionists in Vienna. See Table 15.26 for examples.

Historic Influences in Design

Table 15.26

433

Art Nouveau/Jugendstil Furniture Classics Corbu Chair

Prague Chair Bentwood Rocker

Josef Hoffmann

Michael Thonet

Michael Thonet

Art Nouveau Design, Argyle Chair

Art Nouveau Design, Hill Chair

Charles Rennie Mackintosh

Charles Rennie Mackintosh

Fledermaus Chair

Vienna Café Chair

Josef Hoffmann

Michael Thonet

Japanese Design Japanese architecture and interiors that profoundly inluenced both Organic Modern and Craftsman styles developed from 1392 to 1603 during the Muromachi and Momoyma periods. The resulting style is today considered a classic of excellent proportion and design with superior handcraftsmanship. Japanese interiors are wood framed with inely crafted joints that require no nails

or screws, and which are frankly exposed. Japanese interiors are a pattern for simple, peaceful living, also the result of Zen philosophy, which encourages a “lessis-more” state of tranquility. The traditional Japanese home is one story with an open loor plan divided by sliding shoji screens or plain or decorative fusuma partitions. Japanese wood-framed and woodclad homes feature wide overhanging eaves, the result of

434

Chapter 15

Table 15.27

Japanese Design

Japanese Interior

Tokonoma with Hanging Scroll

Japanese Byobu Screen

hip-and-gable construction. A broad wooden porch, the engawa, protected by the eave, connects the home to the Japanese garden—miniature representations of forests, mountains, rivers, and oceans of the world, illed with greenery and artistically arranged gravel and large stones. Bonsai, or miniature trees, are a result of this aesthetic approach. High aesthetics are also seen in the Japanese understated but powerfully pleasing Shibusa philosophy discussed briely in Chapter 4 and in Table 15.27. Furnishings are few and spare. The low table is centered in the room, with family and guests seated on lat square zabuton cushions. Items required for daily living are kept inside custom-built cabinets.

Craftsman Style (1905–1929) In the second half of the nineteenth century, the English Arts and Crafts movement advocated simple handcraftsmanship in reaction to the shoddiness and poor design

of machine-made, mass-produced products of the Industrial Revolution. At the beginning of the twentieth century, this craftsman philosophy had a signiicant impact on American designers like the Greene brothers and Gustav Stickley. The Craftsman-style house was developed primarily by California architects Charles Greene (1868–1957) and Henry Greene (1870–1954), known as Greene and Greene or the Greene brothers. Around 1903 they created designs for simple Craftsman-style bungalows that were given much attention by magazines such as House Beautiful, Good Housekeeping, and Ladies’ Home Journal. Designs for small model homes in the style were published in Ladies’ Home Journal and in the Craftsman magazine published by Gustav Stickley (1848–1942). Stickley was one of the greatest proponents of the style; the associated Craftsman-style furniture from this period is often called by his name. The publications provided working drawings for Craftsman houses that could be built for under

Historic Influences in Design

Table 15.27

435

Japanese Design (continued)

Interior Details

Textile Description

Floors. Generally 3- by 6-foot tatami mats woven of reeds and sea grass, edged with black silk and placed in right-angle conigurations; these are insulative and durable, as no shoes are worn in the Japanese house, only soft slippers Walls. Wooden post-and-lintel construction with simple, builtin cabinetry for sleeping mats, or futons, which are stored when not in use. A wood-framed focal point niche or shallow open-faced closet, the tokonoma, features one to three asymmetrically arranged items: a hand-painted hanging scroll and ikebana, or stylized loral arrangement, for example— changed often in honor of signiicant events or holidays and regarded with great reverence Windows and Doors. Shoji screens, wood-framed rice paper screens with wooden grids in square or artistic conigurations, are sliding exterior window-doors, although sliding glass doors are also used today next to the house or on the outer side of the engawa for extra insulation. Interior rice paper fusuma screen dividers may be painted with a subtle pattern, with a carved wooden transom above Ceilings. Small-scaled wooden beams with ine wooden slat inill

Colors. The Shibui aesthetic dictates that color is used according to nature’s guidelines: closely blended, neutralized colors with accents of bright hues and sparkle (see the law of chromatic distribution discussed in Chapter 4). Colors are lighter above, darker below, midtones at eye level and planned so that all colors look well against all other colors, patterns, and textures seen at the same time Patterns. Conventional or stylized nature motifs used in Shibui schemes are subtle, even uninished patterns to emphasize the power of the understatement in high aesthetics. Patterns are either abstract (masculine) with clean angular lines, or igurative (feminine). Abstract patterns are geometric designs such as tortoise shells, lozenge/diamond, complex linear designs. Figurative patterns include cherry blossoms and branches, Mount Fuji, simple loral patterns, stylized women in Japanese costume. Many patterns are placed in circular formats and are isolated motifs on a plain background. Textures. Printed and woven cotton broadcloth, tapestries, reined silk embroidery, and brocade

Low Japanese Table with Zabuton Seat Cushions

$1,000. Prefabricated versions of the style could also be purchased from Sears and Roebuck; the components were shipped to the nearest railway station complete with instructions for assembly. The Craftsman-style house enjoyed wide acceptance during the irst 30 years of the twentieth century and is highly regarded again today for its cozy, cottagelike qualities. These homes, crafted of wood, featured low-pitched gabled roofs; wide, bracketed overhangs with exposed rafter tails; full and partial porches supported by wellscaled piers or columns; and shingle, brick, stone, or clapboard siding. The gardens, porches, and loggias were extensions of the houses, creating harmony with their setting, a concept referred to as organic. See Table 15.28 for illustrations of the Craftsman style.

Figure 15.25 The Craftsman style enjoys great contemporary acceptance. Jack Silverio, Architect/photo © Brian Vanden Brink

Japanese Low Table with Banti or Monkey Paw Legs

436

Chapter 15

Table 15.28

Craftsman Design

Exterior Characteristics

Contract Example

• Low-pitched roof (front-gabled, side-gabled, and hipped) • Triangular dormers with three or four grouped windows; or low, lat, horizontal shed dormers with clustered windows • Widely projecting, unenclosed eaves with exposed rafter tails and triangular, cutout brackets • Sided with shingles, brick, clinker brick (appears to be melted), clapboard, stone, or a combination of these • Squared, pop-out bays • Eight- (or six-) over-one, sash or ixed windows • Front porch (full or partial width) • Massive, short, square columns, or clustered columns resting on substantial piers

• First Church of Christ, Scientist (1901), Berkeley, California; Bernard Maybeck, architect

Craftsman Interior

Influences • William Morris and the English Arts and Crafts movement • John Ruskin’s aesthetic philosophies

Residential Examples

Inglenook

• David B. Gamble House (1908), Pasadena, California; Greene and Greene, architects • Craftsman Farms (1911), Parsippany, New Jersey; Gustav Stickley, architect

Craftsman Bungalow

Craftsman Shed Dormer

Gamble House Greene Brothers

Historic Influences in Design

Table 15.28

437

Craftsman Design (continued) William Morris Textiles Craftsman Eight-Light Door

Stickley Armchair

Stickley Cabinet

Stickley Settee

Interior Details Floors. Oak or chestnut hardwood Walls. Wooden wainscot, often with a plate rail; plain, painted plaster; stenciled friezes; wallpaper Windows. Fixed or sash, eight- or six-over-one; pop-out bays; small square windows lanking chimneypiece; some picture windows Doors. Flush with a single light (pane); plank with hammeredmetal straps; two-paneled with a projecting, bracketed shelf under three or four lights; hammered-metal hardware on doors Chimneypiece. Tile surrounded by bracketed mantlepiece, some hammered-copper hoods, some stone or brick chimneypieces; inglenooks: the ireplace is recessed in an alcove, often with lanking benches Ceiling. Beamed or plain, painted plaster

Stairs. Straight-run, single- or double-turn wooden stair with large square newel posts and square balusters; stairways tucked between rooms in some small versions

Textile Description Colors. The natural brown colors of leather were common. Textile and wallpaper designs by William Morris were compatible with Craftsman interiors. Morris, like Stickley, favored colors from nature: pumpkin; sage, sea foam, and leaf greens; light, true, and cobalt blues. Accents of red were also seen among the blues and greens Patterns. Complex leaf and lower and/or fruit patterns with occasional use of animals such as birds or rabbits Textures. Smooth cotton prints, leather, rich tapestries, and simple homespuns

438

Chapter 15

Craftsman Furniture Classics The English Arts and Crafts movement included designers/philosophers William Morris (1834–96) and John Ruskin (1818–1900). They rejected machine construction and advocated simple handcraftsmanship. Gustav Stickley agreed with their ideas about the beauty and honesty of traditional handcrafted design and natural materials. He disseminated these ideas in his Craftsman magazine. In addition to being a magazine publisher, Stickley was, irst and foremost, a furniture designer and manufacturer. The chairs and sofas he designed were rectilinear with vertical back slats, straight lat arms, exposed mortise and tenon joints, and leather seats. He also designed a number of case pieces and tables with comparable lines and details. Craftsman or Stickley-style furniture has recently experienced the same kind of high regard enjoyed by Craftsman-style homes.

Craftsman Color The dominant color in the Craftsman home was the reddish-brown of fumed oak and chestnut loved and recommended by Stickley and used extensively in wall paneling and loors. The use of natural wood inishes imparted a dark and cozy feeling. The color palette for walls and textiles advocated by Stickley included colors from nature such as muted pumpkin, sage, soft golds, and tans. Also used were deep leaf greens and cobalt blues. Hammered metals such as copper and iron added color to the Craftsman interior.

Frank Lloyd Wright’s Organic Architecture (1908–Present)

(A)

Often considered America’s most important architect, Frank Lloyd Wright (1867–1959) successfully broke the cycle of historically styled design typical of the Victorian age and the prevailing Beaux Arts architectural training.

(B)

Figure 15.26 The Robie House exemplifies Frank Lloyd Wright’s Prairie style.

Figure 15.27 Frank Lloyd Wright’s designs. (A) The extensive use of stone in the Lovness House reinforces the organic concept of the design. (B) Fallingwater appears to grow out of its setting. (A) © Norman McGrath; (B) © Sergio Penchansky/Photo Researchers, Inc.

Historic Influences in Design

Like the Greene brothers, Wright felt that a home should relate to its setting. The long, low, horizontal lines of the Robie House (1908), Chicago, Illinois, were in harmony with the prairies of the great Midwest. He called his designs the Prairie style and referred to them as organic. He designed over thirty-ive houses for his neighbors in Oak Park, a Chicago suburb. One of the Wright’s most famous designs is the Edgar J. Kaufmann residence (1939), Fallingwater, in Bear Run, Pennsylvania. The house is dramatically situated over a waterfall where it appears to grow out of the stones that support it. Fallingwater is, however, also an example of how Wright incorporated the concepts and principles of the International style—which had become popular in the 1930s—into his masterful organic design. The broad, light-colored, horizontal bands of the cantilevered terraces and balconies show the marriage of the International and Organic styles—two signiicant directions in modern architecture.

Characteristics of Organic Design • Materials that harmonize with nature • Architectural forms in harmony with the setting • Well-established relationship from the inside of the house to the outdoors • Flexible loor plan: open planning

designs devoid of speciic historical reference. The designs were symbols of the optimism, conidence, and forward thinking of the “Roaring Twenties.” Art Deco is a slick and lashy style that epitomized all that was new and modern. Its rich vocabulary of motifs was inspired by the machine, modes of speeding transportation (locomotives and ocean liners), plants and other natural forms, and even some elements of historical design. The Art Deco style is characterized by rigid geometric forms, zigzags, chevron patterns, stepped pyramid forms, stylized billows of clouds, and stylized human and animal forms. Preferred materials were shiny metals, polished stone or marble, and etched mirrors and glass. As an architectural style it was used for the design of skyscrapers, movie palaces, and even some post ofices and other government buildings. The style has hundreds of vernacular applications in every corner of the country, and its inluence can even be seen in unlikely places such as churches, gas stations, and grocery stores. Its residential application was principally as an interior style and was simply called modern. Examples of Art Deco contract buildings include: • • • •

Richield Oil Building (1929), Los Angeles Chrysler Building (1930), New York City Empire State Building (1931), New York City Rockefeller Center (1931–40), New York City

Art Deco (1918–45) The Art Deco style, though modern in spirit, incorporated the kind of rich ornamentation typical of the BeauxArts era. Architects, trained in that decorative historical tradition, left the past behind, creating sleek, modern Figure 15.28 This house in San Antonio, Texas, is a pleasing combination of Art Deco and International style elements. Photo © David A. Taylor

439

Figure 15.29 The Chrysler Building in New York is an Art Deco monument.

440

Chapter 15

Art Deco Color Art Deco colors were appropriate to typically sleek forms and geometric shapes. Favorite colors were rose, mauve, silver and black, and warm yellowgreens trimmed with gold and mustard yellow.

International Style (1932–Present) The International style, as the name implies, crossed international borders and drew inspiration from several European schools of thought. From the thinking of the De Stijl movement in Holland, the Bauhaus in Germany, and Le Corbusier in France came the principles that dominated and gave form to the International style. Though isolated examples existed before, the new style was introduced into the mainstream of American design in 1932 by Philip Johnson and Henry-Russell Hitchcock when they organized the irst exhibit of modern architecture at the Museum of Modern Art in New York City and published a book called The International Style. The deinition of the new style advanced by these men rapidly gained acceptance and established a formula or framework in which less-imaginative architects could design. The style gained further momentum when many leaders of the International Movement immigrated to America during World War II. Walter Gropius (1883–1969), Ludwig Mies van der Rohe (1886– 1969), and Marcel Breuer (1902–81), all associated at one time with the Bauhaus, became teachers of the new style in the United States. In some ways, the International style is the antithesis of Wright’s Organic style. The Organic style harmonizes with its setting, while the International style stands out in clear contrast. The materials of the International style are bold and hard edged: concrete, structural steel, glass, and stark, white stucco. The architectural approach is minimalist, not adding any unnecessary embellishment, and the plan is open and unencumbered. This architecture is not as “forgiving” as the organic or historical designs; there is little place for the wear and tear of human use and the gentle softening that comes with time. In order to appear pleasing, these clean pure designs must be impeccably maintained. Because of its stark cleanliness, the style has not lent itself to the charming vernacular versions of previous styles. Table 15.29 shows examples of the International style. After the years of historical eclecticism, the International movement was like a breath of fresh air. There is a purity and cool elegance to this approach that is beautiful and refreshing, but trends never continue unaltered. It is noteworthy that one of the

(A)

(B) Figure 15.30 Philip Johnson’s home in Connecticut, known as the “glass house,” is a jewel of International style design. Photo © Norman McGrath

Historic Influences in Design

Table 15.29

International Style

Exterior Characteristics • • • • • • • •

441

Open plan Simple, logical, rectilinear structured forms Generally lat roofed Asymmetrical Large areas of glass (often arranged horizontally) Use of concrete, stucco, and metal Long, uninterrupted white wall planes Contrasts with setting

Residential Examples • Waler Gropius House (1937), Lincoln, Massachusetts; Walter Gropius and Marcel Breuer, architects • Glass House (1949), New Caanan, Connecticut; Philip Johnson, architect • Edgar J. Kaufmann House, Fallingwater (1936), Bear Run, Pennsylvania; Frank Lloyd Wright, architect • Lovell Beach House (1926), Newport Beach, California; Rudolph Schindler, architect

• Lovell-Health House (1927), Los Angeles, California; Richard Neutra, architect • Farnsworth House (designed 1946, built 1950), Plano, Illinois; Ludwig Mies van der Rohe, architect

Contract Examples • 860-80 Lake Shore Drive (1952), Chicago, Illinois; Ludwig Mies van der Rohe, architect • Lever House (1952), New York, New York; Skidmore, Owings, and Merrill, architects • Crown Hall (1956), I.I.T., Chicago, Illinois; Ludwig Mies van der Rohe, architect • General Motors Technical Center (1956), Warren, Michigan; Eero Saarinen and Associates, architects • Seagram Building (1958), New York, New York; Ludwig Mies van der Rohe and Philip Johnson, architects

International Style Philip Johnson

International Style Walter Gropius

International Style Interior

(continued)

442

Chapter 15

Interior Details

Table 15.29

International Style (continued)

Modern Textiles

Floors. Hard, smooth—marble or tile Walls. Plain plaster, glass Windows. Large areas of glass with minimal framing Doors. Flush, plain Chimneypiece. Simple rectangular opening with no trim Ceiling. Plain plaster Stairs. Open riser, no embellishment

Barcelona Chair Ludwig Mies van der Rohe

Textile Description

Cesca Chair Marcel Breuer

MR Chair Ludwig Mies van der Rohe

Colors. Several color palettes have been evident during the twentieth century. Bright primary colors are one; natural neutrals are another. Dulled, neutralized colors and even psychedelic or vivid chroma colors have all been used, according to decades; now, modern trends are established every one to two years Patterns. Where pattern did exist, it has been abstract and stylized, often relecting modern art and architectural grid systems. Some patterns were adapted from nature forms Textures. Textures include leather, handwoven textures (authentic or machine produced), nubby semisheer and casement fabrics, cane, animal hides, woven textures for upholstery

Pony Chaise Le Corbusier

Grand Confort Le Corbusier

Wassily Lounge Marcel Breuer

Brno Chair Basculant Chair Ludwig Mies van der Rohe Le Corbusier

Historic Influences in Design

International style’s irst American proponents, architect Philip Johnson, moved away from strict adherence to its principles to embrace allusions to classical pediments and Gothic spires.

International Furniture Classics The Wassily lounge chair (1925), the world’s irst bent tubular steel chair, was designed by Marcel Breuer, one of the foremost designers of the Bauhaus in Germany. The Bauhaus school of art, architecture, and design attracted some of the world’s inest designers from 1919 to 1933. The chair was named for Wassily Kandinsky (1886– 1944), an important artist and Bauhaus faculty member. Breuer was one of the irst of many designers to take advantage of the possibilities of this versatile combination of materials. The Cesca chair is another bent tubular steel design by Breuer. The Cesca chair has a wood-framed seat and back of cane mounted on a cantilevered frame. The cantilever design has no back legs and was a remarkable breakthrough made possible by the strength of the metal. Both the Wassily lounge and Cesca chair are manufactured by Knoll International and Thonet. The MR chair, made of tubular steel and wicker or leather, was designed in 1926 by Ludwig Mies van der Rohe, the last director of the Bauhaus. The MR chair, like the Cesca chair, is designed on the cantilever principle. The Barcelona collection was designed by Mies van der Rohe for his German pavilion at the Barcelona International Exhibition of 1929. The Barcelona chair and Barcelona stool are constructed on a double X frame of polished stainless steel and are meticulously upholstered in tufted leather. The Barcelona table has an X-shaped frame of polished stainless steel with a glass top.

443

The Brno chair is Mies van der Rohe’s 1930 design for the Tugendhat House in Brno, Czech Republic. The cantilevered design has great strength and visual appeal. The Brno chair, the Barcelona collection, and the MR chair are all manufactured by Knoll International, Inc. The Grand and Petit Confort chairs were designed in 1929 by Swiss-born French designer Charles-Edouard Jeanneret-Gris (1887–1965), better known as Le Corbusier. The Grand Confort has a basketlike frame of bent tubular steel with a series of leather cushions forming the seating unit. The Petit Confort is the same design in smaller scale. The Basculant chair was designed by Le Corbusier in 1928. The chair has a frame of tubular steel with seat and back of calf skin and arm straps of leather. The Pony Chaise, designed by Le Corbusier in 1928, is an adjustable chaise longue with a frame of chromiumplated tubular steel, a base of matte-textured steel, and pony skin or leather upholstery. These three Le Corbusier designs are manufactured by Atelier International.

Scandinavian and Midcentury Design Scandinavian and Midcentury Furniture Classics Scandinavian and midcentury American designers made important contributions to modern furniture manufacture, exploiting new materials as well as earlier methods such as bending wood. Armchair 406 is a 1935 cantilever design by Alvar Aalto (1899–1976) of Finland. The lexible bent laminated plywood frame has a seat and back of woven fabric. Armchair 406 is manufactured by ICF. The Pedestal group was created by Eero Saarinen (1910–61) in 1956 and was a signiicant design of a furniture

Figure 15.31 Mies van der Rohe’s Farnsworth House in Plano, Illinois, is a striking example of the International style. Courtesy of the Landmarks Preservation Council of Illinois

444

Chapter 15

collection without the traditional four legs. The single base design. The chairs are formed of lattice and are made of of the table and chairs is made of aluminum, and the shell a steel rod frame with or without cushions and upholof the seating pieces is made of iberglass. The tabletop stery. The Bertoia chairs, originally designed in 1956 for may be marble, glass, wood, or laminate. The Pedestal Hans and Florence Knoll, are still produced by Knoll group is manufactured by Knoll International. International. THE chair is a classic Scandinavian design by DenThe Platner chair was created in 1966 by architect/ mark’s Hans Wegner (1914–2007). The 1949 piece is the designer Warren Platner (1919–2006) as a “graceful, decepitome of ine craftsmanship featuring a beautifully orative design . . . that enhances the person in it.” The joined wooden frame with a seat of cane or upholstery. nickel-plated steel construction chair is part of a larger THE chair is manufactured by D.S.I. group of chairs, tables, and stools called the Platner ColThe Number Seven chair was designed by Danish lection. Knoll International, Inc., New York, has manuarchitect Arne Jacobsen (1902–71) in 1955. It features a factured the Platner Collection since it was introduced in single molded/bent piece of plywood for the seat and the middle of the last century. Table 15.30 contains sevbent chrome tubular steel legs. The chair was originally eral examples of midcentury design. manufactured in natural beech wood as well as with black and white inishes but today is available in a variMidcentury Color ety of colors. The Number Seven chair is one of the most The outbreak of World War II effectively cut off America successful designs in Danish furniture history, with over from European color inluence. Many interior colors were 5 million having been sold. It is manufactured by Fritz neutral and comparatively drab during the 1940s. DeHansen. signers, however, turned their attention to the optimistic The Egg chair, designed by Arne Jacobsen in 1957, is a and bright colors south of the border—Latin American fabric-covered, foam-molded iberglass shell with a loose hues that were best represented in the interiors of Hollycushion and a base of cast aluminum. The Egg chair was wood movies. created for the Royal SAS Hotel in Copenhagen. Jacobsen designed the hotel and all its ixtures and furniture. Like much midtwentieth-century design, the Egg chair has enjoyed increased favor at the start of the new millennium. Fritz Hansen of Denmark has manufactured the Egg chair since 1958. The Eames lounge chair was designed in 1956 by Charles (1907–78) and Ray (1912–88) Eames. The lounge was designed for comfort featuring a chair and ottoman with metal bases, bent laminated wood frames, and carefully padded leather upholstery. The lounge was a great success and, like many of the classics, has been widely copied. The original design is manufactured by Herman Miller. The Bertoia Wire Group by Italian-born Harry Bertoia (1915–78) is a sculp- Figure 15.32 These three Eames lounge chairs are examples of midcentury design. Courtesy of Herman tural approach to seating Miller, Inc.

Historic Influences in Design

Table 15.30

445

Scandinavian and Midcentury Furniture Classics

Armchair 406

Bertoia Wire Group

Alvar Aalto

Harry Bertoia

THE Chair Number Seven Chair Hans Wegner Arne Jacobsen

Egg Chair Arne Jacobsen

Pedestal Chair Eero Saarinen

Platner Chair Warren Platner

Eames Lounge Charles and Ray Eames

446

Chapter 15

During the 1950s, research that was initiated before and during World War II was utilized for interiors. Dyestuffs chemically invented and applied to synthetic ibers gave rise to bright, clear, and often gaudy colors: bright yellow, carnation and lamingo pink, Oriental blue, lower red, chartreuse, avocado and pine green, and gold. These colors were usually assigned to artwork or textiles, while backgrounds and even furniture remained monochromatic colors such as rose-beige, pale turquoise, black or white, or neutrals. Colors and design from Scandinavia were introduced during the 1950s, and for the irst time in America, blues and greens were stylistically used together.

Contemporary Trends Design is constantly on the move, keeping pace with changes in technology and taste. Only the passage of time will determine the true classics of today. However, it is worthwhile to study the developments taking place around us so that we can put them into context. The following represent three important contemporary trends in design.

High-Tech

playfulness. The characteristic forms of Postmodernism are updated classical elements with a decidedly modern twist. Columns, pediments, domes, and arches, often in simpliied or stylized form, are the elements that give individuality to Postmodernism. Designers have also borrowed many elements of the Art Deco style such as the step-pyramid and the inverted column. The name most associated with Postmodernism is Michael Graves, whose work for Disney is typical of the whimsical quality of the style.

Deconstructivism The themes that deine Deconstructive design are instability, conlict, and disharmony. The materials of the style are corrugated steel, other raw metals, chain-link fencing material, and raw plywood and chipboard. The frank use of materials is similar to High-Tech, but the application is more chaotic. The best description of Deconstructive design is that it appears as if someone took the design apart and didn’t know how to put it back together. Some designs resemble a pile of girders and lumber with the unifying factor being the chaos and disunity. While the descriptions may sound quite grim, the actual product is often exciting. It is a style that has found appropriate application in exclusive but funky clothing stores, bistros, and night clubs. The work of Los Angeles architect Frank O. Gehry, an important proponent of the style, has received international praise and recognition.

High-Tech design is a celebration of technology in which all the inner mechanical workings, as well as the structural members of the building, are left frankly exposed on both the exterior and inte- Figure 15.33 Machine-like High-Tech Lloyd’s of London is unusually juxtaposed with Leadenhall rior. High-Tech designers use Market, its ornate nineteenth-century Victorian neighbor. Photo © Kathryn Taylor elements that were obviously designed for industrial use, such as warehouse lighting and industrial shelving, as furnishings within the interior. The greatest exponents and examples of this style are British: Richard Rogers’s Lloyd’s of London (1986) and Norman Foster’s Hong Kong and Shanghai Bank (1986) in Hong Kong.

Postmodern Postmodern design grew out of a dissatisfaction with the International modern style. Some people were feeling alienated by the severity of the uniform lines and the regularity of the boxy forms associated with the International style. Postmodernism imbued modern design with a sense of individuality and even frivolity or

Historic Influences in Design

447

Putting Things in Perspective The styles and inluences discussed in this chapter are only a part of the story. There is no style to end all styles. The development of style is an ongoing process, as one style inluences another and further variations are born. New technology prompts changes in design, and often some inluence of either traditional or modern design reappears. It takes time to determine the value of a design and to put it into the context of a style. In the past, the classiication of styles was done in retrospect by historians with a clear overview. But from our perspective, the design family tree has grown very bushy since the beginning of the twentieth century. We live in an information age illed with self-awareness and are often conscious of every new “ism” that appears on the scene. For the amateur, this can be confusing and discouraging. It may be comforting to realize, then, that many new developments in design, which have mushroomed along with technology, are still being sifted and judged by time. A knowledge of the basic styles and inluences listed here is a key to understanding the myriad modes that have grown out of the modern movement and the thousands of vernacular adaptations of each modern and traditional style. Understanding leads to appreciation and enrichment. Our architectural heritage should be cherished and preserved for future generations to enjoy. Figure 15.34 The Lloyd’s of London building is a beautifully detailed and exciting example of High-Tech design by Richard Rogers.

Figure 15.35 The Keystone House by architect Michael Graves is an excellent residential example of Postmodern design.

448

Chapter 15

Figure 15.36 This German kindergarten demonstrates the chaotic nature of Deconstructive design.

Figure 15.37 Frank Gehry’s Guggenheim Museum in Bilbao, Spain, with its distinctive sculptural shapes and its brilliant titanium skin, is an internationally recognized example of Deconstructive design. The Soloman R. Guggenheim Foundation, NY/photo: David Heald

Preservation Preservation is often an emotion-charged subject. Preservationists and developers often disagree over whether a building should be preserved for its historic value or removed to make way for new buildings. One problem

is that it takes time to determine the historic or aesthetic value of a building. At the point where suficient time has passed to make that determination, the building may already have disappeared. To address this problem, preservation societies have been established on both local and national levels. The National Trust for Historic

Historic Influences in Design

449

Figure 15.38 Adaptive restoration turned this obsolete warehouse into an upscale office building. Courtesy of Mackey Mitchell Associates, Barbara Elliott Martin photographer

450

Chapter 15

Preservation is the largest of such organizations. This Trust was established in 1949 and today helps determine which buildings, neighborhoods, and historic areas should be preserved. From its headquarters in Washington, D.C., the National Trust maintains museums, assists with restoration and preservation projects, and dispenses information to any who need assistance. Restoration is a research, partial-demolition, and reconstruction process that returns a building to its original state or to some speciic state during its history. Preservation is taking whatever steps are necessary to maintain a building in its present state or the state to which it has been restored. Adaptive restoration or reuse is giving

Table 15.31

new life to buildings of aesthetic or historic worth by remodeling and restoring them for new uses. One of the earliest adaptive restorations was at Ghirardelli Square in San Francisco. In the mid-1960s, the old and unused Ghirardelli Chocolate factory (1915) was turned into a pleasant multilevel shopping center with restaurants and landscaped pedestrian areas. Adaptive reuse has spread across the country, reinvigorating many old spaces that no longer serve their original purposes. This concept has been used to turn old buildings into housing, ofice complexes, theaters, museums, oceanariums, and many other uses.

Roof and Dormer Types

Gable Roof

Hip-and-Gable Roof

Gambrel Roof

Jerkinhead or Clipped-Gable Roof

Hipped or Hip Roof

Mansard Roof with Lucarne (French Dormer)

Historic Influences in Design

Table 15.31

Roof and Dormer Types (continued)

Dovecote Roof

Shed Dormer

451

Gable Dormer

Extended Shed Dormer

Hipped Dormer

Arched Dormer

Eyebrow-Arched Dormer

This page intentionally left blank

Glossary A

acrylic A synthetic iber of over 85 percent acrylonitrile units; used for the manufacture of textiles and furniture.

A lamp Designation for an arbitrary-shaped, standard light globe or lamp bulb.

acrylic paint A synthetic resin, water-based paint.

A588 steel The designation given to steel that rusts only to a certain point and in doing so creates its own rustproof inish.

acrylic sheet A lat plate or sheet of acrylic (a hard plastic) that can be etched to allow special effects. The most common is the exit sign.

Aalto, Alvar (1899–1976) Important Finnish designer of several Modern classic furniture pieces.

active balance Another term for asymmetrical balance, where objects that are not alike balance each other, or like objects are placed at unequal distances from a central point. It is termed active because it requires some effort or activity of the eye to analyze or discern the balance.

abacus The slab, or pillow, above the capital at the top of a column.

active solar system A mechanical system of solar heat collection for space and water heating.

abrasion resistance The ability of a material to resist wear from friction, rubbing, or other abrasive action.

actual density The three-dimensional, literal mass or density of a piece of furniture.

abstract design A type of decorative design that may be based on natural or even geometric design, stylized to the point that the source is not recognizable, and the design is therefore open to interpretation.

Adam, Robert (1728–92) The most inluential of four Scottish architect/designer brothers. His English Neoclassic work was inluenced by the uncovering of Pompeii and Herculaneum near Naples, Italy.

acanthus leaves A representation of the lobed leaves of the acanthus plant used as a decorative motif.

adaptations Furniture based on an antique style, but changed, blended with other similar styles, or slightly modernized. These “adjustments” make the piece an “inaccurate reproduction,” although the piece may still be handsome and appealing for contemporary historic traditional or eclectic interiors.

AAHE American Association of Housing Educators.

accent lighting Focusing or highlighting; sometimes called artistic lighting. accent rug A small rug, also called a scatter or throw rug. Accent rugs may be used for visual accents or to protect the underlying loor material from moisture, dirt, or wear. accessible design Design that allows users to enter, exit, and use its features without obstruction. accessories The items in an interior used to give a quality of inish or completion such as paintings, sculpture, books, lamps, vases, lowers, and plants. accessory apartment Unit in a separate dwelling in a portion of a home, such as the basement or over the garage. accordion door Folding door, with small vertical panels, that stacks against itself. acetate A man-made iber of reconstituted cellulose and acetic acid. achromatic Colors without hue, namely, black, white, and gray. acoustical plaster An irregular plaster surface, usually used for ceilings, designed to absorb rather than relect sound. acoustical tile Tile, usually used for ceilings, designed to absorb rather than relect sound. Acoustical tile is made from iberboard, fabric- or plastic-coated iber, or iberglass.

adaptive restoration Restoring older buildings for purposes other than those for which they were constructed. adjustable luminaire A light ixture, such as track lighting, that is afixed to a ceiling or wall but can easily be repositioned by the user. adobe Large building brick made of clay, baked in the sun. aesthetics The philosophy of art and beauty. The part of art and design that is beautiful and appealing to the senses. afi nity The chemical compatibility of ibers to dyestuffs. afterimages When the human eye focuses on a strong color for several seconds or minutes, then focuses on a neutral area, the complement of that color will appear in shadow form. AID The American Institute of Interior Designers combined in 1975 with NSID to form ASID, the American Society of Interior Designers.

453

454

Glossary

air compression painting Spray painting powered by an air compression machine that allows paint to be diluted for application. air-brush printing Dye sprayed through stencils by pressure ink jet guns. air-conditioning Cool air piped into an interior through an air-conditioning unit or through a furnace unit. air-exchange unit Draws fresh outside air into buildings and expels stale, used air. Necessary in a superinsulated and tight structure with few or no windows. airless paint spraying Mechanical spraying of nondiluted paint. aisle A passageway separated by an arcade, running parallel to the nave of a church. Albers, Josef (1888–1976) Color expert in simultaneous and successive contrast. Albers taught at the Bauhaus in Germany and at Yale University. alkyds, alkyd enamel Oil-modiied resin paints. Alkyd enamels produce glossy surfaces. allocate space To assign space; to determine the location and layout of rooms or areas. alloy A substance formed by fusing one or more metals, or a metal and a nonmetal. all-wood Wooden furniture construction in which all visible parts are made of wood.

An analogous color scheme usually contains three to six adjacent colors. analysis A part of a programming process in which information is assessed and priorities established. ancient Greece, the golden age (i fth century B.C.) Era of the Parthenon and height of philosophical development and architectural excellence. angular lines Any straight line used in interior design that is neither horizontal nor vertical. Angular lines may be diagonal lines in one direction or even or uneven zigzag lines. Angular lines suggest movement and action. animal hair felt pad Moderately resilient carpet underlay of 100 percent animal hair felted into padding. animal skin rugs Rugs of zebra, bear, sheep, and other animal skins. anodize To put a protective oxide ilm on metal through an electrolytic process with chemicals and an electric charge. anthemion A symmetrical stylized Greek lower motif that radiates from a central point at the bottom of the lower. anthropometrics The study and comparison of human body measurements (i.e., anthropometry). antimony A silver-white, crystalline, metallic element used in alloys.

alternate complement A four-color scheme that combines a triad with the direct complement of one of the hues.

antique A piece of furniture, ine art, decorative art, or other item of artistic value that is at least 100 years old (U.S. Customs deinition).

alternation A type of rhythm wherein two shapes alternate. A classic example is egg-and-dart molding.

antique i nish A inish made to appear older by the application of a darker color over the top of a lighter i nish.

aluminum A lightweight silvery metal.

antiquing Making a painted surface look old with a mellow patina by color washing, glazing, spattering, and dragging techniques. See also distressed.

ambient bank A large, well-lit area that may encompass the entire area or can designate smaller areas, such as walls in a larger space. ambient general lighting Overall lighting that covers a large area, often in the form of overhead luminaires. ambulatory A place for walking; the aisle in a cathedral. amenities Facilities shared by condominium owners or available to renters in luxury apartments. These include swimming pools, tennis courts, and entertainment or athletic facilities. American Empire (1820–60) The interior design title of the period concurrent with the antebellum Greek Revival homes. Colors are inluenced by Napoleonic choices of bold, deep hues. ampere or amp The measurement of electrical current in a circuit. anaglypta or anaglyphs Embossed wall or ceiling coverings that resemble plaster, hammered copper, or hand-tooled leather. analogous Colors that are next to each other on the standard color wheel or as they occur in a rainbow or prism.

antistatic i nishes Standard inishes with reduced conduction or static electricity. apartment A home unit housed with other units that are rented for living spaces. apron The face or front piece of a table just below the top, the face of a chair just below the seat, the face of a chest just below the drawers, and the front piece below the windowsill. apse A semicircular or polygonal projection of a church. arcade A row of arches and supporting columns. arch system construction A building type in existence since antiquity; the arch is held together with a splayed keystone under compression. architect A professional who plans three-dimensional space and creates loor plans and blueprints. architectural elements The walls, loors, ceilings, windows, doors, ireplaces, cabinetry, and other ixtures or details that are built in to an interior. architectural glazing See glass.

Glossary

architectural lighting or structural lighting Permanently installed ixtures or luminaires. The wiring must be in place in advance. architectural rods Contract drapery and curtain rods that are usually drawn with wands or batons rather than a traverse cord and pulley.

455

atrium door A French-door pair with one ixed side. Also called a patio door. attached dwelling A residential building divided into apartments or sharing walls with adjoining buildings; designed for occupancy by more than one family.

architrave The lintel, or crosspiece, in a classical entablature.

attic window Pivoting window installed in the pitched roof of an attic.

area rugs Rugs that deine a speciic area, such as a conversation area.

Aubusson rugs Flat tapestry French rugs woven in both historic and contemporary colors and patterns.

armchair A chair with armrests as distinguished from a side chair without arms.

Austrian shades Scalloped and gathered shades that fold up. They are full and formal looking.

armoire The French term for a wardrobe or large movable closet.

Austrian valance Valance in the same style as the Austrian shade.

Art Deco (1918–45) A brief period of design between World Wars I and II that has been repeatedly revived in interior design style and color.

authentic history or period styles Interior design styles that developed in speciic geographic areas or countries during a deinite developmental or political period with a unity of style.

art glass A general term for stained, beveled, leaded, and etched glass used as primary glazing or as hard window treatments. art lamps Unique accessory luminaires, generally smaller than a table lamp.

automatic sensor dimmer A device that automatically turns on and controls the level of artiicial light to supplement natural light in order to keep the light at an even level of brightness.

art lighting A term for luminaires or ixtures that are in themselves works of art where light is the medium of artistic expression.

auxiliary heating A backup heating method needed for solar energy systems when the sun cannot supply all the heating needs of the interior.

Art Nouveau (1890–1910) A style of design based on natural loral motifs and colors.

awning window A top- or bottom-hinged window that swings out.

art rug A rug with a decorative texture or pattern of such interest and quality that it can be considered a piece of art.

Axminster carpet A Jacquard-woven carpet in which colored yarns are inserted as needed. Used extensively in contract carpeting.

artiicial light Incandescent and luorescent light. Amount and direction of artiicial lighting affect color hue, value, and intensity. artiicial stone A fabricated product that imitates natural stone and is generally used for wall facing. artist’s paint Oil or acrylic paint in small bottles or tubes. Arts and Crafts movement A school of thought at the close of the Victorian era that espoused a return to handmade, quality furnishings rather than machine-made items. asbestos shingles A ireproof rooing material in several color choices laid in overlapping manner and nailed tight. ashlar Stone cut into rectangular shapes itted together with grout. Asian or Oriental Styles primarily from China and Japan. ASID American Society of Interior Designers. asymmetrical balance The placement of different objects on either side of a center point where they balance each other. Also called informal balance, asymmetry requires a discerning eye and sensitivity to achieve the balance. atrium Latin for “entrance,” an entry hall, foyer, or lobby that has a high ceiling or, in ancient Roman houses, is open to the sky.

B B lamp A designation for a candelabra lamp or bulb that is a smooth, torpedo-shaped oval. baccalaureate degree The degree granted by colleges and universities and some design schools following four to ive years of general education and speciic topic study. back panel A panel used to cover the back of a case piece; often made of hardboard. backi lling Plowing excavated dirt into a dug-out area. For example, after a building’s foundation is constructed, dirt is backilled against the foundation’s edges. baffle A device such as a board or grid that delects light, either to direct it or to prevent glare. baffled ceiling Ceiling hung with panels of wood, metal, or fabric that serve as a screen. balance The placement of objects (such as furniture or art), or architectural detail (such as windows or columns), to create visual equilibrium. balanced light Light from more than one direction meant to eliminate glare and high contrast of light and dark, or unlattering or fatiguing shadows.

456

Glossary

ballast The connecting mechanism within a luorescent lamp. balloon, pouf, or cloud shades Loosely gathered, full, soft, and billowy shades that pull up from the bottom. balloon valance Valance in the same style as the balloon shade. baluster The member that supports the handrail on a stair. balustrade The railing formed by the newel post, balusters, and handrail. bamboo shades Shades woven of split bamboo and a cotton warp. Also called matchstick shades. bank of light A large, well-lit area of light.

battlement A parapet indented or crenellated along the upper line of a building. Bauhaus A German school of art, design, and architecture that functioned from 1919–33 and espoused the integration of art and technology for the creation of good design. The Bauhaus attracted many important artists and designers and had a signiicant inluence on the development of modern design. bay The area between columns, piers, or buttresses. bay or bow rods Traverse or curtain rods that are prebent to a bay or bow window shape.

bar or island chandelier A suspended light ixture with two or three lamps, each with a separate diffuser/cover. These shine downward in single or overlapping pools of light on work/dining surfaces.

bay window Projecting window in a square or canted coniguration.

Baroque A seventeenth- and eighteenth-century design style characterized by bold, showy, and highly decorative use of classical design elements. The feeling is often luxurious, exuberant, and unrestrained.

beadboard Wood paneling with vertical grooves milled into it so that it resembles board-and-batten walls.

barrel vault An arched roof with a roundheaded arch shape. barrier-free design Design for special populations that presents no physical obstacles or barriers to access and allows free movement in the environment. bartile Quarry or clay tile (gray or red) rooing material. It is costly but never needs replacing. base Finish trim used to cover the joint where the wall meets the loor. base lighting A light placed next to the loor behind a delector board that directs light upward. baseboard Base trim made of wood. baseboard units Plugged-in or prewired units near the loor for room or area heating. basket weave A variation of the plain weave in which groups of warp and weft threads are carried as one. A balanced weave carries the same number in each direction—two over and two under; 3/3; 4/4. An unbalanced basket weave carries uneven groups of threads over and under, such as 2/3 or 3/4.

bead and reel A molding of alternating round bead shapes and oval or disk shapes.

beam system construction Solid beams of steel, wood, or concrete supported with a series of posts. beamed ceiling A ceiling with exposed beams or trusses. Beau-Grip A registered trademark of Beaunit for viscose rayon. bed molding See crown molding. beltcourse A projecting row of bricks or stone on the facade that separates one story from another; also called stringcourse. Belter, John Henry (d. 1865) A New York furniture craftsman best known for his Rococo Revival pieces of carved laminated rosewood. belvedere A cupola or lantern. The small square towers that rise from the roof of the Italianate buildings of the nineteenth century. Bemberg A registered trademark of Beaunit for cuprammonium rayon. bentwood A method of softening wood with steam and then bending it into curved forms.

bas-relief (low relief) The type of sculpture wherein the igures protrude only slightly from the background.

berber rugs Woven or tufted wool rugs left in their natural color state—white, beige, brown, or charcoal, with lecks of light or dark neutrals.

bast ibers Natural cellulosic ibers obtained from the stems and leaves of plants. The best known are linen and jute.

bergère French term for an upholstered armchair with upholstered side panels between the armrest and seat.

bathroom i xtures Two or three lamps on one base, mounted onto the wall above the mirror and sink/countertop to illuminate personal grooming.

berm A pile of earth used to create a visual or physical diversion or to add variety to a landscape.

batik A hand process of resist dyeing. A pattern is drawn with wax onto a cloth, then the cloth is dyed. The waxcovered portion will not be colored. The wax is removed and new wax applied to allow other areas of the pattern to be colored. batting Polyester, cotton, wool, or other suitable ibers formed into sheets for upholstery padding.

Bertoia, Harry (1915–78) Italian-born designer best known for his wire seating group (1956) created for Knoll. beveled glass Thick, decorative glass with a inished edge that is mitered or beveled at less than 90 degrees. beveled paneling Paneling with edges cut at an angle other than 45 degrees. bibelot French term for a small decorative and often rare object.

Glossary

457

Biedermeier The term used to describe the Empire style as interpreted and built by the craftsmen of northern Europe.

bracket lighting A light placed on the wall behind a bracket board that directs light upward and downward.

bifold door A door with vertical double panels that folds back against itself; frequently used for closet doors.

braided rugs Strips of fabric braided, then sewn together in ovals or circles. Originated in colonial New England.

biotechnology The aspect of technology concerned with the application of biological and engineering data to synthetic products and environments. See also ergonomics.

brainstorming Generating ideas without stopping to judge their quality.

bishop sleeve curtains Drapery lengths pulled into a bloused, poufed effect.

breakfront A case piece whose front plane is broken with receding or advancing sections. Also, the projecting section of the facade on Late Georgian houses that is topped with a pediment.

bisymmetrical balance Also called formal or passive balance, the arrangement of like parts or objects in mirror image on each side of a central point.

brass A yellowish alloy of copper and zinc.

breast The front of the ireplace and chimneypiece.

bleaching A preinishing process for natural ibers that whitens gray goods. Also the chemical lightening of the natural wood color as part of the wood inishing process.

Breuer, Marcel (1902–81) Important designer/architect associated with the Bauhaus and known for the design of several classic chairs.

blinds Slats or louvers held together with cords or on a pulley system. Blinds may be horizontal or vertical. Sometimes pull or pouf shades are called blinds.

brick Clay and other additives formed into rectangles and dried in the sun or ired in a kiln oven; used for walls and loors.

block front A furniture detail used on the front section of case pieces. The block front consists of a series of three panels—the two outside panels come forward and the center panel is recessed.

brilliants Several pinpoints of light that produce a glittering effect.

block print A two-dimensional art form printed from a lat wooden or linoleum block on which the background has been carved away, leaving a raised design pattern. block printing A hand-printing technique in which blocks (usually wood) are carved, inked with fabric dye, and pressed onto the fabric. blueprints Floor plans printed in blue ink and used for construction plans. board and batten Vertical wooden siding made of parallel boards with narrow strips of wood (battens) to cover the cracks.

broadloom carpet Woven or tufted carpet typically 12 feet wide. bronze A deeply colored, reddish brown alloy of copper and tin used to make sculptural pieces. brush painting Application of paint with a handheld brush. Ideal for small areas and detail work. brushed i nish A lustrous (but not shiny) inish achieved by brushing a series of uniform scratches into metal. bubble planning The irst step of diagramming, in which bubbles represent zones and are placed in proximity relationships.

boiserie French term for wood paneling; typically Rococo.

budgeting The facet of a design project that dictates the amount of money to be spent on various aspects of the job.

bolection A rounded, projecting molding.

buffet See sideboard.

bonded (rebonded) foam Carpet underlay (padding) of chopped foam and iller materials bonded together by heat, pressure, and some adhesives.

buffet lamps Tall, slender, nonadjustable portable luminaires meant to throw soft light on buffet food or décor and to supplement ambient lighting.

bonnet roof A hipped roof with two pitches. The top is steeply pitched and the bottom, which covers a porch, is low pitched; used on houses of French inluence.

buffet-style dining Guests serve themselves a meal from a table or sideboard (balancing the plate on the lap may be implied).

bonus room An uninished room, often in a basement or attic, that is suitable for inishing as a guest room, home ofice or studio, family or media room.

building information modeling (BIM) Enhanced CADD software capable of generating and managing building data using three-dimensional, real-time, dynamic building modeling software to increase productivity in building design and construction.

border A strip of companion wall covering used to trim and accent. Packaged in ive-yard spools. boss A projecting ornament at the intersection of ribs in the Medieval church. bow window A curved projecting window (in the shape of a bow). bracket An angle-shaped support.

building inspector An oficial whose job is to inspect new or remodeling construction for structural soundness and safety features. building systems Components of a building that are permanent. These include HVAC, electrical and lighting systems, and plumbing.

458

Glossary

bulb More accurately the lamp bulb or lamp, it is the glass container that houses the ilament of incandescent lighting and in luorescent lighting contains phosphorus and gas. bullnose A 180-degree rounded wooden edge on the starting step (also on a table or cabinet top). burl veneer Made from scarlike wood growth or from root wood that imparts a complex, swirling grain pattern to the veneer. burn-out printing See etch printing. business accounting software Computer programs for managing accounting records. buttress A structure built against a wall to strengthen it. buttressed chimney In Medieval construction, a stepped chimney built in the shape of two buttresses placed back to back. buyer One who selects lines or companies whose furnishings are sold in furniture and department stores. byobu Small-scaled decorative folding Japanese screens. Byzantium The ancient Roman name for today’s Istanbul, also called Constantinople (330–1453 a.d.). The city was the capital of the Byzantine Empire, which encompassed much of what is today Greece and western Turkey. Known for its colorful tile mosaics, installed in architecture in many parts of the empire.

C C lamp A cone-shaped lamp or lightbulb. cabinetry or cabinetwork Fine inish woodwork, as opposed to rough carpentry. cable system construction A method of contract building in which a canopy is held in place with steel cables hung from a central column. cabriole leg An S-curved leg typical of the Régence and Louis XV periods in France and the Queen Anne and Chippendale eras in England and America. CAD See computer-aided design. café curtains Curtains that cover the bottom half of a window. calendering A inishing process of ironing under heat with a large cylinder roller. The roller may have raised patterns to imprint designs, and the fabric may also be glazed with a resin, then calendered to produce a high sheen or other special inishes.

cane Thin strips of rattan or bamboo used to weave mesh for chair seats and chair backs. canister A luminaire shaped like a can that contains a lamp at the top or the bottom. canted Beveled or tilted at an angle. cantilever A projecting or overhanging structure anchored at one end so that no outside support is required. Cantrese A registered trademark of DuPont for nylon. capital The decorative head of a column or pillar. Caprolan A registered trademark of Allied Chemical for nylon and polyester. carbon footprint Consumption of nonrenewable energy; deined as the total amount of carbon dioxide (CO2) and other greenhouse gases emitted over the life of a product. Carpenter’s Gothic The wooden, board-and-batten version of the Gothic Revival style. cascades Zigzag-shaped panels of fabric that usually frame swags or festoons. case goods Furniture without upholstery, such as desks, chests, and dressers. cased glass Clear glass encased in a layer of colored glass. casement draperies A strongly textural-looking fabric in a woven or knitted construction. Screens light, cuts down on glare, and provides daytime privacy. casement window A side-hinged window that swings in or out. casing A layer of fabric between the padding and the actual cover in upholstery. cast iron Iron cast in a mold. Casual Contemporary A look of relaxed comfort, with handsome furnishings of low-maintenance materials. cathedra The bishop’s chair from which the term cathedral is derived. cathedral ceiling A high, open, gabled ceiling. cathedral window A pointed window set in the gable of a room with an open ceiling. Caucasian or Turkish rugs Oriental rugs of a coarser weave than Persians, in geometric patterns and often vivid colors. cella Literally, a cell. The interior space of a Roman temple.

came The lead strips used to secure the pieces of glass in leaded or stained glass windows.

cellulosic ibers A classiication of natural ibers that come from plants and are made up of cellulose—cotton and linen being the most commonly used. Also a classiication of man-made ibers that begin with cellulose, such as rayon and acetate.

camel-back sofa A sofa with a serpentine back that rises to a hump in the center.

cement A powder of silica, alumina, lime, and other materials. Mixed with water and aggregate, cement becomes concrete.

candela, candlepower, or candle The unit of luminous intensity from which other measurements of light are calculated.

central air-conditioning Cool or temperate air controlled from a central unit and distributed through ducts and vents.

candle stand A small pedestal table, originally used to accommodate a candlestick or lamp.

Central and South American rugs Folk rugs from natives of Central and South American countries.

Glossary

central vacuum system A vacuum located in one unit with plumbed pipe and outlets where the hose is attached. The wall plate covering the outlet activates the system when it is lifted. ceramic tile White clays ired to a point of vitriication. It comes in many sizes, shapes, colors, and patterns; a strong, hard material for walls, loors, and ceilings. ceramics The art of modeling and baking in clay. chair rail A molding placed on the wall at chair-back height. chaise longue A French term that literally means long chair. It has an elongated seat designed for reclining. chandelier A decorative, ceiling-mounted, or pendant-type luminaire consisting of several branches for candles or electric lamps. chemical i nishes See standard inishes. Chevreul, M. E. (1786–1889) French chemist who was head of dyestuffs at Gobelin Tapestry Works near Paris. Chevreul researched and published theories that were forerunners to the Standard Color-Wheel theory. chimneypiece The decorative detail that covers the irebox and lue. china Designation given by Europeans to porcelain from the Orient. Chinese rugs Oriental rugs woven in Chinese traditional or contemporary patterns in a deep, sculptured pattern. Chinoiserie A French term for Chinese-inspired design, irst popular in the seventeenth and eighteenth centuries. chipboard See particleboard. Chippendale, Thomas II (1718–99) An important English cabinetmaker known for the designs published in his book, The Gentleman and Cabinet-Maker’s Director.

459

classic A work of the highest excellence able to stand the test of time. classical Rome (200 B.C.–A.D. 100) The Roman era of political conquest and architectural achievement. Roman design was discovered by the Western world when the excavation of Pompeii began in 1754. clearance Space required by code or law around a combustible heating unit (stove, ireplace, or furnace) so that nearby materials will not ignite. Also, the clear space between users and the objects they are passing. clerestory window Window placed at the top of the wall or in the highest story of the nave or choir of a church. cloisonné Decorative objects made by soldering metal strips into a pattern on a metal piece and illing the space between the strips with enamel. closed floor plans Floor plans with many rooms that are totally private from other rooms, having solid walls and accessed only through a door that may also close. closed showrooms A design-oriented store for placing orders of merchandise. They deal only with professional interior designers; clients are not allowed to enter. closed stair A stairway with walls on both sides. Also called a housed stair. club foot A round, pad-shaped foot on a cabriole leg. coated fabric wall coverings Fabric layered with vinyl to become wall coverings. coaxial cable A type of wire consisting of a center wire surrounded by insulation and then by a grounded shield of braided wire, used in cable television and computer networks.

choir The section of the church where the choir sings.

cobblestone Large rounded stones such as river cobbles set into concrete and used mainly as nonresilient hard wall materials.

chopped urethane A foam product made from particles of urethane bonded with other materials, often used as a carpet underlay.

code A federal, state, or local ruling, law, or regulation that stipulates building safety and health requirements. Examples include nonlammable materials or irestops.

chroma The relative brightness or intensity of a particular hue or color. Low chroma is dull; high chroma is bright. Chroma, also called intensity, is a designation of the Munsell color system.

coffered ceiling A ceiling formed with recessed boxes, or coffers.

chromium (chrome) A shiny silver metal resistant to rust.

cold-air returns Ducts used in forced-air heating systems to return cooled air to the heat source for warming.

CIDA Council for Interior Design Accreditation. circuit A wiring hookup that forms a path through which electrical current may low. circulation Movement from place to place within an environment. cissing Dropping mineral spirits onto wet spattered paint to make shadows of the spatters. City of London The one-square-mile area that encompasses what was once Roman and Medieval London. clapboard Thin, horizontal, overlapping, exterior wooden siding.

coil spring A cylindrically shaped spring used for upholstery cushioning.

cold-cathode lighting The term for all colors of neon lighting. collectibles Furniture less than 100 years old, but no longer made, and highly valued because it is somewhat rare. collectors Units to capture the sun’s energy or heat for active and passive solar heating. Colonial American (1640–1770) The period before the Revolutionary War that included Medieval and Early and Late Georgian interiors. colonnade A row of columns, often forming a corridor.

460

Glossary

color An element of design, color is pigment in paint or part of the visible spectrum of light that enables us to see hues. It incorporates the study of hue, value, and intensity as well as color schemes, color application, and color psychology. color consultants Professionals trained and skilled in selecting colors for products, architecture, or interiors. May be on-staff or work freelance on a per-job basis. color deiciency An impaired ability to perceive and distinguish colors, and/or light versus dark values. color harmony The selection and arrangement of colors to be pleasing to the eye and to the senses. color rendering index (CRI) Light’s effect on color, scaled from 0 to 100, with sunlight at 100; the higher the number the more “true” the color will appear. color temperature The color of light, measured in Kelvin (K or k). color washing Applying a coat of thinned, sometimes translucent, paint over a white or colored ground. colored incandescent lighting Accomplished with colored glass lamps or by colored screens or ilters placed over a white light. colorfast The ability of a dyed or printed fabric to resist color loss from cleaning, light fading, or atmospheric impurities. color-group moods Groups of color that produce emotional response, such as light and bright colors producing feelings of spontaneity and happiness. coloring A general term for dyeing and printing textiles. column A tall upright supporting shaft. columned chimney A chimney formed in the shape of one or more columns. C.O.M. Customer’s own material—purchased by the customer from someone other than the furniture manufacturer for upholstery on a selected piece. combination Wooden furniture construction with more than one type of wood in the exposed parts of the piece. combination felt padding Carpet underlay felt pad of some animal hair and some synthetic iber. combination floor plans A loor plan with areas that are open and other rooms that are closed. combination weave A fabric employing more than one type of weave; for example, plain and twill weaves seen side by side in a fabric. combing A paint application technique in which a comb or similar toothed object is dragged across the surface of newly applied, wet paint. combustion lighting Candlelight and irelight. communication systems Intercom, computer network, and telephone systems that connect people within the building or beyond the building. compact fluorescent lamp (CFL) Small luorescent lamps that consume one-ifth of the power and can last up to

thirteen times longer than incandescent. May connect to an incandescent ixture. compartmental bathroom A bathroom in which the separate functions are housed in small rooms that open to each other. complementary colors Colors in opposite position on the color wheel. Complementary colors have the greatest contrast of all the color combinations, each making the other more vivid. Types of complementary combinations include direct, split, triadic, double, tetrad, and alternate complements. Composite A Roman architectural capital style composed of volutes from the Ionic order and acanthus leaves from the Corinthian order. compounded fabrics See layered fabrics. computer communication E-mail is used for direct professional communication; Skype and virtual meeting software allow networking and videoconferencing to gather data and evaluate designs downloaded to FTP sites or through CADD BIM software. Social networking sites are used for instant messaging or chatting. Blogs are used for sharing information and as marketing tools. computer hardware The components of a computer system: the keyboard, monitor, computer power drive, printer, and plotter. It can also include large mainframe computers. computer network Connective cables that allow computer terminals within an ofice or design irm to access the same information. computer programs The software that operates the computer hardware. Programs are instructions, information, and databases that allow the machine to operate speciic functions. These include graphics, CAD, word processing, and so on. computer terminal A keyboard and monitor that are connected to a mainframe. Also, a personal computer that can be connected to other computer terminals via a computer network system. computer-aided design (and/or drafting) CAD (CADD) Computer software that enables the designer to draw, draft, arrange furnishing components, and compose simulated perspectives of a proposed interior space. concept An idea for the solution to a problem. conceptual drawings Drawings that show the concept or idea for a design. concrete A mixture of sand, water, and portland cement that dries to a hard material; used for loors and walls, footings, foundations, and exterior latwork. condominium An individually owned home in a complex. The owner pays a monthly or yearly charge to maintain common landscaping and recreation and/or itness facilities. construction drawings See working drawings. Contemporary Organic A style of open cleanliness with generous use of wood on loors, walls, and ceilings as vertical or horizontal planks, paneling, or logs. This style uses a variety of window styles and furnishings, from Colonial to Modern.

Glossary

continuing education Skills, training, and knowledge gleaned by the professional interior designer through seminars and networks sponsored by professional organizations, institutions, and corporations. contract design Design based on a contractual arrangement with the client. Also, design work for which the client is not a residential occupant. contract wall coverings Wall coverings that meet standards or codes for durability, ire safety, and low maintenance. Wider and in longer rolls than residential wall coverings. contrast The difference between two colors, values, or shapes. A large difference is termed sharp contrast, high contrast, or vivid contrast; small differences are termed low contrast. Contrast makes individual objects more meaningful. control The monitoring unit or thermostat needed for a furnace or an active solar heating system. conventional design A type of decorative design taken from nature and adapted, stylized, or conventionalized. The pattern is still recognizable as the nature object (lowers, for example) but is not reproduced in its naturalistic state. conventional traverse rods Drapery rods with a cord-andpulley system for operating pleated draperies. conversation pit Seating areas designed and built in as an integral part of the environment. Pit implies a sunken area, but this type of seating could be designed on a platform or on loor level. cool colors Green, blue-green, blue, blue-violet, and violet. cool white deluxe fluorescent lamps A quality, balanced spectrum lamp whose light does not appear cold and unlattering. coordinating fabric Decorative fabric printed in the same pattern as, or one that harmonizes with, wallpaper. Also called companion fabric. cope To cut a section of paneling to it an adjoining piece. copper A bright, shiny, reddish brown metal used for cookware, tableware, decorative objects, and building components. corbel See bracket. Corinthian A Greek and Roman architectural style that features a capital decorated with acanthus leaves. cork, cork wall coverings Lightweight, resilient bark of the cork oak, a broadleaf evergreen tree that grows in the Mediterranean region. Cork is coated with vinyl for loors and is an ingredient in linoleum. It is used in sheets or tiles or laminated to paper for wall coverings. corner blocks Triangular blocks of wood attached at an angle across the corner of a joint for added strength. corner i replace A ireplace situated in the corner of a room. cornice A wooden top treatment for draperies, frequently shaped on the bottom. Also, the projecting top section of a classical entablature. Found on the exterior under the eaves and on the ceiling where it meets the wall on the interior. cornice lighting A lamp or line of light placed next to the ceiling with a board in front to direct the light downward.

461

cornice molding A more ornate form of crown molding. Coromandel Large Chinese black-lacquered folding screens. corridor A passageway or hallway; usually indicates a contract application. cost analysis The proposed budget, including the design fee for a project or the economic feasibility of the design work. The result of programming research. cost per square foot The total cost of the home or building, or the total cost of building one loor divided by the number of square feet. cottage curtains Curtains often used in tiers or layers with rufles around the edges. cotton A natural cellulosic iber obtained from the boll (fruit of the cotton plant). Cotton comes in short, medium, and long staple ibers and is an absorbent, soft, comfortable iber. It dyes easily and is used in many printed decorative fabrics and in toweling. cotton rugs Accent, scatter, or area rugs woven of cotton. Many are handwoven in India. course A horizontal row of brick or masonry. cove molding A concave, rounded molding placed where wall and ceiling meet. coved ceiling A ceiling with a concave, rounded radius where the ceiling meets the wall. covered-frame wall fabric method Fabric wrapped and stapled around a lath frame, then hung or afixed to a wall. Craftsman style A style of architecture and interior design developed in the late nineteenth century, featuring exposed beams, right-angled furniture, and rustic decoration. Its early proponents were the Greene brothers and Gustav Stickley. Also called Mission style. crenellation The notches or indentations in a parapet. critical path The time frame and overlapping order of every step in the building and inishing process. crocking The rubbing off of excess dyestuffs onto another fabric or onto the skin. crop To trim or cut an art piece to it a frame. cross dyeing Two ibers of different afinities dyed in the same bath; the colors will be accepted differently. cross section A vertical drawing of a slice through the interior of a building, showing the relationships among walls, beams, rooms, stairs, and other architectural elements. crossing The area of a cross-shaped church where the nave and transept cross. crowding Where people are grouped together in tightly restricted areas. crown lintel See jack arch lintel. crown molding Trim placed where the wall and ceiling meet. Also called bed molding. cruciform Floor plan in the form or shape of a cross.

462

Glossary

crypt An underground vault, especially in a church, often used for burial.

daub A coarse plaster used as inill wall inish in Medieval timber-framed buildings.

crystal A high grade of glass containing lead.

David Brewster Color theory Another designation for the Standard Color-Wheel theory.

cubic feet or footage The width multiplied by the length of a room and then by its height. The volume of space we walk through. Rooms with very high ceilings have greater cubic footage than those with lower ceilings. cultured stone A hard synthetic material, lighter in weight than actual stone. Cultured stone is made to imitate a smooth-inished onyx or marble, suitable for interior applications, and to resemble ieldstone, suitable for exterior use. cupola A small-domed structure rising above a roof. curio A rare or curious art object—a curiosity. curtain rods Plain or nontraverse rods of metal or wood. curtain wall construction See metal or space frame system. curtains A general term for fabric window treatments that are shirred or sometimes pleated but usually stationary or hand operated. curved lines Flowing lines, part of the elements of design. Large curves are smooth and gracious; small curves can give a feeling of activity in the interior. curved staircase A staircase with a curved radius. custom design Any design planned and executed according to individual speciications—not mass produced. custom floor plan One that is executed by an architect or designer to meet the needs of the space—custom tailored to the design program. custom-built furniture Furniture built and upholstered, or made of wood. Often a specially designed piece is crafted to it the dimensions of a space for a speciic function.

De Stijl An early twentieth-century Dutch aesthetic philosophical movement best represented by the work of painter Piet Mondrian. debt-to-income ratio This ratio used by mortgage lenders compares the total monthly debt, including housing costs, to the total income. This igure should not exceed 36%. It is written as follows: Housing Costs + Debts divided by Gross Income = 36% or less. Deconstructive design or deconstructivism A style characterized by fragmentation of architectural forms, irregular shapes, distortion, and unusual juxtaposition of architectural elements. The buildings may even seem disjointed and chaotic, as if they have been deconstructed and put back together in random fashion. decorative arts Arts such as ceramics, metal work, textiles, and furniture that are suitable as decoration. decorative design A classiication of design wherein the building, furniture piece, or object is decorated with ornamentation. Decorative design is broken into four categories: naturalistic, conventional, abstract, and geometric. decorative i nishes A group of inishes that add decorative appeal to fabrics. Examples of mechanical decorative i nishes include various calendering, locking, and napping inishes. Chemical decorative inishes include etch or burnout printing and inishes that add brightness, softness, texture, stiffening, and delustering.

custom-painted wall or ceiling murals Scenic depictions of mythical faraway places and perhaps in a distant time.

decorative luminaire Another term for portable decorative luminaire, consisting of plug-in, movable luminaires such as table and loor lamps. Also refers to an architectural or built-in luminaire that is decorative.

cut glass Glass incised with an abrasive to create decorative patterns.

decorator rods Metal drapery rods that are decorative, with traverse cord-and-pulley workings.

cut length The length of unhemmed fabric window treatments.

deep pile A carpet texture in which the loops are cut to a relatively long length. Also called shag carpet, especially if cut long enough that the yarns lop over.

cut pile A carpet texture formed by shearing the carpeting to one or more heights.

D dado A section of paneling that extends from the loor only as high as the chair rail. dado cap A molding used to inish the top of a dado. damper The movable piece in a ireplace that controls the airlow and escape of smoke. database catalog Information and graphic symbols programmed into a database software program. Useful in CAD and in business applications. database programs Software programs that manage, organize, and retrieve iles used for working on documents, graphics, and CAD.

dehumidiier A unit connected to an air-conditioning unit that draws off excess humidity as a part of the cooling system. demographics The statistical data of a particular population. dentil A decorative trim of projecting rectangular blocks. design A process of analyzing, problem-solving, planning, and directing the construction of a building or layout of furnishings or composite interiors; also, the plan or scheme that makes the end product possible in its executed form, material(s), and size. design drawings Plans, elevations, working drawings, renderings, schematics, and other two-dimensional representations of a design project. design process The sequence of steps in creating and executing a design project.

Glossary

designer rugs Custom-design tufted or woven area rugs. desk lamps Portable small luminaires that adjust for exact placement for the task at hand. detached dwelling A single home on a lot of its own. detail A drawing showing an enlargement of a construction component, usually provided when clariication or additional information is needed. deWolfe, Elsie (1865–1950) The greatest and best known of the society interior designers who paved the way for the modern interior design profession. dhurrie rugs Originally cotton, now wool lat tapestry weave reversible rugs. Most are imported from India to meet Western demands. diagonal lines Lines running at a slanting or oblique angle that may go one (or more) direction in an interior. Diagonal lines suggest movement and action.

463

distribution Carrying air heated by active or passive solar systems to the various areas or rooms within a building. doctor of philosophy (PhD) Doctorate degree; a possible requirement for full-time, tenure-track teaching positions in colleges and universities. dome An inverted round-dish or cup-shaped ceiling. dome system construction An arch rotated in a circle to become a dome. domestic Oriental rugs Jacquard machine-woven rugs in Oriental rug designs. doorjamb The vertical piece forming the side of a door frame. dope dyeing See stock dyeing. Doric Greek and Roman architectural style with luted columns and plain capital. dormer window A window that projects from the attic.

diagramming The graphic process of planning space on paper or on a computer using CAD software.

double complement Two sets of direct complementary colors next to each other on the color wheel.

diffusers The glass or plastic cover over a luminaire that serves to soften the light and spread it evenly over the area.

double glazing Filling a window opening with two layers of glass that provide insulation and increase energy eficiency at the window. Also known as twin glazing.

digital subscriber line (DSL) A structured wiring system that enables telephone wires to carry signals at increased speed and with increased capacity. DSL can be retroitted in existing homes. dimensional stability The ability of a fabric to maintain or return to its original shape. dimmable fluorescent system A lighting apparatus utilizing an electronic dimming ballast and special wiring to operate a dimmable luorescent lamp with a wall-box dimmer switch. It is a ire hazard to use a nondimmable luorescent lamp in a dimmer circuit. dimmer switch A manual or automated mechanism that controls the variable brightness of a lamp.

double roll A roll of wall covering with approximately 72 square feet, or double the area of a single roll. double-hung Two layers of draperies, an overdrapery and an underlayer. Also, two sets of shutters, one installed directly above the other. double-hung sash Sash window where both sections are operable. double-shirred valance A valance shirred, or gathered, at the top and bottom. double-turn stair A stair that makes two 90-degree turns on two separate landings.

direct complement Two colors directly across from each other on the color wheel.

double-wide mobile home A mobile home fabricated into sections the size of a single-wide trailer, then itted together to become 24 to 30 feet wide and 20 to 40 feet long.

direct glare Glare from an insuficiently shielded light source directly into the line of vision.

dovetail A series of fan-shaped joints used to connect drawer fronts and sides.

direct glue-down A method of laying carpeting where a layer of adhesive is applied to the loor and the carpet is laid directly on top of it, with no pad.

dowel A type of joint in which a third piece (the dowel) is glued into holes drilled in the two pieces being joined.

direct lighting Lighting that shines directly on the desired area. direct pasteup Gluing fabric or wall coverings up with paste or adhesive. direct solar gain Heating an area through direct exposure of sunshine to the occupied space. discharge printing A process that removes the dyed color in patterned areas and replaces it with another color. distressed A inish made to appear old or antique by the intentional addition of dents, scratches, and lecks of paint during the inishing process. See also antiquing.

down Soft, ine feathers used as illing in some upholstered cushions. draft dodgers A sand-illed tube of fabric or a heavy rug placed against a door to prevent cold air iniltration. drafting The drawing by hand, machine, or computer of loor plans. draftsman A person who drafts, draws, or produces loor plans and blueprints. dragging A paint application technique in which a dry paintbrush is pulled across the wet paint, producing a surface texture of uneven lines. Dragging may be used to produce many curved, angular, and wood-grain effects. See also combing.

464

Glossary

drapability The characteristic of a fabric to fall nicely into folds when draped.

Early American (1650–1750) A general term for American Provincial or country New England interiors.

draperies Pleated fabric hung with hooks on a traverse rod. Also refers to stationary side panels, tied-back fabric, and occasionally long shirred panels.

Early Christian (A.D. 330–800) The architectural period following the oficial recognition of the Christian church by the Roman government.

draw draperies Operable panels hung on a cord or wandoperated traverse rod.

Early Georgian (1695–1750) Architectural period that irst brought the design and elegance of the English Renaissance to America.

drawings One-of-a-kind, two-dimensional art forms produced with pencil, pen and ink, charcoal, chalk, crayon, or grease pencil on paper or other surfaces. drop-leaf table A table with a ixed center section and side laps that can be lowered or raised and held up with various types of supports. Also called occasional table. dropped-pendant luminaires Simple, suspended luminaires dropped from the ceiling with a cord or chain.

ears Moldings on panels, door frames, or chimneypieces that break to form small molded squares at the corners. earthenware Coarse and inexpensive ceramic body used for dinnerware and accessory pieces. easements Short bends in the handrail that allow it to change direction.

drum A cylindrical portion of a building used as the base for a dome.

Eastlake, Charles (1793–1865) Nineteenth-century English designer and scholar who advocated the Gothic Revival style. Wrote Hints on Household Taste.

drywall Another term for wallboard, Sheetrock, or plasterboard; wall material made of pulverized gypsum rock.

echinus An oval-shaped molding between the shaft and the abacus on a column.

ductwork or ducts Metal or plastic pipes that funnel heated or air-conditioned air throughout an interior.

eclectic design Use of furnishings from different styles and periods in a cohesive, interesting, unique, and artistic composition.

duplex A twin home dwelling—two units sharing one roof and foundation. durable i nishes Chemical or decorative inishes that remain on the fabric through repeated cleaning. durable press calendering A decorative mechanical inish that resin presses for durability and pattern impressions. durry rugs See dhurrie rugs. dust panel A panel, usually of hardboard, placed between drawers to keep dust and other objects from passing between levels. dust ruffle A gathered, pleated, or tailored fabric covering that extends from the mattress of a bed to the loor. dutch door A double door, split in half horizontally, with independent top and bottom sections. duvet A nondecorative comforter with a removable cover. dye lot A single run of color printing of wallpaper or fabric, using a particular batch of dye. Background and decorative design colors may vary somewhat with each new dye lot. dyeing The process of coloring done in one of several stages: in the viscose solution (man-made ibers), as stock (natural ibers), the yarn state, or the fabric piece goods state. dyestuff A water-soluble coloring matter used to make a dye bath solution. Dynel A registered trademark of Union Carbide for modacrylic.

E Eames, Charles (1907–78) and Ray (1912–88) An important husband-wife design team responsible for several Modern classic furniture pieces.

eco-friendly paints Paints containing low to zero volatile organic compounds (VOCs) that pollute the air and are hazardous to the health after painting until the paint completes off-gassing the VOCs. economy The relative cost of items as related to an allotted budget. e-design Designing with computer-based software with certain design and speciication capabilities. effects of crowding The effects of crowding are inordinate exposure to sounds, smells, and touch. eficacy The eficiency in converting electricity into light, measured in lumens per watt. More eficient bulbs provide more light using less energy. egg and dart A molding of alternating egg shapes and dart, or arrowhead, shapes. eggshell paint A hard inish semigloss paint. egress The way out; exit. eight plex An apartment building containing eight units. electrical raceways Encased wiring covers, usually installed along baseboards, that carry electrical and telephone cables. Raceways allow ready access so that wiring can be modiied without tearing into walls. electrodeless fluorescent lighting A luorescent lamp without electrodes but with magnetic induction, which lasts up to 100,000 hours, patented as the Everlast™ HD induction system. elements of design The tactile portion of interiors that can be manipulated by the designer. These are space, shape or form, mass, line, texture, pattern, light, and color.

Glossary

465

elevation A lat, two-dimensional drawing of a straight-on (orthographic) view of an object, an exterior facade, or an interior wall.

etched glass Glass that has been engraved with a pattern by hand or by use of an abrasive cutting tool, a corrosive substance, or sandblasting.

embellishment Decoration or ornamentation added to an object or an interior.

etchings Prints made from metal plates that have patterns and designs chemically etched into their surface.

embossed loop pile A looped pile surface carpet with high and low, or multilevel, loops; creates a random pattern.

European handmade rugs French Savonnerie and Aubusson, Portuguese needlepoint, and Spanish rugs.

embossed wall coverings Wallpapers with an imprinted, three-dimensional design.

evaporative cooling system Also called swamp cooling, the system is based on air lowing through a wet pad. Useful and economical in arid climates.

embroidery The hand or machine stitching of threads or yarns to create a pattern on the surface of an otherwise completed fabric.

execution The inal phase of the design process when the design plans are implemented.

emphasis A principle of design that indicates attention is given to a certain area within an interior. Emphasis is also called focal point.

exotic style See Oriental Revival.

enamel paints Oil-based or sometimes water-based paints that are hard and glossy.

exterior elevation A lat, two-dimensional drawing of a straight-on (orthographic) view of a given side of a building’s exterior.

enameled glass Glass that has been encased with an opaque vitreous layer. energy audit A room-by-room and past utility bill inspection resulting in a detailed report of all the ways a home uses or wastes energy. energy consciousness A term often associated with window treatments—covering windows to keep in winter heat and exclude summer solar gain or heat. Energy Guide A label that allows consumers to compare the average yearly energy costs of similar major appliances. Energy Star A joint program of the U.S. Environmental Protection Agency and Department of Energy that encourages energy eficiency through strict guidelines on over 18,000 products in thirty-ive categories, including whole home qualiication. Learn more at http://www.energystar.gov. energy vampires/phantom loads Electricity wasted when electronics are left plugged in but not on, still drawing power. engravings Prints made from a hand-engraved metal plate. entablature A decorative architectural section made up of cornice, frieze, and architrave. envelope A passive solar building system wherein air circulates in a double-wall construction around the house and includes a south-facing solarium. epoxy paint Used to paint over metal or water-illed surfaces. Contains hardeners. equilibrium A state of physical or visual balance or equality. ER lamps See R, ER lamps. ergonomics The study of the relationships between, on the one hand, human form and movements and, on the other, furniture and other products people use. See also biotechnology. etch printing A decorative chemical inish printed with acid to burn out one iber—usually cotton in a cotton/polyester blend—to leave a sheer pattern.

exposed aggregate Pebbles set into and protruding above a concrete base. Hard looring and wall material.

exterior veneer The inish building material on the exterior, such as masonry (brick, stone) or siding (metal, wood, stucco). extrude/extrusion To force out through a small opening; a method used to form tubular steel. Also, man-made ibers formed by forcing a viscose solution through a spinnerette. eyeball spotlight A recessed spotlight that shines at an angle on a wall or object.

F F lamp A lame-shaped, often luted lamp for decorative ixtures such as a candelabra. fabric art Handwoven or constructed fabric or textile pieces that hang on the wall. fabric i nish Any of a variety of treatments that render a fabric more resistant to bacteria, static, wrinkling, lammability, insects, soil, or humidity damage or that increase insulative qualities. A fabric inish may also prepare a fabric for coloring, apply dye or prints, or add aesthetic or decorative effects. fabric shades Vertically or horizontally operated shades of fabric, including roller, Roman, balloon, and Austrian shades. fabric wall coverings Heavy wall coverings made sturdy and substantial with a fabric, rather than paper, backing. Used for vinyl and contract wall coverings. fabric-backed wall covering A heavy-face wallpaper or other heavyweight wall covering, such as vinyl, that is laminated to a supportive layer of fabric. Often used in contract interiors. facade The front or principal face of a building. face weight Yarn weight of carpeting per square measure. Heavier weights indicate more face or pile yarn, or greater density.

466

Glossary

fanlight A half-circle or half-ellipse-shaped window placed above a door or in a pediment.

i nished pile weight Weight in ounces per square measure of inished carpeting.

fascia or fascia board A lat horizontal band or board, especially below a ceiling or roof, or at the end of rafters or eaves.

i nishes Paint and stain used for cabinetry, walls, trim, and other hard surfaces. See also fabric inish.

fauteuil French term for an open armchair.

i nishing Processes or chemicals that render fabrics more durable or decorative.

Federal (1790–1830) The post-revolutionary period in America.

i re alert system A network or single unit that senses heat or smoke, then alerts the occupants through a shrill noise.

feldspar Crystalline materials mixed with kaolin to make porcelain.

i re retardant Certain man-made ibers such as modacrylic, saran, and PVC that resist burning but are not lame-proof.

felt padding Animal and/or synthetic ibers compressed and needlepunched; used for carpet underlay to protect carpet without great resilience.

i rebox The part of the ireplace that contains the ire.

festoon Another term for swag, a half circle of fabric pleated or folded on the ends.

ish-scale shingles Small shingles with round or pointed sawtooth ends used to create decorative surface effects on the nineteenth-century Queen Anne–style houses.

iber felt padding See felt padding. iberglass or glass iber A mineral material made of spun glass ibers, used in applications such as textiles, insulation, roof shingles, windows, and tub enclosures. Trademarked by Owens Corning as Fiberglas®. FIDER Foundation for Interior Design Education and Research, which establishes standards for design education. Also a design school accrediting body. ieldstone Any type of large, rugged rocks used for looring or walls.

i replace insert An enclosed stove unit that can be placed in an existing ireplace to make it more eficient.

i xed window A window that cannot be opened. i xture Something that is ixed in place or an element or feature of a setting. Pieces other than typical furniture that are placed in the environment by the designer, such as pieces of specialized equipment, custom-designed work spaces, or counters. Plumbing ixtures are the sinks, toilets, and various bathtubs and hot tubs. Lighting ixtures are also called luminaires. i xture or luminaire The structured or decorative unit that holds the lamp or bulb and the electric connectors. In luorescent and HID lighting, it also contains the ballast.

i lament The continuous man-made iber strand extruded through the spinnerette. Filaments are combined and spun into threads or yarns. Natural ilaments are silk and horsehair.

flagstone Hard, nonresilient stone that splits into sheets, used for paving and looring.

i le transfer protocol (FTP) An Internet site that allows large or more complex iles to be downloaded and transmitted; they are continuously available until no longer needed.

flame resistant Refers to fabrics such as wool, silk, nylon, olein, and polyester that do not ignite easily, are slowburning, and will often self-extinguish.

i llers Preparatory materials for surfaces to be painted. Used to ill in nail holes, cracks, or other imperfections.

flame-retardant i nishes Chemical inishes that make a fabric constructed of a lammable iber become resistant to ire ignition and spread. Chemical applications that render a fabric less lammable.

i lling yarns The set of yarns woven crosswise into the set of long warp yarns that are threaded onto a loom. Also called weft. i ne arts The arts of architecture, painting, drawing, sculpture, and printmaking, as well as music, literature, drama, and dance. i nial An upward-pointing inishing ornament for pediment, post, or spire. i nish carpenter One who creates custom woodwork and cabinetry. i nish package The woodwork in an interior, including items such as built-in shelving, cabinets, case piece units, baseboard/door/window trim, and railings.

flame-retardant paints Paints with additives that inhibit combustibility. flammability resistance Ability of background textiles to resist catching on ire and/or sustaining a lame. Contract code requirement. flammability tests Tests that measure the rate of ignition, the rate of lame spread when the source of the ire is removed, how long the fabric continues to burn, how long it remains in a red-glow state, and the density and toxicity of the fumes. These tests are conducted to meet stringent state and local ire codes for contract installations.

i nish plumbing The installation of sinks, toilets, and faucet hardware.

flammable or inflammable Refers to fabrics, such as cellulosic cotton, linen, rayon, and acetate, that easily catch on ire or are highly combustible.

i nished length The length of a inished, hemmed fabric window treatment.

flat British term for an apartment; a group of rooms on one level of a building.

Glossary

467

flat paint Any type of paint that dries to a matte, or nonshiny, inish.

flush-face i replace A ireplace whose planes are lush with the wall in which it is built.

flatbed screen printing The traditional method of stencil silkscreen printing in which screens are manually or mechanically moved and paint squeegeed across by hand.

flush-mounted ceiling luminaires Lighting ixtures mounted directly to the ceiling and either completely enclosed or with the diffuser open at the top for airlow to the lamp or for ambient lighting.

flatwork Concrete laid lat for foundation and garage loors, sidewalks, and driveways. Flemish gable A gable incorporating steps, curves, or both. flexibility The ability of a fabric to stretch and rebound to its original shape; a necessary characteristic in upholstery fabrics.

flute A groove in the shaft of a column. flying buttress An inclined brace that spans from the wall to a supporting abutment and receives the outward thrust of the wall. foam rubber pads Carpet underlay of foam rubber.

flickering light An uneven source of light such as candlelight, irelight, or electric lamps that imitate this effect.

focal point Also known as emphasis or center of interest, a focal point draws the eye to an area or object and holds the interest of the viewer. Architectural focal points include picture windows and ireplaces.

flitch The half or quarter log that is cut to make lumber for furniture construction.

foil/mylar wall coverings A mirrorlike shiny or relective background.

floccati, or flokati, rugs Area rugs woven or knitted with tufts of sheared goat’s hair left in its natural cream or brown color.

folded plate system construction A building system of thin reinforced concrete in a folded, zigzag roof pattern.

flexible wall coverings Wall coverings that may be bent or manipulated to it a shape or surface.

flocked carpet A method of producing a carpet pile similar to velvet. Fibers are electrostatically charged, then embedded in a glue-coated fabric backing.

folk rugs Flat tapestry rugs handmade by an ethnic group in native design and color.

flocked wallpapers Wallpapers with chopped ibers afixed to the surface in a decorative pattern.

footcandle or footlambert (fl) The amount of light thrown by one candle on a square foot of surface, equal to 1 lumen per square foot. Conventional ofice lighting may be from 50 to 150 footlamberts.

flocking A decorative process of adhering patterns of tiny ibers to the surface of a fabric; often seen in sheers and locked dotted swiss fabrics.

forced-air heating A conventional furnace-powered heating system in which the hot air is blown through ducts and enters rooms through registers.

floodlight A relective lamp spotlight with a wide-beam spread.

form The three-dimensional shape of an object.

floor lamps Portable, free-standing units with adjustable or nonadjustable luminaires that provide light where it is needed, often for reading or hand-related tasks while seated. floor plan The two-dimensional layout of rooms. Part of the working drawings and blueprints used to construct a space. flowing lines A type of curved lines that suggest graceful continuous or growing movement. flue The chimney pipe above the irebox in a ireplace. fluoresce To glow or become luorescent. fluorescent lighting Artiicial lighting produced by charging mercury argon gas. Light is clear and relatively shadowless. Cool luorescent lighting may produce a bluish cast. Fluorescent light is produced by an arc, or discharge, between two electrodes inside a glass tube illed with very low pressure mercury vapor that produces ultraviolet (invisible) radiation in wavelengths. These activate the white phosphorus lining of the lamp, causing it to glow and converting the ultraviolet energy into visible light. flush door A lat door with lat surfaces—no raised or sunken panels.

formal areas The spaces in residential design where structured visiting, dining, and entertaining take place away from kitchen and other work spaces. formal balance Another term for symmetrical, bisymmetrical, or passive balance. Formal Traditional style Interior design style that takes components from formal European and American historic design that are comfortable for today’s lifestyles. foundation The footings and basement walls that support the building, usually made of concrete. foundation drawings Plans showing the structural details of a building’s interface with the ground, including footings, anchor bolts, breaks in walls, and drains. fourplex or quadplex A four-unit apartment building. frame A case or border made to enclose a picture. framing or framework The wooden or metal skeleton structure used for the majority of buildings today. framing plans Projections of a building from the lowest level to the roof, showing columns, beams, and joists. free-standing i replace A self-contained ireplace unit that is away from the wall.

468

Glossary

freestone A general term for building stones that are easily cut or carved, usually limestone or sandstone.

general contractor A builder who is licensed to construct or oversee construction of all building phases.

French door Double casement-type door that opens in or out.

general lighting See ambient general lighting.

French Empire (1804–20) The period during the time of Napoleon in France.

generic A general type of man-made iber that is signiicantly different from other ibers and thereby has been granted a name, such as nylon, by the Federal Trade Commission. Within each generic group are up to dozens of trademarks or trade names produced by various chemical companies.

French Régence (1715–23) The period between the reigns of Louis XIV and Louis XV in France. fresco A painting made on fresh wet plaster with pigment and lime water. fretwork Patterns of lat interlocking bands or trelliswork. frieze A horizontal band of two- or three-dimensional ornamentation. In classical architecture, the section of the entablature above the architrave and below the cornice. In textiles, a carpet whose yarns are tightly twisted, producing improved resilience and a somewhat rough texture. full-spectrum lighting Light that contains all color wavelengths. full-aniline leather Leather processed with a transparent dye that lets the grain show through. full-grain leather Leather that retains the natural texture and imperfections of the animal hide. function A normal or characteristic action or some duty required in work. Used here to refer to anything that takes place within a given environment, such as play in a children’s playroom or waiting in a doctor’s waiting room.

genuine Wooden furniture construction with veneers of a particular wood, over hardwood plywood, on all the exposed parts of a piece. geodesic dome system construction A building system enclosing spaces with curved, triangular steel truss work. The interior structure must be independent of the dome. geometric design A classiication of decorative design based on geometric shapes: circles, squares, rectangles, and triangles. Georgian The term for design during the period when George I through George IV ruled England. gilded glass Glass encased in a layer of gold. ginger jar A bulbous oriental ceramic pot and lid, designed to hold ginger. gingerbread The decorative trim used on Victorian buildings. glare Strong, steady, daylight or artiicial light that can cause irritation, fatigue, and heat buildup.

functional i nishes See standard inishes.

glare-free Lamps that have silvered lining.

furnace The mechanism that heats air or water by electricity, natural gas, coal, or oil and either blows the heated air through ducts or pumps hot water to radiators.

glass A hard, brittle material of molten silica sand and soda or potash, lime, and possibly metal oxides. Clear, transparent, or colored; used for window glazing, mirrors, walls.

furnishings Furniture and accessories, and ixtures such as lighting and appliances.

glass, architectural glazing Glass used to ill window openings; term usually refers to contract installations.

furniture from scratch, from kits, and uni nished furniture Constructed and/or inished by a skilled do-it-yourselfer, the result can be a gratifying hobby when custom inishing makes a one-of-a-kind piece.

glass block Semihollow blocks of translucent glass primarily for non-load-bearing walls.

fuse-bonded carpet Carpet yarns directly tufted into a liquid rubber or latex backing that solidiies to hold in the tufts.

glass curtains A historic term for sheers shirred onto a curtain rod and placed next to the glass.

fuzzing The working loose of ibers to the surface of the textile.

glass tiles Vitreous glass tiles in thin, square mosaic tesserae. They offer a wide range of colors and are often used to carry out a color scheme. They have a depth of color due to the relectance of the glass.

G

glaze A colored or transparent liquid applied to clay objects that hardens and becomes glasslike when baked at high temperatures.

G lamp A spherical or globe-shaped bulb.

glazing The process of illing an opening with glass. Also, transparent paint colors overlayed in sequence, producing various gradations of color in a painting.

gable The triangular end of a house formed by the pitched roof. galerie A covered porch on the houses of French inluence. gambrel roof A roof line with a double pitch, latter at the top and steeper at the bottom like a barn. garret Same as attic. gazebo A small, open garden house.

glide The mechanism on the bottom or sides of a drawer upon which it slides. gloss paint Hard, shiny paint between semigloss and high gloss. gold electroplate A process for creating gold-plated silverware.

Glossary

gold leaf Extremely thin sheets of gold used in gilding. golden age See ancient Greece. golden mean A pleasing line of division that is placed between one-half and one-third of the height or length of an object, such as tieback draperies or a chair rail. golden section A theory of pleasing proportions based on the sequence 2:3:5:8:13:21, ad inf., where a portion or section of a line relates best to its neighbors in measurements of these or equivalent increments. Gothic (A.D. 1150–1550) A period and style in western Europe characterized by pointed arches and steep roofs. Gothic arch A pointed arch that is the principal form in Gothic architecture. gouache Any water-soluble, opaque watercolor. Often used as a synonym for tempera. gradation A type of rhythm wherein sizes of shapes graduate from large to small or small to large. Also seen in varying color values from dark to light or light to dark. grain The markings and textures in a piece of wood created by the arrangement of the ibers. granite A very hard crystalline rock used for loors and walls. graphic art Artwork such as posters, fashion illustrations, and book illustrations created primarily for commercial purposes but having aesthetic merit. graphic artist A designer who specializes in two-dimensional signage, graphics, type, and design motifs or logos. graphics The visual signs in a retail space that direct customers to departments or to certain goods. Also, the term used for putting on paper the stages of space planning, from bubble diagrams to the inished loor plans. grass cloth Woven grasses laminated to a paper backing and used as wall covering. gray goods or greige Woven fabrics in their natural iber state before bleaching and preinishes. Pieces of bolt length may not be gray but a dingy off-white. grazing or graze Light shining at a very steep angle that emphasizes the texture of the surface. great hall The large, multipurpose area in the English Medieval house. great room An open area in contemporary homes that combines the living room, family room, dining room, and perhaps the kitchen, ofice, and/or library. Greek Revival (1820–60) Architectural style that contained American Empire interiors. green design An approach to design in which preservation of the natural environment is a primary consideration. Green design speciies renewable and biodegradable materials. It utilizes solar, climate, and site factors to minimize the energy consumed by the completed building. Greene brothers Charles (1868–1957) and Henry (1870–1954) Greene, also known as Greene and Greene. Southern

469

California architects who developed and popularized the Craftsman-style bungalow. greenhouse effect Phenomenon in which captured solar heat from long sun rays penetrates glass, bounces off materials and furnishings, and becomes shorter, weaker, and unable to repenetrate the glass. greenhouse window Projecting glass box for growing plants. Gropius, Walter (1883–1969) German-born architect known for his modernist style. Gropius was director of the Bauhaus design school (1919–28) and later chaired the architecture department at Harvard University (1938–52). grounding receiver The third hole in an electric outlet required for ixtures and appliances that consume a lot of power to be connected into the circuit and to prevent electric shock. gum arabic A sticky substance from gum trees that is soluble in water and hardens when exposed to air, used as a vehicle for watercolor. gypsum board See wallboard.

H hand The relative softness or coarseness of a fabric; the way it feels to the touch. hand printing Textile processes such as batik, tie-dye, block printing, and hand silkscreen and stencil printing. handheld communication devices (HHCD) Devices used to send e-mails and perform a wide variety of tasks, from banking transactions to communicating with hard-wired systems and devices. handrail The rail for grasping while ascending a stair. hard window coverings Art glass, blinds, screens, shades, and shutters. hardboard Compressed wood ibers formed into panels with embossed designs or a wood/plastic laminated surface. hardware The metal ittings on furniture such as drawer pulls and keyhole covers. Also, the components that make up a computer: the keyboard, the computer power drive unit, the monitor or screen, the printer, and the plotter. hardwood Tough, heavy timber of compact texture taken from trees with broad, lat leaves such as oak and walnut. harmony A congruous combination of parts into a pleasing whole; the result of unity and variety balanced together in an orderly, agreeable arrangement. hearth The slab that forms the base of a ireplace and extends into the room. heat gain Solar heat that penetrates the interior through glass; desirable in winter and undesirable in summer. heat loss The interior heat lost in winter back through glass to the outside. To prevent heat loss, movable insulation or insulative window treatments are employed.

470

Glossary

heat pump A geothermal heat exchange system, usually composed of a sealed length of liquid-illed underground tubing connected to a heat exchanger that feeds into the building’s ventilation ductwork. It utilizes the relatively constant, moderate temperatures found several feet beneath the earth’s surface to provide heat and/or cooling. heat setting The setting in of permanent creases or folds in polymer fabrics by heating the fold to the point of polymer low (beginning to melt), then rapidly cooling the fabric. heat-transfer printing Decals that are dispersed-transferred from waxed paper to a cloth under heat and pressure. Hepplewhite, George (d. 1786) An important English furniture designer who produced a series of drawings published as The Cabinet-Maker and Upholsterer’s Guide. Herculaneum See Pompeii and Herculaneum. HID (high-intensity discharge) lighting HID lamps establish an arc between two very close electrodes set in opposite ends of small, sealed, translucent or transparent glass tubes. The electric arc generates heat and pressure high enough to vaporize the atoms of various metallic elements inside the lamp, causing the atoms to emit large amounts of visible-range electromagnetic energy. high contrast The difference between small areas of light and the dark area surrounding it. See also high-contrast values. high dei nition (HD) color rendering A marketing term that indicates a high quality of light, typically as compared to the CRI, indicating that a light ixture produces light very similar to natural sunlight. high key All colors in an interior are light or high in value. high rise A building containing several levels or loors of apartments, condominiums, or ofices. high tech/High-Tech design A product of high technology. An architectural and design style that incorporates and celebrates elements of high-tech industry and technology. Technical elements, such as HVAC, are freely exposed so their technology can be fully appreciated.

Hitchcock, Lambert (1795–1852) An American furniture designer known best for his Hitchcock chair with its black painted inish, stenciling, rush or cane seat, and delicate lines. Hoffmann, Josef (1870–1956) Member of the Vienna Secession and founding member of the Wiener Werkstätte. He is best known for his design of the Prague chair and Fledermaus chair. hollow-core door A veneered door with a hollow core illed with cardboard honeycomb. hologram A three-dimensional image projected by splitting a laser beam. home automation Central control of all energy-using ixtures and devices. home designer A design professional who specializes in creating residential loor plans, typically CAD plans. hooded i replace A ireplace with a projecting hood to catch the smoke. hook-and-loop fasteners A two-part fastening system of nylon loops on one tape and a fuzzy nylon surface on another that stick together and can be pulled apart. The bestknown brand is Velcro. hooked rugs A traditional method of making decorative rugs of strips of fabric, punched through a jutelike backing with a special hook. horizontal lines These lines visually widen or lengthen an interior and, when dominant, produce feelings of relaxation and repose. horizontal satin See sateen. horseshoe arch An arch whose apex is wider than its base, resembling a horseshoe in proile. Horseshoe arches are a typical feature of Near Eastern and Central Asian architecture. hourglass A piece for telling time with two globes of glass connected by a narrow neck that allows a quantity of sand to pass during a speciied time.

high values Light variations of a hue; a hue with various amounts of white added.

housed stair A stair attached to walls on both sides. Also called a closed stair.

highboy A tall four- or ive-drawer chest mounted on a dressing table (lowboy). Also known as a tallboy.

housing-to-income ratio Home inancing or lending institutions require that monthly housing costs generally not total more than 28 percent of the gross monthly income. This housing-to-income ratio is expressed as: Housing Costs divided by Gross Income = 28% or less.

high-contrast values A wide division of color value in an interior—very light colors contrasted with very dark colors. high-eficiency furnace A furnace that uses less energy and delivers a higher output. The unit costs more initially. high-gloss paint The shiniest and most durable of the paint lusters.

hue Another word for color, such as the hue red. Often used to mean pure spectral colors as opposed to shades, pastels, etc. An important designation in the Munsell color system.

hiking up The shrinking of a draped fabric that has absorbed moisture, then dried.

humidiier An attachment to a furnace that adds moisture or humidity to the air. (Heating interior air strips it of moisture.)

hipped roof A roof without a gabled end that slopes in four directions.

hutch A side piece with cupboards and drawers and a set of open shelves above; also called a Welsh dresser.

Hispanic Having to do with Spain or Portugal.

HVAC Heating, ventilation, and air-conditioning. A central HVAC system maintains an even temperature and circulates fresh air through the interior.

Hitchcock chair See Hitchcock, Lambert.

Glossary

471

hybrid solar energy system A passive solar system augmented with fans, ducts, blowers, or other mechanical devices.

or Provincial France, Tuscany, Italy, and Colonial Spain which spread throughout the Americas.

hydrophilic A iber that readily absorbs moisture, such as natural and man-made cellulosics and natural protein ibers.

Informal Traditional, Colonial, or American Country A less reined style with a handcrafted charm from the Medieval English Elizabethan period and colonial America.

I IBC Institute of Business Designers.

infrared (IR) transmission A wireless system that uses infrared waves to operate electronic devices or enable one electronic device to communicate with another.

IDC Interior Designers of Canada.

ingress The entrance to a building.

IDEC Interior Design Educators Council.

in-house designer An interior designer who is a salaried staff member of a large organization; responsible for the interior design or facilities management of new and existing buildings owned by that organization.

IDS Interior Design Society. IFDA International Furnishings and Design Association (formerly the National Home Fashions League). IFI International Federation of Interior Architects/Designers.

inlaid vinyl Flooring in which successive layers of vinyl granules are built up to suggest texture.

IIDA International Interior Design Association.

insolation See incident solar radiation.

ikebana Traditional Japanese method of arranging lowers according to strict rules of placement.

Insulating Concrete Forms (ICFs) Large, hollow blocks, forms, or molds that have built-in insulation. They are stacked in place and illed with reinforcing bar and concrete to create structurally sound walls ready to accept inal exterior and interior inishes. Replacing wood-framed structural building systems, they produce interiors that are comfortable (no drafts or cold spots), quiet, energy eficient, lexible, safe, and healthy (no rotting or molding), are termite and pest resistant, and have a two-hour burn rating.

illusion lighting The artistic science of creating illusion through specialty lighting. incandescent lighting Light produced by heating ine metal ilament until it glows. Warm incandescent lighting produces a yellowish cast to colors. incident solar radiation The energy collected from the sun to power active solar panels/systems. Also called insolation. independent living The ability of elderly or handicapped persons to live at home and care for themselves because the space is planned to accommodate their needs. indirect lighting Produced by throwing light against a wall, loor, or ceiling to light a general area. indirect passive solar gain Heat from sunshine that is gathered in a location apart from the primary living space of a building, such as Trombe walls, a thermosiphoning system, roof monitors, or a solar greenhouse. Also called isolated passive solar gain. Indo-Aubusson rugs Deep-pile Oriental rugs in western European styles and colors, especially inluenced by French Neoclassic Aubusson rugs. They originated in India and are woven in the same depth and beveled pattern outlines as Chinese rugs.

insulation A material such as iberglass that prevents heat transfer. Commonly used in batts (iber blanket rolls), rigid panels, shredded recycled paper, or other materials. insulative window treatments Any window covering that deters heat loss and solar gain. intaglio Printing from plates where the design is recessed below the surface of the plate. Those recesses hold the ink. intensity The relative pureness or brightness of a color, as opposed to the dullness or neutralization of that hue. Also called chroma. intercom An electrical system that allows people to communicate within a building; also carries taped or radio music heard through speakers.

indoor air quality The condition of the breathable atmosphere in a building.

interface Interdependency of design phases that must be accomplished simultaneously or consecutively. Also, a computer term in which different terminals can access the same information through a central mainframe computer or a networking system.

ini ll Materials used to ill the space between the timber frame of a building.

interior architecture The contract aspect of interior design that may entail remodeling and work with building systems.

informal areas Areas for relaxed, spontaneous living and entertaining.

interior building systems The systems that are part of the interior: plumbing, HVAC, electrical.

informal balance Also known as asymmetrical, optical, or occult balance, it is the state of equilibrium reached through the arrangement of unlike objects or parts on each side of a central point.

interior design package Materials and furnishings installed when a building’s construction is complete, such as carpeting and rugs, window treatments, wall coverings, and furniture.

Informal European style comes from three areas with common backgrounds similar furnishings. These are Country

interior elevation A lat, two-dimensional drawing of a straight-on (orthographic) view of a given wall of a

472

Glossary

building’s interior, showing any cabinetry, trim, millwork to be installed. interior environmental control system The systems that produce a livable environment in a building, such as plumbing, heating, air-conditioning, and electrical wiring. interior i nish components The structural items and ixtures that are installed in the inal phase of construction; including wall, ceiling, and loor materials; cabinetry and woodwork, and optional wall and window coverings. intermediate hues Six hues on the Standard Color Wheel produced by mixing a primary and secondary color. They are yellow-orange, red-orange, red-violet, blue-violet, bluegreen, and yellow-green. Also known as tertiary hues. International Modern A stark, clean style with expansive windows, plain plaster walls, hard natural and man-made materials, and illed with sculptural modern furniture classics. interrelationship of functions The way areas work together or depend on one another to function effectively. Ionic Greek and Roman architectural style with scroll-shaped capital. iron A heavy black metal. Islamic design Styles of architecture and furniture prevalent in the Near East. isolated passive solar gain See indirect passive solar gain. Itten, Johannes (1888–1967) A colorist who taught at the Bauhaus in Germany and at Yale University. He authored several books, including The Art of Color and The Elements of Color.

J jack arch lintel A trapezoidal lintel with a wedge-shaped keystone used as decoration above windows. Also called a crown lintel. Jacobsen, Arne (1902–71) Danish architect/designer known for his Number Seven chair (1955), and Swan and Egg chairs (1957). Jacquard A loom attachment named after its French inventor that allows complex patterns to be woven in rapid succession. Jacquard fabrics include brocade and brocatelle, damask, lampas, matelassé, and patterned velvets. jalousie window A louvered glass window. Japanese design Characterized by fully exposed woodframed walls and ceilings, tatami mat loor coverings, shoji and fusuma screens, simple built-in cabinets with a recessed tokonoma niche, low furniture, and loor cushions. Jeanneret-Gris, Charles-Edouard (1887–1965) Important architect/designer better known as Le Corbusier. Designer of several Modern classic furniture pieces. joint A closure, such as the mortise and tenon, where two pieces of wood are fastened together in furniture construction.

joists The heavy beams that support the loor and rafters. Journal of Interior Design The scholarly, refereed journal of the Interior Design Educators Council. jute A cellulosic bast iber obtained from the inner stalks of the jute plant and grown in India. juxtaposition Placement of colors next to each other.

K Kandinsky, Wassily (1886–1944) A Russian artist associated with the Bauhaus. kaolin A claylike substance used in making porcelain. The name comes from Kaoling, a mountain in China where kaolin was irst mined. keystone The stone at the top of an arch that is angled on the sides, stabilizing compression and friction. kilim rugs Flat tapestry folk rugs that originated in Romania. kill-a-watt electric usage monitor A plug-in device that gives detailed energy use information and how much an appliance or electronic device costs to operate. kiln An oven capable of controlled high temperatures used for baking or iring clay objects. kilowatt hour The work done by 1,000 watts in one hour. Consumers of electricity pay for their use by the kilowatt hour. kitsch A German term that describes bad taste and is applied to pretentious or foolish art. knickknack A small ornament article. knitted carpet A sturdy pile carpet that is constructed by knitting with multiple needles. knitted fabrics Needle-constructed interlocking fabrics such as single and double knits, laces, rachel warp knits, arnache and malimo fabrics. Knitted fabrics offer speed of construction, variety in patterns, and lacy effects, and either stretch or dimensional stability characteristics.

L lacquer A type of varnish made from shellac or gum resins dissolved in ethyl alcohol or other quick-drying solvents. ladder-back chair A chair back with a number of horizontal slats like a ladder. laminate Wood particleboard with a hard, durable composite vinyl layer bonded over it, used for looring and countertops. laminated foam One or more densities of polyurethane foam laminated together to form a single pad. lamination The process of building up in layers or attaching a single ply as with plywood, foam, or plastic laminates. lamp The technical term for lightbulb. lancet A narrow, pointed arch window.

Glossary

473

landings The platforms of a stair where it begins, ends, or turns.

level-tip carpet Woven or tufted carpet with some loops higher than others. Surface has a smooth, velvetlike texture.

laser A device containing a crystal, gas, or other suitable substance in which atoms, when stimulated by focused light waves, amplify and concentrate these waves, then emit them in a very intense, narrow beam.

life-cycle costing Calculating the overall cost of an item by dividing its purchase price by the number of years of expected use.

Late Georgian (1750–90) The American period that utilized English Georgian design and Chippendale furniture.

light An element of design that is broken into two types: natural (sunlight) and artiicial.

latex A rubber-based synthetic polymer extruded or sprayed on as a coating or backing to hold woven fabrics or tufted carpets stable.

light pipe An acrylic pipe that conducts light along its corridor. The light source can be sunlight or artiicial light.

latex paint A water-based paint that is easy to apply and cleans up with soap and water when still wet. lath Thin strips of wood laid parallel and nailed onto building studs. Historic method of plastering walls is to apply it over lath. lathwork Grids or panels made with strips of lath, used as screens, trellises, or decorative trim on verandas. latillas Sticks laid across the vigas to form the ceiling of the southwest Adobe houses. Latin cross The Western Christian cross with a tail longer than the top and arms. lattice A panel consisting of metal or wooden strips that are interlaced or crossed to form a grid with regular spaces. law of chromatic distribution A rule governing the distribution of color intensity or brightness. The most neutralized colors are used in the largest areas, and the smaller the size or area, the brighter or more intense the chroma proportionately becomes. layered or compounded fabrics A group of fabric constructions that require more than one step to complete. Examples include embroidery, appliqué, and tufting. Le Corbusier See Jeanneret-Gris, Charles-Edouard. leaded glass Glass windows made of small pieces held together with lead caming to form a pattern. leather The tanned hide of cattle or swine, largely used for upholstery. Leather is strong, comfortable, and has a long life span. leather tiles Pieces of leather cut into shapes and applied as wall or loor tiles. Resilient semipermanent materials. LED See light-emitting diode. L’École des Beaux Arts A school of art, design, and architecture in Paris, noted for its emphasis on historical studies. leno weave A variation of the plain weave that has warp thread in hourglass twists where the weft or illing threads are woven in. letter of agreement The legal contractual arrangement between the design irm and the client that spells out responsibilities and services of both parties. level-loop carpet Woven or tufted carpet with an uncut pile of even loops; used in both residential and contract interiors.

lifestyle The way an individual or group lives.

light-emitting diode (LED) A solid-state, ilamentless lamp with an extremely long life expectancy. lighting as art Use of light as a medium to create artistic effects. lighting designer A design professional who specializes in maximizing both the practical and the aesthetic effectiveness of lighting in interiors. lighting plan The portion of the working drawings or blueprints that shows where the lights, switches, and outlets are to be placed in a building and how they are connected to one another and to the circuit-breaker box. Also called the wiring plan. limestone A calcite stone with a uniform, matte texture. It is versatile for building because it can be cut or carved without splitting. line The deliberate connection of two points as seen in planes and outlines of shapes. An element of design. line of credit The total cost of merchandise that may be purchased by a designer on credit on behalf of the designer’s clients. line or outline lighting Lighting the perimeter of an object to give emphasis or even lighting. linen The best known of the cellulosic bast ibers, obtained from the inner stalks of the lax plant. Linen is strong and absorbent and varies from a coarse jutelike texture to i ne table damask linen textures. linenfold A Medieval panel motif resembling folded linen. linoleum A soft resilient looring of ground wood and cork, gum, color pigments, and oxidized linseed oil. Production is limited. lintel A horizontal crosspiece over a door or a window or between two columns. lithographs Prints made from a stone or metal plate to which the pattern or design has been applied with a special grease pencil or wax. log planks Wall paneling split in half lengthwise so the lat side is attached to a lat wood-framed wall and the rounded litch side is the wall material. long, formal curtains Having a shirred or tabbed heading, these long curtains can be hand operable or stationary. long-life bulb An incandescent bulb that lasts from 2,500 to 3,500 hours.

474

Glossary

loose cushions Pillows that are part of an upholstered piece but left unattached in the upholstery process. Louis XV period (1723–74) The period during the reign of King Louis XV of France. Also known as the Rococo period and characterized by ornate, curvilinear, asymmetrical design. Louis XVI period (1774–93) The period during the reign of King Louis XVI of France. Also known as the French Neoclassic period and characterized by rectilinear, classically inspired design. louvered door Door with louvered panels. louvers Horizontal slats in a shutter, screen, or window, sloped downward (or movable) to control light and air passage. low contrast Little difference between colors, meaning their values (lightness vs. darkness) are very close—such as all light colors or all dark colors. low key A color scheme in a variety of dark values. low value Hues that have been darkened. lowboy A low chest of drawers raised on legs, used as a dressing or serving table. With the addition of a tall chest, it becomes a highboy. low-voltage lighting Use of a type of lamp that controls the beam spread and incorporates transformers to reduce voltage; produces superior accent lighting. lucarne A French-style dormer window that often sits on or breaks through the line of the eaves; also, the small dormers in spires. lumber-core door Same as solid-core door. lumen A measure of brightness and the unit of luminous lux or low, measured against the luminous intensity of candle. A typical 14-watt luorescent or 60-watt incandescent lamp (bulb) has a light output of 540 lumens. The higher the lumens, the brighter the light. luminaire A lighting ixture. luminance The intensity of light in a given surface or area.

mainframe computer A large computer into which smaller computer terminals or personal computers can be given access. Mainframes can handle complex data, problems, and CAD with speed and accuracy. maintenance The labor required to maintain a material— tasks such as sweeping, vacuuming, dusting, mopping, scrubbing, or waxing. man-made ibers Chemically derived and extruded from a viscose or liquid solution. mansard roof A hipped roof with two pitches. The bottom pitch is very steep and the top pitch latter, so it is usually not seen from the ground. mantel The projecting shelf of a chimneypiece. marble A very hard stone cut into slabs and polished for loor and wall materials. Smooth and formal, white or colored with streaks of color. marbling Imitating polished marble stone with paint. markets, marketing centers Convenient clusters of trade sources that market goods and services wholesale to interior designers. Marlborough leg A straight, square furniture leg with a square foot. marquetry Patterns created by laminating contrasting pieces of thin wood (and other materials) into a veneered surface. masonry block construction Walls or foundations of cinder block or concrete block without any wooden framework. mass An element of design that denotes density or visual weight within an object. Heavier mass or density will often make an object appear larger than one that has little mass or empty space within its shape. massing Gathering or forming into a mass. The pulling of objects into a group so that together they have more visual weight or importance than they do separately. master of arts degree (MA) A degree that may be considered a terminal degree in interior design education.

luminous ceiling Incandescent or luorescent lights around which a box is framed and inished, with the cover over the lights made of translucent glass or plastic.

master of i ne arts degree (MFA) A degree that may be considered a terminal degree in interior design education. An MFA requires a ine arts skill and showing of work. It is considered the design education equivalent of a PhD.

luminous panels Fluorescent or incandescent lights set into a wall or loor and covered with translucent glass or plastic.

master of science degree (MS) A degree that may be considered a terminal degree in interior design education.

lux The unit of general illumination, equal to 1 lumen per square meter. Bright sunshine is 10,000 lux, a well-lit ofice is 500–1,000, and home lighting is 300–500 lux.

masters Those whose art has passed the test of time to become classic.

luxury homes Spacious or luxurious homes with high-quality detail, cabinet work, and furnishings.

mat A border of mat board or other material, used as a frame or part of the frame of a picture. match The same color from one dye lot to another.

M

materials Textiles and other substances used for loor and wall coverings, window treatments and upholstery, cabinetry, trim, and other physical components of an interior.

Mackintosh, Charles Rennie (1868–1928) Scottish designer/ architect, inluential with the Vienna Secessionists and designer of the Hill chair.

materials and i nishes boards Boards used to show pieces of the materials and i nishes that have been selected for a design.

Glossary

matte paint Any paint that dries to a lat, nonshiny inish. McIntire, Samuel (1757–1811) American architect and designer of houses and public buildings in Salem, Massachusetts. McIntire is best known for the beautifully carved woodwork in his interiors. mechanical i nishes A classiication of decorative fabric inishes that include calendering, napping, and locking. Also called surface treatment inishes. media The substances used to dilute paint—water for watercolor and turpentine for oil paint. Also the means or methods an artist uses to produce a work. Medieval era (A.D. 800–1500) The Middle Ages or Medieval era in Europe was a time of poverty for the masses but in architecture was a period of great cathedral building and colorful stained glass windows.

475

mini-mainframe computer A computer about the size of a personal computer but with greater capacity and power somewhat similar to a mainframe computer. minipendants Small individual suspended lamps with a glass diffuser/cover that spotlight a pool of light downward. They may be used alone or in groups. mirror Glass with the back coated with silver or a silver amalgam (compound) to give the surface a relecting quality; used on walls, ceilings. Mission style See Craftsman style. miter To cut at a 45-degree angle. A joint where two diagonally cut pieces meet at right angles and are nailed or screwed together. mobile home A house trailer for temporary or permanent housing.

melamine A synthetic compound used to make plastic laminates.

mobile home park An area where only mobile homes are placed.

mementos Remembrances or souvenirs of a person, a place, or an event.

modacrylic A synthetic long-chain polymer iber consisting of 35 to 85 percent acrylonitrile units. It is a soft, buoyant fabric that is inherently lame resistant and used extensively for contract draperies where ire codes must be met.

memorabilia Things and events worthy of remembrance. mercerization A process of treating natural cellulosic ibers (cotton and linen) with caustic soda to enlarge and make the ibers more uniform, increase the luster, and better accept and hold dyes. metal Aluminum, tin, brass, stainless steel, and other chemical compounds that are formed into strips, tiles, or sheets for use as wall, ceiling, and furniture materials. metal blinds Originally known as Venetian blinds, metal blinds provide the look of two-inch wood blinds at less cost and with less stacking space required. metal or space frame system Strong, lightweight steel skeleton framework based on the forms of geometry. metameric effect A phenomenon in which colors appear different under different lighting due to the spectral energy distribution in the materials.

Modern classics Furniture pieces by twentieth-century architects and designers that have never fallen out of favor and continue to be produced as exact replicas of original designs. modillion A projecting decorated bracket; also called a console. modular carpet tiles About 18 inches square, they are lexible and can replace damaged or worn tiles without affecting the surrounding tiles that are not damaged, providing a sensible and sustainable looring solution. monitor The computer hardware screen component. monochromatic A color scheme using one color in any of its varieties, plus some white and black. mood lighting Low-level lighting that creates a cozy or inviting ambience or mood.

metamerism The effect of light on color that causes a color to appear differently in different types of light.

Moor A Moslem of mixed Berber (North African) and Arab ancestry.

metope The space between the triglyphs on the frieze of the Doric entablature.

Moroccan rugs Handmade pile rugs from North Africa that have geometric patterns and are coarsely woven.

Mexican tile Clay tile ired at low temperatures. Natural terra-cotta color or hand-painted in bright colors, glazed and unired.

Morris, William (1834–96) A British designer of the Arts and Crafts movement who produced wallpaper, furniture, tapestries, carpets, stained glass windows, and accessories.

Middle Ages See Medieval era.

mortise and tenon A joint that utilizes a square hole carved in one of the pieces being joined and a projection that its the hole in the other.

midtones Colors at their normal value or saturation point. Mies van der Rohe, Ludwig (1886–1969) An important architect/designer associated with the Bauhaus. Designer of several Modern classic furniture pieces. millwork Stock- and custom-milled woodwork in the form of cabinetry, shelving, panels, and molding. miniblinds One-inch wide, concave metal slats held together with nylon cord. Slats or louvers are adjustable and are excellent for light and glare control.

mosaic Small pieces of glass tile or stone itted together and held in place with cement to create a pattern or design. Used for loor, ceiling, or wall decorations or accessories. mosaic tile Small tiles itted together with grout to form a pattern in loors, walls, and countertops. mothprooi ng A inish that renders a fabric, especially wool, unpalatable to moths and other destructive insects.

476

Glossary

motivational lighting A lighting specialty that utilizes brightness, dullness, and darkness to motivate people to behave in a certain manner. It utilizes principles of psychology as well.

natural trafic pattern The pattern of movement users will follow in an environment if their circulation is not hampered or obstructed.

motorized rods Drapery rods that are electronically operable. Used for large or hard-to-reach installations.

naturalistic design A classiication of decorative design that is a copy or representation of something in nature. It is realistic decoration or ornamentation.

movable insulation Interior or exterior insulation that protects against excessive heat loss or solar gain. movable louver shutters Wooden shutters with slats or blades that can be adjusted.

Navajo rugs Handwoven lat tapestry rugs in earth-tone neutral colors and geometric patterns. Woven in the southwestern United States by members of the Navajo tribe.

mullion A vertical dividing piece in an opening, especially a window.

nave The main section of the church where the worshipers stand or sit.

multilevel living Housing that contains one or more changes of planes in addition to the main loor: an upstairs, downstairs, or step-down or step-up areas.

NCIDQ National Council for Interior Design Qualiication.

multilevel-loop pile carpet A looped pile carpet with various levels woven or tufted to create texture or a pattern.

NCIDQ examination An examination administered to interior designers after a minimum of two years of professional work experience. Must be passed for full acceptance into several of the professional design organizations.

multiple-outlet strips Casings with spaced outlets that are prewired or portable, useful in home workbenches, home ofices, and other work spaces.

needle-constructed fabrics Fabrics made or decorated using automated sets of needles, including knits, laces, some casements, and schifli embroidery.

multipurpose furniture Furniture used for two or more things, such as a sofa bed or a storage bench.

needlepoint rugs Hand- or machine-made rugs, most often from China or Portugal, with small stitches of wool yarn on an art canvas background.

multiuse areas Rooms or areas with more than one purpose or function. Munsell, Albert H. (1858–1918) American colorist whose system, based on hue, value, and chroma notation, is widely used in design. Munsell theory Based on three attributes—hue, value, and chroma—in which exact color matching is possible through a notation system. mural A series of wallpapers hung in sequence to depict a scene. Also, a large-scale scenic wall painting.

N nap The fuzzy surface of a fabric formed by short hairs or ibers. NASAD National Association of Schools of Art and Design. natural A wood inish without any added color or stain. natural iber rugs Animal skins, berber rugs, cotton rugs, loccati rugs, sisal/maize mats, and wool rugs. natural ibers Fibers that come from cellulose and protein. natural light Sunlight. natural saturation point The amount of naturally occurring white or black value in a pure hue according to the Munsell system for color notation. natural textiles Come from either cellulosic ibers (cotton, linen, jute), or protein sources (silk, wool, leather) that are derived from natural sources. natural thermal flow The convection or movement of heated air up and/or toward cold air and the consequent dropping of cool air.

needlepunch carpet Carpeting constructed of ibers held together by needlepunching or interlocking the ibers by meshing together with barbed needles. Used primarily in indoor-outdoor and contract applications. negative space The area between the forms in a two- or threedimensional design. Empty or void space not illed in with furnishings, accessories, or mass. Neoclassic (1790–1830) The period in America inluenced by the excavations of Pompeii. neon A thin glass tube containing a gaseous element (neon) that glows when charged with electricity. The tubes can be bent into any shape for artistic or advertising purposes. neon lighting The red spectrum of cold cathode lighting formed with neon gas. network of lighting Interconnected wiring of lights indicated on the lighting or wiring plan in contract buildings. neutralized colors Any hue that is dulled or grayed or lessened in brightness or intensity. neutrals Black, white, and gray. Brown is a hue, derived from orange, but it is often referred to as a neutral, as are beige, tan, and the colored spectrum of off-whites. new furniture A vast category that expands continually and is offered by hundreds of manufacturers worldwide. Quality and design integrity of new furniture vary markedly, which is why design scrutiny, warranties, and quality checks are important. newel post An upright that receives and supports the handrail at critical points on a stair. niche The rounded, half-domed end of a room, or a similar recess in a wall.

Glossary

nogging Brickwork used as inill between timber framing. nonarchitectural lighting Portable luminaires. noncellulosic ibers The range of synthetically composed man-made ibers that begin as chemicals and organic substances other than cellulose. Also known as synthetic ibers. nondurable or soluble i nishes Fabric inishes that are removed with repeated washing or dry cleaning. nonglare glass Clear glass with a faintly textured surface that does not relect light. nonrenewable resources Materials that cannot be reproduced in a sustainable manner. They include materials such as plastics that are made from fossil substances, and materials such as stone and metals that are mined.

477

oil-based paints Paints that must be thinned and cleaned up with solvents or paint thinners. Durable, scrubbable inish. Requires a long drying time and has a strong odor. olei n A synthetic, long-chain polymer iber consisting largely of ethylene or propylene. Olein is durable and economical. Used for carpet face and backing and for upholstery. one-turn stair A stair that turns 90 degrees at a landing. onion dome A pointed dome whose apex is greater in diameter than its base, resembling the shape of an onion. It may be squatly or elongated. Onion domes are found on churches, mosques, and other large buildings in a broad geographical area extending from Germany and the Balkans to Russia and India.

nonresilient flooring materials A category of materials that are hard and have no give or resilience.

open floor plan A concept in interior and architectural planning where areas are left open, without wall divisions. The open areas can be used in a lexible manner to accommodate varying functions.

nonwoven textiles A group of fabrics such as felt, webbing, and ilms that are processed into fabrics without going through the yarn stage.

open ofice planning A large ofice space in which workstations are divided only by systems furniture and other furnishings.

Norman The name given to the Romanesque architectural style in England.

open plan See open loor plan.

nosing The rounded edge of a tread.

open showroom A wholesale trade source that allows clients to accompany the designer into the showroom.

novelty twill A twill weave that changes direction to create a pattern such as herringbone.

open stair A stair not attached to the wall.

nubuck Top-grain leather that has been buffed on the upper side to a soft, velvety nap. nylon A long-chain synthetic polymer iber that consists of amides linked to aramide ring molecules. Nylon is a versatile, durable iber used extensively for carpeting and upholstery.

O objets d’art French term for any object of artistic worth. occasional chair A chair kept away from the main seating area that can be pulled up and used occasionally, as needed. occasional table A small table that can be moved and used for any purpose as needed. occult balance Another word for asymmetrical, informal, active, or optical balance. The balance is not the same on each side but is achieved through arranging until the composition “feels right” and is therefore somewhat mysterious. oculus Literally “an eye.” The circular opening at the top of a dome. off-gassing The process of allowing volatile fumes and gases to dissipate. Newly installed wall and loor coverings, and new upholstered furniture, often require an off-gassing period. oil paint Colored pigment mixed with linseed oil or varnish and thinned with turpentine.

open-riser stair A stairway that is open because it has no risers. operable window A window that can be opened. opposition A form of rhythm wherein right angles meet or light and dark areas contrast in a rhythmic sequence. optical balance Same as asymmetrical, informal, active, or occult balance. Judged by the eye, or optical sense. optical color mixing See subtractive color mixing. optical density The appearance of a pattern or item as heavy or dense or illed in, and therefore judged as heavy mass. orders The styles of Greek and Roman architecture. ordinary incandescent lamps Incandescent bulbs that last from 750 to 2,500 hours. Organic Modern A style originated by Frank Lloyd Wright, whose Prairie style seemed to grow from the ground; harmonious with its setting. It also includes the Greene brothers’ Craftsman style. organizational tool programs Software that analyzes, organizes, and synthesizes information. Used for writing speciications, critical paths, and word processing. Oriental design Includes inluential design from the Near East (historically Persia, India, and the Far East). Today the term often focuses on Japanese and Chinese design. Oriental Revival A style inspired by Islamic design, irst popular in the mid- to late nineteenth century. Oriental rugs Hand-knotted (handwoven) pile rugs from the Near and Far East woven in complex loral or geometric

478

Glossary

patterns. Used for area, art, and accent rugs and wall hangings. May be very valuable. orientation The direction (N, S, E, W) windows face in a room. The natural daylighting of each different orientation has a unique effect on colors. Ostwald theory A system for analyzing color based on the color and the amount of white or black added to the hue. Ostwald, Wilhelm (1853–1932) A physicist who won the 1909 Nobel Prize for chemistry and who turned his research to color, producing the well-known book The Color Primer. ottoman An oversized upholstered footstool, sometimes called a hassock.

panel-track wall fabric installation Metal tracks available for installing fabric on the wall. Used most often in contract settings. paper wall covering Paper front and back; no vinyl coating. papier-mâché A material used for the construction of furniture and accessories made from paper pulp and glue. During the nineteenth century these pieces were often painted black and inlaid with mother-of-pearl. PAR lamp Relective parabolic aluminized relector lamp with heavy, protective glass and a focused beam. Silvering is used to establish the beam spread and the relective quality.

outbuildings Buildings situated away from a house used historically for kitchens, dairies, carriages, or servants’ quarters.

parapet A low wall on the edge of a roof, bridge, or terrace.

outlet strips Prewired or plugged-in casings that contain several outlets in a row.

particleboard A solid panel formed by compressing lakes of wood with resin under heat and pressure.

outlining Painting contrasting colors or white values on architectural molding.

passive balance Another term for symmetrical or formal balance where items are identical on each side of a central point, and therefore no judgment of the composition is needed.

overcrowding An excessive number of people working or living within a given space. overlay A sheet of velum or tracing paper placed over a rough design to improve and reine it. oxford weave Variation of plain weave in which two ine warp threads are interlaced with one heavier weft thread.

P pad painting The application of paint with a lat ibrous pad. padding A general term for carpet underlay or the cushioning layer covering the springs in upholstery. paint A liquid oil-, water-, resin-, alkyd-, acrylic-, or epoxybased material that is applied by spraying, brushing, rolling, or pad painting. Dries to a lat, semigloss, gloss, or high-gloss inish. painting A one-of-a-kind, two-dimensional art form created with color pigments and a number of different substances (vehicles) that give the paint form and body. palette knife A small, usually lexible knife used to mix paint on the artist’s paint tray (palette) or to apply paint to the surface being painted.

parquet The decorative, geometric arrangement of short lengths of wood plank for loors and sometimes walls.

passive solar gain Heat from sunshine that collects through the natural transfer of radiation, conduction, and/or convection. pastel A neutralized color achieved by mixing one or more complementary or contrasting colors with the basic hue to produce a tone, and then adding white. paterae Oval (or round) shapes used as ornament, often decorated with rosettes. patina A inish that comes with use and time to wood and metal. patio door See atrium door. patio home A small home set on a narrow, shallow building lot. pattern An element of design; the arrangement of shapes and perhaps value (light and dark contrast) or relief (high and low areas) brought together to make a random or predictable design. pattern book Books of patterns for houses, furniture, and architectural detail published for general use.

Palette theory Another name for the Standard Color-Wheel theory.

pattern repeat Wall covering or fabric pattern measurement from the top of one pattern to the top of the next, or from one pattern to another horizontally.

palisade wall A paneled ireplace wall formed of boards and battens.

payback period The number of years that a purchase (such as a solar energy installation) takes to pay for itself.

Palladian window An arched window lanked on each side by lower sidelights.

pebble tile or pebble concrete See exposed aggregate.

paneled door A traditional door formed with stiles, rails, and panels. paneling Sheets of wood used for wall and ceiling inish materials. May be solid wood or veneered (sandwiched).

pediment A decorative design detail that originated with the triangular section of the Greek trussed roof. The pediment was adapted from a triangle into a rounded segmental pediment, a broken pediment, which is open at the top, and an ornate scroll pediment. Pediments are used for furniture and architectural embellishment.

Glossary

pediment frieze The sculptural design within the pediment. peelable wall covering Wall covering that can be peeled away from a substrate (backing or lining), which is suitable to be repapered.

479

pigmenting Coloring or dyeing. Also, the process of treating leather with chemical dye. pilaster A lat, false, decorative column.

pembroke table An occasional table with drop leaves and a drawer in the apron.

pile The surface of a carpeting that has depth. Rounded loops are called uncut pile, while cut loops are called cut pile.

pendant lighting A suspended ixture with one or more lamps/bulbs within a single diffuser or shade and large enough to light a general area or dining space.

pile density Closeness of stitches (woven) or tufts of a carpet. Greater or tighter density yields a more durable product.

pendants Decorative downward projections used to embellish architectural and furniture designs.

pile weave A weave that utilizes a third set of threads that form a depth or a pile in the surface. Types of pile weave include velvet, terry cloth, and corduroy.

pent roof A narrow, overhanging roolike structure above the irst story on Pennsylvania German houses.

pilling Tendency of ibers to work into small balls or pills.

perfatape A wide paper tape applied to Sheetrock seams with plasterboard compound or mud.

pillow sham A removable decorative pillowcase.

perimeter lighting Lighting around the outside of a room or an area that visually expands space.

plain slicing method used to cut a log parallel to a line through its center—produces a vaulted or cathedral-like grain.

peristyle A continuous row of columns around a building. Also used to designate the colonnaded garden area at the rear of a Roman house. permanent installations Structural or inish materials that are not likely to be replaced due to their cost or dificulty to install or remove. Persian rugs The inest of the Oriental rugs, traditionally from Persia (today Iran). High knot count, complex, usually loral patterns. Persian prayer rugs contain a Moorish arch, imitative of those in mosques. personal computer A small computer for home or smallbusiness use. personal space The invisible “bubble” of space that surrounds us and that we consider to be our own. perspective sketch A three-dimensional sketch or rendering of an interior space drawn in perspective with vanishing points.

PL lamp Compact twin luorescent bulb.

plain weave The interlacing of threads or yarns in a one-over, one-under sequence. plan drawing A lat, two-dimensional, scaled drawing of an environment as seen from above. plane of light A bank of light; a well-lit area. planned development A tract of land that is developed into housing of a speciic style, size, price range, and type (attached dwellings, single detached dwellings, luxury dwellings). plantation shutters Louvered shutters with wide blades. Used in the South during colonial days as screens to encourage ventilation during the hot months. plaster A thick, pasty mixture of sand, water, and lime used for smooth or rough wall and ceiling textures.

pewter A soft, dull-gray alloy of tin, copper, lead, and antimony used to make tableware.

plasterboard Another name for drywall, Sheetrock, or gypsum board, plasterboard is a wall material made of pulverized gypsum rock and commonly used as a wall i nish material.

Phyfe, Duncan (1768–1854) A New York furniture builder, originally from Scotland, known for his Regency-style pieces.

plastics Synthetically produced, nonmetallic compounds that can be molded, hardened, and used for manufacture of various products.

piano nobile The principal loor of a building; usually a raised irst loor.

plate rail A narrow shelf for displaying plates.

picking out Highlighting features on molding, such as dentil trim or carved bas-relief, with paint. piece dyeing Coloring a bolt or length of fabric after it is woven into cloth. pied-à-terre A French term for a lat or house for occasional use (“foot on the ground”). pier Same as a column but without its details and proportions. pigment A compound that is the coloring agent for paint, ink, crayons, and chalk. A nonsoluble coloring matter that is held onto the surface of the fabric with a resin binder.

Platner, Warren (1919–2006) American architect/designer who created the Platner chair (1966) and other furniture pieces in the Platner Collection. Platner worked in the ofices of Eero Saarinen. pleated shades Factory-manufactured polyester fabric shades permanently heat set into 1- to 3-inch pleats. May be metallized on the reverse for energy eficiency. pleated valances A fabric top treatment that is given fullness through pleating. plenum The space between the suspended ceiling grid and the ceiling. This space often contains mechanical systems.

480

Glossary

Plexiglas A highly transparent, lightweight, thermoplastic acrylic resin made into sheets like glass. Unlike glass, it is not easily broken.

portable decorative luminaires A variety of freestanding loor lamps and lamps that rest on tables or desks to be placed where and when lighting is needed.

plies Thin layers of wood laminated together to make plywood.

portable space heaters Small units that produce heat for a small area or a room. Types include electric and propane heaters; they vary in size, output, electricity consumption, and safety.

plotter A computer mechanical drawing printer that can produce drafting, two- and three-dimensional illustrations, and perspectives.

portal The porch on a Southwest Adobe house.

plumbing The systems that carry water, sewage, or central vacuums.

porthole window A round window, named for its resemblance to a ship’s porthole.

plumbing chase A thick wall containing plumbing.

portico A classical porch formed by a roof with supporting columns.

plush carpet A tufted carpet with a dense, short, even pile in solid colors. Originally intended to imitate the pile of an Oriental rug. plywood A product made of thin sheets of wood glued together in layers. pneumatic system construction Air-inlated or air-supported structures. pocket door A door that slides into a pocket recessed in the wall. podium The base on which Roman buildings are built. point or pinpoint lighting Spotlighting a tiny area for emphasis or a glitter effect. polyester A synthetic long-chain polymer iber of polymer ester. A durable, dimensionally stable iber that is highly versatile. Most sheer and semisheer fabrics are of polyester. Used for residential carpeting and scatter rugs and for wall covering fabrics that are often used in contract interiors. polypropylene A modiied olein iber used for artiicial turf, tufted indoor-outdoor carpeting, and nonwoven (needlepunched) carpets and tiles. Also used for a primary and secondary backing for some carpeting. A registered trademark of Thiokol for olein. polyurethane A synthetic resin used to make foam for cushions and as a base for varnish.

positive space Space illed in with a two- or three-dimensional form or shape. Postmodern design A reaction to the formalism of the International style. It often incorporates simpliied reference to historical architectural elements such as rotundas, turrets, and pediments. In some cases the style is eccentric and witty. postoccupancy evaluation (POE) The formal process of looking at a design once it is in use to see how well it is functioning. potpourri French term for the mixture of dried lower petals used to perfume a room. power-line carrier (PLC) system A structured wiring system that enables AC power wires to carry coded communications signals, forming an interface between household appliances and a computer. PLC systems can be retroitted in existing homes. Prang theory Another name for the Standard Color-Wheel theory. prei nishes Processes that prepare a fabric for coloring, decorative, or functional inishes. Preinishes include scouring, preshrinking, bleaching, mercerizing, and sizing. prepasted wall coverings Wall coverings with a dry paste or adhesive preapplied to the back, which is moistened, then pasted to the wall or ceiling.

Pompeii and Herculaneum (destroyed A.D. 79, excavation began 1754) Sister cities on the Bay of Naples (southern Italy) that contained prosperous classical Roman architecture, preserved by the ashes and lava mud low of Mount Vesuvius. Archaeological excavations resulted in the introduction of the Neoclassic or Classic Revival style in Europe and America.

pressed glass Decorative glass formed in molds.

pool of light A circle of light thrown by a downlighter or spotlight.

pretil A row of brick trim used to cap the adobe walls of the Territorial-style Southwest Adobe houses.

porcelain The highest grade of ceramic. Made of i ne white clay.

pretrimmed wall coverings Wall coverings with selvages trimmed off at the factory.

porphyry A granitelike texture achieved by crisscross brushing, then stippling, spattering, and i nally cissing paint. Also a type of stone.

primary focal point The main point of emphasis in an environment. The object, area, or grouping that irst catches the eye.

portable computer A keyboard, monitor, and drive unit that folds into the size of a briefcase, also called Notebook.

primary hues Red, yellow, and blue, as based on the Standard Color-Wheel theory.

preservation Maintaining a building in its present state or the state to which it has been restored. preshrinking A preinish process of subjecting a fabric to wet or dry heat to cause it to shrink and stabilize before further inishing or coloring.

Glossary

primers Liquid preparations that seal the surface and prepare it for paint application. principles of design Scale, proportion, balance, rhythm, emphasis, and harmony (unity and variety). printing Applying color to a inished cloth by hand (batik, tie-dye, stencil) or mechanical processes (automated silk screen, roller, transfer). printmaking A method of mass-producing two-dimensional art pieces by various means. See also block prints, engravings, etchings, lithographs, and serigraphs. priscilla curtains Sheer, semisheer, or muslin curtains with rufles on all edges, on the ties, and as a valance; they meet at the center or crisscross; a colonial and Victorian style.

481

pueblo Communal dwelling of the Pueblo Indians. punch list A checklist of items to be completed before inal building inspection and occupation.

Q quarry tile Rust-colored tiles that are ired at lower temperatures than ceramic tiles and valued for their natural terracotta coloration. Typically square or hexagonal shapes. quarter slicing A method used to cut logs wherein the blade meets the grain at right angles to the growth rings, resulting in a straight, striped grain.

privacy draperies A white, an off-white, or perhaps a colored fabric installed on a traverse rod next to the window to be drawn closed at night for privacy.

Queen Anne (1665–1714) Queen of England (1702–14) whose name is given to the period design style during her reign, and also to an elaborate style of Victorian architecture popular in the late nineteenth century.

private zones Areas within a home that dictate privacy—the bedroom and the bathroom, for example.

quicksilver An alloy of mercury and tin used for mirror backing.

problem statement A short declaration that identiies a design project according to purpose, location, and those for whom the design is being created.

quire Alternate British spelling for choir. See choir.

product design The design of furniture, accessories, or other components that are marketed in the design ield.

R

proi le An outline of user characteristics, habits, background, and design preferences that helps determine the direction a design should take. program Everything that happens or must be accomplished in an interior. It also is the written document that describes what will take place in an interior. programming The research phase of the design. progression A type of rhythm wherein shapes repeat in diminishing or escalating sizes or where colors graduate from light to dark. Also called rhythm by gradation. project management Overseeing calendars, critical paths, and deadlines so that a design is completed in a timely manner. project managing tools Documents and administrative systems used to accomplish a design project, particularly the critical path and punch list. projecting i replace A ireplace that projects beyond the wall plane to which it is mounted. proportion The relationship of parts to a whole in terms of size, detail, or ornamentation. Good proportion is pleasing and functional. protected aniline leather See semianiline leather. protein ibers Natural ibers or fabrics whose source is animal based: wool, silk, and includes the textile leather. provincial Rustic; local; from the provinces or countryside. proxemics The way people use space and the way that use is related to culture. PS lamp A pear-shaped incandescent lamp, often with a long neck.

quoin Projecting or contrasting brick or stone laid at the corner angle of a building.

R, ER lamps Lamps with a built-in, relective surface. R-20, R-30, R-40 Indicate the degree of beam spread in relector lamps. Rabat rugs Moroccan rugs in a deep, hand-knotted pile with simpliied Oriental designs. radial balance A type of balance seen as radiation from a central point. radiant heat Electrical conduit or water (steam) heat plumbing in ceilings, loors, or walls that radiates heat. radiation A type of rhythm (a principle of design) illustrated by elements radiating out in nearly every direction from a central point, such as spokes of a wheel or concentric circles. radiators Wall or baseboard units that contain steam heat or another heated luid medium, permanent or portable. radio frequency (RF) transmission A wireless system that uses radio frequency waves to operate electronic devices or enable one electronic device to communicate with another. rag rug A plain weave rug woven with strips of fabric, historically rags or recycled clothing. ragging and rag rolling Wet paint or glaze is partially removed by dabbing with a rag or rolling the paint off with a rolled rag or plain newsprint paper. rail The horizontal section of a frame for a panel or door. rain gutter The metal gutter and downspouts that channel rain and snow runoff from the eaves down the side of the building to the ground.

482

Glossary

rainbow roof A curved, gabled roof, attributed to ships’ carpenters, used on some Cape Cod houses.

repetition A type of rhythm wherein shapes, forms, lines, or colors are repeated in a congruous manner.

raised hearth A hearth built on a platform or cantilevered in front of a raised ireplace.

reproductions (art) Printed copies of an artist’s work.

rambler or ranch A one-story detached home with or without a basement. The social, work, and private zones are located on the main loor.

reproductions (furniture) Newly constructed copies of antique originals. research Examining all factors that inluence a design.

random carpet texture See level-tip carpet.

resilient The ability of a fabric or looring to return to its original shape.

rapid-start fluorescent lamps Eliminate lickering as the gases quickly activate the phosphorus in the light. May also be controlled with a dimmer switch.

resist or reserve printing Coating the fabric with a chemical paste that resists the dye, then dyeing the fabric. The area not printed receives the color.

rattan A climbing palm with slender, tough stems used to make wicker.

restoration A research, demolition, and reconstruction process to bring a building back to a speciic state of its history.

rayon A regenerated cellulosic man-made iber that imitates the luster of silk at a lower cost. Primarily used for drapery and upholstery.

retainer fee A deposit given to the designer upon the client’s signature on the letter of agreement that retains or hires the services of the designer.

rebar Bendable steel bars set into concrete for reinforcement and to deter cracking.

Retro Modern A nostalgic contemporary interplay of International, Organic, and/or Scandinavian Modern styles blended with midcentury American culture.

rebonded foam See bonded (rebonded) foam. recessed adjustable lighting Architectural luminaires that are ixed into the ceiling. The lamps can be adjusted to the desired angle.

retroitting Adding an electrical, telecommunications, home automation, solar, or other system to an existing building.

recessed downlight A canister that its into the ceiling and casts pools of light downward.

reversible cushions Loose cushions that can be turned to avoid excessive soiling and wear.

recessed luminaires Luminaires that it into ceilings where the light is noticeable but the ixture is not.

rhythm A principle of design seen in an interior as a visual lowing pattern or regular recurrence. The path the eye follows. Types of rhythm include repetition, alternation, progression or gradation, transition, opposition or contrast, and radiation.

reeding Rows of parallel convex beads or moldings used to embellish a column or leg. If the piece is grooved with concave moldings, it is luted.

reverberation Echoing of sound waves.

rei nement or rei ning The process of placing overlays of tracing paper to improve a space plan design.

rib A projecting band on a ceiling or vault.

reflecting glare Excessive light relecting from a shiny object, for example, sunlight relecting off a glass tabletop.

Robsjohn-Gibbings, T. H. (1905–76) Designer of a group of Greek furniture reproductions, including the Klismos chair.

refraction The bending of a ray of heat, light, or sound. Regency The period or style of English architecture that paralleled American Greek Revival. See American Empire. registers (heat registers) The metal grill that covers the duct opening of the HVAC system. reinforced concrete Concrete (a mixture of cement and a mineral aggregate) that is strengthened by setting steel bars or wire mesh into the mixture while it is wet. relief printing Printing from a pattern that stands out in relief, as is done with a block print. Renaissance The great rebirth of classical art and learning during the fourteenth, ifteenth, and sixteenth centuries. rendering An artist’s conception or perspective of a i nished building exterior or interior, usually done in full color. renewable resources Materials that can be reproduced in a sustainable and timely manner, such as natural-iber textiles, wood, leather, and organic pigments.

riser The vertical member of a stair between two treads.

Rococo See Louis XV period. roller painting Paint application with a roller—a sleeve of soft ibrous pile fabric that can hold and release the paint evenly. Faster than brush painting. It tends to spatter but is very useful for large areas such as walls and ceilings. roller printing A fabric printing method whereby dye is applied to raised igures on a cylinder, then stamped or transferred to fabric as it rolls over the cylinder. roller shade Flat fabric or plastic material on a roller rod, which is operated with a spring or pulley mechanism. rollikan rug A lat tapestry folk rug from Scandinavia that often incorporates simpliied loral patterns and stripes. Roman shade A fabric shade that folds up from the bottom accordion style. May be interlined for energy eficiency. Romanesque (A.D. 800–1150) The Medieval architectural period based on Roman design.

Glossary

roof monitors Clerestory windows, skylights, and cupola windows that catch heat from the sun and allow ventilation for excess summer heat. roof trusses A joist and rafter system that forms the triangular construction of a roof. rotary screen printing A mechanized silk-screen process where the screens are wrapped around a circular drum that rotates the ink onto the fabric moving beneath the rotary screens. It is a fast and eficient process. rotary slicing A method of shaving a continuous layer of wood from a log that has been mounted on a lathe, producing a broad, open grain.

483

safety lighting Lighting required by code or building ordinances to protect the health and safety of the public. Examples include exit signs, aisle lighting, and lighting for stairs and landings. sagging Irregular elongation or stretching of a drapery fabric due to increased humidity or moisture in the air. saltbox roof A gabled roof with one slope longer and lower than the other. sandstone A granular stone that may be used as loor or wall materials, laid at random or in a rectangular, ashlar pattern. saran A synthetic long-chain polymer of vinylidene chloride. Saran is ire retardant and used alone or in fabric blends.

rotogravure or roto A printed pattern overlaid with layers of vinyl for sheet looring.

sash curtains Sheer or semisheer fabric shirred (gathered) onto a rod at the top and bottom of the window frame.

rotunda A round, domed room. rough electrical The wiring installed when the building is framed.

sash window A double window (one panel above, one below) that is opened by raising or lowering one of the panels that slides up and down in its frame.

rough heating The installation of furnace and ductwork systems when the building is framed.

sateen, satine, or horizontal satin A type of satin fabric used for linings and printed decorator fabrics.

rough plumbing The installation of pipes to carry water and sewage and central vacuum.

satin paint A paint that dries to a inish slightly less shiny than semigloss but more lustrous than lat. Also called eggshell, low sheen, or low luster.

round-wire tufting/weaving Carpet construction technique that yields even, round loops. roundheaded arch An arch formed in a perfect half circle, not lattened. A Roman or keystone arch. row house Another term for town house. rubber A natural or synthetic composition that yields a resilient, solid or marble-patterned looring. rubber-backed tufted carpet Carpeting tufted into a foam rubber backing that serves as a pad or underlay. Direct glue-down installation. rubbings Designs made by placing a sheet of paper over any object with a lat, raised pattern and rubbing it with a special crayon. rubble Stone or rocks set or installed to produce an uneven, random surface. rush A grasslike marsh plant used to weave chair seats and loor mats. Rustic European Interior design style that spread throughout the Americas and comes from three areas with common backgrounds and similar furnishings: country, or provincial, France; Tuscany, Italy; and Colonial Spain. rusticated Rough-surfaced masonry or stone. rya rugs Deep pile shaglike rugs hand-knotted with abstract, contemporary patterns from Scandinavia.

S Saarinen, Eero (1910–61) Architect/designer, creator of the pedestal furniture group.

satin weave A smooth, often lustrous fabric weave in which warp threads loat over ive to eight weft or illing threads, then are tied down under one. There are no ridges or wales. Savonnerie rug A hand-knotted pile rug from France, originally woven at the Savonnerie Tapestry Works and patronized by King Louis XIV. Historic and contemporary patterns. scale A principle of design that evaluates the relative size and visual weight of objects. Classiications of scale include small or light, medium, large or heavy, and grand (extra large). Scandinavian Modern A blend of International and Organic styles as interpreted by Scandinavian and American architects and designers. scatter rugs Small rugs (sometimes called throw or accent rugs), often with a tufted cut pile, used in residential areas where water is likely to spill or where dirt is tracked in. Usually of polyester or nylon. schedule The chart that indicates the inish material used on loors, walls, and ceilings and lists types of doors and windows. scheduling Arranging for subcontractors and craftspeople who build or inish portions of a building and its interior to complete their work within a time frame. schematics Quick drawings used to generate or show ideas. schools Groups of artists with like philosophies whose work has similar characteristics. sconce A wall-mounted luminaire. screens A general term for a sliding or free-standing frame illed with wood, paper, fabric, or other materials, which may be placed in front of a window or used as a divider.

484

Glossary

scroll pediment A pediment with a lat bottom and two curved volutes at the top, often with a inial between the volutes. scrubbable Wall coverings that can be repeatedly washed with detergent solutions.

Seventeenth-Century English Medieval style The design style of seventeenth-century America, inspired by the late Medieval designs of England. Architecture, interiors, and furniture were all strongly inluenced by English prototypes.

sculpture The art of fashioning igures and forms of wood, clay, plastics, metal, or stone.

shade A neutralized color achieved by mixing black with a hue.

sculptured carpet A carpet with more than one height to the pile, which gives a pattern to the whole.

shading Blending painted color values from light to dark across a wall or ceiling. Also a slatted polyester shade.

sculptured-loop carpet A multilevel-loop carpet, the same as embossed-loop carpet.

shading devices Interior or exterior window coverings that deter solar gain from penetrating the interior.

sealed environment A building with nonoperable or ixed windows; HVAC provides warm, cool, and clean air.

shag A carpet texture in which the loops are cut to a relatively long length, usually long enough that the yarns lop over. Also called deep pile carpet.

sealers A liquid used to prepare a surface for painting. seasonal affective disorder (SAD) A condition with symptoms of fatigue and depression affecting some people who are deprived of natural light during the long winter season. secondary focal point The point (or points) of emphasis in an environment that is (are) subordinate to the primary focal point because of size, location, color, or other design factors. secondary hues Green, orange, and violet, as based on the Standard Color-Wheel theory. secretary A desk with drawers below and bookcase above. security system A wiring system that detects unlawful entry. segmental pediment A pediment with a lat bottom and a curved radius at the top. semianiline leather Leather colored with a transparent dye and treated with additional substances to increase color saturation and resistance to stains. Also called protected aniline leather. semidetached houses A term for housing in which portions of walls and roofs are common to two or more units. semidurable A fabric inish that will withstand dry, but not wet cleaning. semiflush ceiling luminaries Lighting ixtures that are mounted onto the ceiling at the base and have a short extension to the diffuser and lamp allowing light to be cast onto the ceiling for a wider spread of ambient light. semigloss paint A paint that dries to a luster between lat and shiny; it contrasts nicely with both and hides i ngerprints. semihoused stair A stair attached to the wall on one side. semitrimmed wall covering Wall coverings with only one selvage trimmed off. The selvage edge is overlapped with the next strip or trimmed off at the site. sericulture Cultivated silk production.

shade (window) See roller shade.

shake shingles Wooden roof shingles, somewhat irregular in width, that weather to a gray color. Shakers A late eighteenth-century, early nineteenth-century religious sect whose beliefs included the design of furnishings devoid of excessive decoration. shape An element of design that is the contour or outline of an external surface of a form. shaped valance A lat fabric top treatment with a shaped or curved bottom hem. Interlined with stiffening fabric and/ or batting and sometimes quilted. shed ceiling A ceiling with a single slope. sheer draperies and curtains Transparent or translucent fabric hung next to the glass. Called draperies if pleated and hung on a traverse rod, curtains if shirred or gathered onto a curtain rod. sheet vinyl Rolls of vinyl in widths up to 12 feet, glued down directly to a prepared surface. May have a cushioned backing, and the thickness of the vinyl surface may vary with the quality. Sheetrock Also known as drywall, gypsum board, or plasterboard; a rigid wall material made of pulverized gypsum rock. See wallboard. shellac A inish ilm for wood made by dissolving a secretion of the lac bug in denatured alcohol. Sheraton, Thomas (1751–1806) An important English furniture craftsman best known for the designs published in his book The Cabinet-Maker and Upholsterer’s Drawing Book. Shibusa A Japanese approach to color harmony based on ratios and proportions found in nature. The goal of a Shibui color scheme is to create a mood of tranquility. shingles Wood, asbestos, or tile components commonly used as a inish material on angled (gable or hipped) roofs.

serigraph An art print made by passing ink through a ine screen that has been covered with a cut stencil to form the pattern. Also called silk screen. The process is called serigraphy (see silk-screen printing).

shirred curtains Fabric gathered onto a rod with or without a rufle at the top.

serpentine Literally, like a snake; a line that curves in and out as on a chest front or camel-back sofa.

shoji screens Wooden frames and divider grids illed with translucent mulberry or rice paper. Used in traditional

shirred valance A fabric top treatment gathered onto a curtain rod.

Glossary

Japanese homes and contemporary Western residential and contract interiors as well. showrooms Wholesale businesses usually located in marketing centers where the designer may see lines of merchandise, place orders, or buy furnishings. sick building syndrome A term for unacceptably poor air quality in a building, often attributed to dirty HVAC ductwork, low air-volume exchange, and/or a pollution source near the building’s air intake vents. side chair An armless chair without full upholstery. side draperies Stationary panels hung on each side of a window. sideboard A dining room serving piece with space for storing tableware. The French term buffet and the Italian terms credenza or credence are also used to describe this type of piece. sidelights Vertical, narrow windows used on each side of a door. silhouette lighting Accomplished by shining a light directly on an object to produce a shadow echoing the shape of the object. silk A natural protein iber obtained from the ilament of the silk moth cocoon. Silk is lustrous, is smooth to slubby, and has a dry hand. It has long been woven into fabrics of luxury and prestige. silk screen See serigraph. silk-screen printing A traditional method of stencil printing, done by squeegeeing ink through stencils on sheer silk stretched on wooden screens. Originally it was a hand technique. Now latbed printing automates the moving of fabric under the screens and the raising and lowering of the screens, and rotary screen printing further speeds the process by rotating the pattern onto the fabric with no hand labor. Silk-screening accounts for a large portion of printed textile designs today.

485

sinuous wire spring An essentially lat spring bent in a zigzag fashion used in upholstered furniture, typically in the back rest. sisal and maize mats Natural cellulosic iber mats that are coarse and rough to the touch. site plans Drawings showing a building’s situation on the land, including legal boundaries, key reference points, and hookups for water, sewer, and electricity. sizing A thin liquid painted on a surface before hanging wall coverings. It seals against alkali, lessens the paste quantity needed, and provides some grip for the wallpaper. sketch A rough, quick illustration of a proposed space or a detail of the space. skylight An opening for light set into the roof and ceiling. slate A inely grained metamorphic rock used for rooing and looring. Colors vary from grays to greenish or reddish grays to browns and blacks. slate roof A roof covered with thin sheets of stone, used like shingles. sliding windows Windows that slide horizontally. slipcovers Fitted covers that can be placed over the original upholstery and secured with snaps or other fasteners. Smart House Registered trademark of the National Home Builders’ Association for home automation. smoke detector A ire-alarm device that sounds when triggered by excessive smoke in the air. smooshing A paint application technique in which a plastic sheet is placed on wet paint and then peeled off, leaving a slightly marbled texture. social zones Areas for formal or informal social interaction. sofit The trim applied to the eave, or the boxed projection above cabinets or over a sink. sofit lighting Architectural lighting built into a sofit.

silver plate Flatware made from an alloy of silver and nickel, electroplated with pure silver.

soft window treatments Fabric treatments: curtains, draperies, shades, and top treatments.

silvering The process of coating glass with quicksilver to make a mirror. Also, any process of applying silver or silverlike substances.

software Computer program that accomplishes speciic tasks.

simultaneous contrast The juxtaposition or near placement of opposing, often intense colors that contrast with each other, possibly causing a vibrating afterimage where they border. single family residence (SFR) A detached dwelling, or house, designed for occupancy by one family. single glazing Filling a window opening with one layer of glass. single roll One bolt of wall covering containing approximately 36 square feet. single-hung sash Sash windows in which only the bottom section is operable. single-wide mobile home A mobile home that is approximately 12 to 15 feet wide and 20 to 40 feet long.

softwood Light, easily cut wood taken from cone-bearing trees such as pine and redwood. soil-release i nish Allows a fabric to more readily absorb water and free soil to be lifted out with mild detergent. soil-repellent or soil-resistant i nishes These are sprayed onto the surface of a fabric, forming a temporary barrier that prevents soil from penetrating the fabric. If the soil or stain is not removed quickly, it can be forced into the fabric through tiny cracks in the inish. The soil may then be locked under the inish, making it very dificult to remove. solar energy Energy from sunlight, which can be harnessed for heat and electricity. solar greenhouses A greenhouse living space that is also a passive solar collector; a solarium.

486

Glossary

solar heat gain Heat from sunshine collected through glass walls or windows. May be absorbed, stored, and released through many of the hard background materials such as stone, tile, brick, and concrete. sole proprietorship An interior design business owned by one person. solid Wooden furniture construction with solid pieces of wood in all the external or visible parts of the piece. solid-core door A veneered door with a core of solid wood pieces. Also called lumber-core door. soluble i nish See nondurable inish. solution or dope dyeing The addition of dyes or coloring matter to the viscose solution in man-made ibers before they are extruded. The dyes then become colorfast and will not fade. The process is more costly than other methods of dyeing and must be done well in advance of the inished product, making solution-dyed color somewhat risky in today’s market of rapidly changing color trends. solvent A liquid for thinning and cleaning up oil-based paints. sound board An insulative material in rigid form that prevents audible sounds from being heard; usually used beneath drywall. Southwest Adobe style An architectural style prevalent in Spanish-settled areas of North America, which survives today particularly in New Mexico. It features adobe brick construction with heavy wood beams. space An element of design consisting of a continuous expanse of distance without forms, which is divided with walls, partitions, and furnishings. Filled space is termed positive space, and empty space is called negative space. space heating Heating the area or space where people live and work by passive or active solar means or by mechanical devices such as furnaces or space heaters. space planning The allotment of spaces to create a workable loor plan. The organization and division of spaces into rooms or areas to meet speciic needs.

other pertinent ordering information, and the location where the goods will be installed. Also, in contract architecture, the criteria of minimum durability, cost, and safety requirements of inish materials written or speciied by an architect. speciier A type of designer whose role is limited to selecting or specifying which products or speciications will be used. spectral colors The wave bands of solar energy that correspond to visible frequencies. From longest to shortest wave length, spectral colors are red, orange, yellow, green, blue, and violet, as seen in a rainbow. spectral energy distribution The inherent color characteristics of an object or material due to the type and amount of dyes or pigments. This can cause the object or material to appear as different colors under different kinds of light; also describes the color of the light source. See metamerism. spectral light The visible frequencies of energy that humans perceive as light and colors, as in a rainbow. spinnerette The shower head–like device through which manmade iber viscose solutions are forced to create monoilament. The size and shape of the holes in the spinnerette can be changed to give various characteristics to the ibers. spiral staircase A corkscrew-shaped staircase. splat The vertical wood panel in the center of a chair back. split complement Consists of a hue and the two colors on each side of its direct complement. split-entry or raised ranch home A two-level home in which the entry is located in the center, and the person entering walks upstairs to the kitchen/living/dining areas and the bedroom/bath areas, and downstairs to the family room, extra bedrooms, and storage areas. Has a raised basement. split-level home A three- or four-level home with half lights leading from one area to the next. sponge rubber pad Carpet underlay. The most common example of sponge rubber is wafle padding.

space-saving device Any means of maximizing the existing space, thereby making a space seem larger.

sponging Applying paint with sponges for texture and color overlay.

Spanish Colonial A rustic European style that became especially inluential in regional design in North America as the South and West were colonized. Hard-surfaced loors, stucco walls, beamed ceilings, Spanish arches supported with thick wood or stucco columns, arched or rectangular ireboxes with hooded chimney pieces characterize this style.

spotlight A luminaire that focuses light in one direction, casting a pool of light.

Spanish rugs Hand-knotted pile rugs with a coarse, sparse weave. Classiied with folk rugs. spattering A method of adding texture to painted surfaces by lipping extra paint onto a surface with a illed brush. special rodding Drapery rods that can be bent and suited to custom or special installations. speciications The written list of materials and furnishings, itemized according to company, stock number, color, and

spray painting Paint application through a spray nozzle. Fast and economical for large applications. Should be followed with a roller to smooth out the paint. square feet or footage The width multiplied by the length of a room or building. The two-dimensional loor space. squeegee An implement with a strong, straight crosspiece edged with rubber used to spread a thin layer of ink across and through a silk screen. stain Color mixed with water, oils, or other agents and applied to wood as part of the inishing process. stained glass Colored and clear glass set into patterns and hung in front of windows or used as the window glazing itself sandwiched between plain glass.

Glossary

487

stainless steel An alloy of steel and chromium.

stove A free-standing wood- or coal-burning heating unit.

stains Liquids that penetrate wood with color.

straight lines Lines that directly connect two points; horizontal and vertical lines.

stairwell The open space illed by a stair. Standard Color-Wheel theory Based on three primary colors—red, yellow, and blue—and the variations derived by mixing these, plus black and white. Colors are arranged in a circle, with secondary and tertiary or intermediate colors placed between the primary colors. standard i nishes Applied to fabrics to enhance durability. Also known as wet, chemical, or functional inishes. staple Short ibers that vary from approximately ½ to 2 inches. Staple yarns offer greater bulk, insulation, and area coverage. stapled wall fabric Fabric attached to a wall by staples. starting step The irst step of the stair. state of the art The current or latest technology; the newest developments. steel A hard alloy of iron and carbon. stemware Designation given to ine drinking glasses with raised bowls, stems, and bases. sterling II Flatware with sterling silver handles and stainless steel blades, tines, and bowls.

straight run A stair that makes no turns. strapping-tape method A temporary method of attaching fabric to a wall. Rolls or circles of strapping tape are afixed to the wall and to the fabric. strength or tenacity The inherent ability of a iber or material to withstand stress without breaking. stretchers Crosspieces used to brace and strengthen table and chair legs. stringcourse See beltcourse. stringer The supporting member in a staircase. strip lighting A lighting ixture in which several lamps or bulbs are aligned in a strip. Used in grooming areas around mirrors. strippable A wall covering that can be stripped or completely removed from a wall. Applies to most vinyl wall coverings. structural design A basic or general category of design wherein the design is intrinsic to the structure—one cannot be separated without destroying the other.

Stickley, Gustav (1848–1942) Furniture designer and exponent of the Craftsman, or Mission, style. Published the magazine The Craftsman.

structural systems The components of new or remodeling construction that make up the structure: footings and foundation, as well as the framework (or other systems) that supports the building and to which the inish materials are applied.

stickwork Flat battens used on Victorian buildings to create patterns in imitation of Medieval timber framing.

structured wiring Specialized wiring for home automation and multimedia appliances.

stile The upright section of a frame for a panel or door.

stucco Rough-textured plaster or cement for covering walls.

stippling A paint application technique similar to sponging that uses a stippling brush to dab on a colored glaze or paint, revealing some of the base color.

stylobate The base upon which the Greek temple rests. Contains steps on all sides.

sterling silver Finest type of silverware; 92.5 percent pure.

stock dyeing The coloring of natural ibers (particularly wool) in the raw-goods state (stock) before they are spun into yarns. stock plans Floor plans that are mass produced and purchased, usually by mail order, by anyone wishing to build that home.

subcontract An agreement for specialized work performed by a subcontractor, a person or irm hired to install or build a particular feature of a building’s construction or i nish work.

stone Any hard rock used for looring or wall materials.

subcontractor A person who performs a single task in construction such as foundation work, framing, electrical, plumbing, HVAC, inish work (millwork or woodwork), or tile or loor laying.

stone-ender A seventeenth-century house with stone-covered chimney ends, common to Rhode Island.

subfloors The material (usually wood) nailed to the framework on which the inish loor materials are laid.

stoneware A heavy, durable, thick pottery used for lessformal dinnerware.

subtractive color mixing The phenomenon in which the frequencies of colors placed very near one another are blended. Subtractive color mixing is what enables us to perceive an almost ininite range of colors beyond the spectral colors.

storage Space planned for keeping foodstuffs, linens, tools, clothing, and other items owned by people. It also refers to needs of a contract interior to keep extra stock merchandise, ofice supplies, or other goods. Also, the reservoir for storing thermal energy in a solar system. storm windows Glass or plastic removable windows that add insulation. Summer storm windows are tinted as a shading device.

subtractive color theory The phenomenon in which the frequencies of light striking an object are absorbed, or “subtracted,” except for the frequencies corresponding to the colors with which the object is pigmented. The frequencies not absorbed are relected, and we perceive them as colors. suede Leather that has been buffed to a soft, velvety nap.

488

Glossary

Sullivan, Louis (1856–1924) Called the father of American architecture, he felt that the form of a building should follow its function. sundial A timepiece that shows the time by a shadow cast by a pointer.

the user. As needs change, new components can be added and unneeded elements can be eliminated.

T

superinsulation Extra-heavy insulation of walls, foundations, ceilings, and attic areas to conserve energy; requires thicker than conventional walls.

T lamp Tubular shaped lamp or bulb.

surface treatment i nishes See mechanical inishes.

table lamps Nonadjustable portable luminaires that cast light upwards and downwards for ambient lighting and task lighting, often placed on end or sofa tables and nightstands.

surface-mounted and suspended decorative luminaires Flush and semilush mounted light ixtures, chandeliers, bar or island chandeliers, wall sconces, bathroom ixtures, pendants, and mini-pendants. surround The noncombustible material that separates the opening of a ireplace from the wall or mantel. surrounds (tub or shower) The tile, marble, or imitative plastic inish material used to protect the wall against water in showers and bathtub areas.

tab curtains Flat panel curtains with tabs or strips sewn into loops at the top, then threaded onto a dowel rod.

tackless strip The thin board with recessed-head tacks or staples protruding toward the wall. The strip is nailed down and the carpet is attached over the top to hold it in place for wall-to-wall installations over padding. tapestry A plain or Jacquard weave of heavy decorative textiles.

suspended ceiling A ceiling formed of metal grids and acoustic panels, hung from the superstructure of a building.

tar paper A heavy, black, waterproof paper applied to the roof before the shingles and sometimes on the outside of foundation walls.

suspended i xtures Structural (pendant) or decorative (chandelier) luminaires hung on a cord or chain from the ceiling.

task lighting Bright, concentrated light for accomplishing speciic tasks.

sustainability The ability of a design to be sustained over a long period of time without becoming obsolete; also the ability of a design to impact the environment as little as possible and consequently sustain it.

tatami mats Woven sea grass mats in various thicknesses. A traditional Japanese loor material, they will not hold up to heavy trafic.

swag holders Metal or resin hardware that supports swagged fabric. swags Also called festoons. Semicircles of fabric folded at the top to form a soft or precise curved fabric top treatment. Often inished with a cascade on each side of the swag or arrangement of swags. swamp cooler See evaporative cooling system. swinging door (one way) The typical side-hinged door. switched outlet An electrical outlet controlled by the lip of a switch. symbolism The use of historic color where each color held signiicance or symbolized a value. symmetrical balance Also called bisymmetrical, formal, or passive balance, it is mirror-image arrangement of parts or elements. synthesis Bringing together the research data in the programming process. synthetic ibers The group of ibers that do not begin as cellulose but as chemicals or other natural elements chemically altered or composed into a viscose solution and extruded through a spinnerette. This group includes nylon, acrylic, modacrylic, polyester, olei n, saran, spandex, vinyon, latex, iberglass, and metallic ibers. Also known as noncellulosic man-made ibers. systems furniture Component pieces that can be chosen and assembled to create work spaces according to the needs of

tea caddy Metal container used to import tea during the eighteenth century, often decorated with oriental motifs and designs. tea table A small table, tall enough to accommodate serving tea from a seated position. technical drawings Floor plans, elevations, and detailed drawings of architectural detail, cabinetry, storage, and built-in units. technology tools Computer software and documents used to accomplish a design project, including such applications as CAD, scheduling and critical path systems, budget and purchasing systems. telephone system A network of connected telephones within a building or ofice. tempera Paint made with pigment mixed with egg and thinned with water. tempered glass Glass toughened by heating and rapid cooling. tenant improvement The designer works with the client who will occupy a contract space. The design work within an established budget is paid for by the developer. tender A state of weakness in a fabric wherein it can easily tear. tensile system construction A tentlike building system. tenure-track position A full-time college or university appointment that offers tenure, or the status of holding one’s position on a permanent basis.

Glossary

terrace houses Matching row houses that became popular in England during the eighteenth century. terra-cotta An Italian term for cooked earth used to describe hard, durable reddish brown clay products, such as that used to make roof tiles. terrazzo Chips of marble set into concrete and polished. A hard nonresilient looring for residential and contract interiors. Territorial style The later, more classical version of the Southwest Adobe–style houses of New Mexico, showing the inluence of Greek Revival architecture. territoriality Personal attachment to a certain territory or space. terry cloth A pile fabric with uncut loops, used for towels. tertiary hues See intermediate hues.

489

Tibetan rugs Rugs woven in the Himalayan region for export. Characterized by very coarse yarns, abstract, indistinct patterns, and earthy colors. tieback draperies Panels of pleated or shirred fabric tied back at a soft curve and held with ties (strips of fabric), or cords, or metal holdbacks. tieback holders Concealed hardware to hold the ties or decorative metal rosettes that hold the draperies in the tieback position. tie-dye A hand process for coloring fabric wherein a fabric is folded into various shapes, then tied with string and immersed in a dye bath. Where the folds and tied portions are thick, the dye will not penetrate, creating interesting abstract patterns. tiered curtains Short curtains layered to overlap vertically.

tesserae Pieces of colored glass and stone used to make mosaics.

tight An interior that is sealed or that has few or no windows for natural ventilation; requires HVAC system or airexchange units for fresh air.

tetrad complement A variation of a direct complementary scheme consisting of four colors equidistant (equally spaced) on the color wheel.

tile A lat, geometrically shaped wall, loor, and countertop inish material of kiln-baked clay.

textile wall coverings Fabrics laminated to a paper backing and sold in rolls or bolts. texture The relative smoothness or roughness of a surface read by the eye (visual texture) or with the hand (tactile texture). Texture is produced in several ways: by material, color, line, relief, and inish. texturizing Adding crimp, kink, or waviness to a man-made monoilament thread or yarn to increase bulk and loftiness and to add textural interest. An uneven surface applied to drywall or Sheetrock by blowing on a thin plaster mixture, then sanding it semismooth.

timber frame A frame of heavy timbers used as the structure system for a building. tin A soft bluish-white metal used for decorative accessories or furniture trim. tint A neutralized color achieved by mixing white with a hue. toe-kick or riser lighting Lighting in the toe-kick area beneath a corner, or on the stair riser just beneath the tread. toe-mold lighting Lighting under the toe-kick area of stairs or cabinets.

texturizing paint Thick paint that can be applied to imitate stucco.

tokonoma A small alcove with a low, raised platform reserved for display of aesthetic and sacred objects in the traditional Japanese home.

thatched roof A roof covered with reeds or straw intended to shed water.

tone A neutralized color achieved by mixing one or more complementary or contrasting colors with the basic hue.

thematic interior design Contemporary or current design based on a theme.

tongue and groove Strips of wood milled to it together and interlock with a ilet and a groove.

thermal pane A type of double glazing in which two layers of glass are produced with a pocket of air for insulation.

top treatments Any fabric used as a short covering at the top or above a window or window treatment.

thermoplastics Plastics that change their form by heating.

top-grain leather The outer, most durable layer of the hide.

thermoset plastics Plastic compounds that are hardened by heat.

torchéres Portable loor lamps with diffusers that direct the light onto the ceiling to supplement ambient lighting. They may have dimmer controls.

thermosiphoning A passive solar system of collecting heat through spaces in the walls or roof, then drawing the heat into ducts and forcing it into the interior through fans and registers. thermostat A device that controls the furnace or airconditioning by maintaining a preset temperature.

town house Another term for a dwelling that is narrow, one or two room(s) wide, and two or three stories high. It shares walls with one or two similar town houses, and one roof spans all the units.

thin shell membrane construction A self-supporting membrane of reinforced (mesh) concrete or sprayed foam.

tracery A term used to describe the lacelike ornamentation in stone or woodwork of Gothic design, often seen in windows.

Thonet, Michael (1796–1871) A German craftsman best known for his bentwood furniture designs.

track lighting A track that holds and connects several adjustable spotlights.

490

Glossary

trade sources Wholesale companies that market goods and services to the trade or the interior design profession.

true divider Windows glazed with individual panes, rather than snap-in grids.

trademarks or trade names Names given by chemical companies to a generic iber that identiies it as their product. Trademarks are registered with the Federal Trade Commission and may be accompanied by a small ™ following the name.

trusses Triangular reinforcing in wood or metal that distributes the load effectively. A framework for supporting a roof.

trafic Movement of users through an area or along a route. trafic pattern The pattern created by tracing the movement of a user through an area or along a route. transepts The part of a cross-shaped church that extends at right angles to the nave. (The arms of the cross.) transgenerational design Design that functions for users in various stages of life (from different generations), implying that the design can be used continually without change over a long period. transition A type of rhythm that leads the eye without interruption from one point or area to another. transom A window over a door. transport Moving the sun’s heat through a liquid medium to the storage area in an active solar system unit. transportation design A facet of contract design: airlines, buses, trains, and automobiles. traverse rods Rods equipped with cords and pulleys to draw draperies opened and closed. travertine A light-colored limestone used for nonresilient loors and hard wall materials. tray ceiling A ceiling stepped up to become higher than the perimeter. tread The portion of the stair that is stepped on.

Tudor arch A lattened Gothic arch popular in the Tudor era. tuft bind A measurement indicating the strength of the latex layer that holds tufts of carpet yarns in place. tufted carpets The method by which most carpeting is produced for both residential and contract interiors. Multiple needles threaded with yarn are simultaneously punched into a loosely woven primary backing. The tufts are held in place with a layer of latex, then adhered to a secondary backing of jute or polypropylene. tufting A needle construction technique of inserting yarns into a woven or knitted fabric to create a pile. Examples include many cut-pile carpets and traditional patterned chenille bedspreads. Also, tying back fabric and padding in such a way as to create a patterned, pillowed surface in upholstery. Also the most common type of carpet construction. tufts or stitches per square inch A measurement indicating the density of the tufts or woven stitches in carpeting. tungsten i lament In incandescent lighting, the element that is heated, causing the light to glow. tungsten halogen lamp Lamp in which the ilament is surrounded with halogen gas that reacts with the tungsten, producing a bright light. turnings Decorative spindles formed by turning a piece of wood on a lathe and cutting designs into the wood with a sharp knife or chisel as the piece spins.

triforium A gallery above the arches of the arcade in the nave of a church.

Tuscan design A farmhouse design from the countryside of Tuscany (or Toscano), Italy, with mellow, charming, rustic elements that evolved over several centuries. Stone or tile loors, rough stucco walls, beamed ceilings and arched openings, simple farmhouse furniture with some wrought iron characterize this style.

triglyphs The three decorative vertical grooves on the frieze of the Doric entablature.

Tuscan order A simpliied version of the Roman Doric style without luting on the column.

triple glazing Three layers of window glass for insulation.

twill weave The interlacing of yarns in a sequence such as three over, one under, which creates a distinct diagonal rib or wale. A novelty twill may reverse, creating fabrics such as herringbone or houndstooth.

triadic complement Three colors equidistant (equally spaced) on the color wheel, such as red, yellow, and blue. triangular pediment A pediment in the shape of a triangle.

triple roll A roll or bolt of wall covering containing approximately 108 square feet or three times the area of a single roll. triplex A three-unit apartment building. tripod pedestal table A three-legged table; the legs converge to form a single pedestal. Trombe wall A passive solar system of glass (that collects and ampliies heat) placed in front of a dark masonry wall (that absorbs and slowly releases the heat into the interior).

twin glazing See double glazing. twin home A dwelling that adjoins via a common wall only one other dwelling. A semidetached house. two-way i replace A ireplace with two sides as a dividing wall between two rooms (180 degrees), or a corner unit with two openings in a 90-degree or L-shaped arrangement.

trompe l’oeil “Trick the eye.” Painted surfaces or wall covering in realistic three-dimensional scenes.

U

trophies Mounted ish, animals, animal heads, and skins.

unassembled furniture Lower-quality furniture that comes ready to assemble.

Glossary

491

undertones The addition of a small amount of one hue to another, rendering the latter slightly warm or cool.

vault A ceiling constructed on the principle of an arch. An arched roof.

unity A component of harmony that provides a change or relief from sameness in an interior through differences in the design and furnishing elements.

vaulted system construction A tunnel-like arch system of building.

universal design Design that meets the needs of all users, without drawing attention to those with disabilities. upgrade Of a quality surpassing that of the standard allotment in new construction. Upgrades may be speciied for paint or wall coverings, carpeting, or other materials. upholstered cornice A wooden top treatment that is padded, then covered with a decorative top treatment. upholstered walls Padded, then fabric-covered walls. uplighters or uplighting Canisters, spotlights, or loodlights that cast light upward to the wall or ceiling. urethane foam Synthetic foam used for carpet and upholstery padding. used furniture Previously owned and furniture that may be in excellent, fair, or poor condition. user Anyone who will use a completed design. user friendly Often refers to computer hardware and software that are relatively uncomplicated and easy to operate. U-stair A stair that makes a 180-degree turn at a single landing. utility plans Drawings showing a building’s mechanical systems, such as heating, ventilation, air-conditioning, plumbing, and electrical.

V vacuforming A process of forming plastic in a mold in which all the air is drawn out to form a vacuum that forces the plastic around the mold. valance lighting A light over the top of a window placed behind a board that directs light both upward and downward. value The relative lightness or darkness of a hue according to the amount of white or black inherent in or added to the hue. value contrast Hues or neutrals that differ in value. Highvalue contrast is seen when light and dark values are used together; low-value contrast refers to similar hues or neutral values. value distribution The placement of differing values in an interior to create a balanced and pleasing effect. vapor barrier A heavy-gauge plastic applied to walls or insulative window treatments to prevent moisture and air penetration. variety A component of harmony made possible through repetition or similarity of objects or elements in an interior. varnish A inish ilm for wood made by dissolving resinous substances in oil or alcohol.

Vedic architecture A system of architecture inspired by ancient Hindu texts. Vedic buildings typically have doors and windows oriented to the sun’s path, are centered around an open courtyard or solarium, and use Vedic proportions in both their overall structure and their details. Vedic proportions Proportions for design and building based on principles in the ancient Hindu texts known as the Veda (Sanskrit for “knowledge”). These proportions often use a ratio of 1:1, resulting in squares and cubes as basic design forms. vehicle In painting, the binding agent that holds the particles of pigment together and creates the ilm that adheres to the surface being painted. veiling glare A relected image of a light source, such as a lamp, that obscures all or part of a task area, such as a glossy book page or a television screen. velvet weave carpet A cut-pile woven carpet with no design. Colors are solid or utilize variegated yarns. veneer A thin ply of beautifully grained wood laminated to plywood or solid woods. Venetian glass Delicate and ine glassware made at or near Venice, Italy. A term used to describe glass mirrors with an antique or veined appearance. ventilation Natural fresh air through windows or through a central HVAC unit that circulates clean air through a building. veranda A long covered porch along the front and/or side of a building. vernacular Design executed by local craftspeople, relecting a regional, naive, or unschooled quality. vertical lines Up-and-down lines that lift the eye and give dignity and formality to interiors. vertical louvers Movable louvered blinds with vertical, rather than horizontal, slats. vestibule An air-lock entry consisting of two doors and a compartmentlike room that prevents excessive heat or cold from entering the building. Victorian Era (1837–1901) The English and American era that coincided with the reign of Queen Victoria. It paralleled the Industrial Revolution, during which time many styles were seen. Victorian design is characterized by revivals of nearly every previous historical style, together with rapid technological development. Vienna Secession A group of young Viennese artists and craftsmen, including Otto Wagner, Josef Hoffmann, and Joseph Maria Olbrich, who broke away from the mainstream of traditional art and design around 1897. The group eventually evolved into a more formal workshop—the Wiener Werkstätte headed by Josef Hoffmann.

492

Glossary

viga A large pole beam used to support the roof of Southwest Adobe houses.

wall coverings A general term for paper, cloth, vinyl, and other products designed to be pasted onto walls.

vintage furniture Furniture over 25 years old whose value is found in its charm or nostalgia.

wall sconces Accent lighting mounted onto the wall, also for supplemental lighting. Sconces may shine up and down or in one direction.

vinyl Polymerized vinyl (ethylene), essentially a plastic compound, extruded into sheets for loor and wall coverings. Also a coating for wall coverings and fabrics. vinyl composition A resilient hard looring of vinyl and other compounds. vinyl latex wall coverings Wall coverings that are vinyl through to the backing, which is usually a fabric. They are usually very durable, heavy, and scrubbable. vinyl tile Extruded vinyl sheets cut into square tiles. vinyl wall coverings Any wall covering with a vinyl surface, including vinyl-protected, vinyl latex, and coated fabric wall coverings. vinyl-protected wall coverings Wall coverings, usually paper, with a coating of vinyl, which makes the covering washable. vinyon A synthetic vinyl chloride long-chain polymer generally extruded in sheet form, and often imitating leather, suede, or nearly any surface texture. Often called vinyl or PVC (polyvinyl chloride).

wall washer A general term for a series of lights that wash a wall. These may be recessed adjustable lights or eyeball spotlights, for example. wallboard A term for rigid wall materials installed in sheets or boards: Sheetrock (gypsum board), Masonite, paneling. Also called drywall. warm colors The hues on the color wheel generally considered to produce feelings of warmth. They are red-violet, red, red-orange, orange, yellow-orange, yellow, and yellow-green. warm white deluxe fluorescent lamp Contains a warm light spectrum similar to incandescent lighting. warp threads or yarns The lengthwise or vertical fabric yarns that are threaded onto the loom and form the basis for woven fabric and rugs. wash A soft plane of light from spotlights or track lighting. washable A wallpaper term meaning that the paper can be gently cleaned with a little soap and water.

virtual reality Computer simulation of a three-dimensional physical environment and its visual, auditory, and other sensory aspects.

water closet A toilet.

visual acuity An enhanced ability to see, and especially to distinguish colors.

waterprooi ng Coating the building’s foundation with a sealant such as a tar mixture, tar paper, or plastic.

visual proportion The way a proportion might appear regardless of actual dimensions or proportions.

water-repellent i nish A functional, wet, or standard inish that allows the fabric to shed or repel moisture and stain due to condensation or excessive humidity.

visual weight The weight or scale an object appears to have, regardless of actual weight.

watercolor Paint made solid with gum arabic and thinned with water. Also a painting created with this type of paint.

vitrify To change into a glasslike ceramic by high heat.

watt or wattage A unit of electric power equal to the power of one ampere (amp) as compared to one volt.

Vitruvian proportions Correct classical proportions as recorded by Vitruvius.

wattle A panel of woven sticks used as inill for timber framing or as fencing materials.

Vitruvius A irst-century Roman architect and writer responsible for standardizing classical architectural forms.

weatherstripping Thin strips of insulation, usually with a sticky side, that insulate around windows and doors to prevent cold air iniltration.

volts or voltage The measurement of power that comes through the power line. volute A spiral or scroll on furniture or accessories.

W wainscot Medieval wooden paneling that may or may not reach to the ceiling. wale A pronounced rib or raised cord in fabric that may run vertically with the warp, horizontally with the illing threads or weft, or diagonally as in a twill weave. wall composition The arrangement of furniture, architectural openings, and accessories against a wall.

weft threads or yarns Inserted over and under the warp threads to create a woven fabric. Also called illing yarns. Wegner, Hans (1914–2007) Important Danish furniture craftsman, designer of several Modern classic pieces. welt A fabric-covered piping cord sewn between two pieces of the covering in upholstery. wet i nishes See standard inishes. wicker A general term for furniture, baskets, or other objects woven from twigs. Wiener Werkstätte See Vienna Secession. Wi-Fi technology Connectivity to the Internet and to other devices without wires.

Glossary

493

windbreak Trees, hedges, or fences that provide protection from wind.

wool Natural protein staple ibers taken from the leece of sheep and the hairs of goats. Wool—absorbent, resilient, and lame resistant—is used in high-quality upholstery, wall, and window textiles for both residential and contract use. Also used for carpeting, Oriental, and folk rugs.

window wells The corrugated metal or concrete form that keeps dirt away from basement windows.

wool rugs A term for natural iber rugs or carpeting left in its undyed state. The most common is the berber rug.

windowsill The horizontal ridge or shelf beneath the glass, usually with the frame.

word-processing programs Software programs that offer options in text writing.

Windsor chair Originally an English chair with cabriole legs and a shaped splat. The Windsor chair became common during the eighteenth century in America and featured a carved seat, spindle back, and turned legs.

work zones Areas for tasks such as food preparation and ofice work.

wing chair An upholstered easy chair with a high back and wings on each side for resting the head. wire construction See round-wire tufting/weaving.

Wren, Sir Christopher (1632–1723) One of England’s most important and inluential architects, responsible for building London’s city churches after the great ire of 1666.

wiring plan The portion of the blueprints or working drawings that indicate placement of all electric wiring, ixtures, switched outlets, and connections. Also called the lighting plan.

Wright, Frank Lloyd (1869–1959) A great American architect who believed that a building should relate to its setting. He designed the complete building, including interiors and furniture.

wish list An extensive list of features that users want in a building or remodel and why they want them.

wrinkle-resistant i nish Treating a fabric with a functional inish process so it does not easily wrinkle.

wood blinds Thin lat slats of wood made into miniblinds. They take more stacking space and are more costly than metal miniblinds.

wrought iron Iron that is welded and forged into different shapes.

Wilton Broadloom loop-pile carpeting woven on a Jacquard loom. All colors used in the carpeting are carried beneath the carpet face, creating a thick, heavy carpet.

wood iller A paste or liquid used in the wood-inishing process to ill the natural pores of the wood and create a smooth surface. wood frame or wood truss system The conventional system of framing a building with wood studs, joists, rafters, and beams, reinforced with the herringbone (zigzag) truss system between joists. wood graining Brushing on a glaze and drawing wood grains and lines with an artist’s brush. wood molding Narrow strips of concave and/or convex wood trim. May also be plastic. wood plank (floors) Flooring of strips of wood. Planks may be laid in even width strips or random plank (three different widths). wood planks (walls) Paneling that is installed in horizontal or vertical direction on walls and ceilings. wood rods Curtain and drapery rods of solid wood, often luted. wood- or coal-burning stove A self-contained stove, usually of cast iron, that burns wood or coal for space heating.

working drawings The inal mechanical drawings that are used to obtain bids and construct a design.

Y yarn dyeing Coloring yarn before it is woven or knitted into a fabric. yo-yo effect Uneven high and low areas along the bottom hemline of a draped fabric due to alternating humidity absorption and drying.

Z zapata Carved decorative corbel on the porch of the Southwest Adobe house. zero-clearance i replace unit A ireplace unit that can be set into combustible walls with no clearance. zigzag lines Lines that reverse upon themselves in a regular order, such as a herringbone pattern, or in an irregular order, such as a lame pattern. zones Areas that have similar functions or purposes, such as work zones, social zones, private zones, and storage zones.

This page intentionally left blank

Index A A 588 steel, 231 Aalto, Alvar, 443, 444t Abacus, 379 Abstract design, 71, 72f Acanthus leaves, 379, 380 Accent lighting, 106–07, 107f, 108, 109f, 111f, 118f Accessible design, 45 Accessories scale of, 217 use of, 371–73 Accessory apartments, 179 Accordion doors, 257, 258f Acetate, 334, 334t, 336t Achromatic (no-color) grays, 90, 92 Acoustical tile, 189, 203f, 204, 276t, 281t, 293, 307 Acoustic design, 26 Acoustics, 192 Acropolis, 378 Acrylic, 334t, 337t, 339f Acrylic carpet ibers, 318, 319t Acrylic paint, 358 Acrylics, 242 Acrylic sheets, 108 “Active” balance, 57–58 Active solar systems, 195–96, 197f Actual density, 64 Adam, Robert, 19, 269, 402, 404 Adaptive restoration, 449f, 450 Adaptive reuse, 22t, 26, 37 Adjustable luminaires, 114 Adjustable track lighting, 114t Adobe-style buildings, 420f Afterimages, 94, 98 Air-conditioning. See Heating, ventilation, and air-conditioning (HVAC) Air exchange, 187 Air-exchange units, 187 Air ilter, 42 Air pollution, in the interior environment, 39–40, 414 Air puriiers, 203 Aisles, 383 Albers, Josef, 87–88 Alloys, 364 All-wood construction, 229 Alternate complement colors, 86 Alternation, 58–59 Alternative building system methods, 170 Aluminum, 230 Ambient bank, 108 Ambient lighting, 105f, 106, 111f, 114, 118f Ambulatory, 383 America, European Inluence in, 391–423 Beaux Arts inluence, 422–23,423f, 424t Dutch inluence, 417, 418t English inluence, 391–416 Federal style, 402, 403t-04t German inluence in, 417, 418t Greek Revival/American empire style, 407– 11, 408f, 409t–10t

Jeffersonian federal, 402–05, 405f Louisiana French inluence, 417–19, 419t Shaker inluence, 416, 416t, 417f Spanish inluence, 419–22, 419f, 420t–21t, 420f, 422f, 423t Vernacular tradition, 405–07, 406t-07t Victorian age, 411–16, 411f, 412t–16t Swedish inluence, 417, 417f See also American styles American country style, 75–79 American Empire color, 408–11 console table, 410t fainting sofa/Grecian sofa, 410t furniture classics, 408 interior, 410t interiors and furniture, 410t textiles, 410t American Empire style, 75 American National Standards Institute, 19 Americans with Disabilities Act of 1990, 44–45 Ampere or amperage, 112t Amusement park design, 26t Anaglypta, 269–70, 270f Analogous color schemes, 84f, 85, 85f, 86 Andalusia, 409t Angled ceilings, 285t, 293 Angular (diagonal or zigzag) lines, 55t, 65, 66t Animal-hair felt padding, 321 Animal skins, 328–29, 371 Anne Hathaway Cottage, England, 385f Anodized, 230 Anthemion, 379 Anthropometrics, 208, 240 Antimony, 364–65 Antique oriental rugs, 323 Antiques, 236 Antiquity, color in, 381 Antistatic, 341 Apartment buildings, 177 Apartments, 177, 179, 181t Appliances, 144, 149t–50t energy usage, 148f, 149t planning considerations, 149t price point vs. energy costs, 149t upscale, 137f Applied design, 71, 71f Apron, 395 Apps, 23 Apse, 383 Aquariums, 26t, 371, 372f Arcade, 383, 384t Architects, 23, 65, 78, 170, 181, 185 Architectural details cabinetwork, 272–73, 272f ceilings, 269–72, 269f–72f contract considerations, 266–68, 267f–69f doors, 255–59, 256f–59f ireplaces and chimneypieces, 266–68, 267f–69f stairs, 264–66, 264f–66f walls, 252–55, 252f–55f windows, 259–64, 260f–64f

Architectural elements, balance with furniture, 213, 213f Architectural glazing, 272t Architectural lighting, 113–14 Architectural openings, 216 Architectural rodding, 303t Architectural space planning, 26t See also Space planning Architecture, 19, 22t new, 4 scale of, 55 Architrave, 378, 380t Arch systems, 199t Area rugs, 322, 322f Argyle chair, 432, 433t Armchairs Armchair 443, 445t Queen Anne, 390, 397t Armless chair, 244t Armoire, 246, 427t, 428t Armure, 348 Arnaché, 340t, 348 Arnold House, 392t Art and accessories contract considerations, 374–76 decorative art, 362–70 emotionally supportive design, 360f, 361f, 363f, 373–74, 373f, 374f, i ne art, 358–62 objects from nature, 370–71 other accessories, 371 overall considerations, 373 Art and accessory dealerships, 26t Art Deco style, 439–40, 439f Art lamps, 116 Art glass, 289f, 305t Artiicial lighting, 68, 82, 82f, 83, 101–09, 102f luorescent lighting, 102–05 incandescent lighting, 104–5 LED, 105–6 low-voltage lighting, 105 tungsten halogen lighting, 105 Artistic lighting, 108 Art lighting, 108f, 367 Art nouveau/Jugendstil furniture classics, 432, 433t Art of Color, The (Itten), 88 Art pieces, hanging, 216–17, 217f, 220f Arts and Crafts movement, 434 Asbestos, 40, 187, 203 Ashlar, 278t Asian style, 78 Assisted living center, 52f Asymmetrical furniture groupings, 212f, 213 Asymmetrical (informal) balance, 57–58, 57f Athena, 378 Atria, 41, 381, 382t Attached dwellings, 177–79 Attic windows, 264, 264f Aubusson rugs, 327, 327f Authentic historic styles, 75 Authentic period styles, 75 Automatic doors, 44f

495

496

Index

Automatic sensor dimmers, 125 Auxiliary heating, 195 Average or mediocre design, 73 Awnings, 42 Awning windows, 260–61, 261f Axminster carpets, 318f

B Backilling, 186 Backlighting, 68 Back panels, 230 Back-to-back plumbing, 189f Bacteria, 40 Bad design, 73 Bafled ceiling, 273, 273f Balance, 54, 56–58 “active,” 57–58, 57f of architectural elements with furniture, 213, 213f asymmetrical (informal), 57–58 57f bisymmetrical, 57–58 of form, 64 of furniture, 212–13 of horizontal, vertical, and curved lines, 65f occult, 57–58 optical, 57–58 passive, 57 radial, 58, 59 symmetrical (formal), 56f, 57, 57f Balance light, 108 Ballasts, 102 Balloon (pouf or cloud) shades, 300t Baluster, 264f, 265 Balustrades, 265, 395, 396t Bamboo, 233 Bamboo looring, 37f, 315t Bamboo shades, 296, 305t Banisters, 264f, 265 Barcelona chair, 442t Barcelona collection, 443 Barcelona stool, 443 Barcelona table, 443 Baroque period (1580–1750), 75, 390, 390f Barrel vault, 269f, 270, 379 Barrier-free design, 45 Barrier-free entrance, 46f Bartile, 175f, 187 Basculant chair, 442t, 443 Baseboard, 255, 255f Baseboard units, 190 Base lighting, toe-mold lighting, 113t Base molding, 255, 255f Basic human needs, 130 Baskets, 365, 366f Bas-relief, 355 Bast ibers, 334 Bath linens, 369 Bathrooms design, 25f designed for accessibility, 48f family, 154, 155f loor plan, 155f lighting ixtures, 113t, 115, 115f, 117t master, 153–54, 154f mirrors visually expand the space of, 161 for motion-impaired individuals, 47–48, 48f Batik, 348 Batiste, 348, 299f Batting, 234 Batts, 187 Bauhaus school, 20, 440, 443 Bay rods, 303t Bays, 383, 394 Bay windows, 261, 261f

Bead-and-reel moldings, 379, 380 Beadboard, 253, 253f, 254f, 285t, 286f Beamed ceilings, 262f, 268f, 270f, 271 Beam systems, 200t Beauty, in loor materials, 310 Beaux Arts inluence (1881–1945), in America, 422–23, 423f, 424t, 426 Bed linens, 369, 369f Bedrooms, for motion-impaired individuals, 48–49 Beltcourse, 394 Belter, John Henry, 415t–16t Bengaline, 348 Bentwood rocker, 432, 433t Berber rugs, 329 Bergère, 243f Berms, 11, 198 Bernini, 390 Bertoia, Harry, 444, 445t Bertoia Wire Group, 444, 445t Beveled, 252, 254 Beveled glass, 362 Bibelots, 362 Bids, 14, 15, 18, 25, 28t Biedermeier, 408 Bifold doors, 257, 258f Biltmore, 424t Bird’s-eye, 349 Bisymmetrical balance, 56f, 57 Black and white photography, 360 Blacks, 90 Blanket wrapping, 38 Bleaching, 230 Blinds, 293, 294, 296, 305t Block front furniture, 398, 401t Block print, 359 Blogs, 23 Blown (loose) insulation, 187 Blueprints. See Working drawings Board and batten paneling, 252, 254, 255f, 285t Bold colors, 88 Bonnet roof, 417 Bonsai, 434 Books, 368–69, 368f Bosses, 383 Bouclé, 349 Bouclé marquisette, 349 Bow-back Windsor chair, 407t Bow rods, 303t Bow windows, 261, 261f Box-shaped grouping, 219, 220f Bracketed cornice, 398 Bracket lighting, 113t Brackets, 383 Braided rugs, 326, 326f, 327f Braille, 18, 19f Brainstorming, 14 Brass, 231 Breakfronts, 247t, 398 Breast, 267 Breuer, Marcel, 20, 440, 442t, 443 Brewster chair, 391, 393t Brick, 276, 276t, 280, 394 Brick looring, 313t, 314t Brigham Young University library underground addition, 202f Bright light, 110 Bright-light therapy, 110 Brilliants, 107 British Museum, 378 Brno chair, 442t, 443 Broadcloth, 349 Broadloom carpets, 315, 320 Brocade, 188, 350 Brocatelle, 350 Bronze, 365 Brooklyn Bridge, 412t, 432

Brown, 90–91 Brownstones, 179 Brushed metal, 231 Bubble planning, 170f, 171, 181 Buchram (buckram or crinoline), 350 Buffet, 248t Buffet lamp, 116, 118f Buffet-style dining, 207 Builders, 15, 23 Building materials indigenous, 12 representations of, 177f Built-in indirect lighting, 114 Bulli nch, Charles, 402 Bullnosed, 265 Burlap, 350 Burl veneer, 229 Burn-out, 350 Business skills, 20 Busy lines, 67t Butler, Lee Porter, 198 Butler’s pantry, 145f, 146, 149t Butler’s tray table, 249t Butterly table, 248t, 407t Buttoned upholstery, 235, 235f Buttressed chimneys, 391 Buttresses, 385 Buying, 26t Byobu screen, 366f, 367, 367f, 434t Byzantium, 386

C Cabinet, closet, and storage design, 26t Cabinetmakers, 23, 24f Cabinetwork (cabinetry), 272–73, 272f details, 183f standard sizes of, 151t Cable systems, 200t Cabriole legs, 395 Café curtains, 298t Calculating software, 23 Calendered (rolled) plastics, 232 Calico, 350 California Ranch House, 421–22 California Spanish missions, 419, 419f Callicrates, 378 Cambric, 350 Came, 385 Camisole panel, 299t Candela, candle, or candlepower, 112f, Candelabrum, 59 Candlelight, 101f Cane furniture, 239 Canopy bed, 249t Canted, 261 Canterbury Cathedral, 383f Cantilever design, 418t, 443 CCD (charge-coupled device) chip, 360 Canvas, 354 Cape Cod Cottage, 405, 406t Capitals, 379, 379f Carbon dioxide, 40 Carbon footprint, 42 Carbon monoxide, 40 Careers contract interior design, 25–29 residential interior design, 25 specialized design, 25 teaching interior design, 29 Carpeting, 315–30, 369 broadloom, 315, 320, 320f contract, 331–32 cost per square yard, 310 deep-pile, 321, 321f, 326, 329f

Index

durability, 331 ibers, 318, 319t fuse-bonded, 320 green, 315, 318f installation and padding, 320 knitted, 320 maintenance and cleaning, 322 needlepunch, 320 patterned, 38, 318f, 330f, 331 plush, 320, 320f rubber-backed tufted, 320 shag, 321, 321f texture, 320–21, 320f–21f tiles, modular, 331, 331f tufted broadloom carpets, 320 velvet weave, 320 wall-to-wall, 315, 322f Wilton, 320 woven broadloom carpet, 320 Carver chair, 391, 393t Cased glass, 364 Case goods, 228–29, 229f Casement, 350 Casement draperies, 298t Casement windows, 261, 261f, 262f, 385 Case Studies brownstone remodel, 296f contemporary restaurant, 289f ergonomic chairs, 241f furniture arrangement with CAD, 223f international study center, 17f juxtaposed colors, 91f music room, 16f retail facility, 30f–31f Casing, 234 Cast iron, 365 Cast-iron pipe, 189 Casual contemporary style, 78, 79f Category 5 unshielded twisted-pair cable, 122 Cathedral ceilings, 270 Cathedral windows, 262, 262f Caucasian or Turkish rugs, 324, 324f Caulking, 42 Ceiling fan, 39f Ceiling lighting, luminous, 106 Ceilings, 269–72 angled, 270 architectural details, 269–72 bafled, 273, 273f beamed, 262f, 268f, 270f, 271–72 cathedral, 270 coffered, 59, 272, 272f, 273f contract, 273, 273t coved, 272 lat, 269 materials, 189 plaster, 269 shed, 270 suspended, 273, 273f tray, 270, 271f treatments, 293 vaulted, 270f See also Wall and ceiling materials Cell phone conferencing, 23 Cella, 380 Cellular (honeycomb) shades, 300t Cellulosic ibers, 334 Cement, 186, 289f Center for Universal Design, 37 Central air-conditioning system, 191 Central air-conditioning unit, 191f Central heating, 190 Central plumbing, 189–90 Central vacuum systems, 189 Ceramics, 363 Ceramic tile, 276t, 280t, 281t, 310f, 313t, 330f Ceramic tile loor, 310f, 313t, 330f

Certiied Kitchen Designer, 26 Cesca chair, 442t, 443 Chair rails, 56, 255, 255f Chairs Argyle chair, 432, 433t Barcelona, 442t, 443 Basculant, 442t, 443 bow-back Windsor, 407t Brewster, 391, 393t Brno, 442t, 443 Carver, 391, 393t Cesca, 442t, 443 THE Chair, 444, 445t Chinese, 387t Chinese Chippendale, 387t, 401t Chippendale, 398–99, 400t-01t club, 245t Comb-back Windsor, 407t Corbu, 432, 433t Country French ladder-back, 428t Dante, 389t, 390 Duncan Phyfe, 410t Eames lounge chair, 444f, 445t Egg Chair, 444, 445t ergonomic, 241, 241f, 249 Fledermaus, 432, 433t Grand Confort, 442t, 443 Hepplewhite shield-back, 404t Hill chair, 432, 443t Hitchcock, 408, 408f, 410 ladder-back, 236f, 245t, 246t, 401t, 407t, 416t, 417f, 428t Lawson lounge chair/sofa, 243t–44t MR chair, 442t, 443 Number Seven Chair, 444, 445t occasional, 213 open armchairs, 243t Pedestal Chair, 445t Petit Confort chair, 443 Platner Chair, 444, 445t Prague, 432, 433t Queen Anne, 395, 397t Shaker, 416t, 417f Sheraton, 402, 404t Stickley armchair, 437t tub, 245t Victorian Belter/Rococo Revival armchair, 415t Victorian Gothic Revival, 415t Victorian Renaissance Revival side chair, 416t Vienna cafe chair, 432, 433t Wassily lounge chair, 442, 443t Windsor, 243t, 406, 407t wing, 245t x-frame, 389t, 390 Chaise longues, 245t, 443 Chambray, 350 Chandeliers, 115, 115f, 368, 368f bar, 102f, 116 island, 116 Chelsea Royal Hospital, London, 394 Chenille, 350 Chest of drawers, 247t Chest on chest, 247t Chevreul, 84–86 Chevron, 67t, 350 Chiffon, 350 Children’s spaces, 9f, 155–56, 156f Chimneypiece, 266–68 China (tableware), 363 Chinese chairs, 387t Chinese Chippendale chairs, 387t, 401t Chinese color, 387t Chinese cupboard, 387t Chinese design, 387t Chinese fretwork, 398 Chinese pattern, 387t

497

Chinese porcelain, 386 Chinese porcelain vase, 387t Chinese rugs, 324–25, 325f, 387t, 386 Chinese table, 387t Chinese textiles, 387t Chinoiserie, 386 Chintz, 350 Chipboard, 228 Clutter, 74f, 75 Chippendale, Thomas: The Gentlemen and CabinetMaker’s Director, 398 Chippendale block-front chest, 401t Chippendale breakfront, 399, 401t Chippendale camel-back sofa, 398, 401t Chippendale chairs, 398 ladder-back chair, 401t side chair, 401t wing chair, 401t Chippendale furniture, 398, 400t-01t highboy, 399 Philadelphia highboy, 400t secretary, 399 tilt-top table, 401t Choir (quire), 383 Chopped urethane, 321 Chroma, 87, 89, 94 Chromatic distribution, law of, 89, 89f Chromium (chrome), 231 Chrysler Building, 439, 439f Churchill, Winston, 4 Circular grouping, 220, 221f Circular lines, 65, 65f, 67t Circulation, 207, 225 City of London, 394 Clapboard, 391 Classical details, 380t Classical Roman designs, 382t Classicism, 252 Classics, 358 Cleanup, 146 Clearance, 190, 208, 208f, 209, 209f Clerestory windows, 41, 261, 261f, 262f, 383f, 384t, 385 Climate, 10, 12 affect on color, 83 and shape of space, 172–73 Cloisonné, 367 Closed loor plan, 173 Closed showrooms, 342 Closed stair (enclosed by walls), 265, 265f Closets, for motion-impaired individuals, 49 Club chairs, 245t Club feet, 395 Coal-burning stoves, 190 Coaxial cable, 123 Codes, 6t, 13, 19, 22t Coffered ceilings, 59, 269, 272f, 273, 273f Coffers, 272, 273 Coil springs, 233f, 234 Coir, 334 Cold-air returns, 190, 207 Cold-cathode lighting, 104, 120f Collections, 371–73 of British locomotives and rail cars, 374f Japanese approach to displaying, 372, 373f Victorian approach to displaying, 373, 373f Collectors, 195 Colonial American style, 75–78 Colonnade, 378 Color, 54, 55, 55t, 62, 68–69 alternate complement, 86 in antiquity, 381 Art Deco, 439, 439f bold, 88 complementary, 84f, 86, 86f in contract interiors, 97–98 cool, 85, 88, 94, 95f

498

Index

Color (continued) deiciency, 82 direct complement, 86, 86f double complement, 86 high-contrast, 88 in hospitality facilities, 97 how we see, 82–83 intensity, 69 in medical facilities, 97 medieval, 385 in mid-century design, 444–46 in ofice interiors, 97 placement, 91–92 in production plants, 98 progression, 5 pure, 98f Renaissance, 390 in residential interiors, 96–97 in restaurant settings, 98f Seventeenth-century America, 394 spectral, 83 subtractive, 82 tetrad complement, 86 and texture, 91 trends, 94–95 triadic complement, 83f, 86 values, 69 Victorian era, 416 visually determines scale, 55 warm, 85, 93, 96f washing, 288t Wedgewood jasperware, 402 Color Association of the United States (CAUS), 96t Color associations, common, 94t Color consultants, 96 Colored lighting, 111 luorescent, 104 incandescent, 105 Color-group moods, 93 Color harmony, 88–93 considerations in, 88 neutralized colors, 88–89 neutrals, 90–91 Color-inluencing factors climate, 83 color placement, 91–92 light, 90f seasons, 83 texture and material, 91 value distribution and contrast, 92–93 Coloring, 341 Color Marketing Group (CMG), 96t Color mixing optical, 82 subtractive, 82 Color Notation, 86 Color organizations, 95–96, 96t Color photography, 360 Color Primer, The (Ostwald), 88 Color psychology, 69, 97f afterimage simultaneous contrast, 94 color trend market, 94–95 Color samples, 88 Color schemes, 55, 68, 89f monochromatic, 84f, 85–86, 85f neutralized, 88–89 split complementary, 84f, 86 Color temperature, 112t Color theory, 84–88 Munsell theory, 86–88 Standard Color-Wheel Theory, 84–86 Color wheel, 69, 84f, 86 Columns, 252, 258f, 378 Comb-back Windsor chair, 407t Combination felt padding, 321 Combination (open and closed) plans, 173 Combination wood furniture, 229

Combing, 288t Combustion lighting, 83, 100–01, 101f “C.O.M.” (customer’s own material), 234–35 Communication design, 26t Communication systems, 126–27, 127f Compact luorescent lamps (CFL), 45, 45f, 103f, 104, 104f Compacting, 186 Complementary color scheme, 84f, 86, 86f Composite order, 379–80, 382t Compounded textiles, 338, 340 Compression ring, 200t Computer-aided design and drafting (CADD), 23, 26, 171, 181 Computer communication, 23 Computer-generated animations, 23 Computer monitoring, 164f Computer networks, 127 Computers, 23 Computer skills, 20 Computer software, 170, 181 Concept development, 14 Concepts, 14 Conceptual drawings, 14 Concrete, 186, 280t Concrete block, 276t, 280t Concrete looring, 314t Conduction, 195–96, 195f Cones, 82 Conservation, 22, 26, 192–98 Console table, 249t Constructing the building, 185–92 Construction details, 183f Construction documents, 184 Construction drawings, 14 Construction/project management, 26t Contemporary organic style, 80 Contemporary trends deconstructivism, 446, 448f high-tech, 446, 446f, 447f postmodern, 446, 447f Continuing education units (CEUs), 22 Contract design, 18 carpets, 331 communication and safety systems, 127–27 details, 252 fabric speciications, 348t lat fee for designing interiors, 31 furniture design, 223–25, 242, 249–50 lighting, 119–21 materials, 297 plumbing, HVAC, and indoor air quality, 198–203 presentation room, 21f proile for, 18–19 restaurant, 98f space planning, 164–68 retail space, 18f studio, 19f wall coverings, 307 wiring, 126 Contrast, 54t, 59 Control, 195 Convection, 195f, 196 Conventional design, 70 Conventional traverse rods, 302t, 303t Conversational distance, 211, 211f Cooktop arrangements, for motion-impaired individuals, 14, 14f Cool-beam lamp, 111 Cool colors, 85, 94, 95f Cool lighting, 83 Cool white deluxe lamps, 103 Coped, 254 Copper, 231, 365 Copper pipe, 189, 189f Corbel brackets, 420t–21t Corbu chair, 443t

Corduroy, 350 Corinthian order, 379, 379f, 380t Cork, 276t, 285t, 292t Corner blocks, 229 Corner ireplace, 267, 269f Cornice lighting, 113t Cornice moldings, 255, 256f Cornices, 301t, 378, 380t Coromandel screen, 366f, 367, 386, 387t Corwin House, 392t Cost loor coverings, 311 maintenance, 13 not the issue in design, 73 per square foot, 135, 137, 171 replacement, 13 Cottage curtains, 298t, 299f Cotton rugs, 330, 355t Counter dimensions, for motion-impaired individuals, 547f Country French, 426, 428t, 429f armoire, 428t interior, 428t ladder-back chair, 428t panetière, 428t sleigh bed, 428t textile, 428t Country French style, 78 Courses, brick, 388 Coved ceilings, 269, 272 Cove molding, 255, 256t Coverings, of upholstered furniture, 234–36 Craftsman magazine, 434, 435f, 438 Craftsman style, 188f, 434–38, 436t–37t cabinetry, 272f color, 438 Craftsman Bungalow, 436t eight-light door, 437t furniture classics, 438 shed dormer, 436, 451t Craftspeople, 22 Creativity, 75 Crepe, 350 Cretonne, 350 Crewel embroidery, 350 Crinoline, 350 Critical path, 185–86, 192, 193t Cropping, 362 Crossing, 483 Cross sections, 182f, 184, 185f Crowding, 211 Crown (bed) moldings, 255, 255f Crown lintels, 398 Cruciform, 383 Crypt, 383 Crystal, 364 Cubic footage, 171 calculation of, 171f Culture and ideas of comfort and function, 240 and proxemic patterns, 209–10 relationships, 12, 13f Cupola, 394f, 395 Curios, 362 Curtain rods, 302t Curtains, 99t, 298f, 299f, 304t Curtain wall construction, 202f Curved lines, 55t, 65, 65f Curved staircase, 65f, 266, 266f Cushioning, for upholstered furniture, 234 Custom cabinets, 272–73 Custom designs, 241–42, 237, 237f Custom loor plans, 170, 181 Custom (“to-order”) building, 19 Cutaway view, 185f Cut glass, 364 Cut-pile, 320, 320f

Index

D Dado, 252, 252f, 253f Dado cap, 255 Dado molding, 56,59 Damage, inspection for, 18 Damask, 351 Damper, 267, 267f Dante chair, 389t, 390 Dark values, 92, 93f, 98 Data management, 23 Data software, 23 Daub, 385, 391 David Brewster Color theory. See Standard ColorWheel Theory Deacon’s Bench, 406t Debt-to-income, 136 Decatherms, 42 Deconstructive design, 446,448f Decorative arts, 19 baskets, 365, 366f books, 368–69, 368f clocks, 365–66 decorative lighting ixtures, 367–68 mirrors, 362 screens, 366–67, 366f, 367f tableware and cookware, 362–65, 365f textiles, 369–70, 369f Decorative design, 70–73, 71f, 72f Decorative fabric glossary, 348–56 Decorative i nishes, 341 Decorative luminaire lamps, 108 Decorator rods, 295f, 303t Deep-pile carpets, 321, 321f, 329f Defects, 150 Deforestation, 38 Dehumidiier, 191–92 Demographics, household, 5f, 6 Denim, 351 Dentil trm, 395, 421 Design discernment and excellence, 73 emotionally supportive, 369–70 for the handicapped, 26t for large gatherings, 26t preferences, 13 specialties and related factors, 26t–29t for 21st century living, 165f Design development, 14–18 design concept development, 14 execution, 15–18 working drawings and speciications, 14–15 Design marketing centers (markets), 22 Design elements. See Elements of design Designer fees, 31 Designer rugs, 328, 329f Design longevity, and sustainability, 36–37 Design principles. See Principles of Design Design process, 6t contract considerations, 18–19 letter of agreement, 5 postoccupancy evaluation, 18 problem statement, 5 research and programming, 5–13 Design-review commissions, 37 Desk lamps, 116, 117t De Stijl movement, 440 Details, 3, 20, 23, 184 deWolfe, Elsie, 20 dhurrie rugs, 325, 325f Diagonal lines, 65, 66t Diagramming, and loor plans, 171–173 Diffusers, 114 Digital photography, 360 Digital picture frames, 360 Digital subscriber lines (DSLs), 123

Dimity, 351 Dimmable luorescent lighting, 104 Dining cabinetry, 148t Direct complement colors, 84f, 86, 86f Direct glare, 112, 112t Direct glue-down, 321 Direct lighting, 106 Direct solar gain, 196, 196f, 197f Disabled persons, accessibility, 19 Discernment, power of, 21 Dishwashers, 149t Distressed, 230 Distribution, 195 Doctor of philosophy (Ph.D.), 29 Do-it-yourself building, 185 Do-it-yourself (DIY) project, 42 Domes, 264 Domestic oriental rugs, 328 Dome systems, 200t Doorjamb, 257 Doors, 255–59 Doric order, 379, 379f, 380t Dormers, 451t Dotted Swiss, 351 Double cloth, 353 Double complement colors, 86 Double glazing, 260, 260f Double-hung sash window, 263 Double-turn stair, 265, 266f Dovetail joints, 229–30 Dowels, 229 Down cushions, 234 Draft dodgers, 194 Drafting, 20, 22t, 23, 26t Draperies, 296t, 298t Drapery hardware, 296, 302t–03t Draw draperies, 298t Drawings, 359, 360 Drop-leaf occasional table, 402 Drum, 388 Drywall, 188, 188f DuBarry red, 402 Duck, 351, 354 Ductwork, 190, 191f, 192, 203, 204 Duncan Phyfe, 408 chair, 410t lap-top table, 410t Duplex, 179, 181t Durability, 12, 15 of loor materials, 311 of furniture for nonresidential use, 249–50 Durable i nishes, 341 Durable press calendering, 341 Dust panels, 228, 230 Dutch design, 418t Dutch doors, 257, 259f Dutch inluence, in America, 417 Dyckman House, 418t Dyeing, 341, 341f, 342t Dyestuffs, 82

E E-design, 16f, 23 Eames, Charles, 444 Eames, Ray, 444 Eames lounge chair, 444f, 445t Early Christian style, 381 Early Georgian style (1695–1750), 75, 394–97, 394f, 395f, 396t–97t color, 395 furniture classics, 395 interior, 396t textiles, 397t Earthenware, 363

499

Easements, 265 East India Company, 386 Eastlake, Charles: Hints on Household Taste, 411 Eastlake style, 411 Echinus, 379 Echo noise, 11 Eclectic style, 80 Eclectic Victorian styles, 411 Economic factors, 12–13 Economy in home planning, 137f Edgar J. Kaufmann residence, 439 Egg-and-dart motif, 59, 379, 380 Egg Chair, 379–80, 380t, 445t Egyptian Revival, 413t Eficacy, 112f Electrical raceways, 123 Electricians, 24f Electric usage monitor, 42 Electricity, measuring, 112t Electronic devices, 126f Elements of Color, The (Itten), 88 Elements of design, 55t, 62–73 color, 68–69 light, 68, 69f line, 65–66, 65f, 66t mass, 64–65 pattern, 67–68, 68f shape or form, 63–64, 63f space, 62–63, 62f texture, 66–67, 66f Elevation, 15 Elgin, Lord, 378 Elgin Marbles, 378 E-mail, 23 Embellishment, 391 Embroidery, 340t, 351 Emotionally supportive design, 373–74 Emphasis, 54, 59–60 in furniture arrangements, 213–14 placement of, 67 Empire State Building, 439 Enameled glass, 364 Energy audit, 42 Energy conservation active and passive solar systems, 195–98 and lighting, 40–41 and windows, 42 and window treatments, 293–96 Energy consumption, minimizing, 39f Energy Guide labels, 148f, 149t Energy Star label, 42, 146f, 149t Energy vampires, 42 Engawa, 434 English Gothic, 383f Engravings, 359 Entablatures, 378, 379, 380t Entertainment center design, 26t Entertainment rooms, 157–58 Entry/foyer, 141f Entryway planning, 138 Envelope concept, 198 Environmental considerations, 10, 34–37 air pollution in the interior environment, 39–40 green design, 20, 26t, 37–39 lighting and energy conservation, 40–41 sustainability, 34–37 water conservation, 6 windows and energy conservation, 42 Environmental hazards, 11 “Environmentally Preferable Products,” 39 Environmental Protection Agency (EPA), 39, 42 Environmental safety, 26t Equilibrium, 56 Ergonomics, 14, 14f, 70 chairs, 241f contract furniture, 242, 249 superchairs, 241

500

Index

Etched glass, 362, 364 Etchings, 359 Ethics, 34, 35 European rugs, 326–28, 327f, 328f Evaporative cooling system, 192 Excellent or i ne design, 73 Execution, 15–18 Exhaust, 40 Existing home, buying, 180 Exotic woods, 38 Exposed aggregate looring, 312t Exterior elevations, 184 Exterior i nishing, 187 Exterior veneer, 187 Extruded materials, 198, 230 Extruded textiles, 338 Eye, training, 73–74 Eyeball lighting, 114t Eyeball spotlights, 105f, 106 Eyelet, 351

F Fabric art, 370 Fabricators, 15, 23 Fabric-covered wall, 292, 292f Fabric glossary, 348–56 Fabrics aesthetics, 343–47 color coordination guidelines, 345t, 345f construction, 340t contract considerations, 347–48, 347f durability, 344–47, 348t dyeing and printing, 342t ibers, 334–42 i nishes, 341 lexibility, 344–47 humanizing of interiors, 342–43 livability, 344–47 maintenance guidelines, 338t, 388 obtaining, 341–42 pattern, 344 texture, 344 versatility, 342–47 weight and applications, 347, 347t Fabric wall coverings, 292t Fabric window shades, 296, 300t Facade, 388 Face weight, 331 Facilities management, 26t Facilities managers, 26f, 28t FACS Ed (Family and Consumer Science Education), 29 Faille, 351 Fallingwater, 438f, 439 Familiarity, 12 Family bathrooms, 154, 155f Family room, with billiard table, 157f Fanlights, 260, 260f, 263, 268f, 398, 403t Farnsworth House, 443f Fascia, 187 Fashion changing, 5f, 94–95 vs. longevity, 37 Fauteuil, 236f, 243t, 425, 426t, 427t Federal style, 75, 402–05, 403t–04t, 405f color, 402 elliptical fanlight, 258f, 260, 260f, 403t furniture classics, 402 houses, 402 textiles, 404t Feldspar, 363 Felt padding, 321, 351 Festoons, 301t, 304t Fiber felt padding, 321

Fiberglass, 276t, 281t, 296t Fibers, 334–42 carpet, 318, 319t comparison of, 337t–38t fuzzing, 347 man-made, 334, 334t, 336t pilling, 347 Fieldstone, 276t, 278t Filaments, 334, 334t File Transfer Protocol (FTP) site, 23 Filling, 341 Financial accounting software, 23 Financial considerations, 29–31 Financing, 135–36, 136t Fine art, 358–62 drawing, 359 graphic art, photography, reproductions, and rubbings, 360–61 mosaic, 359 obtaining, 361–62 paintings, 358–59 preparing for display, 362 printmaking, 359–60 sculpture, 358 Finial, 399 Finish carpenters, 272–73 Finished pile weight, 331 Finishes, 14, 15, 20, 23, 26t antique, 230 chemical, 341 decorative, 341 distressed, 230 durable, 341 functional, 341 mechanical, 341 natural, 230 nondurable, 341 paint, 288t soil-repellent, 341 soluble, 341 standard, 341 surface treatment, 341 verdigris, 231 water-repellent, 341 wet, 341 wood, 230 Finishing, 341 Finish package, 189 Finish plumbing, 186, 189, 190f Fire alert systems, 126, 127 Firebox, 267, 267f Fire extinguishers, 12 Fireplaces, 101, 107, 111, 144f, 190, 266–68, 267t, 268f components, 267f inserts, 190, 269 lighting from, 100–01 Fire prevention, 12 Fireproof shingles, 187 Fish tanks, 371, 372f Fixed windows, 257f, 260, 261f Fixtures installation, 186 standard sizes of, 151t Flagstone, 311f, 312t Flame-retardant, 341 Flamestitch, 67t, 351 Flannel, 351 Flap-top table, 248t Flat inverted box pleat valances, 301t Flat Roman shades, 300t Flats, 179 Flatwork, 186 Fledermaus chair, 432, 433t Flexibility, planning for, 163–64 Flexible wall covering, 292 Flickering lighting, 110–11 Flitch, 229

Floccati (lokati) rugs, 329–30 Floor coverings calculations and costs, 310 contract considerations, 330–31 loor requirements and speciications, 310 hard and resilient, 330–31 rugs, 322–30 soft loor coverings, 315–30 Floor lamps, 116, 117t, 368 Floor plans, 173, 180–84 design, 26t and diagramming, 171 evolution of, 130f, 163f fourplex, 178f and housing, 173–85 obtaining, 180–83 one-and-one-half-story, 176f split-level home, 177f split-level home, remodeled, 180f symbols, 173, 174f two phases of schematics or graphics in the evolution of, 163f, 170f, 171 two-story, 177f types, 173 Flowers, 370–71, 371f Flowing lines, 65, 65f, 67t Flue, 267, 267f, 269 Fluorescent lamps, 40, 41, 68, 104f Fluorescent luminaires, 83, 103f compact, 104, 104f shapes of, 103t, 104f Fluoresces, 102 Flush doors, 256, 256f Flush-face ireplace, 267, 267f Fluted, 379, 380 Flying buttresses, 198, 384t, 385 Foam back, 351 Foam blocks, 187 Foam rubber pads, 321 Foams, 187, 198, 234, 321 Focal point, 59–60, 61f primary and secondary, 214–15 Folded plate systems, 200t Folk rugs, 325–26, 325f–26f Food preparation countertop-cabinet-top areas, 147t Food storage cabinetry, 147t Footcandle or footlambert, 112, 112t Forced-air heating, 190 Forensic consultation, 27t Forest management, 35 Form, 62, 63–64, 63f Formal curtains, 299t Formal fabrics, 346f Formaldehyde, 40, 41t Formal European Design, 425–26 Formal space, 138, 141f Formal symmetrical balance, 57, 57f Formal traditional style, 75, 78f “Form follows function,” 70 Form (shape), 62, 62f, 63–64, 63f balance of, 64 “Form follows function,” 70 and furniture arrangement, 216–17 Foster, Norman, 446 Foundation drawings, 184 Foundation for Interior Design Education and Research (FIDER), 20 Foundations, 186 Fourplex, 178f, 179 Four-poster bed, 249t Foyer/entry, 141f Frames, art, 362 Frames, digital, 360 Frames, for upholstered furniture, 234 Frame system, 199t Framing, 186 Framing plans, 184, 185f, 187f

Index

Freestanding ireplace, 269 Freezers, 149t French Aubusson rugs, 327, 327f, 328f French Baroque designs, 390 French casement window, 261f French design, 425t, 426t, 427t, 428t French doors, 258f, 259f with an elliptical fanlight, 258f French Empire, 408 French neoclassical, 427t bergère, 427t bureau plat, 427t fauteuil, 427t interior, 427t textiles, 427t French provincial style, 78 French Régence, 425 French Renaissance style, 424t French Rococo/Louis XV design, 75, 425t–26t French Savonnerie rugs, 326–27, 327f Fresco, 359 Fretwork, 398 Frieze, 378, 380t Frieze yarns, 320, 320f Frisé, 351 Front doorway, 256 Full-aniline leather, 232 Fuller, Buckminster, 200t Full-grain leather, 232 Full-spectrum light, 100, 101f, 110 Function, 131, 140t, 164 and contract space planning, 164–68 and culture, 240 and furniture, 206–08, 239–40 and lifestyle, 6–7 and space planning, 130–31 Functional i nishes, 341 Fungi, 40 Furnace, 190 Furniture design, 27t harmony, 239–40 identiication, 242t–49t obtaining, 238–39, 239f restaurant, 249 “suites” of, 239 types, 240–42 Furniture arrangement balance, scale, and mass, 212–13 and circulation, 207–08, 225 combined functions, 207, 207f contract considerations, 223–25 for conversation, 211, 211f and electric and phone connections, 207 elements and principles of design, 212–18 emphasis, 213–14 form and space, 216–17 function, 206–08 human factors, 208–12 line and harmony, 215–16, 215f mechanical functions, 207–08 and proportion, 217–18 rhythm, 213–15 in a square room, 217, 220f See also Furniture groupings; Furniture selection Furniture categories, 236–38 Adaptations, 236 Antiques, 236, 236f Collectibles, 236, 236f custom built, 237, 237f from kits, 237–38 from scratch, 237–38 Modern classics, 237, 237f multipurpose, 238 new, 237 reproductions, 236

vintage, 236–37 unassembled, 238 uni nished, 237–38 used, 238 Furniture groupings, 218–23 box-shaped groupings, 219, 219f circular groupings, 220, 221f L-shaped groupings, 219, 219f parallel groupings, 220, 221, 221f, 22f solo groupings, 222, 222f straight-line groupings, 218, 218f U-shaped groupings, 215f, 219, 219f, 220f Furniture retail sales or rental business, 27t Furniture selection anthropometrics and ergonomics, 240 contract considerations, 242, 249–50 function, 239–40 metal furniture, 230–31, 231f other furniture materials, 231–33, 232f, 233f upholstered furniture, 233–36, 235f wooden furniture, 228–30, 229f Fuse-bonded carpets, 320 Fusuma, 364, 367, 433 Futons, 435

G Gabardine, 351 Gable, 378, 451t Gabled house, 405 Galerie, 417 Gallery style hanging, 217f, 220f Gamble House, 436t Gambrel roof, 391, 450t Game rooms, 217 Garbage disposals, 150t Gateleg table, 248t, 407t, 493t Gauze, 351 Gehry, Frank O., 446, 448f General and ambient lighting, 106, 109f General contractors, 23, 170, 171, 184, 185 General zones, 130f Generic ibers, 334 Genuine, 229 Geodesic domes, 200t Geometric design, 71, 72f George I, 394 George II, 394 George III, 394 George IV, 394, 408 Georgian era, 395 German inluence, in America, 417 German/Pennsylvania Dutch design, 418t Ghirardelli Square, San Francisco, 450 Gibbs, James: A Book of Architecture, 398 Gilded glass, 364 Gimp, 351 Ginger jars, 367 Glare, 68, 111–12 natural, 100 types of, 112t Glass, 282t–83t Glass block, 282t, 282f Glass doors, 256–57 “Glass house,” 440f Glass tile, 280t, 281f Glassware, 363–64 Glazes, 363 Glazing, 282t glass, 260, 260f paint, 289 Glides, 230 Goddard, John, 398 Gold electroplate, 364 Golden mean, 56

501

Golden rectangles, 5 Golden section, 55, 56f Gold leaf, 364 Good or fair design, 73 Good taste, cultivating, 75 Gothic Revival, 411, 412t, 415t Gothic style, 381–85, 384t arch, 383 Church, cross section, 384t Church, interior elevation, 384t Church plan, 384t Gouache, 359 Governor’s Palace, 396t Grab bars, 45, 47, 48, 48f Graceful aging, 310–11 Gradation, 54t, 58, 59, 59f Grains, 229 Grand Confort chair, 442t, 443 Grandfather clocks, 366 Grandmother clocks, 366 Granite, 276t, 278t, 312t Granite countertops, 278t Graphic art, 360, 360f Graphic design and illustration, 27t Graphics, 171 Graves, Michael, 446, 447f Gray, 10 Grazes, 108 Great hall, 160 Great rooms, 4f, 11, 144–46, 145f, 159f features and trends for, 145–46 Greece (ifth century B.C.), 378–79 architecture, 378–79 colors of, 381 design, 380t furniture classics, 379 orders, 379f, 380t temple form, 408 Greek Revival, 75, 407–08, 408f, 409t Greenbelts, 37 Green carpet, 318f Green design, 37–39, 171, 201f of an award-winning New York skyscraper, 201f assistance for designers, 38–39 Greene, Charles, 434 Greene, Henry, 434 Greene brothers, 434, 436t Greenery, 370–71 Greenhouse, 110, 197, 198 and solarium design, 27t Greenhouse effect, 196 Greenhouse window, 262, 263f Green products, 38 Green spaces, 37 Grenadine, 52 Gretchen Bellinger, Inc., 379 Griswold House, 414t Grommet panel, 299t Gropius, Walter, 20, 440 Grosgrain, 352 Grounding receiver, 126 Guggenheim Museum, Bilbao, Spain, 448f Gum arabic, 358 Gym-spa facility, 168 Gypsum board, 188, 188f

H Hall, Edward T., 209, 211 Halls Croft, 386t Halogen, 40–41, 103t, 105, 112 Hammer-beam ceilings, 269 Hand-held Communication Devices (HHCD), 23 Handrail, 265

502

Index

Handrail diagram, 46f Hangings, 370 Hard and resilient loor materials for contract settings, 330–31 guidelines for selecting, 310–11 Hardboard, 228 Hard Rock Café, Dallas, Texas, 375f Hard-surface loor-covering design, 27t Hardware case goods, 230 design, 27t Hardwood, 228 Harmony, 54, 54t, 60–62 color, 88–93 loor materials, 310 furniture, 239–40 placement of furniture, 215–16, 215f Haughwout Building, 432 Health-care facilities. See Medical facilities Health club/recreational facility design, 27t Hearst Castle, 423f Hearth, 267, 267f Heat gain, 293–94 Heating, ventilation, and air-conditioning (HVAC), 11, 23, 190–92, 191f in contract interiors, 198–203 fresh-air intakes for, 40 heat pump, 192, 197f microbial contamination, 40 Heat loss, 294–96 Heat setting, 341 Heavy mass, 64 Hepplewhite bow-back sofa, 404t shield-back chair, 404t sideboard (buffet), 404t Hepplewhite, George: The Cabinet-Maker and Upholsterer’s Guide, 402 Hepplewhite/Sheraton furniture Pembroke table, 402, 404t sideboard or buffet, 404t Herculaneum, 381, 402, 426 Herringbone, 67t, 338f, 352 HID (high-intensity discharge) lighting, 103t, 120 Highboy, 247t, 395, 397t, 399, 400t High-contrast colors, 93, 98 High dei nition (HD) color rendering, 102, 112t High-eficiency furnace, 190 High-key interiors, 92, 92f High-tech clocks, 365 High-Tech design, 446, 446f, 447f High-technology devices, 186 High values, 92 Hill chair, 432, 433t Hipped roof, 388, 450t Hispanic, 429 Historic buildings early inluences, 378–90 homes, 73 mass density as the measure of strength, 198 Historic furniture pieces, 64 Historic styles, 75 Historic preservation, 22, 28, 29, 448–50 Hitchcock, Henry-Russell, 440 Hitchcock, Lambert, 408 Hitchcock chair, 408, 408f, 410t Hobby areas, 158, 158f Hoffmann, Josef, 432, 433t Hollow core, 256 Holograms, 108 Home automation system, 121–23, 139 Home builder, 184 Home designer, 181 Home Insurance Building, 432 Home ofice, 142f planning, 138–43 where to locate, 143

Homespun, 352 Home theater, 130, 157 Honeycomb shades, 306f Hong Kong, square feet per person, 172 Hong Kong and Shanghai Bank, 446 Hooded ireplace, 267, 268f Hooked rugs, 326 Hook-ups, 189 Hopsacking, 352 Horizontal lines, 55t, 65, 65f, 66t Horseshoe arch, 386 Hospital design, 167f Hospitality facilities colors and patterns, 97 design, 18, 28t space planning, 164–66 Hospitals, space planning, 167–68 Hotels, 164 Houndstooth, 352 Hourglasses, 365 Housed stair, 265 Housing, loor plans and, 173–85 types of, 173–80 Housing-to-income ratio, 136 Hue, 69, 84–85 Hue identity, 88 Human factors, 208–12 anthropometrics, 208 crowding, 211 proxemics, 209–11 standard clearances, 208–09, 208f, 209f territoriality, 211–12 Human scale, 55, 66t Humidiiers, 190 Hunt, Richard Morris, 422 Hutch, 247t, 406, 407t Hybrid solar energy system, 196

I Ictinus, 378 Ikebana, 370, 435t Illusion lighting, 120–21 Incandescent (common ilament) lamps, 41, 68, 103t, 105 Incandescent lighting, 82f, 83, 104–05, 112 Incident solar radiation (insulation), 195 Indian dhurrie rugs, 325, 325f Indirect and isolated passive solar gain, 196–98 Indirect lighting, 110, 113t, 114 Indo-Aubusson rugs, 325 Indoor air quality (IAQ), 43f, 39, 203 Indoor-outdoor living, 156–57 Industrial facilities, 28t Industrial Revolution, 411 Inill, 385 Inluence of the Orient, 386–88, 387t Informal balance, 57–58, 57f Informal traditional style, 75–78 Information-age home automation systems, 122 Information-age wiring and installation, 122–23 Infrared (IR), 105, 118, 123 Inglenook, 436t In-house corporate design, 28t Inquisition, 390 Installers of materials, 23–24 Insulating Concrete Forms (ICF), 187 Insulation, 10, 11, 40, 41t, 42, 187, 191f, 192, 198 window frames, 42 window treatments, 194–95 Intaglio, 359 Intensity, 87 Interaction, 11–12, 12f Interaction of Color (Albers), 89

Intercom systems, 126, 126f in contract installations, 127 Interest rates, 136t Interfacing, 352 Interior design careers in, 25 future of, 32 language of, 2–3 need for, 4–5 profession of, 19–32 residential and contract, 3–4, 25 resources, 22–23 skills, 20 styles, 75–80 Interior design education programs, topics of study, 22t Interior designers must understand the aspects of construction, 20, 185 training and professional development, 20–22 work closely with subcontractors, 24f work with samples, 15f Interior design styles, 75–80 American Country, 75 Art Deco, 78 Art Nouveau, 78 Asian, 78 Authentic Historic, 75 Colonial, 75 Craftsman, 78 Contemporary Organic, 78 Eclectic, 78 Formal Traditional, 75 Informal Traditional, 75 International Modern, 78 Organic Modern, 87 Oriental, 78 Period, 75 Retro Modern, 78 Rustic European, 78 Scandinavian Modern, 78 Thematic, 80 Interior elevations, 175f Interior environmental control systems, 170, 187, 180 Interior i nish components, 170, 188–89 Interior lighting, manipulating mood with, 110–11 Interior space, shaping, 172 Interlining, 352 Intermediate hue, 85–86 International Business Machines (IBM), Purchase, New York, 69f International Colour Authority (ICA), 96t International Conference of Building Oficials, 19 International modern style, 78 International style, 252, 440–43, 440f, 441t–42t, 443f, 439f furniture classics, 443 Internet, 23, 123–24, 127f Intimate distance, 209–10, 210f Inverted pleat draperies, 298t Ionic Capital, with decorative details, 379f, 380t Ionic order, 379 Roman, 379 Iron, 231 Islamic design, 386, 429 Italianate style, 412t Itten, Johannes, 87–88 Iszakaya Restaurant in Atlantic City, NJ, 11f

J Jack arch lintels, 398 Jacobsen, Arne, 444, 445t

Index

Jacquard loom, 320 Jacquard weave, 339f, 340t, 352 Jalousie window, 262, 263f Japanese design, 432–34, 434t–35t Byobu screen, 434t interior, 434t interior details, 435t low table, 435t table with zabuton, 435t textile colors, 435t textile patterns, 435t textile textures, 435t tokonoma, 434t Jeannert-Gris, Charles-Edouard (Le Corbusier), 443 Jefferson, Thomas, 402 Jeffersonian Federal, 402–05, 405f Jenney, William Le Baron, 432 Jersey, 352 “Jesuit” style, 390 Johnson, Philip, 440, 440f Joining methods, 229–30 Joints, 229 Joists, 186 Journalism, 28t Justice design, 25, 28t Jute, 316, 335t Juxtaposition of hues, 91–92, 91f, 94

K Kandinsky, Wassily, 20, 443 Kaolin, 363 Kelvin, 112t Keystone House, 447f Khaki, 352 Kilim rugs, 325, 325f Kilowatt-hours (KWH), 42, 112t Kitchen linens, 369 Kitchen planning, 144–46 cabinetry considerations for, 146, 146f, 147t–48t, working triangles, 146, 150f zones and the working triangle, 146 Kitchens design, 28t designers, 27f economic, 137f features and trends for, 145–46 and great room planning, 144–46 heart of the home, 11, 27f for motion-impaired individuals, 47 Old World, 146f structurally designed, 70f well-planned, 145f Kitsch, 73, 362 Klismos, 379 Klismos, with Saber legs, 380t Knee-hole desk, 246t Knickknacks, 372 Knit, 338, 340t, 352 Knitted carpets, 320 Knoll International, 443–44

L Lace, 339f, 352 Lacquer, 230, 231 Lacquer work, 386 Ladder-back, 398 Ladder-back chairs, 236f, 245t, 246t, 401t, 407t, 428t, 429f, 431t Laminated (sandwiched) foam, 234

Laminate looring, 315t, 315f Lamination, 228 Lamp, 100 Lamp and conservation, 40 Lampas, 352 Lamp shades, 114 Lancets, 385 Landings, 265 Landscaping, 28t Lappet, 352 Large-scale furnishings, 54f Large space, 62–63 Larkin, Thomas, 422 Larkin House, 423t Laser lights, 108 Late Georgian style (1750–90), 75, 398–401, 398f, 399t–401t color, 399 furniture classics, 398–99 interior, 400t textiles, 401t Late medieval (Tudor) style, 385, 386t, 424t Latex, 320 Latillas, 419, 421t Latin cross, 383 Latrobe, Benjamin, 402 Lattice screens, 366 Laundry room planning, 146–52, 152f Law, 28t Lawn, 352 Law of Chromatic Distribution, 89, 89f Law ofice design, 28t Lawson lounge chair, 243t Lawson sofa, 244t Layered lighting sources, 116–18, 118f, 142f Layered or compounded fabrics, 338, 340t Leaded glass, 362, 385 Leadenhall Market, 446f Leadership in Energy and Environmental Design (LEED(tm)) Green Building Rating System, 34f, 38–39 Lead paint, 203 Leather, 334, 336t Leather loor materials, 316t Leather furniture, 232, 232f L’École des Beaux Arts, 422 Le Corbusier, 440, 442t LEDs (light-emitting diodes), 105–06, 120f LED strip lights, 105 Leno, 340t Letter of agreement, 5, 6t, 20, 31 Level loop, 321, 321f Level-tip cut and loop texture, 321, 321f Library design, 28t, 143–44, 144f reception area, 166f Licensing, 22 Life-cycle costing, loor materials, 311 Life safety, contract buildings, 203–04 Lifestyle proiles, 6–7 Light, 68 affects all other elements, 68 affects pattern, 68 affects the perception and appearance of color, 82f measuring, 112t and the mind and body, 109–12 plane of, 108 pool of, 108, 116, 116f quantity of, 116, 120, 260 spectral, 82 Lighting, 28t accent, 106–06, 107f, 108, 118f adjustable track, 114f aisle or exit, 121 ambient, 106, 118f architectural, 113, 114–16, 115f art, 108, 108f

503

backlighting, 68 balance, 108 and balance of furniture arrangement, 213 base, 113t bathroom, 115, 117t bracket, 113t bright, 110 built-in indirect, 113t, 114 candlelight, 101, 101f cold-cathode, 104, 118, 120f cool, 82, 82f cornice, 113t as design element, 100 direct, 106 as element of design, 3, 68–100 and energy conservation, 40–41 eyeball, 105f, 106, 114t ireplace, 101, 107 ixed and adjustable, 114t lickering, 110–11 full-spectrum, 82 for the future, 118–19 general, 106 HID (high-intensity discharge), 103t, 120 illusion, 120–21 indirect, 110, 113t layered sources, 116–18, 118f library, 143–44 LED, 105–06, 120f luminous ceiling, 114 mini pendant, 105f, 109f, 115f, 116f, 117t mood, 107f, 110–11, 120–21 motivational, 120–21 natural, 39f, 40, 41, 41f, 49, 68, 69f, 100–01, 110f, 111f nonarchitectural, 113, 116 pendant, 109f, 115f, 116, 117t, 118f outline, 108 perimeter, 108 pinpoint, 108 plan, 116–18 point, 108 riser, 113t safety, 121 silhouette, 108 sofit, 106, 113t strip, 105, 114t structural, 113 task, 106 toe-kick, 113t track, 106, 107f, 114t undercabinet, 105f, 116f undercounter, 109f valance, 113t See also Artiicial lighting; Luminaires Lighting economy, 118, 119t, 121 Lighting effects, categories of, 108–09 Lighting ixtures, 113–18, 117t, 367–68, 368f Light pipes, 41, 108 Light switches, 124–26 Limestone, 276t, 278t, 279t, 312t Line, 65–67, 65f, 66t–67t combining, 65 and furniture arrangement, 215–16, 215f psychological effects of, 66t–67t Linen, 334, 335t Linenfold panel, 252, 252f Linens, 369, 369f Lining, 352 Linoleum, 316t Linoleum block print, 359 Lintel, 378 Lithographs, 359 Lloyd’s of London, 446, 446f, 447f Load-bearing walls, 186 “Location, location, and location,” 180 Log cabin, 417, 417f

504

Index

Log planks, 285t London shades, 295f, 300t Long-life bulbs, 104 Longwood, Natchez, Mississippi, 411f, 413t Loose cushions, 234 Louis XV design, 425, 425t Louis XVI design, 426, 427t Louisiana French design, 417–19, 419t Louvered doors, 257, 258f Louvered shutters, 296 Louvers, 366 Loveness House, 438f Lowboy, 395 Low contrast, 69 Low-E glazing, 42, 360 Low-low water ixtures, 43 Low-key scheme, 93, 93f Low values, 92–93 L-shaped groupings, 219, 219f Lucarne, 450t Lumber core, 256 Lumens, 112, 112t Luminaires, 103f, 113–14, 117t, 367 decorative, 116 ixed and adjustable, 114 luorescent, 103f, 111f lush-mounted ceiling, 114 portable, 106, 113–14, 116, 117t, 119t semi-lush ceiling, 114 surface-mounted, 114 suspended, 114–15 Luminance, 100 Luminous ceiling lighting, 114, 115f Luminous panels, 102, 114 Lux, 112t Lyocell, 337t

M Machine-made rugs, 328 MacIntosh rose design, 339f Mackintosh, Charles Rennie, 19, 432, 433t MacPhaedris-Warner House, 394f Madame John’s Legacy, 419t Maintenance costs, 13 Maison Carrée, 380, 382t, 402 Maize, 330, 334 Maize mats, 328 Malimo, 340t, 352 Management, 28t Man-made ibers, 334, 334t, 336t cellulosic, 334, 334t noncellulosic/synthetic, 334, 334t Mansard style, 413t Mantel, 266 Manufacturer’s representatives, 28t Marble, 276t, 279t, 307f, 312t Marketing, 28t Marketing centers, 22 Marlborough leg, 398 Marquetry, 229 Marquisette, 353 Marriage chest, 417, 418t Masonite, 228 Masonry block construction, 199t Mass, 55t, 62, 64–65, 212, 212f, 213 Massing, 64, 64f, 65 Master bathroom, 153–54 Master of arts (M.A.), 29 Master of i ne arts (M.F.A.), 29 Master of science (M.S.), 29 Masters, 358 Master suite planning, 152–54 Mat, 62 Matelassé, 353

Materials and color, 91 selection of, 4, 11, 14, 15f Materials boards, 21f McIntire, Samuel, 19, 402 Mechanical i nishes, 341 Media, 73–74, 358 Media center/room, 122f, 157–58, 157f Medical facilities, 26t, 28t philosophy of color, 97 space planning, 167 Medici Palace, Florence, Italy, 388f Medium-density iberboard (MDF), 228 Melamines, 232 Melk Abbey, Austria, 390f Mememto, 374 Memorabilia, 374 Mercerizing, 341 Metal, 276t, 283f, 283t Metal, types of, 230–31 Metal furniture, 230–31 types of metal, 230–31 used in a bedroom, 231f Metal or space frame, 199t Metal shingles, 187 Metals tableware and cookware, 364–65, 365f Metal tieback holders, 303t Metamerism, 82–83, 82f Metopes, 379 Mexican tile, 276t, 281t, 313t Midcentury design, 27f, 443–46, 444f, 445t Middle Ages (800–1500), 381–385 color, 385 design, 384t domestic design, 385, 386t Midtones, 92, 93 Mies van der Rohe, Ludwig, 20, 440 Mildew, 40 Miniblinds, 305t Mini pendants, 105f, 116, 116f, 117 Mirror, 203t, 276t, 281f, 362 Mitering, 254–55 Miter joints, 230 Mobile home, 173 Modacrylic, 337t Model homes, 73 Modern design (1857–present), 432–46 art deco (1981–45), 439–40, 439f art nouveau/Jugendstil (1890–1910), 432–33, 433t contemporary trends, 446 craftsman style (1905–1929), 434–38, 436t–37t Frank Lloyd Wright’s organic architecture (1908–present), 438–39, 438f International style (1932–present), 440–43, 441t–42t, 440f, 443f Scandinavian and mid-century design, 443–46, 445t Modern textiles, 442t Modest living example of, 35f and sustainability, 35–36 Modillions, 395 Modular carpet tiles, 331, 331f Moiré, 353 Mold, 40 Molded plastic doors, 257 Molding, 184, 254–55, 256f Monitoring, budgets, 32 Monitoring, computer, 164f Monochromatic color scheme, 84f, 85, 85f Monterey design, 422, 423t Monticello, 405, 405f Mood lighting, 106, 107f, 108, 110–112, 111f, 120–21 Moors, 367 Morgan, Julia, 423f Morris, William, 19, 438

Mortgage payment, comparison of monthly, 136t Mortise and tenon, 230 Mosaic, 359 Motels, 164 Mothprooi ng, 341 Motion impairment, design recommendations for people with, 46–48 Motivational lighting, 120–21 Motorized rods, 303t Mount Pleasant, 399t Movable insulation, 194–95 MR chair, 442t, 443 Mullions, 385 Multiple-outlet strips, 126 Multiplex units, 179 Multiuse areas, 138, 160 Munsell, Albert H., 86 Munsell color notation system, 86–87 Munsell color wheel, 87f Munsell theory, 86–87, 92–93 Murals, custom painted wall and ceiling, 277 Museum design, 28 Muslin, 353 Mylar, 353

N Napoleon, 408 Naps, 235 National Association of Home Builders (NAHB), 121–22, 171 National Council for Interior Design Qualiication (NCIDQ) examination, 22 National Organization of Professional Organizers (NAPO), 75 National Trust for Historic Preservation, 448 Natural cellulosic ibers, 334, 334t Natural iber rugs, 328–30, 329f Natural ibers, 334 Natural i nishes, 230 Naturalistic design, 70, 71f Natural light, 39f, 40, 41, 49, 68, 69f, 100–01, 101f, 111f in contract settings, 119 Natural Protein ibers, 355t–56t Natural saturation point, 87 Natural thermal low, 196 Natural trafic pattern, 207–08, 207f Natural wool rugs, 329, 329f Nature, 74, 74f Navajo rugs, 325–26, 325f Nave, 383 Near Eastern Islamic cultures, 386 Near Eastern screens, 367 Needle-constructed fabrics, 338, 340t Needlepoint, 353 Needlepoint rugs, 327, 327f Needlepunch carpets, 320 Negative space, 55t, 63, 216–17, 216f Neoclassic style, 75, 427t Nelson, Georg, 27f Neon lights, 104, 108, 120 Nesting tables, 59, 59f, 248t Net, 353 Networking, 23 with clients, 23 with other designers, 29 Neutralized colors, 89, 89f, 98 Neutrals, 90–91 New construction, 132f, 133 rules, 134–35 Newel post, 264f, 265 New oriental rugs, 323 New Orleans French town houses, 418 Niches, 270

Index

Ninon, 353 Nitrogen oxides, 40 Nogging, 385 Noise control, 11, 192 Nonarchitectural lighting, 116 Noncellulosic ibers, 334 Nondurable i nishes, 341 Nonglare glass, 362 Nonrenewable resources, 35 Nonresilient looring materials, 310 Nonwoven textiles, 338, 340t Norman style, 381 Northern Light, 110 Nosing, 264 Notre Dame de Chartres Cathedral, 384t Novelty twills, 340t Nubuck, 232 Number Seven Chair, 444, 445t Nylon, 336t Nylon carpet ibers, 319t

O Objets d’art, 362 Observing design, 3f Occasional chairs, 213 Occult balance, 57–58 Oculus, 377 Off-black, 85f, 90 Off-gassing, 38f, 40 Ofice buildings color trends, 97 design, 28t space planning, 168 Off-white, 90 Oil paintings, 358, Olei n, 334, 337t Olei n/Polypropylene carpet ibers, 319t One-and-one-half story loor plans, 176f One-inch movable louver shutters, 305t One-turn stair, 266f Onion dome, 386, 411f Online painting, 287–89 Online real estate services, 180 Open armchairs, 242t–43t Open loor plan, 142f, 160, 173 Open-riser stair, 264, 270f Open showroom, 341–42 Open stair (no walls), 265, 265f Operable windows, 260 Opposition, 54t, 58, 59 Optical balance, 57–58, Optical color mixing, 82 Optical density, 64 Orange peel, 188 Orders, of Greek architecture, 379 Ordinary incandescent lamps, 112–13 Organdy, 353 Organic design, 438f, Organic modern style, 78 Organization, and modest living, 39–40, Organization and simpliication, 7f, 28f, 36, 74f, 75 Organized clutter, 372–73, 373f Organizer, Professional, 28t, 29f Orient, inluence of, 386–88, 387t Oriental grasses, 334 Oriental philosophies, 58 Oriental Revival, 411f, 413t Oriental rugs, 322–25 Caucasian or Turkish rugs, 324, 324f Chinese rugs, 324–25, 325f Persian prayer rugs, 323–24, 324f Persian rugs, 323, 324f Tibetan rugs, 324, 324f Oriental style, 78

Orientation, 83, 100 and need for light and glare control, 296 and shape of the space, 172 and windows, 260 Ornament, visually determines scale, 5 Ornamentive design, 70 Ostwald, Wilhelm, 87 Ostwald theory, 87–88 Ottoman fabric, 353 Ottomans, 64, 244t Outbuildings, 395 Outdoor living space, 10f, 156f, 157, 140f Outline lighting, 108 Outlining, 286f, 288t Ovens/ranges/cooktops, 149t Overcrowding, 172 Overhangs, 42 Overlays, 170 Oxford cloth, 340t, 353 Oxford plaid, 338f Ozone, 40

P Pad and tackless strip, 321, 321f Padding, 234, 234f Paint, 287–89 contrasting color on trim, 288t eco-friendly, 287t i nishes, 288t low luster, 288t painting guidelines, 287 paint-texturizing techniques, 284t, 288t types of, 287t Painters, 24f Painting, online, 287–89 Paintings, 358–59, 358f, 368f, 375f hanging, 216–17, 217f Paisley, 353 Palace of the Governors, 420t Palace of Versailles, 390 Palazzo Rucellai, 389t Palette knives, 358 Palette theory. See Standard Color-Wheel Theory Palisade wall, 391f, 393t Palladian manner, 398 Palladian window, 260, 260f, 398, 400t Palladio, Andrea, 388 Paneled doors, 256, 256f Paneling, 252–54, 252f–54f Pantheon, Rome, 380, 381f, 383t Papier-mâché, 231 Parallel groupings, 212f, 220, 221f, 222f, Parapet wall, 398 Parisian pleat draperies, 298t PAR lamp, 103t Parquet, 314t, 315f Parthenon, 378, 378f Particleboard, 228, 229 Passive balance, 57 Passive solar systems, 195–98, 197f Pastels, 89 Paterae, 402 Patina, 74, 310–11, 364 Patio home, 173 Pattern books, 388, 398, 402 Patterned carpet, 38, 318f, 330f, 331 Patterned fabric, guidelines for coordinating, 339f, 343f, 344f, 346t, Pattern psychology, 68 Patterns, 55t, 67–68 character of, 67–68 combined, 67, 68, 68f scale of, 68 visually determine scale, 55

Pedestal Chair, 443–44, 445t Pedestal group, 443–44 Pedestal table, 416 Pediment frieze, 378 Pediments, 378, 388, 390, 394, 398 Pellon, 353 Pembroke table, 402, 404t Pendant light, 109f, 115f, 116, 117f, 118f Pendants, 391 Pennsylvania Dutch, 417, 418t Pennsylvania Dutch marriage chest, 418t Percale, 353 Perfa-tape, 188 Perimeter lighting, 108 Peristyle, 381, 382t Persian Oriental rugs, 323, 323f, 324f Persian prayer rugs, 323, 323f “Personal digital assistant,” 186 Personal distance, 210, 210f Personal pieces, 4f, 13f Personal space, 75, 210 Personal style, i nding, 74–75 Perspective sketches, 171 Pewter, 365 Phantom loads, 42 Phidias, 378 Philadelphia highboy, 394, 400t Phosphorus, 102 Photography, 360, 361f black and white, 360 color, 360 digital, 360 sepia-toned, 360 Photoshop, 360 Photo Therapeutics, 110 Physical location, 10–11 Physically handicapped, making buildings accessible to, 19 Piano nobile, 59, 388, 402 Pictures, hanging, 216–17, 217f Pied-è-terre, 179 Pier at Caesars retail shopping, 30f–31f Piers, 383 Pigments, 230, 232, 358 Pilasters, 252, 252f, 388, 390, 394, 398, 408 Pile density, 331 Pile fabric, 353 Pile weave, 340t Piña, 334 Pingree House, 403t Pinpoint lighting, 108 Piqué, 353 Plaid, 338f, 339f, 354 Plain basket weave, 340t Plain leno weave, 340t Plain oxford weave, 340t Plain slicing, 229 Plain weave, 338f, 340t, 341 Plan drawing, 207–08, 207f Plane of light, 106, 108 Plantation shutters, 305t Plants, 370 toxins, 40, 41t Plasterboard, 187, 188, 188f Plaster ceilings, 269 Plasters, 276t, 284t Plastics, 198 furniture materials, 232 informal tableware and accessories, 365 Plate rail, 253 Platner, Warren, 444 Platner Chair, 445t Platner Collection, 444 Pleated shades, 300t Plenum, 204, 203f, 273 egress lighting connected through, 203f systems in, 203f

505

506

Index

Plexiglas, 259, 263, 362 Plies, 228 Plissé, 354 Plumbing chase, 189, 198 Plumbing ixture design, 28t Plumbing systems, 189–90, 189f for contract interiors, 198–203 three stages of, 186 Plush carpets, 320, 320f Plywood, 228, 229 Pneumatic systems, 200t Pocket doors, 162, 143, 154, 257, 257f Podium, 380, 388 Point lighting, 108 Polished cotton, 354 Pollution, 11 Polyester, 334t, 337t batting, 234, 234f carpet ibers, 319t Polylactic acid iber (PLA), 337t Polyurethane, 230, 232 Polyurethane foam, 234 Pompadour blue, 402 Pompeii, 380 house plan, 382t Pony Chaise, 442t, 443 Poor design, 73 Poplin, 354 Porcelain, 363 Portable appliances, 150t Portable luminaires, 113, 116, 117t Portable space heaters, 190 Portal, 421, 429 Porthole windows, 259f, 260, 261f Portico, 380, 398, 402, 405, 408 Portuguese needlepoint rugs, 327, 327f Positive space, 55t, 63 Posters, 360, 360f Postmodern design, 446, 447f Postoccupancy evaluation (POE), 18 Potpourri, 365 Power-line carrier (PLC) systems, 123 Prague chair, 432, 433t Prairie style, 438f, 439 Prang theory. See Standard Color-Wheel Theory Prei nished, 341 Presbyterian Church, 412t Presentation boards, 214, 15f Preservation, 448–50 Preshrinking, 341 Pressed glass, 363–64 Pretil, 421, 421t Prevailing winds, 11 Primary focal point, 214–15, 217 Primary hues, 83f, 84–85 Principles of design, 54–62, 54t balance, 56–58, 56f, 57f emphasis, 59–60, 61f harmony, 60–62 proportion, 55–56, 56f rhythm, 58–59, 58f, 59f scale, 54–55, 54f, 55f Printing, 341f, 342t Printmaking, 358, 359–60 Priscilla curtains, 298t Privacy, 11–12 draperies, 298t and windows, 257, 260, 261 Private zones, 131 Problem statement, 5–6, 6t Product design, 28t Product evaluation, 28t Production plants, 98 Product searches, 98 Product sources, 23 Professional organizations, 24

Professional organizer, 28t, 29f Professionals in related ields, 26t–29t Proile, 6 Programmable thermostat, 43 Programming, 6–14 codes, 13 design preferences, 13 economic factors, 12–13 environmental factors, 1–11 lifestyle and function, 6–7 mechanical considerations, 11 psychological and sociological considerations, 11–12 relationships, 7–8 space requirements, 8 users, 6 Progression, 59, 59f Projecting ireplace, 267, 267f Project management, 26t, 170 Project management software, 23 Proportion, 55–56, 159 of decoration, 73 and furniture arrangement, 217 of a long narrow room, 218f ratio and, 55–56 Protein ibers, 334 Provençal, 426 Provincial settings, 365 Proxemics, 209–11, 209f–11f Psychology of color, 69 Public distance, 210–11, 211f Publicity and public relations (PR), 28t Public spaces, 73, 168 Public transportation, space planning, 168 Pueblo Indian design, 12 Pueblos, 419 Punch list, 186, 192, 194t Purchasing agent, 28t Pure color, 98f PVC polyvinyl chloride pipe, 189

Q Quadplex, 179 Quarry tile, 276t, 281t, 313t Quarter slicing, 229 Queen Anne style, 395, 397t, 415t armchair, 395, 397t, chairs, 395 Highboy, 395, 397t tea table, 397t wing chair, 3905, 397t Quicksilver, 262 Quilted fabric, 354 Quoins, 394

R Rachel, Raschel knit, 340t, 354 Radial balance, 58 Radiant heat, 190, 195 Radiation, 5, 9, 195, 195f Radiator, 190 Radio frequency (RF) transmission, 123 Radon gases, 40 Rafters, 186 Ragging or rag rolling, 288t Rag rugs, 326, 326f Rails, 252, 256 Rainbow roofs, 405 Rain gutters, 187 Raised hearth, 267 Raised ranch style, 176f

Rambler, 176f Ramie, 334 Rammed earth, 39f Ramps, 46 Ranch style, 173 Random cut and loop texture, 321t Rapid-start luorescent lamps, 102 Ratio and proportion, 55–56 Rattan, 233 Raw-iber stage, 334 Rayon, 334, 334t, 336 Real estate developer, 28t Rebar, 186 Rebond, 321 Recessed downlights, 114t, 116f Recessed luminaires, 114 Recessed numerals, raised Braille, 51f Recycling, 34, 38, 198 “Reduce, reuse, recycle, and repair,” 35, 37 Reeded legs, 402 Rei nement, 171 Relecting glare, 112, 112t Relective lamps, 103t Reformation, 390 Refract, 11 Refrigerators, 148f, 149t Refurbishing, 4 Régence (Pre-Rococo) fauteuil, 425t Regency design, 408 Registers, 190, 204 Reinforced concrete, 186 Relationships, 7–8 Relaxed Roman, 300t Relief designs, 379 Relief printing, 359 Remodeler, 184 Remodeling, 26t, 133–35, 133f, 134f, 135f advantages of, 133–34 disadvantages of, 134 plans, 179f rules of, 134–35 Remote-control devices, 121 Renaissance (1420–1650), 57, 75, 252, 258f, 260, 264 color, 390 design, 389t furniture classics, 388–90 palace, 388, 388f textiles, 389t Renaissance Revival, 411–16 Rendering, 14, 16f, 17f, 21f, 28t, 171 Renewable resources, 26t Rep, Repp, 354 Repetition, 54t, 58, 58f Reproductions, 360–61 Residential build-in systems, 126 Residential program, 5–6 Residential space, 2f for 21st century living, 165f and well-being, 4 wiring plan, 124–26, 124f Resilient looring materials, 310, 315, 316t–17t, 330–31 Resource eficiency, and sustainability, 35 Resources, 35 Restaurants, 3f colors, 85f, 88, 97, 98f design, 21f, 28t space planning, 164 Restoration, 28t, 450 Restrictive covenants, 172 Retail design, 28f–30f, 97–98 Retailers, 23, 28t Retainer fee, 31 Retroitting, 42, 196 Retro modern style, 78 Reupholstering, 38

Index

Reverberation of sound, 11 Reversible cushions, 234 RG-6 quad-shielded coaxial cable, 122 Rhythm, 54, 54t, 58–59 by gradation, 59, 59f by opposition, 59, 59f in placement of furniture, 213–15, 213f by radiation, 59, 60f Ribs, 383 Richield Oil Building, 439 Riser, 264, 264f Riser lighting, 113t River cobbles, 278t Robie House, 338f, 339 Robsjohn-Gibbings, T. H., 379 Rockefeller Center, 439 Rocks, 371 Rocky Mountain Institute, 40 Rococo Revival, 411, 415t–16t Rococo style, 26, 71f, 75, 425 bergère, 425t Bureau-à-Cylindre, 426t commode, 426t console table, 425t fauteuil, 426t textiles, 426t Rods, 82 Rogers, Richard, 446 Roller shades, 305t Rollikan rugs, 326 Rolltop desk, 246t Roman arch, 382t Roman design, 382t Roman domestic design, 380–81 Romanesque, 381, 383 Romanesque arches, 384t Romanian kilim, 325, 325f Roman orders, 379, 379f, 382t Roman shades, 300t Roman temple, 252, 380, 381f, 382t Rome (200 B.C.–A.D. 400), 379–81 Roof, 187, 450t–51t Roof monitors, 197 Roof overhang, 197f Roof trusses, 186 Room-sized rugs, 322f, 328f, 329f Rotary slicing, 229 Rotunda, 271, 390 Rough electrical, 187 Rough heating, 187 Rough materials, 192 Rough plumbing, 187, 189f, 203 Roundheaded arch, 382t Roundheaded fanlight, 398 Round windows, 260 Round-wire construction, 321, 321f Routers, 123 Row houses, 179, 402, 422 Rubber-backed tufted carpets, 320 Rubber loor materials, 316t Rubbings, 361 Rubble, 278t Rugs, 322–30, 369 authentic oriental rugs, 322–25 for contract installation, 330–31 designer rugs, 328, 329f European handmade rugs, 326–28 folk rugs, 325–26 machine-made rugs, 328 natural iber rugs, 328–30, 329f Rush furniture, 233 Ruskin, John, 438 Rusticated, 388, 398 Rustic European style, 26, 27f R-value, 42 Rya rugs, 326

S Saarinen, Eero, 443 Safety, 12, 13 contract buildings, 203–04, 203f environmental, 26t loor materials, 311 lighting, 121 Sailcloth, 354 Salon design, 28t Saltbox roofs, 391 Salt Lake City International Airport, 375f San Carlos de Borromeo, 419, 419t Sandstone, 278t San José y Miguel de Aguayo, 419 San Xavier del Bac, 419 Saran, 334 Saridis S. A., 379 Sash curtains, 29t Sash window (nine over nine), 263f Sash windows, 263, 264, 394 Sateen, 340t, 354 Satin, 339f, 340t, 431, 354 Satin weave, 340t Sausage turnings, 405 Savonarola chair, 389t, 390 Savonnerie rugs, 326, 327f Scale, 54–55, 54t of architecture, 55 of furniture, 54f, 55f Scandinavian and mid-century furniture classics, 443–44, 445t Scandinavian book case, continued use, 36f Scandinavian modern style, 78, 80f Scandinavian rya rugs, 326f Scheduling, 184, 185 Schematics, 14 Schifli, 354 Schools of art, 358 Sconces, 114–15, 115f, 117t, 118f, 368, 368f Scottish Lomond Clan Tartan, 338f Screens, 366–67, 366f, 377f Scrim, 354 Scroll pediments, 390f, 399 Sculpture, 358 Sculptured multilevel textures, 320, 321f Sea shells, 371, 371f Season, affect on color, 83 Seasonal affective disorder (SAD), 109–10 Secondary focal point, 214 Secondary hues, 84–85 Secretary, 229f, 236f, 247t, 399 Security, 12, 260 Security systems, 12, 126, 127 Seersucker, 354 Segmental pediments, 382t, 394 Self-valanced shades, 305 Semianiline (protected) aniline, 232 Semiantique oriental rugs, 323 Semi-detached house plan, 178f Semi-detached houses, 179 Semi-housed stair, 254f, 265, 265f curved, 266f Sepia-toned photography, 360 Serge, 354 Sericulture, 334 Serigraphy, 359 Serpentine-shaped, 398 Service/storage cabinetry, 148t Set design, 28t Settees, 237f, 244 Seventeenth-century English medieval style (1608–95), 391–94, 391f, 392t–93t Sevres blue, 402 Shade cloth, 354

507

Shades, 92, 293, 294, 296, 297f, 300t, 304t, 305, 305f, 306f, 308, 308 Shade trees, and energy conservation, 42 Shading devices, 195, 196, 198, 293–94, 296 Shadows-on-the-Teche, 409t Shag carpets, 321, 321f Shaker candlestand, 416t Shaker chair, 416t, 417f Shaker design, 416t Shaker rocker, 416t Shakers, inluence, 416–17 Shake shingles, 187 Shantung, 354 Shape. See Form Shaped valances, 301t Shed ceilings, 270 Sheer draperies, 298t Sheer fabric, 354 Sheetrock, 188, 188f, 269, 276t, 284, 295f Sheet vinyl, 310, 316, 316f, 317t Shellac, 230 Sheraton, Thomas: The Cabinet-Maker and Upholsterer’s Drawing Book, 402 Sheraton Square-back chair, 404t Shibusa, 88, 434 Shingles, 181 Shingle-style, Kragsyde, 414t Shirred, 290, 295f, 296, 298t, 299t, 301t Shoji screens, 259, 259f, 305t, 367, 367f, 433 Shopping malls and retail stores, space planning, 186–87 Showcase homes, 73 Showroom designer, 28t Showrooms, 22, 341–42 “Sick-building syndrome,” 39–40, 203 Side chairs, 242t, 395 Sidelights, 260, 263, 263f, 402, 403t Signage graphics, 27t Silhouette lighting, 108 Silhouette shades, 111f Silk, 336t Silkscreen, 359–60 Silver, 364 Silvering, 362 Silver plate, 364 Simpliication and organization, 75 Simultaneous contrast, 94 Single family residence (SFR), 173 Single glazing, 260, 260f Single-hung sash window, 263 Sinks, 150t Sinuous wire (no-sag) springs, 233f, 234 Sisal, 334 Sisal mats, 330 Site, 10–11, 172–73 Site plans, 184 Skins, 198 Skylights, 41, 110, 116, 119f, 197, 202f, 263, 263f Skype, 23 Skyscrapers, 198, 201f, 432 Slab, 280t Slab stone, 312t–13t Slab system, 199t Slash-and-burn farming, 38 Slate, 277f, 313t Slate roofs, 385 Sleigh bed, 249t Sliding glass door, 256, 256f, 257 Sliding windows, 264, 264f Slipcovers, 235 Slubs, 355 Small spaces, 62 Smoke detectors, 12, 125f, 126, 126f Smoking, 40 Social distance, 210, 211, 211f Social networking sites, 23 Social zones, 130–31, 130f

508

Index

Sofas, 244t–45t Sofit lighting, 113t Soft loor coverings, carpeting, 315–30 Soft sculpture, 370 Soft window coverings, 296 Softwood, 228 Soil-release, 341 Soil-repellent i nish, 341 Solar design, 28t Solar energy, 196 Solar exposure, 196, 197f Solar gain, 260, 308, 308f Solar greenhouses, 196f, 197–98 Solarium, 110, 197f Solar shades, 308f Solar systems, 195–98 active, 195 Solid, 229 Solid core, 256 Solo grouping, 220f, 222, 222f Soluble i nishes, 341 Sound board, 187 Sound waves, 11 Southwest adobe style, 419–21, 420t–21t, 420f Southwest textiles, 421t Spa Café, Cliff Lodge, Snowbird, Utah, 101f Space frames, 199t Space heating, 190, 195 Space planning brainstorming, 131–32 children’s spaces, 155–56, 156f contract considerations, 68 economic considerations, 135–38 entry or foyer, 138 factors that affect economy, 136–38 family bathrooms, 154, 155f features and beneits, 138 for lexibility, 162–64 formal living spaces, 138 functional analysis, 130–31 for furniture arrangement, 216–17 hobby and special-use areas, 158 home ofice, 138–43 indoor-outdoor living, 156–57, 156f interrelating functions, 131 kitchen and great room, 144–46 laundry room, 146–52 library, 143–44 living with less space, 159–61, 160f, 161f long-range, 137 making large spaces seem smaller, 161–62, 162f master suite, 152–54 media and entertainment rooms, 157–58, 157f new construction versus remodeling, 132–35 and the principles and elements of design, 159–64 prioritizing needs and wants, 130–38 residential, for the human scale, 137t shaping, 172 space-reducing devices, 162 space requirements, 8 space-restricting devices, 62 space-saving devices, 160–61 storage, 158–59 stretching space, 160–61, 161f trafic patterns, 162, 163f, 168 unequal allotment, 62 Spanish colonial style, 78 Spanish colonial, 426–30 furniture, 430t interior, 430t textiles, 430t Spanish missions, 419 Special design considerations, as fundamental goals, 52 Special needs users, considerations for, 44–45

Special populations, design for, 45–52 elderly, 50–51 hearing impaired, 49 motion impaired, 45–49 other populations, 51 visually impaired, 49–50 Special-use areas, 158, 158f Speciication software, 23 Speciications, 6t, 14–15, 184, 198 Spectral colors, 82, 83 Spectral energy distribution, 83 Spectral light, 82, 83 Spinnerette, 334, 334t Spiral staircase, 265, 266f Split complementary color scheme, 84f, 86 Split entry, 173 Split level, 177f Split spindles, 391 Sponge rubber pads, 321 Sponging, 288t Spotlights, 105f, 106, 106f, 107, 125f Springs, for upholstered furniture, 234 Square footage, 171–72 calculation of, 171f proportional to the cost of the building or home, 135 St. Paul’s Cathedral, 394 Stability, 12 Stacking washer and dryer, 152f Stained glass, 305t, 385 Stainless steel, 231, 364, 365f Stains, 230, 232 Staircases, 264–66, 264f, 266f components, 264f traditional, 265 Standard Color-Wheel Theory, 84–86, 84f Standard i nishes, 341 Standard ring top panel, 299t Stanton Hall, Natchez, Mississippi, 408f Starting step, 265 State House, Richmond, Virginia, 402 Steel A 588, 231 for contract furniture and ittings, 231 weathering, 231 Steel-framed houses, 186 Stemware, 364 Steps, 46 Sterling II, 364 Sterling silver, 364 Stewardship, 36 Stickley, Gustav, 434, 438 Stickley armchair, 437t Stickley cabinet, 437t Stickley settee, 437t Stick style, 414t Stiles, 252, 256 Stock plans, 170, 181 Stone, 277f, 278f, 278t–79t, 307f Stone-enders, 391, 392t Stone looring, 312t–13t Stoneware, 363 Storage, 158–59, 158f, 159f, 195 Storm windows, 260 Stoves, 269 Straight (horizontal or vertical) lines, 66t Straight-line grouping, 218, 218f Straight lines, 66t–67t Straight-run stair, 254f, 265, 265f, 266f Stretchers, 391 Strié, 355 Stringcourse, 394 Stringer, 264, 265f Strip lighting, 105, 106, 114t Structural building components and systems, 186–91 acoustics, 192

contract buildings, 199t–200t for contract interiors, 198–204 foundation, 186 framing, 186–87 HVAC systems, 190–92 interior i nish components, 188–89 interior systems, 187 plumbing systems, 189–90 Structural design, 70, 70f Structural lighting, 113 Structural soundness, 180, 181 Structured wiring, 122 Stylobate, 378 Subcontractors, 16–17, 24f, 184–85 hiring yourself, 184–85 Subloors, 185f, 311 Subtractive color theory, 82 Subway tile, 289f Suede, 232 Suedecloth, 355 Sundials, 365 Sunlower chest, 393t Sun tunnel, 119f Superinsulated structure, 187 Surface-mounted downlights, 114t Surface-mounted luminaires, 114, 117t Surface treatment i nishes, 341 Surrounds, 189, 267 Suspended ceilings, 203f, 273, 273f Suspended luminaires, 114, 115f, 117t, 118f Sustainability, 34–37, 198 Swag Chair and desk, 27f Swag holders, 303t Swags, 301t, 304t Swamp cooler, 192 Swedish inluence, 417, 417f Swinging doors, 162 Swiss fabric, 355 Switched outlets, 125, 125f Switches, 124–26 Symbols for appliances, walls, stairs, and mechanical support equipment, 174f door and window, 174f plumbing ixture, 174f Symmetrical (formal) balance, 54t, 56f, 57 Symmetrical furniture groupings, 212f, 213 Symmetry, 57f Synthetic ibers, 336t Systems furniture, 26f, 38, 220f, 240–41, 241f maintenance of, 26f planning for, 225

T Tab curtains, 299t Table desk, 246t Table lamps, 116, 119t, 367–68, 368f Table linens, 369 Tableware, 362–65 Tableware storage cabinetry, 147t Tackless strips, 321, 321f Taffeta, 355 Tall case clock, 246t Tapestry, 355, 369–70 Tar paper, 187 Task lighting, 105f, 106, 107f Tatami, 330, 435t Tea caddies, 367 Tea table, 248t Technical drawing, 20 Technology, 121–27 Technology tools, 170 Telecommunication device for the deaf (TDD), 49 Telephone conferencing, 23

Index

Telephone systems, 11, 127 Tempera, 359 Tempered glass doors, 256 Tensile systems, 200t Terrace houses (row houses), 402 Terrazzo, 312t Territoriality, 212–13, 224f Territorial style, 421, 421t, 422f Terry, 340t, 355 Tesserae, 359 Tetrad complement colors, 86 Textile art, 328f Textile design, 28t Textiles, 369–70 Texture, 55t, 62, 66–67, 66f of carpeting, 320–21, 320f–21f and color, 91 fabrics, 344, 346t and upkeep, 67 wall, 284t, 289f for warning visually impaired, 49, 49f, 50f Textured polyester, 355 Texturizing, 188 Texturizing ibers, 334 Thatched, 385, 385f THE Chair, 444, 445t Thematic interior design, 80 Theory of design, 54, 54t Therapeutic light devices, 110 Thermal pane, 260 Thermoplastics, 232 Thermoset plastics, 232 Thermosiphoning, 196, 196f Thermostat, 190, 195 Thiel, Philip: Visual Awareness and Design, 193 Thin shell membranes, 200t Thonet, Michael, 432 Thoroughgood House, 392t Three-dimension shapes, 55t, 63 Three-part casement window with leaded panes, 393t Tibetan rugs, 324, 324f Ticking, 355 Tieback draperies, 56, 298t Tieback holder, 303t Tiered curtains, 298t Tightly curved lines, 67t Tight superinsulation, 187 Tile, 280t–81t, 313t–14t looring, 310f installation costs for, 310 Tilt-top table, 248t Timber-framed houses, 385, 385f Tints, 89 Titlement, 22 Title registration, 24 Tobacco smoke, 40, 41t Toe-kick lighting, 113t Toe-mold lighting, 113t Toile, 355 Toilet diagonal approach, 48f side approach, 48f Tokonoma, 372, 434t Tones, 89 Tongue-and-groove paneling, 254, 255f Top grain leather, 232 Top treatments, 296 types of, 301t Torchère, 368 Town houses, 179, 181t, 405, 418, 422, 425 Tracery, 260, 385 Track lighting, 106, 114t Trademarks, 334 Trade names, 334 Trade resources, 22 Trafic patterns, 162, 170f

contract furniture arrangement, 225 contract spaces, 168 and furniture arrangement, 207–08, 207f Training specialists, 29t Transepts, 383 Transgenerational design, 37 Transition, 59 Transoms, 262f, 263, 263f, 367, 367f, 408, 409t Transportation design, 29t Transport, 195 Trash compactors, 150t Traverse rods, 296, 302t Travertine, 313t Tray ceiling, 270, 271f Treads, 264, 264f, 265f Triadic complement colors, 83f, 86 Triangular pediment, 382t, 394, 398 Tricot, 355 Triforium, 383, 383f, 384t Triglyphs, 379 Triple glazing, 260, 260f Triplex, 179 Tripod pedestal table, 416, 416t Trombe walls, 196, 196f, 197 Trompe l’oeil, 286t Trophies, 371 Tropical rain forests, 38 True Sun, 110 Truss system, 186 Tunnel skylight, 119t, 119f Tub chairs, 245t Tufted broadloom carpets, 320 Tufted carpets, 340t Tufted fabric, 355 Tufted upholstery, 235f, 245t Tungsten ilament, 104 Tungsten halogen lamp, 105 Turkish oriental rugs, 323f, 324, 324f Turnings, 391 Turnkey design, 29t Turrets, 264 Tuscan order, 379, 379f, 382t Tuscan style, 66f, 78, 431–32, 431t Tuscany (Toscana), 431 Tweed, 355 Twill weave, 338f, 340, 341 Twin homes, 178f, 179 Two-dimensional shapes, 55t, 63–64 Two Gray Hills rugs, 326 Two-inch metal blinds, 305t Two-story loor plans, 177f Tyron Palace, 399t

U Ultraviolet radiation, 102, 105 Undercabinet lighting, 105f, 116f Undercounter lighting, 109f Undertones, 89, 90, 93f, 96f Uniform Building Code (UBC), 19 Union cloth, 355 United Airlines terminal, O’Hare Airport, Chicago, 108f United East India Company, 386 Unity, 61 Universal and transgenerational design, 29t, 37, 146 and sustainability, 37 University of Virginia at Charlottesville Rotunda, 402 Upholstered cornices, 301t Upholstered furniture, 233–36, 235f Upholstered walls, 291t, 292, 292f Upholsterer, 23, 235f Upholstery process, 235f

509

Upkeep, loor materials, 311 Upkeep costs, doors, 255 Uplighters, 106f Urea formaldehyde, 228 Urethane foam carpet padding, 321 U.S. Green Building Council (USGBC), 38 Users, 6 U-shaped groupings, 215f, 219, 219f, 220f U-stair, 265, 266f Utility plans, 184

V Vacuformed plastics, 232 Valance lighting, 113t Valances, 301t, 302f, 304t Values, 87, 93 distribution, 92–93 distribution based on nature, 88 normal, 87t scale, 92f Vapor barrier plastic, 187 Variety, 61–62 Varnish, 230 Vaulted ceiling, 262, 269f, 270 Vaulted systems, 189t Vaults, 383 Vehicles, for painting, 358 Velux sun tunnel, 119f, 119t Veiling glare, 112, 112t Velour, 355 Velvet, 340t, 355–56 Velvet weave carpets, 320 Veneer, 228, 229 Venetian glass, 362 Venetian plaster, 289f Ventilation, 191 Verbal communication skills, 20, 22t Verdigris i nish, 231 Vernacular European design, 426–32 Vernacular Greek Revival, 409t Vernacular American design, 405–07, 406t-07t furniture classics, 405–06 Georgian design, 406t textiles, 407t Vertical lines, 65, 66t Vertical louvers, 293, 305t Vertical space, 216–17 Vestibules, 194 Vibrating simultaneous contrast, 94 Victorian Gothic Revival side chair, 415t Victorian Style, 75 Victorian age (1837–1901), 411–16 color, 416 design, 412t–16t furniture classics, 411–16 Renaissance Revival cabinet, 416t Renaissance Revival side chair, 416t textiles, 416t Victorian Belter/Rococo Revival armchair, 415t Victorian Belter/Rococo Revival table, 416t Videoconferencing, 23 Vienna cafe chair, 432, 433t Vienna Secession, 432 View, 11, 172f Vigas, 118f, 271, 419, 421t Villa Rotonda, 388, 389t Vinyl, 232, 316t, 334t, 337t, 356 composition, 316t fabric, 356 resilient sheet looring, 317t tile, 317t Virtual meeting software, 23 Virtual reality, 32

510

Index

Viscose-solution stage, 334 Visual acuity, 82 Visual communication skills, 20 Visual impairment, unobstructed walking space for those with, 50f Visual proportion, 217 Visual weight, 212, 213 Vita-Light, 110 Vitruvian proportions, 381 Vitruvius, 381 Voile, 356 Volatile organic compounds (VOCs), 39–40 Volt or voltage, 112t Voluntary Simplicity, 36 Volutes, 264f, 265, 379, 380

W Wainscot, 252, 253f, 255 Wale, 340t Wall and ceiling materials, 252–54 contract considerations, 297, 306–08 hard or rigid wall materials, 277–87 moldings, 254–55, 255f overview of, 276t paint, 287–89 selection guidelines, 287 wood paneling, 252–54, 252f–54f Wallboard, 188, 188f, 276t, 284t Wall composition, 216–17 Wall coverings, 290–92 fabric, 292, 292f, 292t guidelines, 290 terms, 291t types of, 292t Wallpaper, 291t–92t Wall sconces, 114–15, 115f, 118f Wall textures, rough, 284t Wall-to-wall carpeting, 322f Wants, 130 Warm colors, 85, 88, 93, 93f, 96f Warm light, 82, 82f Warm white deluxe lamps, 103 Warps, carpet, 320 Warp yarns, 341 Warranties, 180 Wash, 106 Wassily lounge chair, 442t, 443 Waste management, 34 Waste plumbing, 190 Watercolor, 358, 373 Water conservation, 38 Water disposal systems, 189, 189f Waterfall Roman shade, 300t Water features, 140f Water heaters, 175f, 190, 196 Water intake system, 189 Waterprooi ng, the foundation, 186 Water-repellent i nish, 341 Wattle, 385 Watt or wattage, 40, 42, 112t Weather, 10 Weatherstripping, 194 Weaves, types of, 341 Web camera conferencing, 23 Wedgewood jasperware colors, 402 Weft, carpet, 320 Weft yarns, 341 Wegner, Hans, 444

Welts, 235 Wentz House, 418t Westover, 395f, 396t Wet i nishes, 341 Whaler’s Church, 413t Wheelchairs, space required for passage and turning, 46–48, 47f, 48f White, 90 Whitield House, 392t Whiton, Sherrill, 3 Wholesalers, 23 Wicker furniture, 233, 233f Wiener Werkstätte, 432 Wi-Fi , 123–24, 123f, 127f ad-hoc transmission, 126 hot spots, 122, 123, 126 William and Mary College, 394 William Morris textiles, 437t Williamsburg, Virginia, 394 Wilton carpets, 320 Windbreaks, 11 Windows, 187 architectural details, 259–64 attic, 264, 264f awning, 260, 261f bay, 261, 261f bow, 261, 261f casement, 261, 261f, 385, 394 cathedral, 262, 262f clerestory, 41, 261, 261f, 262f, 383, 384t, 385 and energy conservation, 42 ixed, 257f, 258f, 260, 261f French casement, 261f greenhouse, 262, 263f jalousie, 262, 263f with masonry, 187f operable, 260 and orientation, 260 Palladian, 260, 260f, 398, 400t porthole, 259f, 260, 261f and privacy, 260 round, 260 sash, 263, 263f, 394 sliding, 264, 264f storm, 260 three-part casement window with leaded panes, 393t transom, 262f, 263, 263f and view, 172f Windowsills, 189 Window ilm, 293–94, 294f Window treatments, 29t, 293–97 aesthetic coordination, 293 alternative, 296–97, 305t, 305f calculating yardage for, 304t considerations, 293–96 contract, 297, 306–08 and energy consciousness, 293–96 and glare control, 293f and light control, 296, 297f operational control, 293, 296, 306f privacy, 293, 297f, 306f shading devices, 293 soft window coverings, 296 types of alternative, 305t and UV control, 294, 294f Window wells, 186 Windsor chairs, 243t, 406, 407t Wing chairs, 245t, 395, 397t, 401t Wireless internet access (Wi-Fi), 127

Wireless voice applications (VoWLAN or WVOIP), 124, 126 Wiring plans, 124–26 lighting symbols for, 125f Wish list, 138, 139t–40t Wood, 186, 285t blinds, 305t exotic, 38 iller, 230 looring, 315t, 327t painted loor, 327f paneling, 252–54, 252f–54f, 285t planks, 285t, 285f, 314t, 326f rods, 303t shutters, 305t wood-framing system, 185f See also Wooden furniture Wood-burning stoves, 190, 191f Wooden furniture, 228–30 case goods, 228–29, 229f hardwood and softwood, 228 joining methods, 229–30 other forms of wood, 228 wood i nishes, 230 wood grains, 229 Wooden accessories, 364, 364f Wool, 335t Wool carpet ibers, 319t Working drawings, 14–15, 184 Working triangle, 146, 150f Work zones, 130, 131f World Financial Center, New York City, 60f Woven broadloom carpet, 320 Woven fabric construction, 340t Wren, Christopher, 390, 394 Wren-Baroque style, 394, 398 Wright, Frank Lloyd, 438, 438f Wrinkle-resistant, 341 Written program, 14 Wrought iron, 365, 365f Wrought iron rods, 302t

X X-frame chairs, 390

Y Yellow acetate lens, 51f

Z Zabuton, 434, 435t Zapatas, 421, 421t Zenlike space, 140f Zen philosophy, 433 Zero-clearance ireplace units, 190–91, 267 Zigzag lines, 65, 67t Zones and kitchen planning, 146 private, 130f, 131 social, 130, 130f within zone, 131 Zoning, and contract buildings, 164–68